Renesas H2215C Renesas 16-bit single-chip microcomputer h8s family/h8s/2200 sery Datasheet

The revision list can be viewed directly by clicking the title page.
The revision list summarizes the locations of revisions and
additions. Details should always be checked by referring to the
relevant text.
32
H8S/2215 Group
User's Manual: Hardware
Renesas 16-Bit Single-Chip Microcomputer
H8S Family/H8S/2200 Series
H8S/2215
H8S/2215R
H8S/2215T
H8S/2215C
HD64F2215
HD64F2215U
HD6432215B
HD6432215C
HD64F2215R
HD64F2215RU
HD64F2215T
HD64F2215TU
HD64F2215CU
Rev.9.00 Sep 2010
Notice
1.
All information included in this document is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is
subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas Electronics products listed herein, please
confirm the latest product information with a Renesas Electronics sales office. Also, please pay regular and careful attention to
additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas Electronics such as that disclosed through our website.
2.
Renesas Electronics does not assume any liability for infringement of patents, copyrights, or other intellectual property rights
of third parties by or arising from the use of Renesas Electronics products or technical information described in this document.
No license, express, implied or otherwise, is granted hereby under any patents, copyrights or other intellectual property rights
of Renesas Electronics or others.
3.
You should not alter, modify, copy, or otherwise misappropriate any Renesas Electronics product, whether in whole or in part.
4.
Descriptions of circuits, software and other related information in this document are provided only to illustrate the operation of
semiconductor products and application examples. You are fully responsible for the incorporation of these circuits, software,
and information in the design of your equipment. Renesas Electronics assumes no responsibility for any losses incurred by
you or third parties arising from the use of these circuits, software, or information.
5.
When exporting the products or technology described in this document, you should comply with the applicable export control
laws and regulations and follow the procedures required by such laws and regulations. You should not use Renesas
Electronics products or the technology described in this document for any purpose relating to military applications or use by
the military, including but not limited to the development of weapons of mass destruction. Renesas Electronics products and
technology may not be used for or incorporated into any products or systems whose manufacture, use, or sale is prohibited
under any applicable domestic or foreign laws or regulations.
6.
Renesas Electronics has used reasonable care in preparing the information included in this document, but Renesas Electronics
does not warrant that such information is error free. Renesas Electronics assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages
incurred by you resulting from errors in or omissions from the information included herein.
7.
Renesas Electronics products are classified according to the following three quality grades: "Standard", "High Quality", and
"Specific". The recommended applications for each Renesas Electronics product depends on the product's quality grade, as
indicated below. You must check the quality grade of each Renesas Electronics product before using it in a particular
application. You may not use any Renesas Electronics product for any application categorized as "Specific" without the prior
written consent of Renesas Electronics. Further, you may not use any Renesas Electronics product for any application for
which it is not intended without the prior written consent of Renesas Electronics. Renesas Electronics shall not be in any way
liable for any damages or losses incurred by you or third parties arising from the use of any Renesas Electronics product for an
application categorized as "Specific" or for which the product is not intended where you have failed to obtain the prior written
consent of Renesas Electronics. The quality grade of each Renesas Electronics product is "Standard" unless otherwise
expressly specified in a Renesas Electronics data sheets or data books, etc.
"Standard":
Computers; office equipment; communications equipment; test and measurement equipment; audio and visual
equipment; home electronic appliances; machine tools; personal electronic equipment; and industrial robots.
"High Quality": Transportation equipment (automobiles, trains, ships, etc.); traffic control systems; anti-disaster systems; anticrime systems; safety equipment; and medical equipment not specifically designed for life support.
"Specific":
Aircraft; aerospace equipment; submersible repeaters; nuclear reactor control systems; medical equipment or
systems for life support (e.g. artificial life support devices or systems), surgical implantations, or healthcare
intervention (e.g. excision, etc.), and any other applications or purposes that pose a direct threat to human life.
8.
You should use the Renesas Electronics products described in this document within the range specified by Renesas Electronics,
especially with respect to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation
characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas Electronics shall have no liability for malfunctions or
damages arising out of the use of Renesas Electronics products beyond such specified ranges.
9.
Although Renesas Electronics endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, semiconductor products have
specific characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use conditions. Further,
Renesas Electronics products are not subject to radiation resistance design. Please be sure to implement safety measures to
guard them against the possibility of physical injury, and injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a
Renesas Electronics product, such as safety design for hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire
control and malfunction prevention, appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other appropriate measures. Because
the evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or system
manufactured by you.
10.
Please contact a Renesas Electronics sales office for details as to environmental matters such as the environmental
compatibility of each Renesas Electronics product. Please use Renesas Electronics products in compliance with all applicable
laws and regulations that regulate the inclusion or use of controlled substances, including without limitation, the EU RoHS
Directive. Renesas Electronics assumes no liability for damages or losses occurring as a result of your noncompliance with
applicable laws and regulations.
11.
This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written consent of Renesas
Electronics.
12.
Please contact a Renesas Electronics sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this
document or Renesas Electronics products, or if you have any other inquiries.
(Note 1) "Renesas Electronics" as used in this document means Renesas Electronics Corporation and also includes its majorityowned subsidiaries.
(Note 2) "Renesas Electronics product(s)" means any product developed or manufactured by or for Renesas Electronics.
Page ii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products
The following usage notes are applicable to all MPU/MCU products from Renesas. For detailed usage notes
on the products covered by this manual, refer to the relevant sections of the manual. If the descriptions under
General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products and in the body of the manual differ from each
other, the description in the body of the manual takes precedence.
1. Handling of Unused Pins
Handle unused pins in accord with the directions given under Handling of Unused Pins in
the manual.
⎯ The input pins of CMOS products are generally in the high-impedance state. In
operation with an unused pin in the open-circuit state, extra electromagnetic noise is
induced in the vicinity of LSI, an associated shoot-through current flows internally, and
malfunctions may occur due to the false recognition of the pin state as an input signal.
Unused pins should be handled as described under Handling of Unused Pins in the
manual.
2. Processing at Power-on
The state of the product is undefined at the moment when power is supplied.
⎯ The states of internal circuits in the LSI are indeterminate and the states of register
settings and pins are undefined at the moment when power is supplied.
In a finished product where the reset signal is applied to the external reset pin, the
states of pins are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the
reset process is completed.
In a similar way, the states of pins in a product that is reset by an on-chip power-on
reset function are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the
power reaches the level at which resetting has been specified.
3. Prohibition of Access to Reserved Addresses
Access to reserved addresses is prohibited.
⎯ The reserved addresses are provided for the possible future expansion of functions. Do
not access these addresses; the correct operation of LSI is not guaranteed if they are
accessed.
4. Clock Signals
After applying a reset, only release the reset line after the operating clock signal has
become stable. When switching the clock signal during program execution, wait until the
target clock signal has stabilized.
⎯ When the clock signal is generated with an external resonator (or from an external
oscillator) during a reset, ensure that the reset line is only released after full stabilization
of the clock signal. Moreover, when switching to a clock signal produced with an
external resonator (or by an external oscillator) while program execution is in progress,
wait until the target clock signal is stable.
5. Differences between Products
Before changing from one product to another, i.e. to one with a different type number,
confirm that the change will not lead to problems.
⎯ The characteristics of MPU/MCU in the same group but having different type numbers
may differ because of the differences in internal memory capacity and layout pattern.
When changing to products of different type numbers, implement a system-evaluation
test for each of the products.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page iii of liv
Configuration of This Manual
This manual comprises the following items:
1. General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products
2. Configuration of This Manual
3. Preface
4. Main Revisions for This Edition
The history of revisions is a summary of sections that have been revised and sections that have
been added to earlier versions. This does not include all of the revised contents. For details,
confirm by referring to the main description of this manual.
5. Contents
6. Overview
7. Table of Contents
8. Summary
9. Description of Functional Modules
•
CPU and System-Control Modules
•
On-Chip Peripheral Modules
The configuration of the functional description of each module differs according to the
module. However, the generic style includes the following items:
i) Features
ii) I/O pins
iii) Description of Registers
iv) Description of Operation
v) Usage: Points for Caution
When designing an application system that includes this LSI, take the points for caution into
account. Each section includes points for caution in relation to the descriptions given, and points
for caution in usage are given, as required, as the final part of each section.
10. List of Registers
11. Electrical Characteristics
12. Appendix
•
Product-type codes and external dimensions
Page iv of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Preface
This LSI is a high-performance microcomputer (MCU) made up of the H8S/2000 CPU with
Renesas’ original architecture as its core, and the peripheral functions required to configure a
system.
The H8S/2000 CPU has an internal 32-bit configuration, sixteen 16-bit general registers, and a
simple and optimized instruction set for high-speed operation. The H8S/2000 CPU can handle a
16-Mbyte linear address space. The instruction set of the H8S/2000 CPU maintains upward
compatibility at the object level with the H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs. This allows the H8/300,
H8/300L, or H8/300H user to easily utilize the H8S/2000 CPU.
This LSI is equipped with ROM, RAM, a direct memory access controller (DMAC), a bus master
for a data transfer controller (DTC), a 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU), an 8-bit timer (TMR), a
watchdog timer (WDT), a universal serial bus (USB), two types of serial communication
interfaces (SCIs), an A/D converter, a D/A converter, and I/O ports as on-chip peripheral modules
for system configuration.
A single-power flash memory (F-ZTAT™*) version and masked ROM version are available for
this LSI’s ROM. The F-ZTAT version provides flexibility as it can be reprogrammed in no time to
cope with all situations from the early stages of mass production to full-scale mass production.
This is particularly applicable to application devices with specifications that will most probably
change.
This manual describes this LSI’s hardware.
Note: * F-ZTAT is a trademark of Renesas Electronics Corp.
Target Users: This manual was written for users who will be using the H8S/2215 Group in the
design of application systems. Target users are expected to understand the
fundamentals of electrical circuits, logical circuits, and microcomputers.
Objective:
This manual was written to explain the hardware functions and electrical
characteristics of the H8S/2215 Group to the target users.
Refer to the H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual, for a detailed
description of the instruction set.
Notes on reading this manual:
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page v of liv
• In order to understand the overall functions of the chip
Read the manual according to the contents. This manual can be roughly categorized into parts
on the CPU, system control functions, peripheral functions and electrical characteristics.
• In order to understand the details of the CPU’s functions
Read the H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual.
• In order to understand the details of a register when its name is known
Read the index that is the final part of the manual to find the page number of the entry on the
register. The addresses, bits, and initial values of the registers are summarized in appendix A,
I/O Port States in Each Processing State.
Examples:
Related Manuals:
Register name:
The following notation is used for cases when the same or a
similar function, e.g. 16-bit timer pulse unit or serial
communication, is implemented on more than one channel:
XXX_N (XXX is the register name and N is the channel
number)
Bit order:
The MSB is on the left and the LSB is on the right.
The latest versions of all related manuals are available from our web site.
Please ensure you have the latest versions of all documents you require.
http://www.renesas.com/eng/
H8S/2215 Group Manuals:
Document Title
Document No.
H8S/2215 Group Hardware Manual
This manual
H8S/2600 Series, H8S/2000 Series Software Manual
REJ09B0139
User’s Manuals for Development Tools:
Document Title
Document No.
H8S, H8/300 Series C/C++ Compiler, Assembler, Optimizing Linkage Editor
User’s Manual
REJ10J2039
H8S, H8/300 Series Simulator/Debugger User’s Manual
REJ10B0211
High-performance Embedded Workshop User’s Manual
REJ10J2169
Page vi of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Main Revisions for This Edition
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
1.5 Pin Functions
17
Table amended
Pin No.
2.6.1 Table of
45
Instructions Classified
by Function
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Boundary
scan
TRST
109
B5
Function
Input
Reset pin for the TAP controller
Perform pin processing even when
the boundary scan function is not
used. For details, see 14.5, Usage
Notes.
Table amended
Instruction
Size*
Function
BAND
B
C ∧ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
ANDs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
Table 2.7 Bit
Manipulation
Instructions (1)
BIAND
B
C∧
[ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) ] → C
ANDs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register
or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number
is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
BOR
B
C ∨ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIOR
B
C ∨ [ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) ] → C
ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register
or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit number
is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
5.7.5 IRQ Interrupt
106
Description added
5.7.6 NMI Interrupts
Usage Notes
107
Description added
6.6.4 Wait Control
138
Description amended
Pin Wait Insertion: Setting the WAITE bit in BCRL to 1
enables wait insertion by means of the WAIT pin.
8.5 Operation
Figure 8.5 Flowchart
of DTC Operation
216
Figure amended
No
Transfer
counter = 0
or DISEL = 1
No
Yes
*2
Clear an active flag
Clear DTCER
End
Interrupt exception
handling
*1
Note: *1 For details on the processing that takes place, refer to the chapter on the peripheral module in question.
*2 When IRQx is the DTC activation source and the IRQ sense control registers (ISCRH and ISCRL) are
set to level sensing, the activation source flag is not cleared while IRQx is low level and DTC transfers
are performed repeatedly.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page vii of liv
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
15.3.2 USB Control
Register (UCTLR)
505
Table amended
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
1
UIFRST
1
R/W
Description
USB Interface Software Reset
Controls USB module internal reset. When the
UIFRST bit is set to 1, the USB internal modules other
than UCTLR, UIER3, and the CK48 READY bit of
UIFR3 are all reset. At initialization, the UIFRST bit
must be cleared to 0 after the USB operating clock
stabilization time has passed following USB module
stop mode cancellation.
0: Sets the USB internal modules to the operating state
(at initialization, this bit must be cleared after the
USB operating clock stabilization time has passed).
1: Sets the USB internal modules other than UCTLR,
UIER3, and the CK48 READY bit of UIFR3 reset
state.
If after being cleared to 0 the UIFIRST bit is again set
to 1, the UDCRST bit must also be set to 1 at the same
time.
16.2 Input/Output
Pins
603
Table amended
Pin Name
Symbol
I/O
Function
Analog input pin 0
AN0*
Input
Analog input pins
Analog input pin 1
AN1*
Input
Note added
Note:
16.5.1 Single Mode
609
Figure 16.3 A/D
Conversion Timing
(Single-Chip Mode,
Channel 1 Selected)
AN0 and AN1 can be used only when Vcc = AVcc.
ADDRA
Read conversion result*
A/D conversion result 1
ADDRB
Read conversion result*
A/D conversion result 2
ADDRC
16.8.3 Range of
616
Analog Power Supply
and Other Pin Settings
24.3 DC
Characteristics
*
Figure amended
727
Description amended
•
Relationship between AVcc, AVss and Vcc, Vss
Set AVss = Vss as the relationship between AVcc, AVss
and Vcc, Vss. If the A/D converter is not used, the AVcc and
AVss pins must not be left open. In addition, AN0 and AN1
can be used only when Vcc = AVcc.
Table amended
Item
Table 24.2 DC
Characteristics
Input high
voltage
729
Symbol Min.
Ports 4* and 9 VIH
6
VCC × 0.8
Typ.
Max.
Unit
—
AVCC + 0.3* V
Test
Conditions
6
Note added
5. The FWE pin is effective only in the F-ZTAT version.
6. When VCC < AVCC, the maximum value for P40 and P41 is
VCC + 0.3 V.
Page viii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Item
Page
24.6 A/D Conversion 749
Characteristics
Table 24.9 A/D
Conversion
Characteristics
Revision (See Manual for Details)
Conditions added
Conditions: VCC = PLLVCC = DrVCC = 2.7 V to 3.6 V*, AVCC = 2.7
V to 3.6 V*, Vref = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = PLLVSS = DrVSS = AVSS = 0
V, φ = 13 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Note added
Note: * AN0 and AN1 can be used only when VCC = AVCC.
25.3 DC
Characteristics
755
Table amended
Item
Table 25.2 DC
Characteristics
Input high
voltage
757
Symbol Min.
6
Ports* 4 and 9 VIH
VCC × 0.8
Typ.
—
Test
Unit Conditions
6
*
AVCC + 0.3
V
Max.
Note added
3. ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.67 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB halted)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.85 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB operating, f = 16 MHz : PLL 3 ×
multiplication)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.72 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB operating, f = 24 MHz : PLL 2 ×
multiplication)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.55 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f (sleep
mode)
5. The FWE pin is effective only in the F-ZTAT version.
6. When VCC < AVCC, the maximum value for P40 and P41 is
VCC + 0.3 V.
25.6 A/D Conversion 778
Characteristics
Table 25.9 A/D
Conversion
Characteristics
Conditions added
Condition A: VCC = PLLVCC = DrVCC = 2.7 V to 3.6 V*, AVCC = 2.7
V to 3.6 V*, Vref = 2.7 V to AVCC, VSS = PLLVSS = DrVSS = AVSS = 0
V, φ = 13 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B: VCC = PLLVCC = DrVCC = 3.0 V to 3.6 V*, AVCC = 3.0
V to 3.6 V*, Vref = 3.0 V to AVCC, VSS = PLLVSS = DrVSS = AVSS = 0
V, φ = 13 MHz to 24 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Note added
Note: * AN0 and AN1 can be used only when VCC = AVCC.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page ix of liv
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
26.3 DC
Characteristics
784
Table amended
Item
Table 26.2 DC
Characteristics
Input high
voltage
786
Symbol Min.
6
Ports* 4 and 9 VIH
VCC × 0.8
Typ.
—
Test
Unit Conditions
6
*
AVCC + 0.3
V
Max.
Note added
3. ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.67 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB halted)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.85 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB operating, f = 16 MHz : PLL 3 ×
multiplication)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.72 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB operating, f = 24 MHz : PLL 2 ×
multiplication)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.55 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f (sleep
mode)
6. When VCC < AVCC, the maximum value for P40 and P41 is
VCC + 0.3 V.
26.6 A/D Conversion 804
Characteristics
Table 26.9 A/D
Conversion
Characteristics
Conditions added
Conditions: VCC = PLLVCC = DrVCC = 3.0 V to 3.6 V*, AVCC = 3.0
V to 3.6 V*, Vref = 3.0 V to AVCC, VSS = PLLVSS = DrVSS = AVSS = 0
V, φ = 16 MHz to, 24 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Note added
Note: * AN0 and AN1 can be used only when VCC = AVCC.
27.3 DC
Characteristics
Table 27.2 DC
Characteristics
Page x of liv
809
Table amended
Item
Input high
voltage
Symbol Min.
Ports* 4 and 9 VIH
6
VCC × 0.8
Typ.
Max.
—
AVCC + 0.3*
Test
Unit Conditions
6
V
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
27.3 DC
Characteristics
811
Note added
Table 27.2 DC
Characteristics
3. ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.67 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB halted)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.85 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB operating, f = 16 MHz : PLL 3 ×
multiplication)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.72 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f
(normal operation, USB operating, f = 24 MHz : PLL 2 ×
multiplication)
ICC (max.) = 1.0 (mA) + 0.55 (mA/(MHz x V)) × VCC × f (sleep
mode)
5. The FWE pin is supported on the F-ZTAT version only.
6. When VCC < AVCC, the maximum value for P40 and P41 is
VCC + 0.3 V.
27.6 A/D Conversion 831
Characteristics
Table 27.9 A/D
Conversion
Characteristics
Conditions added
Conditions: VCC = PLLVCC = DrVCC = 3.0 V to 3.6 V*, AVCC = 3.0
V to 3.6 V*, Vref = 3.0 V to AVCC, VSS = PLLVSS = DrVSS = AVSS = 0
V, φ = 16 MHz to 24 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Note added
Note: * AN0 and AN1 can be used only when VCC = AVCC.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xi of liv
All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Page xii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Contents
Section 1 Overview .................................................................................................................. 1
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
Overview............................................................................................................................... 1
Internal Block Diagram......................................................................................................... 3
Pin Arrangement ................................................................................................................... 4
Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode ................................................................................ 6
Pin Functions ...................................................................................................................... 11
Section 2 CPU ......................................................................................................................... 23
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
Features............................................................................................................................... 23
2.1.1
Differences between H8S/2600 CPU and H8S/2000 CPU ................................. 24
2.1.2
Differences from H8/300 CPU ........................................................................... 25
2.1.3
Differences from H8/300H CPU......................................................................... 25
CPU Operating Modes........................................................................................................ 26
2.2.1
Normal Mode...................................................................................................... 26
2.2.2
Advanced Mode.................................................................................................. 28
Address Space..................................................................................................................... 30
Register Configuration........................................................................................................ 31
2.4.1
General Registers ................................................................................................ 32
2.4.2
Program Counter (PC) ........................................................................................ 33
2.4.3
Extended Control Register (EXR) ...................................................................... 33
2.4.4
Condition-Code Register (CCR) ......................................................................... 34
2.4.5
Initial Register Values......................................................................................... 35
Data Formats....................................................................................................................... 36
2.5.1
General Register Data Formats ........................................................................... 36
2.5.2
Memory Data Formats ........................................................................................ 38
Instruction Set ..................................................................................................................... 39
2.6.1
Table of Instructions Classified by Function ...................................................... 40
2.6.2
Basic Instruction Formats ................................................................................... 49
Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation....................................................... 50
2.7.1
Register Direct—Rn............................................................................................ 51
2.7.2
Register Indirect—@ERn ................................................................................... 51
2.7.3
Register Indirect with Displacement—@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:32, ERn)............. 51
2.7.4
Register Indirect with Post-Increment or Pre-Decrement—@ERn+ or @-ERn.... 51
2.7.5
Absolute Address—@aa:8, @aa:16, @aa:24, or @aa:32................................... 51
2.7.6
Immediate—#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32 ................................................................ 52
2.7.7
Program-Counter Relative—@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC)................................... 52
2.7.8
Memory Indirect—@@aa:8 ............................................................................... 53
2.7.9
Effective Address Calculation ............................................................................ 54
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xiii of liv
2.8
2.9
Processing States ................................................................................................................ 56
Usage Notes ........................................................................................................................ 58
2.9.1
Note on TAS Instruction Usage .......................................................................... 58
2.9.2
STM/LTM Instruction Usage ............................................................................. 58
2.9.3
Note on Bit Manipulation Instructions................................................................ 58
2.9.4
Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits............................................... 60
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes ..................................................................................... 63
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
Operating Mode Selection .................................................................................................. 63
Register Descriptions.......................................................................................................... 64
3.2.1
Mode Control Register (MDCR) ........................................................................ 64
3.2.2
System Control Register (SYSCR) ..................................................................... 64
Operating Mode Descriptions ............................................................................................. 66
3.3.1
Mode 4 ................................................................................................................ 66
3.3.2
Mode 5 ................................................................................................................ 66
3.3.3
Mode 6 ................................................................................................................ 67
3.3.4
Mode 7 ................................................................................................................ 67
3.3.5
Pin Functions ...................................................................................................... 68
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode .............................................................................. 69
Section 4 Exception Handling ............................................................................................ 73
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7
4.8
Exception Handling Types and Priority.............................................................................. 73
Exception Sources and Exception Vector Table................................................................. 73
Reset ................................................................................................................................... 75
4.3.1
Reset Types......................................................................................................... 75
4.3.2
Reset Exception Handling................................................................................... 76
4.3.3
Interrupts after Reset........................................................................................... 78
4.3.4
State of On-Chip Peripheral Modules after Reset Release ................................. 78
Traces.................................................................................................................................. 79
Interrupts............................................................................................................................. 79
Trap Instruction .................................................................................................................. 80
Stack Status after Exception Handling................................................................................ 81
Notes on Use of the Stack................................................................................................... 82
Section 5 Interrupt Controller ............................................................................................. 83
5.1
5.2
5.3
Features............................................................................................................................... 83
Input/Output Pins................................................................................................................ 85
Register Descriptions.......................................................................................................... 86
5.3.1
Interrupt Priority Registers A to G, I to K, M
(IPRA to IPRG, IPRI to IPRK, IPRM) ............................................................... 87
Page xiv of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.3.2
IRQ Enable Register (IER) ................................................................................. 88
5.3.3
IRQ Sense Control Registers H and L (ISCRH, ISCRL).................................... 89
5.3.4
IRQ Status Register (ISR)................................................................................... 91
Interrupt Sources................................................................................................................. 92
5.4.1
External Interrupts .............................................................................................. 92
5.4.2
Internal Interrupts................................................................................................ 93
Interrupt Exception Handling Vector Table........................................................................ 93
Interrupt Control Modes and Interrupt Operation ............................................................... 96
5.6.1
Interrupt Control Mode 0 .................................................................................... 96
5.6.2
Interrupt Control Mode 2 .................................................................................... 98
5.6.3
Interrupt Exception Handling Sequence ........................................................... 100
5.6.4
Interrupt Response Times ................................................................................. 101
5.6.5
DTC Activation by Interrupt............................................................................. 102
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 105
5.7.1
Contention between Interrupt Generation and Disabling.................................. 105
5.7.2
Instructions that Disable Interrupts ................................................................... 106
5.7.3
Times when Interrupts Are Disabled ................................................................ 106
5.7.4
Interrupts during Execution of EEPMOV Instruction....................................... 106
5.7.5
IRQ Interrupt..................................................................................................... 106
5.7.6
NMI Interrupts Usage Notes ............................................................................. 107
Section 6 Bus Controller .................................................................................................... 109
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
Features............................................................................................................................. 109
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 111
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 111
6.3.1
Bus Width Control Register (ABWCR)............................................................ 112
6.3.2
Access State Control Register (ASTCR) .......................................................... 113
6.3.3
Wait Control Registers H and L (WCRH, WCRL)........................................... 114
6.3.4
Bus Control Register H (BCRH) ...................................................................... 118
6.3.5
Bus Control Register L (BCRL) ....................................................................... 119
6.3.6
Pin Function Control Register (PFCR) ............................................................. 120
Bus Control ....................................................................................................................... 121
6.4.1
Area Divisions .................................................................................................. 121
6.4.2
Bus Specifications............................................................................................. 122
6.4.3
Bus Interface for Each Area.............................................................................. 123
6.4.4
Chip Select Signals ........................................................................................... 124
Basic Timing..................................................................................................................... 124
6.5.1
On-Chip Memory (ROM, RAM) Access Timing ............................................. 125
6.5.2
On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Timing..................................................... 126
6.5.3
External Address Space Access Timing ........................................................... 127
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xv of liv
6.6
6.7
6.8
6.9
6.10
6.11
Basic Bus Interface ........................................................................................................... 127
6.6.1
Data Size and Data Alignment.......................................................................... 127
6.6.2
Valid Strobes .................................................................................................... 128
6.6.3
Basic Timing..................................................................................................... 129
6.6.4
Wait Control ..................................................................................................... 138
urst ROM Interface ........................................................................................................... 139
6.7.1
Basic Timing..................................................................................................... 140
6.7.2
Wait Control ..................................................................................................... 141
Idle Cycle.......................................................................................................................... 142
Bus Release....................................................................................................................... 145
6.9.1
Notes on Bus Release ....................................................................................... 146
Bus Arbitration ................................................................................................................. 147
6.10.1
Operation .......................................................................................................... 147
6.10.2
Bus Transfer Timing......................................................................................... 147
6.10.3
External Bus Release Usage Note..................................................................... 148
Resets and the Bus Controller........................................................................................... 148
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC) .............................................................................. 149
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
Features............................................................................................................................. 149
Register Configuration...................................................................................................... 151
Register Descriptions........................................................................................................ 153
7.3.1
Memory Address Registers (MAR) .................................................................. 153
7.3.2
I/O Address Register (IOAR) ........................................................................... 153
7.3.3
Execute Transfer Count Register (ETCR) ........................................................ 154
7.3.4
DMA Control Register (DMACR) ................................................................... 155
7.3.5
DMA Band Control Register (DMABCR) ....................................................... 162
7.3.6
DMA Write Enable Register (DMAWER) ....................................................... 170
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 172
7.4.1
Transfer Modes................................................................................................. 172
7.4.2
Sequential Mode ............................................................................................... 173
7.4.3
Idle Mode.......................................................................................................... 176
7.4.4
Repeat Mode..................................................................................................... 178
7.4.5
Normal Mode.................................................................................................... 181
7.4.6
Block Transfer Mode ........................................................................................ 184
7.4.7
DMAC Activation Sources ............................................................................... 189
7.4.8
Basic DMAC Bus Cycles.................................................................................. 191
7.4.9
DMAC Bus Cycles (Dual Address Mode)........................................................ 192
7.4.10
DMAC Multi-Channel Operation ..................................................................... 197
7.4.11
Relation between the DMAC, External Bus Requests, and the DTC ............... 198
7.4.12
NMI Interrupts and DMAC .............................................................................. 198
Page xvi of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
7.5
7.6
7.4.13
Forced Termination of DMAC Operation......................................................... 199
7.4.14
Clearing Full Address Mode ............................................................................. 200
Interrupts........................................................................................................................... 201
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 202
7.6.1
DMAC Register Access during Operation........................................................ 202
7.6.2
Module Stop...................................................................................................... 203
7.6.3
Medium-Speed Mode........................................................................................ 203
7.6.4
Activation Source Acceptance .......................................................................... 204
7.6.5
Internal Interrupt after End of Transfer............................................................. 204
7.6.6
Channel Re-Setting ........................................................................................... 204
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC).................................................................... 205
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
Features............................................................................................................................. 205
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 207
8.2.1
DTC Mode Register A (MRA) ......................................................................... 208
8.2.2
DTC Mode Register B (MRB).......................................................................... 209
8.2.3
DTC Source Address Register (SAR)............................................................... 209
8.2.4
DTC Destination Address Register (DAR)....................................................... 209
8.2.5
DTC Transfer Count Register A (CRA) ........................................................... 210
8.2.6
DTC Transfer Count Register B (CRB)............................................................ 210
8.2.7
DTC Enable Registers (DTCERA to DTCERF)............................................... 210
8.2.8
DTC Vector Register (DTVECR)..................................................................... 211
Activation Sources............................................................................................................ 212
Location of Register Information and DTC Vector Table ................................................ 213
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 216
8.5.1
Normal Mode.................................................................................................... 218
8.5.2
Repeat Mode ..................................................................................................... 219
8.5.3
Block Transfer Mode ........................................................................................ 220
8.5.4
Chain Transfer .................................................................................................. 221
8.5.5
Interrupts........................................................................................................... 222
8.5.6
Operation Timing.............................................................................................. 222
8.5.7
Number of DTC Execution States .................................................................... 223
Procedures for Using DTC................................................................................................ 225
8.6.1
Activation by Interrupt...................................................................................... 225
8.6.2
Activation by Software ..................................................................................... 225
Examples of Use of the DTC ............................................................................................ 226
8.7.1
Normal Mode.................................................................................................... 226
8.7.2
Software Activation .......................................................................................... 226
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 227
8.8.1
Module Stop...................................................................................................... 227
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xvii of liv
8.8.2
8.8.3
8.8.4
On-Chip RAM .................................................................................................. 227
DTCE Bit Setting.............................................................................................. 227
DMAC Transfer End Interrupt.......................................................................... 227
Section 9 I/O Ports ............................................................................................................... 229
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
9.5
9.6
9.7
Port 1................................................................................................................................. 233
9.1.1
Port 1 Data Direction Register (P1DDR).......................................................... 233
9.1.2
Port 1 Data Register (P1DR)............................................................................. 234
9.1.3
Port 1 Register (PORT1)................................................................................... 234
9.1.4
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 235
Port 3................................................................................................................................. 238
9.2.1
Port 3 Data Direction Register (P3DDR).......................................................... 238
9.2.2
Port 3 Data Register (P3DR)............................................................................. 239
9.2.3
Port 3 Register (PORT3)................................................................................... 239
9.2.4
Port 3 Open-Drain Control Register (P3ODR) ................................................. 240
9.2.5
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 240
Port 4................................................................................................................................. 243
9.3.1
Port 4 Register (PORT4)................................................................................... 243
9.3.2
Pin Function...................................................................................................... 243
Port 7................................................................................................................................. 244
9.4.1
Port 7 Data Direction Register (P7DDR).......................................................... 244
9.4.2
Port 7 Data Register (P7DR)............................................................................. 245
9.4.3
Port 7 Register (PORT7)................................................................................... 245
9.4.4
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 246
Port 9................................................................................................................................. 247
9.5.1
Port 9 Register (PORT9)................................................................................... 247
9.5.2
Pin Function...................................................................................................... 247
Port A................................................................................................................................ 248
9.6.1
Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) ........................................................ 248
9.6.2
Port A Data Register (PADR)........................................................................... 249
9.6.3
Port A Register (PORTA) ................................................................................. 249
9.6.4
Port A MOS Pull-Up Control Register (PAPCR) ............................................. 250
9.6.5
Port A Open Drain Control Register (PAODR)................................................ 250
9.6.6
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 251
9.6.7
Port A Input Pull-Up MOS Function ................................................................ 253
Port B................................................................................................................................ 253
9.7.1
Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) ........................................................ 254
9.7.2
Port B Data Register (PBDR) ........................................................................... 254
9.7.3
Port B Register (PORTB) ................................................................................. 255
9.7.4
Port B MOS Pull-Up Control Register (PBPCR) ............................................. 255
Page xviii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
9.8
9.9
9.10
9.11
9.12
9.13
9.7.5
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 256
9.7.6
Port B Input Pull-Up MOS Function ................................................................ 258
Port C ................................................................................................................................ 258
9.8.1
Port C Data Direction Register (PCDDR) ........................................................ 259
9.8.2
Port C Data Register (PCDR) ........................................................................... 259
9.8.3
Port C Register (PORTC) ................................................................................. 260
9.8.4
Port C Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PCPCR).............................................. 260
9.8.5
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 261
9.8.6
Port C Input Pull-Up MOS Function ................................................................ 263
Port D................................................................................................................................ 263
9.9.1
Port D Data Direction Register (PDDDR) ........................................................ 264
9.9.2
Port D Data Register (PDDR) ........................................................................... 264
9.9.3
Port D Register (PORTD) ................................................................................. 265
9.9.4
Port D Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PDPCR) ............................................. 265
9.9.5
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 266
9.9.6
Port D Input Pull-Up MOS Function ................................................................ 267
Port E ................................................................................................................................ 268
9.10.1
Port E Data Direction Register (PEDDR) ......................................................... 268
9.10.2
Port E Data Register (PEDR)............................................................................ 269
9.10.3
Port E Register (PORTE).................................................................................. 269
9.10.4
Port E Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PEPCR) .............................................. 270
9.10.5
Pin Function...................................................................................................... 270
9.10.6
Port E Input Pull-Up MOS State....................................................................... 273
Port F ................................................................................................................................ 274
9.11.1
Port F Data Direction Register (PFDDR) ......................................................... 274
9.11.2
Port F Data Register (PFDR) ............................................................................ 275
9.11.3
Port F Register (PORTF) .................................................................................. 275
9.11.4
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 276
Port G................................................................................................................................ 278
9.12.1
Port G Data Direction Register (PGDDR) ........................................................ 278
9.12.2
Port G Data Register (PGDR) ........................................................................... 279
9.12.3
Port G Register (PORTG) ................................................................................. 279
9.12.4
Pin Functions .................................................................................................... 280
Handling of Unused Pins .................................................................................................. 281
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU) ................................................................... 283
10.1
10.2
10.3
Features............................................................................................................................. 283
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 287
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 288
10.3.1
Timer Control Register (TCR) .......................................................................... 289
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xix of liv
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7
10.8
10.3.2
Timer Mode Register (TMDR) ......................................................................... 293
10.3.3
Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR) .................................................................. 295
10.3.4
Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER) ........................................................... 304
10.3.5
Timer Status Register (TSR)............................................................................. 306
10.3.6
Timer Counter (TCNT)..................................................................................... 309
10.3.7
Timer General Register (TGR) ......................................................................... 309
10.3.8
Timer Start Register (TSTR) ............................................................................ 309
10.3.9
Timer Synchro Register (TSYR) ...................................................................... 310
Interface to Bus Master..................................................................................................... 311
10.4.1
16-Bit Registers ................................................................................................ 311
10.4.2
8-Bit Registers .................................................................................................. 311
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 313
10.5.1
Basic Functions................................................................................................. 313
10.5.2
Synchronous Operation..................................................................................... 319
10.5.3
Buffer Operation ............................................................................................... 320
10.5.4
PWM Modes ..................................................................................................... 324
10.5.5
Phase Counting Mode....................................................................................... 328
Interrupts........................................................................................................................... 333
10.6.1
Interrupt Source and Priority ............................................................................ 333
10.6.2
DTC Activation................................................................................................. 334
10.6.3
DMAC Activation............................................................................................. 334
10.6.4
A/D Converter Activation................................................................................. 334
Operation Timing.............................................................................................................. 335
10.7.1
Input/Output Timing ......................................................................................... 335
10.7.2
Interrupt Signal Timing .................................................................................... 339
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 342
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR) ....................................................................................... 349
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
11.5
Features............................................................................................................................. 349
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 351
Register Descriptions........................................................................................................ 351
11.3.1
Timer Counters (TCNT) ................................................................................... 351
11.3.2
Time Constant Registers A (TCORA) .............................................................. 352
11.3.3
Time Constant Registers B (TCORB) .............................................................. 352
11.3.4
Time Control Registers (TCR).......................................................................... 353
11.3.5
Timer Control/Status Registers (TCSR) ........................................................... 354
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 356
11.4.1
Pulse Output...................................................................................................... 356
Operation Timing.............................................................................................................. 357
11.5.1
TCNT Incrementation Timing .......................................................................... 357
Page xx of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
11.6
11.7
11.8
11.5.2
Setting of Compare Match Flags CMFA and CMFB ....................................... 358
11.5.3
Timer Output Timing........................................................................................ 358
11.5.4
Timing of Compare Match Clear ...................................................................... 359
11.5.5
Timing of TCNT External Reset....................................................................... 359
11.5.6
Timing of Overflow Flag (OVF) Setting .......................................................... 360
Operation with Cascaded Connection............................................................................... 361
11.6.1
16-Bit Counter Mode ........................................................................................ 361
11.6.2
Compare Match Count Mode............................................................................ 361
Interrupts........................................................................................................................... 362
11.7.1
Interrupt Sources and DTC Activation ............................................................. 362
11.7.2
A/D Converter Activation................................................................................. 363
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 363
11.8.1
Contention between TCNT Write and Clear..................................................... 363
11.8.2
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment ............................................. 364
11.8.3
Contention between TCOR Write and Compare Match ................................... 365
11.8.4
Contention between Compare Matches A and B .............................................. 366
11.8.5
Switching of Internal Clocks and TCNT Operation.......................................... 366
11.8.6
Mode Setting with Cascaded Connection ......................................................... 368
11.8.7
Module Stop Mode Setting ............................................................................... 368
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)............................................................................... 369
12.1
12.2
12.3
12.4
12.5
Features............................................................................................................................. 369
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 370
12.2.1
Timer Counter (TCNT)..................................................................................... 370
12.2.2
Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) ............................................................. 370
12.2.3
Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR) ......................................................... 372
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 373
12.3.1
Watchdog Timer Mode ..................................................................................... 373
12.3.2
Timing of Setting of Watchdog Timer Overflow Flag (WOVF) ...................... 374
12.3.3
Interval Timer Mode ......................................................................................... 375
12.3.4
Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF) ...................................................... 375
Interrupts........................................................................................................................... 376
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 376
12.5.1
Notes on Register Access.................................................................................. 376
12.5.2
Contention between Timer Counter (TCNT) Write and Increment .................. 378
12.5.3
Changing Value of CKS2 to CKS0................................................................... 378
12.5.4
Switching between Watchdog Timer Mode and Interval Timer Mode............. 378
12.5.5
Internal Reset in Watchdog Timer Mode.......................................................... 379
12.5.6
OVF Flag Clearing in Interval Timer Mode ..................................................... 379
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxi of liv
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface ................................................................. 381
13.1
13.2
13.3
13.4
13.5
13.6
13.7
Features............................................................................................................................. 381
13.1.1
Block Diagram.................................................................................................. 383
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 386
Register Descriptions........................................................................................................ 386
13.3.1
Receive Shift Register (RSR) ........................................................................... 387
13.3.2
Receive Data Register (RDR) ........................................................................... 387
13.3.3
Transmit Data Register (TDR).......................................................................... 387
13.3.4
Transmit Shift Register (TSR) .......................................................................... 387
13.3.5
Serial Mode Register (SMR) ............................................................................ 388
13.3.6
Serial Control Register (SCR) .......................................................................... 392
13.3.7
Serial Status Register (SSR) ............................................................................. 396
13.3.8
Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR) ................................................................. 402
13.3.9
Serial Extended Mode Register (SEMR) (Only for Channel 0 in H8S/2215) .. 403
13.3.10 Serial Extended Mode Register A_0 (SEMRA_0)
(Only for Channel 0 in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C) .................. 411
13.3.11 Serial Extended Mode Register B_0 (SEMRB_0)
(Only for Channel 0 in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C) .................. 413
13.3.12 Bit Rate Register (BRR) ................................................................................... 415
Operation in Asynchronous Mode .................................................................................... 423
13.4.1
Data Transfer Format........................................................................................ 424
13.4.2
Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Asynchronous
Mode................................................................................................................. 425
13.4.3
Clock................................................................................................................. 426
13.4.4
SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode).......................................................... 427
13.4.5
Data Transmission (Asynchronous Mode)........................................................ 428
13.4.6
Serial Data Reception (Asynchronous Mode)................................................... 430
Multiprocessor Communication Function ........................................................................ 434
13.5.1
Multiprocessor Serial Data Transmission ......................................................... 435
13.5.2
Multiprocessor Serial Data Reception .............................................................. 437
Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode ........................................................................ 440
13.6.1
Clock................................................................................................................. 440
13.6.2
SCI Initialization (Clocked Synchronous Mode).............................................. 441
13.6.3
Serial Data Transmission (Clocked Synchronous Mode) ................................. 441
13.6.4
Serial Data Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode)....................................... 444
13.6.5
Simultaneous Serial Data Transmission and Reception
(Clocked Synchronous Mode) .......................................................................... 445
Operation in Smart Card Interface.................................................................................... 447
13.7.1
Pin Connection Example................................................................................... 447
13.7.2
Data Format (Except for Block Transfer Mode)............................................... 448
Page xxii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
13.7.3
Clock................................................................................................................. 449
13.7.4
Block Transfer Mode ........................................................................................ 449
13.7.5
Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin.................................... 450
13.7.6
Initialization ...................................................................................................... 451
13.7.7
Serial Data Transmission (Except for Block Transfer Mode)........................... 452
13.7.8
Serial Data Reception (Except for Block Transfer Mode) ................................ 455
13.7.9
Clock Output Control........................................................................................ 457
13.8 SCI Select Function .......................................................................................................... 459
13.9 Interrupts........................................................................................................................... 461
13.9.1
Interrupts in Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode............................ 461
13.9.2
Interrupts in Smart Card Interface Mode .......................................................... 463
13.10 Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 464
13.10.1 Break Detection and Processing (Asynchronous Mode Only).......................... 464
13.10.2 Mark State and Break Detection (Asynchronous Mode Only) ......................... 464
13.10.3 Receive Error Flags and Transmit Operations
(Clocked Synchronous Mode Only).................................................................. 464
13.10.4 Restrictions on Use of DMAC or DTC............................................................. 464
13.10.5 Operation in Case of Mode Transition.............................................................. 465
13.10.6 Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function .................................. 469
13.10.7 Module Stop Mode Setting ............................................................................... 470
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function ............................................................................... 471
14.1
14.2
14.3
14.4
14.5
Features............................................................................................................................. 471
Pin Configuration.............................................................................................................. 473
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 474
14.3.1
Instruction Register (INSTR)............................................................................ 474
14.3.2
IDCODE Register (IDCODE) .......................................................................... 476
14.3.3
BYPASS Register (BYPASS) .......................................................................... 476
14.3.4
Boundary Scan Register (BSCANR) ................................................................ 477
Boundary Scan Function Operation .................................................................................. 485
14.4.1
TAP Controller ................................................................................................. 485
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 486
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB) ....................................................... 489
15.1
15.2
15.3
Features............................................................................................................................. 489
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 492
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 493
15.3.1
USB Endpoint Information Registers 00_0 to 22_4
(UEPIR00_0 to UEPIR22_4)............................................................................ 495
15.3.2
USB Control Register (UCTLR)....................................................................... 502
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxiii of liv
15.3.3
15.3.4
15.3.5
15.3.6
15.3.7
15.3.8
15.3.9
15.3.10
15.3.11
15.3.12
15.3.13
15.3.14
15.3.15
15.3.16
15.3.17
15.3.18
15.3.19
15.3.20
15.3.21
15.3.22
15.3.23
15.3.24
15.3.25
15.3.26
15.3.27
15.3.28
15.3.29
15.3.30
15.3.31
15.3.32
15.3.33
15.3.34
15.3.35
15.3.36
15.3.37
15.3.38
Page xxiv of liv
USB DMAC Transfer Request Register (UDMAR)......................................... 506
USB Device Resume Register (UDRR)............................................................ 507
USB Trigger Register 0 (UTRG0) .................................................................... 508
USB Trigger Register 1 (UTRG1) .................................................................... 509
USBFIFO Clear Register 0 (UFCLR0)............................................................. 510
USBFIFO Clear Register 1 (UFCLR1)............................................................. 511
USB Endpoint Stall Register 0 (UESTL0)........................................................ 512
USB Endpoint Stall Register 1 (UESTL1)........................................................ 513
USB Endpoint Data Register 0s (UEDR0s)...................................................... 513
USB Endpoint Data Register 0i (UEDR0i)....................................................... 514
USB Endpoint Data Register 0o (UEDR0o)..................................................... 514
USB Endpoint Data Register 1i (UEDR1i)....................................................... 514
USB Endpoint Data Register 2i (UEDR2i)....................................................... 515
USB Endpoint Data Register 2o (UEDR2o)..................................................... 515
USB Endpoint Data Register 3i (UEDR3i)....................................................... 515
USB Endpoint Data Register 3o (UEDR3o)..................................................... 516
USB Endpoint Data Register 4i (UEDR4i)....................................................... 516
USB Endpoint Data Register 4o (UEDR4o)..................................................... 516
USB Endpoint Data Register 5i (UEDR5i)....................................................... 517
USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 0o (UESZ0o) ................................ 517
USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 2o (UESZ2o) ................................ 517
USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 3o (UESZ3o) ................................ 518
USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 4o (UESZ4o) ................................ 518
USB Interrupt Flag Register 0 (UIFR0)............................................................ 518
USB Interrupt Flag Register 1 (UIFR1) (Only in H8S/2215) ........................... 520
USB Interrupt Flag Register 1 (UIFR1)
(Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)......................................... 522
USB Interrupt Flag Register 2 (UIFR2) (Only in H8S/2215) ........................... 524
USB Interrupt Flag Register 2 (UIFR2)
(Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)......................................... 525
USB Interrupt Flag Register 3 (UIFR3)............................................................ 527
USB Interrupt Enable Register 0 (UIER0) ....................................................... 529
USB Interrupt Enable Register 1 (UIER1) (Only in H8S/2215)....................... 529
USB Interrupt Enable Register 1 (UIER1)
(Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)......................................... 530
USB Interrupt Enable Register 2 (UIER2) ....................................................... 530
USB Interrupt Enable Register 2 (UIER2)
(Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)......................................... 531
USB Interrupt Enable Register 3 (UIER3) ....................................................... 531
USB Interrupt Select Register 0 (UISR0) ......................................................... 532
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
15.3.39
15.3.40
15.4
15.5
15.6
15.7
15.8
15.9
USB Interrupt Select Register 1 (UISR1) (Only in H8S/2215) ........................ 533
USB Interrupt Select Register 1 (UISR1)
(Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C) ......................................... 533
15.3.41 USB Interrupt Select Register 2 (UISR2) (Only in H8S/2215) ........................ 534
15.3.42 USB Interrupt Select Register 2 (UISR2)
(Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C) ......................................... 534
15.3.43 USB Interrupt Select Register 3 (UISR3) ......................................................... 535
15.3.44 USB Data Status Register (UDSR) ................................................................... 536
15.3.45 USB Configuration Value Register (UCVR) .................................................... 537
15.3.46 USB Time Stamp Registers H, L (UTSRH, UTSRL)....................................... 538
15.3.47 USB Test Register 0 (UTSTR0) ....................................................................... 539
15.3.48 USB Test Register 1 (UTSTR1) ....................................................................... 541
15.3.49 USB Test Registers 2 and A to F (UTSTR2, UTSRA to UTSRF).................... 543
15.3.50 Module Stop Control Register B (MSTPCRB)................................................. 543
Interrupt Sources............................................................................................................... 543
Communication Operation................................................................................................ 547
15.5.1
Initialization ...................................................................................................... 547
15.5.2
USB Cable Connection/Disconnection ............................................................. 548
15.5.3
Suspend and Resume Operations...................................................................... 552
15.5.4
Control Transfer................................................................................................ 556
15.5.5
Interrupt-In Transfer (EP1i Is specified as Endpoint) ....................................... 563
15.5.6
Bulk-In Transfer (Dual FIFOs) (EP2i Is specified as Endpoint)....................... 564
15.5.7
Bulk-Out Transfer (Dual FIFOs) (EP2o Is specified as Endpoint) ................... 566
15.5.8
Isochronous–In Transfer (Dual-FIFO)
(When EP3i Is Specified as Endpoint).............................................................. 568
15.5.9
Isochronous–Out Transfer (Dual-FIFO)
(When EP3o Is Specified as Endpoint)............................................................. 570
15.5.10 Processing of USB Standard Commands and Class/Vendor Commands.......... 572
15.5.11 Stall Operations................................................................................................. 573
DMA Transfer Specifications ........................................................................................... 577
15.6.1
DMA Transfer by USB Request ....................................................................... 577
15.6.2
DMA Transfer by Auto-Request....................................................................... 580
Endpoint Configuration Example ..................................................................................... 582
USB External Circuit Example ......................................................................................... 587
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 591
15.9.1
Operating Frequency......................................................................................... 591
15.9.2
Bus Interface ..................................................................................................... 591
15.9.3
Setup Data Reception........................................................................................ 591
15.9.4
FIFO Clear ........................................................................................................ 592
15.9.5
IRQ6 Interrupt................................................................................................... 592
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxv of liv
15.9.6
15.9.7
15.9.8
15.9.9
15.9.10
15.9.11
15.9.12
15.9.13
15.9.14
15.9.15
15.9.16
15.9.17
15.9.18
Data Register Overread or Overwrite ............................................................... 592
EP3o Isochronous Transfer............................................................................... 593
Reset ................................................................................................................. 595
EP0 Interrupt Assignment................................................................................. 595
Level Shifter for VBUS and IRQx Pins............................................................ 596
Read and Write to USB Endpoint Data Register .............................................. 596
Restrictions for Software Standby Mode Transition......................................... 596
USB External Circuit Example......................................................................... 598
Pin Processing when USB Not Used ................................................................ 599
Notes on Emulator Usage ................................................................................. 599
Notes on TR Interrupt ....................................................................................... 599
Notes on UIFRO ............................................................................................... 600
Clearing the FIFOs in DMA Transfer Mode..................................................... 600
Section 16 A/D Converter .................................................................................................. 601
16.1
16.2
16.3
16.4
16.5
16.6
16.7
16.8
Features............................................................................................................................. 601
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 603
Register Descriptions........................................................................................................ 603
16.3.1
A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD) .......................................... 604
16.3.2
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) ............................................................ 604
16.3.3
A/D Control Register (ADCR) ......................................................................... 606
Interface to Bus Master..................................................................................................... 607
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 608
16.5.1
Single Mode...................................................................................................... 608
16.5.2
Scan Mode ........................................................................................................ 609
16.5.3
Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time ...................................................... 610
16.5.4
External Trigger Input Timing.......................................................................... 612
Interrupts........................................................................................................................... 613
A/D Conversion Precision Definitions ............................................................................. 613
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 615
16.8.1
Permissible Signal Source Impedance .............................................................. 615
16.8.2
Influences on Absolute Precision...................................................................... 615
16.8.3
Range of Analog Power Supply and Other Pin Settings................................... 616
16.8.4
Notes on Board Design ..................................................................................... 616
16.8.5
Notes on Noise Countermeasures ..................................................................... 616
16.8.6
Module Stop Mode Setting ............................................................................... 618
Section 17 D/A Converter .................................................................................................. 619
17.1
17.2
Features............................................................................................................................. 619
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 620
Page xxvi of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
17.3
17.4
17.5
Register Description.......................................................................................................... 620
17.3.1
D/A Data Register (DADR) .............................................................................. 620
17.3.2
D/A Control Register (DACR) ......................................................................... 621
Operation .......................................................................................................................... 621
Usage Note........................................................................................................................ 623
17.5.1
Module Stop Mode Setting ............................................................................... 623
Section 18 RAM ................................................................................................................... 625
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version) ............................................................. 627
19.1
19.2
19.3
19.4
19.5
19.6
19.7
19.8
19.9
19.10
19.11
19.12
19.13
19.14
Features............................................................................................................................. 627
Mode Transitions .............................................................................................................. 629
Block Configuration ......................................................................................................... 633
Input/Output Pins.............................................................................................................. 634
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 634
19.5.1
Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1).................................................. 635
19.5.2
Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2).................................................. 636
19.5.3
Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1) ........................................................................ 637
19.5.4
Erase Block Register 2 (EBR2) ........................................................................ 638
19.5.5
RAM Emulation Register (RAMER)................................................................ 639
19.5.6
Serial Control Register X (SCRX).................................................................... 640
On-Board Programming Modes........................................................................................ 641
19.6.1
SCI Boot Mode (HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, and HD64F2215T) .................. 641
19.6.2
USB Boot Mode
(HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU) ......... 645
19.6.3
Programming/Erasing in User Program Mode.................................................. 649
Flash Memory Emulation in RAM ................................................................................... 650
Flash Memory Programming/Erasing ............................................................................... 652
19.8.1
Program/Program-Verify .................................................................................. 652
19.8.2
Erase/Erase-Verify............................................................................................ 654
Program/Erase Protection ................................................................................................. 656
19.9.1
Hardware Protection ......................................................................................... 656
19.9.2
Software Protection........................................................................................... 656
19.9.3
Error Protection................................................................................................. 656
Interrupt Handling when Programming/Erasing Flash Memory....................................... 657
Programmer Mode ............................................................................................................ 657
Power-Down States for Flash Memory............................................................................. 658
Flash Memory Programming and Erasing Precautions..................................................... 659
Note on Switching from F-ZTAT Version to Masked ROM Version .............................. 664
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxvii of liv
Section 20 Masked ROM ................................................................................................... 665
20.1
Features............................................................................................................................. 665
Section 21 Clock Pulse Generator ................................................................................... 667
21.1
21.2
21.3
21.4
21.5
21.6
21.7
21.8
Register Descriptions........................................................................................................ 668
21.1.1
System Clock Control Register (SCKCR) ........................................................ 668
21.1.2
Low-Power Control Register (LPWRCR) ........................................................ 670
System Clock Oscillator ................................................................................................... 671
21.2.1
Connecting a Crystal Resonator........................................................................ 671
21.2.2
Connecting a Ceramic Resonator (H8S/2215T) ............................................... 672
21.2.3
Inputting an External Clock .............................................................................. 672
Duty Adjustment Circuit................................................................................................... 674
Medium-Speed Clock Divider .......................................................................................... 674
Bus Master Clock Selection Circuit.................................................................................. 674
USB Operating Clock (48 MHz) ...................................................................................... 675
21.6.1
Connecting a Ceramic Resonator...................................................................... 675
21.6.2
Inputting an 48-MHz External Clock................................................................ 675
21.6.3
Pin Handling when 48-MHz External Clock Is Not Needed
(On-chip PLL Circuit Is Used) ......................................................................... 676
PLL Circuit for USB......................................................................................................... 677
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 678
21.8.1
Note on Crystal Resonator ................................................................................ 678
21.8.2
Note on Board Design....................................................................................... 678
21.8.3
Note on Switchover of External Clock ............................................................. 678
Section 22 Power-Down Modes....................................................................................... 681
22.1
22.2
22.3
22.4
Register Descriptions........................................................................................................ 684
22.1.1
Standby Control Register (SBYCR) ................................................................. 684
22.1.2
Module Stop Control Registers A to C (MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC)................ 686
Medium-Speed Mode ....................................................................................................... 688
Sleep Mode ....................................................................................................................... 689
22.3.1
Transition to Sleep Mode.................................................................................. 689
22.3.2
Exiting Sleep Mode .......................................................................................... 689
Software Standby Mode.................................................................................................... 690
22.4.1
Transition to Software Standby Mode .............................................................. 690
22.4.2
Clearing Software Standby Mode..................................................................... 690
22.4.3
Setting Oscillation Stabilization Time after Clearing
Software Standby Mode.................................................................................... 691
22.4.4
Software Standby Mode Application Example................................................. 692
Page xxviii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
22.5
22.6
22.7
22.8
Hardware Standby Mode .................................................................................................. 693
22.5.1
Transition to Hardware Standby Mode ............................................................. 693
22.5.2
Clearing Hardware Standby Mode.................................................................... 693
22.5.3
Hardware Standby Mode Timing...................................................................... 694
22.5.4
Hardware Standby Mode Timings .................................................................... 695
Module Stop Mode ........................................................................................................... 696
φ Clock Output Disabling Function .................................................................................. 696
Usage Notes ...................................................................................................................... 697
22.8.1
I/O Port Status................................................................................................... 697
22.8.2
Current Dissipation during Oscillation Stabilization Wait Period .................... 697
22.8.3
DMAC and DTC Module Stop ......................................................................... 697
22.8.4
On-Chip Peripheral Module Interrupts ............................................................. 697
22.8.5
Writing to MSTPCR ......................................................................................... 697
Section 23 List of Registers ............................................................................................... 699
23.1
23.2
23.3
Register Addresses (Address Order)................................................................................. 699
Register Bits...................................................................................................................... 708
Register States in Each Operating Mode .......................................................................... 718
Section 24 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215) ....................................................... 725
24.1
24.2
24.3
24.4
24.5
24.6
24.7
24.8
24.9
Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................................................. 725
Power Supply Voltage and Operating Frequency Range.................................................. 726
DC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 727
AC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 730
24.4.1
Clock Timing .................................................................................................... 731
24.4.2
Control Signal Timing ...................................................................................... 733
24.4.3
Bus Timing ....................................................................................................... 735
24.4.4
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules.......................................................... 741
USB Characteristics .......................................................................................................... 747
A/D Conversion Characteristics........................................................................................ 749
D/A Conversion Characteristics........................................................................................ 749
Flash Memory Characteristics .......................................................................................... 750
Usage Note........................................................................................................................ 751
Section 25 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215R).................................................... 753
25.1
25.2
25.3
25.4
Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................................................. 753
Power Supply Voltage and Operating Frequency Range.................................................. 754
DC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 755
AC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 758
25.4.1
Clock Timing .................................................................................................... 759
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxix of liv
25.5
25.6
25.7
25.8
25.9
25.4.2
Control Signal Timing ...................................................................................... 761
25.4.3
Bus Timing ....................................................................................................... 763
25.4.4
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules.......................................................... 770
USB Characteristics.......................................................................................................... 776
A/D Conversion Characteristics ....................................................................................... 778
D/A Conversion Characteristics ....................................................................................... 779
Flash Memory Characteristics .......................................................................................... 779
Usage Note........................................................................................................................ 781
Section 26 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215T) .................................................... 783
26.1
26.2
26.3
26.4
26.5
26.6
26.7
26.8
26.9
Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................................................. 783
Power Supply Voltage and Operating Frequency Range.................................................. 783
DC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 784
AC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 787
26.4.1
Clock Timing .................................................................................................... 788
26.4.2
Control Signal Timing ...................................................................................... 790
26.4.3
Bus Timing ....................................................................................................... 792
26.4.4
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules.......................................................... 798
USB Characteristics.......................................................................................................... 803
A/D Conversion Characteristics ....................................................................................... 804
D/A Conversion Characteristics ....................................................................................... 805
Flash Memory Characteristics .......................................................................................... 805
Usage Note........................................................................................................................ 806
Section 27 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215C).................................................... 807
27.1
27.2
27.3
27.4
27.5
27.6
27.7
27.8
27.9
Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................................................................. 807
Power Supply Voltage and Operating Frequency Range.................................................. 808
DC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 809
AC Characteristics ............................................................................................................ 812
27.4.1
Clock Timing .................................................................................................... 813
27.4.2
Control Signal Timing ...................................................................................... 815
27.4.3
Bus Timing ....................................................................................................... 817
27.4.4
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules.......................................................... 823
USB Characteristics.......................................................................................................... 829
A/D Conversion Characteristics ....................................................................................... 831
D/A Conversion Characteristics ....................................................................................... 831
Flash Memory Characteristics .......................................................................................... 832
Usage Note........................................................................................................................ 834
Appendix ................................................................................................................................... 835
Page xxx of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
A.
B.
C.
I/O Port States in Each Processing State........................................................................... 835
Product Model Lineup ...................................................................................................... 839
Package Dimensions ......................................................................................................... 840
Index .......................................................................................................................................... 843
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxxi of liv
Page xxxii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figures
Section 1 Overview
Figure 1.1 Internal Block Diagram ................................................................................................. 3
Figure 1.2 Pin Arrangement (TFP-120, TFP-120V)....................................................................... 4
Figure 1.3 Pin Arrangement (BP-112, BP-112V)........................................................................... 5
Section 2 CPU
Figure 2.1 Exception Vector Table (Normal Mode)..................................................................... 27
Figure 2.2 Stack Structure in Normal Mode................................................................................. 27
Figure 2.3 Exception Vector Table (Advanced Mode)................................................................. 28
Figure 2.4 Stack Structure in Advanced Mode ............................................................................. 29
Figure 2.5 Memory Map............................................................................................................... 30
Figure 2.6 CPU Registers ............................................................................................................. 31
Figure 2.7 Usage of General Registers ......................................................................................... 32
Figure 2.8 Stack ............................................................................................................................ 33
Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (1).............................................................................. 36
Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (2).............................................................................. 37
Figure 2.10 Memory Data Formats............................................................................................... 38
Figure 2.11 Instruction Formats (Examples) ................................................................................ 50
Figure 2.12 Branch Address Specification in Memory Indirect Mode ......................................... 53
Figure 2.13 State Transitions ........................................................................................................ 57
Figure 2.14 Flowchart of Method for Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits ............. 61
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
Figure 3.1
Figure 3.2
Figure 3.3
Figure 3.4
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD64F2215 and HD64F2215U.............. 69
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD6432215B.......................................... 70
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD6432215C.......................................... 71
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD64F2215R, HD64F2215RU,
HD64F2215T, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU .................................................. 72
Section 4 Exception Handling
Figure 4.1
Figure 4.2
Figure 4.3
Figure 4.4
Reset Sequence (Mode 4)............................................................................................ 77
Reset Sequence (Modes 6, 7) ...................................................................................... 78
Stack Status after Exception Handling ........................................................................ 81
Operation when SP Value Is Odd................................................................................ 82
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Figure 5.1 Block Diagram of Interrupt Controller........................................................................ 84
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxxiii of liv
Figure 5.2
Figure 5.3
Figure 5.4
Figure 5.5
Figure 5.6
Figure 5.7
Figure 5.8
Block Diagram of IRQn Interrupts.............................................................................. 92
Set Timing for IRQnF ................................................................................................. 93
Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in Interrupt Control Mode 0..... 97
Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in Interrupt Control Mode 2..... 99
Interrupt Exception Handling.................................................................................... 100
Interrupt Control for DTC and DMAC ..................................................................... 103
Contention between Interrupt Generation and Disabling .......................................... 105
Section 6 Bus Controller
Figure 6.1 Block Diagram of Bus Controller.............................................................................. 110
Figure 6.2 Overview of Area Divisions...................................................................................... 121
Figure 6.3 CSn Signal Output Timing (n = 0 to 7) ..................................................................... 124
Figure 6.4 On-Chip Memory Access Cycle................................................................................ 125
Figure 6.5 Pin States during On-Chip Memory Access.............................................................. 125
Figure 6.6 On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Cycle................................................................ 126
Figure 6.7 Pin States during On-Chip Peripheral Module Access.............................................. 126
Figure 6.8 Access Sizes and Data Alignment Control (8-Bit Access Space) ............................. 127
Figure 6.9 Access Sizes and Data Alignment Control (16-Bit Access Space) ........................... 128
Figure 6.10 Bus Timing for 8-Bit 2-State Access Space ............................................................ 129
Figure 6.11 Bus Timing for 8-Bit 3-State Access Space (Except Area 6).................................. 130
Figure 6.12 Bus Timing for Area 6............................................................................................. 131
Figure 6.13 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 2-State Access Space (1) (Even Address Byte Access) ...... 132
Figure 6.14 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 2-State Access Space (2) (Odd Address Byte Access) ....... 133
Figure 6.15 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 2-State Access Space (3) (Word Access)............................ 134
Figure 6.16 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 3-State Access Space (1) (Even Address Byte Access) ...... 135
Figure 6.17 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 3-State Access Space (2) (Odd Address Byte Access) ....... 136
Figure 6.18 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 3-State Access Space (3) (Word Access)............................ 137
Figure 6.19 Example of Wait State Insertion Timing................................................................. 139
Figure 6.20 Example of Burst ROM Access Timing (When AST0 = BRSTS1 = 1).................. 140
Figure 6.21 Example of Burst ROM Access Timing (When AST0 = BRSTS1 = 0).................. 141
Figure 6.22 Example of Idle Cycle Operation (1) ...................................................................... 142
Figure 6.23 Example of Idle Cycle Operation (2) ...................................................................... 143
Figure 6.24 Relationship between Chip Select (CS) and Read (RD) ......................................... 144
Figure 6.25 Bus-Released State Transition Timing .................................................................... 146
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Figure 7.1
Figure 7.2
Figure 7.3
Figure 7.4
Block Diagram of DMAC ......................................................................................... 150
Areas for Register Re-Setting by DTC (Example: Channel 0A)............................... 170
Operation in Sequential Mode................................................................................... 174
Example of Sequential Mode Setting Procedure....................................................... 175
Page xxxiv of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figure 7.5 Operation in Idle Mode ............................................................................................. 176
Figure 7.6 Example of Idle Mode Setting Procedure.................................................................. 177
Figure 7.7 Operation in Repeat Mode......................................................................................... 179
Figure 7.8 Example of Repeat Mode Setting Procedure............................................................. 180
Figure 7.9 Operation in Normal Mode ....................................................................................... 182
Figure 7.10 Example of Normal Mode Setting Procedure.......................................................... 183
Figure 7.11 Operation in Block Transfer Mode (BLKDIR = 0) ................................................. 185
Figure 7.12 Operation in Block Transfer Mode (BLKDIR = 1) ................................................. 186
Figure 7.13 Operation Flow in Block Transfer Mode................................................................. 187
Figure 7.14 Example of Block Transfer Mode Setting Procedure.............................................. 188
Figure 7.15 Example of DMA Transfer Bus Timing.................................................................. 191
Figure 7.16 Example of Short Address Mode Transfer .............................................................. 192
Figure 7.17 Example of Full Address Mode (Cycle Steal) Transfer........................................... 193
Figure 7.18 Example of Full Address Mode (Burst Mode) Transfer.......................................... 194
Figure 7.19 Example of Full Address Mode (Block Transfer Mode) Transfer........................... 195
Figure 7.20 Example of DREQ Level Activated Normal Mode Transfer .................................. 196
Figure 7.21 Example of Multi-Channel Transfer........................................................................ 197
Figure 7.22 Example of Procedure for Continuing Transfer on Channel Interrupted by NMI
Interrupt................................................................................................................... 199
Figure 7.23 Example of Procedure for Forcibly Terminating DMAC Operation....................... 199
Figure 7.24 Example of Procedure for Clearing Full Address Mode ......................................... 200
Figure 7.25 Block Diagram of Transfer End/Transfer Break Interrupt ...................................... 201
Figure 7.26 DMAC Register Update Timing.............................................................................. 202
Figure 7.27 Contention between DMAC Register Update and CPU Read................................. 203
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Figure 8.1 Block Diagram of DTC ............................................................................................. 206
Figure 8.2 Block Diagram of DTC Activation Source Control .................................................. 213
Figure 8.3 Correspondence between DTC Vector Address and Register Information ............... 214
Figure 8.4 Correspondence between DTC Vector Address and Register Information ............... 214
Figure 8.5 Flowchart of DTC Operation..................................................................................... 216
Figure 8.6 Memory Mapping in Normal Mode .......................................................................... 218
Figure 8.7 Memory Mapping in Repeat Mode ........................................................................... 219
Figure 8.8 Memory Mapping in Block Transfer Mode............................................................... 220
Figure 8.9 Chain Transfer Memory Map.................................................................................... 221
Figure 8.10 DTC Operation Timing (Example in Normal Mode or Repeat Mode).................... 222
Figure 8.11 DTC Operation Timing
(Example of Block Transfer Mode, with Block Size of 2)..................................... 223
Figure 8.12 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Chain Transfer) ............................................ 223
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxxv of liv
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Figure 10.1 Block Diagram of TPU............................................................................................ 284
Figure 10.2 16-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TCNT (16 Bits)] ...................... 311
Figure 10.3 8-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TCR (Upper 8 Bits)].................. 312
Figure 10.4 8-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TMDR (Lower 8 Bits)] ............. 312
Figure 10.5 8-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TCR and TMDR (16 Bits)] ....... 312
Figure 10.6 Example of Counter Operation Setting Procedure .................................................. 313
Figure 10.7 Free-Running Counter Operation ............................................................................ 314
Figure 10.8 Periodic Counter Operation..................................................................................... 315
Figure 10.9 Example of Setting Procedure for Waveform Output by Compare Match.............. 315
Figure 10.10 Example of 0 Output/1 Output Operation ............................................................. 316
Figure 10.11 Example of Toggle Output Operation ................................................................... 316
Figure 10.12 Example of Input Capture Operation Setting Procedure ....................................... 317
Figure 10.13 Example of Input Capture Operation .................................................................... 318
Figure 10.14 Example of Synchronous Operation Setting Procedure ........................................ 319
Figure 10.15 Example of Synchronous Operation...................................................................... 320
Figure 10.16 Compare Match Buffer Operation......................................................................... 321
Figure 10.17 Input Capture Buffer Operation............................................................................. 321
Figure 10.18 Example of Buffer Operation Setting Procedure................................................... 321
Figure 10.19 Example of Buffer Operation (1) .......................................................................... 322
Figure 10.20 Example of Buffer Operation (2) .......................................................................... 323
Figure 10.21 Example of PWM Mode Setting Procedure .......................................................... 325
Figure 10.22 Example of PWM Mode Operation (1) ................................................................. 325
Figure 10.23 Example of PWM Mode Operation (2) ................................................................. 326
Figure 10.24 Example of PWM Mode Operation (3) ................................................................. 327
Figure 10.25 Example of Phase Counting Mode Setting Procedure........................................... 328
Figure 10.26 Example of Phase Counting Mode 1 Operation .................................................... 329
Figure 10.27 Example of Phase Counting Mode 2 Operation .................................................... 330
Figure 10.28 Example of Phase Counting Mode 3 Operation .................................................... 331
Figure 10.29 Example of Phase Counting Mode 4 Operation .................................................... 332
Figure 10.30 Count Timing in Internal Clock Operation............................................................ 335
Figure 10.31 Count Timing in External Clock Operation .......................................................... 335
Figure 10.32 Output Compare Output Timing ........................................................................... 336
Figure 10.33 Input Capture Input Signal Timing........................................................................ 336
Figure 10.34 Counter Clear Timing (Compare Match) .............................................................. 337
Figure 10.35 Counter Clear Timing (Input Capture) .................................................................. 337
Figure 10.36 Buffer Operation Timing (Compare Match) ......................................................... 338
Figure 10.37 Buffer Operation Timing (Input Capture) ............................................................. 338
Figure 10.38 TGI Interrupt Timing (Compare Match) ............................................................... 339
Page xxxvi of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figure 10.39
Figure 10.40
Figure 10.41
Figure 10.42
Figure 10.43
Figure 10.44
Figure 10.45
Figure 10.46
Figure 10.47
Figure 10.48
Figure 10.49
Figure 10.50
Figure 10.51
Figure 10.52
Figure 10.53
TGI Interrupt Timing (Input Capture) ................................................................... 339
TCIV Interrupt Setting Timing.............................................................................. 340
TCIU Interrupt Setting Timing.............................................................................. 340
Timing for Status Flag Clearing by CPU .............................................................. 341
Timing for Status Flag Clearing by DTC or DMAC Activation ........................... 341
Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Counting Mode ................ 342
Contention between TCNT Write and Clear Operations....................................... 343
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment Operations ............................... 343
Contention between TGR Write and Compare Match........................................... 344
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match.......................... 345
Contention between TGR Read and Input Capture ............................................... 345
Contention between TGR Write and Input Capture .............................................. 346
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture.............................. 347
Contention between Overflow and Counter Clearing............................................ 347
Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow................................................... 348
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Figure 11.1 Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer ................................................................................ 350
Figure 11.2 Example of Pulse Output......................................................................................... 356
Figure 11.3 Count Timing for Internal Clock Input.................................................................... 357
Figure 11.4 Count Timing for External Clock Input .................................................................. 357
Figure 11.5 Timing of CMF Setting ........................................................................................... 358
Figure 11.6 Timing of Timer Output .......................................................................................... 358
Figure 11.7 Timing of Compare Match Clear............................................................................. 359
Figure 11.8 Timing of Clearance by External Reset................................................................... 359
Figure 11.9 Timing of OVF Setting............................................................................................ 360
Figure 11.10 Contention between TCNT Write and Clear ......................................................... 363
Figure 11.11 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment.................................................. 364
Figure 11.12 Contention between TCOR Write and Compare Match ........................................ 365
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Figure 12.1
Figure 12.2
Figure 12.3
Figure 12.4
Figure 12.5
Figure 12.6
Figure 12.7
Figure 12.8
Block Diagram of WDT .......................................................................................... 369
Operation in Watchdog Timer Mode....................................................................... 373
Timing of WOVF Setting ........................................................................................ 374
Operation in Interval Timer Mode........................................................................... 375
Timing of OVF Setting............................................................................................ 375
Format of Data Written to TCNT and TCSR .......................................................... 376
Format of Data Written to RSTCSR (Example of WDT0)...................................... 377
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment.................................................... 378
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxxvii of liv
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Figure 13.1
Figure 13.2
Figure 13.3
Figure 13.4
Figure 13.4
Figure 13.5
Figure 13.5
Figure 13.5
Figure 13.5
Figure 13.6
Block Diagram of SCI_0 (H8S/2215) ..................................................................... 383
Block Diagram of SCI_0 (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C).................... 384
Block Diagram of SCI_1 and SCI_2 ....................................................................... 385
Examples of Base Clock when Average Transfer Rate Is Selected (1)................... 405
Examples of Base Clock when Average Transfer Rate Is Selected (2)................... 406
Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (1) ............. 407
Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (2) ............. 408
Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (3) ............. 409
Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (4) ............. 410
Data Format in Asynchronous Communication
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, Two Stop Bits).................................................. 423
Figure 13.7 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode ........................................ 426
Figure 13.8 Relationship between Output Clock and Transfer Data Phase
(Asynchronous Mode)............................................................................................. 426
Figure 13.9 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart ....................................................................... 427
Figure 13.10 Example of Operation in Transmission in Asynchronous Mode
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit).................................................. 428
Figure 13.11 Sample Serial Transmission Data Flowchart......................................................... 429
Figure 13.12 Example of SCI Operation in Reception
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit).................................................. 430
Figure 13.13 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (1) ........................................................ 432
Figure 13.13 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (2) ........................................................ 433
Figure 13.14 Example of Communication Using Multiprocessor Format
(Transmission of Data H'AA to Receiving Station A) .......................................... 435
Figure 13.15 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Transmission Flowchart ........................................ 436
Figure 13.16 Example of SCI Operation in Reception
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Multiprocessor Bit, One Stop Bit) ............................. 437
Figure 13.17 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (1)........................................ 438
Figure 13.17 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (2)........................................ 439
Figure 13.18 Data Format in Synchronous Communication (For LSB-First) ............................ 440
Figure 13.19 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart ..................................................................... 441
Figure 13.20 Sample SCI Transmission Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode .................. 442
Figure 13.21 Sample Serial Transmission Data Flowchart......................................................... 443
Figure 13.22 Example of SCI Operation in Reception ............................................................... 444
Figure 13.23 Sample Serial Reception Flowchart ...................................................................... 445
Figure 13.24 Sample Flowchart of Simultaneous Serial Transmit and Receive Operations ...... 446
Figure 13.25 Schematic Diagram of Smart Card Interface Pin Connections.............................. 447
Figure 13.26 Normal Smart Card Interface Data Format ........................................................... 448
Figure 13.27 Direct Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 0) ...................................................... 448
Page xxxviii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figure 13.28 Inverse Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 1)..................................................... 449
Figure 13.29 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Smart Card Mode
(Using Clock of 372 Times the Transfer Rate) ..................................................... 450
Figure 13.30 Retransfer Operation in SCI Transmit Mode......................................................... 453
Figure 13.31 TEND Flag Generation Timing in Transmission Operation.................................. 453
Figure 13.32 Example of Transmission Processing Flow........................................................... 454
Figure 13.33 Retransfer Operation in SCI Receive Mode .......................................................... 456
Figure 13.34 Example of Reception Processing Flow ................................................................ 456
Figure 13.35 Timing for Fixing Clock Output Level.................................................................. 457
Figure 13.36 Clock Halt and Restart Procedure ......................................................................... 458
Figure 13.37 Example of Communication Using the SCI Select Function................................. 459
Figure 13.38 Example of Communication Using the SCI Select Function................................. 460
Figure 13.39 Example of Clocked Synchronous Transmission by DMAC or DTC ................... 465
Figure 13.40 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Transmission ............................... 466
Figure 13.41 Port Pin State of Asynchronous Transmission Using Internal Clock .................... 466
Figure 13.42 Port Pin State of Synchronous Transmission Using Internal Clock ...................... 467
Figure 13.43 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Reception .................................... 468
Figure 13.44 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function ............ 469
Figure 13.45 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function
(Example of Preventing Low-Level Output)......................................................... 470
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Figure 14.1
Figure 14.2
Figure 14.3
Figure 14.4
Figure 14.5
Block Diagram of Boundary Scan Function............................................................ 472
Boundary Scan Register Configuration ................................................................... 477
TAP Controller Status Transition ............................................................................ 485
Recommended Reset Signal Design........................................................................ 486
Serial Data Input/Output.......................................................................................... 486
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Figure 15.1
Figure 15.2
Figure 15.3
Figure 15.4
Figure 15.5
Figure 15.6
Figure 15.7
Figure 15.8
Block Diagram of USB ........................................................................................... 491
Example of Endpoint Configuration based on Bluetooth Standard......................... 499
USB Initialization.................................................................................................... 547
USB Cable Connection
(When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Not Used)................................. 548
USB Cable Connection (When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Used) . 549
USB Cable Disconnection
(When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Not Used)................................. 550
USB Cable Disconnection
(When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Used)........................................ 551
Example Flowchart of Suspend and Resume Operations........................................ 552
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xxxix of liv
Figure 15.9 Example Flowchart of Suspend and Resume Interrupt Processing ......................... 553
Figure 15.10 Example Flowchart of Suspend and Remote-Wakeup Operations........................ 554
Figure 15.11 Example Flowchart of Remote-Wakeup Interrupt Processing .............................. 555
Figure 15.12 Control Transfer Stage Configuration ................................................................... 556
Figure 15.13 Setup Stage Operation ........................................................................................... 557
Figure 15.14 Data Stage Operation (Control-In) ........................................................................ 559
Figure 15.15 Data Stage Operation (Control-Out)...................................................................... 560
Figure 15.16 Status Stage Operation (Control-In)...................................................................... 561
Figure 15.17 Status Stage Operation (Control-Out) ................................................................... 562
Figure 15.18 EP1i Interrupt-In Transfer Operation .................................................................... 563
Figure 15.19 EP2i Bulk-In Transfer Operation .......................................................................... 565
Figure 15.20 EP2o Bulk-Out Transfer Operation....................................................................... 567
Figure 15.21 EP3i Isochronous-In Transfer Operation............................................................... 569
Figure 15.22 EP3o Isochronous-Out Transfer Operation ........................................................... 571
Figure 15.23 Forcible Stall by Firmware.................................................................................... 574
Figure 15.24 Automatic Stall by USB Function Module............................................................ 576
Figure 15.25 EP2iPKTE Operation in UTRG0 .......................................................................... 578
Figure 15.26 EP2oRDFN Operation in UTRG0......................................................................... 579
Figure 15.27 EP2iPKTE Operation in UTRG0 (Auto-Request)................................................. 581
Figure 15.28 EP2oRDFN Operation in UTRG0 (Auto-Request) ............................................... 581
Figure 15.29 Endpoint Configuration Example.......................................................................... 582
Figure 15.30 USB External Circuit in Bus-Powered Mode
(When On-Chip Transceiver Is Used)................................................................... 587
Figure 15.31 USB External Circuit in Self-Powered Mode
(When On-Chip Transceiver Is Used)................................................................... 588
Figure 15.32 USB External Circuit in Bus-Powered Mode
(When External Transceiver Is Used) ................................................................... 589
Figure 15.33 USB External Circuit in Self-Powered Mode
(When External Transceiver Is Used) ................................................................... 590
Figure 15.34 10-Byte Data Reception ........................................................................................ 593
Figure 15.35 EP3o Data Reception............................................................................................. 594
Figure 15.36 Transition to and from Software Standby Mode ................................................... 597
Figure 15.37 USB Software Standby Mode Transition Timing ................................................. 598
Figure 15.38 TR Interrupt Flag Set Timing ................................................................................ 599
Section 16 A/D Converter
Figure 16.1
Figure 16.2
Figure 16.3
Figure 16.4
Page xl of liv
Block Diagram of A/D Converter ........................................................................... 602
Access to ADDR (When Reading H'AA40)............................................................ 607
A/D Conversion Timing (Single-Chip Mode, Channel 1 Selected) ........................ 609
A/D Conversion Timing (Scan Mode, Channels AN0 to AN3 Selected)................ 610
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figure 16.5 A/D Conversion Timing .......................................................................................... 611
Figure 16.6 External Trigger Input Timing ................................................................................ 612
Figure 16.7 A/D Conversion Precision Definitions (1) .............................................................. 614
Figure 16.8 A/D Conversion Precision Definitions (2) .............................................................. 614
Figure 16.9 Example of Analog Input Circuit ............................................................................ 615
Figure 16.10 Example of Analog Input Protection Circuit ......................................................... 617
Figure 16.11 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit ..................................................................... 617
Section 17 D/A Converter
Figure 17.1 Block Diagram of D/A Converter ........................................................................... 619
Figure 17.2 Example of D/A Converter Operation..................................................................... 622
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Figure 19.1 Block Diagram of Flash Memory............................................................................ 628
Figure 19.2 Flash Memory State Transitions.............................................................................. 629
Figure 19.3 Boot Mode (Sample) ............................................................................................... 631
Figure 19.4 User Program Mode (Sample)................................................................................. 632
Figure 19.5 Flash Memory Block Configuration........................................................................ 633
Figure 19.6 System Configuration in SCI Boot Mode................................................................ 642
Figure 19.7 System Configuration Diagram when Using USB Boot Mode ............................... 646
Figure 19.8 Programming/Erasing Flowchart Example in User Program Mode ........................ 649
Figure 19.9 Flowchart for Flash Memory Emulation in RAM ................................................... 650
Figure 19.10 Example of RAM Overlap Operation.................................................................... 651
Figure 19.11 Program/Program-Verify Flowchart...................................................................... 653
Figure 19.12 Erase/Erase-Verify Flowchart ............................................................................... 655
Figure 19.13 Memory Map in Programmer Mode...................................................................... 658
Figure 19.14 Power-On/Off Timing (Boot Mode)...................................................................... 661
Figure 19.15 Power-On/Off Timing (User Program Mode) ....................................................... 662
Figure 19.16 Mode Transition Timing
(Example: Boot Mode → User Mode ↔ User Program Mode) ........................... 663
Section 20 Masked ROM
Figure 20.1
Block Diagram of On-Chip Masked ROM (256 kbytes)........................................ 665
Section 21 Clock Pulse Generator
Figure 21.1
Figure 21.2
Figure 21.3
Figure 21.4
Figure 21.5
Block Diagram of Clock Pulse Generator ............................................................... 667
Connection of Crystal Resonator (Example)........................................................... 671
Crystal Resonator Equivalent Circuit ...................................................................... 672
Example Wiring Diagram for Connecting a Ceramic Resonator ............................ 672
External Clock Input (Examples) ............................................................................ 673
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xli of liv
Figure 21.6 External Clock Input Timing................................................................................... 674
Figure 21.7 Connection of Ceramic Resonator........................................................................... 675
Figure 21.8 Connection of Ceramic Resonator........................................................................... 675
Figure 21.9 48-MHz External Clock Input Timing .................................................................... 676
Figure 21.10 Pin Handling when 48-MHz External Clock Is Not Used..................................... 676
Figure 21.11 Example of PLL Circuit ........................................................................................ 677
Figure 21.12 Note on Board Design of Oscillator Circuit .......................................................... 678
Figure 21.13 Example of External Clock Switching Circuit ...................................................... 679
Figure 21.14 Example of External Clock Switchover Timing.................................................... 679
Section 22 Power-Down Modes
Figure 22.1
Figure 22.2
Figure 22.3
Figure 22.4
Figure 22.5
Figure 22.6
Mode Transition Diagram ....................................................................................... 683
Medium-Speed Mode Transition and Clearance Timing ........................................ 689
Software Standby Mode Application Example ....................................................... 692
Hardware Standby Mode Timing (Example) .......................................................... 694
Timing of Transition to Hardware Standby Mode .................................................. 695
Timing of Recovery from Hardware Standby Mode............................................... 695
Section 24 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215)
Figure 24.1 Power Supply Voltage and Operating Ranges ........................................................ 726
Figure 24.2 Output Load Circuit ................................................................................................ 730
Figure 24.3 System Clock Timing.............................................................................................. 732
Figure 24.4 Oscillation Stabilization Timing.............................................................................. 732
Figure 24.5 Reset Input Timing.................................................................................................. 733
Figure 24.6 Interrupt Input Timing............................................................................................. 734
Figure 24.7 Basic Bus Timing (Two-State Access).................................................................... 736
Figure 24.8 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access).................................................................. 737
Figure 24.9 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access with One Wait State) ................................ 738
Figure 24.10 Burst ROM Access Timing (Two-State Access)................................................... 739
Figure 24.11 External Bus Release Timing ................................................................................ 740
Figure 24.12 I/O Port Input/Output Timing................................................................................ 743
Figure 24.13 TPU Input/Output Timing ..................................................................................... 743
Figure 24.14 TPU Clock Input Timing....................................................................................... 743
Figure 24.15 8-bit Timer Output Timing.................................................................................... 744
Figure 24.16 8-bit Timer Clock Input Timing ............................................................................ 744
Figure 24.17 8-bit Timer Reset Input Timing............................................................................. 744
Figure 24.18 SCK Clock Input Timing ...................................................................................... 744
Figure 24.19 SCI Input/Output Timing (Clock Synchronous Mode) ......................................... 745
Figure 24.20 A/D Converter External Trigger Input Timing...................................................... 745
Figure 24.21 Boundary Scan TCK Input Timing ....................................................................... 745
Page xlii of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figure 24.22
Figure 24.23
Figure 24.24
Figure 24.25
Boundary Scan TRST Input Timing (At Reset Hold) ........................................... 745
Boundary Scan Data Transmission Timing........................................................... 746
Data Signal Timing ............................................................................................... 748
Test Load Circuit................................................................................................... 748
Section 25 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215R)
Figure 25.1 Power Supply Voltage and Operating Ranges......................................................... 754
Figure 25.2 Output Load Circuit................................................................................................. 758
Figure 25.3 System Clock Timing .............................................................................................. 760
Figure 25.4 Oscillation Stabilization Timing.............................................................................. 760
Figure 25.5 Reset Input Timing.................................................................................................. 762
Figure 25.6 Interrupt Input Timing............................................................................................. 762
Figure 25.7 Basic Bus Timing (Two-State Access).................................................................... 765
Figure 25.8 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access).................................................................. 766
Figure 25.9 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access with One Wait State) ................................ 767
Figure 25.10 Burst ROM Access Timing (Two-State Access)................................................... 768
Figure 25.11 External Bus Release Timing ................................................................................ 769
Figure 25.12 I/O Port Input/Output Timing................................................................................ 772
Figure 25.13 TPU Input/Output Timing ..................................................................................... 772
Figure 25.14 TPU Clock Input Timing....................................................................................... 772
Figure 25.15 8-bit Timer Output Timing.................................................................................... 773
Figure 25.16 8-bit Timer Clock Input Timing ............................................................................ 773
Figure 25.17 8-bit Timer Reset Input Timing............................................................................. 773
Figure 25.18 SCK Clock Input Timing....................................................................................... 773
Figure 25.19 SCI Input/Output Timing (Clock Synchronous Mode) ......................................... 774
Figure 25.20 A/D Converter External Trigger Input Timing...................................................... 774
Figure 25.21 Boundary Scan TCK Input Timing ....................................................................... 774
Figure 25.22 Boundary Scan TRST Input Timing (At Reset Hold) ........................................... 774
Figure 25.23 Boundary Scan Data Transmission Timing........................................................... 775
Figure 25.24 Data Signal Timing ............................................................................................... 777
Figure 25.25 Test Load Circuit................................................................................................... 777
Section 26 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215T)
Figure 26.1
Figure 26.2
Figure 26.3
Figure 26.4
Figure 26.5
Figure 26.6
Figure 26.7
Power Supply Voltage and Operating Ranges......................................................... 783
Output Load Circuit................................................................................................. 787
System Clock Timing .............................................................................................. 789
Oscillation Stabilization Timing.............................................................................. 789
Reset Input Timing.................................................................................................. 790
Interrupt Input Timing............................................................................................. 791
Basic Bus Timing (Two-State Access).................................................................... 793
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xliii of liv
Figure 26.8 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access).................................................................. 794
Figure 26.9 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access with One Wait State) ................................ 795
Figure 26.10 Burst ROM Access Timing (Two-State Access)................................................... 796
Figure 26.11 External Bus Release Timing ................................................................................ 797
Figure 26.12 I/O Port Input/Output Timing................................................................................ 799
Figure 26.13 TPU Input/Output Timing ..................................................................................... 800
Figure 26.14 TPU Clock Input Timing....................................................................................... 800
Figure 26.15 8-bit Timer Output Timing.................................................................................... 800
Figure 26.16 8-bit Timer Clock Input Timing ............................................................................ 800
Figure 26.17 8-bit Timer Reset Input Timing............................................................................. 801
Figure 26.18 SCK Clock Input Timing ...................................................................................... 801
Figure 26.19 SCI Input/Output Timing (Clock Synchronous Mode) ......................................... 801
Figure 26.20 A/D Converter External Trigger Input Timing...................................................... 801
Figure 26.21 Boundary Scan TCK Input Timing ....................................................................... 802
Figure 26.22 Boundary Scan TRST Input Timing (At Reset Hold) ........................................... 802
Figure 26.23 Boundary Scan Data Transmission Timing........................................................... 802
Figure 26.24 Data Signal Timing ............................................................................................... 804
Figure 26.25 Test Load Circuit................................................................................................... 804
Section 27 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215C)
Figure 27.1 Power Supply Voltage and Operating Ranges ........................................................ 808
Figure 27.2 Output Load Circuit ................................................................................................ 812
Figure 27.3 System Clock Timing.............................................................................................. 814
Figure 27.4 Oscillation Stabilization Timing.............................................................................. 814
Figure 27.5 Reset Input Timing.................................................................................................. 816
Figure 27.6 Interrupt Input Timing............................................................................................. 816
Figure 27.7 Basic Bus Timing (Two-State Access).................................................................... 818
Figure 27.8 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access).................................................................. 819
Figure 27.9 Basic Bus Timing (Three-State Access with One Wait State) ................................ 820
Figure 27.10 Burst ROM Access Timing (Two-State Access)................................................... 821
Figure 27.11 External Bus Release Timing ................................................................................ 822
Figure 27.12 I/O Port Input/Output Timing................................................................................ 825
Figure 27.13 TPU Input/Output Timing ..................................................................................... 825
Figure 27.14 TPU Clock Input Timing....................................................................................... 825
Figure 27.15 8-bit Timer Output Timing.................................................................................... 826
Figure 27.16 8-bit Timer Clock Input Timing ............................................................................ 826
Figure 27.17 8-bit Timer Reset Input Timing............................................................................. 826
Figure 27.18 SCK Clock Input Timing ...................................................................................... 826
Figure 27.19 SCI Input/Output Timing (Clock Synchronous Mode) ......................................... 827
Figure 27.20 A/D Converter External Trigger Input Timing...................................................... 827
Page xliv of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Figure 27.21
Figure 27.22
Figure 27.23
Figure 27.24
Figure 27.25
Boundary Scan TCK Input Timing ....................................................................... 827
Boundary Scan TRST Input Timing (At Reset Hold) ........................................... 827
Boundary Scan Data Transmission Timing........................................................... 828
Data Signal Timing ............................................................................................... 830
Test Load Circuit................................................................................................... 830
Appendix
Figure C.1 TFP-120, TFP-120V Package Dimension ................................................................ 840
Figure C.2 BP-112, BP-112V Package Dimension .................................................................... 841
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xlv of liv
Page xlvi of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Tables
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.1
Table 2.2
Table 2.3
Table 2.4
Table 2.4
Table 2.5
Table 2.6
Table 2.7
Table 2.7
Table 2.8
Table 2.9
Table 2.10
Table 2.11
Table 2.12
Table 2.13
Table 2.13
Instruction Classification........................................................................................... 39
Operation Notation.................................................................................................... 40
Data Transfer Instructions ......................................................................................... 41
Arithmetic Operations Instructions (1)...................................................................... 42
Arithmetic Operations Instructions (2)...................................................................... 43
Logic Operations Instructions ................................................................................... 44
Shift Instructions ....................................................................................................... 44
Bit Manipulation Instructions (1) .............................................................................. 45
Bit Manipulation Instructions (2) .............................................................................. 46
Branch Instructions ................................................................................................... 47
System Control Instruction........................................................................................ 48
Block Data Transfer Instruction ................................................................................ 49
Addressing Modes..................................................................................................... 50
Absolute Address Access Ranges ............................................................................. 52
Effective Address Calculation (1) ............................................................................. 54
Effective Address Calculation (2) ............................................................................. 55
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
Table 3.1
Table 3.2
Table 3.3
MCU Operating Mode Selection............................................................................... 63
USB Support in Mode 7 ............................................................................................ 67
Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode..................................................................... 68
Section 4 Exception Handling
Table 4.1
Table 4.2
Table 4.3
Table 4.4
Table 4.5
Exception Types and Priority .................................................................................... 73
Exception Handling Vector Table ............................................................................. 74
Reset Types ............................................................................................................... 75
Status of CCR and EXR after Trace Exception Handling......................................... 79
Status of CCR and EXR after Trap Instruction Exception Handling ........................ 80
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Table 5.1
Table 5.2
Table 5.3
Table 5.4
Table 5.5
Table 5.6
Pin Configuration ...................................................................................................... 85
Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Interrupt Priorities ................................... 94
Interrupt Control Modes............................................................................................ 96
Interrupt Response Times........................................................................................ 101
Number of States in Interrupt Handling Routine Execution Statuses ..................... 102
Interrupt Source Selection and Clearing Control .................................................... 104
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xlvii of liv
Section 6 Bus Controller
Table 6.1
Table 6.2
Table 6.3
Table 6.4
Table 6.5
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 111
Bus Specifications for Each Area (Basic Bus Interface) ......................................... 123
Data Buses Used and Valid Strobes ........................................................................ 128
Pin States in Idle Cycle ........................................................................................... 144
Pin States in Bus Released State ............................................................................. 145
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Table 7.1
Table 7.2
Table 7.3
Table 7.4
Table 7.5
Table 7.6
Table 7.7
Table 7.8
Table 7.9
Table 7.10
Short Address Mode and Full Address Mode
(For 1 Channel: Example of Channel 0) ................................................................. 152
DMAC Transfer Modes .......................................................................................... 172
Register Functions in Sequential Mode................................................................... 173
Register Functions in Idle Mode ............................................................................. 176
Register Functions in Repeat Mode ........................................................................ 178
Register Functions in Normal Mode ....................................................................... 181
Register Functions in Block Transfer Mode ........................................................... 184
DMAC Activation Sources ..................................................................................... 189
DMAC Channel Priority Order ............................................................................... 197
Interrupt Source Priority Order ............................................................................... 201
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Table 8.1
Table 8.2
Table 8.3
Table 8.4
Table 8.5
Table 8.6
Table 8.7
Table 8.8
Activation Source and DTCER Clearance .............................................................. 212
Interrupt Sources, DTC Vector Addresses, and Corresponding DTCE .................. 215
Overview of DTC Functions ................................................................................... 217
Register Information in Normal Mode.................................................................... 218
Register Information in Repeat Mode ..................................................................... 219
Register Information in Block Transfer Mode ........................................................ 220
DTC Execution Status............................................................................................. 224
Number of States Required for Each Execution Status........................................... 224
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.1
Table 9.1
Table 9.1
Table 9.1
Table 9.2
Table 9.3
Table 9.4
Table 9.5
Table 9.6
Page xlviii of liv
Port Functions (1).................................................................................................... 229
Port Functions (2).................................................................................................... 230
Port Functions (3).................................................................................................... 231
Port Functions (4).................................................................................................... 232
P17 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 235
P16 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 235
P15 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 236
P14 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 236
P13 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 236
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Table 9.7
Table 9.8
Table 9.9
Table 9.10
Table 9.11
Table 9.12
Table 9.13
Table 9.14
Table 9.15
Table 9.16
Table 9.17
Table 9.18
Table 9.19
Table 9.20
Table 9.21
Table 9.22
Table 9.23
Table 9.24
Table 9.25
Table 9.26
Table 9.27
Table 9.28
Table 9.29
Table 9.30
Table 9.31
Table 9.32
Table 9.33
Table 9.34
Table 9.35
Table 9.36
Table 9.37
Table 9.38
Table 9.39
Table 9.40
Table 9.41
Table 9.42
Table 9.43
Table 9.44
Table 9.45
Table 9.46
P12 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 237
P11 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 237
P10 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 237
P36 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 240
P35 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 241
P34 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 241
P33 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 241
P32 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 242
P31 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 242
P30 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 242
P74 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 246
P73 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 246
P72 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 246
P71 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 246
P70 Pin Function ..................................................................................................... 247
PA3 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 251
PA2 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 252
PA1 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 252
PA0 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 252
Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port A) ........................................................................ 253
PB7 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 256
PB6 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 256
PB5 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 256
PB4 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 256
PB3 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 257
PB2 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 257
PB1 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 257
PB0 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 257
Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port B)......................................................................... 258
PC7 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 261
PC6 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 261
PC5 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 261
PC4 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 261
PC3 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 261
PC2 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 262
PC1 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 262
PC0 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 262
Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port C)......................................................................... 263
PD7 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 266
PD6 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 266
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page xlix of liv
Table 9.47
Table 9.48
Table 9.49
Table 9.50
Table 9.51
Table 9.52
Table 9.53
Table 9.54
Table 9.55
Table 9.56
Table 9.57
Table 9.58
Table 9.59
Table 9.60
Table 9.61
Table 9.62
Table 9.63
Table 9.64
Table 9.65
Table 9.66
Table 9.67
Table 9.68
Table 9.69
Table 9.70
Table 9.71
Table 9.72
Table 9.73
Table 9.74
Table 9.75
Table 9.76
PD5 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 266
PD4 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 266
PD3 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 266
PD2 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 267
PD1 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 267
PD0 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 267
Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port D) ........................................................................ 267
PE7 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 270
PE6 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 270
PE5 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 271
PE4 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 271
PE3 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 271
PE2 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 271
PE1 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 272
PE0 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 272
Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port E)......................................................................... 273
PF7 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 276
PF6 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 276
PF5 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 276
PF4 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 276
PF3 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 277
PF2 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 277
PF1 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 277
PF0 Pin Function..................................................................................................... 277
PG4 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 280
PG3 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 280
PG2 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 280
PG1 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 280
PG0 Pin Function .................................................................................................... 280
Examples of Ways to Handle Unused Input Pins.................................................... 281
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.1
Table 10.2
Table 10.3
Table 10.4
Table 10.5
Table 10.6
Table 10.7
Table 10.8
Page l of liv
TPU Functions ........................................................................................................ 285
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 287
CCLR2 to CCLR0 (channel 0)................................................................................ 290
CCLR2 to CCLR0 (channels 1 and 2)..................................................................... 290
TPSC2 to TPSC0 (channel 0).................................................................................. 291
TPSC2 to TPSC0 (channel 1).................................................................................. 291
TPSC2 to TPSC0 (channel 2).................................................................................. 292
MD3 to MD0........................................................................................................... 294
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Table 10.9
Table 10.10
Table 10.11
Table 10.12
Table 10.13
Table 10.14
Table 10.15
Table 10.16
Table 10.17
Table 10.18
Table 10.19
Table 10.20
Table 10.21
Table 10.22
Table 10.23
Table 10.24
TIORH_0 (channel 0).............................................................................................. 296
TIORH_0 (channel 0).............................................................................................. 297
TIORL_0 (channel 0) .............................................................................................. 298
TIORL_0 (channel 0) .............................................................................................. 299
TIOR_1 (channel 1) ................................................................................................ 300
TIOR_1 (channel 1) ................................................................................................ 301
TIOR_2 (channel 2) ................................................................................................ 302
TIOR_2 (channel 2) ................................................................................................ 303
Register Combinations in Buffer Operation............................................................ 320
PWM Output Registers and Output Pins................................................................. 324
Phase Counting Mode Clock Input Pins.................................................................. 328
Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 1 ........................................ 329
Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 2 ........................................ 330
Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 3 ........................................ 331
Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 4 ........................................ 332
TPU Interrupts......................................................................................................... 333
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Table 11.1
Table 11.2
Table 11.3
Table 11.4
Table 11.5
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 351
Clock Input to TCNT and Count Condition ............................................................ 354
8-Bit Timer Interrupt Sources ................................................................................. 362
Timer Output Priorities ........................................................................................... 366
Switching of Internal Clock and TCNT Operation ................................................. 367
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Table 12.1
WDT Interrupt Source............................................................................................. 376
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Table 13.1
Table 13.2
Table 13.3
Table 13.4
Table 13.5
Table 13.6
Table 13.7
Table 13.8
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 386
Relationships between the N Setting in BRR and Bit Rate B ................................. 415
BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode) ................................... 416
Maximum Bit Rate for Each Frequency (Asynchronous Mode)............................. 420
Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode)................... 420
BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Clocked Synchronous Mode) ....................... 421
Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Clocked Synchronous Mode)....... 421
BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates
(Smart Card Interface Mode, when n = 0 and S = 372)........................................... 422
Table 13.9 Maximum Bit Rate at Various Frequencies (Smart Card Interface Mode) ............. 422
Table 13.10 Serial Transfer Formats (Asynchronous Mode) ...................................................... 424
Table 13.11 SSR Status Flags and Receive Data Handling......................................................... 431
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page li of liv
Table 13.12 SCI Interrupt Sources.............................................................................................. 462
Table 13.13 Interrupt Sources in Smart Card Interface Mode .................................................... 463
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Table 14.1
Table 14.2
Table 14.3
Table 14.4
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 473
Instruction configuration ......................................................................................... 474
IDCODE Register Configuration ............................................................................ 476
Correspondence between LSI Pins and Boundary Scan Register ........................... 478
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.1
Table 15.2
Table 15.3
Table 15.4
Table 15.5
Table 15.6
Table 15.7
Table 15.8
Table 15.9
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 492
EPINFO Data Settings ............................................................................................ 500
Relationship between the UTSTR0 Setting and Pin Outputs .................................. 540
Relationship between the UTSTR1 Settings and Pin Inputs ................................... 542
SCI Interrupt Sources.............................................................................................. 544
Command Decoding on Firmware .......................................................................... 572
Register Name Modification List ............................................................................ 583
Bit Name Modification List .................................................................................... 584
EPINFO Data Settings ............................................................................................ 585
Section 16 A/D Converter
Table 16.1
Table 16.2
Table 16.3
Table 16.4
Table 16.5
Table 16.6
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 603
Analog Input Channels and Corresponding ADDR Registers ................................ 604
A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode) ..................................................................... 611
A/D Conversion Time (Scan Mode) ....................................................................... 612
A/D Converter Interrupt Source .............................................................................. 613
Analog Pin Specifications ....................................................................................... 617
Section 17 D/A Converter
Table 17.1
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 620
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Table 19.1
Table 19.2
Table 19.3
Table 19.4
Table 19.5
Table 19.6
Table 19.7
Page lii of liv
Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode..................................... 630
Pin Configuration .................................................................................................... 634
Setting On-Board Programming Modes.................................................................. 641
SCI Boot Mode Operation....................................................................................... 644
System Clock Frequencies for Which Automatic Adjustment of LSI Bit Rate Is
Possible ................................................................................................................... 644
Enumeration Information ........................................................................................ 645
USB Boot Mode Operation ..................................................................................... 648
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Table 19.8
Table 19.9
Flash Memory Operating States .............................................................................. 658
Registers Present in F-ZTAT Version but Absent in Masked ROM Version ......... 664
Section 21 Clock Pulse Generator
Table 21.1
Table 21.2
Table 21.3
Table 21.4
Table 21.5
Table 21.6
List of Suitable Resonators...................................................................................... 671
Damping Resistance Value ..................................................................................... 671
Crystal Resonator Characteristics ........................................................................... 672
External Clock Input Conditions............................................................................. 673
External Clock Input Conditions when Duty Adjustment Circuit Is Not Used ....... 674
External Clock Input Conditions when Duty Adjustment Circuit Is Not Used ....... 676
Section 22 Power-Down Modes
Table 22.1
Table 22.2
Table 22.3
Table 22.4
LSI Internal States in Each Mode............................................................................ 682
Low Power Dissipation Mode Transition Conditions ............................................. 683
Oscillation Stabilization Time Settings ................................................................... 691
φ Pin State in Each Processing State ....................................................................... 696
Section 24 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215)
Table 24.1
Table 24.2
Table 24.3
Table 24.4
Table 24.5
Table 24.6
Table 24.7
Table 24.8
Absolute Maximum Ratings.................................................................................... 725
DC Characteristics................................................................................................... 727
Permissible Output Currents ................................................................................... 730
Clock Timing .......................................................................................................... 731
Control Signal Timing............................................................................................. 733
Bus Timing.............................................................................................................. 735
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules ................................................................ 741
USB Characteristics (USD+ and USD- pins) when On-Chip USB Transceiver Is
Used ........................................................................................................................ 747
Table 24.9 A/D Conversion Characteristics .............................................................................. 749
Table 24.10 D/A Conversion Characteristics .............................................................................. 749
Table 24.11 Flash Memory Characteristics................................................................................. 750
Section 25 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215R)
Table 25.1
Table 25.2
Table 25.3
Table 25.4
Table 25.5
Table 25.6
Table 25.7
Absolute Maximum Ratings.................................................................................... 753
DC Characteristics................................................................................................... 755
Permissible Output Currents ................................................................................... 758
Clock Timing .......................................................................................................... 759
Control Signal Timing............................................................................................. 761
Bus Timing.............................................................................................................. 763
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules ................................................................ 770
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page liii of liv
Table 25.8
USB Characteristics (USD+ and USD- pins) when On-Chip USB Transceiver Is
Used ........................................................................................................................ 776
Table 25.9 A/D Conversion Characteristics.............................................................................. 778
Table 25.10 D/A Conversion Characteristics.............................................................................. 779
Table 25.11 Flash Memory Characteristics................................................................................. 779
Section 26 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215T)
Table 26.1
Table 26.2
Table 26.3
Table 26.4
Table 26.5
Table 26.6
Table 26.7
Table 26.8
Absolute Maximum Ratings.................................................................................... 783
DC Characteristics .................................................................................................. 784
Permissible Output Currents ................................................................................... 787
Clock Timing .......................................................................................................... 788
Control Signal Timing............................................................................................. 790
Bus Timing.............................................................................................................. 792
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules ................................................................ 798
USB Characteristics (USD+ and USD- pins) when On-Chip USB Transceiver Is
Used ........................................................................................................................ 803
Table 26.9 A/D Conversion Characteristics.............................................................................. 804
Table 26.10 D/A Conversion Characteristics.............................................................................. 805
Table 26.11 Flash Memory Characteristics................................................................................. 805
Section 27 Electrical Characteristics (H8S/2215C)
Table 27.1
Table 27.2
Table 27.3
Table 27.4
Table 27.5
Table 27.6
Table 27.7
Table 27.8
Absolute Maximum Ratings.................................................................................... 807
DC Characteristics .................................................................................................. 809
Permissible Output Currents ................................................................................... 812
Clock Timing .......................................................................................................... 813
Control Signal Timing............................................................................................. 815
Bus Timing.............................................................................................................. 817
Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules ................................................................ 823
USB Characteristics (USD+ and USD- pins) when On-Chip USB Transceiver Is
Used ........................................................................................................................ 829
Table 27.9 A/D Conversion Characteristics.............................................................................. 831
Table 27.10 D/A Conversion Characteristics.............................................................................. 831
Table 27.11 Flash Memory Characteristics................................................................................. 832
Page liv of liv
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Section 1 Overview
1.1
Overview
• High-speed H8S/2000 central processing unit with 16-bit architecture
⎯ Upward-compatible with H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs on an object level
⎯ Sixteen 16-bit general registers
⎯ 65 basic instructions
• Various peripheral functions
⎯ DMA controller (DMAC)
⎯ Data transfer controller (DTC)
⎯ 16-bit timer-pulse unit (TPU)
⎯ 8-bit timer (TMR)
⎯ Watchdog timer (WDT)
⎯ Asynchronous or clocked synchronous serial communication interface (SCI)
⎯ Boundary scan
⎯ Universal serial bus (USB)
⎯ 10-bit A/D converter
⎯ 8-bit D/A converter
•
User debug interface (H-UDI)*
⎯ Clock pulse generator
Note: * Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
• On-chip memory
ROM
Part No.
ROM
RAM
Remarks
F-ZTAT Version
HD64F2215
256 kbytes
16 kbytes
SCI boot version
HD64F2215U
256 kbytes
16 kbytes
USB boot version
HD64F2215CU
256 kbytes
20 kbytes
USB boot version
HD64F2215T
256 kbytes
20 kbytes
SCI boot version
HD64F2215TU
256 kbytes
20 kbytes
USB boot version
HD64F2215R
256 kbytes
20 kbytes
SCI boot version
HD64F2215RU
256 kbytes
20 kbytes
USB boot version
HD6432215B
128 kbytes
16 kbytes
⎯
HD6432215C
64 kbytes
8 kbytes
⎯
Masked ROM
Version
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 1 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
• General I/O ports
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 6
Mode 7
⎯ I/O pins:
41
41
68
⎯ Input-only pins:
15
23
7
• Supports various power-down states
• Compact package
Package
(Code)
Body Size
Pin Pitch
Remarks
TQFP-120
TFP-120, TFP-120V*
14.0 × 14.0 mm
0.4 mm
⎯
P-LFBGA-112
BP-112, BP-112V*
10.0 × 10.0 mm
0.8 mm
⎯
Note: *
Page 2 of 846
TFP-120V and BP-120V only for H8S/2215C.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
PD7 / D15
PD6 / D14
PD5 / D13
PD4 / D12
PD3 / D11
PD2 / D10
PD1 / D9
PD0 / D8
PE7 / D7
PE6 / D6
PE5 / D5
PE4 / D4
PE3 / D3
PE2 / D2
PE1 / D1
PE0 / D0
Internal Block Diagram
VCC
VCC
VSS
VSS
DrVCC
DrVSS
TDO
TDI
TCK
TMS
TRST
EMLE*2
1.2
Section 1 Overview
Port D
Port E
Port A
Port B
PB7/A15
PB6/A14
PB5/A13
PB4/A12
PB3 / A11
PB2/A10
PB1/A9
PB0/A8
Port C
PC7/A7
PC6/A6
PC5/A5
PC4/A4
PC3/A3
PC2/A2
PC1/A1
PC0/A0
Port 3
Bus controller
Internal address bus
PA3/A19/SCK2/SUSPND
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA1/A17/TxD2
PA0/A16
P36(PUPD+)
P35/SCK1/IRQ5
P34/RxD1
P33/TxD1
P32/SCK0/IRQ4
P31/RxD0
P30/TxD0
Peripheral data bus
USB
WDT
ROM
Peripheral address bus
DMAC
DTC
Port F
TMR (2 channels)
SCI0 (1 channnel, high speed UART)
SCI1, 2 (2 channels)
RAM
A/D converter (6 channels)
TPU (3 channels)
AVCC
Vref
AVSS
D/A converter (1 channel)
Port 9
P96/AN14/DA0
Port 4
P97/AN15/DA1
Port 7
P43/AN3
P42/AN2
P41/AN1
P40/AN0
P10 / TIOCA0 /A20/VM
P11 / TIOCB0 /A21/VP
P12 / TIOCC0 / TCLKA/A22/RCV
P13 / TIOCD0 / TCLKB/A23/VPO
P14 / TIOCA1/IRQ0
P15 / TIOCB1 / TCLKC/FSE0
P16 / TIOCA2/IRQ1
P17 / TIOCB2/ TCLKD/OE
Port 1
P70/TMRI01/TMCI01/CS4
P71/CS5
P72 /TMO0/CS6
P73 / T M O 1 /CS7
P74 / MRES
PG4/CS0
PG3/CS1
PG2/CS2
PG1/CS3/IRQ7
PG0
Interrupts controller
Port G
PF7/φ
PF6/AS
PF5/RD
PF4/HWR
PF3/LWR/ADTRG/IRQ3
PF2/WAIT
PF1/BACK
PF0/BREQ/IRQ2
Internal data bus
USB
STBY
RES
NMI
FWE*1
USPND
USD+
USDUBPM
VBUS
H8S/2000 CPU
clock pulse
generator
PLL for
USB
System
clock pulse
generator
Boundary scan
H-UDI*2
MD2
MD1
MD0
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLVCC
PLLCAP
PLLVSS
EXTAL48
XTAL48
Notes: 1. The FWE pin is only provided in the flash memory version.
2. The H-UDI function and EMLE pin are only provided in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T
and H8S/2215C.
Figure 1.1 Internal Block Diagram
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 3 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin Arrangement
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
P32/CSK0/IRQ4
P31/RxD0
P30/TxD0
PF0/BREQ/IRQ2
PF1/BACK
PF2/WAIT
NC
PF3/LWR/ADTRG/IRQ3
NC
PF4/HWR
PF5/RD
PF6/AS
PF7/φ
MD2
EXTAL
VCC
XTAL
VSS
RES
STBY
NMI
FWE*1
MD1
MD0
EXTAL48
XTAL48
PLLVCC
PLLCAP
PLLVSS
VSS
1.3
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
(Pin Arrangement)
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
DrVSS
USDUSD+
DrVCC
UBPM
VBUS
NC
USPND
NC
AVCC
Vref
P40/AN0
P41/AN1
P42/AN2
P43/AN3
P96/AN14/DA0
P97/AN15/DA1
AVSS
P17/TIOCB2/TCLKD/OE
P16/TIOCA2/IRQ1
P15/TIOCB1/TCLKC/FSE0
P14/TIOCA1/IRQ0
P13/TIOCD0/TCLKB/A23/VPO
P12/TIOCC0/TCLKA/A22/RCV
P11/TIOCB0/A21/VP
P10/TIOCA0/A20/VM
NC
PA3/A19/SCK2/SUSPND
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA1/A17/TxD2
NC or EMLE*2
PD0/D8
PD1/D9
PD2/D10
PD3/D11
PD4/D12
PD5/D13
PD6/D14
PD7/D15
VCC
PC0/A0
VSS
PC1/A1
PC2/A2
PC3/A3
PC4/A4
PC5/A5
PC6/A6
PC7/A7
PB0/A8
PB1/A9
NC
PB2/A10
NC
PB3/A11
PB4/A12
PB5/A13
PB6/A14
PB7/A15
PA0/A16
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
P33/TxD1
P34/RxD1
P35/SCK1/IRQ5
P36(PUPD+)
NC
P74/MRES
P73/TMO1/CS7
P72/TMO0/CS6
P71/CS5
P70/TMRI01/TMCI01/CS4
PG0
PG1/CS3/IRQ7
PG2/CS2
PG3/CS1
PG4/CS0
TDO
TCK
TMS
TRST
TDI
PE0/D0
NC
PE1/D1
NC
PE2/D2
PE3/D3
PE4/D4
PE5/D5
PE6/D6
PE7/D7
Notes: NC (No Connection): These pins should not be connected; they should be left open.
1. The FWE pin is only provided in the flash memory version.
2. NC pin in H8S/2215. EMLE pin in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
Figure 1.2 Pin Arrangement (TFP-120, TFP-120V)
Page 4 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11
10
Section 1 Overview
NC
P31/RxD0 PF1/BACK PF4/HWR
P34/RxD1 P33/TxD1 P30/TxD0 PF2/WAIT
PF7/φ
VCC
RES
FWE*1
PF6/AS
EXTAL
VSS
MD1
XTAL48
PLLVSS
USD-
EXTAL48 PLLCAP
NC
9
P74/
MRES
P36
(PUPD+)
P32/
SCK0/
IRQ4
PF0/
BREQ/
IRQ2
PF5/RD
XTAL
STBY
MD0
DrVSS
USD+
UBPM
8
P71/CS5
P72/
TMO0/
CS6
P73/
TMO1/
CS7
P35/
SCK1/
IRQ5
PF3/
LWR/
ADTRG/
IRQ3
MD2
NMI
PLLVCC
DrVCC
VBUS
AVCC
7
PG1/
PG2/CS2
CS3/IRQ7
PG0
P70/
TMRI01/
TMCI01/
CS4
USPND
Vref
6
PG4/CS0
TDO
PG3/CS1
TCK
5
TMS
TRST
TDI
PE1/D1
4
PE0/D0
PE2/D2
PE4/D4
PD2/D10
VCC
PC5/A5
PB2/A10
3
PE3/D3
PE5/D5
PE7/D7
PD5/D13
PC0/A0
PC2/A2
PB0/A8
PB5/A13
PA0/A16
P10/
TIOCA0/
A20/VM
2
PE6/D6
PD0/D8
PD3/D11
PD6/D14
PC1/A1
PC4/A4
PC7/A7
PB3/A11
PB6/A14
PA1/
PA2/
A17/TxD2 A18/RxD2
1
NC*2 or
EMLE
PD1/D9
PD4/D12 PD7/D15
VSS
PC3/A3
PC6/A6
PB1/A9
PB4/A12
PB7/A15
NC
A
B
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
C
D
BP-112,
BP-112V
(Top view)
P42/AN2
P40/AN0 P41/AN1
P97/
P43/AN3
AN15/DA1
P96/
AN14/
DA0
P15/
P17/
TIOCB1/ P16/TIO
TIOCB2/
AVSS
TCLKC/ CA2/IRQ1
TCLKD/OE
FSE0
PA3/
P12/
P13/
P14/
A19/
TIOCC0/ TIOCD0/
TIOCA1/
SCK2/
TCLKA/
TCLKB/
IRQ0
SUSPND A22/RCV A23/VPO
P11/
TIOCB0/
A21/VP
INDEX
Notes: NC (No Connection): These pins should not be connected; they should be left open.
1. The FWE pin is only provided in the flash memory version.
2. NC in H8S/2215. EMLE pin in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
Figure 1.3 Pin Arrangement (BP-112, BP-112V)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 5 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
1.4
Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode
Pin No.
Pin Name
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V
Mode 4
1
A1
NC or EMLE*
2
B2
D8
D8
D8
PD0
D0
3
B1
D9
D9
D9
PD1
D1
4
D4
D10
D10
D10
PD2
D2
5
C2
D11
D11
D11
PD3
D3
6
C1
D12
D12
D12
PD4
D4
7
D3
D13
D13
D13
PD5
D5
8
D2
D14
D14
D14
PD6
D6
9
D1
D15
D15
D15
PD7
D7
10
E4
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
11
E3
A0
A0
PC1/A0
PC0
A0
12
E1
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
13
E2
A1
A1
PC1/A1
PC1
A1
14
F3
A2
A2
PC2/A2
PC2
A2
15
F1
A3
A3
PC3/A3
PC3
A3
16
F2
A4
A4
PC4/A4
PC4
A4
17
F4
A5
A5
PC5/A5
PC5
A5
18
G1
A6
A6
PC6/A6
PC6
A6
19
G2
A7
A7
PC7/A7
PC7
A7
20
G3
PB0/A8
PB0/A8
PB0/A8
PB0
A8
21
H1
PB1/A9
PB1/A9
PB1/A9
PB1
A9
22
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
Mode 5
2
NC or EMLE*
Mode 7*1
Mode 6
2
NC or EMLE*
2
NC or EMLE*
PROM Mode
2
NC
23
G4
PB2/A10
PB2/A10
PB2/A10
PB2
A10
24
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
25
H2
PB3/A11
PB3/A11
PB3/A11
PB3
A11
26
J1
PB4/A12
PB4/A12
PB4/A12
PB4
A12
27
H3
PB5/A13
PB5/A13
PB5/A13
PB5
A13
28
J2
PB6/A14
PB6/A14
PB6/A14
PB6
A14
29
K1
PB7/A15
PB7/A15
PB7/A15
PB7
A15
Page 6 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Pin Name
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V
Mode 4
Mode 5
Mode 6
Mode 7*1
PROM Mode
30
J3
PA0/A16
PA0/A16
PA0/A16
PA0
A16
31
K2
PA1/A17/TxD2
PA1/A17/TxD2
PA1/A17/TxD2
PA1/TxD2
A17
32
L2
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA2/RxD2
A18
33
H4
PA3/A19/SCK2/
SUSPND
PA3/A19/SCK2/
SUSPND
PA3/A19/SCK2/
SUSPND
PA3/SCK2
NC
34
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
35
K3
P10/TIOCA0/
A20/VM
P10/TIOCA0/
A20/VM
P10/TIOCA0/
A20/VM
P10/TIOCA0
NC
36
L3
P11/TIOCB0/
A21/VP
P11/TIOCB0/
A21/VP
P11/TIOCB0/
A21/VP
P11/TIOCB0
NC
37
J4
P12/TIOCC0/
TCLKA/A22/
RCV
P12/TIOCC0/
TCLKA/A22/
RCV
P12/TIOCC0/
TCLKA/A22/
RCV
P12/TIOCC0/
TCLKA
NC
38
K4
P13/TIOCD0/
TCLKB/A23/
VPO
P13/TIOCD0/
TCLKB/A23/
VPO
P13/TIOCD0/
TCLKB/A23/
VPO
P13/TIOCD0/
TCLKB
NC
39
L4
P14/TIOCA1/
IRQ0
P14/TIOCA1/
IRQ0
P14/TIOCA1/
IRQ0
P14/TIOCA1/
IRQ0
VSS
40
H5
P15/TIOCB1/
TCLKC/FSE0
P15/TIOCB1/
TCLKC/FSE0
P15/TIOCB1/
TCLKC/FSE0
P15/TIOCB1/
TCLKC
NC
41
J5
P16/TIOCA2/
IRQ1
P16/TIOCA2/
IRQ1
P16/TIOCA2/
IRQ1
P16/TIOCA2/
IRQ1
VSS
42
L5
P17/TIOCB2/
TCLKD/OE
P17/TIOCB2/
TCLKD/OE
P17/TIOCB2/
TCLKD/OE
P17/TIOCB2/
TCLKD/OE
NC
43
K5
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
VSS
44
J6
P97/AN15/DA1
P97/AN15/DA1
P97/AN15/DA1
P97/AN15/DA1
NC
45
L6
P96/AN14/DA0
P96/AN14/DA0
P96/AN14/DA0
P96/AN14/DA0
NC
46
K6
P43/AN3
P43/AN3
P43/AN3
P43/AN3
NC
47
H6
P42/AN2
P42/AN2
P42/AN2
P42/AN2
NC
48
L7
P41/AN1
P41/AN1
P41/AN1
P41/AN1
NC
49
K7
P40/AN0
P40/AN0
P40/AN0
P40/AN0
NC
50
J7
Vref
Vref
Vref
Vref
VCC
51
L8
AVCC
AVCC
AVCC
AVCC
VCC
52
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 7 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Pin Name
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V
Mode 4
Mode 5
Mode 6
Mode 7*1
PROM Mode
53
H7
USPND
USPND
USPND
—
NC
54
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
55
K8
VBUS
VBUS
VBUS
VSS
VSS
56
L9
UBPM
UBPM
UBPM
VSS
VSS
57
J8
DrVCC
DrVCC
DrVCC
VSS
VCC
58
K9
USD+
USD+
USD+
—
NC
59
L10
USD-
USD-
USD-
—
NC
60
J9
DrVSS
DrVSS
DrVSS
—
VSS
61
—
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
62
K10
PLLVSS
PLLVSS
PLLVSS
—
VSS
63
K11
PLLCAP
PLLCAP
PLLCAP
NC
NC
64
H8
PLLVCC
PLLVCC
PLLVCC
—
VCC
65
J10
XTAL48
XTAL48
XTAL48
—
NC
66
J11
EXTAL48
EXTAL48
EXTAL48
—
VCC
67
H9
MD0
MD0
MD0
MD0
VSS
68
H10
MD1
MD1
MD1
MD1
VSS
69
H11
FWE
FWE
FWE
FWE
FWE
70
G8
NMI
NMI
NMI
NMI
VCC
71
G9
STBY
STBY
STBY
STBY
VCC
72
G11
RES
RES
RES
RES
RES
73
G10
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
74
F9
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
75
F11
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
76
F10
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
77
F8
MD2
MD2
MD2
MD2
VSS
78
E11
PF7/φ
PF7/φ
PF7/φ
PF7/φ
NC
79
E10
AS
AS
AS
PF6
NC
80
E9
RD
RD
RD
PF5
NC
81
D11
HWR
HWR
HWR
PF4
NC
82
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
Page 8 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V
Pin Name
Mode 4
Mode 5
Mode 6
Mode 7*1
PROM Mode
83
E8
PF3/LWR/
ADTRG/IRQ3
PF3/LWR/
ADTRG/IRQ3
PF3/LWR/
ADTRG/IRQ3
PF3/ADTRG/
IRQ3
VCC
84
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
85
D10
PF2/WAIT
PF2/WAIT
PF2/WAIT
PF2
NC
86
C11
PF1/BACK
PF1/BACK
PF1/BACK
PF1
NC
87
D9
PF0/BREQ/
IRQ2
PF0/BREQ/
IRQ2
PF0/BREQ/
IRQ2
PF0/IRQ2
VCC
88
C10
P30/TxD0
P30/TxD0
P30/TxD0
P30/TxD0
NC
89
B11
P31/RxD0
P31/RxD0
P31/RxD0
P31/RxD0
NC
90
C9
P32/SCK0/IRQ4 P32/SCK0/IRQ4 P32/SCK0/IRQ4 P32/SCK0/IRQ4 NC
91
B10
P33/TxD1
P33/TxD1
P33/TxD1
P33/TxD1
NC
92
A10
P34/RxD1
P34/RxD1
P34/RxD1
P34/RxD1
NC
93
D8
P35/SCK1/IRQ5 P35/SCK1/IRQ5 P35/SCK1/IRQ5 P35/SCK1/IRQ5 NC
94
B9
P36 (PUPD+)
P36 (PUPD+)
P36 (PUPD+)
P36 (PUPD+)*3
NC
95
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
96
A9
P74/MRES
P74/MRES
P74/MRES
P74/MRES
NC
97
C8
P73/TMO1/CS7
P73/TMO1/CS7
P73/TMO1/CS7
P73/TMO1
NC
98
B8
P72/TMO0/CS6
P72/TMO0/CS6
P72/TMO0/CS6
P72/TMO0
NC
99
A8
P71/CS5
P71/CS5
P71/CS5
P71
NC
100
D7
P70/TMRI01/
TMCI01/CS4
P70/TMRI01/
TMCI01/CS4
P70/TMRI01/
TMCI01/CS4
P70/TMRI01/
TMCI01
NC
101
C7
PG0
PG0
PG0
PG0
NC
102
A7
PG1/CS3/IRQ7
PG1/CS3/IRQ7
PG1/CS3/IRQ7
PG1/IRQ7
NC
103
B7
PG2/CS2
PG2/CS2
PG2/CS2
PG2
NC
104
C6
PG3/CS1
PG3/CS1
PG3/CS1
PG3
NC
105
A6
PG4/CS0
PG4/CS0
PG4/CS0
PG4
NC
106
B6
TDO
TDO
TDO
TDO
VCC
107
D6
TCK
TCK
TCK
TCK
VCC
108
A5
TMS
TMS
TMS
TMS
VCC
109
B5
TRST
TRST
TRST
TRST
RES
110
C5
TDI
TDI
TDI
TDI
VCC
111
A4
PE0/D0
PE0/D0
PE0/D0
PE0
NC
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 9 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Pin Name
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V
Mode 4
Mode 5
Mode 6
Mode 7*1
PROM Mode
112
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
113
D5
PE1/D1
PE1/D1
PE1/D1
PE1
NC
114
—
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
115
B4
PE2/D2
PE2/D2
PE2/D2
PE2
NC
116
A3
PE3/D3
PE3/D3
PE3/D3
PE3
VCC
117
C4
PE4/D4
PE4/D4
PE4/D4
PE4
VSS
118
B3
PE5/D5
PE5/D5
PE5D5
PE5
OE
119
A2
PE6/D6
PE6/D6
PE6/D6
PE6
WE
120
C3
PE7/D7
PE7/D7
PE7/D7
PE7
CE
—
A1, A11,
L1, L11
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
Notes: NC (No Connection): These pins should not be connected; they should be left open.
1. The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
2. NC in H8S/2215. EMLE pin in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
3. PUPD+ pin in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
Page 10 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
1.5
Section 1 Overview
Pin Functions
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
Power Supply VCC
VSS
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
10
E4
75
F11
12
61
73
E1
Function
Input
Power supply pins. Connect all these
pins to the system power supply.
Input
Ground pins. Connect all these pins
to the system power supply (0 V).
G10
PLLVCC
64
H8
Input
Power supply pin for internal PLL
oscillator. Connect this pin to the
system power supply.
PLLVSS
62
K10
Input
Ground pin for an on-chip PLL
oscillator.
PLLCAP
63
K11
Output
External capacitor pin for an on-chip
PLL oscillator.
XTAL
74
F9
Input
For connection to a crystal resonator.
For examples of crystal resonator
connection and external clock input,
see section 21, Clock Pulse
Generator.
EXTAL
76
F10
Input
For connection to a crystal resonator.
(An external clock can be supplied
from the EXTAL pin.) For examples
of crystal resonator connection and
external clock input, see section 21,
Clock Pulse Generator.
XTAL48
65
J10
Input
USB operating clock input pins.
EXTAL48
66
J11
Input
48-MHz clock for USB
communications is input. For
examples of using an on-chip PLL,
EXTAL48 must be fixed low and
XTAL48 must be open.
φ
78
E11
Output
Supplies the system clock to external
devices.
Operating
MD2
Mode Control MD1
77
F8
Input
68
H10
MD0
67
H9
Except for mode changing, be sure to
fix the levels of the mode pins (MD2
to MD0) by pulling them down or
pulling them up until the power turns
off.
Clock
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 11 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
System
Control
RES
72
G11
Input
Reset input pin. When this pin is
driven low, the chip is reset.
STBY
71
G9
Input
When this pin is driven low, a
transition is made to hardware
standby mode.
MRES
96
A9
Input
When this pin is driven low, a
transition is made to manual reset
mode.
BREQ
87
D9
Input
Used by an external bus master to
issue a bus request to this LSI
BACK
86
C11
Output
Indicates that the bus has been
released to an external bus master.
FWE
69
H11
Input
Pin for use by flash memory. This pin
is only used in the flash memory
version. In the mask ROM version it
should be fixed at 0.
1
EMLE*
1*
A1*
Input
Emulator enable pin. Leave open if
the E10A is not used. Drive low level
only if E10A is used.
NMI
70
G8
Input
Nonmaskable interrupt pin. If this pin
is not used, it should be fixed high.
IRQ7
102
A7
Input
IRQ5
93
D8
These pins request a maskable
interrupt.
IRQ4
90
C9
IRQ3
83
E8
IRQ2
87
D9
IRQ1
41
J5
IRQ0
39
L4
Interrupts
Page 12 of 846
1
1
Function
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Function
Address bus
A23
38
K4
These pins output an address.
A22
37
J4
A21
36
L3
A20
35
K3
A19
33
H4
A18
32
L2
A17
31
K2
A16
30
J3
A15
29
K1
A14
28
J2
A13
27
H3
A12
26
J1
A11
25
H2
A10
23
G4
A9
21
H1
A8
20
G3
A7
19
G2
A6
18
G1
A5
17
F4
A4
16
F2
A3
15
F1
A2
14
F3
A1
13
E2
A0
11
E3
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Output
Page 13 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Data bus
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
120
119
118
117
116
115
113
111
Page 14 of 846
D1
D2
D3
C1
C2
D4
B1
B2
C3
A2
B3
C4
A3
B4
D5
A4
I/O
Function
These pins constitute a bi-directional
data bus.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Function
Bus Control
CS7
97
C8
Output
Signals for selecting areas 7 to 0.
CS6
98
B8
CS5
99
A8
CS4
100
D7
CS3
102
A7
CS2
103
B7
CS1
104
C6
CS0
105
A6
AS
79
E10
Output
When this pin is low, it indicates that
address output on the address bus is
enabled.
RD
80
E9
Output
When this pin is low, it indicates that
the external address space can be
read.
HWR
81
D11
Output
A strobe signal that writes to external
space and indicates that the upper
half (D15 to D8) of the data bus is
enabled.
LWR
83
E8
Output
A strobe signal that writes to external
space and indicates that the lower
half (D7 to D0) of the data bus is
enabled.
WAIT
85
D10
Input
Requests insertion of a wait state in
the bus cycle when accessing
external 3-state address space.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 15 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Function
16-bit timer
pulse unit
(TPU)
TCLKA
37
J4
Input
TPU external clock input pins.
TCLKB
38
K4
TCLKC
40
H5
TCLKD
42
L5
TIOCA0
35
K3
I/O
TIOCB0
36
L3
TIOCC0
37
J4
The TGRA_0 to TGRD_0 input
capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pins.
TIOCD0
38
K4
TIOCA1
39
L4
I/O
TIOCB1
40
H5
The TGRA_1 to TGRB_1 input
capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pins.
TIOCA2
41
J5
I/O
TIOCB2
42
L5
The TGRA_2 to TGRB_2 input
capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pins.
TMO1
97
C8
Output
Compare match output pins.
TMO0
98
B8
TMCI01
100
D7
Input
Input pins for the external clock input
to the counter.
8-bit timer
(TMR)
100
D7
Input
The counter reset input pins.
Serial
TxD2
Communica- TxD1
tion interface
TxD0
(SCI)
RxD2
TMRI01
31
K2
Output
Data output pins
91
B10
88
C10
32
L2
Input
Data input pins
RxD1
92
A10
RxD0
89
B11
SCK2
33
H4
I/O
Clock input/output pins
SCK1
93
D8
SCK0
90
C9
Page 16 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
A/D converter AN15
44
J6
AN14
45
L6
AN3
46
K6
AN2
47
H6
AN1
48
L7
AN0
49
K7
ADTRG
83
D/A converter DA1
DA0
Input
Analog input pins for the A/D
converter.
E8
Input
Pin for input of an external trigger to
start A/D conversion
44
J6
Output
45
L6
Analog output pins for the D/A
converter.
51
L8
Input
Power supply pin for the A/D and D/A
converter. When the D/A converter is
not used, connect this pin to the
system power supply (VCC).
AVSS
43
K5
Input
The ground pin for the A/D and D/A
converter. Connect this pin to the
system power supply (0 V).
Vref
50
J7
Input
The reference voltage input pin for
the A/D and D/A converter. When the
A/D and D/A converter is not used,
this pin should be connected to the
system power supply (VCC).
TMS
108
A5
Input
Control signal input pin for the
boundary scan
TCK
107
D6
Input
Clock input pin for the boundary scan
TD0
106
B6
Output
Data output pin for the boundary scan
A/D converter AVCC
D/A converter
Boundary
scan
Function
TDI
110
C5
Input
Data input pin for the boundary scan
TRST
109
B5
Input
Reset pin for the TAP controller
Perform pin processing even when
the boundary scan function is not
used. For details, see 14.5, Usage
Notes.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 17 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Function
USB
USD+
58
K9
I/O
USB data input/output pin
USD-
59
L10
VBUS
55
K8
Input
Connection/disconnection detecting
Input/output pin for the USB cable
USPND
53
H7
Output
USB suspend output
This pin is driven high when a
transition is made to suspend state.
VM
35
K3
VP
36
L3
RCV
37
J4
VPO
38
K4
FSE0
40
H5
OE
42
L5
SUSPND
33
H4
UBPM
56
L9
Input
Pins to be connected to the
transceiver (ISP1104) manufactured
by NXP.
Output
Input
Bus power/self power mode setting
Input.
When the USB is used in bus power
mode, this input pin must be fixed at
0.
When the USB is used in self power
mode, this input pin must be fixed at
1.
Page 18 of 846
DrVCC
57
J8
⎯
Power supply for the on-chip
transceiver. Connect this pin to the
system power supply.
DrVSS
60
J9
⎯
Ground pin for the on-chip
transceiver.
P36
(PUPD+)
94
B9
I/O
Used for D+ pull-up control.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
I/O port
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
L5
J5
H5
L4
K4
J4
L3
K3
I/O
8-bit I/O pins
P36
P35
P34
P33
P32
P31
P30
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
B9
D8
A10
B10
C9
B11
C10
I/O
7-bit I/O pins
P43
46
K6
Input
4-bit input pins
P42
47
H6
P41
48
L7
P40
49
K7
P74
96
A9
I/O
5-bit I/O pins
P73
97
C8
P72
98
B8
P71
99
A8
P70
100
D7
P97
44
J6
Input
2-bit input pins
P96
45
L6
PA3
33
H4
I/O
4-bit I/O pins
PA2
32
L2
PA1
31
K2
PA0
30
J3
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Function
Page 19 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Function
I/O port
PB7
29
K1
I/O
8-bit I/O pins
PB6
28
J2
PB5
27
H3
PB4
26
J1
PB3
25
H2
PB2
23
G4
PB1
21
H1
I/O
8-bit I/O pins
I/O
8-bit I/O pins
I/O
8-bit I/O pins
Page 20 of 846
PB0
20
G3
PC7
19
G2
PC6
18
G1
PC5
17
F4
PC4
16
F2
PC3
15
F1
PC2
14
F3
PC1
13
E2
PC0
11
E3
PD7
9
D1
PD6
8
D2
PD5
7
D3
PD4
6
C1
PD3
5
C2
PD2
4
D4
PD1
3
B1
PD0
2
B2
PE7
120
C3
PE6
119
A2
PE5
118
B3
PE4
117
C4
PE3
116
A3
PE2
115
B4
PE1
113
D5
PE0
111
A4
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 1 Overview
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
TFP-120, BP-112,
TFP-120V BP-112V I/O
Function
I/O port
PF7
78
E11
I/O
8-bit I/O pins
PF6
79
E10
PF5
80
E9
PF4
81
D11
PF3
83
E8
PF2
85
D10
PF1
86
C11
I/O
5-bit I/O pins
⎯
NC (No Connection): These pins
should not be connected; they should
be left open.
NC
PF0
87
D9
PG4
105
A6
PG3
104
C6
PG2
103
B7
PG1
102
A7
PG0
101
C7
NC
1*
A1*
2
2
22
A11
24
L1
34
L11
52
54
82
84
95
112
114
Notes: 1. Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C. (NC in H8S/2215.)
2. Available only in H8S/2215 (EMLE pin in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 21 of 846
Section 1 Overview
Page 22 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Section 2 CPU
The H8S/2000 CPU is a high-speed central processing unit with an internal 32-bit architecture that
is upward compatible with the H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs. The H8S/2000 CPU has sixteen 16-bit
general registers, can address a 16-Mbyte linear address space, and is ideal for realtime control.
This section describes the H8S/2000 CPU. The usable modes and address spaces differ depending
on the product. For details on each product, refer to section 3, MCU Operating Modes.
2.1
Features
• Upward-compatible with H8/300 and H8/300H CPUs
⎯ Can execute H8/300 and H8/300H CPU object programs
• General-register architecture
⎯ Sixteen 16-bit general registers also usable as sixteen 8-bit registers or eight 32-bit registers
• Sixty-five basic instructions
⎯ 8/16/32-bit arithmetic and logic instructions
⎯ Multiply and divide instructions
⎯ Powerful bit-manipulation instructions
• Eight addressing modes
⎯ Register direct [Rn]
⎯ Register indirect [@ERn]
⎯ Register indirect with displacement [@(d:16,ERn) or @(d:32,ERn)]
⎯ Register indirect with post-increment or pre-decrement [@ERn+ or @–ERn]
⎯ Absolute address [@aa:8, @aa:16, @aa:24, or @aa:32]
⎯ Immediate [#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32]
⎯ Program-counter relative [@(d:8,PC) or @(d:16,PC)]
⎯ Memory indirect [@@aa:8]
• 16-Mbyte address space
⎯ Program: 16 Mbytes
⎯ Data: 16 Mbytes
• High-speed operation
⎯ All frequently-used instructions execute in one or two states
⎯ 8/16/32-bit register-register add/subtract: 1 state
⎯ 8 × 8-bit register-register multiply: 12 states
⎯ 16 ÷ 8-bit register-register divide: 12 states
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 23 of 846
CPUS211A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
⎯ 16 × 16-bit register-register multiply: 20 states
⎯ 32 ÷ 16-bit register-register divide: 20 states
• Two CPU operating modes
⎯ Normal mode*
⎯ Advanced mode
Note: * Normal mode is not available in this LSI.
• Power-down state
⎯ Transition to power-down state by SLEEP instruction
⎯ CPU clock speed selection
2.1.1
Differences between H8S/2600 CPU and H8S/2000 CPU
The differences between the H8S/2600 CPU and the H8S/2000 CPU are as shown below.
• Register configuration
The MAC register is supported only by the H8S/2600 CPU.
• Basic instructions
The four instructions MAC, CLRMAC, LDMAC, and STMAC are supported only by the
H8S/2600 CPU.
• The number of execution states of the MULXU and MULXS instructions
Execution States
Instruction
MULXU
MULXS
Mnemonic
H8S/2600
H8S/2000
MULXU.B Rs, Rd
3
12
MULXU.W Rs, ERd
4
20
MULXS.B Rs, Rd
4
13
MULXS.W Rs, ERd
5
21
In addition, there are differences in address space, CCR and EXR register functions, power-down
modes, etc., depending on the model.
Page 24 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
2.1.2
Section 2 CPU
Differences from H8/300 CPU
In comparison to the H8/300 CPU, the H8S/2000 CPU has the following enhancements.
• More general registers and control registers
⎯ Eight 16-bit extended registers, and one 8-bit and two 32-bit control registers, have been
added.
• Extended address space
⎯ Normal mode supports the same 64-kbyte address space as the H8/300 CPU.
⎯ Advanced mode supports a maximum 16-Mbyte address space.
• Enhanced addressing
⎯ The addressing modes have been enhanced to make effective use of the 16-Mbyte address
space.
• Enhanced instructions
⎯ Addressing modes of bit-manipulation instructions have been enhanced.
⎯ Signed multiply and divide instructions have been added.
⎯ Two-bit shift instructions have been added.
⎯ Instructions for saving and restoring multiple registers have been added.
⎯ A test and set instruction has been added.
• Higher speed
⎯ Basic instructions execute twice as fast.
2.1.3
Differences from H8/300H CPU
In comparison to the H8/300H CPU, the H8S/2000 CPU has the following enhancements.
• Additional control register
⎯ One 8-bit control registers have been added.
• Enhanced instructions
⎯ Addressing modes of bit-manipulation instructions have been enhanced.
⎯ Two-bit shift instructions have been added.
⎯ Instructions for saving and restoring multiple registers have been added.
⎯ A test and set instruction has been added.
• Higher speed
⎯ Basic instructions execute twice as fast.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 25 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.2
CPU Operating Modes
The H8S/2000 CPU has two operating modes: normal and advanced. Normal mode supports a
maximum 64-kbyte address space. Advanced mode supports a maximum 16-Mbyte total address
space. The mode is selected by the mode pins.
2.2.1
Normal Mode
The exception vector table and stack have the same structure as in the H8/300 CPU.
• Address Space
A maximum address space of 64 kbytes can be accessed.
• Extended Registers (En)
The extended registers (E0 to E7) can be used as 16-bit registers, or as the upper 16-bit
segments of 32-bit registers. When En is used as a 16-bit register it can contain any value, even
when the corresponding general register (Rn) is used as an address register. If the general
register is referenced in the register indirect addressing mode with pre-decrement (@–Rn) or
post-increment (@Rn+) and a carry or borrow occurs, however, the value in the corresponding
extended register (En) will be affected.
• Instruction Set
All instructions and addressing modes can be used. Only the lower 16 bits of effective
addresses (EA) are valid.
• Exception Vector Table and Memory Indirect Branch Addresses
In normal mode the top area starting at H'0000 is allocated to the exception vector table. One
branch address is stored per 16 bits. The exception vector table in normal mode is shown in
figure 2.1. For details of the exception vector table, see section 4, Exception Handling.
The memory indirect addressing mode (@@aa:8) employed in the JMP and JSR instructions
uses an 8-bit absolute address included in the instruction code to specify a memory operand
that contains a branch address. In normal mode the operand is a 16-bit (word) operand,
providing a 16-bit branch address. Branch addresses can be stored in the top area from H'0000
to H'00FF. Note that this area is also used for the exception vector table.
• Stack Structure
When the program counter (PC) is pushed onto the stack in a subroutine call, and the PC,
condition-code register (CCR), and extended control register (EXR) are pushed onto the stack
in exception handling, they are stored as shown in figure 2.2. EXR is not pushed onto the stack
in interrupt control mode 0. For details, see section 4, Exception Handling.
Note: Normal mode is not available in this LSI.
Page 26 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
H'0000
H'0001
H'0002
H'0003
H'0004
H'0005
H'0006
H'0007
H'0008
H'0009
H'000A
H'000B
Reset exception vector
(Reserved for system use)
(Reserved for system use)
Exception
vector table
Exception vector 1
Exception vector 2
Figure 2.1 Exception Vector Table (Normal Mode)
SP
PC
(16 bits)
EXR*1
SP
Reserved*1*3
(SP*2
)
CCR
CCR*3
PC
(16 bits)
(a) Subroutine Branch
(b) Exception Handling
Notes: 1. When EXR is not used, it is not stored on the stack.
2. SP when EXR is not used.
3. Ignored when returning.
Figure 2.2 Stack Structure in Normal Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 27 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.2.2
Advanced Mode
• Address Space
Linear access is provided to a 16-Mbyte maximum address space.
• Extended Registers (En)
The extended registers (E0 to E7) can be used as 16-bit registers, or as the upper 16-bit
segments of 32-bit registers or address registers.
• Instruction Set
All instructions and addressing modes can be used.
• Exception Vector Table and Memory Indirect Branch Addresses
In advanced mode the top area starting at H'00000000 is allocated to the exception vector table
in units of 32 bits. In each 32 bits, the upper 8 bits are ignored and a branch address is stored in
the lower 24 bits (figure 2.3). For details of the exception vector table, see section 4, Exception
Handling.
H'00000000
Reserved
Reset exception vector
H'00000003
H'00000004
Reserved
(Reserved for system use)
H'00000007
H'00000008
Exception vector table
H'0000000B
H'0000000C
H'00000010
(Reserved for system use)
Reserved
Exception vector 1
Figure 2.3 Exception Vector Table (Advanced Mode)
The memory indirect addressing mode (@@aa:8) employed in the JMP and JSR instructions
uses an 8-bit absolute address included in the instruction code to specify a memory operand
that contains a branch address. In advanced mode the operand is a 32-bit longword operand,
Page 28 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
providing a 32-bit branch address. The upper 8 bits of these 32 bits are a reserved area that is
regarded as H'00. Branch addresses can be stored in the area from H'00000000 to H'000000FF.
Note that the first part of this range is also the exception vector table.
• Stack Structure
In advanced mode, when the program counter (PC) is pushed onto the stack in a subroutine
call, and the PC, condition-code register (CCR), and extended control register (EXR) are
pushed onto the stack in exception handling, they are stored as shown in figure 2.4. When
EXR is invalid, it is not pushed onto the stack. For details, see section 4, Exception Handling.
EXR*1
SP
SP
Reserved*1*3
Reserved
PC
(24 bits)
(SP*2
)
(a) Subroutine Branch
CCR
PC
(24 bits)
(b) Exception Handling
Notes: 1. When EXR is not used, it is not stored on the stack.
2. SP when EXR is not used.
3. Ignored when returning.
Figure 2.4 Stack Structure in Advanced Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 29 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.3
Address Space
Figure 2.5 shows a memory map of the H8S/2000 CPU. The H8S/2000 CPU provides linear
access to a maximum 64-kbyte address space in normal mode, and a maximum 16-Mbyte
(architecturally 4-Gbyte) address space in advanced mode. The usable modes and address spaces
differ depending on the product. For details on each product, refer to section 3, MCU Operating
Modes.
H'0000
H'00000000
64 kbytes
16 Mbytes
H'FFFF
Program area
H'00FFFFFF
Data area
Not available
in this LSI.
H'FFFFFFFF
(a) Normal Mode*
(b) Advanced Mode
Note: * Not available in this LSI.
Figure 2.5 Memory Map
Page 30 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
2.4
Section 2 CPU
Register Configuration
The H8S/2000 CPU has the internal registers shown in figure 2.6. There are two types of registers:
general registers and control registers. Control registers are a 24-bit program counter (PC), an 8-bit
extended control register (EXR), and an 8-bit condition code register (CCR).
General Registers (Rn) and Extended Registers (En)
15
0 7
0 7
0
ER0
E0
R0H
R0L
ER1
E1
R1H
R1L
ER2
E2
R2H
R2L
ER3
E3
R3H
R3L
ER4
E4
R4H
R4L
ER5
E5
R5H
R5L
ER6
E6
R6H
R6L
ER7 (SP)
E7
R7H
R7L
Control Registers (CR)
23
0
PC
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
- - - - I2 I1 I0
EXR T
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
CCR I UI H U N Z V C
Legend:
SP:
PC:
EXR:
T:
I2 to I0:
CCR:
I:
UI:
Stack pointer
Program counter
Extended control register
Trace bit
Interrupt mask bits
Condition-code register
Interrupt mask bit
User bit or interrupt mask bit*
H:
U:
N:
Z:
V:
C:
Half-carry flag
User bit
Negative flag
Zero flag
Overflow flag
Carry flag
Note: * Cannot be used as an interrupt mask bit in this LSI.
Figure 2.6 CPU Registers
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 31 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.4.1
General Registers
The H8S/2000 CPU has eight 32-bit general registers. These general registers are all functionally
alike and can be used as both address registers and data registers. When a general register is used
as a data register, it can be accessed as a 32-bit, 16-bit, or 8-bit register. Figure 2.7 illustrates the
usage of the general registers. When the general registers are used as 32-bit registers or address
registers, they are designated by the letters ER (ER0 to ER7).
The ER registers divide into 16-bit general registers designated by the letters E (E0 to E7) and R
(R0 to R7). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum sixteen 16-bit
registers. The E registers (E0 to E7) are also referred to as extended registers.
The R registers divide into 8-bit general registers designated by the letters RH (R0H to R7H) and
RL (R0L to R7L). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum sixteen 8-bit
registers.
The usage of each register can be selected independently.
General register ER7 has the function of stack pointer (SP) in addition to its general-register
function, and is used implicitly in exception handling and subroutine calls. Figure 2.8 shows the
stack.
• Address registers
• 32-bit registers
• 16-bit registers
• 8-bit registers
E registers (extended registers)
(E0 to E7)
ER registers
(ER0 to ER7)
RH registers
(R0H to R7H)
R registers
(R0 to R7)
RL registers
(R0L to R7L)
Figure 2.7 Usage of General Registers
Page 32 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Free area
SP (ER7)
Stack area
Figure 2.8 Stack
2.4.2
Program Counter (PC)
This 24-bit counter indicates the address of the next instruction the CPU will execute. The length
of all CPU instructions is two bytes (one word), so the least significant PC bit is ignored (When an
instruction is fetched, the least significant PC bit is regarded as 0).
2.4.3
Extended Control Register (EXR)
EXR is an 8-bit register that manipulates the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions.
When these instructions except for the STC instruction is executed, all interrupts including NMI
will be masked for three states after execution is completed.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
T
0
Trace Bit
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, a trace exception is
generated each time an instruction is executed. When
this bit is cleared to 0, instructions are executed in
sequence.
6 to
—
All 1
—
3
2 to
0
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1.
I2
1
I1
R/W
These bits designate the interrupt mask level (0 to 7).
For details, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller.
I0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 33 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.4.4
Condition-Code Register (CCR)
This 8-bit register contains internal CPU status information, including an interrupt mask bit (I) and
half-carry (H), negative (N), zero (Z), overflow (V), and carry (C) flags.
Operations can be performed on the CCR bits by the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC
instructions. The N, Z, V, and C flags are used as branching conditions for conditional branch
(Bcc) instructions.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W Description
7
I
1
R/W Interrupt Mask Bit
Masks interrupts other than NMI when set to 1. NMI is
accepted regardless of the I bit setting. The I bit is set to 1
by hardware at the start of an exception-handling
sequence. For details, refer to section 5, Interrupt
Controller.
6
UI
undefined
R/W User Bit or Interrupt Mask Bit
Can be written and read by software using the LDC, STC,
ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. This bit cannot be
used as an interrupt mask bit in this LSI.
5
H
undefined
R/W Half-Carry Flag
When the ADD.B, ADDX.B, SUB.B, SUBX.B, CMP.B or
NEG.B instruction is executed, this flag is set to 1 if there is
a carry or borrow at bit 3, and cleared to 0 otherwise. When
the ADD.W, SUB.W, CMP.W, or NEG.W instruction is
executed, the H flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow
at bit 11, and cleared to 0 otherwise. When the ADD.L,
SUB.L, CMP.L, or NEG.L instruction is executed, the H flag
is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 27, and cleared
to 0 otherwise.
4
U
undefined
R/W User Bit
Can be written and read by software using the LDC, STC,
ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions.
3
N
undefined
R/W Negative Flag
Stores the value of the most significant bit of data as a sign
bit.
2
Z
undefined
R/W Zero Flag
Set to 1 to indicate zero data, and cleared to 0 to indicate
non-zero data.
Page 34 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W Description
1
V
undefined
R/W Overflow Flag
Set to 1 when an arithmetic overflow occurs, and cleared to
0 at other times.
0
C
undefined
R/W Carry Flag
Set to 1 when a carry occurs, and cleared to 0 otherwise.
Used by:
•
•
•
Add instructions, to indicate a carry
Subtract instructions, to indicate a carry
Shift and rotate instructions, to indicate a carry
They carry flag is also used as a bit accumulator by bit
manipulation instructions.
2.4.5
Initial Register Values
Reset exception handling loads the CPU’s program counter (PC) from the vector table, clears the
trace bit in EXR to 0, and sets the interrupt mask bits in CCR and EXR to 1. The other CCR bits
and the general registers are not initialized. In particular, the stack pointer (ER7) is not initialized.
The stack pointer should therefore be initialized by an MOV.L instruction executed immediately
after a reset.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 35 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.5
Data Formats
The H8S/2000 CPU can process 1-bit, 4-bit (BCD), 8-bit (byte), 16-bit (word), and 32-bit
(longword) data. Bit-manipulation instructions operate on 1-bit data by accessing bit n (n = 0, 1, 2,
…, 7) of byte operand data. The DAA and DAS decimal-adjust instructions treat byte data as two
digits of 4-bit BCD data.
2.5.1
General Register Data Formats
Figure 2.9 shows the data formats in general registers.
Data Type
Register Number
Data Image
7
RnH
1-bit data
0
Don't care
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
7
1-bit data
RnL
4-bit BCD data
RnH
4-bit BCD data
RnL
Byte data
RnH
Don't care
7
4 3
Upper
0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0
Lower
Don't care
7
Don't care
7
4 3
Upper
0
Don't care
MSB
LSB
7
Byte data
RnL
0
Lower
0
Don't care
MSB
LSB
Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (1)
Page 36 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Data Type
Register Number
Word data
Rn
Data Image
15
0
MSB
Word data
15
0
MSB
Longword data
LSB
En
LSB
ERn
31
16 15
MSB
En
0
Rn
LSB
Legend:
ERn:
En:
Rn:
RnH:
RnL:
MSB:
LSB:
General register ER
General register E
General register R
General register RH
General register RL
Most significant bit
Least significant bit
Figure 2.9 General Register Data Formats (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 37 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.5.2
Memory Data Formats
Figure 2.10 shows the data formats in memory. The H8S/2000 CPU can access word data and
longword data in memory, but word or longword data must begin at an even address. If an attempt
is made to access word or longword data at an odd address, no address error occurs but the least
significant bit of the address is regarded as 0, so the access starts at the preceding address. This
also applies to instruction fetches.
When SP (ER7) is used as an address register to access the stack, the operand size should be word
size or longword size.
Data Type
Address
Data Image
1-bit data
Address L
7
Byte data
Address L
MSB
Word data
Address 2M
MSB
7
0
6
5
4
3
2
Address 2N
0
LSB
LSB
Address 2M+1
Longword data
1
MSB
Address 2N+1
Address 2N+2
Address 2N+3
LSB
Figure 2.10 Memory Data Formats
Page 38 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
2.6
Section 2 CPU
Instruction Set
The H8S/2000 CPU has 65 types of instructions. The instructions are classified by function in
table 2.1.
Table 2.1
Instruction Classification
Function
Instructions
Size
Types
Data transfer
MOV
B/W/L
5
1
1
POP* , PUSH*
5
5
LDM* , STM*
W/L
MOVFPE* , MOVTPE*
3
Arithmetic
operations
L
3
B
ADD, SUB, CMP, NEG
B/W/L
ADDX, SUBX, DAA, DAS
B
INC, DEC
B/W/L
ADDS, SUBS
L
MULXU, DIVXU, MULXS, DIVXS
B/W
EXTU, EXTS
4
TAS*
W/L
B
Logic operations
AND, OR, XOR, NOT
B/W/L
4
Shift
SHAL, SHAR, SHLL, SHLR, ROTL, ROTR, ROTXL,
ROTXR
B/W/L
8
Bit manipulation
BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BTST, BLD, BILD, BST, BIST, BAND, B
BIAND, BOR, BIOR, BXOR, BIXOR
Branch
Bcc* , JMP, BSR, JSR, RTS
—
5
System control
TRAPA, RTE, SLEEP, LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, XORC,
NOP
—
9
—
1
2
Block data transfer EEPMOV
19
14
Total: 65
Legend:
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
Notes: 1. POP.W Rn and PUSH.W Rn are identical to MOV.W @SP+, Rn and MOV.W Rn,
@-SP. POP.L ERn and PUSH.L ERn are identical to MOV.L @SP+, ERn and MOV.L
ERn, @-SP.
2. Bcc is the general name for conditional branch instructions.
3. Cannot be used in this LSI.
4. Only register ER0, ER1, ER4, or ER5 should be used when using the TAS instruction.
5. The ER7 register functions as a stack pointer for the LDM and STM instructions, so it
cannot be for saving (STM) or restoring (LDM) data.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 39 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.6.1
Table of Instructions Classified by Function
Tables 2.3 to 2.10 summarizes the instructions in each functional category. The notation used in
tables 2.3 to 2.10 is defined below.
Table 2.2
Operation Notation
Symbol
Description
Rd
Rs
General register (destination)*
General register (source)*
Rn
General register*
ERn
General register (32-bit register)
(EAd)
Destination operand
(EAs)
Source operand
EXR
Extended control register
CCR
Condition-code register
N
N (negative) flag in CCR
Z
Z (zero) flag in CCR
V
V (overflow) flag in CCR
C
C (carry) flag in CCR
PC
Program counter
SP
Stack pointer
#IMM
Immediate data
disp
Displacement
+
Addition
–
Subtraction
×
Multiplication
÷
Division
∧
Logical AND
∨
Logical OR
⊕
Logical exclusive OR
→
Move
∼
NOT (logical complement)
:8/:16/:24/:32
8-, 16-, 24-, or 32-bit length
Note:
*
General registers include 8-bit registers (R0H to R7H, R0L to R7L), 16-bit registers (R0
to R7, E0 to E7), and 32-bit registers (ER0 to ER7).
Page 40 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Table 2.3
Section 2 CPU
Data Transfer Instructions
Instruction
Size*
Function
MOV
B/W/L
(EAs) → Rd, Rs → (EAd)
1
Moves data between two general registers or between a general register
and memory, or moves immediate data to a general register.
MOVFPE
B
Cannot be used in this LSI.
MOVTPE
B
Cannot be used in this LSI.
POP
W/L
@SP+ → Rn
Pops a general register from the stack. POP.W Rn is identical to MOV.W
@SP+, Rn. POP.L ERn is identical to MOV.L @SP+, ERn
PUSH
W/L
Rn → @-SP
Pushes a general register onto the stack. PUSH.W Rn is identical to
MOV.W Rn, @-SP. PUSH.L ERn is identical to MOV.L ERn, @-SP.
2
LDM*
L
@SP+ → Rn (register list)
Pops two or more general registers from the stack.
STM*
2
L
Rn (register list) → @-SP
Pushes two or more general registers onto the stack.
Notes: 1. Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
2. ER7 is used as a stack pointer in STM and LDM instructions. ER7, therefore, should not
be used as a saving (STM) or restoring (LDM) register.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 41 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.4
Arithmetic Operations Instructions (1)
Instruction
Size*
ADD
B/W/L
SUB
Function
Rd ± Rs → Rd, Rd ± #IMM → Rd
Performs addition or subtraction on data in two general registers, or on
immediate data and data in a general register. (Immediate byte data
cannot be subtracted from byte data in a general register. Use the SUBX
or ADD instruction.)
ADDX
B
SUBX
Rd ± Rs ± C → Rd, Rd ± #IMM ± C → Rd
Performs addition or subtraction with carry or borrow on byte data in two
general registers, or on immediate data and data in a general register.
INC
B/W/L
DEC
Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd
Increments or decrements a general register by 1 or 2. (Byte operands
can be incremented or decremented by 1 only.)
ADDS
L
SUBS
Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd, Rd ± 4 → Rd
Adds or subtracts the value 1, 2, or 4 to or from data in a 32-bit register.
DAA
B
DAS
Rd (decimal adjust) → Rd
Decimal-adjusts an addition or subtraction result in a general register by
referring to the OCR to produce 4-bit BCD data.
MULXU
B/W
Rd × Rs → Rd
Performs unsigned multiplication on data in two general registers: either
8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits.
MULXS
B/W
Rd × Rs → Rd
Performs signed multiplication on data in two general registers: either 8
bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits.
DIVXU
B/W
Rd ÷ Rs → Rd
Performs unsigned division on data in two general registers: either 16
bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits →
16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder.
Note:
*
Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
Page 42 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.4
Arithmetic Operations Instructions (2)
Instruction
Size*
DIVXS
B/W
1
Function
Rd ÷ Rs → Rd
Performs signed division on data in two general registers: either 16 bits ÷
8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits → 16-bit
quotient and 16-bit remainder.
CMP
B/W/L
Rd – Rs, Rd – #IMM
Compares data in a general register with data in another general register
or with immediate data, and sets CCR bits according to the result.
NEG
B/W/L
0 – Rd → Rd
Takes the two's complement (arithmetic complement) of data in a
general register.
EXTU
W/L
Rd (zero extension) → Rd
Extends the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word size, or the lower 16
bits of a 32-bit register to longword size, by padding with zeros on the
left.
EXTS
W/L
Rd (sign extension) → Rd
Extends the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word size, or the lower 16
bits of a 32-bit register to longword size, by extending the sign bit.
TAS*
2
B
@ERd – 0, 1 → (<bit 7> of @ERd)
Tests memory contents, and sets the most significant bit (bit 7) to 1.
Notes: 1. Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
2. Only register ER0, ER1, ER4, or ER5 should be used when using the TAS instruction.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 43 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.5
Logic Operations Instructions
Instruction
Size*
Function
AND
B/W/L
Rd ∧ Rs → Rd, Rd ∧ #IMM → Rd
Performs a logical AND operation on a general register and another
general register or immediate data.
OR
B/W/L
Rd ∨ Rs → Rd, Rd ∨ #IMM → Rd
Performs a logical OR operation on a general register and another
general register or immediate data.
XOR
B/W/L
Rd ⊕ Rs → Rd, Rd ⊕ #IMM → Rd
Performs a logical exclusive OR operation on a general register and
another general register or immediate data.
NOT
B/W/L
∼ Rd → Rd
Takes the one's complement (logical complement) of general register
contents.
Note:
*
Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
Table 2.6
Shift Instructions
Instruction
Size*
Function
SHAL
B/W/L
Rd (shift) → Rd
SHAR
Performs an arithmetic shift on general register contents. 1-bit or 2 bit
shift is possible.
SHLL
B/W/L
SHLR
Performs an logical shift on general register contents. 1-bit or 2 bit shift is
possible.
ROTL
B/W/L
ROTR
Rd (rotate) → Rd
Rotates general register contents. 1-bit or 2 bit rotation is possible.
ROTXL
B/W/L
ROTXR
Note:
Rd (shift) → Rd
Rd (rotate) → Rd
Rotates general register contents through the carry flag. 1-bit or 2 bit
rotation is possible.
*
Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
Page 44 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.7
Bit Manipulation Instructions (1)
Instruction
Size*
BSET
B
Function
1 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Sets a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 1. The bit
number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of a
general register.
BCLR
B
0 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Clears a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 0. The
bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of
a general register.
BNOT
B
∼ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Inverts a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. The bit
number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower three bits of a
general register.
BTST
B
∼ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → Z
Tests a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and sets or
clears the Z flag accordingly. The bit number is specified by 3-bit
immediate data or the lower three bits of a general register.
BAND
B
C ∧ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
ANDs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIAND
B
C ∧ ∼ [ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) ] → C
ANDs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general
register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The
bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
BOR
B
C ∨ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIOR
B
C ∨ [∼ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) ] → C
ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register
or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag. The bit
number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
Note:
*
Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 45 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.7
Bit Manipulation Instructions (2)
Instruction
Size*
BXOR
B
Function
C ⊕ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
Exclusive-ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or
memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIXOR
B
C ⊕ [∼ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) ] → C
Exclusive-ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a
general register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry
flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
BLD
B
(<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
Transfers a specified bit in a general register or memory to the carry
flag.
BILD
B
∼ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
Transfers the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand to the carry flag. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate
data.
BST
B
C → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Transfers the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general register or
memory operand.
BIST
B
∼ C → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Transfers the inverse of the carry flag value to a specified bit in a
general register or memory operand. The bit number is specified by 3bit immediate data.
Note:
*
Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
Page 46 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Table 2.8
Section 2 CPU
Branch Instructions
Instruction
Size
Function
Bcc
—
Branches to a specified address if a specified condition is true. The
branching conditions are listed below.
Mnemonic
Description
Condition
BRA (BT)
Always (true)
Always
BRN (BF)
Never (false)
Never
BHI
High
C∨Z=0
BLS
Low or same
C∨Z=1
BCC (BHS)
Carry clear
C=0
(high or same)
BCS (BLO)
Carry set (low)
C=1
BNE
Not equal
Z=0
BEQ
Equal
Z=1
BVC
Overflow clear
V=0
BVS
Overflow set
V=1
BPL
Plus
N=0
BMI
Minus
N=1
BGE
Greater or equal
N⊕V=0
BLT
Less than
N⊕V=1
BGT
Greater than
Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 0
BLE
Less or equal
Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 1
JMP
—
Branches unconditionally to a specified address.
BSR
—
Branches to a subroutine at a specified address
JSR
—
Branches to a subroutine at a specified address
RTS
—
Returns from a subroutine
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 47 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.9
System Control Instruction
Instruction
Size*
Function
TRAPA
—
Starts trap-instruction exception handling.
RTE
—
Returns from an exception-handling routine.
SLEEP
—
Causes a transition to a power-down state.
LDC
B/W
(EAs) → CCR, (EAs) → EXR
Moves the source operand contents or immediate data to CCR or EXR.
Although CCR and EXR are 8-bit registers, word-size transfers are
performed between them and memory. The upper 8 bits are valid.
STC
B/W
CCR → (EAd), EXR → (EAd)
Transfers CCR or EXR contents to a general register or memory.
Although CCR and EXR are 8-bit registers, word-size transfers are
performed between them and memory. The upper 8 bits are valid.
ANDC
B
CCR ∧ #IMM → CCR, EXR ∧ #IMM → EXR
Logically ANDs the CCR or EXR contents with immediate data.
ORC
B
CCR ∨ #IMM → CCR, EXR ∨ #IMM → EXR
Logically ORs the CCR or EXR contents with immediate data.
XORC
B
CCR ⊕ #IMM → CCR, EXR ⊕ #IMM → EXR
Logically exclusive-ORs the CCR or EXR contents with immediate data.
NOP
—
PC + 2 → PC
Only increments the program counter.
Note:
*
Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
Page 48 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.10 Block Data Transfer Instruction
Instruction
Size
Function
EEPMOV.B
—
if R4L ≠ 0 then
Repeat @ER5+ → @ER6+
R4L–1 → R4L
Until R4L = 0
else next;
EEPMOV.W
—
if R4 ≠ 0 then
Repeat @ER5+ → @ER6+
R4–1 → R4
Until R4 = 0
else next;
Transfer a data block. Starting from the address set in ER5, transfers
data for the number of bytes set in R4L or R4 to the address location
set in ER6.
Execution of the next instruction begins as soon as the transfer is
completed.
2.6.2
Basic Instruction Formats
The H8S/2000 CPU instructions consist of 2-byte (1-word) units. An instruction consists of an
operation field (op), a register field (r), an effective address extension (EA), and a condition field
(cc).
Figure 2.11 shows examples of instruction formats.
• Operation Field
Indicates the function of the instruction, the addressing mode, and the operation to be carried
out on the operand. The operation field always includes the first four bits of the instruction.
Some instructions have two operation fields.
• Register Field
Specifies a general register. Address registers are specified by 3 bits, data registers by 3 bits or
4 bits. Some instructions have two register fields. Some have no register field.
• Effective Address Extension
8, 16, or 32 bits specifying immediate data, an absolute address, or a displacement.
• Condition Field
Specifies the branching condition of Bcc instructions.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 49 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
(1) Operation field only
op
NOP, RTS, etc.
(2) Operation field and register fields
op
rm
rn
ADD.B Rn, Rm, etc.
(3) Operation field, register fields, and effective address extension
op
rn
rm
MOV.B @(d:16, Rn), Rm, etc.
EA(disp)
(4) Operation field, effective address extension, and condition field
op
cc
EA(disp)
BRA d:16, etc.
Figure 2.11 Instruction Formats (Examples)
2.7
Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation
The H8S/2000 CPU supports the eight addressing modes listed in table 2.11. Each instruction uses
a subset of these addressing modes. Arithmetic and logic instructions can use the register direct
and immediate modes. Data transfer instructions can use all addressing modes except programcounter relative and memory indirect. Bit manipulation instructions use register direct, register
indirect, or absolute addressing mode to specify an operand, and register direct (BSET, BCLR,
BNOT, and BTST instructions) or immediate (3-bit) addressing mode to specify a bit number in
the operand.
Table 2.11 Addressing Modes
No. Addressing Mode
Symbol
1
Rn
Register direct
2
Register indirect
@ERn
3
Register indirect with displacement
@(d:16,ERn)/@(d:32,ERn)
4
Register indirect with post-increment
@ERn+
Register indirect with pre-decrement
@–ERn
Absolute address
@aa:8/@aa:16/@aa:24/@aa:32
5
6
Immediate
#xx:8/#xx:16/#xx:32
7
Program-counter relative
@(d:8,PC)/@(d:16,PC)
8
Memory indirect
@@aa:8
Page 50 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
2.7.1
Section 2 CPU
Register Direct—Rn
The register field of the instruction specifies an 8-, 16-, or 32-bit general register containing the
operand. R0H to R7H and R0L to R7L can be specified as 8-bit registers. R0 to R7 and E0 to E7
can be specified as 16-bit registers. ER0 to ER7 can be specified as 32-bit registers.
2.7.2
Register Indirect—@ERn
The register field of the instruction code specifies an address register (ERn) which contains the
address of the operand on memory. If the address is a program instruction address, the lower 24
bits are valid and the upper 8 bits are all assumed to be 0 (H'00).
2.7.3
Register Indirect with Displacement—@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:32, ERn)
A 16-bit or 32-bit displacement contained in the instruction is added to an address register (ERn)
specified by the register field of the instruction, and the sum gives the address of a memory
operand. A 16-bit displacement is sign-extended when added.
2.7.4
Register Indirect with Post-Increment or Pre-Decrement—@ERn+ or @-ERn
Register indirect with post-increment—@ERn+: The register field of the instruction code
specifies an address register (ERn) which contains the address of a memory operand. After the
operand is accessed, 1, 2, or 4 is added to the address register contents and the sum is stored in the
address register. The value added is 1 for byte access, 2 for word transfer instruction, or 4 for
longword transfer instruction. For word or longword transfer instruction, the register value should
be even.
Register indirect with pre-decrement—@-ERn: The value 1, 2, or 4 is subtracted from an
address register (ERn) specified by the register field in the instruction code, and the result
becomes the address of a memory operand. The result is also stored in the address register. The
value subtracted is 1 for byte access, 2 for word transfer instruction, or 4 for longword transfer
instruction. For word or longword transfer instruction, the register value should be even.
2.7.5
Absolute Address—@aa:8, @aa:16, @aa:24, or @aa:32
The instruction code contains the absolute address of a memory operand. The absolute address
may be 8 bits long (@aa:8), 16 bits long (@aa:16), 24 bits long (@aa:24), or 32 bits long
(@aa:32). Table 2.12 indicates the accessible absolute address ranges.
To access data, the absolute address should be 8 bits (@aa:8), 16 bits (@aa:16), or 32 bits
(@aa:32) long. For an 8-bit absolute address, the upper 24 bits are all assumed to be 1 (H'FFFF).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 51 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
For a 16-bit absolute address the upper 16 bits are a sign extension. A 32-bit absolute address can
access the entire address space.
A 24-bit absolute address (@aa:24) indicates the address of a program instruction. The upper 8
bits are all assumed to be 0 (H'00).
Table 2.12 Absolute Address Access Ranges
Absolute Address
Data address
Normal Mode*
Advanced Mode
8 bits (@aa:8)
H'FF00 to H'FFFF
H'FFFF00 to H'FFFFFF
16 bits (@aa:16)
H'0000 to H'FFFF
H'000000 to H'007FFF,
H'FF8000 to H'FFFFFF
32 bits (@aa:32)
Program instruction
address
Note:
2.7.6
*
H'000000 to H'FFFFFF
24 bits (@aa:24)
Not available in this LSI.
Immediate—#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32
The instruction contains 8-bit (#xx:8), 16-bit (#xx:16), or 32-bit (#xx:32) immediate data as an
operand.
The ADDS, SUBS, INC, and DEC instructions contain immediate data implicitly. Some bit
manipulation instructions contain 3-bit immediate data in the instruction code, specifying a bit
number. The TRAPA instruction contains 2-bit immediate data in its instruction code, specifying a
vector address.
2.7.7
Program-Counter Relative—@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC)
This mode is used in the Bcc and BSR instructions. An 8-bit or 16-bit displacement contained in
the instruction is sign-extended and added to the 24-bit PC contents to generate a branch address.
Only the lower 24 bits of this branch address are valid; the upper 8 bits are all assumed to be 0
(H'00). The PC value to which the displacement is added is the address of the first byte of the next
instruction, so the possible branching range is –126 to +128 bytes (–63 to +64 words) or –32766 to
+32768 bytes (–16383 to +16384 words) from the branch instruction. The resulting value should
be an even number.
Page 52 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
2.7.8
Section 2 CPU
Memory Indirect—@@aa:8
This mode can be used by the JMP and JSR instructions. The instruction code contains an 8-bit
absolute address specifying a memory operand. This memory operand contains a branch address.
The upper bits of the absolute address are all assumed to be 0, so the address range is 0 to 255
(H'0000 to H'00FF in normal mode*, H'000000 to H'0000FF in advanced mode). In normal mode
the memory operand is a word operand and the branch address is 16 bits long. In advanced mode
the memory operand is a longword operand, the first byte of which is assumed to be H'00.
Note that the first part of the address range is also the exception vector area. For further details,
refer to section 4, Exception Handling.
If an odd address is specified in word or longword memory access, or as a branch address, the
least significant bit is regarded as 0, causing data to be accessed or instruction code to be fetched
at the address preceding the specified address. (For further information, see section 2.5.2, Memory
Data Formats.)
Note: * Not available in this LSI.
Specified
by @aa:8
Branch address
Specified
by @aa:8
Reserved
Branch address
(a) Normal Mode*
(b) Advanced Mode
Note: * Normal mode is not available in this LSI.
Figure 2.12 Branch Address Specification in Memory Indirect Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 53 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
2.7.9
Effective Address Calculation
Table 2.13 indicates how effective addresses are calculated in each addressing mode. In normal
mode the upper 8 bits of the effective address are ignored in order to generate a 16-bit address.
Table 2.13 Effective Address Calculation (1)
No
1
Addressing Mode and Instruction Format
op
2
Effective Address Calculation
Effective Address (EA)
Register direct (Rn)
rm
Operand is general register contents.
rn
Register indirect (@ERn)
31
0
op
3
31
24 23
0
Don't care
General register contents
r
Register indirect with displacement
@(d:16,ERn) or @(d:32,ERn)
31
0
General register contents
op
r
31
disp
31
Register indirect with post-increment or
pre-decrement
• Register indirect with post-increment @ERn+
op
disp
31
0
31
24 23
0
Don't care
General register contents
r
• Register indirect with pre-decrement @-ERn
0
0
Sign extension
4
24 23
Don't care
1, 2, or 4
31
0
General register contents
31
24 23
0
Don't care
op
r
1, 2, or 4
Operand Size
Byte
Word
Longword
Page 54 of 846
Offset
1
2
4
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
Table 2.13 Effective Address Calculation (2)
No
5
Addressing Mode and Instruction Format
Effective Address Calculation
Effective Address (EA)
Absolute address
@aa:8
31
op
@aa:16
31
op
0
H'FFFF
24 23
16 15
0
Don't care Sign extension
abs
@aa:24
31
op
8 7
24 23
Don't care
abs
24 23
0
Don't care
abs
@aa:32
op
31
6
Immediate
#xx:8/#xx:16/#xx:32
op
7
0
24 23
Don't care
abs
Operand is immediate data.
IMM
23
Program-counter relative
0
PC contents
@(d:8,PC)/@(d:16,PC)
op
disp
0
23
Sign
extension
disp
31
24 23
0
Don't care
8
Memory indirect @@aa:8
• Normal mode*
31
op
abs
0
8 7
abs
H'000000
15
0
31
24 23
Don't care
Memory contents
16 15
0
H'00
• Advanced mode
8 7
31
op
abs
H'000000
0
abs
0
31
31
24 23
Don't care
0
Memory contents
Note: * Normal mode is not available in this LSI.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 55 of 846
Section 2 CPU
2.8
H8S/2215 Group
Processing States
The H8S/2000 CPU has five main processing states: the reset state, exception handling state,
program execution state, bus-released state, and power-down state. Figure 2.13 indicates the state
transitions.
• Reset State
In this state the CPU and internal peripheral modules are all initialized and stop. When the
RES input goes low all current processing stops and the CPU enters the reset state. All
interrupts are masked in the reset state. Reset exception handling starts when the RES signal
changes from low to high. For details, refer to section 4, Exception Handling.
The reset state can also be entered by a watchdog timer overflow.
• Exception-Handling State
The exception-handling state is a transient state that occurs when the CPU alters the normal
processing flow due to an exception source, such as, a reset, trace, interrupt, or trap instruction.
The CPU fetches a start address (vector) from the exception vector table and branches to that
address. For further details, refer to section 4, Exception Handling.
• Program Execution State
In this state the CPU executes program instructions in sequence.
• Bus-Released State
In a product which has a bus master other than the CPU, such as a direct memory access
controller (DMAC) and a data transfer controller (DTC), the bus-released state occurs when
the bus has been released in response to a bus request from a bus master other than the CPU.
While the bus is released, the CPU halts operations.
• Power-Down State
This is a power-down state in which the CPU stops operating. The program stop state occurs
when a SLEEP instruction is executed or the CPU enters hardware standby mode. For details,
refer to section 22, Power-Down Modes.
Page 56 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
End of bus request
Bus request
Program execution state
SLEEP instruction,
SSBY = 0
ion
ha
nd
lin
g
s
bu
t
of est
d
es
qu
En requ
e
r
s
Bu
Sleep mode
st
que
SLEEP instruction,
SSBY = 1
t re
up
err
Int
En
d
o
ha f ex
nd ce
lin pti
g on
Re
qu
es
tf
or
ex
ce
pt
Bus-released state
Exception handling state
RES = High,
MRES = High
External interrupt request
Software standby mode
STBY = High, RES = Low
Reset state*1
Hardware standby mode*2
Power-down state
Notes: 1. From any state except hardware standby mode, a transition to the reset state occurs whenever RES
goes low. A transition can also be made to the reset state when the watchdog timer overflows.
From any state except hardware standby mode and power-on reset state, a transition to the manual
reset state occurs whenever MRES goes low.
2. From any state, a transition to hardware standby mode occurs when STBY goes low.
Figure 2.13 State Transitions
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 57 of 846
Section 2 CPU
2.9
Usage Notes
2.9.1
Note on TAS Instruction Usage
H8S/2215 Group
Only register ER0, ER1, ER4, or ER5 should be used when using the TAS instruction. The TAS
instruction is not generated by the Renesas Electronics H8S and H8/300 series C/C++ compilers.
If the TAS instruction is used as a user-defined intrinsic function, ensure that only register ER0,
ER1, ER4, or ER5 is used.
2.9.2
STM/LTM Instruction Usage
With the STM or LDM instruction, the ER7 register is used as the stack pointer, and thus cannot
be used as a register that allows save (STM) or restore (LDM) operation.
With a single STM or LDM instruction, two to four registers can be saved or restored. The
available registers are as follows:
For two registers: ER0 and ER1, ER2 and ER3, or ER4 and ER5
For three registers: ER0 to ER2, or ER4 to ER6
For four registers: ER0 to ER3
For the Renesas Electronics H8S or H8/300 Series C/C++ Compiler, the STM/LDM instruction
including ER7 is not created.
2.9.3
Note on Bit Manipulation Instructions
Using bit manipulation instructions on registers containing write-only bits can result in the bits
that should have been manipulated not being manipulated as intended or in the wrong bits being
manipulated.
Reading data from a register containing write-only bits may return fixed or undefined values.
Consequently, bit manipulation instructions that use the read values to perform operations (BNOT,
BTST, BAND, BIAND, BOR, BIOR, BXOR, BIXOR, BLD, and BILD) will not work properly.
In addition, bit manipulation instructions that write data following operations based on the data
values read (BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BST, and BIST) may change the values of bits unrelated to the
intended bit manipulation. Therefore, caution is necessary when using bit manipulation
instructions on registers containing write-only bits.
The instructions BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BST, and BIST perform the following operations in the
order shown:
Page 58 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
1. Read data in byte units
2. Perform bit manipulation on the read data according to the instruction
3. Write data in byte units
Example: Using the BCLR instruction to clear pin 14 only of P1DDR for port 1
P1DDR is an 8-bit register that contains write-only bits. It is used to specify the I/O setting of the
individual pins in port 1. Reading produces invalid data. Attempting to read from P1DDR returns
undefined values.
In this example, the BCLR instruction is used to set pin 14 as an input port. Let us assume that
pins 17 to 14 are presently set as output pins and pins 13 to 10 are set as input pins. Thus, the
value of P1DDR is initially H'F0.
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Output
Input
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
To change pin 14 from an output pin to an input pin, the value of bit 4 in P1DDR must be changed
from 1 to 0 (H'F0 to H'E0). Now assume that the BCLR instruction is used to clear bit 4 in
P1DDR to 0.
BCLR
#4, @P1DDR
However, using the above bit manipulation instruction on the write-only register P1DDR can
cause problems, as described below.
The BCLR instruction first reads data from P1DDR in byte units, but in this case the read values
are undefined. These undefined values can be 0 or 1 for each bit in the register, but there is no way
of telling which. Since all of the bits in P1DDR are write-only, undefined values are returned for
all of the bits when the register is read. In this example the value of P1DDR is H'F0, but we will
assume that the value returned when the register was read is H'F8, which would give bit 3 a value
of 1.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 59 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Output
Input
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
The BCLR instruction performs bit manipulation on the read value, which is H'F8 in this example.
It clears bit 4 to 0.
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Output
Input
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
After bit
manipulation
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
Following bit manipulation the data is written to P1DDR and the BCLR instruction terminates.
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Input
Output
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
Write value
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
The contents of P1DDR should have been overwritten with a value of H'E0, but in fact a value of
H'E8 was written to the register. This changed pin 13, which should have been an input pin, to an
output pin. In this example we assumed that pin 13 was read as 1. However, since the values
returned for pins 17 to 10 are all undefined when read, there is the possibility that individual bit
values could be changed from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0. To prevent this from happening, the
recommendations in section 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits, should be
followed when changing the values of registers containing write-only bits.
In addition, the BCLR instruction can be used to clear flags in internal I/O registers to 0. In such
cases it is not necessary to read the relevant flag beforehand so long as it is clear that it has been
set to 1 by an interrupt processing routine or the like.
2.9.4
Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits
Using data transfer instructions or bit manipulation instructions on registers containing write-only
bits can result in undefined values being read. To prevent the reading of undefined values, the
procedure described below should be used to access registers containing write-only bits.
Page 60 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
In order to write to a register containing write-only bits, set aside a work area in memory (in onchip RAM, for example) and write the data to be manipulated to it. After accessing and
manipulating the data in the work area in memory, write the resulting data to the register
containing write-only bits.
Figure 2.14 Example Flowchart of Method for Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits
Write data to work area
Write initial value
Write data from work area to
register containing write-only bits
Access data in work area
(using either data transfer instructions
or bit manipulation instructions)
Change value of register containing
write-only bits
Write data from work area to
register containing write-only bits
Figure 2.14 Flowchart of Method for Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits
Example: Clearing pin 14 only of P1DDR for port 1
P1DDR is an 8-bit register that contains write-only bits. It is used to specify the I/O setting of the
individual pins in port 1. Reading produces invalid data. Attempting to read from P1DDR returns
undefined values.
In this example, the BCLR instruction is used to set pin 14 as an input port. To start, the initial
value H'F0 to be written to P1DDR is written ahead of time to the work area (RAM0) in memory.
MOV.B
#H'F0,
R0L
MOV.B
R0L,
@RAM0
MOV.B
R0L,
@P1DDR
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 61 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 2 CPU
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Output
Input
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
RAM0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
To change pin 14 from an output pin to an input pin, the value of bit 4 in P1DDR must be changed
from 1 to 0 (H'F0 to H'E0). Here the BCLR instruction will be used to clear bit 4 in P1DDR to 0.
BCLR
#4,
@RAM0
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Output
Input
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
RAM0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Since RAM0 is a read/write area of memory, performing the above bit manipulation using the
BCLR instruction causes only bit 4 in RAM0 to be cleared to 0. The value of RAM0 is then
written to P1DDR.
MOV.B
@RAM0,
R0L
MOV.B
R0L,
@P1DDR
P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
I/O
Output
Output
Output
Input
Input
Input
Input
Input
P1DDR
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
RAM0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
By using the above procedure to access registers containing write-only bits, it is possible to create
programs that are not dependent on the type of instructions used.
Page 62 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
3.1
Operating Mode Selection
This LSI supports four operating modes (modes 7 to 4). These modes are depending on the setting
of mode pins (MD2 to MD0). Modes 6 to 4 are extended modes in which external memory and
external peripheral devices can be accessed. In extended modes, each area can be used as 8-bit or
16-bit address space according to the bus controller settings after program execution. In this case,
if an area is specified as 16-bit access space, 16-bit bus mode is employed for all areas; while if an
area is specified as 8-bit access space, 8-bit bus mode is employed for all areas. In mode 7,
external addresses cannot be used. Do not change the mode pin settings during operation.
Table 3.1
MCU Operating Mode Selection
External Data Bus
MCU
Operating
Mode
CPU Operating
MD2 MD1 MD0 Mode
4
1
0
0
Advanced mode
5
1
0
1
6
1
1
7*
1
1
Note:
*
Maximum
Initial Value Value
On-chip ROM
disabled, extended
mode
Disabled
16 bits
16 bits
Advanced mode
On-chip ROM
disabled, extended
mode
Disabled
8 bits
16 bits
0
Advanced mode
On-chip ROM
enabled, extended
mode
Enabled
8 bits
16 bits
1
Advanced mode
Single-chip mode
Enabled
—
—
The following applies to the use of mode 7.
(1) H8S/2215
The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
(2) H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T or H8S/2215C
Development work using the E6000 emulator:
The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
Development work using the on-chip (E10A-USB) emulator:
The USB can be used in mode 7.
See section 3.3.4, Mode 7, for details.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
On-Chip
ROM
Description
Page 63 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
3.2
Register Descriptions
The following registers are related to the operating mode.
• Mode control register (MDCR)
• System control register (SYSCR)
3.2.1
Mode Control Register (MDCR)
MDCR is used to monitor the current operating mode of this LSI.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
—
1
Reserved
—
This bit is always read as 1 and cannot be modified.
6 to 3
—
All 0
—
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
R
Mode select 2 to 0
MDS1
—*
—*
R
MDS0
—*
R
These bits indicate the input levels at pins MD2 to
MD0 (the current operating mode).Bits MDS2 to
MDS0 correspond to MD2 to MD0. MDS2 to MDS0
are read-only bits and they cannot be written to. The
mode pin (MD2 to MD0) input levels are latched into
these bits when MDCR is read.
2
MDS2
1
0
These latches are canceled by a power-on reset, but
maintained at manual reset.
Note:
3.2.2
*
Determined by the MD2 to MD0 pin settings.
System Control Register (SYSCR)
SYSCR is used to select the interrupt control mode and the detected edge for NMI, select the
MRES input pin enable or disable, and enables or disables on-chip RAM.
Page 64 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
—
0
Reserved
R/W
The write value should always be 0.
6
—
0
—
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
5
INTM1
0
R/W
4
INTM0
0
R/W
These bits select the control mode of the interrupt
controller. For details of the interrupt control modes,
see section 5.6, Interrupt Control Modes and Interrupt
Operation.
00: Interrupt control mode 0
01: Setting prohibited
10: Interrupt control mode 2
11: Setting prohibited
3
NMIEG
0
R/W
NMI Edge Select
Selects the valid edge of the NMI interrupt input.
0: An interrupt is requested at the falling edge of NMI
input
1: An interrupt is requested at the rising edge of NMI
input
2
MRESE
0
R/W
Manual reset Select
Enables or disables the MRES pin input.
0: The MRES pin input (manual reset) is disabled
1: The MRES pin input (manual reset) is enabled
The MRES input pin can be used.
1
—
0
—
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
0
RAME
1
R/W
RAM Enable
Enables or disables the on-chip RAM. The RAME bit
is initialized when the reset status is released.
0: On-chip RAM is disabled
1: On-chip RAM is enabled
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 65 of 846
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
3.3
Operating Mode Descriptions
3.3.1
Mode 4
H8S/2215 Group
The CPU can access a 16-Mbyte address space in advanced mode. The on-chip ROM is disabled.
Pins P13 to P10, and ports A, B, and C function as an address bus, ports D and E function as a
data bus, and part of port F carries bus control signals.
Pins P13 to P11 function as input ports immediately after a reset. Pin 10 and ports A and B
function as address (A20 to A8) outputs immediately after a reset. Address (A23 to A21) output
can be enabled or disabled by bits AE3 to AE0 in the pin function control register (PFCR)
regardless of the corresponding data direction register (DDR) values. Pins for which address
output is disabled among pins P13 to P10 and in ports A and B become port outputs when the
corresponding DDR bits are set to 1.
Port C always has an address (A7 to A0) output function.
The initial bus mode after a reset is 16 bits, with 16-bit access to all areas. However, note that if 8bit access is designated by the bus controller for all areas, the bus mode switches to 8 bits.
3.3.2
Mode 5
The CPU can access a 16-Mbyte address space in advanced mode. The on-chip ROM is disabled.
Pins P13 to P10, and ports A, B, and C function as an address bus, ports D and E function as a
data bus, and part of port F carries bus control signals.
Pins P13 to P11 function as input ports immediately after a reset. Pin 10 and ports A and B
function as address (A20 to A8) outputs immediately after a reset. Address (A23 to A21) output
can be enabled or disabled by bits AE3 to AE0 in the pin function control register (PFCR)
regardless of the corresponding data direction register (DDR) values. Pins for which address
output is disabled among pins P13 to P10 and in ports A and B become port outputs when the
corresponding DDR bits are set to 1.
Port C always has an address (A7 to A0) output function.
The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. However, note that if 16bit access is designated by the bus controller for any area, the bus mode switches to 16 bits and
port E becomes a data bus.
Page 66 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
3.3.3
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
Mode 6
The CPU can access a 16-Mbyte address space in advanced mode. The on-chip ROM is enabled.
Pins P13 to P10, and ports A, B and C function as input ports immediately after a reset. Address
(A23 to A8) output can be enabled or disabled by bits AE3 to AE0 in the pin function control
register (PFCR) regardless of the corresponding data direction register (DDR) values. Pins for
which address output is disabled among pins P13 to P10 and in ports A and B become port outputs
when the corresponding DDR bits are set to 1.
Port C is an input port immediately after a reset. Addresses A7 to A0 are output by setting the
corresponding DDR bits to 1.
Ports D and E function as a data bus, and part of port F carries data bus signals.
The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. However, note that if 16bit access is designated by the bus controller for any area, the bus mode switches to 16 bits and
port E becomes a data bus.
3.3.4
Mode 7
The CPU can access a 16-Mbyte address space in advanced mode. The on-chip ROM is enabled,
but external addresses cannot be accessed.
All I/O ports are available for use as input-output ports.
In addition, the USB is not supported in some cases due to development tool issues, as
summarized in table 3.2.
Table 3.2
USB Support in Mode 7
Development Tool
H8S/2215
H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T or H8S/2215C
E6000
×
×
E10A-USB
⎯*
Note:
*
The H8S/2215 does not have an on-chip emulator function.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 67 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
3.3.5
Pin Functions
The pin functions of ports 1, and A to F vary depending on the operating mode. Table 3.3 shows
the functions in modes 4 to 7.
Table 3.3
Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode
Mode 4
Mode 5
Mode 6
Mode 7*
P13 to P11
P*/A
P*/A
P*/A
P
P10
P/A*
P/A*
P/A*
P/A*
P*/A
P*/A
P
Port B
P/A*
P/A*
P
Port C
A
A
P*/A
P*/A
Port D
D
P/D*
D
P*/D
P
Port E
D
P*/D
Port F
PF7
P/C*
P/C*
P/C*
P*/C
PF6 to PF4
C
PF3
C
P*/C
C
P*/C
P
P/C*
P*/C
P*/C
P*/C
Port
Port 1
Port A
PA3 to PA0
PF2 to PF0
1
P
P
P
Legend:
P: I/O port
A: Address bus output
D: Data bus I/O
C: Control signals, clock I/O
*: After reset
Note: 1. The following applies to the use of mode 7.
(1) H8S/2215
The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
(2) H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T or H8S/2215C
Development work using the E6000 emulator:
The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
Development work using the on-chip (E10A-USB) emulator:
The USB can be used in mode 7.
See section 3.3.4, Mode 7, for details.
Page 68 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
3.4
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode
Figures 3.1 to 3.4 show the memory map in each operating mode for HD64F2215, HD64F2215U,
HD6432215B, and HD6432215C.
ROM: —
RAM: 16 kbytes
Modes 4 and 5
(advanced extended modes
with on-chip ROM disabled)
H'000000
ROM: 256 kbytes
RAM: 16 kbytes
Mode 6
(advanced extended mode
with on-chip ROM enabled)
ROM: 256 kbytes
RAM: 16 kbytes
Mode 7*2
(advanced single-chip mode)
H'000000
H'000000
On-chip ROM
On-chip ROM
External address
space
H'03FFFF
H'040000
External address
space
H'C00000
On-chip USB
registers
H'C00000
H'E00000
H'E00000
External address
space
H'FF9000
H'FFB000
H'FFEFC0
On-chip USB
registers
Reserved*1
*1
On-chip RAM
External address
space
On-chip USB
registers
External address
space
Reserved*1
H'FFB000
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFEFC0
External address
space
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF40
H'FFFF40
Reserved
H'DFFFFF
H'FF9000
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'C00000
H'FFB000
H'FFEFBF
On-chip RAM
H'FFF800
Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF3F
Reserved
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM
H'FFFFFF
Notes: 1. External addresses can be accessed by clearing the RAME bit in SYSCR to 0.
2. The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
See section 3.3.4, Mode 7, for details.
Figure 3.1 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD64F2215 and HD64F2215U
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 69 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
ROM: —
RAM: 16 kbytes
Modes 4 and 5
(advanced extended modes
with on-chip ROM disabled)
ROM: 128 kbytes
RAM: 16 kbytes
Mode 6
(advanced extended mode
with on-chip ROM enabled)
(advanced single-chip mode)
H'000000
H'000000
H'000000
ROM: 128 kbytes
RAM: 16 kbytes
Mode 7*2
On-chip ROM
On-chip ROM
H'01FFFF
H'020000
Reserved
External address
space
H'040000
External address
space
H'C00000
On-chip USB
registers
H'C00000
H'E00000
H'E00000
External address
space
H'FF9000
H'FFB000
H'FFEFC0
On-chip USB
registers
Reserved*1
*1
On-chip RAM
External address
space
External address
space
Reserved*1
H'FFB000
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFEFC0
External address
space
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF40
H'FFFF40
Reserved
On-chip USB
registers
H'DFFFFF
H'FF9000
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'C00000
H'FFB000
On-chip RAM
H'FFEFBF
H'FFF800
Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF3F
Reserved
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM
H'FFFFFF
Notes: 1. External addresses can be accessed by clearing the RAME bit in SYSCR to 0.
2. The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
See section 3.3.4, Mode 7, for details.
Figure 3.2 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD6432215B
Page 70 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
ROM: —
RAM: 8 kbytes
Modes 4 and 5
(advanced extended modes
with on-chip ROM disabled)
ROM: 64 kbytes
RAM: 8 kbytes
Mode 6
(advanced extended mode
with on-chip ROM enabled)
(advanced single-chip mode)
H'000000
H'000000
H'000000
ROM: 64 kbytes
RAM: 8 kbytes
Mode 7*2
On-chip ROM
On-chip ROM
H'00FFFF
H'010000
Reserved
External address
space
H'040000
External address
space
H'C00000
On-chip USB
registers
H'C00000
H'E00000
H'E00000
External address
space
H'FF9000
On-chip USB
registers
Reserved*1
On-chip USB
registers
H'FF9000
Reserved*1
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFD000
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFEFC0
External address
space
H'FFEFC0
External address
space
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF40
H'FFFF40
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'DFFFFF
External address
space
H'FFD000
Reserved
H'C00000
H'FFD000
H'FFEFBF
On-chip RAM
H'FFF800
Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF3F
Reserved
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM
H'FFFFFF
Notes: 1. External addresses can be accessed by clearing the RAME bit in SYSCR to 0.
2. The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
See section 3.3.4, Mode 7, for details.
Figure 3.3 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD6432215C
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 71 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
ROM: —
RAM: 20 kbytes
Modes 4 and 5
(advanced extended modes
with on-chip ROM disabled)
H'000000
ROM: 256 kbytes
RAM: 20 kbytes
Mode 6
(advanced extended mode
with on-chip ROM enabled)
H'000000
ROM: 256 kbytes
RAM: 20 kbytes
Mode 7*2
(advanced single-chip mode)
H'000000
On-chip ROM
On-chip ROM
External address
space
H'03FFFF
H'040000
External address
space
H'C00000
On-chip USB
registers
H'C00000
H'E00000
H'E00000
External address
space*3
H'FF9000
On-chip USB
registers
Reserved*1
On-chip USB
registers
H'FF9000
Reserved*1
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFA000
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFEFC0
External address
space
H'FFEFC0
External address
space
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFF800 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF40
H'FFFF40
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'DFFFFF
External address
space*3
H'FFA000
Reserved
H'C00000
H'FFA000
H'FFEFBF
On-chip RAM
H'FFF800
Internal I/O registers
H'FFFF3F
Reserved
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM*1
H'FFFFFF
H'FFFF60 Internal I/O registers
H'FFFFC0
On-chip RAM
H'FFFFFF
Notes: 1. External addresses can be accessed by clearing the RAME bit in SYSCR to 0.
2. Development work using the E6000 emulator:
The USB cannot be used in mode 7.
Development work using the on-chip (E10A-USB) emulator:
The USB can be used in mode 7.
See section 3.3.4, Mode 7, for details.
3. When using an on-chip emulator, do not access the area from H'FEE800 to H'FEFFFF.
Figure 3.4 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode for HD64F2215R, HD64F2215RU,
HD64F2215T, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU
Page 72 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 4 Exception Handling
Section 4 Exception Handling
4.1
Exception Handling Types and Priority
As table 4.1 indicates, exception handling may be caused by a reset, trace, trap instruction, or
interrupt. Exception handling is prioritized as shown in table 4.1. If two or more exceptions occur
simultaneously, they are accepted and processed in order of priority. Exception sources, the stack
structure, and operation of the CPU vary depending on the interrupt control mode. For details on
the interrupt control mode, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller.
Table 4.1
Exception Types and Priority
Priority
Exception Type
Start of Exception Handling
High
Reset
Starts immediately after a low-to-high transition at the RES or
MRES pin, or when the watchdog timer overflows. The CPU enters
the reset state when the RES pin is low. The CPU enters the
manual reset state when the MRES pin is low.
Trace
Starts when execution of the current instruction or exception
handling ends, if the trace (T) bit in the EXR is set to 1. This is
enabled only in trace interrupt control mode 2. Trace exception
processing is not performed after RTE instruction execution.
Interrupt
Starts when execution of the current instruction or exception
handling ends, if an interrupt request has been issued. Note that
after executing the ANDC, ORC, XORC, or LDC instruction or at
the completion of reset exception processing, no interrupt is
detected.
Trap instruction
(TRAPA)
Started by execution of a trap instruction (TRAPA). Trap exception
processing is always accepted in program execution state.
Low
4.2
Exception Sources and Exception Vector Table
Different vector addresses are assigned to different exception sources. Table 4.2 lists the exception
sources and their vector addresses. Since the usable modes differ depending on the product, for
details on each product, refer to section 3, MCU Operating Modes.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 73 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 4 Exception Handling
Table 4.2
Exception Handling Vector Table
Vector Address*
Exception Source
Vector Number
Normal Mode*
2
1
Advanced Mode
Power-on reset
0
H'0000 to H'0001
H'0000 to H'0003
Manual reset
1
H'0002 to H'0003
H'0004 to H'0007
Reserved for system use
2
H'0004 to H'0005
H'0008 to H'000B
3
H'0006 to H'0007
H'000C to H'000F
4
H'0008 to H'0019
H'0010 to H'0013
Trace
5
H'000A to H000B
H'0014 to H0017
2
Direct transitions*
6
H'000C to H000D
H'0018 to H001B
External interrupt (NMI)
7
H'000E to H'000F
H'001C to H'001F
Trap instruction
#0
8
H'0010 to H'0011
H'0020 to H'0023
#1
9
H'0012 to H'0013
H'0024 to H'0027
#2
10
H'0014 to H'0015
H'0028 to H'002B
#3
11
H'0016 to H'0017
H'002C to H'002F
12
H'0018 to H'0019
H'0030 to H'0033
13
H'001A to H'001B
H'0034 to H'0037
14
H'001C to H'001D
H'0038 to H'003B
15
H'001E to H'001F
H'003C to H'003F
Reserved for system use
External interrupt
IRQ0
16
H'0020 to H'0021
H'0040 to H'0043
External interrupt
IRQ1
17
H'0022 to H'0023
H'0044 to H'0047
External interrupt
IRQ2
18
H'0024 to H'0025
H'0048 to H'004B
External interrupt
IRQ3
19
H'0026 to H'0027
H'004C to H'004F
External interrupt
IRQ4
20
H'0028 to H'0029
H'0050 to H'0053
External interrupt
IRQ5
21
H'002A to H'002B
H'0054 to H'0057
USB interrupt
IRQ6
22
H'002C to H'002D
H'0058 to H'005B
External interrupt
3
Internal interrupt*
IRQ7
23
H'002E to H'002F
H'005C to H'005F
24
H'0030 to H'0031
H'0060 to H'0063
⏐
⏐
⏐
127
H'00FE to H'00FF
H'01FC to H'01FF
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address.
2. Not available in this LSI.
3. For details of internal interrupt vectors, see section 5.5, Interrupt Exception Handling
Vector Table.
Page 74 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
4.3
Section 4 Exception Handling
Reset
A reset has the highest exception priority.
When the RES or MRES pin goes low, all processing halts and this LSI enters the reset state. To
ensure that this LSI is reset, hold the RES pin low for at least 20 ms at power-on.
A reset initializes the internal state of the CPU and the registers of on-chip peripheral modules.
This LSI can also be reset by overflow of the watchdog timer. For details, see section 12,
Watchdog Timer (WDT).
Immediately after a reset, interrupt control mode 0 is set.
Note: TRST should be brought low level at power-on. For details, see section 14, Boundary
Scan Function.
4.3.1
Reset Types
A reset can be of either of two types: a power-on reset or a manual reset. Reset types are shown in
table 4.3. A power-on reset should be used when powering on.
The internal state of the CPU is initialized by either type of reset. A power-on reset also initializes
all the registers in the on-chip peripheral modules, while a manual reset initializes all the registers
in the on-chip peripheral modules except for the bus controller and I/O ports, which retain their
previous states.
With a manual reset, since the on-chip peripheral modules are initialized, ports used as on-chip
peripheral module I/O pins are switched to I/O ports controlled by DDR and DR.
Table 4.3
Reset Types
Reset Transition
Condition
RES
CPU
On-Chip Peripheral Modules
Power-on reset ×
Low
Initialized
Initialized
Manual reset
High
Initialized
Initialized, except for bus controller and I/O
ports
Type
MRES
Internal State
Low
Legend:
×: Don’t care
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 75 of 846
Section 4 Exception Handling
H8S/2215 Group
A reset caused by the watchdog timer can also be of either of two types: a power-on reset or a
manual reset.
When the MRES pin is used, MRES pin input must be enabled by setting the MRESE bit to 1 in
SYSCR.
4.3.2
Reset Exception Handling
When the RES or MRES pin goes high after being held low for the necessary time, this LSI starts
reset exception handling as follows:
1. The internal state of the CPU and the registers of the on-chip peripheral modules are
initialized, the T bit is cleared to 0 in EXR, and the I bit is set to 1 in EXR and CCR.
2. The reset exception handling vector address is read and transferred to the PC, and program
execution starts from the address indicated by the PC.
Page 76 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 4 Exception Handling
Figures 4.1 and 4.2 show examples of the reset sequence.
Internal
Prefetch of first
processing program instruction
Vector fetch
*
*
*
φ
RES, MRES
Address bus
(3)
(1)
(5)
RD
HWR, LWR
High
D15 to D0
(1) (3)
(2) (4)
(5)
(6)
(2)
(4)
(6)
Reset exception handling vector address (for power-on reset, (1) = H'000000,
(3) = H'000002; for manual reset, (1) = H'000004, (3) = H'000006)
Start address (contents of reset exception handling vector address)
Start address ((5) = (2) (4))
First program instruction
Note: * Three program wait states are inserted.
Figure 4.1 Reset Sequence (Mode 4)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 77 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 4 Exception Handling
Prefetch of
first program
Internal
processing instruction
Vector fetch
φ
RES, MRES
Internal address
bus
(1)
(3)
(5)
Internal read
signal
Internal write
signal
High
(2)
Internal data
bus
(1) (3)
(2) (4)
(5)
(6)
(4)
(6)
Reset exception handling vector address (for power-on reset, (1) = H'000000,
(3) = H'000002; for manual reset, (1) = H'000004, (3) = H'000006)
Start address (contents of reset exception handling vector address)
Start address ((5) = (2) (4))
First program instruction
Figure 4.2 Reset Sequence (Modes 6, 7)
4.3.3
Interrupts after Reset
If an interrupt is accepted after a reset but before the stack pointer (SP) is initialized, the PC and
CCR will not be saved correctly, leading to a program crash. To prevent this, all interrupt requests,
including NMI, are disabled immediately after a reset. Since the first instruction of a program is
always executed immediately after the reset state ends, make sure that this instruction initializes
the stack pointer (example: MOV.L #xx SP).
4.3.4
State of On-Chip Peripheral Modules after Reset Release
After reset release, MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC are initialized to H'3F, H'FF, and H'FF, respectively,
and all modules except the DMAC and DTC enter module stop mode. Consequently, on-chip
peripheral module registers cannot be read from or written to. Register reading and writing is
enabled when module stop mode is exited.
Page 78 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
4.4
Section 4 Exception Handling
Traces
Traces are enabled in interrupt control mode 2. Trace mode is not activated in interrupt control
mode 0, irrespective of the state of the T bit. For details of interrupt control modes, see section 5,
Interrupt Controller.
If the T bit in EXR is set to 1, trace mode is activated. In trace mode, a trace exception occurs on
completion of each instruction. Trace mode is not affected by interrupt masking. Table 4.4 shows
the state of CCR and EXR after execution of trace exception handling. Trace mode is canceled by
clearing the T bit in EXR to 0. The T bit saved on the stack retains its value of 1, and when control
is returned from the trace exception handling routine by the RTE instruction, trace mode resumes.
Trace exception handling is not carried out after execution of the RTE instruction.
Interrupts are accepted even within the trace exception handling routine.
Table 4.4
Status of CCR and EXR after Trace Exception Handling
Interrupt Control Mode
CCR
I
0
2
EXR
UI
I2 to I0
T
Trace exception handling cannot be used.
1
—
—
0
Legend:
1: Set to 1
0: Cleared to 0
—: Retains value prior to execution.
4.5
Interrupts
Interrupts are controlled by the interrupt controller. The interrupt controller has two interrupt
control modes and can assign interrupts other than NMI to eight priority/mask levels to enable
multiplexed interrupt control. The source to start interrupt exception handling and the vector
address differ depending on the product. For details, refer to section 5, Interrupt Controller.
The interrupt exception handling is as follows:
1. The values in the program counter (PC), condition code register (CCR), and extended control
register (EXR) are saved in the stack.
2. The interrupt mask bit is updated and the T bit is cleared.
3. A vector address corresponding to the interrupt source is generated, the start address is loaded
from the vector table to the PC, and program execution starts from that address.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 79 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 4 Exception Handling
4.6
Trap Instruction
Trap instruction exception handling starts when a TRAPA instruction is executed. Trap instruction
exception handling can be executed at all times in the program execution state.
The trap instruction exception handling is as follows:
1. The values in the program counter (PC), condition code register (CCR), and extended control
register (EXR) are saved in the stack.
2. The interrupt mask bit is updated and the T bit is cleared.
3. A vector address corresponding to the interrupt source is generated, the start address is loaded
from the vector table to the PC, and program execution starts from that address.
The TRAPA instruction fetches a start address from a vector table entry corresponding to a vector
number from 0 to 3, as specified in the instruction code.
Table 4.5 shows the status of CCR and EXR after execution of trap instruction exception handling.
Table 4.5
Status of CCR and EXR after Trap Instruction Exception Handling
Interrupt Control Mode
CCR
EXR
I
UI
I2 to I0
T
0
1
—
—
—
2
1
—
—
0
Legend:
1: Set to 1
0: Cleared to 0
—: Retains value prior to execution.
Page 80 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
4.7
Section 4 Exception Handling
Stack Status after Exception Handling
Figure 4.3 shows the stack after completion of trap instruction exception handling and interrupt
exception handling.
(a) Normal Modes*2
SP
EXR
Reserved*1
SP
CCR
CCR
CCR*1
CCR*1
PC (16 bits)
PC (16 bits)
Interrupt control mode 0
Interrupt control mode 2
(b) Advanced Modes
SP
EXR
Reserved*1
SP
CCR
PC (24 bits)
Interrupt control mode 0
CCR
PC (24 bits)
Interrupt control mode 2
Notes: 1. Ignored on return.
2. Normal modes are not available in this LSI.
Figure 4.3 Stack Status after Exception Handling
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 81 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 4 Exception Handling
4.8
Notes on Use of the Stack
When accessing word data or longword data, this LSI assumes that the lowest address bit is 0. The
stack should always be accessed by word transfer instruction or longword transfer instruction, and
the value of the stack pointer (SP: ER7) should always be kept even. Use the following
instructions to save registers:
PUSH.W Rn (or MOV.W Rn, @-SP)
PUSH.L ERn (or MOV.L ERn, @-SP)
Use the following instructions to restore registers:
POP.W Rn (or MOV.W @SP+, Rn)
POP.L ERn (or MOV.L @SP+, ERn)
Setting SP to an odd value may lead to a malfunction. Figure 4.4 shows an example of what
happens when the SP value is odd.
Address
CCR
SP
H'FFFEFA
R1L
SP
H'FFFEFB
PC
PC
H'FFFEFC
H'FFFEFD
H'FFFEFE
SP
H'FFFEFF
SP set to H'FFFEFF
TRAPA instruction executed
MOV.B R1L, @-ER7 executed
Data saved above SP
Contents of CCR lost
Legend:
CCR:
PC:
R1L:
SP:
Condition code register
Program counter
General register R1L
Stack pointer
Note: This diagram illustrates an example in which the interrupt control mode is 0, in advanced mode.
Figure 4.4 Operation when SP Value Is Odd
Page 82 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.1
Features
• Two interrupt control modes
⎯ Any of two interrupt control modes can be set by means of the INTM1 and INTM0 bits in
the system control register (SYSCR).
• Priorities settable with IPR
⎯ An interrupt priority register (IPR) is provided for setting interrupt priorities. Eight priority
levels can be set for each module for all interrupts except NMI. NMI is assigned the
highest priority level of 8, and can be accepted at all times.
• Independent vector addresses
⎯ All interrupt sources are assigned independent vector addresses, making it unnecessary for
the source to be identified in the interrupt handling routine.
• Eight external interrupts (NMI, IRQ7, and IRQ5 to IRQ0)
⎯ NMI is the highest-priority interrupt, and is accepted at all times. Rising edge or falling
edge can be selected for NMI. Falling edge, rising edge, or both edge detection, or level
sensing, can be selected for IRQ7 and IRQ5 to IRQ0. IRQ6 is an interrupt only for the onchip USB.
• DTC and DMAC control
⎯ DTC or DMAC activation is performed by means of interrupts.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 83 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
A block diagram of the interrupt controller is shown in figure 5.1.
CPU
INTM1, INTM0
SYSCR
NMIEG
NMI input
NMI input unit
IRQ input
IRQ input unit
ISR
ISCR
IER
Interrupt
request
Vector number
Priority
determination
I
Internal interrupt
request
SWDTEND to EXIRQ1
CCR
I2 to I0
EXR
IPR
Interrupt controller
Legend:
ISCR:
IER:
ISR:
IPR:
SYSCR:
IRQ sense control register
IRQ enable register
IRQ status register
Interrupt priority register
System control register
Figure 5.1 Block Diagram of Interrupt Controller
Page 84 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
5.2
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Input/Output Pins
Table 5.1 summarizes the pins of the interrupt controller.
Table 5.1
Pin Configuration
Name
I/O
NMI
Input
Function
Nonmaskable external interrupt
Rising or falling edge can be selected
IRQ7
Input
Maskable external interrupts
IRQ5
Input
IRQ4
Input
Rising, falling, or both edges, or level sensing, (IRQ6 is an interrupt
signal only for the on-chip USB) can be selected
IRQ3
Input
IRQ2
Input
IRQ1
Input
IRQ0
Input
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 85 of 846
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.3
H8S/2215 Group
Register Descriptions
The interrupt controller has the following registers. For details on the system control register, refer
to section 3.2.2, System Control Register (SYSCR).
• System control register (SYSCR)
• IRQ sense control register H (ISCRH)
• IRQ sense control register L (ISCRL)
• IRQ enable register (IER)
• IRQ status register (ISR)
• Interrupt priority register A (IPRA)
• Interrupt priority register B (IPRB)
• Interrupt priority register C (IPRC)
• Interrupt priority register D (IPRD)
• Interrupt priority register E (IPRE)
• Interrupt priority register F (IPRF)
• Interrupt priority register G (IPRG)
• Interrupt priority register I (IPRI)
• Interrupt priority register J (IPRJ)
• Interrupt priority register K (IPRK)
• Interrupt priority register M (IPRM)
Page 86 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
5.3.1
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Interrupt Priority Registers A to G, I to K, M (IPRA to IPRG, IPRI to IPRK,
IPRM)
The IPR registers set priorities (levels 7 to 0) for interrupts other than NMI.
The correspondence between interrupt sources and IPR settings is shown in table 5.2. Setting a
value in the range from H'0 to H'7 in the 3-bit groups of bits 6 to 4 and 2 to 0 sets the priority of
the corresponding interrupt.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
—
0
Reserved
—
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
6
IPR6
1
R/W
Sets the priority of the corresponding interrupt source.
5
IPR5
1
R/W
000: Priority level 0 (Lowest)
4
IPR4
1
R/W
001: Priority level 1
010: Priority level 2
011: Priority level 3
100: Priority level 4
101: Priority level 5
110: Priority level 6
111: Priority level 7 (Highest)
3
—
0
—
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
2
IPR2
1
R/W
Sets the priority of the corresponding interrupt source.
1
IPR1
1
R/W
000: Priority level 0 (Lowest)
0
IPR0
1
R/W
001: Priority level 1
010: Priority level 2
011: Priority level 3
100: Priority level 4
101: Priority level 5
110: Priority level 6
111: Priority level 7 (Highest)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 87 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.3.2
IRQ Enable Register (IER)
IER controls enabling and disabling of interrupt requests IRQ7 to IRQ0.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
IRQ7E
0
IRQ7 Enable
R/W
The IRQ7 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
6
IRQ6E
0
R/W
IRQ6 Enable*
The IRQ6 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
5
IRQ5E
0
R/W
IRQ5 Enable
The IRQ5 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
4
IRQ4E
0
R/W
IRQ4 Enable
The IRQ4 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
3
IRQ3E
0
R/W
IRQ3 Enable
The IRQ3 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
2
IRQ2E
0
R/W
IRQ2 Enable
The IRQ2 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
1
IRQ1E
0
R/W
IRQ1 Enable
The IRQ1 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
0
IRQ0E
Note:
*
0
R/W
IRQ0 Enable
The IRQ0 interrupt request is enabled when this bit is 1.
IRQ6 is an interrupt only for the on-chip USB.
Page 88 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
5.3.3
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
IRQ Sense Control Registers H and L (ISCRH, ISCRL)
The ISCR registers select the source that generates an interrupt request at pins IRQ7, and IRQ5 to
IRQ0.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
15
IRQ7SCB
0
R/W
IRQ7 Sense Control B
14
IRQ7SCA
0
R/W
IRQ7 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ7 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ7
input
10: Interrupt request generated rising edge of IRQ7
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and
rising edges of IRQ7 input
13
IRQ6SCB
0
R/W
12
IRQ6SCA
0
R/W
IRQ6* Sense Control B
IRQ6* Sense Control A
00: Setting prohibited when using on-chip USB
suspend or resume interrupt
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ6
input
1×: Setting prohibited
11
IRQ5SCB
0
R/W
IRQ5 Sense Control B
10
IRQ5SCA
0
R/W
IRQ5 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ5 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ5
input
10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ5
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and
rising edges of IRQ5 input
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Note: * IRQ6 is an interrupt only for the on-chip USB.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 89 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
9
IRQ4SCB
0
R/W
IRQ4 Sense Control B
8
IRQ4SCA
0
R/W
IRQ4 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ4 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ4
input
10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ4
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and
rising edges of IRQ4 input
7
IRQ3SCB
0
R/W
IRQ3 Sense Control B
6
IRQ3SCA
0
R/W
IRQ3 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ3 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ3
input
10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ3
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and
rising edges of IRQ3 input
5
IRQ2SCB
0
R/W
IRQ2 Sense Control B
4
IRQ2SCA
0
R/W
IRQ2 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ2 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ2
input
10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ2
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and
rising edges of IRQ2 input
3
IRQ1SCB
0
R/W
IRQ1 Sense Control B
2
IRQ1SCA
0
R/W
IRQ1 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ1 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ1
input
10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ1
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and rising
edges of IRQ1 input
Page 90 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
1
IRQ0SCB
0
R/W
IRQ0 Sense Control B
0
IRQ0SCA
0
R/W
IRQ0 Sense Control A
00: Interrupt request generated at IRQ0 input low level
01: Interrupt request generated at falling edge of IRQ0
input
10: Interrupt request generated at rising edge of IRQ0
input
11: Interrupt request generated at both falling and
rising edges of IRQ0 input
5.3.4
IRQ Status Register (ISR)
ISR indicates the status of IRQ7 to IRQ0 interrupt requests. Only 0 should be written to these bits
for clearing the flag.
Bit
7
Bit Name
IRQ7F
Initial Value R/W
Description
0
R/(W)*
[Setting condition]
•
6
IRQ6F
0
R/(W)*
5
IRQ5F
0
R/(W)*
4
IRQ4F
0
R/(W)*
3
IRQ3F
0
R/(W)*
2
IRQ2F
0
R/(W)*
1
IRQ1F
0
R/(W)*
0
IRQ0F
0
R/(W)*
When the interrupt source selected by the ISCR
registers occurs
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
•
•
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear the flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Cleared by reading IRQnF flag when IRQnF = 1,
then writing 0 to IRQnF flag
When interrupt exception handling is executed
when low-level detection is set and, IRQn input is
high
When IRQn interrupt exception handling is
executed when falling, rising, or both-edge
detection is set
When the DTC is activated by an IRQn interrupt,
and the DISEL bit in MRB of the DTC is cleared
to 0
Page 91 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.4
Interrupt Sources
5.4.1
External Interrupts
There are eight external interrupts: NMI, IRQ7, and IRQ5 to IRQ0. These interrupts can be used
to restore this LSI from software standby mode. IRQ6 is an interrupt only for the on-chip USB.
However, IRQ6 is functionally same as IRQ7 restore this LSI from software standby mode. IRQ6
is functionally same as IRQ7 and IRQ5 to IRQ0.
NMI Interrupt: NMI is the highest-priority interrupt, and is always accepted by the CPU
regardless of the interrupt control mode or the status of the CPU interrupt mask bits. The NMIEG
bit in SYSCR can be used to select whether an interrupt is requested at a rising edge or a falling
edge on the NMI pin.
IRQ7 to IRQ0 Interrupts: Interrupts IRQ7 to IRQ0 are requested by an input signal at pins IRQ7
to IRQ0. Interrupts IRQ7 to IRQ0 have the following features:
• Using ISCR, it is possible to select whether an interrupt is generated by a low level, falling
edge, rising edge, or both edges, at pins IRQ7 to IRQ0
• Enabling or disabling of interrupt requests IRQ7 to IRQ0 can be selected with IER.
• The interrupt priority level can be set with IPR.
⎯ The status of interrupt requests IRQ7 to IRQ0 is indicated in ISR. ISR flags can be cleared to 0
by software.
A block diagram of IRQn interrupts is shown in figure 5.2.
IRQnE
IRQnSCA, IRQnSCB
IRQnF
Edge/level
detection circuit
IRQn input
S
Q
IRQn interrupt
request
R
Clear signal
Note: n = 7 to 0
Figure 5.2 Block Diagram of IRQn Interrupts
Page 92 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
The setting for IRQnF is shown in figure 5.3.
φ
IRQn
input pin
IRQnF
Note: n = 7 to 0
Figure 5.3 Set Timing for IRQnF
The detection of IRQn interrupts does not depend on whether the relevant pin has been set for
input or output. However, when a pin is used as an external interrupt input pin, do not clear the
corresponding DDR to 0; and use the pin as an I/O pin for another function. IRQnF interrupt
request flag is set when the setting condition is satisfied, regardless of IER settings. Accordingly,
refer to only necessary flags.
5.4.2
Internal Interrupts
The sources for internal interrupts from on-chip peripheral modules have the following features:
• For each on-chip peripheral module there are flags that indicate the interrupt request status,
and enable bits that select enabling or disabling of these interrupts. If both of these are set to 1
for a particular interrupt source, an interrupt request is issued to the interrupt controller.
• The interrupt priority level can be set by means of IPR.
• The DMAC or DTC can be activated by a TPU, SCI, or other interrupt request.
• When the DMAC or DTC is activated by an interrupt request, it is not affected by the interrupt
control mode or CPU interrupt mask bit.
5.5
Interrupt Exception Handling Vector Table
Table 5.2 shows interrupt exception handling sources, vector addresses, and interrupt priorities.
For default priorities, the lower the vector number, the higher the priority. Priorities among
modules can be set by means of the IPR. Modules set at the same priority will conform to their
default priorities. Priorities within a module are fixed.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 93 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Table 5.2
Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Interrupt Priorities
Vector Address*
Interrupt
Source
Origin of Interrupt
Source
Vector
Number
Advanced Mode
External pins
NMI
7
H'001C
IRQ0
16
H'0040
IPRA6 to IPRA4
IRQ1
17
H'0044
IPRA2 to IPRA0
IRQ2
18
H'0048
IPRB6 to IPRB4
IRQ3
19
H'004C
IRQ4
20
H'0050
IPR
Priority
High
IPRB2 to IPRB0
IRQ5
21
H'0054
USB
IRQ6
22
H'0058
External pins
IRQ7
23
H'005C
DTC
SWDTEND
24
H'0060
IPRC2 to IPRC0
Watchdog
Timer
WOVI
25
H'0064
IPRD6 to IPRD4
A/D
ADI
28
H'0070
TPU channel 0 TGI0A
32
H'0080
TGI0B
33
H'0084
TGI0C
34
H'0088
TGI0D
35
H'008C
TGI0V
36
H'0090
TPU channel 1 TGI1A
40
H'00A0
TGI1B
41
H'00A4
TGI1V
42
H'00A8
TGI1U
43
H'00AC
TPU channel 2 TGI2A
44
H'00B0
TGI2B
45
H'00B4
8-bit timer
channel 0
Page 94 of 846
TGI2V
46
H'00B8
TGI2U
47
H'00BC
CMIA0 (compare
match A)
64
H'0100
CMIB0 (compare
match B)
65
H'0104
OVI0 (overflow)
66
H'0108
IPRC6 to IPRC4
IPRF6 to IPRF4
IPRF2 to IPRF0
IPRG6 to IPRG4
IPRI6 to IPRI4
Low
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Interrupt
Source
Origin of Interrupt
Source
Vector
Number
Vector Address*
IPR
Priority
8-bit timer
channel 1
CMIA1 (compare
match A)
68
H'0110
IPRI2 to IPRI0
High
CMIB1 (compare
match B)
69
H'0114
OVI1 (overflow)
70
H'0118
DEND0A
72
H'0120
DEND0B
73
H'0124
DEND1A
74
H'0128
DEND1B
75
H'012C
SCI channel 0 ERI0
80
H'0140
RXI0
81
H'0144
TXI0
82
H'0148
TEI0
83
H'014C
SCI channel 1 ERI1
84
H'0150
RXI1
85
H'0154
TXI1
86
H'0158
TEI1
87
H'015C
SCI channel 2 ERI2
88
H'0160
RXI2
89
H'0164
TXI2
90
H'0168
TEI2
91
H'016C
EXIRQ0
104
H'01A0
EXIRQ1
105
H'01A4
DMAC
USB
Note:
*
IPRJ2 to IPRJ0
IPRK6 to IPRK4
IPRK2 to IPRK0
IPRM6 to IPRM4
Low
Lower 16 bits of the start address.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
IPRJ6 to IPRJ4
Page 95 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.6
Interrupt Control Modes and Interrupt Operation
The interrupt controller has two modes: interrupt control mode 0 and interrupt control mode 2.
Interrupt operations differ depending on the interrupt control mode. The interrupt control mode is
selected by SYSCR. Table 5.3 shows the differences between interrupt control mode 0 and
interrupt control mode 2.
Table 5.3
Interrupt Control Modes
Interrupt
Control Mode
Priority Setting Interrupt Mask
Register
Bits
Description
0
Default
I
The priority of interrupt sources are fixed at the
default settings.
Interrupt sources except for NMI is marked by
the I bit.
2
IPR
I2 to I0
8-level interrupt mask control is performed by
bits I2 to I0.
8 priority levels other than NMI can be set with
IPR.
5.6.1
Interrupt Control Mode 0
In interrupt control mode 0, interrupt requests except for NMI is masked by the I bit of CCR in the
CPU. Figure 5.4 shows a flowchart of the interrupt acceptance operation in this case.
1. If an interrupt source occurs when the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an
interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller.
2. If the I bit is set to 1, only an NMI interrupt is accepted, and other interrupt requests are held
pending. If the I bit is cleared, an interrupt request is accepted.
3. Interrupt requests are sent to the interrupt controller, the highest-ranked interrupt according to
the priority system is accepted, and other interrupt requests are held pending.
4. When the CPU accepts an interrupt request, it starts interrupt exception handling after
execution of the current instruction has been completed.
5. The PC and CCR are saved to the stack area by interrupt exception handling. The PC saved on
the stack shows the address of the first instruction to be executed after returning from the
interrupt handling routine.
6. Next, the I bit in CCR is set to 1. This masks all interrupts except NMI.
Page 96 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
7. The CPU generates a vector address for the accepted interrupt and starts execution of the
interrupt handling routine at the address indicated by the contents of the vector address in the
vector table.
Program execution status
No
Interrupt generated?
Yes
Yes
NMI
No
No
I=0
Hold
pending
Yes
No
IRQ0
Yes
No
IRQ1
Yes
EXIRQ1
Yes
Save PC and CCR
I←1
Read vector address
Branch to interrupt handling routine
Figure 5.4 Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance
in Interrupt Control Mode 0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 97 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.6.2
Interrupt Control Mode 2
In interrupt control mode 2, mask control is done in eight levels for interrupt requests except for
NMI by comparing the EXR interrupt mask level (I2 to I0 bits) in the CPU and the IPR setting.
Figure 5.5 shows a flowchart of the interrupt acceptance operation in this case.
1. If an interrupt source occurs when the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an
interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller.
2. When interrupt requests are sent to the interrupt controller, the interrupt with the highest
priority according to the interrupt priority levels set in IPR is selected, and lower-priority
interrupt requests are held pending. If a number of interrupt requests with the same priority are
generated at the same time, the interrupt request with the highest priority according to the
priority system shown in table 5.2 is selected.
3. Next, the priority of the selected interrupt request is compared with the interrupt mask level set
in EXR. An interrupt request with a priority no higher than the mask level set at that time is
held pending, and only an interrupt request with a priority higher than the interrupt mask level
is accepted.
4. When the CPU accepts an interrupt request, it starts interrupt exception handling after
execution of the current instruction has been completed.
5. The PC, CCR, and EXR are saved to the stack area by interrupt exception handling. The PC
saved on the stack shows the address of the first instruction to be executed after returning from
the interrupt handling routine.
6. The T bit in EXR is cleared to 0. The interrupt mask level is rewritten with the priority level of
the accepted interrupt.
If the accepted interrupt is NMI, the interrupt mask level is set to H'7.
7. The CPU generates a vector address for the accepted interrupt and starts execution of the
interrupt handling routine at the address indicated by the contents of the vector address in the
vector table.
Page 98 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Program execution status
Interrupt generated?
No
Yes
Yes
NMI
No
Level 7 interrupt?
No
Yes
Mask level 6
or below?
Yes
No
Level 6 interrupt?
No
Yes
Level 1 interrupt?
Mask level 5
or below?
No
No
Yes
Yes
Mask level 0?
No
Yes
Save PC, CCR, and EXR
Hold
pending
Clear T bit to 0
Update mask level
Read vector address
Branch to interrupt handling routine
Figure 5.5 Flowchart of Procedure Up to Interrupt Acceptance in
Interrupt Control Mode 2
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 99 of 846
Page 100 of 846
(2) (4)
(3)
(5)
(7)
(1)
Internal
data bus
(1)
(2)
(4)
(3)
Instruction prefetch address (Not executed.
This is the contents of the saved PC, the return address)
Instruction code (Not executed)
Instruction prefetch address (Not executed)
SP-2
SP-4
Internal
write signal
Internal
read signal
Internal
address bus
Interrupt
request signal
φ
Internal
operation
(6) (8)
(9) (11)
(10) (12)
(13)
(14)
(5)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
Vector fetch
(12)
(11)
Internal
operation
Saved PC and saved CCR
Vector address
Interrupt handling routine start address (Vector address contents)
Interrupt handling routine start address ((13) = (10) (12))
First instruction of interrupt handling routine
(6)
stack
(14)
(13)
Interrupt service
routine instruction
prefetch
5.6.3
Interrupt level determination Instruction
Wait for end of instruction
prefetch
Interrupt
acceptance
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
H8S/2215 Group
Interrupt Exception Handling Sequence
Figure 5.6 shows the interrupt exception handling sequence. The example shown is for the case
where interrupt control mode 0 is set in advanced mode, and the program area and stack area are
in on-chip memory.
Figure 5.6 Interrupt Exception Handling
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
5.6.4
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Interrupt Response Times
Table 5.4 shows interrupt response times ⎯ the interval between generation of an interrupt request
and execution of the first instruction in the interrupt handling routine. The execution status
symbols used in table 5.4 are explained in table 5.5.
This LSI is capable of fast word transfer to on-chip memory, and have the program area in on-chip
ROM and the stack area in on-chip RAM, enabling high-speed processing.
Table 5.4
Interrupt Response Times
Normal Mode*
5
No.
Execution State
Interrupt
Control
Mode 0
1
1
Interrupt priority determination*
3
Advanced Mode
Interrupt
Control
Mode 2
Interrupt
Control
Mode 0
Interrupt
Control
Mode 2
3
3
3
2
Number of wait states until executing 1 to 19+2⋅SI 1 to 19+2⋅SI 1 to 19+2⋅SI 1 to 19+2⋅SI
2
instruction ends*
3
PC, CCR, EXR stack save
2⋅SK
3⋅SK
2⋅SK
3⋅SK
4
Vector fetch
SI
2⋅SI
2⋅SI
2⋅SI
5
2⋅SI
SI
3
Instruction fetch*
6
4
Internal processing*
2
2
2
2
11 to 31
12 to 32
12 to 32
13 to 33
Total (using on-chip memory)
Notes: 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
2⋅SI
Two states in case of internal interrupt.
Refers to MULXS and DIVXS instructions.
Prefetch after interrupt acceptance and interrupt handling routine prefetch.
Internal processing after interrupt acceptance and internal processing after vector fetch.
Not available in this LSI.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
2⋅SI
Page 101 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Table 5.5
Number of States in Interrupt Handling Routine Execution Statuses
Object of Access
External Device
8-Bit Bus
Symbol
Instruction fetch
SI
Branch address read
SJ
Stack manipulation
SK
16-Bit Bus
Internal
Memory
2-State
Access
3-State
Access
2-State
Access
3-State
Access
1
4
6 + 2m
2
3+m
Legend:
m: Number of wait states in an external device access.
5.6.5
DTC Activation by Interrupt
The DTC and DMAC can be activated by an interrupt. In this case, the following options are
available:
• Interrupt request to CPU
• Activation request to DTC
• Activation request to DMAC
• Selection of a number of the above
For details of interrupt requests that can be used with to activate the DTC and DMAC, see section
7, DMA Controller (DMAC) and section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC).
Figure 5.7 shows a block diagram of the interrupt controller of DTC and DMAC.
Page 102 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Disenable
signal
Clear signal
DMAC
Interrupt
request
IRQ
interrupt
DTC activation
request vector
number
Selection
circuit
Select
signal
Clear signal
On-chip
supporting
module
Interrupt source
clear signal
Control logic
DTC
DTCER
Clear signal
DTVECR
SWDTE
clear signal
Determination of
priority
CPU interrupt
request vector
number
CPU
I, I2 to I0
Interrupt controller
Figure 5.7 Interrupt Control for DTC and DMAC
Selection of Interrupt Source: An activation factor is directly input to each channel of the
DMAC. The activation factors for each channel of the DMAC are selected by the DTF3 to DTF0
bits of DMACR. The DTA bit of DMABCR can be used to select whether the selected activation
factors are managed by the DMAC. By setting the DTA bit to 1, the interrupt factor which was the
activation factor for that DMAC cannot act as the DTC activation factor or the CPU interrupt
factor.
Interrupt factors other than the interrupts managed by the DMAC are selected as DTC activation
request or CPU interrupt request by the DTCERA to DTCERF of DTC and the DTCE bit of
DTCERI.
By specifying the DISEL bit of the DTC’s MRB, it is possible to clear the DTCE bit to 0 after
DTC data transfer, and request a CPU interrupt.
If DTC carries out the designate number of data transfers and the transfer counter reads 0, after
DTC data transfer, the DTCE bit is also cleared to 0, CPU interrupt requested.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 103 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Determination of Priority: The DTC activation source is selected in accordance with the default
priority order, and is not affected by mask or priority levels. See section 8.4, Location of Register
Information and DTC Vector Table. The activation source is directly input to each channel of
DMAC.
Operation Order: If the same interrupt is selected as a DTC activation source and a CPU
interrupt source, the DTC data transfer is performed first, followed by CPU interrupt exception
handling.
If the same interrupt is selected as the DMAC activation factor and as the DTC activation factor or
CPU interrupt factor, these operate independently. They operate in accordance with the respective
operating states and bus priorities.
Table 5.6 shows the interrupt factor clear control and selection of interrupt factors by specification
of the DTA bit of DMAC’s DMABCR, DTC’s DTCERA to DTCERF’s DTCE bit, and the DISEL
bit of DTC’s MRB.
Table 5.6
Interrupt Source Selection and Clearing Control
Settings
DMAC
DTC
Interrupt Sources Selection/Clearing Control
DTA
DTCE
DISEL
DMAC
DTC
CPU
0
0
*
Δ
X
Ο
1
0
Δ
Ο
X
1
Δ
Δ
Ο
*
Ο
X
X
1
*
Legend:
Ο: The relevant interrupt is used. Interrupt source clearing is performed.
(The CPU should clear the source flag in the interrupt handling routine.)
Δ: The relevant interrupt is used. The interrupt source is not cleared.
X: The relevant bit cannot be used.
*: Don’t care
Notes on Use: The SCI interrupt source is cleared when the DMAC or DTC reads or writes to the
prescribed register, and is not dependent upon the DTA bit, DTCE bit, or DISEL bit.
Page 104 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.7
Usage Notes
5.7.1
Contention between Interrupt Generation and Disabling
When an interrupt enable bit is cleared to 0 to disable interrupts, the disabling becomes effective
after execution of the instruction.
When an interrupt enable bit is cleared to 0 by an instruction such as BCLR or MOV, if an
interrupt is generated during execution of the instruction, the interrupt concerned will still be
enabled on completion of the instruction, and so interrupt exception handling for that interrupt will
be executed on completion of the instruction. However, if there is an interrupt request of higher
priority than that interrupt, interrupt exception handling will be executed for the higher-priority
interrupt, and the lower-priority interrupt will be ignored.
The same also applies when an interrupt source flag is cleared to 0.
Figure 5.8 shows an example in which the TGIEA bit in the TPU’s TIER_0 is cleared to 0.
The above contention will not occur if an enable bit or interrupt source flag is cleared to 0 while
the interrupt is masked.
TIER0 write cycle by CPU
TGI0A exception handling
φ
Internal
address bus
TIER_0 address
Internal
write signal
TGIEA
TGFA
TGI0A
Interrupt signal
Figure 5.8 Contention between Interrupt Generation and Disabling
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 105 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.7.2
Instructions that Disable Interrupts
Instructions that disable interrupts are LDC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC. After any of these
instructions is executed, all interrupts including NMI are disabled and the next instruction is
always executed. When the I bit is set by one of these instructions, the new value becomes valid
two states after execution of the instruction ends.
5.7.3
Times when Interrupts Are Disabled
There are times when interrupt acceptance is disabled by the interrupt controller.
The interrupt controller disables interrupt acceptance for a 3-state period after the CPU has
updated the mask level with an LDC, ANDC, ORC, or XORC instruction.
5.7.4
Interrupts during Execution of EEPMOV Instruction
Interrupt operation differs between the EEPMOV.B instruction and the EEPMOV.W instruction.
With the EEPMOV.B instruction, an interrupt request (including NMI) issued during the transfer
is not accepted until the move is completed.
With the EEPMOV.W instruction, if an interrupt request is issued during the transfer, interrupt
exception handling starts at a break in the transfer cycle. The PC value saved on the stack in this
case is the address of the next instruction.
Therefore, if an interrupt is generated during execution of an EEPMOV.W instruction, the
following coding should be used.
L1: EEPMOV.W
5.7.5
MOV.W
R4,R4
BNE
L1
IRQ Interrupt
During clock operation, IRQ input is accepted in synchronization with the clock.
In software standby mode, non-synchronous input is accepted.
For details of the input conditions, see the Control Signal Timing description in the Electrical
Characteristics section for the product in question.
Page 106 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
5.7.6
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
NMI Interrupts Usage Notes
The NMI interrupt is part of the exception processing performed cooperatively by the LSI's
internal interrupt controller and the CPU when the system is operating normally under the
specified electrical conditions. No operations, including NMI interrupts, are guaranteed when
operation is not normal (runaway status) due to software problems or abnormal input to the LSI's
pins. In such cases, the LSI may be restored to the normal program execution state by applying an
external reset.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 107 of 846
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
Page 108 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Section 6 Bus Controller
This LSI has a built-in bus controller (BSC) that manages the external address space divided into
eight areas. The bus controller also has a bus arbitration function, and controls the operation of the
internal bus masters: the CPU, DMA controller (DMAC), and data transfer controller (DTC).
6.1
Features
• Manages external address space in area units
⎯ Manages the external space as eight areas of 2 Mbytes
⎯ Bus specifications can be set independently for each area
⎯ Burst ROM interface can be set
• Basic bus interface*
⎯ Chip select (CS0 to CS7 ) can be output for areas 0 to 7
⎯ 8-bit access or 16-bit access can be selected for each area
⎯ 2-state access or 3-state access can be selected for each area
⎯ Program wait states can be inserted for each area
• Burst ROM interface
⎯ Burst ROM interface can be selected for area 0
⎯ One or two states can be selected for the burst cycle
• Idle cycle insertion
⎯ Idle cycle can be inserted between consecutive read accesses to different areas
⎯ Idle cycle can be inserted before a write access to an external area immediately after a read
access to an external area
• Bus arbitration
⎯ The on-chip bus arbiter arbitrates bus mastership among CPU, DMAC, and DTC
• Other features
⎯ External bus release function
Note: * Chip select CS6 in area 6 is for the on-chip USB. Therefore it cannot be used as an
external area. 8-bit bus mode, 3-state access, and no program wait state should be set
for area 6.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 109 of 846
BSCS207A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Figure 6.1 shows a block diagram of the bus controller.
Chip select signals
Internal
address bus
Area decorder
ABWCR
External bus control signals
ASTCR
BCRH
BCRL
BACK
WAIT
Bus
controller
Wait
controller
Internal data bus
BREQ
Internal control
signals
Bus mode signal
WCRH
WCRL
CPU bus request signal
Bus arbiter
DTC bus request signal
DMAC bus request signal
CPU bus acknowledge signal
DTC bus acknowledge signal
DMAC bus acknowledge signal
Legend:
ABWCR:
ASTCR:
WCRH, WCRL:
BCRH, BCRL:
Bus width control register
Access state control register
Wait control register H, L
Bus control register H, L
Figure 6.1 Block Diagram of Bus Controller
Page 110 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.2
Section 6 Bus Controller
Input/Output Pins
Table 6.1 summarizes the pins of the bus controller.
Table 6.1
Pin Configuration
Name
Symbol
I/O
Address strove
AS
Output Strobe signal indicating that address output on
address bus is enabled.
Read
RD
Output Strobe signal indicating that external space is being
read.
High write
HWR
Output Strobe signal indicating that external space is to be
written, and upper half (D15 to D8) of data bus is
enabled.
Low write
LWR
Output Strobe signal indicating that external space is to be
written, and lower half (D7 to D0) of data bus is
enabled.
Chip select 0 to 7 CS0 to CS7
Function
Output Strobe signal indicating that areas 0 to 7 are selected.
Wait
WAIT
Input
Wait request signal when accessing external 3-state
access space.
Bus request
BREQ
Input
Request signal that releases bus to external device.
Bus request
acknowledge
BACK
Output Acknowledge signal indicating that bus has been
released.
6.3
Register Descriptions
The following shows the registers of the bus controller.
• Bus width control register (ABWCR)
• Access state control register (ASTCR)
• Wait control register H (WCRH)
• Wait control register L (WCRL)
• Bus control register H (BCRH)
• Bus control register L (BCRL )
• Pin function control register (PFCR)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 111 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.3.1
Bus Width Control Register (ABWCR)
ABWCR designates each area for either 8-bit access or 16-bit access.
ABWCR sets the data bus width for the external memory space. The bus width for on-chip
memory and internal I/O registers except for the on-chip USB is fixed regardless of the settings in
ABWCR.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
ABW7
1
1/0*
R/W
Area 7 to 0 Bus Width Controls
6
ABW6*
R/W
5
ABW5
1/0*
1
1/0*
R/W
These bits select whether the corresponding area is to
be designated for 8-bit access or 16-bit access.
4
ABW4
R/W
0: Area n is designated for 16-bit access
3
ABW3
1/0*
1
1/0*
R/W
1: Area n is designated for 8-bit access
R/W
Note: n = 7 to 0
R/W
2
1
1
2
ABW2
1
ABW1
1/0*
1
1/0*
0
ABW0
1/0*
1
1
R/W
Notes: 1. In modes 5 to 7, initial value of each bit is 1. In mode 4, initial value of each bit is 0.
2. The on-chip USB is allocated to area 6. Therefore this bit should be set to 1.
Page 112 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.3.2
Section 6 Bus Controller
Access State Control Register (ASTCR)
ASTCR designates each area as either a 2-state access space or a 3-state access space.
ASTCR sets the number of access states for the external memory space. The number of access
states for on-chip memory and internal I/O registers except for the on-chip USB is fixed regardless
of the settings in ASTCR.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
AST7
1
R/W
Area 7 to 0 Access State Controls
6
AST6*
1
R/W
5
AST5
1
R/W
4
AST4
1
R/W
These bits select whether the corresponding area is to
be designated as a 2-state access space or a 3-state
access space. Wait state insertion is enabled or disabled
at the same time.
3
AST3
1
R/W
2
AST2
1
R/W
1
AST1
1
R/W
0
AST0
1
R/W
0: Area n is designated for 2-state access
Wait state insertion in area n external space is
disabled
1: Area n is designated for 3-state access
Wait state insertion in area n external space is
enabled
Note: n = 7 to 0
Note:
*
The on-chip USB is allocated to area 6. Therefore this bit should be set to 1.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 113 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.3.3
Wait Control Registers H and L (WCRH, WCRL)
WCRH and WCRL select the number of program wait states for each area.
Program waits are not inserted in the case of on-chip memory or internal I/O registers except for
the on-chip USB.
• WCRH
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
W71
1
R/W
Area 7 Wait Control 1 and 0
6
W70
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 7 in external space is accessed while the
AST7 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
7 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 7 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 7 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 7 is accessed
5
4
W61*
W60*
1
R/W
Area 6 Wait Control 1 and 0
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 6 in external space is accessed while the
AST6 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
6 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 6 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 6 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 6 is accessed
Page 114 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
3
W51
1
R/W
Area 5 Wait Control 1 and 0
2
W50
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 5 in external space is accessed while the
AST5 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
5 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 5 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 5 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 5 is accessed
1
W41
1
R/W
Area 4 Wait Control 1 and 0
0
W40
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 4 in external space is accessed while the
AST4 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
4 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 4 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 4 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 4 is accessed
Note:
*
The on-chip USB is allocated to area 6. Therefore these bits should be set to 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 115 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
• WCRL
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
W31
1
R/W
Area 3 Wait Control 1 and 0
6
W30
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 3 in external space is accessed while the
AST3 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
3 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 3 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 3 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 3 is accessed
5
W21
1
R/W
Area 2 Wait Control 1 and 0
4
W20
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 2 in external space is accessed while the
AST2 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
2 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 2 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 2 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 2 is accessed
3
W11
1
R/W
Area 1 Wait Control 1 and 0
2
W10
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 1 in external space is accessed while the
AST1 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
1 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 1 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 1 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 1 is accessed
Page 116 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
1
W01
1
R/W
Area 0 Wait Control 1 and 0
0
W00
1
R/W
These bits select the number of program wait states
when area 0 in external space is accessed while the
AST0 bit in ASTCR is set to 1.
00: Program wait not inserted when external space area
0 is accessed
01: 1 program wait state inserted when external space
area 0 is accessed
10: 2 program wait states inserted when external space
area 0 is accessed
11: 3 program wait states inserted when external space
area 0 is accessed
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 117 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.3.4
Bus Control Register H (BCRH)
BCRH selects enabling or disabling of idle cycle insertion, and the memory interface for area 0.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
ICIS1
1
Idle Cycle Insert 1
R/W
Selects whether or not one idle cycle state is to be
inserted between bus cycles when successive external
read cycles are performed in different areas.
0: Idle cycle not inserted in case of successive external
read cycles in different areas
1: Idle cycle inserted in case of successive external read
cycles in different areas
6
ICIS0
1
R/W
Idle Cycle Insert 0
Selects whether or not one idle cycle state is to be
inserted between bus cycles when successive external
read and write cycles are performed.
0: Idle cycle not inserted in case of successive external
read and write cycles
1: Idle cycle inserted in case of successive external read
and write cycles
5
BRSTRM
0
R/W
Burst ROM enable
Selects whether area 0 is used as a burst ROM interface.
0: Area 0 is basic bus interface
1: Area 0 is burst ROM interface
4
BRSTS1
1
R/W
Burst Cycle Select 1
Selects the number of burst cycles for the burst ROM
interface.
0: Burst cycle comprises 1 state
1: Burst cycle comprises 2 states
3
BRSTS0
0
R/W
Burst Cycle Select 0
Selects the number of words that can be accessed in a
burst ROM interface burst access.
0: Max. 4 words in burst access
1: Max. 8 words in burst access
2 to
0
—
Page 118 of 846
All 0
R/W
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.3.5
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus Control Register L (BCRL)
BCRL performs selection of the external bus-released state protocol, and enabling or disabling of
WAIT pin input.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7
BRLE
0
R/W
Description
Bus release enable
Enables or disables external bus release.
0: External bus release is disabled. BREQ and BACK
can be used as I/O ports.
1: External bus release is enabled.
6
—
0
R/W
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
5
—
0
—
4
—
0
R/W
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
3
—
1
R/W
Reserved
The write value should always be 1.
2,
—
All 0
R/W
1
0
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
WAITE
0
R/W
WAIT pin enable
Selects enabling or disabling of wait input by the WAIT
pin.
0: Wait input by WAIT pin disabled. WAIT pin can be
used as I/O port.
1: Wait input by WAIT pin enabled.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 119 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.3.6
Pin Function Control Register (PFCR)
PFCR performs address output control in external extended mode.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
All 0
Reserved
3
AE3
1/0*
R/W
Address Output Enable 3 to 0
2
AE2
1/0*
R/W
1
AE1
0
R/W
0
AE0
1/0*
R/W
These bits select enabling or disabling of address
outputs A8 to A23 in ROMless extended mode and
modes with ROM.
Note:
R/W
The write value should always be 0.
*
When a pin is enabled for address output, the address is
output regardless of the corresponding DDR setting.
When a pin is disabled for address output, it becomes an
output port when the corresponding DDR bit is set to 1.
0000:
A8 to A23 output disabled (Initial value in modes 6, 7)
0001:
A8 output enabled; A9 to A23 output disabled
0010:
A8, A9 output enabled; A10 to A23 output disabled
0011:
A8 to A10 output enabled; A11 to A23 output disabled
0100:
A8 to A11 output enabled; A12 to A23 output disabled
0101:
A8 to A12 output enabled; A13 to A23 output disabled
0110:
A8 to A13 output enabled; A14 to A23 output disabled
0111:
A8 to A14 output enabled; A15 to A23 output disabled
1000:
A8 t o A15 output enabled; A16 to A23 output disabled
1001:
A8 to A16 output enabled; A17 to A23 output disabled
1010:
A8 to A17 output enabled; A18 to A23 output disabled
1011:
A8 to A18 output enabled; A19 to A23 output disabled
1100:
A8 to A19 output enabled; A20 to A23 output disabled
1101:
A8 to A20 output enabled; A21 to A23 output disabled
(Initial value in modes 4, 5)
1110:
A8 to A21 output enabled; A22, A23 output disabled
1111:
A8 to A23 output enabled
In modes 4 and 5, initial value of each bit is 1. In modes 6 and 7, initial value of each bit
is 0.
Page 120 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.4
Bus Control
6.4.1
Area Divisions
Section 6 Bus Controller
In advanced mode, the bus controller partitions the 16-Mbyte address space into eight areas, 0 to
7, in 2-Mbyte units, and performs bus control for external space in area units. In normal mode*, it
controls a 64-kbyte address space comprising part of area 0.
Figure 6.2 shows an outline of the memory map.
Chip select signals (CS0 to CS7 ) can be output for each area.
Note: * Not available in this LSI.
H'000000
H'0000
Area 0
(2 Mbytes)
H'1FFFFF
H'200000
Area 1
(2 Mbytes)
H'3FFFFF
H'400000
Area 2
(2 Mbytes)
H'FFFF
H'5FFFFF
H'600000
Area 3
(2 Mbytes)
H'7FFFFF
H'800000
Area 4
(2 Mbytes)
H'9FFFFF
H'A00000
Area 5
(2 Mbytes)
H'BFFFFF
H'C00000
Area 6*2
(2 Mbytes)
H'DFFFFF
H'E00000
Area 7
(2 Mbytes)
H'FFFFFF
(1)
Advanced mode
(2)
Normal mode*1
Notes: 1. Not available in this LSI.
2. This area is allocated to the on-chip USB in this LSI.
Figure 6.2 Overview of Area Divisions
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 121 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.4.2
Bus Specifications
The external space bus specifications consist of three elements: bus width, number of access
states, and number of program wait states.
The bus width and number of access states for on-chip memory and internal I/O registers except
for the on-chip USB are fixed, and are not affected by the bus controller.
Bus Width: A bus width of 8 or 16 bits can be selected with ABWCR. An area for which an 8-bit
bus is selected functions as an 8-bit access space, and an area for which a 16-bit bus is selected
functions as a 16-bit access space.
If all areas are designated for 8-bit access, 8-bit bus mode is set; if any area is designated for 16-bit
access, 16-bit bus mode is set. When the burst ROM interface is designated, 16-bit bus mode is
always set. 8-bit bus mode should be set for area 6 in this LSI.
Number of Access States: Two or three access states can be selected with ASTCR.
An area for which 2-state access is selected functions as a 2-state access space, and an area for
which 3-state access is selected functions as a 3-state access space.
With the burst ROM interface, the number of access states may be determined without regard to
ASTCR.
When 2-state access space is designated, wait insertion is disabled.
Area 6 should be set to function as a 3-state access space in this LSI.
Number of Program Wait States: When 3-state access space is designated by ASTCR, the
number of program wait states to be inserted automatically is selected with WCRH and WCRL.
From 0 to 3 program wait states can be selected.
The number of program wait states in area 6 should be set to 0 in this LSI.
Page 122 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Table 6.2
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus Specifications for Each Area (Basic Bus Interface)
ABWCR ASTCR
WCRH, WCRL
ABWn
ASTn
Wn1
Wn0
Number of Access Number of Program
Wait States
Bus Width States
0
0
⎯
⎯
16
1
0
0
1
1
6.4.3
2
0
3
0
1
1
0
2
1
3
0
⎯
⎯
1
0
0
1
Bus Specifications (Basic Bus Interface)
8
2
3
0
0
1
1
0
2
1
3
Bus Interface for Each Area
The initial state of each area is basic bus interface, 3-state access space. The initial bus width is
selected according to the operating mode. The bus specifications described here cover basic items
only, and the sections on each memory interface (see section 6.6, Basic Bus Interface and section
6.7, Burst ROM Interface) should be referred to for further details.
Area 0: Area 0 includes on-chip ROM, and in ROM-disabled extended mode, all of area 0 is
external space. In ROM-enabled extended mode, the space excluding on-chip ROM is external
space.
When area 0 external space is accessed, the CS0 signal can be output.
Either basic bus interface or burst ROM interface can be selected for area 0.
Areas 1 to 6: In external extended mode, all of areas 1 to 6 are external spaces. When areas 1 to 6
external space are accessed, the CS1 to CS6 pin signals respectively can be output. Only the basic
bus interface can be used for areas 1 to 6. Area 6 is only for the on-chip USB. For details, see
section 15, Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB).
Area 7: Area 7 includes the on-chip RAM and internal l/O registers. In external extended mode,
the space excluding the on-chip RAM and internal l/O registers, is external space. The on-chip
RAM is enabled when the RAME bit in the system control register (SYSCR) is set to 1; when the
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 123 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
RAME bit is cleared to 0, the on-chip RAM is disabled and the corresponding space becomes
external space.
When area 7 external space is accessed, the CS7 signal can be output.
Only the basic bus interface can be used for the area 7.
6.4.4
Chip Select Signals
This LSI can output chip select signals (CS0 to CS7) to areas 0 to 7, the signal being driven low
when the corresponding external space area is accessed. Figure 6.3 shows an example of CSn (n =
0 to 7) output timing. Enabling or disabling of the CSn signal is performed by setting the data
direction register (DDR) for the port corresponding to the particular CSn pin.
In ROM-disabled extended mode, the CS0 pin is placed in the output state after a power-on reset.
Pins CS1 to CS7 are placed in the input state after a power-on reset, and so the corresponding
DDR should be set to 1 when outputting signals CS1 to CS7.
In ROM-enabled extended mode, pins CS0 to CS7 are all placed in the input state after a power-on
reset, and so the corresponding DDR should be set to 1 when outputting signals CS0 to CS7. For
details, see section 9, I/O Ports.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
φ
Address bus
Area n external address
CSn
Figure 6.3 CSn Signal Output Timing (n = 0 to 7)
6.5
Basic Timing
The CPU is driven by a system clock (φ), denoted by the symbol φ. The period from one rising
edge of φ to the next is referred to as a “state”. The memory cycle or bus cycle consists of one,
two, or three states. Different methods are used to access on-chip memory, on-chip peripheral
modules, and the external address space.
Page 124 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.5.1
Section 6 Bus Controller
On-Chip Memory (ROM, RAM) Access Timing
On-chip memory is accessed in one state. The data bus is 16 bits wide, permitting both byte and
word transfer instruction. Figure 6.4 shows the on-chip memory access cycle. Figure 6.5 shows the
pin states.
Bus cycle
T1
φ
Internal address bus
Address
Internal read signal
Read
access
Internal data bus
Read data
Internal write signal
Write
access
Internal data bus
Write data
Figure 6.4 On-Chip Memory Access Cycle
Bus cycle
T1
φ
Address bus
Unchanged
AS
High
RD
High
HWR, LWR
High
Data bus
High-impedance state
Figure 6.5 Pin States during On-Chip Memory Access
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 125 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.5.2
On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Timing
The on-chip peripheral modules are accessed in two states except on-chip USB. The data bus is
either 8 bits or 16 bits wide, depending on the particular internal I/O register being accessed.
Figure 6.6 shows the access timing for the on-chip peripheral modules. Figure 6.7 shows the pin
states.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
φ
Internal address bus
Read
access
Address
Internal read signal
Internal data bus
Write
access
Read data
Internal write signal
Internal data bus
Write data
Figure 6.6 On-Chip Peripheral Module Access Cycle
Bus cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address bus
Unchanged
AS
High
RD
High
HWR, LWR
High
Data bus
High-impedance state
Figure 6.7 Pin States during On-Chip Peripheral Module Access
Page 126 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.5.3
Section 6 Bus Controller
External Address Space Access Timing
The external address space is accessed with an 8-bit or 16-bit data bus width in a two-state or
three-state bus cycle. In three-state access, wait states can be inserted. For further details, refer to
section 6.6.3, Basic Timing.
6.6
Basic Bus Interface
The basic bus interface enables direct connection of ROM, SRAM, and so on.
6.6.1
Data Size and Data Alignment
Data sizes for the CPU and other internal bus masters are byte, word, and longword. The bus
controller has a data alignment function, and when accessing external space, controls whether the
upper data bus (D15 to D8) or lower data bus (D7 to D0) is used according to the bus
specifications for the area being accessed (8-bit access space or 16-bit access space) and the data
size.
8-Bit Access Space: Figure 6.8 illustrates data alignment control for the 8-bit access space. With
the 8-bit access space, the upper data bus (D15 to D8) is always used for accesses. The amount of
data that can be accessed at one time is one byte: a word transfer instruction is performed as twobyte accesses, and a longword transfer instruction, as four-byte accesses.
Upper data bus
Lower data bus
D15
D8 D7
D0
Byte size
Word size
1st bus cycle
2nd bus cycle
1st bus cycle
Longword
size
2nd bus cycle
3rd bus cycle
4th bus cycle
Figure 6.8 Access Sizes and Data Alignment Control (8-Bit Access Space)
16-Bit Access Space: Figure 6.9 illustrates data alignment control for the 16-bit access space.
With the 16-bit access space, the upper data bus (D15 to D8) and lower data bus (D7 to D0) are
used for accesses. The amount of data that can be accessed at one time is one byte or one word,
and a longword transfer instruction is executed as two word transfer instructions.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 127 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
In byte access, whether the upper or lower data bus is used is determined by whether the address is
even or odd. The upper data bus is used for an even address, and the lower data bus for an odd
address.
Upper data bus
Lower data bus
D15
D8 D7
D0
Byte size
· Even address
Byte size
· Odd address
Word size
1st bus cycle
Longword
size
2nd bus cycle
Figure 6.9 Access Sizes and Data Alignment Control (16-Bit Access Space)
6.6.2
Valid Strobes
Table 6.3 shows the data buses used and valid strobes for the access spaces.
In a read, the RD signal is valid without discrimination between the upper and lower halves of the
data bus.
In a write, the HWR signal is valid for the upper half of the data bus, and the LWR signal for the
lower half.
Table 6.3
Area
8-bit access
space
Data Buses Used and Valid Strobes
Access
Size
Read/
Write
Address
Valid Strobe
Upper Data Bus Lower Data Bus
(D15 to D8)
(D7 to D0)
Byte
Read
—
RD
Valid
Write
—
HWR
Read
Even
RD
16-bit access Byte
space
Odd
Hi-Z
Valid
Invalid
Invalid
Valid
Even
HWR
Valid
Hi-Z
Odd
LWR
Hi-Z
Valid
Read
—
RD
Valid
Valid
Write
—
HWR, LWR
Valid
Valid
Write
Word
Invalid
Notes: Hi-Z:
High impedance.
Invalid: Input state: input value is ignored.
Page 128 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.6.3
Section 6 Bus Controller
Basic Timing
8-Bit 2-State Access Space: Figure 6.10 shows the bus timing for an 8-bit 2-state access space.
When an 8-bit access space is accessed, the upper half (D15 to D8) of the data bus is used.
Wait states cannot be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
(16-bit bus
mode)
Write
LWR
(8-bit bus
mode)
D15 to D8
D7 to D0
High
High impedance
Valid
High impedance
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.10 Bus Timing for 8-Bit 2-State Access Space
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 129 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
8-Bit 3-State Access Space (Except Area 6): Figure 6.11 shows the bus timing for an 8-bit 3state access space. When an 8-bit access space is accessed, the upper half (D15 to D8) of the data
bus is used.
Wait states can be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
(16-bit bus
mode)
Write
LWR
(8-bit bus
mode)
D15 to D8
D7 to D0
High
High impedance
Valid
High impedance
Note: n = 0 to 5, 7
Figure 6.11 Bus Timing for 8-Bit 3-State Access Space (Except Area 6)
Page 130 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
8-Bit 3-State Access Space (Area 6): Figure 6.12 shows the bus timing for area 6. When area 6 is
accessed, the data bus cannot be used.
Wait states cannot be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
φ
Address bus
CS6
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Invalid
D7 to D0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
(16-bit bus
mode)
Write
LWR
(8-bit bus
mode)
D15 to D8
High
High impedance
High impedance
High impedance
D7 to D0
Figure 6.12 Bus Timing for Area 6
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 131 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
16-Bit 2-State Access Space: Figures 6.13 to 6.15 show bus timings for a 16-bit 2-state access
space. When a 16-bit access space is accessed, the upper half (D15 to D8) of the data bus is used
for the even address, and the lower half (D7 to D0) for the odd address.
Wait states cannot be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
High
Write
D15 to D8
D7 to D0
Valid
High impedance
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.13 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 2-State Access Space (1) (Even Address Byte Access)
Page 132 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Invalid
D7 to D0
Valid
HWR
High
LWR
Write
High impedance
D15 to D8
D7 to D0
Valid
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.14 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 2-State Access Space (2) (Odd Address Byte Access)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 133 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Valid
HWR
LWR
Write
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Valid
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.15 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 2-State Access Space (3) (Word Access)
Page 134 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
16-Bit 3-State Access Space: Figures 6.16 to 6.18 show bus timings for a 16-bit 3-state access
space. When a 16-bit access space is accessed, the upper half (D15 to D8) of the data bus is used
for the even address, and the lower half (D7 to D0) for the odd address.
Wait states can be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
High
Write
D15 to D8
D7 to D0
Valid
High impedance
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.16 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 3-State Access Space (1) (Even Address Byte Access)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 135 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Invalid
D7 to D0
Valid
HWR
High
LWR
Write
D15 to D8
D7 to D0
High impedance
Valid
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.17 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 3-State Access Space (2) (Odd Address Byte Access)
Page 136 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
φ
Address bus
CSn
AS
RD
Read
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Valid
HWR
LWR
Write
D15 to D8
Valid
D7 to D0
Valid
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.18 Bus Timing for 16-Bit 3-State Access Space (3) (Word Access)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 137 of 846
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.6.4
H8S/2215 Group
Wait Control
When accessing external space, this LSI can extend the bus cycle by inserting one or more wait
states (Tw). There are two ways of inserting wait states: program wait insertion and pin wait
insertion using the WAIT pin.
Program Wait Insertion: From 0 to 3 wait states can be inserted automatically between the T2
state and T3 state on an individual area basis in 3-state access space, according to the settings of
WCRH and WCRL.
Pin Wait Insertion: Setting the WAITE bit in BCRL to 1 enables wait insertion by means of the
WAIT pin. When external space is accessed in this state, program wait insertion is first carried out
according to the settings in WCRH and WCRL. Then, if the WAIT pin is low at the falling edge of
φ in the last T2 or TW state, a TW state is inserted. If the WAIT pin is held low, TW states are inserted
until it goes high.
Page 138 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Figure 6.19 shows an example of wait state insertion timing.
By program
wait
T1
T2
Tw
By WAIT pin
Tw
Tw
T3
φ
WAIT
Address bus
AS
RD
Read
Data bus
Read data
HWR, LWR
Write
Data bus
Write data
Note: ↓ indicates the timing of WAIT pin sampling.
Figure 6.19 Example of Wait State Insertion Timing
6.7
urst ROM Interface
With this LSI, external space area 0 can be designated as burst ROM space, and burst ROM
interfacing can be performed. The burst ROM space interface enables 16-bit configuration ROM
with burst access capability to be accessed at high speed.
Area 0 can be designated as burst ROM space by means of the BRSTRM bit in BCRH.
Consecutive burst accesses of a maximum of 4 words or 8 words can be performed for CPU
instruction fetches only. One or two states can be selected for burst access.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 139 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.7.1
Basic Timing
The number of states in the initial cycle (full access) of the burst ROM interface is in accordance
with the setting of the AST0 bit in ASTCR. Also, when the AST0 bit is set to 1, wait state
insertion is possible. One or two states can be selected for the burst cycle, according to the setting
of the BRSTS1 bit in BCRH. Wait states cannot be inserted. When area 0 is designated as burst
ROM space, it becomes 16-bit access space regardless of the setting of the ABW0 bit in ABWCR.
When the BRSTS0 bit in BCRH is cleared to 0, burst access of up to 4 words is performed; when
the BRSTS0 bit is set to 1, burst access of up to 8 words is performed.
The basic access timing for burst ROM space is shown in figures 6.20 and 6.21. The timing shown
in figure 6.20 is for the case where the AST0 and BRSTS1 bits are both set to 1, and that in figure
6.21 is for the case where both these bits are cleared to 0.
Full access
T1
T2
Burst access
T3
T1
T2
T1
T2
φ
Only lower address changed
Address bus
CS0
AS
RD
Data bus
Read data
Read data
Read data
Figure 6.20 Example of Burst ROM Access Timing (When AST0 = BRSTS1 = 1)
Page 140 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Full access
T1
T2
Burst access
T1
T1
φ
Address bus
Only lower address changed
CS0
AS
RD
Data bus
Read data
Read data Read data
Figure 6.21 Example of Burst ROM Access Timing (When AST0 = BRSTS1 = 0)
6.7.2
Wait Control
As with the basic bus interface, either program wait insertion or pin wait insertion using the WAIT
pin can be used in the initial cycle (full access) of the burst ROM interface. See section 6.6.4, Wait
Control.
Wait states cannot be inserted in a burst cycle.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 141 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.8
Idle Cycle
When this LSI accesses external space, it can insert a 1-state idle cycle (TI) between bus cycles in
the following two cases: (1) when read accesses between different areas occur consecutively, and
(2) when a write cycle occurs immediately after a read cycle. By inserting an idle cycle it is
possible, for example, to avoid data collisions between ROM, with a long output floating time, and
high-speed memory, I/O interfaces, and so on.
Consecutive Reads between Different Areas: If consecutive reads between different areas occur
while the ICIS1 bit in BCRH is set to 1, an idle cycle is inserted at the start of the second read
cycle.
Figure 6.22 shows an example of the operation in this case. In this example, bus cycle A is a read
cycle from ROM with a long output floating time, and bus cycle B is a read cycle from SRAM,
each being located in a different area. In (a), an idle cycle is not inserted, and a collision occurs in
cycle B between the read data from ROM and that from SRAM. In (b), an idle cycle is inserted,
and a data collision is prevented.
Bus cycle A
φ
T1
T2
T3
Bus cycle B
T1
Bus cycle A
T2
φ
Address bus
Address bus
CS (area A)
CS (area A)
CS (area B)
CS (area B)
RD
RD
Data bus
Data bus
Long output floating time
(a) Idle cycle not inserted
(ICIS1 = 0)
T1
T2
T3
Bus cycle B
TI
T1
T2
Data collision
(b) Idle cycle inserted
(Initial value ICIS1 = 1)
Figure 6.22 Example of Idle Cycle Operation (1)
Page 142 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Write after Read: If an external write occurs after an external read while the ICIS0 bit in BCRH
is set to 1, an idle cycle is inserted at the start of the write cycle.
Figure 6.23 shows an example of the operation in this case. In this example, bus cycle A is a read
cycle from ROM with a long output floating time, and bus cycle B is a CPU write cycle. In (a), an
idle cycle is not inserted, and a collision occurs in cycle B between the read data from ROM and
the CPU write data. In (b), an idle cycle is inserted, and a data collision is prevented.
Bus cycle A
T1
T2
T3
Bus cycle B
T1
Bus cycle A
T2
T1
φ
φ
Address bus
Address bus
CS (area A)
CS (area A)
CS (area B)
CS (area B)
RD
RD
HWR
HWR
Data bus
Data bus
Long output floating time
(a) Idle cycle not inserted
(ICIS0 = 0)
T2
T3
Bus cycle B
TI
T1
T2
Data collision
(b) Idle cycle inserted
(Initial value ICIS0 = 1)
Figure 6.23 Example of Idle Cycle Operation (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 143 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Relationship between Chip Select (CS) Signal and Read (RD) Signal: Depending on the
system’s load conditions, the RD signal may lag behind the CS signal. An example is shown in
figure 6.24.
In this case, with the setting for no idle cycle insertion (a), there may be a period of overlap
between the bus cycle A RD signal and the bus cycle B CS signal.
Setting idle cycle insertion, as in (b), however, will prevent any overlap between the RD and CS
signals.
In the initial state after reset release, idle cycle insertion (b) is set.
Bus cycle A
T1
T2
T3
Bus cycle B
T1
Bus cycle A
T2
T1
φ
φ
Address bus
Address bus
CS (area A)
CS (area A)
CS (area B)
CS (area B)
RD
RD
T2
T3
Bus cycle B
TI
T1
T2
Possibility of overlap between
CS (area B) and RD
(a) Idle cycle not inserted
(ICIS1 = 0)
(b) Idle cycle inserted
(Initial value ICIS1 = 1)
Figure 6.24 Relationship between Chip Select (CS) and Read (RD)
Table 6.4 shows pin states in an idle cycle.
Table 6.4
Pin States in Idle Cycle
Pins
Pin State
A23 to A0
Contents of next bus cycle
D15 to D0
High impedance
CSn
High
AS
High
RD
High
HWR
High
LWR
High
Page 144 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.9
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus Release
This LSI can release the external bus in response to a bus request from an external device. In the
external bus released state, the internal bus master continues to operate as long as there is no
external access.
In external extended mode, the bus can be released to an external device by setting the BRLE bit
in BCRL to 1. Driving the BREQ pin low issues an external bus request to this LSI. When the
BREQ pin is sampled, at the prescribed timing the BACK pin is driven low, and the address bus,
data bus, and bus control signals are placed in the high-impedance state, establishing the external
bus-released state.
In the external bus released state, an internal bus master can perform accesses using the internal
bus. When an internal bus master wants to make an external access, it temporarily defers
activation of the bus cycle, and waits for the bus request from the external bus master to be
dropped.
When the BREQ pin is driven high, the BACK pin is driven high at the prescribed timing and the
external bus released state is terminated.
In the event of simultaneous external bus release request and external access request generation,
the order of priority is as follows:
(High) External bus release > Internal bus master external access (Low)
Table 6.5 shows pin states in the external bus released state.
Table 6.5
Pin States in Bus Released State
Pins
Pin State
A23 to A0
High impedance
D15 to D0
High impedance
CSn
High impedance
AS
High impedance
RD
High impedance
HWR
High impedance
LWR
High impedance
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 145 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 6 Bus Controller
Figure 6.25 shows the timing for transition to the bus-released state.
CPU cycle
T0
T1
CPU
cycle
External bus released state
T2
φ
High impedance
Address bus
Address
High impedance
Data bus
High impedance
CSn
High impedance
AS
High impedance
RD
High impedance
HWR, LWR
BREQ
BACK
Minimum
1 state
[1]
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
Low level of BREQ pin is sampled at rise of T2 state.
BACK pin is driven low at end of CPU read cycle, releasing bus to external bus
master.
BREQ pin state is still sampled in external bus released state.
High level of BREQ pin is sampled.
BACK pin is driven high, ending bus release cycle.
Note : n = 0 to 7
Figure 6.25 Bus-Released State Transition Timing
6.9.1
Notes on Bus Release
The external bus release function halts when a transition is made to sleep mode while MSTPCR is
set to H'FFFFFF. To use the external bus release function in sleep mode, do not set MSTPCR to
H'FFFFFF.
Page 146 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
6.10
Section 6 Bus Controller
Bus Arbitration
This LSI has a bus arbiter that arbitrates bus master operations.
There are three bus masters, the CPU, DMAC, and DTC, which perform read/write operations
when they have possession of the bus. Each bus master requests the bus by means of a bus request
signal. The bus arbiter determines priorities at the prescribed timing, and permits use of the bus by
means of a bus request acknowledge signal. The selected bus master then takes possession of the
bus and begins its operation.
6.10.1
Operation
The bus arbiter detects the bus masters’ bus request signals, and if the bus is requested, sends a bus
request acknowledge signal to the bus master making the request. If there are bus requests from
more than one bus master, the bus request acknowledge signal is sent to the one with the highest
priority. When a bus master receives the bus request acknowledge signal, it takes possession of the
bus until that signal is canceled.
The order of priority of the bus masters is as follows:
(High) DMAC > DTC > CPU (Low)
An internal bus access by an internal bus master, and external bus release, can be executed in
parallel.
In the event of simultaneous external bus release request, and internal bus master external access
request generation, the order of priority is as follows:
(High) External bus release > Internal bus master external access (Low)
6.10.2
Bus Transfer Timing
Even if a bus request is received from a bus master with a higher priority than that of the bus
master that has acquired the bus and is currently operating, the bus is not necessarily transferred
immediately. There are specific times at which each bus master can relinquish the bus.
CPU: The CPU is the lowest-priority bus master, and if a bus request is received from the DMAC
and DTC, the bus arbiter transfers the bus to the bus master that issued the request. The timing for
transfer of the bus is as follows:
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 147 of 846
Section 6 Bus Controller
H8S/2215 Group
• The bus is transferred at a break between bus cycles. However, if a bus cycle is executed in
discrete operations, as in the case of a longword-size access, the bus is not transferred between
the operations.
• If the CPU is in sleep mode, it transfers the bus immediately.
DTC: The DTC sends the bus arbiter a request for the bus when an activation request is generated.
The DTC can release the bus after a vector read, a register information read (3 states), a single data
transfer, or a register information write (3 states). It does not release the bus during a register
information read (3 states), a single data transfer, or a register information write (3 states).
DMAC: The DMAC sends the bus arbiter a request for the bus when an activation request is
generated.
In the case of a USB request in normal mode, and in short address mode or in cycle steal mode,
the DMAC releases the bus after a single transfer.
In block transfer mode, it releases the bus after transfer of one block, and in burst mode, after
completion of the transfer.
6.10.3
External Bus Release Usage Note
External bus release can be performed on completion of an external bus cycle. The CS signal
remains low until the end of the external bus cycle. Therefore, when external bus release is
performed, the CS signal may change from the low level to the high-impedance state.
6.11
Resets and the Bus Controller
In a power-on reset, this LSI, including the bus controller, enters the reset state at that point, and
an executing bus cycle is discontinued.
In a manual reset, the bus controller’s registers and internal state are maintained, and an executing
external bus cycle is completed. In this case, WAIT input is ignored and write data is not
guaranteed.
Page 148 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
This LSI has a built-in DMA controller (DMAC) which can carry out data transfer on up to 4
channels.
7.1
Features
The features of the DMAC are listed below.
• Choice of short address mode or full address mode
(1) Short address mode
⎯ Maximum of 4 channels can be used
⎯ Choice of dual address mode
⎯ In dual address mode, one of the two addresses, transfer source and transfer destination, is
specified as 24 bits and the other as 16 bits
⎯ Choice of sequential mode, idle mode, or repeat mode for dual address mode
(2) Full address mode
⎯ Maximum of 2 channels can be used
⎯ Transfer source and transfer destination address specified as 24 bits
⎯ Choice of normal mode or block transfer mode
• 16-Mbyte address space can be specified directly
• Byte or word can be set as the transfer unit
• Activation sources: internal interrupt, USB request, auto-request (depending on transfer mode)
⎯ 16-bit timer-pulse unit (TPU) compare match/input capture interrupts
⎯ Serial communication interface (SCI_0, SCI_1) transmission complete interrupt, reception
complete interrupt
⎯ A/D conversion end interrupt
⎯ USB request
⎯ Auto-request
• Module stop mode can be set
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 149 of 846
DMAS220A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
A block diagram of the DMAC is shown in figure 7.1.
Internal address bus
Internal interrupts
TGI0A
TGI1A
TGI2A
TXI0
RXI0
TXI1
RXI1
ADI
Addres buffer
USB request signals
DREQ0
DREQ1
DMAWER
DMATCR
Channel 1
DMACR0A
DMACR0B
Interrupt signals
DEND0A
DEND0B
DEND1A
DEND1B
DMACR1A
DMACR1B
DMABCR
MAR0A
IOAR0A
ETCR0A
MAR0B
IOAR0B
ETCR0B
Module data bus
Channel 0
Control logic
Channel 1B Channel 1A Channel 0B Channel 0A
Processor
MAR1A
IOAR1A
ETCR1A
MAR1B
IOAR1B
ETCR1B
Data buffer
Internal address bus
Legend:
DMAWER: DMA write enable register
DMATCR: DMA terminal control register *
DMABCR: DMA band control register (for all channels)
DMACR: DMA control register
Memory address register
MAR:
I/O address register
IOAR:
Executive transfer counter register
ETCR:
Note: * Reserved register
Figure 7.1 Block Diagram of DMAC
Page 150 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.2
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Register Configuration
The DMAC registers are listed below.
• Memory address register 0A (MAR0A)
• I/O address register 0A (IOAR0A)
• Transfer count register 0A (ETCR0A)
• Memory address register 0B (MAR0B)
• I/O address register 0B (IOAR0B)
• Transfer count register 0B (ETCR0B)
• Memory address register 1A (MAR1A)
• I/O address register 1A (IOAR1A)
• Transfer count register 1A (ETCR1A)
• Memory address register 1B (MAR1B)
• I/O address register 1B (IOAR1B)
• Transfer count register 1B (ETCR1B)
• DMA write enable register (DMAWER)
• DMA control register 0A (DMACR0A)
• DMA control register 0B (DMACR0B)
• DMA control register 1A (DMACR1A)
• DMA control register 1B (DMACR1B)
• DMA band control register (DMABCR)
The DMAC register functions differs depending on the address modes: short address mode and
full address mode. The DMAC register functions are described in each address mode. Short
address mode or full address mode can be selected for channels 1 and 0 independently by means
of bits FAE1 and FAE0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 151 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Table 7.1
FAE0
0
Short Address Mode and Full Address Mode (For 1 Channel: Example of
Channel 0)
Description
Short address mode specified (channels A and B operate independently)
Specifies transfer source/transfer destination address
Channel 0A
MAR0A
IOAR0A
Specifies transfer destination/transfer source address
ETCR0A
Specifies number of transfers
DMACR0A
Specifies transfer source/transfer destination address
Channel 0B
MAR0B
IOAR0B
Specifies transfer destination/transfer source address
ETCR0B
Specifies number of transfers
DMACR0B
Specifies transfer size, mode, activation source, etc.
Full address mode specified (channels A and B operate combination)
Channel 0
1
Specifies transfer size, mode, activation source, etc.
MAR0A
Specifies transfer source address
MAR0B
Specifies transfer destination address
IOAR0A
Not used
IOAR0B
Not used
ETCR0A
Specifies number of transfers
ETCR0B
Specifies number of transfers (used in block transfer mode only)
DMACR0A DMACR0B
Page 152 of 846
Specifies transfer size, mode, activation source, etc.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.3
Register Descriptions
7.3.1
Memory Address Registers (MAR)
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
• Short Address Mode
MAR is a 32-bit readable/writable register that specifies the transfer source address or
destination address. The upper 8 bits of MAR are reserved: they are always read as 0, and
cannot be modified. Whether MAR functions as the source address register or as the
destination address register can be selected by means of the DTDIR bit in DMACR.
MAR is incremented or decremented each time a byte or word transfer is executed, so that the
address specified by MAR is constantly updated. For details, see section 7.3.4, DMA Control
Register (DMACR). MAR is not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
• Full Address Mode
MAR is a 32-bit readable/writable register; MARA functions as the transfer source address
register, and MARB as the destination address register.
MAR is composed of two 16-bit registers, MARH and MARL. The upper 8 bits of MARH are
reserved: they are always read as 0, and cannot be modified. MAR is incremented or
decremented each time a byte or word transfer is executed, so that the source or destination
memory address can be updated automatically. For details, see section 7.3.4, DMA Control
Register (DMACR). MAR is not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
7.3.2
I/O Address Register (IOAR)
• Short Address Mode
IOAR is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the lower 16 bits of the transfer
source address or destination address. The upper 8 bits of the transfer address are automatically
set to H'FF. Whether IOAR functions as the source address register or as the destination
address register can be selected by means of the DTDIR bit in DMACR.
IOAR is not incremented or decremented each time a transfer is executed, so that the address
specified by IOAR is fixed. IOAR is not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
• Full Address Mode
IOAR is not used in full address mode transfer.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 153 of 846
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.3.3
H8S/2215 Group
Execute Transfer Count Register (ETCR)
• Short Address Mode
ETCR is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the number of transfers. The setting
of this register is different for sequential mode and idle mode on the one hand, and for repeat
mode on the other. ETCR is not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
⎯ Sequential Mode and Idle Mode
In sequential mode and idle mode, ETCR functions as a 16-bit transfer counter (with a
count range of 1 to 65,536). ETCR is decremented by 1 each time a transfer is performed,
and when the count reaches H'0000, the DTE bit in DMABCR is cleared, and transfer ends.
⎯ Repeat Mode
In repeat mode, ETCR functions as an 8-bit transfer counter ETCRL (with a count range of
1 to 256) and transfer number storage register ETCRH. ETCRL is decremented by 1 each
time a transfer is performed, and when the count reaches H'00, ETCRL is loaded with the
value in ETCRH. At this point, MAR is automatically restored to the value it had when the
count was started. The DTE bit in DMABCR is not cleared, and so transfers can be
performed repeatedly until the DTE bit is cleared by the user.
• Full Address Mode
ETCR is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the number of transfers. The function
of this register is different in normal mode and in block transfer mode. ETCR is not initialized
by a reset or in standby mode.
⎯ Normal Mode
(a) ETCRA
In normal mode, ETCRA functions as a 16-bit transfer counter. ETCRA is decremented by
1 each time a transfer is performed, and transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000.
(b) ETCRB
ETCRB is not used in normal mode.
⎯ Block Transfer Mode
(a) ETCRA
In block transfer mode, ETCRAL functions as an 8-bit block size counter and ETCRAH
holds the block size. ETCRAL is decremented each time a 1-byte or 1-word transfer is
performed, and when the count reaches H'00, ETCRAL is loaded with the value in
ETCRAH. So by setting the block size in ETCRAH and ETCRAL, it is possible to
repeatedly transfer blocks consisting of any desired number of bytes or words.
(b) ETCRB
ETCRB functions in block transfer mode, as a 16-bit block transfer counter. ETCRB is
decremented by 1 each time a block is transferred, and transfer ends when the count
reaches H'0000.
Page 154 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.3.4
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
DMA Control Register (DMACR)
DMACR controls the operation of each DMAC channel.
• Short Address Mode (common to DMACRA and DMACRB)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
7
Data Transfer Size
DTSZ
0
R/W
Selects the size of data to be transferred at one time.
0: Byte-size transfer
1: Word-size transfer
6
DTID
0
R/W
Data Transfer Increment/Decrement
Selects incrementing or decrementing of MAR every data
transfer in sequential mode or repeat mode.
In idle mode, MAR is neither incremented nor decremented.
0: MAR is incremented after a data transfer
•
When DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after a
transfer
•
When DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after a
transfer
1: MAR is decremented after a data transfer
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
•
When DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after a
transfer
•
When DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after a
transfer
Page 155 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
5
Repeat Enable
RPE
0
R/W
Used in combination with the DTIE bit in DMABCR to select
the mode (sequential, idle, or repeat) in which transfer is to
be performed.
RPE
DTIE
0
0:
Transfer in sequential mode (no transfer end
interrupt)
0
1:
Transfer in sequential mode (with transfer end
interrupt)
1
0:
Transfer in repeat mode (no transfer end
interrupt)
1
1:
Transfer in idle mode (with transfer end
interrupt)
Note: For details of operation in sequential, idle, and repeat
mode, see section 7.4.2, Sequential Mode, section 7.4.3, Idle
Mode, and section 7.4.4, Repeat Mode.
4
DTDIR
0
R/W
Data Transfer Direction
Specifies the data transfer direction (source or destination).
0: Transfer with MAR as source address and IOAR as
destination address
1: Transfer with IOAR as source address and MAR as
destination address
Page 156 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
3
DTF3
0
R/W
Data Transfer Factor
2
DTF2
0
R/W
These bits select the data transfer factor (activation source).
1
DTF1
0
R/W
0000: —
0
DTF0
0
R/W
0001: Activated by A/D conversion end interrupt
0010: —
0011: —
0100: Activated by SCI channel 0 transmission complete
interrupt
0101: Activated by SCI channel 0 reception complete
interrupt
0110: Activated by SCI channel 1 transmission complete
interrupt
0111: Activated by SCI channel 1 reception complete
interrupt
1000: Activated by TPU channel 0 compare match/input
capture A interrupt
1001: Activated by TPU channel 1 compare match/input
capture A interrupt
1010: Activated by TPU channel 2 compare match/input
capture A interrupt
1011: —
1100: —
1101: —
1110: —
1111: —
The same factor can be selected for more than one channel. In this case, activation starts with the
highest-priority channel according to the relative channel priorities. For relative channel priorities,
see section 7.4.10, DMAC Multi-Channel Operation.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 157 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
• Full Address Mode (DMACRA)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
15
Data Transfer Size
DTSZ
0
R/W
Selects the size of data to be transferred at one time.
0: Byte-size transfer
1: Word-size transfer
14
SAID
0
R/W
Source Address Increment/Decrement
13
SAIDE
0
R/W
Source Address Increment/Decrement Enable
These bits specify whether source address register MARA is
to be incremented, decremented, or left unchanged, when
data transfer is performed.
00: MARA is fixed
01: MARA is incremented after a data transfer
•
When DTSZ = 0, MARA is incremented by 1 after a
transfer
• When DTSZ = 1, MARA is incremented by 2 after a
transfer
10: MARA is fixed
11: MARA is decremented after a data transfer
•
•
Page 158 of 846
When DTSZ = 0, MARA is decremented by 1 after a
transfer
When DTSZ = 1, MARA is decremented by 2 after a
transfer
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
12
BLKDIR
0
R/W
Block Direction
11
BLKE
0
R/W
Block Enable
These bits specify whether normal mode or block transfer
mode is to be used. If block transfer mode is specified, the
BLKDIR bit specifies whether the source side or the
destination side is to be the block area.
00: Transfer in normal mode
01: Transfer in block transfer mode, destination side is block
area
10: Transfer in normal mode
11: Transfer in block transfer mode, source side is block area
For operation in normal mode and block transfer mode, see
section 7.4, Operation.
10 ⎯
to 8
All 0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R/W
Reserved
Although these bits are readable/writable, only 0 should be
written here.
Page 159 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
• Full Address Mode (DMACRB)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
7
⎯
0
R/W
Description
Reserved
Although this bit is readable/writable, only 0 should be written
here.
6
DAID
0
R/W
Destination Address Increment/Decrement
5
DAIDE
0
R/W
Destination Address Increment/Decrement Enable
These bits specify whether destination address register
MARB is to be incremented, decremented, or left unchanged,
when data transfer is performed.
00: MARB is fixed
01: MARB is incremented after a data transfer
•
When DTSZ = 0, MARB is incremented by 1 after a
transfer
• When DTSZ = 1, MARB is incremented by 2 after a
transfer
10: MARB is fixed
11: MARB is decremented after a data transfer
•
•
4
—
0
R/W
When DTSZ = 0, MARB is decremented by 1 after a
transfer
When DTSZ = 1, MARB is decremented by 2 after a
transfer
Reserved
Although this bit is readable/writable, only 0 should be written
here.
Page 160 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
3
2
1
0
DTF3
DTF2
DTF1
DTF0
0
0
0
0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Description
Data Transfer Factor
These bits select the data transfer factor (activation source).
In normal mode
0000: —
0001: —
0010: —
0011: —
010×: —
0110: Auto-request (cycle steal)
0111: Auto-request (burst)
1×××: —
In block transfer mode
0000: —
0001: Activated by A/D conversion end interrupt
0010: —
0011: Activated by DREQ signal’s low level input from USB
(USB request)
0100: Activated by SCI channel 0 transmission complete
interrupt
0101: Activated by SCI channel 0 reception complete
interrupt
0110: Activated by SCI channel 1 transmission complete
interrupt
0111: Activated by SCI channel 1 reception complete
interrupt
1000: Activated by TPU channel 0 compare match/input
capture A interrupt
1001: Activated by TPU channel 1 compare match/input
capture A interrupt
1010: Activated by TPU channel 2 compare match/input
capture A interrupt
1011: —
11××: —
The same factor can be selected for more than one channel.
In this case, activation starts with the highest-priority channel
according to the relative channel priorities. For relative
channel priorities, see section 7.4.10, DMAC Multi-Channel
Operation.
Legend: ×: Don’t care
Page 161 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.3.5
DMA Band Control Register (DMABCR)
DMABCR controls the operation of each DMAC channel.
• Short Address Mode
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
15
FAE1
0
R/W
Description
Full Address Enable 1
Specifies whether channel 1 is to be used in short address
mode or full address mode.
In short address mode, channels 1A and 1B are used as
independent channels.
0: Short address mode
1: Full address mode
14
FAE0
0
R/W
Full Address Enable 0
Specifies whether channel 0 is to be used in short address
mode or full address mode.
In short address mode, channels 0A and 0B are used as
independent channels.
0: Short address mode
1: Full address mode
13, ⎯
12
Page 162 of 846
All 0
R/W
Reserved
Only 0 should be written to these bits.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
11
DTA1B
0
R/W
Data Transfer Acknowledge
10
DTA1A
0
R/W
9
DTA0B
0
R/W
8
DTA0A
0
R/W
These bits enable or disable clearing, when DMA transfer is
performed, of the internal interrupt source selected by the
data transfer factor setting.
When DTE = 1 and DTA = 1, the internal interrupt source
selected by the data transfer factor setting is cleared
automatically by DMA transfer. When DTE = 1 and DTA = 1,
the internal interrupt source selected by the data transfer
factor setting does not issue an interrupt request to the CPU
or DTC.
When DTE = 1 and DTA = 0, the internal interrupt source
selected by the data transfer factor setting is not cleared
when a transfer is performed, and can issue an interrupt
request to the CPU or DTC in parallel. In this case, the
interrupt source should be cleared by the CPU or DTC
transfer.
When DTE = 0, the internal interrupt source selected by the
data transfer factor setting issues an interrupt request to the
CPU or DTC regardless of the DTA bit setting.
0: Clearing of selected internal interrupt source at time of
DMA transfer is disabled
1: Clearing of selected internal interrupt source at time of
DMA transfer is enabled
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 163 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
7
DTE1B
0
R/W
Data Transfer Enable
6
DTE1A
0
R/W
5
DTE0B
0
R/W
4
DTE0A
0
R/W
When DTE = 0, data transfer is disabled and the activation
source selected by the data transfer factor setting is ignored.
If the activation source is an internal interrupt, an interrupt
request is issued to the CPU or DTC. If the DTIE bit is set to
1when DTE = 0, the DMAC regards this as indicating the end
of a transfer, and issues a transfer end interrupt request to
the CPU or DTC.
The conditions for the DTE bit being cleared to 0 are as
follows:
•
•
When initialization is performed
When the specified number of transfers have been
completed in a transfer mode other than repeat mode
• When 0 is written to the DTE bit to forcibly abort the
transfer, or for a similar reason
When DTE = 1, data transfer is enabled and the DMAC waits
for a request by the activation source selected by the data
transfer factor setting. When a request is issued by the
activation source, DMA transfer is executed. The condition for
the DTE bit being set to 1 is as follows:
•
When 1 is written to the DTE bit after the DTE bit is read
as 0
0: Data transfer disabled
1: Data transfer enabled
3
DTIE1B
0
R/W
Data Transfer End Interrupt Enable
2
DTIE1A
0
R/W
1
DTIE0B
0
R/W
0
DTIE0A
0
R/W
These bits enable or disable an interrupt to the CPU or DTC
when transfer ends. If the DTIE bit is set to 1 when DTE = 0,
the DMAC regards this as indicating the end of a transfer,
and issues a transfer end interrupt request to the CPU or
DTC.
A transfer end interrupt can be canceled either by clearing
the DTIE bit to 0 in the interrupt handling routine, or by
performing processing to continue transfer by setting the
transfer counter and address register again, and then setting
the DTE bit to 1.
0: Transfer end interrupt disabled
1: Transfer end interrupt enabled
Page 164 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
• Full Address Mode
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
15
Full Address Enable 1
FAE1
0
R/W
Specifies whether channel 1 is to be used in short address
mode or full address mode.
In full address mode, channels 1A and 1B are used together
as a single channel.
0: Short address mode
1: Full address mode
14
FAE0
0
R/W
Full Address Enable 0
Specifies whether channel 0 is to be used in short address
mode or full address mode.
In full address mode, channels 0A and 0B are used together
as a single channel.
0: Short address mode
1: Full address mode
13, —
12
All 0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R/W
Reserved
Although these bits are readable/writable, only 0 should be
written here.
Page 165 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
Data Transfer Acknowledge
Enables or disables clearing, when DMA transfer is
performed, of the internal interrupt source selected by the
data transfer factor setting.
When DTE = 1 and DTA = 1, the internal interrupt source
selected by the data transfer factor setting is cleared
automatically by DMA transfer. When DTE = 1 and DTA = 1,
the internal interrupt source selected by the data transfer
factor setting does not issue an interrupt request to the CPU
or DTC.
When DTE = 1 and DTA = 0, the internal interrupt source
selected by the data transfer factor setting is not cleared
when a transfer is performed, and can issue an interrupt
request to the CPU or DTC in parallel. In this case, the
interrupt source should be cleared by the CPU or DTC
transfer.
When DTE = 0, the internal interrupt source selected by the
data transfer factor setting issues an interrupt request to the
CPU or DTC regardless of the DTA bit setting.
The state of the DTME bit does not affect the above
operations.
11
DTA1
0
R/W
Data transfer acknowledge 1
Enables or disables clearing, when DMA transfer is
performed, of the internal interrupt source selected by the
channel 1 data transfer factor setting.
0: Clearing of selected internal interrupt source at time of
DMA transfer is disabled
1: Clearing of selected internal interrupt source at time of
DMA transfer is enabled
10
—
0
R/W
Reserved
This bit can be read from or written to. The write value should
always be 0.
Page 166 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
9
Data Transfer Acknowledge 0
DTA0
0
R/W
Enables or disables clearing, when DMA transfer is
performed, of the internal interrupt source selected by the
channel 0 data transfer factor setting.
0: Clearing of selected internal interrupt source at time of
DMA transfer is disabled
1: Clearing of selected internal interrupt source at time of
DMA transfer is enabled
8
—
0
R/W
Reserved
Although this bit is readable/writable, only 0 should be written
here.
Data Transfer Master Enable 1
Together with the DTE bit, this bit controls enabling or
disabling of data transfer on the relevant channel. When both
the DTME bit and the DTE bit are set to 1, transfer is enabled
for the channel. If the relevant channel is in the middle of a
burst mode transfer when an NMI interrupt is generated, the
DTME bit is cleared, the transfer is interrupted, and bus
mastership passes to the CPU. When the DTME bit is
subsequently set to 1 again, the interrupted transfer is
resumed. In block transfer mode, however, the DTME bit is
not cleared by an NMI interrupt, and transfer is not
interrupted.
The conditions for the DTME bit being cleared to 0 are as
follows:
• When initialization is performed
• When NMI is input in burst mode
• When 0 is written to the DTME bit
The condition for DTME being set to 1 is as follows:
•
7
DTME1
0
R/W
When 1 is written to DTME after DTME is read as 0
Data Transfer Master Enable 1
Enables or disables data transfer on channel 1
0: Data transfer disabled. In burst mode, cleared to 0 by an
NMI interrupt
1: Data transfer enabled
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 167 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
Data Transfer Enable 1
When DTE = 0, data transfer is disabled and the activation
source selected by the data transfer factor setting is ignored.
If the activation source is an internal interrupt, an interrupt
request is issued to the CPU or DTC. If the DTIE bit is set to
1 when DTE = 0, the DMAC regards this as indicating the
end of a transfer, and issues a transfer end interrupt request
to the CPU.
The conditions for the DTE bit being cleared to 0 are as
follows:
•
•
When initialization is performed
When the specified number of transfers have been
completed
• When 0 is written to the DTE bit to forcibly abort the
transfer, or for a similar reason
When DTE = 1 and DTME = 1, data transfer is enabled and
the DMAC waits for a request by the activation source
selected by the data transfer factor setting. When a request
is issued by the activation source, DMA transfer is executed.
The condition for the DTE bit being set to 1 is as follows:
•
6
DTE1
0
R/W
When 1 is written to the DTE bit after the DTE bit is read
as 0
Data Transfer Enable 1
Enables or disables data transfer on channel 1.
0: Data transfer disabled
1: Data transfer enabled
5
DTME0
0
R/W
Data Transfer Master Enable 0
Enables or disables data transfer on channel 0.
0: Data transfer disabled. In burst mode, cleared to 0 by an
NMI interrupt
1: Data transfer enabled
4
DTE0
0
R/W
Data Transfer Enable 0
Enables or disables data transfer on channel 0.
0: Data transfer disabled
1: Data transfer enabled
Page 168 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
Data Transfer Interrupt Enable B
Enables or disables an interrupt to the CPU or DTC when
transfer is interrupted. If the DTIEB bit is set to 1 when DTME
= 0, the DMAC regards this as indicating a break in the
transfer, and issues a transfer break interrupt request to the
CPU or DTC. A transfer break interrupt can be canceled
either by clearing the DTIEB bit to 0 in the interrupt handling
routine, or by performing processing to continue transfer by
setting the DTME bit to 1.
3
DTIE1B
0
R/W
Data Transfer Interrupt Enable 1B
Enables or disables the channel 1 transfer break interrupt.
0: Transfer break interrupt disabled
1: Transfer break interrupt enabled
Data Transfer End Interrupt Enable A
Enables or disables an interrupt to the CPU or DTC when
transfer ends. If the DTIEA bit is set to 1 when DTE = 0, the
DMAC regards this as indicating the end of a transfer, and
issues a transfer end interrupt request to the CPU or DTC. A
transfer end interrupt can be canceled either by clearing the
DTIEA bit to 0 in the interrupt handling routine, or by
performing processing to continue transfer by setting the DTE
bit to 1.
2
DTIE1A
0
R/W
Data Transfer End Interrupt Enable 1A
Enables or disables the channel 1 transfer end interrupt.
0: Transfer end interrupt disabled
1: Transfer end interrupt enabled
1
DTIE0B
0
R/W
Data Transfer Interrupt Enable 0B
Enables or disables the channel 0 transfer break interrupt.
0: Transfer break interrupt disabled
1: Transfer break interrupt enabled
0
DTIE0A
0
R/W
Data Transfer End Interrupt Enable 0A
Enables or disables the channel 0 transfer end interrupt.
0: Transfer end interrupt disabled
1: Transfer end interrupt enabled
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 169 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.3.6
DMA Write Enable Register (DMAWER)
The DMAC can activate the DTC with a transfer end interrupt, rewrite the channel on which the
transfer ended using a DTC chain transfer, and reactivate the DTC. DMAWER applies restrictions
so that only specific bits of DMACR for the specific channel and also DMABCR can be changed
to prevent inadvertent changes being made to registers other than those for the channel concerned.
The restrictions applied by DMAWER are valid for the DTC.
Figure 7.2 shows the transfer areas for activating the DTC with a channel 0A transfer end
interrupt, and reactivating channel 0A. The address register and count register area is re-set by the
first DTC transfer, then the control register area is re-set by the second DTC chain transfer.
When re-setting the control register area, perform masking by setting bits in DMAWER to prevent
modification of the contents of the other channels.
First transfer area
MAR0A
IOAR0A
ETCR0A
MAR0B
IOAR0B
ETCR0B
MAR1A
DTC
IOAR1A
ETCR1A
MAR1B
IOAR1B
ETCR1B
Second transfer area
using chain transfer
DMAWER
DMATCR
DMACR0A
DMACR0B
DMACR1A
DMACR1B
DMABCR
Figure 7.2 Areas for Register Re-Setting by DTC (Example: Channel 0A)
DMAWER controls enabling or disabling of writes to the DMACR and DMABCR by the DTC.
Page 170 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Bit Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
7 to —
4
All 0
Reserved
3
0
WE1B
—
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
R/W
Write Enable 1B
Enables or disables writes to all bits in DMACR1B, bits 11, 7,
and 3 in DMABCR by the DTC.
0: Writes to all bits in DMACR1B, bits 11, 7, and 3 in
DMABCR are disabled
1: Writes to all bits in DMACR1B, bits 11, 7, and 3 in
DMABCR are enabled
2
WE1A
0
R/W
Write Enable 1A
Enables or disables writes to all bits in DMACR1A, and bits
10, 6, and 2 in DMABCR by the DTC.
0: Writes to all bits in DMACR1A, and bits 10, 6, and 2 in
DMABCR are disabled
1: Writes to all bits in DMACR1A, and bits 10, 6, and 2 in
DMABCR are enabled
1
WE0B
0
R/W
Write Enable 0B
Enables or disables writes to all bits in DMACR0B, bits 9, 5,
and 1 in DMABCR by the DTC.
0: Writes to all bits in DMACR0B, bits 9, 5, and 1 in
DMABCR, are disabled
1: Writes to all bits in DMACR0B, bits 9, 5, and 1 in
DMABCR are enabled
0
WE0A
0
R/W
Write Enable 0A
Enables or disables writes to all bits in DMACR0A, and bits 8,
4, and 0 in DMABCR by the DTC.
0: Writes to all bits in DMACR0A, and bits 8, 4, and 0 in
DMABCR are disabled
1: Writes to all bits in DMACR0A, and bits 8, 4, and 0 in
DMABCR are enabled
Writes by the DTC to bits 15 to 12 (FAE and SAE) in DMABCR are invalid regardless of the
DMAWER settings. These bits should be changed, if necessary, by CPU processing.
In writes by the DTC to bits 7 to 4 (DTE) in DMABCR, 1 can be written without first reading 0.
To reactivate a channel set to full address mode, write 1 to both Write Enable A and Write Enable
B for the channel to be reactivated.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 171 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
MAR, IOAR, and ETCR are always write-enabled regardless of the DMAWER settings. When
modifying these registers, the channel for which the modification is to be made should be halted.
7.4
Operation
7.4.1
Transfer Modes
Table 7.2 lists the DMAC modes.
Table 7.2
DMAC Transfer Modes
Transfer Mode
Short
address
mode
Dual
address
mode
Transfer Source
(1) Sequential mode •
(2) Idle mode
(3) Repeat Mode
•
•
•
Full
address
mode
(4) Normal mode
•
•
(5) Block transfer
mode
•
•
•
•
Page 172 of 846
Remarks
TPU channel 0 to 2
•
compare match/input
capture A interrupts
SCI transmission
complete interrupt
SCI reception
complete interrupt
A/D conversion end
interrupt
•
USB request
Auto-request
TPU channel 0 to 2
compare match/input •
capture A interrupts
SCI transmission
complete interrupt
SCI reception
complete interrupt
A/D conversion end
interrupt
Up to 4 channels can
operate
independently
Max. 2-channel
operation, combining
channels A and B
With auto-request,
burst mode transfer
or cycle steal transfer
can be selected
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.4.2
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Sequential Mode
Sequential mode can be specified by clearing the RPE bit in DMACR to 0. In sequential mode,
MAR is updated after each byte or word transfer in response to a single transfer request, and this is
executed the number of times specified in ETCR. One address is specified by MAR, and the other
by IOAR. The transfer direction can be specified by the DTDIR bit in DMACR. Table 7.3
summarizes register functions in sequential mode.
Table 7.3
Register Functions in Sequential Mode
Function
Register
23
DTDIR = 0
DTDIR = 1
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source
address
register
Destination
address
register
Start address of
transfer destination
or transfer source
Incremented/decrem
ented every transfer
0
Destination
address
register
Source
address
register
Start address of
transfer source or
transfer destination
Fixed
MAR
23
15
H'FF
IOAR
15
0
ETCR
Transfer counter
Number of transfers Decremented every
transfer, transfer
ends when count
reaches H'0000
MAR specifies the start address of the transfer source or transfer destination as 24 bits. MAR is
incremented or decremented by 1 or 2 each time a byte or word is transferred. IOAR specifies the
lower 16 bits of the other address. The 8 bits above IOAR have a value of H'FF. Figure 7.3
illustrates operation in sequential mode.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 173 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Address T
Transfer
IOAR
1 byte or word transfer performed in
response to 1 transfer request
Address B
Note:
Address T = L
Address B = L + (–1)DTID · (2DTSZ · (N–1))
Where: L = Value set in MAR
N = Value set in ETCR
Figure 7.3 Operation in Sequential Mode
The number of transfers is specified as 16 bits in ETCR. ETCR is decremented by 1 each time a
transfer is executed, and when its value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared and transfer ends.
If the DTIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an interrupt request is sent to the CPU or DTC. The
maximum number of transfers, when H'0000 is set in ETCR, is 65,536. Transfer requests
(activation sources) consist of A/D conversion end interrupt, SCI transmission complete and
reception complete interrupts, and TPU channel 0 to 2 compare match/input capture A interrupts.
External requests can be set for channel B only. Figure 7.4 shows an example of the setting
procedure for sequential mode.
Page 174 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
[1] Set each bit in DMABCRH.
Sequential mode
setting
· Clear the FAE bit to 0 to select short address
mode.
· Specify enabling or disabling of internal interrupt
Set DMABCRH
[1]
clearing with the DTA bit.
[2] Set the transfer source address and transfer
destination address in MAR and IOAR.
[3] Set the number of transfers in ETCR.
Set transfer source
and transfer destination
addresses
[2]
[4] Set each bit in DMACR.
· Set the transfer data size with the DTSZ bit.
· Specify whether MAR is to be incremented or
decremented with the DTID bit.
Set number of transfers
[3]
· Clear the RPE bit to 0 to select sequential
mode.
· Specify the transfer direction with the DTDIR bit.
· Select the activation source with bits DTF3 to
Set DMACR
[4]
DTF0.
[5] Read the DTE bit in DMABCRL as 0.
[6] Set each bit in DMABCRL.
· Specify enabling or disabling of transfer
Read DMABCRL
[5]
andinterrupts with the DTIE bit.
· Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable transfer.
Set DMABCRL
[6]
Sequential mode
Figure 7.4 Example of Sequential Mode Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 175 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.4.3
Idle Mode
Idle mode can be specified by setting the RPE bit and DTIE bit in DMACR to 1. In idle mode, one
byte or word is transferred in response to a single transfer request, and this is executed the number
of times specified in ETCR. One address is specified by MAR, and the other by IOAR. The
transfer direction can be specified by the DTDIR bit in DMACR. Table 7.4 summarizes register
functions in idle mode.
Table 7.4
Register Functions in Idle Mode
Function
Register
23
DTDIR = 0
DTDIR = 1
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source
address
register
Destination
address
register
Start address of
transfer destination
or transfer source
Fixed
0
Destination
address
register
Source
address
register
Start address of
transfer source or
transfer destination
Fixed
MAR
23
15
H'FF
IOAR
15
0
Transfer counter
Number of transfers Decremented every
transfer, transfer
ends when count
reaches H'0000
ETCR
MAR specifies the start address of the transfer source or transfer destination as 24 bits. MAR is
neither incremented nor decremented each time a byte or word is transferred. IOAR specifies the
lower 16 bits of the other address. The 8 bits above IOAR have a value of H'FF. Figure 7.5
illustrates operation in idle mode.
MAR
Transfer
IOAR
1 byte or word transfer performed in
response to 1 transfer request
Figure 7.5 Operation in Idle Mode
The number of transfers is specified as 16 bits in ETCR. ETCR is decremented by 1 each time a
transfer is executed, and when its value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared and transfer ends.
If the DTIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an interrupt request is sent to the CPU or DTC. The
maximum number of transfers, when H'0000 is set in ETCR, is 65,536.
Page 176 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Transfer requests (activation sources) consist of A/D conversion end interrupt, SCI transmission
complete and reception complete interrupts, and TPU channel 0 to 2 compare match/input capture
A interrupts. External requests can be set for channel B only. When the DMAC is used in single
address mode, only channel B can be set. Figure 7.6 shows an example of the setting procedure for
idle mode.
[1] Set ech bit in DMABCRH.
Idle mode setting
· Clear the FAE bit to 0 to select short address
mode.
· Specify enabling or disabling of internal interrupt
Set DMABCRH
[1]
clearing with the DTA bit.
[2] Set the transfer source address and transfer
destinatiln address in MAR and IOAR.
Set transfer source
and transfer destination
addresses
[3] Set the number of transfers in ETCR.
[2]
[4] Set each bit in DMACR.
· Set the transfer data size with the DTSZ bit.
· Specify whether MAR is to be incremented or
decremented with the DTID bit.
Set number of transfers
[3]
· Set the RPE bit to 1.
· Specify the transfer direction with the DTDIR bit.
· Select the activation source with bits DTF3 to
DTF0.
Set DMACR
[4]
[5] Read the DTE bit in DMABCRL as 0.
[6] Set each bit in DMABCRL.
· Set the DTIE bit to 1.
· Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable transfer.
Read DMABCRL
[5]
Set DMABCRL
[6]
Idle mode
Figure 7.6 Example of Idle Mode Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 177 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.4.4
Repeat Mode
Repeat mode can be specified by setting the RPE bit in DMACR to 1, and clearing the DTIE bit to
0. In repeat mode, MAR is updated after each byte or word transfer in response to a single transfer
request, and this is executed the number of times specified in ETCR. On completion of the
specified number of transfers, MAR and ETCRL are automatically restored to their original
settings and operation continues. One address is specified by MAR, and the other by IOAR. The
transfer direction can be specified by the DTDIR bit in DMACR. Table 7.5 summarizes register
functions in repeat mode.
Table 7.5
Register Functions in Repeat Mode
Function
Register
23
DTDIR = 0
DTDIR = 1
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source
address
register
Destination
address
register
Start address of
transfer destination
or transfer source
Incremented/decrem
ented every transfer.
Initial setting is
restored when value
reaches H'0000
0
Destination
address
register
Source
address
register
Start address of
transfer source or
transfer destination
Fixed
MAR
23
15
H'FF
IOAR
7
0
Holds number of transfers
Number of transfers Fixed
Transfer counter
Number of transfers Decremented every
transfer. Loaded
with ETCRH value
when count reaches
H'00
ETCRH
7
0
ETCRL
MAR specifies the start address of the transfer source or transfer destination as 24 bits. MAR is
incremented or decremented by 1 or 2 each time a byte or word is transferred. IOAR specifies the
lower 16 bits of the other address. The 8 bits above IOAR have a value of H'FF. The number of
transfers is specified as 8 bits by ETCRH and ETCRL. The maximum number of transfers, when
H'00 is set in both ETCRH and ETCRL, is 256.
Page 178 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
In repeat mode, ETCRL functions as the transfer counter, and ETCRH is used to hold the number
of transfers. ETCRL is decremented by 1 each time a transfer is executed, and when its value
reaches H'00, it is loaded with the value in ETCRH. At the same time, the value set in MAR is
restored in accordance with the values of the DTSZ and DTID bits in DMACR. The MAR
restoration operation is as shown below.
MAR = MAR – (–1)
DTID
·2
DTSZ
· ETCRH
The same value should be set in ETCRH and ETCRL.
In repeat mode, operation continues until the DTE bit is cleared. To end the transfer operation,
therefore, you should clear the DTE bit to 0. A transfer end interrupt request is not sent to the CPU
or DTC. By setting the DTE bit to 1 again after it has been cleared, the operation can be restarted
from the transfer after that terminated when the DTE bit was cleared. Figure 7.7 illustrates
operation in repeat mode.
Address T
Transfer
IOAR
1 byte or word transfer performed in
rewponse to 1 transfer request
Address B
Note:
Address T = L
Address B = L + (–1)DTID · (2DTSZ · (N–1))
Where: L = Value set in MAR
N = Value set in ETCR
Figure 7.7 Operation in Repeat Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 179 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Transfer requests (activation sources) consist of A/D conversion end interrupt, SCI transmission
complete and reception complete interrupts, and TPU channel 0 to 2 compare match/input capture
A interrupts. External requests can be set for channel B only. Figure 7.8 shows an example of the
setting procedure for repeat mode.
[1] Set each bit in DMABCRH.
Repeat mode
setting
· Clear the FAE bit to 0 to select short address
mode.
· Specify enabling or disabling of internal interrupt
Read DMABCRH
[1]
clearing with the DTA bit.
[2] Set the transfer source address and transfer
destination address in MAR and IOAR.
[3] Set the number of transfers in ETCR.
Set transfer source
and transfer destination
addresses
[2]
[4] Set each bit in DMACR.
· Set the transfer data size with the DTSZ bit.
· Specify whether MAR is to be incremented or
decremented with the DTID bit.
Set number of transfers
[3]
· Set the RPE bit to 1.
· Specify the transfer direction with the DTDIR bit.
· Select the activation source with bits DTF3 to
DTF0.
Set DMACR
[4]
[5] Read the DTE bit in DMABCRL as 0.
[6] Set each bit in DMABCRL.
· Clear the DTIE bit to 1.
· Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable transfer.
Read DMABCRL
[5]
Set DMABCRL
[6]
Repeat mode
Figure 7.8 Example of Repeat Mode Setting Procedure
Page 180 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.4.5
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Normal Mode
In normal mode, transfer is performed with channels A and B used in combination. Normal mode
can be specified by setting the FAE bit in DMABCR to 1 and clearing the BLKE bit in DMACRA
to 0. In normal mode, MAR is updated after each byte or word transfer in response to a single
transfer request, and this is executed the number of times specified in ETCRA. The transfer source
is specified by MARA, and the transfer destination by MARB. Table 7.6 summarizes register
functions in normal mode.
Table 7.6
Register Functions in Normal Mode
Register
23
Function
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source address
register
Start address of
transfer source
Incremented/decremented
every transfer, or fixed
0
Destination address Start address of
register
transfer destination
MARA
23
MARB
15
0
ETCRA
Transfer counter
Incremented/decremented
every transfer, or fixed
Number of transfers Decremented every
transfer; transfer ends
when count reaches
H'0000
MARA and MARB specify the start addresses of the transfer source and transfer destination,
respectively, as 24 bits. MAR can be incremented or decremented by 1 or 2 each time a byte or
word is transferred, or can be fixed. Incrementing, decrementing, or holding a fixed value can be
set separately for MARA and MARB.
The number of transfers is specified by ETCRA as 16 bits. ETCRA is decremented each time a
transfer is performed, and when its value reaches H'0000 the DTE bit is cleared and transfer ends.
If the DTIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an interrupt request is sent to the CPU or DTC. The
maximum number of transfers, when H'0000 is set in ETCRA, is 65,536.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 181 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Figure 7.9 illustrates operation in normal mode.
Address TA
Transfer
Address TB
Address BB
Address BA
Note:
Address TA = LA
Address TB = LB
Address BA = LA + SAIDE · (–1)SAID · (2DTSZ · (N–1))
Address BB = LB + DAIDE · (–1)DAID · (2DTSZ · (N–1))
LA = Value set in MARA
LB = Value set in MARB
N = Value set in ETCRA
Figure 7.9 Operation in Normal Mode
Transfer requests (activation sources) are external requests and auto-requests. With auto-request,
the DMAC is only activated by register setting, and the specified number of transfers are
performed automatically. With auto-request, cycle steal mode or burst mode can be selected. In
cycle steal mode, the bus is released to another bus master each time a transfer is performed. In
burst mode, the bus is held continuously until transfer ends. For setting details, see section 7.3.4,
DMA Controller Register (DMACR).
Page 182 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Figure 7.10 shows an example of the setting procedure for normal mode.
[1] Set each bit in DMABCRH.
Normal mode
setting
· Set the FAE bit to 1 to select full address mode.
· Specify enabling or disabling of internal interrupt
clearing with the DTA bit.
Set DMABCRH
[1]
[2] Set the transfer source address in MARA, and the
transfer destination address in MARB.
[3] Set the number of transfers in ETCRA.
[4] Set each bit in DMACRA and DMACRB.
Set transfer source
and transfer destination
addresses
[2]
· Set the transfer data size with the DTSZ bit.
· Specify whether MARA is to be incremented,
decremented, or fixed, with the SAID and SAIDE
bits.
Set number of transfers
[3]
· Clear the BLKE bit to 0 to select normal mode.
· Specify whether MARB is to be incremented,
decremented, or fixed, with the DAID and DAIDE
bits.
Set DMACR
[4]
· Select the activation source with bits DTF3 to
DTF0.
[5] Read the DTE = 0 and DTME = 0 in DMABCRL.
[6] Set each bit in DMABCRL.
Read DMABCRL
[5]
· Specify enabling or desabling of transfer end
interrupts with the DTIE bit.
· Set both the DTME bit and the DTE bit to 1 to
enable transfer.
Set DMABCRL
[6]
Normal mode
Figure 7.10 Example of Normal Mode Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 183 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.4.6
Block Transfer Mode
In block transfer mode, transfer is performed with channels A and B used in combination. Block
transfer mode can be specified by setting the FAE bit in DMABCR and the BLKE bit in
DMACRA to 1. In block transfer mode, a transfer of the specified block size is carried out in
response to a single transfer request, and this is executed the specified number of times. The
transfer source is specified by MARA, and the transfer destination by MARB. Either the transfer
source or the transfer destination can be selected as a block area (an area composed of a number of
bytes or words). Table 7.7 summarizes register functions in block transfer mode.
Table 7.7
Register Functions in Block Transfer Mode
Register
23
Function
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source address
register
Start address of
transfer source
Incremented/decremented
every transfer, or fixed
0
Description address Start address of
register
transfer destination
Incremented/decremented
every transfer, or fixed
Holds block size
Block size
Fixed
Block size counter
Block size
decremented every
transfer; ETCRH value
copied when count reaches
H'00
Block transfer
counter
Number of block
transfers
Decremented every block
transfer; transfer ends
when count reaches
H'0000
MARA
23
MARB
7
0
ETCRAH
7
0
ETCRAL
15
0
ETCRA
MARA and MARB specify the start addresses of the transfer source and transfer destination,
respectively, as 24 bits. MAR can be incremented or decremented by 1 or 2 each time a byte or
word is transferred, or can be fixed. Incrementing, decrementing, or holding a fixed value can be
set separately for MARA and MARB. Whether a block is to be designated for MARA or for
MARB is specified by the BLKDIR bit in DMACRA.
To specify the number of transfers, if M is the size of one block (where M = 1 to 256) and N
transfers are to be performed (where N = 1 to 65,536), M is set in both ETCRAH and ETCRAL,
and N in ETCRB.
Page 184 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Figure 7.11 illustrates operation in block transfer mode when MARB is designated as a block area.
Address TB
Address TA
1st block
2nd block
Transfer
Consecutive transfer
of M bytes or words
is performed in
rewponse to one
request
Block area
Address BB
Nth block
Address BA
Note:
Address TA = LA
Address TB = LB
Address BA = LA + SAIDE · (–1)SAID · (2DTSZ · (M · N–1))
Address BB = LB + DAIDE · (–1)DAID · (2DTSZ · (N–1))
LA = Value set in MARA
LB = Value set in MARB
N = Value set in ETCRA
M = Value set in ETCRAH and ETCRAL
Figure 7.11 Operation in Block Transfer Mode (BLKDIR = 0)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 185 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Figure 7.12 illustrates operation in block transfer mode when MARA is designated as a block area.
Address TA
Address TB
Block area
Address BA
Transfer
1st block
Consecutive transfer
of M bytes or words
is performed in
rewponse to one
request
2nd block
Nth block
Address BB
Note:
Address TA = LA
Address TB = LB
Address BA = LA + SAIDE · (–1)SAID · (2DTSZ · (N–1))
Address BB = LB + DAIDE · (–1)DAID · (2DTSZ · (M · N–1))
LA = Value set in MARA
LB = Value set in MARB
N = Value set in ETCRB
M = Value set in ETCRAH and ETCRAL
Figure 7.12 Operation in Block Transfer Mode (BLKDIR = 1)
ETCRAL is decremented by 1 each time a byte or word transfer is performed. In response to a
single transfer request, burst transfer is performed until the value in ETCRAL reaches H'00.
ETCRAL is then loaded with the value in ETCRAH. At this time, the value in the MAR register
for which a block designation has been given by the BLKDIR bit in DMACRA is restored in
accordance with the DTSZ, SAID/DAID, and SAIDE/DAIDE bits in DMACR.
Page 186 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
ETCRB is decremented by 1 every block transfer, and when the count reaches H'0000 the DTE bit
is cleared and transfer ends. If the DTIE bit is set to 1 at this point, an interrupt request is sent to
the CPU or DTC. Figure 7.13 shows the operation flow in block transfer mode.
Start
(DTE = DTME = 1)
Transfer request?
No
Yes
Acquire bus
Read address specified by MARA
MARA = MARA + SAIDE · (–1)SAID · 2DTSZ
Write to address specified by MARB
MARB = MARB + DAIDE · (–1)DAID · 2DTSZ
ETCRAL = ETCRAL–1
ETCRAL = H'00
No
Yes
Release bus
ETCRAL = ETCRAH
BLKDIR = 0
No
Yes
MARB = MARB – DAIDE · (–1)DAID · 2DTSZ · ETCRAH
MARA = MARA – SAIDE · (–1)SAID · 2DTSZ · ETCRAH
ETCRB = ETCRB – 1
No
ETCRB = H'0000
Yes
Clear DTE bit to 0
to end transfer
Figure 7.13 Operation Flow in Block Transfer Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 187 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Transfer requests (activation sources) consist of A/D conversion end interrupt, SCI transmission
complete and reception complete interrupts, and TPU channel 0 to 2 compare match/input capture
A interrupts. For details, see section 7.3.4, DMA Control Register (DMACR). Figure 7.14 shows
an example of the setting procedure for block transfer mode.
[1] Set each bit in DMABCRH.
Block transfer
mode setting
· Set the FAE bit to 1 to select full address
mode.
· Specify enabling or disabling of internal
Set DMABCRH
[1]
interrupt clearing with the DTA bit.
[2] Set the transfer source address in MARA, and the
transfer destination address in MARB.
[3] Set the transfer source address in ETCRAH and
Set transfer source
and transfer destination
addresses
[2]
ETCRAL. Set the number of transfers in ETCRB.
[4] Set each bit in DMACRA and DMACRB.
· Set the transfer data size with the DTSZ bit.
· Specify whether MARA is to be incremented,
Set number of transfers
[3]
decremented, or fixed, with the SAID and
SAIDE bits.
· Set the BLKE bit to 1 to select block transfer
mode.
Set DMACR
[4]
· Specify whether the transfer source or the
transfer destination is a block area with the
BLKDIR bit.
· Select MARB increment/decrement/fixed with
Read DMABCRL
[5]
DAID and DAIDE bits.
· Select the activation source with bits DTF3 to
DTF0.
[5] Read the DTE = 0 and DTME = 0 in DMABCRL.
Set DMABCRL
[6]
[6] Set each bit in DMABCRL.
· Specify enabling or desabling of transfer end
interrupts to the CPU with the DTIE bit.
· Set both the DTME bit and the DTE bit to 1 to
Block transfer mode
enable transfer.
Figure 7.14 Example of Block Transfer Mode Setting Procedure
Page 188 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.4.7
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
DMAC Activation Sources
DMAC activation sources consist of internal interrupts, external requests, and auto-requests. The
activation sources that can be specified depend on the transfer mode, as shown in table 7.8.
Table 7.8
DMAC Activation Sources
Full Address Mode
Short Address
Mode
Normal Mode
Activation
Source
Internal
interrupt
ADI
×
TXI0
×
RXI0
×
TXI1
×
RXI1
×
TGI0A
×
TGI1A
×
×
TGI2A
USB request
Low level input of the DERQ
signal
Auto-request
Block Transfer
Mode
×
×
×
×
Legend:
: Can be specified
×: Cannot be specified
Activation by Internal Interrupt: An interrupt request selected as a DMAC activation source
can be sent simultaneously to the CPU and DTC. For details, see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
With activation by an internal interrupt, the DMAC accepts the request independently of the
interrupt controller. Consequently, interrupt controller priority settings are not accepted.
If the DMAC is activated by a CPU interrupt source or an interrupt source that is not used as a
DTC activation source (DTA = 1), the interrupt source flag is cleared automatically by the DMA
transfer. With ADI, TXI, and RXI interrupts, however, the interrupt source flag is not cleared
unless the prescribed register is accessed in a DMA transfer. If the same interrupt is used as an
activation source for more than one channel, the interrupt request flag is cleared when the highestpriority channel is activated first. Transfer requests for other channels are held pending in the
DMAC, and activation is carried out in order of priority.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 189 of 846
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
H8S/2215 Group
When DTE = 0, such as after completion of a transfer, a request from the selected activation
source is not sent to the DMAC, regardless of the DTA bit. In this case, the relevant interrupt
request is sent to the CPU or DTC. In case of overlap with a CPU interrupt source or DTC
activation source (DTA = 0), the interrupt request flag is not cleared by the DMAC.
Activation by USB Request: A USB request (DREQ signal) may be specified as the activation
source. Level sensing is used for USB requests. In the normal mode of the full address mode, USB
requests operate as follows.
Transfer request standby status continues while the DREQ signal is held high. If the DREQ signal
is held low, the bus is released each time a single byte of data is transferred, causing continuous
transfers to be split up into chunks. If the DREQ signal goes high while a transfer is in progress,
the transfer is suspended and the status changes to transfer request standby.
Activation by Auto-Request: Auto-request activation is performed by register setting only, and
transfer continues to the end. With auto-request activation, cycle steal mode or burst mode can be
selected.
In cycle steal mode, the DMAC releases the bus to another bus master each time a byte or word is
transferred. DMA and CPU cycles usually alternate. In burst mode, the DMAC keeps possession
of the bus until the end of the transfer, and transfer is performed continuously.
Page 190 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.4.8
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Basic DMAC Bus Cycles
An example of the basic DMAC bus cycle timing is shown in figure 7.15. In this example, wordsize transfer is performed from 16-bit, 2-state access space to 8-bit, 3-state access space. When the
bus is transferred from the CPU to the DMAC, a source address read and destination address write
are performed. The bus is not released in response to another bus request, etc., between these read
and write operations. As with CPU cycles, DMA cycles conform to the bus controller settings.
CPU cycle
DMAC cycle (1-word transfer)
T1
T2
T1
T2
T3
T1
T2
CPU cycle
T3
φ
Source
address
Destination address
Address bus
RD
HWR
LWR
Figure 7.15 Example of DMA Transfer Bus Timing
The address is not output to the external address bus in an access to on-chip memory or an internal
I/O register.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 191 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.4.9
DMAC Bus Cycles (Dual Address Mode)
Short Address Mode: Figure 7.16 shows a transfer example in which TEND* output is enabled
and byte-size short address mode transfer (sequential/idle/repeat mode) is performed from external
8-bit, 2-state access space to internal I/O space.
DMA read
DMA write
DMA read
DMA write
DMA
DMA read DMA write dead
φ
Address bus
RD
HWR
LWR
TEND*
Bus release
Bus release
Bus release
Last transfer cycle
Bus release
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
Figure 7.16 Example of Short Address Mode Transfer
A one-byte or one-word transfer is performed for one transfer request, and after the transfer the
bus is released. While the bus is released one or more bus cycles are inserted by the CPU or DTC.
In the transfer end cycle (the cycle in which the transfer counter reaches 0), a one-state DMA dead
cycle is inserted after the DMA write cycle.
In repeat mode, when TEND* output is enabled, TEND* output goes low in the transfer cycle in
which the transfer counter reaches 0.
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
Page 192 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Full Address Mode (Cycle Steal Mode): Figure 7.17 shows a transfer example in which
TEND*output is enabled and word-size full address mode transfer (cycle steal mode) is performed
from external 16-bit, 2-state access space to external 16-bit, 2-state access space.
DMA read
DMA write
DMA read
DMA write
DMA
DMA read DMA write dead
φ
Address bus
RD
HWR
LWR
TEND*
Bus release
Bus release
Bus release
Last transfer cycle
Bus release
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
Figure 7.17 Example of Full Address Mode (Cycle Steal) Transfer
A one-byte or one-word transfer is performed, and after the transfer the bus is released. While the
bus is released one bus cycle is inserted by the CPU or DTC.
In the transfer end cycle (the cycle in which the transfer counter reaches 0), a one-state DMA dead
cycle is inserted after the DMA write cycle.
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 193 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Full Address Mode (Burst Mode): Figure 7.18 shows a transfer example in which TEND*
output is enabled and word-size full address mode transfer (burst mode) is performed from
external 16- bit, 2-state access space to external 16-bit, 2-state access space.
DMA
DMA read DMA write DMA read DMA write DMA read DMA write dead
φ
Address bus
RD
HWR
LWR
TEND*
Last transfer cycle
Bus release
Bus release
Burst transfer
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
Figure 7.18 Example of Full Address Mode (Burst Mode) Transfer
In burst mode, one-byte or one-word transfers are executed consecutively until transfer ends. In
the transfer end cycle (the cycle in which the transfer counter reaches 0), a one-state DMA dead
cycle is inserted after the DMA write cycle.
If a request from another higher-priority channel is generated after burst transfer starts, that
channel has to wait until the burst transfer ends.
If an NMI is generated while a channel designated for burst transfer is in the transfer enabled state,
the DTME bit is cleared and the channel is placed in the transfer disabled state. If burst transfer
has already been activated inside the DMAC, the bus is released on completion of a one-byte or
one-word transfer within the burst transfer, and burst transfer is suspended. If the last transfer
cycle of the burst transfer has already been activated inside the DMAC, execution continues to the
end of the transfer even if the DTME bit is cleared.
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
Page 194 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Full Address Mode (Block Transfer Mode): Figure 7.19 shows a transfer example in which
TEND* output is enabled and word-size full address mode transfer (block transfer mode) is
performed from internal 16-bit, 1-state access space to external 16-bit, 2-state access space.
DMA
read
DMA
write
DMA
read
DMA
write
DMA
dead
DMA
read
DMA
write
DMA
read
DMA
write
DMA
dead
φ
Address bus
RD
HWR
LWR
TEND*
Bus release
Block transfer
Bus release
Last block transfer
Bus release
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
Figure 7.19 Example of Full Address Mode (Block Transfer Mode) Transfer
A one-block transfer is performed for one transfer request, and after the transfer the bus is
released. While the bus is released, one or more bus cycles are inserted by the CPU or DTC.
In the transfer end cycle of each block (the cycle in which the transfer counter reaches 0), a onestate DMA dead cycle is inserted after the DMA write cycle.
One block is transmitted without interruption. NMI generation does not affect block transfer
operation.
Note: * TEND output cannot be used with this LSI.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 195 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
DREQ Signal Level Activation Timing (Normal Mode): Set the DTA bit for the channel for which the
DREQ signal is selected to 1.
Figure 7.20 shows an example of DREQ level activated normal mode transfer.
Bus release
DMA
read
DMA
write
Bus
release
Transfer
source
Transfer
destination
DMA
read
DMA
write
Transfer
source
Transfer
destination
Bus
release
φ
DREQ
Address bus
DMA control
Channel
Idle
Read Write
Request
Request clear period
Minimum of 2 cycles
[1]
[2]
Idle
[3]
Read
Request
Write
Idle
Request clear period
Minimum of 2 cycles
[4]
[5]
Acceptance resumes
[6]
[7]
Acceptance resumes
Acceptance after transfer enabling; the DREQ signal low level is sampled on the rising
edge of f, and the request is held.
[2] [5] The request is cleared at the next bus break, and activation is started in the DMAC.
[3] [6] Start of DMA cycle.
[4] [7] Acceptance is resumed after the write cycle is completed.
(As in [1], the DREQ signal low level is sampled on the rising edge of f, and the request
is held.)
[1]
Figure 7.20 Example of DREQ Level Activated Normal Mode Transfer
DREQ signal sampling is performed every cycle, with the rising edge of the next φ cycle after the
end of the DMABCR write cycle for setting the transfer enabled state as the starting point.
When the DREQ signal low level is sampled while acceptance by means of the DREQ signal is
possible, the request is held in the DMAC. Then, when activation is initiated in the DMAC, the
request is cleared. Acceptance resumes after the end of the write cycle, DREQ pin low level
sampling is performed again, and this operation is repeated until the transfer ends.
Note: The DREQ signal of this chip is an internal signal of chip, so it is not output from the pin.
Page 196 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.4.10
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
DMAC Multi-Channel Operation
The DMAC channel priority order is: channel 0 > channel 1, and channel A > channel B. Table
7.9 summarizes the priority order for DMAC channels.
Table 7.9
DMAC Channel Priority Order
Short Address Mode
Full Address Mode
Priority
Channel 0A
Channel 0
High
Channel 0B
Channel 1A
Channel 1
Channel 1B
Low
If transfer requests are issued simultaneously for more than one channel, or if a transfer request for
another channel is issued during a transfer, when the bus is released the DMAC selects the
highest-priority channel from among those issuing a request according to the priority order shown
in table 7.14. During burst transfer, or when one block is being transferred in block transfer, the
channel will not be changed until the end of the transfer. Figure 7.21 shows a transfer example in
which transfer requests are issued simultaneously for channels 0A, 0B, and 1.
DMA read
DMA write
DMA read
DMA write
DMA read
DMA
DMA write read
φ
Address bus
RD
HWR
LWR
DMA control Idle Read
Channel 0A
Idle
Write
Read
Write
Idle
Read
Write
Read
Request clear
Channel 0B
Request
hold
Selection
Channel 1
Request
hold
Nonselection
Bus
release
Channel 0A
transfer
Request clear
Request
hold
Bus
release
Selection
Channel 0B
transfer
Request clear
Bus
release
Channel 1 transfer
Figure 7.21 Example of Multi-Channel Transfer
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 197 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.4.11
Relation between the DMAC, External Bus Requests, and the DTC
There can be no break between a DMA cycle read and a DMA cycle write. This means that a
refresh cycle, external bus release cycle, or DTC cycle is not generated between the external read
and external write in a DMA cycle.
In the case of successive read and write cycles, such as in burst transfer or block transfer, a refresh
or external bus released state may be inserted after a write cycle. Since the DTC has a lower
priority than the DMAC, the DTC does not operate until the DMAC releases the bus.
When DMA cycle reads or writes are accesses to on-chip memory or internal I/O registers, these
DMA cycles can be executed at the same time as refresh cycles or external bus release. However,
simultaneous operation may not be possible when a write buffer is used.
7.4.12
NMI Interrupts and DMAC
When an NMI interrupt is requested, burst mode transfer in full address mode is interrupted. An
NMI interrupt does not affect the operation of the DMAC in other modes.
In full address mode, transfer is enabled for a channel when both the DTE bit and the DTME bit
are set to 1. With burst mode setting, the DTME bit is cleared when an NMI interrupt is requested.
If the DTME bit is cleared during burst mode transfer, the DMAC discontinues transfer on
completion of the 1-byte or 1-word transfer in progress, then releases the bus, which passes to the
CPU.
The channel on which transfer was interrupted can be restarted by setting the DTME bit to 1 again.
Figure 7.22 shows the procedure for continuing transfer when it has been interrupted by an NMI
interrupt on a channel designated for burst mode transfer.
Page 198 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Resumption of
transfer on interrupted
channel
DTE = 1
DTME = 0
[1]
Check that DTE = 1 and
DTME = 0 in DMABCRL.
[2]
Write 1 to the DTME bit.
[1]
No
Yes
Set DTME bit to 1
[2]
Transfer ends
Transfer continues
Figure 7.22 Example of Procedure for Continuing Transfer on Channel Interrupted by
NMI Interrupt
7.4.13
Forced Termination of DMAC Operation
If the DTE bit for the channel currently operating is cleared to 0, the DMAC stops on completion
of the 1-byte or 1-word transfer in progress. DMAC operation resumes when the DTE bit is set to
1 again. In full address mode, the same applies to the DTME bit. Figure 7.23 shows the procedure
for forcibly terminating DMAC operation by software.
[1]
Forced termination
of DMAC
Clear DTE bit to 0
Clear the DTE bit in DMABCRL to 0.
If you want to prevent interrupt generation after
forced termination of DMAC operation, clear the
DTIE bit to 0 at the same time.
[1]
Forced termination
Figure 7.23 Example of Procedure for Forcibly Terminating DMAC Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 199 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.4.14
Clearing Full Address Mode
Figure 7.24 shows the procedure for releasing and initializing a channel designated for full address
mode. After full address mode has been cleared, the channel can be set to another transfer mode
using the appropriate setting procedure.
Clearing full
address mode
Stop the channel
[1]
[1] Clear both the DTE bit and the DTME bit in
DMABCRL to 0; or wait until the transfer ends
and the DTE bit is cleared to 0, then clear the
DTME bit to 0.
Also clear the corresponding DTIE bit to 0 at the
same time.
[2] Clear all bits in DMACRA and DMACRB to 0.
[3] Clear the FAE bit in DMABCRH to 0.
Initialize DMACR
[2]
Clear FAE bit to 0
[3]
Initialization;
operation halted
Figure 7.24 Example of Procedure for Clearing Full Address Mode
Page 200 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
7.5
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
Interrupts
The sources of interrupts generated by the DMAC are transfer end and transfer break. Table 7.10
shows the interrupt sources and their priority order.
Table 7.10 Interrupt Source Priority Order
Interrupt
Name
Interrupt Source
Interrupt
Priority Order
Short Address Mode
Full Address Mode
DEND0A
Interrupt due to end of transfer
on channel 0A
Interrupt due to end of transfer
on channel 0
DEND0B
Interrupt due to end of transfer
on channel 0B
Interrupt due to break in transfer
on channel 0
DEND1A
Interrupt due to end of transfer
on channel 1A
Interrupt due to end of transfer
on channel 1
DEND1B
Interrupt due to end of transfer
on channel 1B
Interrupt due to break in transfer
on channel 1
Low
High
Enabling or disabling of each interrupt source is set by means of the DTIE bit for the
corresponding channel in DMABCR, and interrupts from each source are sent to the interrupt
controller independently. The relative priority of transfer end interrupts on each channel is decided
by the interrupt controller, as shown in table 7.10.
Figure 7.25 shows a block diagram of a transfer end/transfer break interrupt. An interrupt is
always generated when the DTIE bit is set to 1 while DTE bit is cleared to 0.
DTE/
DTME
Transfer end/transfer
break interrupt
DTIE
Figure 7.25 Block Diagram of Transfer End/Transfer Break Interrupt
In full address mode, a transfer break interrupt is generated when the DTME bit is cleared to 0
while DTIEB bit is set to 1. In both short address mode and full address mode, DMABCR should
be set so as to prevent the occurrence of a combination that constitutes a condition for interrupt
generation during setting.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 201 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.6
Usage Notes
7.6.1
DMAC Register Access during Operation
Except for forced termination, the operating (including transfer waiting state) channel setting
should not be changed. The operating channel setting should only be changed when transfer is
disabled. Also, the DMAC register should not be written to in a DMA transfer.
DMAC register reads during operation (including the transfer waiting state) are described below.
1. DMAC control starts one cycle before the bus cycle, with output of the internal address.
Consequently, MAR is updated in the bus cycle before DMAC transfer.
Figure 7.26 shows an example of the update timing for DMAC registers in dual address
transfer mode.
DMA last transfer cycle
DMA transfer cycle
DMA read
DMA read
DMA write
DMA write
DMA
dead
φ
DMA Internal
address
DMA control
Idle
DMA register
operation
[1]
Transfer
source
Transfer
destination
Read
Write
[2]
Transfer
destination
Transfer
source
Read
Idle
[1]
Write
[2']
Idle
Dead
[3]
[1] Transfer source address register MAR operation (incremented/decremented/fixed)
Transfer counter ETCR operation (decremented)
Block size counter ETCR operation (decremented in block transfer mode)
[2] Transfer destination address register MAR operation (incremented/decremented/fixed)
[2'] Transfer destination address register MAR operation (incremented/decremented/fixed)
Block transfer counter ETCR operation (decremented, in last transfer cycle of
a block in block transfer mode)
[3] Transfer address register MAR restore operation (in block or repeat transfer mode)
Transfer counter ETCR restore (in repeat transfer mode)
Block size counter ETCR restore (in block transfer mode)
Note: The MAR operation is post-incrementing/decrementing of the DMA internal address value.
Figure 7.26 DMAC Register Update Timing
Page 202 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
2. If a DMAC transfer cycle occurs immediately after a DMAC register read cycle, the DMAC
register is read as shown in figure 7.27.
DMA transfer cycle
CPU longword read
MAR upper
word read
MAR lower
word read
DMA read
DMA write
φ
DMA internal
address
DMA control
DMA register
operation
Note:
Idle
[1]
Transfer
source
Transfer
destination
Read
Write
Idle
[2]
The lower word of MAR is the updated value after the operation in [1].
Figure 7.27 Contention between DMAC Register Update and CPU Read
7.6.2
Module Stop
When the MSTPA7 bit in MSTPCR is set to 1, the DMAC clock stops, and the module stop state
is entered. However, 1 cannot be written to the MSTPA7 bit if any of the DMAC channels is
enabled. This setting should therefore be made when DMAC operation is stopped.
When the DMAC clock stops, DMAC register accesses can no longer be made. Since the
following DMAC register settings are valid even in the module stop state, they should be
invalidated, if necessary, before a module stop.
• Transfer end/suspend interrupt (DTE = 0 and DTIE = 1)
7.6.3
Medium-Speed Mode
When the DTA bit is 0, internal interrupt signals specified as DMAC transfer sources are edgedetected. In medium-speed mode, the DMAC operates on a medium-speed clock, while on-chip
peripheral modules operate on a high-speed clock.
Consequently, if the period in which the relevant interrupt source is cleared by the CPU, DTC, or
another DMAC channel, and the next interrupt is generated, is less than one state with respect to
the DMAC clock (bus master clock), edge detection may not be possible and the interrupt may be
ignored.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 203 of 846
Section 7 DMA Controller (DMAC)
7.6.4
H8S/2215 Group
Activation Source Acceptance
At the start of activation source acceptance, a low level is detected in both DREQ signal falling
edge sensing and low level sensing. Similarly, in the case of an internal interrupt, the interrupt
request is detected. Therefore, a request is accepted from an internal interrupt or DREQ pin low
level that occurs before execution of the DMABCRL write to enable transfer.
When the DMAC is activated, take any necessary steps to prevent an internal interrupt or DREQ
signal low level remaining from the end of the previous transfer, etc.
7.6.5
Internal Interrupt after End of Transfer
When the DTE bit is cleared to 0 by the end of transfer or an abort, the selected internal interrupt
request will be sent to the CPU or DTC even if DTA is set to 1.
Also, if internal DMAC activation has already been initiated when operation is aborted, the
transfer is executed but flag clearing is not performed for the selected internal interrupt even if
DTA is set to 1.
An internal interrupt request following the end of transfer or an abort should be handled by the
CPU as necessary.
7.6.6
Channel Re-Setting
To reactivate a number of channels when multiple channels are enabled, use exclusive handling of
transfer end interrupts, and perform DMABCR control bit operations exclusively. Note, in
particular, that in cases where multiple interrupts are generated between reading and writing of
DMABCR, and a DMABCR operation is performed during new interrupt handling, the DMABCR
write data in the original interrupt handling routine will be incorrect, and the write may invalidate
the results of the operations by the multiple interrupts. Ensure that overlapping DMABCR
operations are not performed by multiple interrupts, and that there is no separation between read
and write operations by the use of a bit-manipulation instruction. Also, when the DTE and DTME
bits are cleared by the DMAC or are written with 0, they must first be read while cleared to 0
before the CPU can write a 1 to them.
Page 204 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
This LSI includes a data transfer controller (DTC). The DTC can be activated by an interrupt or
software, to transfer data.
8.1
Features
• Transfer possible over any number of channels
⎯ Transfer information is stored in memory
⎯ One activation source can trigger a number of data transfer (chain transfer)
• Three transfer modes
⎯ Normal, repeat, and block transfer modes available
• One activation source can trigger a number of data transfers (chain transfer)
• Direct specification of 16-Mbyte address space possible
• Activation by software is possible
• Transfer can be set in byte or word units
• A CPU interrupt can be requested for the interrupt that activated the DTC
• Module stop mode can be set
Figure 8.1 shows a block diagram of the DTC. The DTC’s register information is stored in the onchip RAM. When the DTC is used, the RAME bit in SYSCR must be set to 1. A 32-bit bus
connects the DTC to the on-chip RAM (1 kbyte), enabling 32-bit/1-state reading and writing of
the DTC register information.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 205 of 846
DTCH807A_000120020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Internal address bus
CPU interrupt
request
Legend:
MRA, MRB:
CRA, CRB:
SAR:
DAR:
DTCERA to DTCERF:
DTVECR:
Register information
MRA MRB
CRA
CRB
DAR
SAR
DTC service
request
DTVECR
Interrupt
request
DTCERA
to
DTCERF
On-chip
RAM
DTC
Control logic
Interrupt controller
Internal data bus
DTC mode registers A and B
DTC transfer count registers A and B
DTC source address register
DTC destination address register
DTC enable registers A to F
DTC vector register
Figure 8.1 Block Diagram of DTC
Page 206 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
8.2
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Register Descriptions
DTC has the following registers.
• DTC mode register A (MRA)
• DTC mode register B (MRB)
• DTC source address register (SAR)
• DTC destination address register (DAR)
• DTC transfer count register A (CRA)
• DTC transfer count register B (CRB)
These six registers cannot be directly accessed from the CPU. When activated, the DTC reads a set
of register information that is stored in an on-chip RAM to the corresponding DTC registers and
transfers data. After the data transfer, it writes a set of updated register information back to the
RAM.
• DTC enable registers (DTCERA to DTCERF)
• DTC vector register (DTVECR)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 207 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.2.1
DTC Mode Register A (MRA)
MRA selects the DTC operating mode.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
SM1
Undefined
—
Source Address Mode 1 and 0
6
SM0
Undefined
—
These bits specify an SAR operation after a data transfer.
0×: SAR is fixed
10: SAR is incremented after a transfer
(by +1 when Sz = 0; by +2 when Sz = 1)
11: SAR is decremented after a transfer
(by –1 when Sz = 0; by –2 when Sz = 1)
5
DM1
Undefined
—
Destination Address Mode 1 and 0
4
DM0
Undefined
—
These bits specify a DAR operation after a data transfer.
0×: DAR is fixed
10: DAR is incremented after a transfer
(by +1 when Sz = 0; by +2 when Sz = 1)
11: DAR is decremented after a transfer
(by –1 when Sz = 0; by –2 when Sz = 1)
3
MD1
Undefined
—
DTC Mode
2
MD0
Undefined
—
These bits specify the DTC transfer mode.
00: Normal mode
01: Repeat mode
10: Block transfer mode
11: Setting prohibited
1
DTS
Undefined
—
DTC Transfer Mode Select
Specifies whether the source side or the destination side
is set to be a repeat area or block area, in repeat mode or
block transfer mode.
0: Destination side is repeat area or block area
1: Source side is repeat area or block area
0
Sz
Undefined
—
DTC Data Transfer Size
Specifies the size of data to be transferred.
0: Byte-size transfer
1: Word-size transfer
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Page 208 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
8.2.2
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
DTC Mode Register B (MRB)
MRB selects the DTC operating mode.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
CHNE
—
DTC Chain Transfer Enable
Undefined
This bit specifies a chain transfer. For details, refer to
section 8.5.4, Chain Transfer.
In data transfer with CHNE set to 1, determination of the
end of the specified number of transfers, clearing of the
interrupt source flag, and clearing of DTCER, are not
performed.
0: DTC data transfer completed (waiting for start)
1: DTC chain transfer (reads new register information and
transfers data)
6
DISEL
Undefined
—
DTC Interrupt Select
This bit specifies whether CPU interrupt is disabled or
enabled after a data transfer.
0: Interrupt request is issued to the CPU when the
specified data transfer is completed.
1: DTC issues interrupt request to the CPU in every
data transfer (DTC does not clear the interrupt
request flag that is a cause of the activation).
5 to
0
8.2.3
—
Undefined
—
Reserved
These bits have no effect on DTC operation, and the write
value should always be 0.
DTC Source Address Register (SAR)
SAR is a 24-bit register that designates the source address of data to be transferred by the DTC.
For word-size transfer, specify an even source address.
8.2.4
DTC Destination Address Register (DAR)
DAR is a 24-bit register that designates the destination address of data to be transferred by the
DTC. For word-size transfer, specify an even destination address.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 209 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.2.5
DTC Transfer Count Register A (CRA)
CRA is a 16-bit register that designates the number of times data is to be transferred by the DTC.
In normal mode, the entire CRA functions as a 16-bit transfer counter (1 to 65,536). It is
decremented by 1 every time data is transferred, and transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000.
In repeat mode or block transfer mode, the CRA is divided into two parts: the upper 8 bits
(CRAH) and the lower 8 bits (CRAL). CRAH holds the number of transfers while CRAL
functions as an 8-bit transfer counter (1 to 256). In block transfer mode, CRAH stores the block
size while CRAL functions as an 8-bit block size counter (1 to 256). CRAL is decremented by 1
every time data is transferred, and the contents of CRAH are sent when the count reaches H'00.
This operation is repeated.
8.2.6
DTC Transfer Count Register B (CRB)
CRB is a 16-bit register that designates the number of times data is to be transferred by the DTC in
block transfer mode. It functions as a 16-bit transfer counter (1 to 65,536) that is decremented by 1
every time data is transferred, and transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000.
8.2.7
DTC Enable Registers (DTCERA to DTCERF)
DTCER which is comprised of seven registers, DTCERA to DTCERF, is a register that specifies
DTC activation interrupt sources. The correspondence between interrupt sources and DTCE bits is
shown in table 8.2. For DTCE bit setting, use bit manipulation instructions such as BSET and
BCLR for reading and writing. If all interrupts are masked, multiple activation sources can be set
at one time (only at the initial setting) by writing data after executing a dummy read on the
relevant register.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTCEn7
DTCEn6
DTCEn5
DTCEn4
DTCEn3
DTCEn2
DTCEn1
DTCEn0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
DTC Activation Enable 7 to 0
0: Prohibits DTC startup by an interrupt.
1: Selects a corresponding interrupt source as the DTC
startup source.
[Clearing conditions]
• When the DISEL bit is 1 and the data transfer has
ended
• When the specified number of transfers have ended
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
[Holding condition]
• These bits are not cleared when the DISEL bit is 0 and
the specified number of transfers have not ended
Page 210 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
8.2.8
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
DTC Vector Register (DTVECR)
DTVECR enables or disables DTC activation by software, and sets a vector number for the
software activation interrupt.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
7
SWDTE
R/W* DTC Software Activation Enable
0
Description
This bit specifies whether DTC software startup is enabled
or prohibited.
0: Prohibits DTC software startup.
1: Enables DTC software startup.
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
When the DISEL bit is 0 and the specified number of
transfers have not ended
When 0 s written to the DISEL bit after a softwareactivated data transfer end interrupt (SWDTEND)
request has been sent to the CPU
[Holding conditions]
•
•
•
The DISEL bit is set to 1 and data transfer has
finished.
The specified number of data transfers have
completed.
A software-triggered data transfer is in progress.
6
DTVEC6
0
R/W
DTC Software Activation Vector 6 to 0
5
DTVEC5
0
R/W
4
DTVEC4
0
R/W
These bits specify a vector number for DTC software
activation.
3
DTVEC3
0
R/W
2
DTVEC2
0
R/W
1
DTVEC1
0
R/W
0
DTVEC0
0
R/W
Note:
*
Only 1 may be written to the SWDTE bit.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
The vector address is expressed as H'0400 + (vector
number × 2). For example, when DTVEC6 to
DTVEC0 = H'10, the vector address is H'0420. When the
bit SWDTE is 0, these bits can be written.
Page 211 of 846
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.3
H8S/2215 Group
Activation Sources
The DTC operates when activated by an interrupt or by a write to DTVECR by software. DTCER
is used to select the activation interrupt source. An interrupt request can be directed to the CPU or
DTC, as designated by the corresponding DTCER bit. At the end of a data transfer (or the last
consecutive transfer in the case of chain transfer), the activation source or corresponding DTCER
bit is cleared. Table 8.1 shows an activation source and DTCER clearance. The activation source
flag, in the case of RXI0, for example, is the RDRF flag of SCI channel 0.
When an interrupt has been designated a DTC activation source, existing CPU mask level and
interrupt controller priorities have no effect. If there is more than one activation source at the same
time, the DTC operates in accordance with the default priorities. Figure 8.2 shows a block diagram
of activation source control. For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
Table 8.1
Activation Source and DTCER Clearance
Activation Source
When the DISEL Bit Is 0 and the
Specified Number of Transfer
Have Not Ended
When the DISEL Bit Is 1, or when
the Specified Number of Transfers
Have Ended
Software activation
The SWDTE bit is cleared to 0
The SWDTE bit remains set to 1
An interrupt is issued to the CPU
Interrupt activation
The corresponding DTCER bit
remains set to 1
The corresponding DTCER bit is
cleared to 0
The activation source flag is cleared The activation source flag remains
to 0
set to 1
A request is issued to the CPU for
the activation source interrupt
Page 212 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Source flag cleared
Clear
controller
Clear
DTCER
On-chip
supporting
module
IRQ interrupt
DTVECR
Interrupt
request
Selection circuit
Select
Clear request
DTC
CPU
Interrupt controller
Interrupt mask
Figure 8.2 Block Diagram of DTC Activation Source Control
8.4
Location of Register Information and DTC Vector Table
Locate the register information in the on-chip RAM (addresses: H'FFEBC0 to H'FFEFBF).
Register information should be located at the address that is multiple of four within the range.
Locating the register information in address space is shown in figure 8.3. Locate the MRA, SAR,
MRB, DAR, CRA, and CRB registers, in that order, from the start address of the register
information. In the case of chain transfer, register information should be located in consecutive
areas and the register information start address should be located at the corresponding vector
address to the interrupt source. The DTC reads the start address of the register information from
the vector address set for each activation source, and then reads the register information from that
start address.
When the DTC is activated by software, the vector address is obtained from: H'0400 +
(DTVECR[6:0] × 2). For example, if DTVECR is H'10, the vector address is H'0420. The
configuration of the vector address is the same in both normal and advanced modes, a 2-byte unit
being used in both cases. These two bytes specify the lower bits of the register information start
address.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 213 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Lower address
0
Register
information
start address
1
2
MRA
SAR
MRB
DAR
Register information
CRB
CRA
Chain
transfer
3
MRA
SAR
MRB
DAR
Register information
for 2nd transfer in
chain transfer
CRB
CRA
4 bytes
Figure 8.3 Correspondence between DTC Vector Address and Register Information
DTC vector
address
Register information
start address
Register information
Chain transfer
Figure 8.4 Correspondence between DTC Vector Address and Register Information
Page 214 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Table 8.2
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Interrupt Sources, DTC Vector Addresses, and Corresponding DTCE
Interrupt Source
Origin of
Interrupt Source
Vector
Number
DTC Vector
Address
Software
Write to DTVECR
DTVECR
H'0400 +
DTVECR[6:0] ×2
External pins
IRQ0
16
H'0420
DTCEA7
IRQ1
17
H'0422
DTCEA6
IRQ2
18
H'0424
DTCEA5
IRQ3
19
H'0426
DTCEA4
IRQ4
20
H'0428
DTCEA3
IRQ5
21
H'042A
DTCEA2
IRQ7
23
H'042E
DTCEA0
A/D
ADI
28
H'0438
DTCEB6
TPU channel 0
TGIA0
32
H'0440
DTCEB5
TGIB0
33
H'0442
DTCEB4
TGIC0
34
H'0444
DTCEB3
TGID0
35
H'0446
DTCEB2
TGI1A
40
H'0450
DTCEB1
TGI1B
41
H'0452
DTCEB0
TPU channel 1
TPU channel 2
8-bit timer
channel 0
8-bit timer
channel 1
DMAC
SIC channel 0
SIC channel 1
SIC channel 2
Note:
*
Priority
High
TGI2A
44
H'0458
DTCEC7
TGI2B
45
H'045A
DTCEC6
CMIA0
64
H'0480
DTCED3
CMIB0
65
H'0482
DTCED2
CMIA1
68
H'0488
DTCED1
CMIB1
69
H'048A
DTCED0
DEND0A
72
H'0490
DTCEE7
DEND0B
73
H'0492
DTCEE6
DEND1A
74
H'0494
DTCEE5
DEND1A
75
H'0496
DTCEE4
RXI0
81
H'04A2
DTCEE3
TXI0
82
H'04A4
DTCEE2
RXI1
85
H'04AA
DTCEE1
TXI1
86
H'04AC
DTCEE0
RXI2
89
H'04B2
DTCEF7
TXI2
90
H'04B4
DTCEF6
Low
DTCE bits with no corresponding interrupt are reserved, and the write value should
always be 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
DTCE*
Page 215 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.5
Operation
Register information is stored in an on-chip RAM. When activated, the DTC reads register
information in an on-chip RAM and transfers data. After the data transfer, it writes updated
register information back to the memory. Pre-storage of register information in the memory makes
it possible to transfer data over any required number of channels. The transfer mode can be
specified as normal, repeat, and block transfer mode. Setting the CHNE bit to 1 makes it possible
to perform a number of transfers with a single activation source (chain transfer).
The 24-bit SAR designates the DTC transfer source address and the 24-bit DAR designates the
transfer destination address. After each transfer, SAR and DAR are independently incremented,
decremented, or left fixed depending on its register information.
Figure 8.5 shows a flowchart of DTC operation.
Start
Read DTC vector
Next transfer
Register information read
Data transfer
Write register information
CHNE = 1
Yes
No
Transfer
counter = 0
or DISEL = 1
No
Yes
*2
Clear an active flag
Clear DTCER
End
Interrupt exception
handling
*1
Note: *1 For details on the processing that takes place, refer to the chapter on the peripheral module in question.
*2 When IRQx is the DTC activation source and the IRQ sense control registers (ISCRH and ISCRL) are
set to level sensing, the activation source flag is not cleared while IRQx is low level and DTC transfers
are performed repeatedly.
Figure 8.5 Flowchart of DTC Operation
Page 216 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Table 8.3 summarizes DTC functions.
Table 8.3
Overview of DTC Functions
Address Register
Transfer Mode
Activation Source
Source
Destination
Normal mode
•
•
•
•
24 bits
24 bits
•
One byte or one word data is transferred
in response to a single transfer request.
• The memory address is incremented by
1 or 2.
• The number of times of data transfer is
designated as 1 to 65,536.
Repeat mode
•
One byte or one word data is transferred
in response to a single transfer request.
• The memory address is incremented by
1 or 2.
• When the specified number of transfers
(1 to 256) have ended, the initial state is
restored, and transfer is repeated.
Block transfer mode
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
IRQ
TGI for TPU
CMI for 8-bit timer
TXI and RXI for
SCI
ADI for A/D
converter
DEND for DMAC
Software
The data of the specified block is
transferred in response to a single
transfer request.
The block size is designated as 1 to 256
bytes or words.
The number of times of data transfer is
designated as 1 to 65,536.
Either the transfer source or destination
is designated as a block area.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 217 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.5.1
Normal Mode
In normal mode, one operation transfers one byte or one word of data.
From 1 to 65,536 transfers can be specified. Once the specified number of transfers have ended, a
CPU interrupt can be requested.
Table 8.4 shows the register information in normal mode, and figure 8.6 shows the memory
mapping in normal mode.
Table 8.4
Register Information in Normal Mode
Name
Abbreviation
Function
DTC source address register
SAR
Designates source address
DTC destination address
register
DAR
Designates destination address
DTC transfer count register A
CRA
Designates transfer count
DTC transfer count register B
CRB
Not used
SAR
DAR
Transfer
Figure 8.6 Memory Mapping in Normal Mode
Page 218 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
8.5.2
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Repeat Mode
In repeat mode, one operation transfers one byte or one word of data. From 1 to 256 transfers can
be specified. Once the specified number of transfers have ended, the initial state of the transfer
counter and the address register specified as the repeat area is restored, and transfer is repeated. In
repeat mode the transfer counter value does not reach H'00, and therefore CPU interrupts cannot
be requested when DISEL = 0.
Table 8.5 shows the register information in repeat mode, and figure 8.7 shows the memory
mapping in repeat mode.
Table 8.5
Register Information in Repeat Mode
Name
Abbreviation
DTC source address register
SAR
Designates source address
DTC destination address
register
DAR
Designates destination address
DTC transfer count register AH
CRAH
Holds number of transfers
DTC transfer count register AL
CRAL
Designates transfer count
DTC transfer count register B
CRB
Not used
SAR
or
DAR
Function
Repeat area
Transfer
DAR
or
SAR
Figure 8.7 Memory Mapping in Repeat Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 219 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.5.3
Block Transfer Mode
In block transfer mode, one operation transfers one block of data. Either the transfer source or the
transfer destination is designated as a block area. The block size is 1 to 256. When the transfer of
one block ends, the initial state of the block size counter and the address register specified as the
block area is restored. The other address register is then incremented, decremented, or left fixed.
From 1 to 65,536 transfers can be specified. Once the specified number of transfers have ended, a
CPU interrupt is requested.
Table 8.6 shows the register information in block transfer mode, and figure 8.8 shows the memory
mapping in block transfer mode.
Table 8.6
Register Information in Block Transfer Mode
Name
Abbreviation
Function
DTC source address register
SAR
Designates source address
DTC destination address
register
DAR
Designates destination address
DTC transfer count register AH
CRAH
Holds block size
DTC transfer count register AL
CRAL
Designates block size count
DTC transfer count register B
CRB
Transfer count
First block
SAR
or
DAR
.
.
.
DAR
or
SAR
Block area
Transfer
Nth block
Figure 8.8 Memory Mapping in Block Transfer Mode
Page 220 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
8.5.4
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Chain Transfer
Setting the CHNE bit to 1 enables a number of data transfers to be performed consecutively in
response to a single transfer request. SAR, DAR, CRA, CRB, MRA, and MRB, which define data
transfers, can be set respectively.
Figure 8.9 shows the memory map for chain transfer. When activated, the DTC reads the register
information start address stored at the vector address, and then reads the first register information
at that start address. After the data transfer, the CHNE bit will be tested. When it has been set to 1,
DTC reads next register information located in a consecutive area and performs the data transfer.
These sequences are repeated until the CHNE bit is cleared to 0.
In the case of transfer with CHNE set to 1, an interrupt request to the CPU is not generated at the
end of the specified number of transfers or by setting of the DISEL bit to 1, and the interrupt
source flag for the activation source is not affected.
Source
Destination
Register information
CHNE = 1
DTC vector
address
Register information
start address
Register information
CHNE = 0
Source
Destination
Figure 8.9 Chain Transfer Memory Map
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 221 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.5.5
Interrupts
An interrupt request is issued to the CPU when the DTC finishes the specified number of data
transfers, or a data transfer for which the DISEL bit was set to 1. In the case of interrupt activation,
the interrupt set as the activation source is generated. These interrupts to the CPU are subject to
CPU mask level and interrupt controller priority level control.
In the case of activation by software, a software activated data transfer end interrupt (SWDTEND)
is generated. When the DISEL bit is 1 and one data transfer has ended, or the specified number of
transfers have ended, after data transfer ends, the SWDTE bit is held at 1 and an SWDTEND
interrupt is generated. The interrupt handling routine should clear the SWDTE bit to 0.
When the DTC is activated by software, an SWDTEND interrupt is not generated during a data
transfer wait or during data transfer even if the SWDTE bit is set to 1.
8.5.6
Operation Timing
Figures 8.10 to 8.12 show the DTC operation timing.
φ
DTC activation
request
DTC
request
Vector read
Data transfer
Address
Read Write
Transfer
information read
Transfer
information write
Figure 8.10 DTC Operation Timing (Example in Normal Mode or Repeat Mode)
Page 222 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
φ
DTC activation
request
DTC
request
Data transfer
Vector read
Read Write Read Write
Address
Transfer
information read
Transfer
information write
Figure 8.11 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Block Transfer Mode,
with Block Size of 2)
φ
DTC activation
request
DTC
request
Data transfer
Data transfer
Read Write
Read Write
Vector read
Address
Transfer
information read
Transfer
information
write
Transfer
information
read
Transfer
information write
Figure 8.12 DTC Operation Timing (Example of Chain Transfer)
8.5.7
Number of DTC Execution States
Table 8.7 lists execution status for a single DTC data transfer, and table 8.8 shows the number of
states required for each execution status.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 223 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Table 8.7
DTC Execution Status
Vector Read
Register
information
Read/Write
Data read
Data Write
Internal
Operations
Mode
I
J
K
L
M
Normal
1
6
1
1
3
Repeat
1
6
1
1
3
Block transfer
1
6
N
N
3
Legend:
N: Block size (initial setting of CRAH and CRAL)
Table 8.8
Number of States Required for Each Execution Status
On- OnOn-Chip I/O
Chip Chip
Registers
RAM ROM
Object to be Accessed
External Devices
Bus width
32
16
8
16
Access states
1
1
2
2
2
3
2
3
SI
—
1
—
—
4
6 + 2m
2
3+m
Register information
read/write
SJ
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Byte data read
SK
1
1
2
2
2
3+m
2
3+m
Word data read
SK
1
1
4
2
4
6 + 2m
2
3+m
Byte data write
SL
1
1
2
2
2
3+m
2
3+m
Word data write
SL
1
1
4
2
4
6 + 2m
2
3+m
Internal operation
SM
Execution
status
Vector read
8
16
1
Legend:
m: Number of wait states in an external device access
The number of execution states is calculated from the formula below. Note that Σ means the sum
of all transfers activated by one activation event (the number in which the CHNE bit is set to 1,
plus 1).
Number of execution states = I · S I + Σ (J · S J + K · S K + L · S L ) + M · S M
For example, when the DTC vector address table is located in on-chip ROM, normal mode is set,
and data is transferred from the on-chip ROM to an internal I/O register, the time required for the
DTC operation is 13 states. The time from activation to the end of the data write is 10 states.
Page 224 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
8.6
Procedures for Using DTC
8.6.1
Activation by Interrupt
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
The procedure for using the DTC with interrupt activation is as follows:
1. Set the MRA, MRB, SAR, DAR, CRA, and CRB register information in the on-chip RAM.
2. Set the start address of the register information in the DTC vector address.
3. Set the corresponding bit in DTCER to 1.
4. Set the enable bits for the interrupt sources to be used as the activation sources to 1. The DTC
is activated when an interrupt used as an activation source is generated.
5. After the end of one data transfer, or after the specified number of data transfers have ended,
the DTCE bit is cleared to 0 and a CPU interrupt is requested. If the DTC is to continue
transferring data, set the DTCE bit to 1.
8.6.2
Activation by Software
The procedure for using the DTC with software activation is as follows:
1. Set the MRA, MRB, SAR, DAR, CRA, and CRB register information in the on-chip RAM.
2. Set the start address of the register information in the DTC vector address.
3. Check that the SWDTE bit is 0.
4. Write 1 to SWDTE bit and the vector number to DTVECR.
5. Check the vector number written to DTVECR.
6. After the end of one data transfer, if the DISEL bit is 0 and a CPU interrupt is not requested,
the SWDTE bit is cleared to 0. If the DTC is to continue transferring data, set the SWDTE bit
to 1. When the DISEL bit is 1, or after the specified number of data transfers have ended, the
SWDTE bit is held at 1 and a CPU interrupt is requested.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 225 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
8.7
Examples of Use of the DTC
8.7.1
Normal Mode
An example is shown in which the DTC is used to receive 128 bytes of data via the SCI.
1. Set MRA to fixed source address (SM1 = SM0 = 0), incrementing destination address (DM1 =
1, DM0 = 0), normal mode (MD1 = MD0 = 0), and byte size (Sz = 0). The DTS bit can have
any value. Set MRB for one data transfer by one interrupt (CHNE = 0, DISEL = 0). Set the
SCI RDR address in SAR, the start address of the RAM area where the data will be received in
DAR, and 128 (H'0080) in CRA. CRB can be set to any value.
2. Set the start address of the register information at the DTC vector address.
3. Set the corresponding bit in DTCER to 1.
4. Set the SCI to the appropriate receive mode. Set the RIE bit in SCR to 1 to enable the reception
complete (RXI) interrupt. Since the generation of a receive error during the SCI reception
operation will disable subsequent reception, the CPU should be enabled to accept receive error
interrupts.
5. Each time reception of one byte of data ends on the SCI, the RDRF flag in SSR is set to 1, an
RXI interrupt is generated, and the DTC is activated. The receive data is transferred from RDR
to RAM by the DTC. DAR is incremented and CRA is decremented. The RDRF flag is
automatically cleared to 0.
6. When CRA becomes 0 after the 128 data transfers have ended, the RDRF flag is held at 1, the
DTCE bit is cleared to 0, and an RXI interrupt request is sent to the CPU. The interrupt
handling routine should perform wrap-up processing.
8.7.2
Software Activation
An example is shown in which the DTC is used to transfer a block of 128 bytes of data by means
of software activation. The transfer source address is H'1000 and the destination address is
H'2000. The vector number is H'60, so the vector address is H'04C0.
1. Set MRA to incrementing source address (SM1 = 1, SM0 = 0), incrementing destination
address (DM1 = 1, DM0 = 0), block transfer mode (MD1 = 1, MD0 = 0), and byte size (Sz =
0). The DTS bit can have any value. Set MRB for one block transfer by one interrupt (CHNE =
0). Set the transfer source address (H'1000) in SAR, the destination address (H'2000) in DAR,
and 128 (H'8080) in CRA. Set 1 (H'0001) in CRB.
2. Set the start address of the register information at the DTC vector address (H'04C0).
3. Check that the SWDTE bit in DTVECR is 0. Check that there is currently no transfer activated
by software.
Page 226 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
4. Write 1 to the SWDTE bit and the vector number (H'60) to DTVECR. The write data is H'E0.
5. Read DTVECR again and check that it is set to the vector number (H'60). If it is not, this
indicates that the write failed. This is presumably because an interrupt occurred between steps
3 and 4 and led to a different software activation. To activate this transfer, go back to step 3.
6. If the write was successful, the DTC is activated and a block of 128 bytes of data is transferred.
7. After the transfer, an SWDTEND interrupt occurs. The interrupt handling routine should clear
the SWDTE bit to 0 and perform other wrap-up processing.
8.8
Usage Notes
8.8.1
Module Stop
DTC operation can be prohibited or enabled using the module stop control register. Access to the
register is prohibited in the module stop mode. However, the module stop mode cannot be
specified while the DTC is operating. For details, see section 22, Power-Down Modes.
8.8.2
On-Chip RAM
The MRA, MRB, SAR, DAR, CRA, and CRB registers are all located in on-chip RAM. When the
DTC is used, the RAME bit in SYSCR must not be cleared to 0.
8.8.3
DTCE Bit Setting
For DTCE bit setting, use bit manipulation instructions such as BSET and BCLR. If all interrupts
are masked, multiple activation sources can be set at one time (only at the initial setting) by
writing data after executing a dummy read on the relevant register.
8.8.4
DMAC Transfer End Interrupt
When DTC transfer is activated by a DMAC transfer end interrupt, the DMAC’s DTE bit is not
subject to DTC control, regardless of the transfer counter and DISEL bit, and the write data has
priority. Consequently, an interrupt request is not sent to the CPU when the DTC transfer counter
reaches 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 227 of 846
Section 8 Data Transfer Controller (DTC)
Page 228 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.1 summarizes the port functions. The pins of each port also have other functions such as
input/output or external interrupt input pins of on-chip peripheral modules. Each I/O port includes
a data direction register (DDR) that controls input/output, a data register (DR) that stores output
data, and a port register (PORT) used to read the pin states. The input-only ports do not have a DR
and a DDR.
Ports A to E have a built-in pull-up MOS function and a input pull-up MOS control register (PCR)
to control the on/off state of input pull-up MOS.
Ports 3 and A include an open-drain control register (ODR) that controls the on/off state of the
output buffer PMOS.
All the I/O ports can drive a single TTL load and 30 pF capacitive load.
Table 9.1
Port Functions (1)
Port
Description
Modes 4 and 5
Port 1
General I/O port
also functioning
as TPU I/O pins,
interrupt input
pins, and external
USB transceiver
I/O
P17/TIOCB2/TCLKD/OE
P16/TIOCA2/IRQ1
P15/TIOCB1/TCLKC/FSE0
P13/TIOCD0/TCLKB
P12/TIOCC0/TCLKA/A22/RCV
P12/TIOCC0/TCLKA
P11/TIOCB0/A21/VP
P11/TIOCB0
P10/TIOCA0/A20/VM
P10/TIOCA0
P36
P35/SCK1/IRQ5
P34/RxD1
P33/TxD1
P32/SCK0/IRQ4
P31/RxD0
P30/TxD0
Port 4
General I/O port P43/AN3
also functioning P42/AN2
as A/D converter
P41/AN1
analog inputs
P40/AN0
Open-drain
output
Schmitt
triggered input
(IRQ5, IRQ4)
The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Input/Output
Type
P17/TIOCB2/TCLKD Schmitt
triggered input
(IRQ1, IRQ0)
P15/TIOCB1/TCLKC
P13/TIOCD0/TCLKB/A23/VPO
General I/O port
also functioning
as SCI_0, SCI_1
pins and interrupt
input pins
*
Mode 7*
P14/TIOCA1/IRQ0
Port 3
Note:
Mode 6
Page 229 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.1
Port Functions (2)
Port
Description
Modes 4 and 5
Port 7
General I/O port
also functioning
as bus control
output pins,
manual reset
input pin, and 8bit timer I/O
P74/MRES
P73/TMO1/CS7
P72/TMO0/CS6*2
Mode 6
P71/CS5
P70/TMRI01/TMCI01/CS4
Port 9
General I/O port P97/AN15/DA1
also functioning P96/AN14/DA0
as D/A converter
analog outputs
and A/D
converter analog
input
Port A
General I/O port
also functioning
as SCI_2 I/O
pins, address
output pins, and
external USB
transceiver output
Port B
General I/O port PB7/A15
also functioning PB6/A14
as address output PB5/A13
pins
PB4/A12
PB3/A11
PB2/A10
PB1/A9
PB0/A8
Port C
General I/O port A7
also functioning
as address output
A6
pins
P74/MRES
P73/TMO1
P72/TMO0
P71
P70/TMRI01/TMCI01
PA3/SCK2
PA2/RxD2
PA1/TxD2
PA0
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
Open-drain
output
PB7
PB6
PB5
PB4
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
When DDR = 0: PC7
When DDR = 1: A7*2
PC7
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
When DDR = 0: PC6
When DDR = 1: A6*2
PC6
When DDR = 0: PC5
When DDR = 1: A5*2
PC5
PA3/A19/SCK2/SUSPND
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA1/A17/TxD2
PA0/A16
A5
Input/Output
Type
Mode 7*1
Notes: 1. The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
2. CS6 and A7 to A0 should be designated as an output when on-chip USB is used in
mode 6.
Page 230 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Table 9.1
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port Functions (3)
Mode 6
Mode 7*1
General I/O port A4
also functioning
as address output
A3
pins
When DDR = 0: PC4
When DDR = 1: A4*2
PC4
When DDR = 0: PC3
When DDR = 1: A3*2
PC3
A2
When DDR = 0: PC2
When DDR = 1: A2*2
PC2
A1
When DDR = 0: PC1
When DDR = 1: A1*2
PC1
A0
When DDR = 0: PC0
When DDR = 1: A0*2
PC0
Port
Description
Port C
Port D
Port E
General I/O port
also functioning
as data I/O pins
Modes 4 and 5
D15
PD7
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
General I/O port 8-bit bus mode: PE7
also functioning 16-bit bus mode: D7
as address output
8-bit bus mode: PE6
pins
16-bit bus mode: D6
PE7
8-bit bus mode: PE5
16-bit bus mode: D5
PE5
8-bit bus mode: PE4
16-bit bus mode: D5
PE4
8-bit bus mode: PE3
PE3
Input/Output
Type
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
PE6
16-bit bus mode: D3
8-bit bus mode: PE2
16-bit bus mode: D2
PE2
Notes: 1. The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
2. CS6 and A7 to A0 should be designated as an output when on-chip USB is used in
mode 6.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 231 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.1
Port Functions (4)
Port
Description
Port E
General I/O port 8-bit bus mode: PE1
also functioning 16-bit bus mode: D1
as address output
8-bit bus mode: PE0
pins
16-bit bus mode: D0
Port F
General I/O port
also functioning
as interrupt input
pins and bus
control I/O pins
Port G
General I/O port
also functioning
as bus control
input pins and
interrupt Input
pins
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 6
Input/Output
Type
Mode 7*
PE1
Built-in input
pull-up MOS
PE0
When DDR = 0: PF7
When DDR = 1 (after
reset): φ
When DDR = 0
(after reset): PF7
When DDR = 1: φ
AS
PF6
RD
PF5
HWR
PF4
8-bit bus mode:
PF3/ADTRG/IRQ3
16-bit bus mode: LWR
PF3/ADTRG/IRQ3
When WAITE = 0
(after reset) : PF2
When WAITE = 1:
WAIT
PF2
When BRLE = 0
(after reset): PF1
When BRLE = 1:
BACK
PF1
When BRLE = 0
(after reset): PF0/IRQ2
When BRLE = 1:
BREQ/IRQ2
PF0/IRQ2
When DDR = 0 (after reset in mode 6):
PG4
PG4
When DDR = 1 (after reset in modes 4, 5):
CS0
When DDR = 0: PG3
When DDR = 1: CS1
PG3
When DDR = 0: PG2
PG2
Schmitt
triggered input
(IRQ3, IRQ2)
Schmitt
triggered input
(IRQ7)
When DDR = 1: CS2
When DDR = 0: PG1/IRQ7
When DDR = 1: CS3/IRQ7
PG1/IRQ7
PG0
Note:
*
The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
Page 232 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.1
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port 1
Port 1 is an 8-bit I/O port. The port 1 has the following registers.
• Port 1 data direction register (P1DDR)
• Port 1 data register (P1DR)
• Port 1 register (PORT1)
9.1.1
Port 1 Data Direction Register (P1DDR)
P1DDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify input or output for the
pins of port 1. Since this is a write-only register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used
to write to it. For details, see section 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
P17DDR
0
W
6
P16DDR
0
W
5
P15DDR
0
W
4
P14DDR
0
W
3
P13DDR
0
W
Modes 4 to 6
If address output is enabled by the setting of bits AE3 to
AE0 in PFCR, pins P13 to P10 are address outputs. Pins
P17 to P14, and pins P13 to P10 when address output is
disabled, are output ports when the corresponding
P1DDR bits are set to 1, and input ports when the
corresponding P1DDR bits are cleared to 0.
2
P12DDR
0
W
1
P11DDR
0
W
0
P10DDR
0
W
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Mode 7
Setting a P1DDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port 1
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
Page 233 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.1.2
Port 1 Data Register (P1DR)
P1DR stores output data for the port 1 pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
P17DR
0
R/W
6
P16DR
0
R/W
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
5
P15DR
0
R/W
4
P14DR
0
R/W
3
P13DR
0
R/W
2
P12DR
0
R/W
1
P11DR
0
R/W
0
P10DR
0
R/W
9.1.3
Port 1 Register (PORT1)
PORT1 shows the pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
P17
R
P16
⎯*
⎯*
P15
⎯*
If a port 1 read is performed while P1DDR bits are set to
1, the P1DR value is read. If a port 1 read is performed
while P1DDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read.
6
R
4
P14
⎯*
R
3
P13
R
2
P12
⎯*
⎯*
P11
⎯*
R
P10
⎯*
R
5
1
0
Note:
*
R
R
Determined by the states of pins P17 to P10.
Page 234 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.1.4
Section 9 I/O Ports
Pin Functions
Port 1 pins also function as TPU I/O pins, external interrupt input pins (IRQ1, IRQ0), external
USB transceiver input, and address bus (A23 to A20) output pins. The correspondence between
the register specification and the pin functions is shown below.
Table 9.2
P17 Pin Function
FADSEL in UCTLR*
3
TPU Channel 2 Setting*
1
Output
P17DDR
Pin function
0
1
Input or Initial Value
—
—
0
1
—
TIOCB2 output
P17 input
P17 output
3
OE output*
TIOCB2 input
TCLKD input
Table 9.3
P16 Pin Function
TPU Channel 2 Setting*
P16DDR
Pin function
1
Output
Input or Initial Value
—
0
1
TIOCA2 output
P16 input
P16 output
TIOCA2 input
IRQ1 input*
2
Notes: 1. For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse
Unit (TPU).
2. When used as an external interrupt pin, do not use for another functions.
3. The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 235 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.4
P15 Pin Function
FADSEL in UCTLR*
3
1
TPU Channel 1 Setting*
Output
P15DDR
Pin function
0
1
Input or Initial Value
—
—
0
1
—
TIOCB1 output
P15 input
P15 output
FSE0 output*
3
TIOCB1 input
TCLKC input
Table 9.5
P14 Pin Function
TPU Channel 1 Setting*
1
Output
P14DDR
Pin function
Input or Initial Value
—
0
1
TIOCA1 output
P14 input
P14 output
TIOCA1 input
2
*
IRQ0 input
Notes: 1. For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse
Unit (TPU).
2. When used as an external interrupt pin, do not use for another functions.
3. On-chip USB cannot be used in mode 7.
Table 9.6
AE3 to AE0*
P13 Pin Function
1
FADSEL in UCTLR*
Other than B'1111
3
TPU Channel 0 Setting*
P13DDR
Pin function
0
2
Output
Input or Initial Value
B'1111
1
—
—
—
—
0
1
—
—
TIOCD0
output
P13 input
P13 output
VPO
3
output*
A23 output
TIOCD0 input
TCLKB input
Notes: 1. Valid in modes 4 to 6.
2. For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse
Unit (TPU).
3. The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
Page 236 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Table 9.7
AE3 to AE0*
Section 9 I/O Ports
P12 Pin Function
1
Other than B'1111
3
FADSEL in UCTLR*
0
2
TPU Channel 0 Setting*
Output
P12DDR
—
Pin function
TIOCC0
output
Input or Initial Value
0
P12 input
B'1111
1
—
—
—
1
—
P12 output
RCV input*
—
3
A22 output
TIOCC0 input
TCLKA input
Table 9.8
AE3 to AE0*
P11 Pin Function
1
Other than (B'1110 to B'1111)
3
FADSEL in UCTLR*
0
2
TPU Channel 0 Setting*
Output
P11DDR
—
Pin function
TIOCB0
output
Table 9.9
AE3 to AE0*
1
—
—
—
1
—
—
P11 output
3
VP input*
A21 output
Input or Initial Value
0
P11 input
B'1110 to
B'1111
TIOCB0 input
P10 Pin Function
1
FADSEL in UCTLR*
Other than (B'1101 to B'1111)
3
0
TPU Channel 0 Setting*
2
P10DDR
Pin function
Output
Input or Initial Value
B'1101 to
B'1111
1
—
—
—
—
0
1
—
—
TIOCA0
output
P10 input
P10 output
VM input
A20 output
TIOCA0 input
Notes: 1. Valid in modes 4 to 6.
2. For details on the TPU channel specification, refer to section 10, 16-Bit Timer Pulse
Unit (TPU).
3. The USB may be unusable in mode 7 in some cases. See section 3, MCU Operating
Modes, for details.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 237 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.2
Port 3
Port 3 is a 7-bit I/O port also functioning as SCI I/O and external interrupt input (IRQ4, IRQ5).
• Port 3 data direction register (P3DDR)
• Port 3 data register (P3DR)
• Port 3 register (PORT3)
• Port 3 open-drain control register (P3ODR)
9.2.1
Port 3 Data Direction Register (P3DDR)
The individual bits of P3DDR specify input or output for the pins of port 3. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
—
—
Reserved
Undefined
This bit is undefined and cannot be modified.
6
P36DDR
0
W
5
P35DDR
0
W
4
P34DDR
0
W
3
P33DDR
0
W
2
P32DDR
0
W
1
P31DDR
0
W
0
P30DDR
0
W
Page 238 of 846
Setting a P3DDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port 3
pin an output pin, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the pin
an input pin.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.2.2
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port 3 Data Register (P3DR)
P3DR stores output data for the port 3 pins (P36 to P30).
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
—
—
Reserved
Undefined
This bit is undefined and cannot be modified.
6
P36DR
0
R/W
5
P35DR
0
R/W
4
P34DR
0
R/W
3
P33DR
0
R/W
2
P32DR
0
R/W
1
P31DR
0
R/W
0
P30DR
0
R/W
9.2.3
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
Port 3 Register (PORT3)
PORT3 shows the pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
—
—
Reserved
Undefined
This bit is undefined.
6
P36
—*
R
5
P35
—*
R
4
P34
—*
R
3
P33
—*
R
2
P32
—*
R
1
P31
R
0
P30
—*
—*
Note:
*
R
Determined by the state of pins P36 to P30.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
If a port 3 read is performed while P3DDR bits are set to
1, the P3DR values are read. If a port 3 read is performed
while P3DDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read.
Page 239 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.2.4
Port 3 Open-Drain Control Register (P3ODR)
P3ODR controls the PMOS on/off status for each port 3 pin (P36 to P30).
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
—
—
Reserved
Undefined
This bit is undefined and cannot be modified.
6
P36ODR
0
R/W
5
P35ODR
0
R/W
4
P34ODR
0
R/W
3
P33ODR
0
R/W
2
P32ODR
0
R/W
1
P31ODR
0
R/W
0
P30ODR
0
R/W
9.2.5
Setting a P3ODR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port 3
pin an NMOS open-drain output pin, while clearing the bit
to 0 makes the pin a CMOS output pin.
Pin Functions
Port 3 pins also function as SCI I/O pins and external interrupt input pins (IRQ4, IRQ5). Port 3 pin
functions are shown below.
Table 9.10 P36 Pin Function
P36DDR
Pin function
Page 240 of 846
0
1
P36 input
P36 output
(USB D+ pull-up control output
in HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU, HD64F2215CU)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.11 P35 Pin Function
CKE1 in SCR_1
0
C/A in SMR_1
1
0
CKE0 in SCR_1
0
P35DDR
0
Pin function
1
P35 input
1
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
P35 output* SCK1 output* SCK1 output* SCK1 input
1
IRQ5 input*
2
2
2
Notes: 1. When used as an external interrupt pin, do not use for another function.
2. Note on Development Using the E6000 Emulator
2
The H8S/2215 Group does not have an I C bus function and pins 35 and 34 are used
for CMOS output (except when P35ODR and P34ODR are set to 1). The E6000
emulator expects pins 35 and 34 to be used for NMOS push-pull output, which differs
from the pin output characteristics of the H8S/2215 Group. If it is necessary to use pins
35 and 34 for CMOS output, an appropriate resistance should be used for pull-up when
using the H8S/2215 with the E6000.
Table 9.12 P34 Pin Function
RE in SCR_1
0
P34DDR
Pin function
Note:
*
1
0
1
—
P34 input
P34 output*
RxD1 input
Note on Development Using the E6000 Emulator
2
The H8S/2215 Group does not have an I C bus function and pins 35 and 34 are used
for CMOS output (except when P35ODR and P34ODR are set to 1). The E6000
emulator expects pins 35 and 34 to be used for NMOS push-pull output, which differs
from the pin output characteristics of the H8S/2215 Group. If it is necessary to use pins
35 and 34 for CMOS output, an appropriate resistance should be used for pull-up when
using the H8S/2215 with the E6000.
Table 9.13 P33 Pin Function
SMIF in SCMR_1
0
TE in SCR_1
P33DDR
Pin function
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
—
0
1
0
1
P33
input
P33
output
TxD1
output
P33
input
Setting
prohibited
TxD1
output
Setting
prohibited
Page 241 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.14 P32 Pin Function
CKE1 in SCR_0
0
C/A in SMR_0
0
CKE0 in SCR_0
Pin function
*
1
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
0
P32DDR
Note:
1
0
1
P32 input
P32 output
SCK0 output SCK0 output
IRQ4 input*
SCK0 input
When used as an external interrupt pin, do not use for another function.
Table 9.15 P31 Pin Function
RE in SCR_0
0
P31DDR
Pin function
1
0
1
—
P31 input
P31 output
RxD0 input
Table 9.16 P30 Pin Function
SMIF in SCMR_0
0
TE in SCR_0
P30DDR
Pin function
Page 242 of 846
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
—
0
1
0
1
P30
input
P30
output
TxD0
output
P30
input
Setting
prohibited
TxD0
output
Setting
prohibited
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.3
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port 4
Port 4 is a 4-bit I/O port also functioning as A/D converter analog input. Port 4 has the following
register.
• Port 4 register (PORT4)
9.3.1
Port 4 Register (PORT4)
PORT4 shows port 4 pin states. PORT4 cannot be modified.
Bit
Bit
Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
Undefined
—
Reserved
3
P43
R
2
P41
—*
—*
1
P41
R
0
P40
—*
—*
Note:
9.3.2
These bits are undefined.
R
The pin states are always read when a port 4 read is
performed.
R
Determined by the states of pins P43 to P40.
*
Pin Function
Port 4 also functions as A/D converter analog input (AN3 to AN0).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 243 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.4
Port 7
Port 7 is a 5-bit I/O port also functioning as bus control output, manual reset input, and 8-bit timer
I/O. Port 7 has the following registers.
• Port 7 data direction register (P7DDR)
• Port 7 data register (P7DR)
• Port 7 register (PORT7)
9.4.1
Port 7 Data Direction Register (P7DDR)
P7DDR is an 8-bit write-only register, the individual bits of which specify input or output for the
pins of port 7. P7DDR cannot be read; if it is, an undefined value will be read. Since this is a
write-only register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see
section 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
—
—
Reserved
4
P74DDR
0
W
3
P73DDR
0
W
2
P72DDR
0
W
1
P71DDR
0
W
0
P70DDR
0
W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
Page 244 of 846
Setting a P7DDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port 7
pin an output pin, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the pin
an input pin.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.4.2
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port 7 Data Register (P7DR)
P7DR stores output data for the port 7 pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
—
—
Reserved
4
P74DR
0
R/W
3
P73DR
0
R/W
2
P72DR
0
R/W
1
P71DR
0
R/W
0
P70DR
0
R/W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
9.4.3
Stores output data for the port 7 pins.
Port 7 Register (PORT7)
PORT7 shows the pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
—
Undefined
—
Reserved
P74
—*
R
P73
—*
R
P72
—*
R
1
P71
R
0
P70
—*
—*
4
3
2
Note:
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
*
R
Determined by the state of pins P74 to P70.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
If a port 7 read is performed while P7DDR bits are set to
1, the P7DR values are read. If a port 7 read is performed
while P7DDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are read.
Page 245 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.4.4
Pin Functions
Port 7 pins also function as bus control output pins, manual reset input pin, and 8 bit timer
input/output. Port 7 pin functions are shown below.
Table 9.17 P74 Pin Function
MRESE
0
P74DDR
Pin function
1
0
1
—
P74 input
P74 output
MRES input
Table 9.18 P73 Pin Function
Operating Mode
OS3 to OS0 in
TCSR_1
P73DDR
Modes 4 to 6
OS3 to OS0 are all 0
0
Pin function
Mode 7
At least one
of OS3 to
OS0 is 1
1
—
OS3 to OS0 are all 0
0
At least one
of OS3 to
OS0 is 1
1
—
P73 input CS7 output TMO1 output P73 input P73 output TMO1 output
Table 9.19 P72 Pin Function
Modes 4 to 6*
Operating Mode
OS3 to OS0 in
TCSR_0
P72DDR
0
Pin function
Note:
*
OS3 to OS0 are all 0s
Mode 7
At least
one of OS3
to OS0 is 1
1
P72 input CS6 output
OS3 to OS0 are all 0
At least one
of OS3 to
OS0 is 1
—
0
1
—
TMO0
output
P72 input
P72output
TMO0
output
When on-chip USB is used in modes 4 to 6, bit P72DDR should be set to 1 so that the
pin outputs CS6.
Table 9.20 P71 Pin Function
Operating Mode
P71DDR
Pin function
Page 246 of 846
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
0
1
0
1
P71 input
CS5 output
P71 input
P71 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.21 P70 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
P70DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
0
1
0
1
P70 input
CS4 output
P70 input
P70 output
TMRI01, TMCI01 input
9.5
Port 9
Port 9 pins also function as A/D converter analog input and D/A converter analog output pins. The
port 9 has the following register.
• Port 9 register (PORT9)
9.5.1
Port 9 Register (PORT9)
PORT9 shows port 9 pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
7
P97
6
P96
—*
—*
5 to
0
—
Undefined
Note:
9.5.2
R/W
Description
R
The pin states are always read when a port 9 read is
performed.
—
R
Reserved
These bits are undefined.
Determined by the states of pins P97 and P96.
*
Pin Function
Port 9 also functions as A/D converter analog input (AN15, AN14) and D/A converter analog
output (DA1, DA0).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 247 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.6
Port A
Port A is a 4-bit I/O port that also functions as address bus (A19 to A16) output, external USB
transceiver output, and SCI_2 I/O, and interrupt input. The port A has the following registers.
• Port A data direction register (PADDR)
• Port A data register (PADR)
• Port A register (PORTA)
• Port A pull-up MOS control register (PAPCR)
• Port A open-drain control register (PAODR)
9.6.1
Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR)
The individual bits of PADDR specify input or output for the pins of port A. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
—
Reserved
3
PA3DDR 0
W
2
PA2DDR 0
W
1
PA1DDR 0
W
0
PA0DDR 0
W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
Modes 4 to 6
If address output is enabled by the setting of bits AE3 to
AE0 in PFCR, the corresponding port A pins are address
outputs. When address output is disabled, setting a
PADDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port A pin an
output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the pin an
input port.
Mode 7
Setting a PADDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port A
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
Page 248 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.6.2
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port A Data Register (PADR)
PADR stores output data for the port A pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
—
Reserved
3
PA3DR
0
R/W
2
PA2DR
0
R/W
1
PA1DR
0
R/W
0
PA0DR
0
R/W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
9.6.3
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
Port A Register (PORTA)
PORTA shows port A pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
—
Reserved
3
PA3
—*
R
2
PA2
—*
R
1
PA1
—*
R
0
PA0
—*
R
Note:
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
*
Determined by the states of pins PA3 to PA0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
If a port A read is performed while PADDR bits are set to
1, the PADR values are read. If a port A read is performed
while PADDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are
read.
Page 249 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.6.4
Port A MOS Pull-Up Control Register (PAPCR)
PAPCR controls the function of the port A input pull-up MOS. PAPCR is valid for port input and
SCI input pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
—
Reserved
3
PA3PCR* 0
R/W
2
PA2PCR
0
R/W
1
PA1PCR
0
R/W
0
PA0PCR
0
R/W
Note:
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
*
9.6.5
When a pin function is specified to an input port, setting
the corresponding bit to 1 turns on the input pull-up MOS
for that pin.
Set PA3PCR to 0 when FADSEL of USB is 1.
Port A Open Drain Control Register (PAODR)
PAODR specifies an output type of port A. PAODR is valid for port output and SCI output pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
—
—
Reserved
3
PA3ODR 0
R/W
2
PA2ODR 0
R/W
1
PA1ODR 0
R/W
0
PA0ODR 0
R/W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
Page 250 of 846
Setting a PAODR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port A
pin an NMOS open-drain output pin, while clearing the bit
to 0 makes the pin a CMOS output pin.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.6.6
Section 9 I/O Ports
Pin Functions
Port A pins also function as address bus (A19 to A16) output, external USB transceiver output,
SCI_2 I/O, and interrupt input. The correspondence between the register specification and the pin
functions is shown below.
Table 9.22 PA3 Pin Function
Operating mode
Modes 4 to 6
AE3 to AE0
11xx
Other than 11xx
FADSEL of UCTLR
—
CKE1 in SCR_2
—
C/A in SMR_2
—
CKE0 in SCR_2
—
PA3DDR
—
0
A19 output
PA3
input
Pin function
0
0
1
—
1
—
—
1
—
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
PA3
output
SCK2
output
SCK2
output
SCK2
input
SUSPND
output
0
0
Operating mode
Mode 7
AE3 to AE0
—
FADSEL of UCTLR*
0
C/A in SMR_2
Note:
*
—
1
—
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
1
—
—
—
—
PA3
input
PA3
output
SCK2
output
SCK2
output
SCK2
input
SUSPND
output*
On-chip USB cannot be used in mode 7.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
1
0
CKE0 in SCR_2
Pin function
1*
0
CKE1 in SCR_2
PA3DDR
1
Page 251 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.23 PA2 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
Modes 4 to 6
1011 or
11xx
Mode 7
Other than 1011 or 11xx
RE in SCR_2
—
PA2DDR
—
0
1
—
0
1
—
A18
output
PA2 input
PA2
output
RxD2
input
PA2 input
PA2
output
RxD2
input
Pin function
0
—
1
0
1
Table 9.24 PA1 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
Modes 4 to 6
101x or
11xx
SMIF in SCMR_2
—
TE in SCR_2
—
PA1DDR
Pin function
Other than 101x or 11xx
0
1
0
1
—
0
1
—
0
1
0
1
PA1
input
PA1
output
TxD2
output
PA1
input
Setting
prohibited
TxD2
output
Setting
prohibited
Mode 7
SMIF in SCMR_2
0
TE in SCR_2
Pin function
1
A17
output
Operating mode
PA1DDR
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
—
0
1
0
1
PA1
input
PA1
output
TxD2
output
PA1
input
Setting
prohibited
TxD2
output
Setting
prohibited
Table 9.25 PA0 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
PA0DDR
Pin function
Page 252 of 846
Modes 4 to 6
Other than 0xxxx
or 1000
Mode 7
0xxx or 1000
—
—
0
1
0
1
PA16 output
PA0 input
PA0 output
PA0 input
PA0 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.6.7
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port A Input Pull-Up MOS Function
Port A has a built-in input pull-up MOS function that can be controlled by software. Input pull-up
MOS can be specified as on or off for individual bits.
Table 9.26 summarizes the input pull-up MOS states.
Table 9.26 Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port A)
Pins
Power-On
Reset
Address output, port
output, SCI output
Hardware
Standby
Mode
Manual
Reset
OFF
Port input, SCI input
Software
Standby
Mode
In Other
Operations
OFF
ON/OFF
Legend:
OFF:
Input pull-up MOS is always off.
ON/OFF: On when PADDR = 0 and PAPCR = 1; otherwise off.
9.7
Port B
Port B is an 8-bit I/O port that also has address bus (A15 to A8) output. The port B has the
following registers. Internal I/O Register.
• Port B data direction register (PBDDR)
• Port B data register (PBDR)
• Port B register (PORTB)
• Port B MOS pull-up control register (PBPCR)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 253 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.7.1
Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR)
The individual bits of PBDDR specify input or output for the pins of port B. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PB7DDR 0
W
6
PB6DDR 0
W
5
PB5DDR 0
W
4
PB4DDR 0
W
3
PB3DDR 0
W
Modes 4 to 6
If address output is enabled by the setting of bits AE3 to
AE0 in PFCR, the corresponding port B pins are address
outputs. When address output is disabled, setting a
PBDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port B pin an
output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the pin an
input port.
2
PB2DDR 0
W
1
PB1DDR 0
W
0
PB0DDR 0
W
9.7.2
Mode 7
Setting a PBDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port B
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
Port B Data Register (PBDR)
PBDR stores output data for the port B pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PB7DR
0
R/W
6
PB6DR
0
R/W
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
5
PB5DR
0
R/W
4
PB4DR
0
R/W
3
PB3DR
0
R/W
2
PB2DR
0
R/W
1
PB1DR
0
R/W
0
PB0DR
0
R/W
Page 254 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.7.3
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port B Register (PORTB)
PORTB shows port B pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PB7
—*
R
PB6
—*
R
5
PB5
—*
R
If the port B read is performed while PBDDR bits are set
to 1, the PBDR values are read. If a port B read is
performed while PBDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin
states are read.
6
4
PB4
—*
R
3
PB3
—*
R
2
PB2
—*
R
1
PB1
R
0
PB0
—*
—*
Note:
9.7.4
R
Determined by the status of pins PB7 to PB0.
*
Port B MOS Pull-Up Control Register (PBPCR)
PBPCR controls the on/off state of input pull-up MOS of port B.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PB7PCR
0
R/W
6
PB6PCR
0
R/W
When a pin functions specified to an input port, setting the
corresponding bit to 1 turns on the input pull-up MOS for
that pin.
5
PB5PCR
0
R/W
4
PB4PCR
0
R/W
3
PB3PCR
0
R/W
2
PB2PCR
0
R/W
1
PB1PCR
0
R/W
0
PB0PCR
0
R/W
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 255 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.7.5
Pin Functions
Port B pins also function as address bus (A15 to A9) output pins. The correspondence between the
register specification and the pin functions is shown below.
Table 9.27 PB7 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
PB7DDR
Pin function
Modes 4 to 6
B'1xxx
Mode 7
Other than B'1xxx
—
—
0
1
0
1
A15 output
PB7 input
PB7 output
PB7 input
PB7 output
Table 9.28 PB6 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
PB6DDR
Pin function
Modes 4 to 6
B'0111 or
B'1xxx
Mode 7
Other than B'0111 or B'1xxx
—
—
0
1
0
1
A14 output
PB6 input
PB6 output
PB6 input
PB6 output
Table 9.29 PB5 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
PB5DDR
Pin function
Modes 4 to 6
B'011x or
B'1xxx
Mode 7
Other than B'011x or B'1xxx
—
—
0
1
0
1
A13 output
PB5 input
PB5 output
PB5 input
PB5 output
Table 9.30 PB4 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
PB4DDR
Pin function
Page 256 of 846
Modes 4 to 6
Other than
B'0100 or
B'00xx
Mode 7
B'0100 or B'00xx
—
—
0
1
0
1
A12 output
PB4 input
PB4 output
PB4 input
PB4 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.31 PB3 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
Modes 4 to 6
Other than
B'00xx
PB3DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
B'00xx
—
—
0
1
0
1
A11 output
PB3 input
PB3 output
PB3 input
PB3 output
Table 9.32 PB2 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
Modes 4 to 6
Other than
B'0010 or
B'000x
PB2DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
B'0010 or B'000x
—
—
0
1
0
1
A10 output
PB2 input
PB2 output
PB2 input
PB2 output
Table 9.33 PB1 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
Modes 4 to 6
Other than
B'000x
PB1DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
B'000x
—
—
0
1
0
1
A9 output
PB1 input
PB1 output
PB1 input
PB1 output
Table 9.34 PB0 Pin Function
Operating mode
AE3 to AE0
Modes 4 to 6
Other than
B'0000
PB0DDR
Pin function
B'0000
—
0
0
1
0
1
A8 output
PB0 input
PB0 output
PB0 input
PB0 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Mode 7
Page 257 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.7.6
Port B Input Pull-Up MOS Function
Port B has a built-in input pull-up MOS function that can be controlled by software. Input pull-up
MOS can be specified as on or off for individual bits.
Table 9.35 summarizes the input pull-up MOS states.
Table 9.35 Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port B)
Pins
Power-On
Reset
Address output, port
output
Hardware
Standby
Mode
Manual
Reset
OFF
Port input
Software
Standby
Mode
In Other
Operations
OFF
ON/OFF
Legend:
OFF:
Input pull-up MOS is always off.
ON/OFF: On when PBDDR = 0 and PBPCR = 1; otherwise off.
9.8
Port C
Port C is an 8-bit I/O port that also has address bus (A7 to A0) output pins. The port C has the
following registers.
• Port C data direction register (PCDDR)
• Port C data register (PCDR)
• Port C register (PORTC)
• Port C pull-up MOS control register (PCPCR)
Note: When using the on-chip USB in mode 6, set PCDDR so that addresses A7 to A0 are
output from PC7 to PC0.
Page 258 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.8.1
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port C Data Direction Register (PCDDR)
The individual bits of PCDDR specify input or output for the pins of port C. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PC7DDR 0
W
6
PC6DDR 0
W
Modes 4 and 5
Port C pins are address outputs regardless of the PCDDR
settings.
5
PC5DDR 0
W
4
PC4DDR 0
W
3
PC3DDR 0
W
2
PC2DDR 0
W
1
PC1DDR 0
W
0
PC0DDR 0
W
9.8.2
Mode 6
Setting a PCDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port C
pin an address output, while clearing the bit to 0 makes
the pin an input port.
Mode 7
Setting a PCDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port C
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
Port C Data Register (PCDR)
PCDR stores output data for the port C pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PC7DR
0
R/W
6
PC6DR
0
R/W
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
5
PC5DR
0
R/W
4
PC4DR
0
R/W
3
PC3DR
0
R/W
2
PC2DR
0
R/W
1
PC1DR
0
R/W
0
PC0DR
0
R/W
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 259 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.8.3
Port C Register (PORTC)
PORTC shows port C pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PC7
—*
R
PC6
—*
R
5
PC5
—*
R
If a port C read is performed while PCDDR bits are set to
1, the PCDR values are read. If a port C read is
performed while PCDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin
states are read.
6
4
PC4
—*
R
3
PC3
—*
R
2
PC2
—*
R
1
PC1
R
0
PC0
—*
—*
Note:
9.8.4
*
R
Determined by the states of pins PC7 to PC0.
Port C Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PCPCR)
PCPCR controls the on/off state of input pull-up MOS of port C.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PC7PCR 0
R/W
6
PC6PCR 0
R/W
When a pin function is specified to an input port, setting
the corresponding bit to 1 turns on the input pull-up MOS
for that pin.
5
PC5PCR 0
R/W
4
PC4PCR 0
R/W
3
PC3PCR 0
R/W
2
PC2PCR 0
R/W
1
PC1PCR 0
R/W
0
PC0PCR 0
R/W
Page 260 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.8.5
Section 9 I/O Ports
Pin Functions
Port C pins also function as Address bus (A7 to A0) output. The correspondence between the
register specification and the pin functions is shown below.
Table 9.36 PC7 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC7DDR
Pin Function
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A7 output
PC7 input
A7 output
PC7 input
PC7 output
Table 9.37 PC6 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC6DDR
Pin Function
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A6 output
PC6 input
A6 output
PC6 input
PC6 output
Table 9.38 PC5 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC5DDR
Pin Function
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A5 output
PC5 input
A5 output
PC5 input
PC5 output
Table 9.39 PC4 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC4DDR
Pin Function
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A4 output
PC4 input
A4 output
PC4 input
PC4 output
Table 9.40 PC3 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC3DDR
Pin Function
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A3 output
PC3 input
A3 output
PC3 input
PC3 output
Page 261 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.41 PC2 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC2DDR
Pin Function
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A2 output
PC2 input
A2 output
PC2 input
PC2 output
Table 9.42 PC1 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC1DDR
Pin Function
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A1 output
PC1 input
A1 output
PC1 input
PC1 output
Table 9.43 PC0 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PC0DDR
Pin Function
Note:
*
Mode 6*
Modes 4 and 5
Mode 7
—
0
1
0
1
A0 output
PC0 input
A0 output
PC0 input
PC0 output
When on-chip USB is used in mode 6, bits PC7DDR to PC0DDR should be set to H'FF
so that the pins output A7 to A0.
Page 262 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.8.6
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port C Input Pull-Up MOS Function
Port C has a built-in input pull-up MOS function that can be controlled by software. Input pull-up
MOS can be used in modes 6 and 7, and can be specified as on or off for individual bits.
Table 9.44 summarizes the input pull-up MOS states.
Table 9.44 Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port C)
Pins
Power-On
Reset
Address output (modes 4
and 5), port output
(modes 6 and 7)
Hardware
Standby
Mode
Manual
Reset
OFF
Port input (modes 6 and
7)
Software
Standby
Mode
In Other
Operations
OFF
ON/OFF
Legend:
OFF:
Input pull-up MOS is always off.
ON/OFF: On when PCDDR = 0 and PCPCR = 1; otherwise off.
9.9
Port D
Port D is an 8-bit I/O port that also has data bus (D15 to D8) I/O. The port D has the following
registers.
• Port D data direction register (PDDDR)
• Port D data register (PDDR)
• Port D register (PORTD)
• Port D Pull-up MOS control register (PDPCR)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 263 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.9.1
Port D Data Direction Register (PDDDR)
The individual bits of PDDDR specify input or output for the pins of port D. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PD7DDR 0
W
6
PD6DDR 0
W
Modes 4 to 6
Port D pins automatically function as data input/output
pins.
5
PD5DDR 0
W
4
PD4DDR 0
W
3
PD3DDR 0
W
2
PD2DDR 0
W
1
PD1DDR 0
W
0
PD0DDR 0
W
9.9.2
Mode 7
Setting a PDDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port D
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
Port D Data Register (PDDR)
PDDR stores output data for the port D pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PD7DR
0
R/W
6
PD6DR
0
R/W
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose I/O output port.
5
PD5DR
0
R/W
4
PD4DR
0
R/W
3
PD3DR
0
R/W
2
PD2DR
0
R/W
1
PD1DR
0
R/W
0
PD0DR
0
R/W
Page 264 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.9.3
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port D Register (PORTD)
PORTD shows port D pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PD7
—*
R
PD6
—*
R
5
PD5
—*
R
If a port D read is performed while PDDDR bits are set to
1, the PDDR values are read. If a port D read is
performed while PDDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin
states are read.
6
4
PD4
—*
R
3
PD3
—*
R
2
PD2
—*
R
1
PD1
R
0
PD0
—*
—*
Note:
9.9.4
R
Determined by the states of pins PD7 to PD0.
*
Port D Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PDPCR)
PDPCR controls on/off states of the input pull-up MOS of port D.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PD7PCR 0
R/W
6
PD6PCR 0
R/W
When the pin is in its input state, the input pull-up MOS of
the input pin is on when the corresponding bit is set to 1.
5
PD5PCR 0
R/W
4
PD4PCR 0
R/W
3
PD3PCR 0
R/W
2
PD2PCR 0
R/W
1
PD1PCR 0
R/W
0
PD0PCR 0
R/W
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 265 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.9.5
Pin Functions
Port D pins also functions as data bus (D15 to D8) I/O. The correspondence between the register
specification and the pin functions in shown below.
Table 9.45 PD7 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PD7DDR
Pin Function
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
—
0
1
D15 input/output
PD7 input
PD7 output
Table 9.46 PD6 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PD6DDR
Pin Function
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
—
0
1
D14 input/output
PD6 input
PD6 output
Table 9.47 PD5 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PD5DDR
Pin Function
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
—
0
1
D13 input/output
PD5 input
PD5 output
Table 9.48 PD4 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PD4DDR
Pin Function
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
—
0
1
D12 input/output
PD4 input
PD4 output
Table 9.49 PD3 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PD3DDR
Pin Function
Page 266 of 846
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
—
0
1
D11 input/output
PD3 input
PD3 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.50 PD2 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PD2DDR
Pin Function
Mode 7
—
0
1
D10 input/output
PD2 input
PD2 output
Table 9.51 PD1 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PD1DDR
Pin Function
Mode 7
—
0
1
D9 input/output
PD1 input
PD1 output
Table 9.52 PD0 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PD0DDR
Pin Function
9.9.6
Mode 7
—
0
1
D8 input/output
PD0 input
PD0 output
Port D Input Pull-Up MOS Function
Port D has a built-in input pull-up MOS function that can be controlled by software. Input pull-up
MOS can be used in mode 7, and can be specified as on or off for individual bits.
Table 9.53 summarizes the input pull-up MOS states.
Table 9.53 Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port D)
Pins
Address output (modes 4
to 6), port output (mode
7)
Power-On
Reset
Hardware
Standby
Mode
Manual
Reset
OFF
Port input (mode 7)
Software
Standby
Mode
In Other
Operations
OFF
ON/OFF
Legend:
OFF:
Input pull-up MOS is always off.
ON/OFF: On when PDDDR = 0 and PDPCR = 1; otherwise off.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 267 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.10
Port E
Port E is an 8-bit I/O port that also has data bus (D7 to D0) I/O. The port E has the following
registers.
• Port E data direction register (PEDDR)
• Port E data register (PEDR)
• Port E register (PORTE)
• Port E Pull-up MOS control register (PEPCR)
9.10.1
Port E Data Direction Register (PEDDR)
The individual bits of PEDDR specify input or output for the pins of port E. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PE7DDR 0
W
6
PE6DDR 0
W
5
PE5DDR 0
W
4
PE4DDR 0
W
3
PE3DDR 0
W
2
PE2DDR 0
W
1
PE1DDR 0
W
Modes 4 to 6
When 8-bit bus mode is selected, port E functions as an
I/O port. Setting a PEDDR bit to 1 makes the
corresponding port E pin an output port, while clearing the
bit to 0 makes the pin an input port. When 16-bit bus
mode is selected, the input/output direction settings in
PEDDR are ignored, and port E pins automatically
function as data input/output pins.
See section 6, Bus Controller, on 8-/16-bit bus mode.
0
PE0DDR 0
W
Page 268 of 846
Mode 7
Setting a PEDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port E
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.10.2
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port E Data Register (PEDR)
PEDR stores output data for the port E pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PE7DR
0
R/W
6
PE6DR
0
R/W
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
5
PE5DR
0
R/W
4
PE4DR
0
R/W
3
PE3DR
0
R/W
2
PE2DR
0
R/W
1
PE1DR
0
R/W
0
PE0DR
0
R/W
9.10.3
Port E Register (PORTE)
PORTE shows port E pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PE7
—*
R
PE6
—*
R
5
PE5
—*
R
If a port E read is performed while PEDDR bits are set to
1, the PEDR values are read. If a port E read is performed
while PEDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are
read.
6
4
PE4
—*
R
3
PE3
—*
R
2
PE2
—*
R
1
PE1
R
0
PE0
—*
—*
Note:
*
Determined by the states of pins PE7 to PE0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R
Page 269 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.10.4
Port E Pull-Up MOS Control Register (PEPCR)
PEPCR controls on/off states of the input pull-up MOS of port E.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PE7PCR
0
R/W
6
PE6PCR
0
R/W
When the pin is in the input state, the input pull-up MOS
of the input pin is on when the corresponding bit is set to
1.
5
PE5PCR
0
R/W
4
PE4PCR
0
R/W
3
PE3PCR
0
R/W
2
PE2PCR
0
R/W
1
PE1PCR
0
R/W
0
PE1PCR
0
R/W
9.10.5
Pin Function
Port E pins also functions as data bus (D7 to D0) I/O. The correspondence between the register
specification and the pin function in show below.
Table 9.54 PE7 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE7DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE7 input
PE7 output
D7
input/output
PE7 input
PE7 output
Pin Function
16-bit bus
mode
—
Table 9.55 PE6 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE6DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE6 input
PE6 output
D6
input/output
PE6 input
PE6 output
Pin Function
Page 270 of 846
16-bit bus
mode
—
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.56 PE5 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE5DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE5 input
PE5 output
D5
input/output
PE5 input
PE5 output
Pin Function
16-bit bus
mode
—
Table 9.57 PE4 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE4DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE4 input
PE4 output
D4
input/output
PE4 input
PE4 output
Pin Function
16-bit bus
mode
—
Table 9.58 PE3 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE3DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE3 input
PE3 output
D3
input/output
PE3 input
PE3 output
Pin Function
16-bit bus
mode
—
Table 9.59 PE2 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE2DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE2 input
PE2 output
D2
input/output
PE2 input
PE2 output
Pin Function
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
16-bit bus
mode
—
Page 271 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.60 PE1 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE1DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE1 input
PE1 output
D1
input/output
PE1 input
PE1 output
Pin Function
16-bit bus
mode
—
Table 9.61 PE0 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
8-bit bus mode
PE0DDR
0
1
—
0
1
PE0 input
PE0 output
D0
input/output
PE0 input
PE0 output
Pin Function
Page 272 of 846
16-bit bus
mode
—
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.10.6
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port E Input Pull-Up MOS State
Port E has a built-in input pull-up MOS function that can be controlled by software. Input pull-up
MOS can be used in 8-bit bus mode in modes 4 to 6 or in mode 7, and can be specified as on or off
for individual bits.
Table 9.62 summarizes the input pull-up MOS states.
Table 9.62 Input Pull-Up MOS States (Port E)
Pins
Data output (16-bit bus
mode in modes 4 to 6),
port output (8-bit bus
mode in modes 4 to 6 or
mode 7)
Power-On
Reset
Hardware
Standby
Mode
Manual
Reset
OFF
Port input (8-bit bus mode
in modes 4 to 6 or mode
7)
Software
Standby
Mode
In Other
Operations
OFF
ON/OFF
Legend:
OFF:
Input pull-up MOS is always off.
ON/OFF: On when PEDDR = 0 and PEPCR = 1; otherwise off.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 273 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.11
Port F
Port F is an 8-bit I/O port that also has external interrupt input (IRQ2, IRQ3), bus control sign I/O,
system clock output. The port F has the following registers.
• Port F data direction register (PFDDR)
• Port F data register (PFDR)
• Port F register (PORTF)
9.11.1
Port F Data Direction Register (PFDDR)
The individual bits of PFDDR specify input or output for the pins of port F. Since this is a writeonly register, bit manipulation instructions should not be used to write to it. For details, see section
2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
W
Modes 4 to 6
Pin PF7 functions as the φ output pin when the
corresponding PFDDR bit is set to 1, and as an input port
when the bit is cleared to 0. The input/output direction
specification in PFDDR is ignored for pins PF6 to PF3,
which are automatically designated as bus control
outputs. Pins PF2 to PF0 are made bus control
input/output pins by bus controller settings. Otherwise,
setting a PFDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding pin an
output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the pin an
input port.
7
PF7DDR
1/0*
6
PF6DDR
0
W
5
PF5DDR
0
W
4
PF4DDR
0
W
3
PF3DDR
0
W
2
PF2DDR
0
W
1
PF1DDR
0
W
0
PF0DDR
0
W
Mode 7
Setting a PFDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port F
pin PF6 to PF0 an output port, or in the case of pin PF7,
the φ output pin. Clearing the bit to 0 makes the pin an
input port.
Note:
*
In modes 4 to 6, set to 1; in mode 7 cleared to 0.
Page 274 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.11.2
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port F Data Register (PFDR)
PFDR stores output data for the port F pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
PF7DR
0
R/W
6
PF6DR
0
R/W
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
5
PF5DR
0
R/W
4
PF4DR
0
R/W
3
PF3DR
0
R/W
2
PF2DR
0
R/W
1
PF1DR
0
R/W
0
PF0DR
0
R/W
9.11.3
Port F Register (PORTF)
PORTF shows port F pin states.
Bit
R/W
Description
PF7
—*
R
PF6
—*
R
PF5
—*
R
If a port F read is performed while PFDDR bits are set to
1, the PFDR values are read. If a port F read is performed
while PFDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin states are
read.
PF4
—*
R
PF3
—*
R
PF2
—*
R
1
PF1
R
0
PF0
—*
—*
7
6
5
4
3
2
Note:
Bit Name Initial Value
*
Determined by the states of pins PF7 to PF0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R
Page 275 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.11.4
Pin Functions
Port F is an 8-bit I/O port. Port F pins also function as external interrupt input (IRQ2 and IRQ3),
bus control signal, and system clock output (φ).
Table 9.63 PF7 Pin Function
PF7DDR
Pin function
0
1
PF7 input
φ output
Table 9.64 PF6 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PF6DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
—
0
1
AS output
PF6 input
PF6 output
Table 9.65 PF5 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PF5DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
—
0
1
RD output
PF5 input
PF5 output
Table 9.66 PF4 Pin Function
Operating Mode
PF4DDR
Pin function
Page 276 of 846
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
—
0
1
HWR output
PF4 input
PF4 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
Table 9.67 PF3 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
Mode 7
Bus Mode
16 bits
PF3DDR
—
0
1
0
LWR output
PF3 input
PF3 output
PF3 input
Pin function
8 bits
—
ADTRG input *
2
IRQ3 input *
1
PF3 output
1
Notes: 1. ADTRG input when TRGS0=TRGS1=1.
2. When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use as an I/O pin for another
function.
Table 9.68 PF2 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
WAITE
0
PF2DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
1
—
0
1
—
0
1
PF2 input
PF2 output
WAIT input
PF2 input
PF2 output
Table 9.69 PF1 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
BRLE
0
PF1DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
1
—
0
1
—
0
1
PF1 input
PF1 output
BACK output
PF1 input
PF1 output
Table 9.70 PF0 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
BRLE
0
PF0DDR
Pin function
Note:
*
1
—
0
1
—
0
1
PF0 input
PF0 output
BREQ input
IRQ2 input*
PF0 input
PF0 output
When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use as an I/O pin for another
function.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Mode 7
Page 277 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.12
Port G
Port G is a 5-bit I/O port that also has functioning as external interrupt input (IRQ7) and bus
control output (CS0 to CS3). The port G has the following registers.
• Port G data direction register (PGDDR)
• Port G data register (PGDR)
• Port G register (PORTG)
9.12.1
Port G Data Direction Register (PGDDR)
The individual bits of PGDDR specify input or output for the pins of port G. If port G is, an
undefined value will be read. Since this is a write-only register, bit manipulation instructions
should not be used to write to it. For details, see section 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing
Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
—
—
Reserved
4
PG4DDR 0/1*
W
3
PG3DDR 0
W
2
PG2DDR 0
W
1
PG1DDR 0
W
0
PG0DDR 0
W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
Modes 4 to 6
Setting a PGDDR bit to 1 makes the PG4 to PG1 pins bus
control signal outputs, while clearing the bit to 0 makes
the pin input ports. Signal outputs, while clearing the bit to
0 makes the pin input ports. Setting a PGDDR bit to 1
makes the PG0 pin an output port, while clearing the bit to
0 makes the pin an input port.
Mode 7
Setting a PGDDR bit to 1 makes the corresponding port G
pin an output port, while clearing the bit to 0 makes the
pin an input port.
Note:
*
In modes 4 and 5, set to 1; in modes 6 and 7 cleared to 0.
Page 278 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.12.2
Section 9 I/O Ports
Port G Data Register (PGDR)
PGDR stores output data for the port G pins.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
—
—
Reserved
4
PG4DR
0
R/W
3
PG3DR
0
R/W
2
PG2DR
0
R/W
1
PG1DR
0
R/W
0
PG0DR
0
R/W
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
9.12.3
An output data for a pin is stored when the pin function is
specified to a general purpose output port.
Port G Register (PORTG)
PORTG shows port G pin states.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
—
—
Reserved
4
PG4
—*
R
3
PG3
—*
R
2
PG2
—*
R
1
PG1
R
0
PG0
—*
—*
Note:
Undefined
These bits are undefined and cannot be modified.
*
R
Determined by the states of pins PG4 to PG0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
If a port G read is performed while PGDDR bits are set to
1, the PGDR values are read. If a port G read is
performed while PGDDR bits are cleared to 0, the pin
states are read.
Page 279 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.12.4
Pin Functions
Port G is an 8-bit I/O port. Port G pins also function as external interrupt inputs (IRQ7) and bus
control signals (CS0 to CS3).
Table 9.71 PG4 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PG4DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
0
1
0
1
PG4 input
CS0 output
PG4 input
PG4 output
Table 9.72 PG3 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PG3DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
0
1
0
1
PG3 input
CS1 output
PG3 input
PG3 output
Table 9.73 PG2 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PG2DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
0
1
0
1
PG2 input
CS2 output
PG2 input
PG2 output
Table 9.74 PG1 Pin Function
Operating Mode
Modes 4 to 6
PG1DDR
Pin function
Mode 7
0
1
0
1
PG1 input
CS3 output
PG1 input
PG1output
IRQ7 input*
Note:
*
When used as an external interrupt input pin, do not use as an I/O pin for another
function.
Table 9.75 PG0 Pin Function
PG0DDR
Pin function
Page 280 of 846
0
1
PG0 input
PG0 output
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
9.13
Section 9 I/O Ports
Handling of Unused Pins
Unused input pins should be fixed high or low. Generally, the input pins of CMOS products are
high-impedance. Leaving unused pins open can cause the generation of intermediate levels due to
peripheral noise induction. This can result in shoot-through current inside the device and cause it
to malfunction. Table 9.76 lists examples of ways to handle unused pins.
For the handling of dedicated boundary scan pins that are unused, see section 14.2, Pin
Configuration, and section 14.5, Usage Notes. For the handling of dedicated USB pins that are
unused, see section 15.9.14, Pin Processing when USB Not Used.
Table 9.76 Examples of Ways to Handle Unused Input Pins
Pin Name
Pin Handling Example
Port 1
Connect each pin to Vcc (pull-up) or to Vss (pull-down) via a resistor.
Port 3
Port 4
Connect each pin to AVcc (pull-up) or to AVss (pull-down) via a resistor.
Port 7
Connect each pin to Vcc (pull-up) or to Vss (pull-down) via a resistor.
Port 9
Connect each pin to AVcc (pull-up) or to AVss (pull-down) via a resistor.
Port A
Connect each pin to Vcc (pull-up) or to Vss (pull-down) via a resistor.
Port B
Port C
Port D
Port E
Port F
Port G
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 281 of 846
Section 9 I/O Ports
Page 282 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
This LSI has an on-chip 16-bit timer pulse unit (TPU) that comprises three 16-bit timer channels.
The function list of the 16-bit timer unit and its block diagram are shown in table 10.1 and figure
10.1, respectively.
10.1
Features
• Maximum 8-pulse input/output
• Selection of 8 counter input clocks for each channel
⎯ The following operations can be set for each channel
Waveform output at compare match, input capture function, counter clear operation,
simultaneous writing to multiple timer counters (TCNT), simultaneous clearing using compare
match or input capture, simultaneous input/output for individual registers using counter
synchronous operation, PWM output using user-defined duty, up to 7-phase PWM output by
combination with synchronous operation
• Buffer operation settable for channel 0
• Phase counting mode settable independently for each of channels 1 and 2
• Fast access via internal 16-bit bus
• 13 interrupt sources
• Automatic transfer of register data
• A/D converter conversion start trigger can be generated
• Module stop mode can be set
• Baud rate clock for the SCI0 can be generated by channels 1 and 2
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 283 of 846
TIMTPU2A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Legend:
TSTR: Timer start register
TSYR: Timer synchro register
TCR: Timer control register
TMDR: Timer mode register
A/D converter convertion start signal
TGRC
TGRD
TGRB
TGRB
TGRB
TCNT
TCNT
TGRA
TCNT
TGRA
Module data bus
TSR
TSR
TGRA
Bus
interface
Internal data bus
TSTR
TIER
TIER
TIER
TSR
TIOR
TIOR
TIORH TIORL
Common
Control logic
TMDR
Channel 2
TCR
TMDR
Channel 1
TIOR (H, L):
TIER:
TSR:
TGR (A, B, C, D):
TCR
SCK0 (to SCI0)
TMDR
Channel 2:
Channel 0
Channel 1:
TIOCA0
TIOCB0
TIOCC0
TIOCD0
TIOCA1
TIOCB1
TIOCA2
TIOCB2
Control logic for channels 0 to 2
Input/output pins
Channel 0:
TCR
External clock:
φ/1
φ/4
φ/16
φ/64
φ/256
φ/1024
TCLKA
TCLKB
TCLKC
TCLKD
TSYR
Clock input
Internal clock:
Interrupt request signals
Channel 0: TGI0A
TGI0B
TGI0C
TGI0D
TCI0V
Channel 1: TGI1A
TGI1B
TCI1V
TCI1U
Channel 2: TGI2A
TGI2B
TCI2V
TCI2U
Timer I/O control registers (H, L)
Timer interrupt enable register
Timer status register
TImer general registers (A, B, C, D)
Figure 10.1 Block Diagram of TPU
Page 284 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.1 TPU Functions
Item
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 2
Count clock
φ/1
φ/1
φ/1
φ/4
φ/4
φ/4
φ/16
φ/16
φ/16
φ/64
φ/64
φ/64
TCLKA
φ/256
φ/1024
TCLKB
TCLKA
TCLKA
TCLKC
TCLKB
TCLKB
TCLKD
General registers
TCLKC
TGRA_0
TGRA_1
TGRA_2
TGRB_0
TGRB_1
TGRB_2
General registers/buffer TGRC_0
registers
TGRD_0
not possible
not possible
I/O pins
TIOCA0
TIOCA1
TIOCA2
TIOCB0
TIOCB1
TIOCB2
TIOCC0
TIOCD0
Counter clear function
TGR compare match TGR compare match TGR compare match or
or input capture
or input capture
input capture
Compare
match
output
possible
0 output
possible
possible
1 output
possible
possible
possible
Toggle
output
possible
possible
possible
Input capture function
possible
possible
possible
Synchronous operation
possible
possible
possible
PWM mode
possible
possible
possible
Phase counting mode
not possible
possible
possible
Buffer operation
possible
not possible
not possible
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 285 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Item
Channel 0
DTC activation
TGR compare match or TGR compare match or TGR compare match
input capture
input capture
or input capture
DMAC activation
TGRA_0 compare
match or input capture
TGRA_1 compare
match or input capture
TGRA_2 compare
match or input
capture
A/D converter trigger
TGRA_0 compare
match or input capture
TGRA_1 compare
match or input capture
TGRA_2 compare
match or input
capture
5 sources
4 sources
4 sources
•
•
•
Interrupt sources
•
•
•
•
Page 286 of 846
Compare match or
input capture 0A
Compare match or
input capture 0B
Compare match or
input capture 0C
Compare match or
input capture 0D
Overflow
Channel 1
•
•
•
Compare match or
input capture 1A
Compare match or
input capture 1B
Overflow
Underflow
Channel 2
•
•
•
Compare match or
input capture 2A
Compare match or
input capture 2B
Overflow
Underflow
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.2
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Input/Output Pins
Table 10.2 Pin Configuration
Channel
Symbol
I/O
Function
All
TCLKA
Input
External clock A input pin
(Channel 1 phase counting mode A phase input)
TCLKB
Input
External clock B input pin
(Channel 1 phase counting mode B phase input)
TCLKC
Input
External clock C input pin
(Channel 2 phase counting mode A phase input)
TCLKD
Input
External clock D input pin
(Channel 2 phase counting mode B phase input)
TIOCA0
I/O
TGRA_0 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCB0
I/O
TGRB_0 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCC0
I/O
TGRC_0 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCD0
I/O
TGRD_0 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCA1
I/O
TGRA_1 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCB1
I/O
TGRB_1 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCA2
I/O
TGRA_2 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOCB2
I/O
TGRB_2 input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
0
1
2
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 287 of 846
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.3
H8S/2215 Group
Register Descriptions
The TPU has the following registers.
• Timer control register_0 (TCR_0)
• Timer mode register_0 (TMDR_0)
• Timer I/O control register H_0 (TIORH_0)
• Timer I/O control register L_0 (TIORL_0)
• Timer interrupt enable register_0 (TIER_0)
• Timer status register_0 (TSR_0)
• Timer counter_0 (TCNT_0)
• Timer general register A_0 (TGRA_0)
• Timer general register B_0 (TGRB_0)
• Timer general register C_0 (TGRC_0)
• Timer general register D_0 (TGRD_0)
• Timer control register_1 (TCR_1)
• Timer mode register_1 (TMDR_1)
• Timer I/O control register _1 (TIOR_1)
• Timer interrupt enable register_1 (TIER_1)
• Timer status register_1 (TSR_1)
• Timer counter_1 (TCNT_1)
• Timer general register A_1 (TGRA_1)
• Timer general register B_1 (TGRB_1)
• Timer control register_2 (TCR_2)
• Timer mode register_2 (TMDR_2)
• Timer I/O control register_2 (TIOR_2)
• Timer interrupt enable register_2 (TIER_2)
• Timer status register_2 (TSR_2)
• Timer counter_2 (TCNT_2)
• Timer general register A_2 (TGRA_2)
• Timer general register B_2 (TGRB_2)
Common Registers
• Timer start register (TSTR)
• Timer synchro register (TSYR)
Page 288 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.3.1
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Timer Control Register (TCR)
The TCR registers control the TCNT operation for each channel. The TPU has a total of three
TCR registers, one for each channel (channels 0 to 2). TCR register settings should be made only
when TCNT operation is stopped.
Bit
Bit Name Initial value
R/W
Description
7
CCLR2
0
R/W
Counter Clear 2 to 0
6
CCLR1
0
R/W
5
CCLR0
0
R/W
These bits select the TCNTcounter clearing source. See
tables 10.3 and 10.4 for details.
4
CKEG1
0
R/W
Clock Edge 1 and 0
3
CKEG0
0
R/W
These bits select the input clock edge. When the internal
clock is counted using both edges, the input clock
frequency is halved (e.g., φ/4 both edges = φ/2 rising
edge). If phase counting mode is used on channels 1, 2,
4, and 5, this setting is ignored and the phase counting
mode setting has priority. Internal clock edge selection is
valid when the input clock is φ/4 or slower. If φ/1 is
selected as the input clock, this setting is ignored and
count at falling edge of φ is selected.
00: Count at rising edge
01: Count at falling edge
1×: Count at both edges
Legend: ×: Don’t care
2
TPSC2
0
R/W
Time Prescaler 2 to 0
1
TPSC1
0
R/W
0
TPSC0
0
R/W
These bits select the TCNT counter clock. The clock
source can be selected independently for each channel.
See tables 10.5 to 10.10 for details.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 289 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.3 CCLR2 to CCLR0 (channel 0)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Channel
CCLR2
CCLR1
CCLR0
0
0
0
0
TCNT clearing disabled
1
TCNT cleared by TGRA compare
match/input capture
0
TCNT cleared by TGRB compare
match/input capture
1
TCNT cleared by counter clearing for
another channel performing synchronous
1
clearing/synchronous operation*
0
TCNT clearing disabled
1
TCNT cleared by TGRC compare
2
match/input capture*
0
TCNT cleared by TGRD compare
2
match/input capture*
1
TCNT cleared by counter clearing for
another channel performing synchronous
1
clearing/synchronous operation*
1
1
0
1
Description
Notes: 1. Synchronous operation setting is performed by setting the SYNC bit in TSYR to 1.
2. When TGRC or TGRD is used as a buffer register. TCNT is not cleared because the
buffer register setting has priority, and compare match/input capture does not occur.
Table 10.4 CCLR2 to CCLR0 (channels 1 and 2)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Channel
2
Reserved* CCLR1
CCLR0
Description
1, 2
0
0
TCNT clearing disabled
1
TCNT cleared by TGRA compare
match/input capture
0
TCNT cleared by TGRB compare
match/input capture
1
TCNT cleared by counter clearing for
another channel performing synchronous
1
clearing/synchronous operation*
0
1
Notes: 1. Synchronous operation setting is performed by setting the SYNC bit in TSYR to 1.
2. Bit 7 is reserved in channels 1 and 2. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
Page 290 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.5 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (channel 0)
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Channel
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Description
0
0
0
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/1
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/4
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/16
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/64
0
External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: counts on TCLKB pin input
0
External clock: counts on TCLKC pin input
1
External clock: counts on TCLKD pin input
1
1
0
1
Table 10.6 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (channel 1)
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Channel
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Description
1
0
0
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/1
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/4
1
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/16
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/64
0
External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: counts on TCLKB pin input
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/256
1
Setting prohibited
1
0
1
Note: This setting is ignored when channel 1 is in phase counting mode.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 291 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.7 TPSC2 to TPSC0 (channel 2)
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Channel
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Description
2
0
0
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/1
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/4
0
Internal clock: counts on φ/16
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/64
0
External clock: counts on TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: counts on TCLKB pin input
0
External clock: counts on TCLKC pin input
1
Internal clock: counts on φ/1024
1
1
0
1
Note: This setting is ignored when channel 1 is in phase counting mode.
Page 292 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.3.2
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Timer Mode Register (TMDR)
The TMDR registers are used to set the operating mode for each channel. The TPU has three
TMDR registers, one for each channel. TMDR register settings should be made only when TCNT
operation is stopped.
Bit
Bit Name Initial value
R/W
7,
—
—
All 1
6
5
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified.
BFB
0
R/W
Buffer Operation B
Specifies whether TGRB is to operate in the normal way,
or TGRB and TGRD are to be used together for buffer
operation. When TGRD is used as a buffer register.
TGRD input capture/output compare is not generation. In
channels 1 and 2, which have no TGRD, bit 5 is
reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
0: TGRB operates normally
1: TGRB and TGRD used together for buffer operation
4
BFA
0
R/W
Buffer Operation A
Specifies whether TGRA is to operate in the normal way,
or TGRA and TGRC are to be used together for buffer
operation. When TGRC is used as a buffer register,
TGRC input capture/output compare is not generated. In
channels 1 and 2, which have no TGRC, bit 4 is
reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
0: TGRA operates normally
1: TGRA and TGRC used together for buffer operation
3
MD3
0
R/W
Modes 3 to 0
2
MD2
0
R/W
These bits are used to set the timer operating mode.
1
MD1
0
R/W
0
MD0
0
R/W
MD3 is a reserved bit. In a write, the write value should
always be 0. See table 10.8, for details.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 293 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.8 MD3 to MD0
Bit 3
Bit2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
MD3*
2
MD2*
MD1
MD0
Description
0
0
0
0
Normal operation
1
Reserved
0
PWM mode 1
1
PWM mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 1
1
Phase counting mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 3
1
Phase counting mode 4
×
—
1
1
0
1
1
×
×
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Notes: 1. MD3 is reserved bit. In a write, it should be written with 0.
2. Phase counting mode cannot be set for channels 0 and 3. In this case, 0 should always
be written to MD2.
Page 294 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.3.3
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR)
The TIOR registers control the TGR registers. The TPU has eight TIOR registers, two each for
channel 0, and one each for channels 1 and 2. Care is required since TIOR is affected by the
TMDR setting. The initial output specified by TIOR is valid when the counter is stopped (the CST
bit in TSTR is cleared to 0). Note also that, in PWM mode 2, the output at the point at which the
counter is cleared to 0 is specified. When TGRC or TGRD is designated for buffer operation, this
setting is invalid and the register operates as a buffer register.
• TIORH_0, TIOR_1, TIOR_2
Bit
Bit Name Initial value
R/W
Description
7
IOB3
0
R/W
I/O Control B3 to B0
6
IOB2
0
R/W
Specify the function of TGRB.
5
IOB1
0
R/W
4
IOB0
0
R/W
3
IOA3
0
R/W
I/O Control A3 to A0
2
IOA2
0
R/W
Specify the function of TGRA.
1
IOA1
0
R/W
0
IOA0
0
R/W
Bit
Bit Name Initial value
R/W
Description
7
IOD3
0
R/W
I/O Control D3 to D0
6
IOD2
0
R/W
Specify the function of TGRD.
5
IOD1
0
R/W
4
IOD0
0
R/W
3
IOC3
0
R/W
I/O Control C3 to C0
2
IOC2
0
R/W
Specify the function of TGRC.
1
IOC1
0
R/W
0
IOC0
0
R/W
• TIORL_0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 295 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.9 TIORH_0 (channel 0)
Description
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
TGRB_0
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
Function
TIOCB0 Pin Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register
Output disabled
1
1
0
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
1
0
0
Input capture
register
Capture input source is TIOCB0 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCB0 pin
Input capture at falling edge
1
×
Capture input source is TIOCB0 pin
Input capture at both edges
×
×
Setting prohibited
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Page 296 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.10 TIORH_0 (channel 0)
Description
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TGRA_0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Function
TIOCA0 Pin Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register
Output disabled
1
1
0
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
0
1
Input capture
register
Capture input source is TIOCA0 pin
Input capture at rising edge
Capture input source is TIOCA0 pin
Input capture at falling edge
1
×
Capture input source is TIOCA0 pin
Input capture at both edges
1
×
×
Setting prohibited
Legend:
×: Don’t care
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 297 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.11 TIORL_0 (channel 0)
Description
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
TGRD_0
IOD3
IOD2
IOD1
IOD0
Function
0
0
0
0
Output
Compare
register*
1
1
0
TIOCD0 Pin Function
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1
Initial output is 1 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
1
0
0
Input capture
register*
Capture input source is TIOCD0 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCD0 pin
Input capture at falling edge
1
×
Capture input source is TIOCD0 pin
Input capture at both edges
×
×
Setting prohibited
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Note: * When the BFB bit in TMDR_0 is set to 1 and TGRD_0 is used as a buffer register, this
setting is invalid and input capture/output compare is not generated.
Page 298 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.12 TIORL_0 (channel 0)
Description
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TGRC_0
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register*
1
1
0
TIOCC0 Pin Function
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
1
0
0
Input capture
register*
Capture input source is TIOCC0 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCC0 pin
Input capture at falling edge
1
×
Capture input source is TIOCC0 pin
Input capture at both edges
×
×
Setting prohibited
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Note: * When the BFA bit in TMDR_0 is set to 1and TGRC_0 is used as a buffer register, this
setting is invalid and input capture/output compare is not generated.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 299 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.13 TIOR_1 (channel 1)
Description
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
TGRB_1
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register
1
1
0
TIOCB1 Pin Function
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
1
0
0
Input capture
register
Capture input source is TIOCB1 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCB1 pin
Input capture at falling edge
1
×
Capture input source is TIOCB1 pin
Input capture at both edges
×
×
Setting prohibited
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Page 300 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.14 TIOR_1 (channel 1)
Description
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TGRA_1
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register
1
1
0
TIOCA1 Pin Function
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
1
0
0
Input capture
register
Capture input source is TIOCA1 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCA1 pin
Input capture at falling edge
1
×
Capture input source is TIOCA1 pin
Input capture at both edges
×
×
Setting prohibited
Legend:
×: Don’t care
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 301 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.15 TIOR_2 (channel 2)
Description
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
TGRB_2
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register
1
1
0
TIOCB2 Pin Function
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
×
0
1
0
Input capture
register
Capture input source is TIOCB2 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCB2 pin
Input capture at falling edge
×
Capture input source is TIOCB2 pin
Input capture at both edges
Legend
×: Don’t care
Page 302 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Table 10.16 TIOR_2 (channel 2)
Description
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TGRA_2
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Function
0
0
0
0
Output
compare
register
1
1
0
TIOCA2 Pin Function
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 output
0 output at compare match
Initial output is 0 output
1 output at compare match
1
Initial output is 0 output
Toggle output at compare match
1
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 output
0 output at compare match
1
0
Initial output is 1 output
1 output at compare match
Initial output is 1 output
1
Toggle output at compare match
1
×
0
1
0
Input capture
register
Capture input source is TIOCA2 pin
Input capture at rising edge
1
Capture input source is TIOCA2 pin
Input capture at falling edge
×
Capture input source is TIOCA2 pin
Input capture at both edges
Legend:
×: Don’t care
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 303 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.3.4
Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER)
The TIER registers control enabling or disabling of interrupt requests for each channel. The TPU
has three TIER registers, one for each channel.
Bit
Bit Name Initial value
R/W
Description
7
TTGE
R/W
A/D Conversion Start Request Enable
0
Enables or disables generation of A/D conversion start
requests by TGRA input capture/compare match.
0: A/D conversion start request generation disabled
1: A/D conversion start request generation enabled
6
—
1
—
Reserved
This bit is always read as 1 and cannot be modified.
5
TCIEU
0
R/W
Underflow Interrupt Enable
Enables or disables interrupt requests (TCU) by the TCFU
flag when the TCFU flag in TSR is set to 1 in channels 1
and 2. In channel 0, bit 5 is reserved.
0: Interrupt requests (TCIU) by TCFU disabled
1: Interrupt requests (TCIU) by TCFU enabled
4
TCIEV
0
R/W
Overflow Interrupt Enable
Enables or disables interrupt requests (TCIV) by the
TCFV flag when the TCFV flag in TSR is set to 1.
0: Interrupt requests (TCIV) by TCFV disabled
1: Interrupt requests (TCIV) by TCFV enabled
3
TGIED
0
R/W
TGR Interrupt Enable D
Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGID) by the
TGFD bit when the TGFD bit in TSR is set to 1 in channel
0. In channels 1 and 2, bit 3 is reserved. It is always read
as 0 and cannot be modified.
0: Interrupt requests (TGID) by TGFD disabled
1: Interrupt requests (TGID) by TGFD enabled
2
TGIEC
0
R/W
TGR Interrupt Enable C
Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGIC) by the
TGFC bit when the TGFC bit in TSR is set to 1 in channel
0. In channels 1 and 2, bit 2 is reserved. It is always read
as 0 and cannot be modified.
0: Interrupt requests (TGIC) by TGFC disabled
1: Interrupt requests (TGIC) by TGFC enabled
Page 304 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Bit
Bit Name Initial value
R/W
Description
1
TGIEB
R/W
TGR Interrupt Enable B
0
Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGIB) by the
TGFB bit when the TGFB bit in TSR is set to 1.
0: Interrupt requests (TGIB) by TGFB disabled
1: Interrupt requests (TGIB) by TGFB enabled
0
TGIEA
0
R/W
TGR Interrupt Enable A
Enables or disables interrupt requests (TGIA) by the
TGFA bit when the TGFA bit in TSR is set to 1.
0: Interrupt requests (TGIA) by TGFA disabled
1: Interrupt requests (TGIA) by TGFA enabled
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 305 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.3.5
Timer Status Register (TSR)
The TSR registers indicate the status of each channel. The TPU has three TSR registers, one for
each channel.
Bit
Bit Name Initial value R/W
7
TCFD
1
R
Description
Count Direction Flag
Status flag that shows the direction in which TCNT counts
in channels 1 and 2. In channel 0, bit 7 is reserved. It is
always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
0: TCNT counts down
1: TCNT counts up
6
—
1
—
0
R/(W)*
Reserved
This bit is always read as 1 and cannot be modified.
5
TCFU
Underflow Flag
Status flag that indicates that TCNT underflow has
occurred when channels 1 and 2 are set to phase
counting mode. The write value should always be 0 to
clear this flag. In channel 0, bit 5 is reserved.
[Setting condition]
•
When the TCNT value underflows (change from
H'0000 to H'FFFF)
[Clearing condition]
•
4
TCFV
0
R/(W)*
When 0 is written to TCFU after reading TCFU = 1
Overflow Flag
Status flag that indicates that TCNT overflow has
occurred. The write value should always be 0 to clear this
flag.
[Setting condition]
•
When the TCNT value overflows (change from H'FFFF
to H'0000)
[Clearing condition]
•
Page 306 of 846
When 0 is written to TCFV after reading TCFV = 1
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Bit
Bit Name Initial value R/W
3
TGFD
0
R/(W)*
Description
Input Capture/Output Compare Flag D
Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRD input
capture or compare match in channel 0. The write value
should always be 0 to clear this flag. In channels 1 and 2,
bit 3 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
[Setting conditions]
•
When TCNT = TGRD while TGRD is functioning as
output compare register
• When TCNT value is transferred to TGRD by input
capture signal while TGRD is functioning as input
capture register
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
2
TGFC
0
R/(W)*
When DTC is activated by TGID interrupt, DISEL bit in
MRB of DTC is cleared to 0, and transfer counter
value is not 0
When 0 is written to TGFD after reading TGFD = 1
Input Capture/Output Compare Flag C
Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRC input
capture or compare match in channel 0. The write value
should always be 0 to clear this flag. In channels 1 and 2,
bit 2 is reserved. It is always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
[Setting conditions]
•
When TCNT = TGRC while TGRC is functioning as
output compare register
• When TCNT value is transferred to TGRC by input
capture signal while TGRC is functioning as input
capture register
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
When DTC is activated by TGIC interrupt, DISEL bit in
MRB of DTC is cleared to 0, and transfer counter
value is not 0
When 0 is written to TGFC after reading TGFC = 1
Page 307 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Bit
Bit Name Initial value R/W
1
TGFB
0
R/(W)*
Description
Input Capture/Output Compare Flag B
Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRB input
capture or compare match. The write value should always
be 0 to clear this flag.
[Setting conditions]
•
When TCNT = TGRB while TGRB is functioning as
output compare register
• When TCNT value is transferred to TGRB by input
capture signal while TGRB is functioning as input
capture register
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
0
TGFA
0
R/(W)*
When DTC is activated by TGIB interrupt, DISEL bit in
MRB of DTC is cleared to 0, and transfer counter
value is not 0
When 0 is written to TGFB after reading TGFB = 1
Input Capture/Output Compare Flag A
Status flag that indicates the occurrence of TGRA input
capture or compare match. The write value should always
be 0 to clear this flag.
[Setting conditions]
•
When TCNT = TGRA while TGRA is functioning as
output compare register
• When TCNT value is transferred to TGRA by input
capture signal while TGRA is functioning as input
capture register
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
Note:
*
When DTC is activated by TGIA interrupt, DISEL bit in
MRB of DTC is cleared to 0, and transfer counter
value is not 0
When 0 is written to TGFA after reading TGFA = 1
The write value should always be 0 to clear the flag.
Page 308 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.3.6
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Timer Counter (TCNT)
The TCNT registers are 16-bit counters. The TPU has three TCNT counters, one for each channel.
The TCNT counters are initialized to H'0000 by a reset, and in hardware standby mode. The
TCNT counters cannot be accessed in 8-bit units; they must always be accessed as a 16-bit unit.
10.3.7
Timer General Register (TGR)
The TGR registers are 16-bit registers with a dual function as output compare and input capture
registers. The TPU has 16 TGR registers, four each for channel 0 and two each for channels 1 and
2. TGRC and TGRD for channel 0 can also be designated for operation as buffer registers. The
TGR registers cannot be accessed in 8-bit units; they must always be accessed as a 16-bit unit.
TGR buffer register combinations are TGRA—TGRC and TGRB—TGRD.
10.3.8
Timer Start Register (TSTR)
TSTR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects operation/stoppage for channels 0 to 2.
When setting the operating mode in TMDR or setting the count clock in TCR, first stop the TCNT
counter.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
3
—
—
Reserved
2
CST2
0
R/W
Counter Start 2 to 0 (CST2 to CST0)
1
CST1
0
R/W
These bits select operation or stoppage for TCNT.
0
CST0
0
R/W
If 0 is written to the CST bit during operation with the
TIOC pin designated for output, the counter stops but the
TIOC pin output compare output level is retained.
All 0
The write value should always be 0.
If TIOR is written to when the CST bit is cleared to 0, the
pin output level will be changed to the set initial output
value.
0: TCNT_2 to TCNT_0 count operation is stopped
1: TCNT_2 to TCNT_0 performs count operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 309 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.3.9
Timer Synchro Register (TSYR)
TSYR selects independent operation or synchronous operation for the channel 0 to 2 TCNT
counters. A channel performs synchronous operation when the corresponding bit in TSYR is set to
1.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
7 to
3
—
—
2
SYNC2
0
R/W
Timer Synchro 2 to 0
1
SYNC1
0
R/W
0
SYNC0
0
R/W
These bits select whether operation is independent of or
synchronized with other channels.
When synchronous operation is selected, synchronous
presetting of multiple channels, and synchronous clearing
through counter clearing on another channel are possible.
To set synchronous operation, the SYNC bits for at least
two channels must be set to 1. To set synchronous
clearing, in addition to the SYNC bit, the TCNT clearing
source must also be set by means of bits CCLR2 to
CCLR0 in TCR.
All 0
Description
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
0: TCNT_2 to TCNT_0 operates independently
(TCNT presetting /clearing is unrelated to other
channels)
1: TCNT_2 to TCNT_0 performs synchronous operation
TCNT synchronous presetting/synchronous clearing is
possible
Page 310 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.4
Interface to Bus Master
10.4.1
16-Bit Registers
TCNT and TGR are 16-bit registers. As the data bus to the bus master is 16 bits wide, these
registers can be read and written to in 16-bit units.
These registers cannot be read from or written to in 8-bit units; 16-bit access must always be used.
An example of 16-bit register access operation is shown in figure 10.2.
Internal data bus
H
Bus
master
L
Module
data bus
Bus interface
TCNTH
TCNTL
Figure 10.2 16-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TCNT (16 Bits)]
10.4.2
8-Bit Registers
Registers other than TCNT and TGR are 8-bit. As the data bus to the CPU is 16 bits wide, these
registers can be read and written to in 16-bit units. They can also be read and written to in 8-bit
units.
Examples of 8-bit register access operation are shown in figures 10.3 to 10.5.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 311 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Internal data bus
H
Bus
master
L
Module
data bus
Bus interface
TCR
Figure 10.3 8-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TCR (Upper 8 Bits)]
Internal data bus
H
Bus
master
L
Module
data bus
Bus interface
TMDR
Figure 10.4 8-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TMDR (Lower 8 Bits)]
Internal data bus
H
Bus
master
L
Module
data bus
Bus interface
TCR
TMDR
Figure 10.5 8-Bit Register Access Operation [Bus Master ↔ TCR and TMDR (16 Bits)]
Page 312 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.5
Operation
10.5.1
Basic Functions
Each channel has a TCNT and TGR. TCNT performs up-counting, and is also capable of freerunning operation, synchronous counting, and external event counting. Each TGR can be used as
an input capture register or output compare register.
Counter Operation: When one of bits CST0 to CST2 is set to 1 in TSTR, the TCNT counter for
the corresponding channel starts counting. TCNT can operate as a free-running counter, periodic
counter, and so on.
1. Example of count operation setting procedure
Figure 10.6 shows an example of the count operation setting procedure.
Operation selection
Select counter clock
[1]
Periodic counter
Select counter clearing source
Free-running counter
[2]
[3]
Select output compare register
Set period
[4]
Start count operation
[5]
<Periodic counter>
Start count operation
<Free-running counter>
[1] Select the counter
clock with bits
TPSC2 to TPSC0 in
TCR. At the same
time, select the
input clock edge
with bits CKEG1
and CKEG0 in TCR.
[2] For periodic counter
operation, select the
TGR to be used as
the TCNT clearing
source with bits
CCLR2 to CCLR0 in
TCR.
[3] Designate the TGR
selected in [2] as an
output compare
register by means of
TIOR.
[4] Set the periodic
counter cycle in the
TGR selected in [2].
[5] Set the CST bit in
TSTR to 1 to start
the counter
operation.
Figure 10.6 Example of Counter Operation Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 313 of 846
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
H8S/2215 Group
2. Free-running count operation and periodic count operation
Immediately after a reset, the TPU’s TCNT counters are all designated as free-running
counters. When the relevant bit in TSTR is set to 1 the corresponding TCNT counter starts upcount operation as a free-running counter. When TCNT overflows (from H'FFFF to H'0000),
the TCFV bit in TSR is set to 1. If the value of the corresponding TCIEV bit in TIER is 1 at
this point, the TPU requests an interrupt. After overflow, TCNT starts counting up again from
H'0000. Figure 10.7 illustrates free-running counter operation.
TCNT value
H'FFFF
H'0000
Time
CST bit
TCFV
Figure 10.7 Free-Running Counter Operation
When compare match is selected as the TCNT clearing source, the TCNT counter for the
relevant channel performs periodic count operation. The TGR register for setting the period is
designated as an output compare register, and counter clearing by compare match is selected
by means of bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR. After the settings have been made, TCNT starts
up-count operation as periodic counter when the corresponding bit in TSTR is set to 1. When
the count value matches the value in TGR, the TGF bit in TSR is set to 1 and TCNT is cleared
to H'0000. If the value of the corresponding TGIE bit in TIER is 1 at this point, the TPU
requests an interrupt. After a compare match, TCNT starts counting up again from H'0000.
Figure 10.8 illustrates periodic counter operation.
Page 314 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Counter cleared by TGR
compare match
TCNT value
TGR
H'0000
Time
CST bit
Flag cleared by software or
DTC activation
TGF
Figure 10.8 Periodic Counter Operation
Waveform Output by Compare Match: The TPU can perform 0, 1, or toggle output from the
corresponding output pin using compare match.
1. Example of setting procedure for waveform output by compare match
Figure 10.9 shows an example of the setting procedure for waveform output by compare
match.
Output selection
Select waveform output mode
[1]
Set output timing
[2]
Start count operation
[3]
[1] Select initial value 0 output or 1 output, and
compare match output value 0 output, 1 output,
or toggle output, by means of TIOR. The set
initial value is output at the TIOC pin unit the
first compare match occurs.
[2] Set the timing for compare match generation in
TGR.
[3] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the count
operation.
<Waveform output>
Figure 10.9 Example of Setting Procedure for Waveform Output by Compare Match
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 315 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
2. Examples of waveform output operation
Figure 10.10 shows an example of 0 output/1 output. In this example TCNT has been
designated as a free-running counter, and settings have been made so that 1 is output by
compare match A, and 0 is output by compare match B. When the set level and the pin level
coincide, the pin level does not change.
TCNT value
H'FFFF
TGRA
TGRB
Time
H'0000
No change
No change
1 output
TIOCA
No change
TIOCB
0 output
No change
Figure 10.10 Example of 0 Output/1 Output Operation
Figure 10.11 shows an example of toggle output. In this example TCNT has been designated
as a periodic counter (with counter clearing performed by compare match B), and settings have
been made so that output is toggled by both compare match A and compare match B.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by TGRB compare match
H'FFFF
TGRB
TGRA
Time
H'0000
Toggle output
TIOCB
Toggle output
TIOCA
Figure 10.11 Example of Toggle Output Operation
Page 316 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Input Capture Function: The TCNT value can be transferred to TGR on detection of the TIOC
pin input edge. Rising edge, falling edge, or both edges can be selected as the detected edge.
1. Example of input capture operation setting procedure
Figure 10.12 shows an example of the input capture operation setting procedure.
Input selection
Select input capture input
Start count
[1] Designate TGR as an input capture register by
means of TIOR, and select rising edge, falling
edge, or both edges as the input capture source
and input signal edge.
[2] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the count
operation.
[1]
[2]
<Input capture operation>
Figure 10.12 Example of Input Capture Operation Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 317 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
2. Example of input capture operation
Figure 10.13 shows an example of input capture operation. In this example both rising and
falling edges have been selected as the TIOCA pin input capture input edge, falling edge has
been selected as the TIOCB pin input capture input edge, and counter clearing by TGRB input
capture has been designated for TCNT.
Counter cleared by TIOCB
input (falling edge)
TCNT value
H'0180
H'0160
H'0010
H'0005
Time
H'0000
TIOCA
TGRA
H'0005
H'0160
H'0010
TIOCB
TGRB
H'0180
Figure 10.13 Example of Input Capture Operation
Page 318 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.5.2
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Synchronous Operation
In synchronous operation, the values in a number of TCNT counters can be rewritten
simultaneously (synchronous presetting). Also, a number of TCNT counters can be cleared
simultaneously by making the appropriate setting in TCR (synchronous clearing). Synchronous
operation enables TGR to be incremented with respect to a single time base. Channels 0 to 2 can
all be designated for synchronous operation.
Example of Synchronous Operation Setting Procedure: Figure 10.14 shows an example of the
synchronous operation setting procedure.
Synchronous operation
selection
Set synchronous
operation
[1]
Synchronous presetting
Set TCNT
Synchronous clearing
[2]
Clearing
source generation
channel?
No
Yes
<Synchronous presetting>
Select counter
clearing source
[3]
Set synchronous
counter clearing
[4]
Start count
[5]
Start count
[5]
<Counter clearing>
<Synchronous clearing>
[1] Set to 1 the SYNC bits in TSYR corresponding to the channels to be designated for synchronous
operation.
[2] When the TCNT counter of any of the channels designated for synchronous operation is
written to, the same value is simultaneously written to the other TCNT counters.
[3] Use bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR to specify TCNT clearing by input capture/output compare,
etc.
[4] Use bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR to designate synchronous clearing for the counter clearing
source.
[5] Set to 1 the CST bits in TSTR for the relevant channels, to start the count operation.
Figure 10.14 Example of Synchronous Operation Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 319 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Example of Synchronous Operation: Figure 10.15 shows an example of synchronous operation.
In this example, synchronous operation and PWM mode 1 have been designated for channels 0 to
2, TGRB_0 compare match has been set as the channel 0 counter clearing source, and
synchronous clearing has been set for the channel 1 and 2 counter clearing sources. Three-phase
PWM waveforms are output from pins TIOC0A, TIOC1A, and TIOC2A. At this time,
synchronous presetting, and synchronous clearing by TGRB_0 compare match, is performed for
channel 0 to 2 TCNT counters, and the data set in TGRB_0 is used as the PWM cycle. For details
of PWM modes, see section 10.5.4, PWM Modes.
Synchronous clearing by TGRB_0 compare match
TCNT0 to TCNT2 values
TGRB_0
TGRB_1
TGRA_0
TGRB_2
TGRA_1
TGRA_2
Time
H'0000
TIOCA_0
TIOCA_1
TIOCA_2
Figure 10.15 Example of Synchronous Operation
10.5.3
Buffer Operation
Buffer operation, provided for channel 0, enables TGRC and TGRD to be used as buffer registers.
Buffer operation differs depending on whether TGR has been designated as an input capture
register or as a compare match register. Table 10.17 shows the register combinations used in
buffer operation.
Table 10.17 Register Combinations in Buffer Operation
Channel
Timer General Register
Buffer Register
0
TGRA_0
TGRC_0
TGRB_0
TGRD_0
Page 320 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
• When TGR is an output compare register
When a compare match occurs, the value in the buffer register for the corresponding channel is
transferred to the timer general register. This operation is illustrated in figure 10.16.
Compare match signal
Timer general
register
Buffer register
Comparator
TCNT
Figure 10.16 Compare Match Buffer Operation
• When TGR is an input capture register
When input capture occurs, the value in TCNT is transferred to TGR and the value previously
held in the timer general register is transferred to the buffer register. This operation is
illustrated in figure 10.17.
Input capture
signal
Timer general
register
Buffer register
TCNT
Figure 10.17 Input Capture Buffer Operation
Example of Buffer Operation Setting Procedure: Figure 10.18 shows an example of the buffer
operation setting procedure.
Buffer operation
Select TGR function
[1]
Set buffer operation
[2]
Start count
[3]
[1] Designate TGR as an input capture register or
output compare register by means of TIOR.
[2] Designate TGR for buffer operation with bits
BFA and BFB in TMDR.
[3] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 start the count
operation.
<Buffer operation>
Figure 10.18 Example of Buffer Operation Setting Procedure
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 321 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Examples of Buffer Operation
1. When TGR is an output compare register
Figure 10.19 shows an operation example in which PWM mode 1 has been designated for
channel 0, and buffer operation has been designated for TGRA and TGRC. The settings used
in this example are TCNT clearing by compare match B, 1 output at compare match A, and 0
output at compare match B. As buffer operation has been set, when compare match A occurs
the output changes and the value in buffer register TGRC is simultaneously transferred to
timer general register TGRA. This operation is repeated each time compare match A occurs.
For details of PWM modes, see section 10.5.4, PWM Modes.
TCNT value
TGRB_0
H'0520
H'0450
H'0200
TGRA_0
Time
H'0000
TGRC_0 H'0200
H'0450
H'0520
Transfer
TGRA_0
H'0200
H'0450
TIOCA
Figure 10.19 Example of Buffer Operation (1)
Page 322 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
2. When TGR is an input capture register
Figure 10.20 shows an operation example in which TGRA has been designated as an input
capture register, and buffer operation has been designated for TGRA and TGRC. Counter
clearing by TGRA input capture has been set for TCNT, and both rising and falling edges have
been selected as the TIOCA pin input capture input edge. As buffer operation has been set,
when the TCNT value is stored in TGRA upon occurrence of input capture A, the value
previously stored in TGRA is simultaneously transferred to TGRC.
TCNT value
H'0F07
H'09FB
H'0532
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
TGRA
TGRC
H'0532
H'0F07
H'09FB
H'0532
H'0F07
Figure 10.20 Example of Buffer Operation (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 323 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.5.4
PWM Modes
In PWM mode, PWM waveforms are output from the output pins. 0, 1, or toggle output can be
selected as the output level in response to compare match of each TGR. Settings of TGR registers
can output a PWM waveform in the range of 0 % to 100 % duty. Designating TGR compare match
as the counter clearing source enables the period to be set in that register. All channels can be
designated for PWM mode independently. Synchronous operation is also possible. There are two
PWM modes, as described below.
• PWM mode 1
PWM output is generated from the TIOCA and TIOCC pins by pairing TGRA with TGRB and
TGRC with TGRD. The output specified by bits IOA3 to IOA0 and IOC3 to IOC0 in TIOR is
output from the TIOCA and TIOCC pins at compare matches A and C, and the output
specified by bits IOB3 to IOB0 and IOD3 to IOD0 in TIOR is output at compare matches B
and D. The initial output value is the value set in TGRA or TGRC. If the set values of paired
TGRs are identical, the output value does not change when a compare match occurs. In PWM
mode 1, a maximum 4-phase PWM output is possible.
• PWM mode 2
PWM output is generated using one TGR as the cycle register and the others as duty registers.
The output specified in TIOR is performed by means of compare matches. Upon counter
clearing by a synchronization register compare match, the output value of each pin is the initial
value set in TIOR. If the set values of the cycle and duty registers are identical, the output
value does not change when a compare match occurs. In PWM mode 2, a maximum 7-phase
PWM output is possible by combined use with synchronous operation. The correspondence
between PWM output pins and registers is shown in table 10.18.
Table 10.18 PWM Output Registers and Output Pins
Output Pins
Channel
Registers
PWM Mode 1
0
TGRA_0
TIOCA0
TGRB_0
TGRC_0
TGRA_1
TIOCC0
TGRA_2
TGRB_2
TIOCC0
TIOCD0
TIOCA1
TGRB_1
2
TIOCA0
TIOCB0
TGRD_0
1
PWM Mode 2
TIOCA1
TIOCB1
TIOCA2
TIOCA2
TIOCB2
Note: In PWM mode 2, PWM output is not possible for the TGR register in which the period is set.
Page 324 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Example of PWM Mode Setting Procedure: Figure 10.21 shows an example of the PWM mode
setting procedure.
PWM mode
Select counter clock
[1]
Select counter clearing source
[2]
Select waveform output level
[3]
Set TGR
[4]
Set PWM mode
[5]
Start count
[6]
[1] Select the counter clock with bits TPSC2 to
TPSC0 in TCR. At the same time, select the
input clock edge with bits CKEG1 and CKEG0
in TCR.
[2] Use bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in TCR to select the
TGR to be used as the TCNT clearing source.
[3] Use TIOR to designate the TGR as an output
compare register, and select the initial value and
output value.
[4] Set the cycle in the TGR selected in [2], and set
the duty in the other the TGR.
[5] Select the PWM mode with bits MD3 to MD0 in
TMDR.
[6] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 start the count
operation.
<PWM mode>
Figure 10.21 Example of PWM Mode Setting Procedure
Examples of PWM Mode Operation: Figure 10.22 shows an example of PWM mode 1
operation.
In this example, TGRA compare match is set as the TCNT clearing source, 0 is set for the TGRA
initial output value and output value, and 1 is set as the TGRB output value. In this case, the value
set in TGRA is used as the period, and the values set in TGRB registers as the duty.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by
TGRA compare match
TGRA
TGRB
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
Figure 10.22 Example of PWM Mode Operation (1)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 325 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Figure 10.23 shows an example of PWM mode 2 operation. In this example, synchronous
operation is designated for channels 0 and 1, TGRB_1 compare match is set as the TCNT clearing
source, and 0 is set for the initial output value and 1 for the output value of the other TGR registers
(TGRA_0 to TGRD_0, TGRA_1), to output a 5-phase PWM waveform. In this case, the value set
in TGRB_1 is used as the cycle, and the values set in the other TGRs as the duty.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by
TGRB_1 compare match
TGRB_1
TGRA_1
TGRD_0
TGRC_0
TGRB_0
TGRA_0
H'0000
Time
TIOCA0
TIOCB0
TIOCC0
TIOCD0
TIOCA1
Figure 10.23 Example of PWM Mode Operation (2)
Page 326 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Figure 10.24 shows examples of PWM waveform output with 0% duty and 100% duty in PWM
mode.
TCNT value
TGRB rewritten
TGRA
TGRB
TGRB rewritten
TGRB
rewritten
H'0000
Time
0% duty
TIOCA
Output does not change when cycle register and duty register
compare matches occur simultaneously
TCNT value
TGRB rewritten
TGRA
TGRB rewritten
TGRB rewritten
TGRB
H'0000
Time
100% duty
TIOCA
Output does not change when cycle register and duty
register compare matches occur simultaneously
TCNT value
TGRB rewritten
TGRA
TGRB rewritten
TGRB
TGRB rewritten
Time
H'0000
100% duty
TIOCA
0% duty
Figure 10.24 Example of PWM Mode Operation (3)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 327 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.5.5
Phase Counting Mode
In phase counting mode, the phase difference between two external clock inputs is detected and
TCNT is incremented/decremented accordingly. This mode can be set for channels 1 and 2. When
phase counting mode is set, an external clock is selected as the counter input clock and TCNT
operates as an up/down-counter regardless of the setting of bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 and bits CKEG1
and CKEG0 in TCR. However, the functions of bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR, and of TIOR,
TIER, and TGR are valid, and input capture/compare match and interrupt functions can be used.
This can be used for two-phase encoder pulse input. When overflow occurs while TCNT is
counting up, the TCFV flag in TSR is set; when underflow occurs while TCNT is counting down,
the TCFU flag is set. The TCFD bit in TSR is the count direction flag. Reading the TCFD flag
provides an indication of whether TCNT is counting up or down. Table 10.19 shows the
correspondence between external clock pins and channels.
Table 10.19 Phase Counting Mode Clock Input Pins
External Clock Pins
Channels
A-Phase
B-Phase
When channel 1 is set to phase counting mode
TCLKA
TCLKB
When channel 2 is set to phase counting mode
TCLKC
TCLKD
Example of Phase Counting Mode Setting Procedure: Figure 10.25 shows an example of the
phase counting mode setting procedure.
[1] Select phase counting mode with bits MD3 to
MD0 in TMDR.
[2] Set the CST bit in TSTR to 1 to start the count
operation.
Phase counting mode
Select phase counting mode
[1]
Start count
[2]
<Phase counting mode>
Figure 10.25 Example of Phase Counting Mode Setting Procedure
Page 328 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Examples of Phase Counting Mode Operation: In phase counting mode, TCNT counts up or
down according to the phase difference between two external clocks. There are four modes,
according to the count conditions.
1. Phase counting mode 1
Figure 10.26 shows an example of phase counting mode 1 operation, and table 10.20
summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions.
TCLKA (channel 1)
TCLKC (channel 2)
TCLKB (channel 1)
TCLKD (channel 2)
TCNT value
Down-count
Up-count
Time
Figure 10.26 Example of Phase Counting Mode 1 Operation
Table 10.20 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 1
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
High level
Operation
Up-count
Low level
Low level
High level
Down-count
High level
Low level
High level
Low level
Legend:
: Rising edge
: Falling edge
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 329 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
2. Phase counting mode 2
Figure 10.27 shows an example of phase counting mode 2 operation, and table 10.21
summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions.
TCLKA (channel 1)
TCLKC (channel 2)
TCLKB (channel 1)
TCLKD (channel 2)
TCNT value
Up-count
Down-count
Time
Figure 10.27 Example of Phase Counting Mode 2 Operation
Table 10.21 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 2
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
High level
Operation
Don’t care
Low level
Low level
High level
High level
Up-count
Don’t care
Low level
High level
Low level
Down-count
Legend:
: Rising edge
: Falling edge
Page 330 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
3. Phase counting mode 3
Figure 10.28 shows an example of phase counting mode 3 operation, and table 10.22
summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions.
TCLKA (channel 1)
TCLKC (channel 2)
TCLKB (channel 1)
TCLKD (channel 2)
TCNT value
Down-count
Up-count
Time
Figure 10.28 Example of Phase Counting Mode 3 Operation
Table 10.22 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 3
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
High level
Operation
Don’t care
Low level
Low level
High level
High level
Up-count
Down-count
Low level
Don’t care
High level
Low level
Legend:
: Rising edge
: Falling edge
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 331 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
4. Phase counting mode 4
Figure 10.29 shows an example of phase counting mode 4 operation, and table 10.23
summarizes the TCNT up/down-count conditions.
TCLKA (channel 1)
TCLKC (channel 2)
TCLKB (channel 1)
TCLKD (channel 2)
TCNT value
Down-count
Up-count
Time
Figure 10.29 Example of Phase Counting Mode 4 Operation
Table 10.23 Up/Down-Count Conditions in Phase Counting Mode 4
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
High level
Operation
Up-count
Low level
Low level
Don’t care
High level
Down-count
High level
Low level
High level
Don’t care
Low level
Legend:
: Rising edge
: Falling edge
Page 332 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.6
Interrupts
10.6.1
Interrupt Source and Priority
There are three kinds of TPU interrupt source: TGR input capture/compare match, TCNT
overflow, and TCNT underflow. Each interrupt source has its own status flag and enable/disabled
bit, allowing generation of interrupt request signals to be enabled or disabled individually. When
an interrupt request is generated, the corresponding status flag in TSR is set to 1. If the
corresponding enable/disable bit in TIER is set to 1 at this time, an interrupt is requested. The
interrupt request is cleared by clearing the status flag to 0. Relative channel priorities can be
changed by the interrupt controller, but the priority order within a channel is fixed. For details, see
section 5, Interrupt Controller. Table 10.24 lists the TPU interrupt sources.
Table 10.24
Channel Name
0
1
2
Note:
*
TPU Interrupts
Interrupt Source
DTC
Activation
DMAC
Activation
Priority*
High
TGI0A
TGFA
TGRA_0 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Possible
TGI0B
TGFB
TGRB_0 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Not possible
TGI0C
TGFC
TGRC_0 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Not possible
TGI0D
TGFD
TGRD_0 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Not possible
TCI0V
TCNT_0 overflow
TGI1A
TGFA
TGRA_1 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Possible
TGI1B
TGFB
TGRB_1 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Not possible
TCI1V
TCNT_1 overflow
TCFV
Not possible Not possible
TCI1U
TCNT_1 underflow
TCFU
Not possible Not possible
TGI2A
TGFA
TGRA_2 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Possible
TGI2B
TGFB
TGRB_2 input
capture/compare match
Possible
Not possible
TCFV
Not possible Not possible
TCI2V
TCNT_2 overflow
TCFV
Not possible Not possible
TCI2U
TCNT_2 underflow
TCFU
Not possible Not possible Low
This table shows the initial state immediately after a reset. The relative channel
priorities
can be changed by the interrupt controller.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Interrupt
Flag
Page 333 of 846
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
H8S/2215 Group
Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupt: An interrupt is requested if the TGIE bit in TIER is
set to 1 when the TGF flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of a TGR input capture/compare
match on a particular channel. The interrupt request is cleared by clearing the TGF flag to 0. The
TPU has 8 input capture/compare match interrupts, four each for channel 0, and two each for
channels 1 and 2.
Overflow Interrupt: An interrupt is requested if the TCIEV bit in TIER is set to 1 when the
TCFV flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of TCNT overflow on a channel. The interrupt
request is cleared by clearing the TCFV flag to 0. The TPU has three overflow interrupts, one for
each channel.
Underflow Interrupt: An interrupt is requested if the TCIEU bit in TIER is set to 1 when the
TCFU flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of TCNT underflow on a channel. The interrupt
request is cleared by clearing the TCFU flag to 0. The TPU has two underflow interrupts, one each
for channels 1 and 2.
10.6.2
DTC Activation
The DTC can be activated by the TGR input capture/compare match interrupt for a channel. For
details, see section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC). A total of 8 TPU input capture/compare
match interrupts can be used as DTC activation sources, four each for channel 0, and two each for
channels 1 and 2.
10.6.3
DMAC Activation
The DMAC can be activated by the TGRA input capture/compare match interrupt for a channel.
For details, see section 7, DMA Controller (DMAC). With the TPU, a total of three TGRA input
capture/compare match interrupts can be used as DMAC activation sources, one for each channel.
10.6.4
A/D Converter Activation
The A/D converter can be activated by the TGRA input capture/compare match for a channel. If
the TTGE bit in TIER is set to 1 when the TGFA flag in TSR is set to 1 by the occurrence of a
TGRA input capture/compare match on a particular channel, a request to start A/D conversion is
sent to the A/D converter. If the TPU conversion start trigger has been selected on the A/D
converter side at this time, A/D conversion is started. In the TPU, a total of three TGRA input
capture/compare match interrupts can be used as A/D converter conversion start sources, one for
each channel.
Page 334 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.7
Operation Timing
10.7.1
Input/Output Timing
TCNT Count Timing: Figure 10.30 shows TCNT count timing in internal clock operation, and
figure 10.31 shows TCNT count timing in external clock operation.
φ
Internal clock
Falling edge
Rising edge
TCNT
input clock
N-1
TCNT
N
N+1
N+2
Figure 10.30 Count Timing in Internal Clock Operation
φ
External clock
Falling edge
Rising edge
Falling edge
TCNT
input clock
N-1
TCNT
N
N+1
N+2
Figure 10.31 Count Timing in External Clock Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 335 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Output Compare Output Timing: A compare match signal is generated in the final state in
which TCNT and TGR match (the point at which the count value matched by TCNT is updated).
When a compare match signal is generated, the output value set in TIOR is output at the output
compare output pin. After a match between TCNT and TGR, the compare match signal is not
generated until the TCNT input clock is generated. Figure 10.32 shows output compare output
timing.
φ
TCNT
input clock
N
TCNT
N+1
N
TGR
Compare
match signal
TIOC pin
Figure 10.32 Output Compare Output Timing
Input Capture Signal Timing: Figure 10.33 shows input capture signal timing.
φ
Input capture
input
Input capture
signal
TCNT
TGR
N
N+1
N+2
N
N+2
Figure 10.33 Input Capture Input Signal Timing
Page 336 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Timing for Counter Clearing by Compare Match/Input Capture: Figure 10.34 shows the
timing when counter clearing by compare match occurrence is specified, and figure 10.35 shows
the timing when counter clearing by input capture occurrence is specified.
φ
Compare
match signal
Counter
clear signal
TCNT
N
TGR
N
H'0000
Figure 10.34 Counter Clear Timing (Compare Match)
φ
Input capture
signal
Counter clear
signal
N
TCNT
H'0000
N
TGR
Figure 10.35 Counter Clear Timing (Input Capture)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 337 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Buffer Operation Timing: Figures 10.36 and 10.37 show the timing in buffer operation.
φ
TCNT
n
n+1
Compare
match signal
TGRA,
TGRB
n
TGRC,
TGRD
N
N
Figure 10.36 Buffer Operation Timing (Compare Match)
φ
Input capture
signal
TCNT
N
TGRA,
TGRB
n
TGRC,
TGRD
N+1
N
N+1
n
N
Figure 10.37 Buffer Operation Timing (Input Capture)
Page 338 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
10.7.2
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Interrupt Signal Timing
TGF Flag Setting Timing in Case of Compare Match: Figure 10.38 shows the timing for
setting of the TGF flag in TSR by compare match occurrence, and TGI interrupt request signal
timing.
φ
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
N
TGR
N
N+1
Compare
match signal
TGF flag
TGI interrupt
Figure 10.38 TGI Interrupt Timing (Compare Match)
TGF Flag Setting Timing in Case of Input Capture: Figure 10.39 shows the timing for setting
of the TGF flag in TSR by input capture occurrence, and TGI interrupt request signal timing.
φ
Input capture
signal
TCNT
N
TGR
N
TGF flag
TGI interrupt
Figure 10.39 TGI Interrupt Timing (Input Capture)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 339 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
TCFV Flag/TCFU Flag Setting Timing: Figure 10.40 shows the timing for setting of the TCFV
flag in TSR by overflow occurrence, and TCIV interrupt request signal timing. Figure 10.41
shows the timing for setting of the TCFU flag in TSR by underflow occurrence, and TCIU
interrupt request signal timing.
φ
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
(overflow)
H'FFFF
H'0000
Overflow
signal
TCFV flag
TCIV interrupt
Figure 10.40 TCIV Interrupt Setting Timing
φ
TCNT
input clock
TCNT
(underflow)
H'0000
H'FFFF
Underflow
signal
TCFU flag
TCIU interrupt
Figure 10.41 TCIU Interrupt Setting Timing
Page 340 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Status Flag Clearing Timing: After a status flag is read as 1 by the CPU, it is cleared by writing
0 to it. When the DTC or DMAC is activated, the flag is cleared automatically. Figure 10.42
shows the timing for status flag clearing by the CPU, and figure 10.43 shows the timing for status
flag clearing by the DTC or DMAC.
TSR write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
TSR address
Write signal
Status flag
Interrupt
request
signal
Figure 10.42 Timing for Status Flag Clearing by CPU
DTC/DMAC
read cycle
T1
T2
DTC/DMAC
write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
Source address
Destination
address
Status flag
Interrupt
request
signal
Figure 10.43 Timing for Status Flag Clearing by DTC or DMAC Activation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 341 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
10.8
Usage Notes
Input Clock Restrictions: The input clock pulse width must be at least 1.5 states in the case of
single-edge detection, and at least 2.5 states in the case of both-edge detection. The TPU will not
operate properly with a narrower pulse width. In phase counting mode, the phase difference and
overlap between the two input clocks must be at least 1.5 states, and the pulse width must be at
least 2.5 states. Figure 10.44 shows the input clock conditions in phase counting mode.
Overlap
Phase
Phase
differdifferOverlap
ence
ence
Pulse width
Pulse width
TCLKA
(TCLKC)
TCLKB
(TCLKD)
Pulse width
Pulse width
Notes: Phase difference and overlap : 1.5 states or more
Pulse width
: 2.5 states or more
Figure 10.44 Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Counting Mode
Caution on Period Setting: When counter clearing by compare match is set, TCNT is cleared in
the final state in which it matches the TGR value (the point at which the count value matched by
TCNT is updated). Consequently, the actual counter frequency is given by the following formula:
φ
f = ————
(N + 1)
Where f : Counter frequency
φ : Operating frequency
N : TGR set value
Page 342 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Contention between TCNT Write and Clear Operations: If the counter clear signal is
generated in the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, TCNT clearing takes precedence and the TCNT
write is not performed. Figure 10.45 shows the timing in this case.
TCNT write cycle
T2
T1
φ
TCNT address
Address
Write signal
Counter clear
signal
TCNT
N
H'0000
Figure 10.45 Contention between TCNT Write and Clear Operations
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment Operations: If incrementing occurs in the T2
state of a TCNT write cycle, the TCNT write takes precedence and TCNT is not incremented.
Figure 10.46 shows the timing in this case.
TCNT write cycle
T2
T1
φ
TCNT address
Address
Write signal
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
N
M
TCNT write data
Figure 10.46 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment Operations
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 343 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Contention between TGR Write and Compare Match: If a compare match occurs in the T2
state of a TGR write cycle, the TGR write takes precedence and the compare match signal is
inhibited. A compare match does not occur even if the same value as before is written. Figure
10.47 shows the timing in this case.
TGR write cycle
T2
T1
φ
TGR address
Address
Write signal
Compare
match signal
Prohibited
TCNT
N
N+1
TGR
N
M
TGR write data
Figure 10.47 Contention between TGR Write and Compare Match
Page 344 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match: If a compare match occurs in
the T2 state of a TGR write cycle, the data transferred to TGR by the buffer operation will be the
data prior to the write. Figure 10.48 shows the timing in this case.
TGR write cycle
T2
T1
φ
Buffer register
address
Address
Write signal
Compare
match signal
Buffer register write data
Buffer
register
N
M
N
TGR
Figure 10.48 Contention between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match
Contention between TGR Read and Input Capture: If the input capture signal is generated in
the T1 state of a TGR read cycle, the data that is read will be the data after input capture transfer.
Figure 10.49 shows the timing in this case.
TGR read cycle
T2
T1
φ
TGR address
Address
Read signal
Input capture
signal
TGR
X
Internal
data bus
M
M
Figure 10.49 Contention between TGR Read and Input Capture
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 345 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Contention between TGR Write and Input Capture: If the input capture signal is generated in
the T2 state of a TGR write cycle, the input capture operation takes precedence and the write to
TGR is not performed. Figure 10.50 shows the timing in this case.
TGR write cycle
T2
T1
φ
Address
TGR address
Write signal
Input capture
signal
TCNT
TGR
M
M
Figure 10.50 Contention between TGR Write and Input Capture
Page 346 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture: If the input capture signal is
generated in the T2 state of a buffer register write cycle, the buffer operation takes precedence and
the write to the buffer register is not performed. Figure 10.51 shows the timing in this case.
Buffer register write cycle
T2
T1
φ
Buffer register
address
Address
Write signal
Input capture
signal
TCNT
N
M
TGR
Buffer
register
N
M
Figure 10.51 Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture
Contention between Overflow/Underflow and Counter Clearing: If overflow/underflow and
counter clearing occur simultaneously, the TCFV/TCFU flag in TSR is not set and TCNT clearing
takes precedence. Figure 10.52 shows the operation timing when a TGR compare match is
specified as the clearing source, and H'FFFF is set in TGR.
φ
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
H'FFFF
H'0000
Counter
clear signal
TGF flag
Prohibited
TCFV flag
Figure 10.52 Contention between Overflow and Counter Clearing
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 347 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 10 16-Bit Timer Pulse Unit (TPU)
Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow/Underflow: If there is an up-count or downcount in the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, and overflow/underflow occurs, the TCNT write takes
precedence and the TCFV/TCFU flag in TSR is not set. Figure 10.53 shows the operation timing
when there is contention between TCNT write and overflow.
TCNT write cycle
T2
T1
φ
Address
TCNT address
Write signal
TCNT
TCFV flag
TCNT write data
H'FFFF
M
Prohibited
Figure 10.53 Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow
Multiplexing of I/O Pins: In this LSI, the TCLKA input pin is multiplexed with the TIOCC0 I/O
pin, the TCLKB input pin with the TIOCD0 I/O pin, the TCLKC input pin with the TIOCB1 I/O
pin, and the TCLKD input pin with the TIOCB2 I/O pin. When an external clock is input,
compare match output should not be performed from a multiplexed pin.
Interrupts and Module Stop Mode: If module stop mode is entered when an interrupt has been
requested, it will not be possible to clear the CPU interrupt source or the DTC activation source.
Interrupts should therefore be disabled before entering module stop mode.
Module Stop Mode Setting: TPU operation can be disabled or enabled using the module stop
control register. The initial setting is for TPU operation to be halted. Register access is enabled by
clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 22, Power-Down Modes.
Page 348 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
This LIS includes an 8-bit timer module with two channels. Each channel has an 8-bit counter and
two registers that are constantly compared with the TCNT value to detect compare match events.
The 8-bit timer module can thus be used for a variety of functions, including pulse output with an
arbitrary duty cycle.
11.1
Features
The features of the 8-bit timer module are listed below.
• Selection of four clock sources
⎯ The counters can be driven by one of three internal clock signals (φ/8, φ/64, or φ/8192) or
an external clock input (enabling use as an external event counter).
• Selection of three ways to clear the counters
⎯ The counters can be cleared on compare match A or B, or by an external reset signal.
• Timer output control by a combination of two compare match signals
⎯ The timer output signal in each channel is controlled by a combination of two independent
compare match signals, enabling the timer to generate output waveforms with an arbitrary
duty cycle or PWM output.
• Provision for cascading of two channels
⎯ Operation as a 16-bit timer is possible, using channel 0 (TMR_0) for the upper 8 bits and
channel 1 (TMR_1) for the lower 8 bits (16-bit count mode).
⎯ Channel 1 (TMR_1) can be used to count channel 0 (TMR_0) compare matches (compare
match count mode).
• Three independent interrupts
⎯ Compare match A and B and overflow interrupts can be requested independently.
• A/D converter conversion start trigger can be generated
⎯ Channel 0 compare match A signal can be used as an A/D converter conversion start
trigger.
⎯ Module stop mode can be set
Figure 11.1 shows a block diagram of the 8-bit timer module (TMR_0 and TMR_1).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 349 of 846
TIMH220A_000020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
External clock source
TMCI01
Internal clock sources
φ/8
φ/64
φ/8192
Clock select
Clock 1
Clock 0
TCORA_0
TCORA_1
Compare match A1
Compare match A0 Comparator A_0
Overflow 1
Overflow 0
TMO0
TMRI01
TCNT_0
Comparator A_1
TCNT_1
Clear 0
TMO1
Control logic
Compare match B1
Compare match B0 Comparator B_0
A/D
conversion
start request
signal
Internal bus
Clear 1
Comparator B_1
TCORB_0
TCORB_1
TCSR_0
TCSR_1
TCR_0
TCR_1
CMIA0
CMIB0
OVI0
CMIA1
CMIB1
OVI1
Interrupt signals
Legend:
TCORA_0:
TCORB_0:
TCNT_0:
TCSR_0:
TCR_0:
Time constant register A_0
Time constant register B_0
Timer counter_0
Timer control/status register_0
Timer control register_0
TCORA_1:
TCORB_1:
TCNT_1:
TCSR_1:
TCR_1:
Time constant register A_1
Time constant register B_1
Timer counter_1
Timer control/status register_1
Timer control register_1
Figure 11.1 Block Diagram of 8-Bit Timer
Page 350 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11.2
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Input/Output Pins
Table 11.1 summarizes the input and output pins of the TMR.
Table 11.1 Pin Configuration
Channel
Name
Symbol
I/O
Function
0
Timer output pin 0
TMO0
Output
Outputs at compare match
1
Timer output pin 1
TMO1
Output
Outputs at compare match
All
Timer clock input pin 01
TMCI01
Input
Inputs external clock for counter
Timer reset input pin 01
TMRI01
Input
Inputs external reset to counter
11.3
Register Descriptions
The TMR registers are listed below. For details on the module stop control register, refer to
section 22.1.2, Module Stop Registers A to C (MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC).
• Timer counter (TCNT)
• Time constant register A (TCORA)
• Time constant register B (TCORB)
• Timer control register (TCR)
• Timer control/status register (TCSR)
11.3.1
Timer Counters (TCNT)
The TCNT registers are 8-bit up-counters. TCNT_0 and TCNT_1 comprise a single 16-bit register
so they can be accessed together by a word transfer instruction. Bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCR are
used to select a clock. The TCNT counters can be cleared by an external reset input or by a
compare match signal A or B. Which signal is to be used for clearing is selected by bits CCLR1
and CCLR0 in TCR. When a TCNT counter overflows from H'FF to H'00, OVF in TCSR is set to
1. The TCNT counters are each initialized to H'00.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 351 of 846
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.3.2
H8S/2215 Group
Time Constant Registers A (TCORA)
The TCORA_0 and TCORA_1 registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers. TCORA_0 and
TCORA_1 comprise a single 16-bit register so they can be accessed together by a word transfer
instruction. The value in TCORA is continually compared with the value in TCNT. When a match
is detected, the corresponding CMFA flag in TCSR is set to 1. Note, however, that comparison is
disabled during the T2 state of a TCOR write cycle. The timer output (TMO) can be freely
controlled by these compare match signals and the settings of bits OS1 and OS0 in TCSR.
TCORA_0 and TCORA_1 are each initialized to H'FF.
11.3.3
Time Constant Registers B (TCORB)
The TCORB_0 registers are 8-bit readable/writable registers. TCORB_0 and TCORB_1 comprise
a single 16-bit register so they can be accessed together by a word transfer instruction. TCORB is
continually compared with the value in TCNT. When a match is detected, the corresponding
CMFB flag in TCSR is set to 1. Note, however, that comparison is disabled during the T2 state of a
TCOR write cycle. The timer output can be freely controlled by these compare match signals and
the settings of output select bits OS3 and OS2 in TCSR. TCORB_0 and TCORB_1 are each
initialized to H'FF.
Page 352 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11.3.4
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Time Control Registers (TCR)
The TCR registers select the clock source and the time at which TCNT is cleared, and enable
interrupts.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
CMIEB
0
R/W
Compare Match Interrupt Enable B
Selects whether CMFB interrupt requests (CMIB) are
enabled or disabled when the CMFB flag in TCSR is
set to 1.
0: CMFB interrupt requests (CMIB) are disabled
1: CMFB interrupt requests (CMIB) are enabled
6
CMIEA
0
R/W
Compare Match Interrupt Enable A
Selects whether CMFA interrupt requests (CMIA) are
enabled or disabled when the CMFA flag in TCSR is
set to 1.
0: CMFA interrupt requests (CMIA) are disabled
1: CMFA interrupt requests (CMIA) are enabled
5
OVIE
0
R/W
Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable
Selects whether OVF interrupt requests (OVI) are
enabled or disabled when the OVF flag in TCSR is set
to 1.
0: OVF interrupt requests (OVI) are disabled
1: OVF interrupt requests (OVI) are enabled
4
3
CCLR1
CCLR0
0
0
R/W
R/W
Counter Clear 1 and 0
These bits select the method by which TCNT is
cleared.
00: Clear is disabled
01: Clear by compare match A
10: Clear by compare match B
11: Clear by rising edge of external reset input
2
1
0
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
0
0
0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R/W
R/W
R/W
Clock Select 2 to 0
These bits select the clock input to TCNT and count
condition. See table 11.2.
Page 353 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Table 11.2 Clock Input to TCNT and Count Condition
TCR
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Channel
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
Description
TMR_0
0
0
1
TMR_1
All
Note:
11.3.5
*
0
Clock input disabled
1
Internal clock, counted at falling edge of φ/8
0
Internal clock, counted at falling edge of φ/64
1
1
0
0
Internal clock, counted at falling edge of φ/8192
Count at TCNT1 overflow signal*
0
0
0
Clock input disabled
1
Internal clock, counted at falling edge of φ/8
1
0
Internal clock, counted at falling edge of φ/64
1
Internal clock, counted at falling edge of φ/8192
1
0
0
Count at TCNT0 compare match A*
1
0
1
External clock, counted at rising edge
1
0
External clock, counted at falling edge
1
1
External clock, counted at both rising and falling
edges
If the count input of TMR_0 is the TCNT_1 overflow signal and that of TMR_1 is the
TCNT_0 compare match signal, no incrementing clock is generated. This setting is
prohibited.
Timer Control/Status Registers (TCSR)
The TCSR registers display status flags, and control compare match output.
Page 354 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
7
CMFB
0
R/(W)* Compare Match Flag B
0
[Setting condition]
• Set when TCNT matches TCORB
[Clearing conditions]
• Cleared by reading CMFB when CMFB = 1, then
writing 0 to CMFB
• When DTC is activated by CMIB interrupt, while
DISEL bit is 0, and transfer counter value is not 0
R/(W)* Compare Match Flag A
0
[Setting condition]
• Set when TCNT matches TCORA
[Clearing conditions]
• Cleared by reading CMFA when CMFA = 1, then
writing 0 to CMFA
• When DTC is activated by CMIA interrupt, while
DISEL bit is 0, and transfer counter value is not 0
*
R/(W) Timer Overflow Flag
6
5
CMFA
OVF
Description
[Setting condition]
• Set when TCNT overflows from H'FF to H'00
[Clearing condition]
• Cleared by reading OVF when OVF = 1, then
writing 0 to OVF
4
ADTE
0
R/W
A/D Trigger Enable (only in channel 0)
Selects enabling or disabling of A/D converter start
requests by compare match A.
This bit is reserved in channel 1. Always read as 1, and
cannot be modified.
0: A/D converter start requests by compare match A are
disabled
1: A/D converter start requests by compare match A are
enabled
3
2
OS3
OS2
0
0
R/W
R/W
Output Select 3 and 2
These bits select a method of TMO pin output when
compare match B of TCOR and TCNT occurs.
00: No change when compare match B occurs
01: 0 is output when compare match B occurs
10: 1 is output when compare match B occurs
11: Output is inverted when compare match B occurs
(toggle output)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 355 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
1
0
OS1
OS0
0
0
R/W
R/W
Output Select 1 and 0
These bits select a method of TMO pin output when
compare match A of TCOR and TCNT occurs.
00: No change when compare match A occurs
01: 0 is output when compare match A occurs
10: 1 is output when compare match A occurs
11: Output is inverted when compare match A occurs
(toggle output)
Note:
The write value should always be 0 to clear these flags.
*
11.4
Operation
11.4.1
Pulse Output
Figure 11.2 shows an example that the 8-bit timer is used to generate a pulse output with a
selected duty cycle. The control bits are set as follows:
1. In TCR, bit CCLR1 is cleared to 0 and bit CCLR0 is set to 1 so that the timer counter is
cleared at a TCORA compare match.
2. In TCSR, bits OS3 to OS0 are set to B'0110, causing the output to change to 1 at a TCORA
compare match and to 0 at a TCORB compare match.
With these settings, the 8-bit timer provides output of pulses at a rate determined by TCORA with
a pulse width determined by TCORB. No software intervention is required.
TCNT
H'FF
Counter clear
TCORA
TCORB
H'00
TMO
Figure 11.2 Example of Pulse Output
Page 356 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.5
Operation Timing
11.5.1
TCNT Incrementation Timing
Figure 11.3 shows the count timing for internal clock input. Figure 11.4 shows the count timing
for external clock signal. Note that the external clock pulse width must be at least 1.5 states for
incrementation at a single edge, and at least 2.5 states for incrementation at both edges. The
counter will not increment correctly if the pulse width is less than these values.
φ
Internal clock
Clock input
to TCNT
TCNT
N–1
N
N+1
Figure 11.3 Count Timing for Internal Clock Input
φ
External clock
input
Clock input
to TCNT
TCNT
N–1
N
N+1
Figure 11.4 Count Timing for External Clock Input
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 357 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.5.2
Setting of Compare Match Flags CMFA and CMFB
The CMFA and CMFB flags in TCSR are set to 1 by a compare match signal generated when the
TCOR and TCNT values match. The compare match signal is generated at the last state in which
the match is true, just before the timer counter is updated. Therefore, when TCOR and TCNT
match, the compare match signal is not generated until the next incrementation clock input. Figure
11.5 shows this timing.
φ
TCNT
N
TCOR
N
N+1
Compare match
signal
CMF
Figure 11.5 Timing of CMF Setting
11.5.3
Timer Output Timing
When compare match A or B occurs, the timer output changes as specified by bits OS3 to OS0 in
TCSR. Figure 11.6 shows the timing when the output is set to toggle at compare match A.
φ
Compare match A
signal
Timer output pin
Figure 11.6 Timing of Timer Output
Page 358 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11.5.4
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Timing of Compare Match Clear
The timer counter is cleared when compare match A or B occurs, depending on the setting of the
CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR. Figure 11.7 shows the timing of this operation.
φ
Compare match
signal
TCNT
N
H'00
Figure 11.7 Timing of Compare Match Clear
11.5.5
Timing of TCNT External Reset
TCNT is cleared at the rising edge of an external reset input, depending on the settings of the
CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR. The clear pulse width must be at least 1.5 states. Figure 11.8
shows the timing of this operation.
φ
External reset
input pin
Clear signal
TCNT
N–1
N
H'00
Figure 11.8 Timing of Clearance by External Reset
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 359 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.5.6
Timing of Overflow Flag (OVF) Setting
The OVF in TCSR is set to 1 when TCNT overflows (changes from H'FF to H'00).
Figure 11.9 shows the timing of this operation.
φ
TCNT
H'FF
H'00
Overflow signal
OVF
Figure 11.9 Timing of OVF Setting
Page 360 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11.6
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Operation with Cascaded Connection
If bits CKS2 to CKS0 in either TCR_0 or TCR_1 are set to B'100, the 8-bit timers of the two
channels are cascaded. With this configuration, a single 16-bit timer could be used (16-bit counter
mode) or compare matches of the 8-bit channel 0 could be counted by the timer of channel 1
(compare match count mode). In this case, the timer operates as below.
11.6.1
16-Bit Counter Mode
When bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCR_0 are set to B'100, the timer functions as a single 16-bit timer
with channel 0 occupying the upper 8 bits and channel 1 occupying the lower 8 bits.
• Setting of compare match flags
⎯ The CMF flag in TCSR_0 is set to 1 when a 16-bit compare match event occurs.
⎯ The CMF flag in TCSR_1 is set to 1 when a lower 8-bit compare match event occurs.
• Counter clear specification
⎯ If the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR_0 have been set for counter clear at compare match,
the 16-bit counters (TCNT_0 and TCNT_1 together) are cleared when a 16-bit compare
match event occurs. The 16-bit counters (TCNT0 and TCNT1 together) are cleared even if
counter clear by the TMRI0 pin has also been set.
⎯ The settings of the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR_1 are ignored. The lower 8 bits cannot
be cleared independently.
• Pin output
⎯ Control of output from the TMO0 pin by bits OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_0 is in accordance with
the 16-bit compare match conditions.
⎯ Control of output from the TMO1 pin by bits OS3 to OS0 in TCSR_1 is in accordance with
the lower 8-bit compare match conditions.
11.6.2
Compare Match Count Mode
When bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCR_1 are B'100, TCNT_1 counts compare match A’s for channel
0. Channels 0 and 1 are controlled independently. Conditions such as setting of the CMF flag,
generation of interrupts, output from the TMO pin, and counter clear are in accordance with the
settings for each channel.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 361 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.7
Interrupts
11.7.1
Interrupt Sources and DTC Activation
There are three 8-bit timer interrupt sources: CMIA, CMIB, and OVI. Their relative priorities are
shown in table 11.3. Each interrupt source is set as enabled or disabled by the corresponding
interrupt enable bit in TCR or TCSR, and independent interrupt requests are sent for each to the
interrupt controller. It is also possible to activate the DTC by means of CMIA and CMIB
interrupts.
Table 11.3 8-Bit Timer Interrupt Sources
Channel
0
1
Note:
*
Name
Interrupt Source
Interrupt
Flag
DTC Activation
Priority*
High
CMIA0
TCORA_0 compare match
CMFA
Possible
CMIB0
TCORB_0 compare match
CMFB
Possible
OVI0
TCNT_0 overflow
OVF
Not possible
CMIA1
TCORA_1 compare match
CMFA
Possible
CMIB1
TCORB_1 compare match
CMFB
Possible
OVI1
TCNT_1 overflow
OVF
Not possible
Low
This table shows the initial state immediately after a reset. The relative channel
priorities can be changed by the interrupt controller.
Page 362 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11.7.2
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
A/D Converter Activation
The A/D converter can be activated only by TMR_0 compare match A. If the ADTE bit in TCSR0
is set to 1 when the CMFA flag is set to 1 by the occurrence of TMR_0 compare match A, a
request to start A/D conversion is sent to the A/D converter. If the 8-bit timer conversion start
trigger has been selected on the A/D converter side at this time, A/D conversion is started.
11.8
Usage Notes
11.8.1
Contention between TCNT Write and Clear
If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the clear
takes priority, so that the counter is cleared and the write is not performed. Figure 11.10 shows this
operation.
TCNT write cycle by CPU
T1
T2
φ
Address
TCNT address
Internal write signal
Counter clear signal
TCNT
N
H'00
Figure 11.10 Contention between TCNT Write and Clear
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 363 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.8.2
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment
If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the write
takes priority and the counter is not incremented. Figure 11.11 shows this operation.
TCNT write cycle by CPU
T1
T2
φ
Address
TCNT address
Internal write signal
TCNT input clock
TCNT
N
M
Counter write data
Figure 11.11 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment
Page 364 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
11.8.3
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Contention between TCOR Write and Compare Match
During the T2 state of a TCOR write cycle, the TCOR write has priority and the compare match
signal is prohibited even if a compare match event occurs. Figure 11.12 shows this operation.
TCOR write cycle by CPU
T1
T2
φ
Address
TCOR address
Internal write signal
TCNT
N
N+1
TCOR
N
M
TCOR write data
Compare match signal
Prohibited
Figure 11.12 Contention between TCOR Write and Compare Match
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 365 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
11.8.4
Contention between Compare Matches A and B
If compare match events A and B occur at the same time, the 8-bit timer operates in accordance
with the priorities for the output statuses set for compare match A and compare match B, as shown
in table 11.4.
Table 11.4 Timer Output Priorities
Output Setting
Priority
Toggle output
High
1 output
0 output
No change
11.8.5
Low
Switching of Internal Clocks and TCNT Operation
TCNT may increment erroneously when the internal clock is switched over. Table 11.5 shows the
relationship between the timing at which the internal clock is switched (by writing to the CKS1
and CKS0 bits) and the TCNT operation.
When the TCNT clock is generated from an internal clock, the falling edge of the internal clock
pulse is detected. If clock switching causes a change from high to low level, as shown in case 3 in
table 11.5, a TCNT clock pulse is generated on the assumption that the switchover is a falling
edge. This increments TCNT.
The erroneous incrementation can also happen when switching between internal and external
clocks.
Page 366 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
Table 11.5 Switching of Internal Clock and TCNT Operation
No.
1
Timing of Switchover
by Means of CKS1
and CKS0 Bits
TCNT Clock Operation
Switching from
1
low to low*
Clock before
switchover
Clock after
switchover
TCNT clock
TCNT
N
N+1
CKS bit rewrite
2
Switching from
2
low to high*
Clock before
switchover
Clock after
switchover
TCNT clock
TCNT
N
N+1
N+2
CKS bit rewrite
3
Switching from
3
high to low*
Clock before
switchover
Clock after
switchover
*4
TCNT clock
TCNT
N
N+1
N+2
CKS bit rewrite
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 367 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 11 8-Bit Timers (TMR)
No.
4
Timing of Switchover
by Means of CKS1
and CKS0 Bits
TCNT Clock Operation
Switching from high
to high
Clock before
switchover
Clock after
switchover
TCNT clock
TCNT
N
N+1
N+2
CKS bit rewrite
Notes: 1.
2.
3.
4.
11.8.6
Includes switching from low to stop, and from stop to low.
Includes switching from stop to high.
Includes switching from high to stop.
Generated on the assumption that the switchover is a falling edge; TCNT is
incremented.
Mode Setting with Cascaded Connection
If 16-bit counter mode and compare match count mode are specified at the same time, input clocks
for TCNT_0 and TCNT_1 are not generated, and the counter stops. Do not specify 16-bit counter
and compare match count modes simultaneously.
11.8.7
Module Stop Mode Setting
Operation of the TMR can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The
initial setting is for operation of the TMR to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing
module stop mode. For details, refer to section 22, Power-Down Modes.
Page 368 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
The watchdog timer (WDT) is an 8-bit timer that can generate an internal reset signal for this LSI
if a system crash prevents the CPU from writing to the timer counter, thus allowing it to overflow.
When this watchdog function is not needed, the WDT can be used as an interval timer. In interval
timer operation, an interval timer interrupt is generated each time the counter overflows.
The block diagram of the WDT is shown in figure 12.1.
12.1
Features
• Selectable from eight counter input clocks
• Switchable between watchdog timer mode and interval timer mode
In watchdog timer mode
• If the counter overflows, it is possible to select whether this LSI is internally reset or not.
In interval timer mode
• If the counter overflows, the WDT generates an interval timer interrupt (WOVI).
Internal reset signal*
Interrupt
control
Clock
Clock
select
Reset
control
RSTCSR
TCNT
φ/2
φ/64
φ/128
φ/512
φ/2048
φ/8192
φ/32768
φ/131072
Internal clock
sources
TCSR
Module bus
Bus
interface
Internal bus
Overflow
WOVI
(interrupt request
signal)
WDT
Legend:
Timer control/status register
TCSR:
Timer counter
TCNT:
RSTCSR: Reset control/status register
Note: * The type of internal reset signal depends on a register setting.
Figure 12.1 Block Diagram of WDT
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 369 of 846
WDT0104A_000020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
12.2
Register Descriptions
The WDT has the following three registers. For details, refer to section 23, List of Registers. To
prevent accidental overwriting, TCSR, TCNT, and RSTCSR have to be written to by a different
method to normal registers. For details, refer to section 12.5.1, Notes on Register Access.
• Timer counter (TCNT)
• Timer control/status register (TCSR)
• Reset control/status register (RSTCSR)
12.2.1
Timer Counter (TCNT)
TCNT is an 8-bit readable/writable up-counter. TCNT is initialized to H'00 by a reset, when the
TME bit in TCSR is cleared to 0.
12.2.2
Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)
TCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register. Its functions include selecting the clock source to be
input to TCNT, and selecting the timer mode.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
OVF
0
R/(W)*
Overflow Flag
Indicates that TCNT has overflowed. Only a write
of 0 is permitted, to clear the flag.
[Setting condition]
•
When TCNT overflows (changes from H'FF to
H'00)
When internal reset request generation is
selected in watchdog timer mode, OVF is cleared
automatically by the internal reset.
[Clearing condition]
•
Cleared by reading TCSR when OVF = 1,
then writing 0 to OVF
When polling CVF when the interval timer
interrupt has been prohibited, OVF = 1 status
should be read two or more times.
Page 370 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
6
WT/IT
0
R/W
Timer Mode Select
Selects whether the WDT is used as a watchdog
timer or interval timer.
0: Interval timer mode
1: Watchdog timer mode
5
TME
0
R/W
Timer Enable
When this bit is set to 1, TCNT starts counting.
When this bit is cleared, TCNT stops counting
and is initialized to H'00.
4, 3
—
All 1
—
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be
modified.
2
CKS2
0
R/W
Clock Select 2 to 0
1
CKS1
0
R/W
0
CKS0
0
R/W
Selects the clock source to be input to TCNT. The
overflow frequency for φ = 16 MHz is enclosed in
parentheses.
000: Clock φ/2 (frequency: 32.0 μs)
001: Clock φ/64 (frequency: 1.0 ms)
010: Clock φ/128 (frequency: 2.0 ms)
011: Clock φ/512 (frequency: 8.2 ms)
100: Clock φ/2048 (frequency: 32.8 ms)
101: Clock φ/8192 (frequency: 131.1 ms)
110: Clock φ/32768 (frequency: 524.3 ms)
111: Clock φ/131072 (frequency: 2.1 s)
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 371 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
12.2.3
Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR)
RSTCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the generation of the internal reset
signal when TCNT overflows, and selects the type of internal reset signal. RSTCSR is initialized
to H'1F by a reset signal from the RES pin, and not by the WDT internal reset signal caused by
overflows.
Bit
7
Bit Name
WOVF
Initial Value
R/W
Description
0
R/(W)*
Watchdog Overflow Flag
This bit is set when TCNT overflows in watchdog
timer mode. This bit cannot be set in interval timer
mode, and the write value should always be 0.
[Setting condition]
•
Set when TCNT overflows (changed from
H'FF to H'00) in watchdog timer mode
[Clearing condition]
•
6
RSTE
0
R/W
Cleared by reading RSTCSR when WOVF =
1, and then writing 0 to WOVF
Reset Enable
Specifies whether or not a reset signal is
generated in the chip if TCNT overflows during
watchdog timer operation.
0: Reset signal is not generated even if TCNT
overflows
(Though this LSI is not reset, TCNT and
TCSR in WDT are reset)
1: Reset signal is generated if TCNT overflows
5
RSTS
0
R/W
Reset Select
Selects the type of internal reset generated if
TCNT overflows during watchdog timer operation.
0: Power-on reset
1: Setting prohibited
4 to 0 —
All 1
—
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be
modified.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
Page 372 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
12.3
Operation
12.3.1
Watchdog Timer Mode
To use the WDT as a watchdog timer, set the WT/IT bit in TCSR and the TME bit to 1.
TCNT does not overflow while the system is operating normally. Software must prevent TCNT
overflows by rewriting the TCNT value (normally be writing H'00) before overflows occurs.
When the RSTE bit of the RSTCSR is set to 1, and if the TCNT overflows, an internal reset signal
for this LSI is issued. In this case, select power-on reset or manual reset by setting the RSTS bit of
the RSTCSR to 0.
If a reset caused by a signal input to the RES pin occurs at the same time as a reset caused by a
WDT overflow, the RES pin reset has priority and the WOVF bit in RSTCSR is cleared to 0. The
internal reset signal is output for 518 states.
When the TCNT overflows in watchdog timer mode, the WOVF bit of the RSTCSR is set to 1. If
the RSTE bit of the RSTCSR has been set to 1, an internal reset signal for the entire LSI is
generated at TCNT overflow.
TCNT value
Overflow
H'FF
Time
H'00
WT/IT = 1
TME = 1
H'00 written
to TCNT
WOVF = 1
Internal reset
generated
WT/IT = 1 H'00 written
TME = 1 to TCNT
Internal reset signal*
518 states (WDT0)
Legend:
WT/IT: Timer mode select bit
TME: Timer enable bit
Note: * With WDT0, the internal reset signal is generated only when the RSTE bit is set to 1.
Figure 12.2 Operation in Watchdog Timer Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 373 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
12.3.2
Timing of Setting of Watchdog Timer Overflow Flag (WOVF)
With WDT0, the WOVF bit in RSTCSR is set to 1 if TCNT overflows in watchdog timer mode. If
TCNT overflows while the RSTE bit in RSTCSR is set to 1, an internal reset signal is generated
for the entire chip. This timing is illustrated in figure 12.3.
φ
TCNT
H'FF
H'00
Overflow signal
(internal signal)
WOVF
Internal reset
signal
518 states (WDT0)
Figure 12.3 Timing of WOVF Setting
Page 374 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
12.3.3
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Interval Timer Mode
To use the WDT as an interval timer, clear bit WT/IT in TCSR to 0 and set bit TME to 1. When
the interval timer is operating, an interval timer interrupt (WOVI) is generated each time the
TCNT overflows. Therefore, an interrupt can be generated at intervals.
TCNT count
Overflow
H'FF
Overflow
Overflow
Overflow
Time
H'00
WT/IT = 0
TME = 1
WOVI
WOVI
WOVI
WOVI
Legend:
WOVI: Interval interrupt request generation
Figure 12.4 Operation in Interval Timer Mode
12.3.4
Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF)
The OVF flag is set to 1 if TCNT overflows during interval timer operation. At the same time, an
interval timer interrupt (WOVI) is requested. This timing is shown in figure 12.5.
φ
TCNT
H'FF
H'00
Overflow signal
(internal signal)
OVF
Figure 12.5 Timing of OVF Setting
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 375 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
12.4
Interrupts
During interval timer mode operation, an overflow generates an interval timer interrupt (WOVI).
The interval timer interrupt is requested whenever the OVF flag is set to 1 in TCSR. OVF must be
cleared to 0 in the interrupt handling routine.
Table 12.1 WDT Interrupt Source
Name
Interrupt Source
Interrupt Flag
DTC Activation
WOVI
TCNT overflow
WOVF
Impossible
12.5
Usage Notes
12.5.1
Notes on Register Access
The watchdog timer’s TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR registers differ from other registers in being
more difficult to write to. The procedures for writing to and reading these registers are given
below.
Writing to TCNT and TCSR: These registers must be written to by a word transfer instruction.
They cannot be written to with byte transfer instructions. Figure 12.6 shows the format of data
written to TCNT and TCSR.
TCNT and TCSR both have the same write address. For a write to TCNT, the upper byte of the
written word must contain H'5A and the lower byte must contain the write data. For a write to
TCSR, the upper byte of the written word must contain H'A5 and the lower byte must contain the
write data. This transfers the write data from the lower byte to TCNT or TCSR.
TCNT write
15
8 7
H'5A
Address: H'FF74
0
Write data
TCSR write
15
Address: H'FF74
8 7
H'A5
0
Write data
Figure 12.6 Format of Data Written to TCNT and TCSR
Page 376 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Writing to RSTCSR: RSTCSR must be written to by a word transfer to address H'FF76. It cannot
be written to with byte instructions. Figure 12.7 shows the format of data written to RSTCSR. The
method of writing 0 to the WOVF bit differs from that for writing to the RSTE and RSTS bits.
To write 0 to the WOVF bit, the upper byte of the written word must contain H'A5 and the lower
byte must contain H'00. This clears the WOVF bit to 0, but has no effect on the RSTE and RSTS
bits. To write to the RSTE and RSTS bits, the upper byte must contain H'5A and the lower byte
must contain the write data. This writes the values in bits 6 and 5 of the lower byte into the RSTE
and RSTS bits, but has no effect on the WOVF bit.
Writing 0 to WOVF bit
15
8 7
H'A5
Address: H'FF76
0
H'00
Write to RSTE, RSTS bits
15
Address: H'FF76
8 7
H'5A
0
Write data
Figure 12.7 Format of Data Written to RSTCSR (Example of WDT0)
Reading from TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR: TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR are read by using the
same method as for the general registers. TCSR, TCNT, and RSTCSR are allocated in addresses
H'FF74, H'FF75, and H'FF77 respectively.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 377 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
12.5.2
Contention between Timer Counter (TCNT) Write and Increment
If a timer counter clock pulse is generated during the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, the write
takes priority and the timer counter is not incremented. Figure 12.8 shows this operation.
TCNT write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
Internal write
signal
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
N
M
Counter write data
Figure 12.8 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment
12.5.3
Changing Value of CKS2 to CKS0
If bits CKS0 to CKS2 in TCSR are written to while the WDT is operating, errors could occur in
the incrementation. Software must be used to stop the watchdog timer (by clearing the TME bit to
0) before changing the value of bits CKS0 to CKS2.
12.5.4
Switching between Watchdog Timer Mode and Interval Timer Mode
If the mode is switched from watchdog timer to interval timer while the WDT is operating, errors
could occur in the incrementation. Software must be used to stop the watchdog timer (by clearing
the TME bit to 0) before switching the mode.
Page 378 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
12.5.5
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Internal Reset in Watchdog Timer Mode
This LSI is not reset internally if TCNT overflows while the RSTE bit is cleared to 0 during
watchdog timer operation, however TCNT and TCSR of the WDT are reset.
TCNT, TCSR, or RSTCR cannot be written to for 132 states following an overflow. During this
period, any attempt to read the WOVF flag is not acknowledged. Accordingly, wait 132 states
after overflow to write 0 to the WOVF flag for clearing.
12.5.6
OVF Flag Clearing in Interval Timer Mode
When the OVF flag setting conflicts with the OVF flag reading in interval timer mode, writing 0
to the OVF flag may not clear the flag even though the OVF flag has been read while it is 1. If
there is a possibility that the OVF flag setting and reading will conflict, such as when the OVF
flag is polled with the interval timer interrupt disabled, read the OVF flag while it is 1 at least
twice before writing 0 to the OVF flag to clear the flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 379 of 846
Section 12 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Page 380 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
This LSI has three independent serial communication interface (SCI) channels. The SCI can
handle both asynchronous and clocked synchronous serial communication. Asynchronous serial
data communication can be carried out using standard asynchronous communication chips such as
a Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) or an Asynchronous Communication
Interface Adapter (ACIA). The SCI also supports the smart card (IC card) interface based on
ISO/IEC 7816-3 (Identification Card) as an enhanced asynchronous communication function.
13.1
Features
• Choice of asynchronous or clocked synchronous serial communication mode
•
Full-duplex communication capability
The transmitter and receiver are mutually independent, enabling transmission and reception to
be executed simultaneously.
Double-buffering is used in both the transmitter and the receiver, enabling continuous
transmission and continuous reception of serial data.
•
On-chip baud rate generator allows any bit rate to be selected
External clock can be selected as a transfer clock source (except for in Smart Card interface
mode).
• Choice of LSB-first or MSB-first transfer (except in the case of asynchronous mode 7-bit data)
• Four interrupt sources
Transmit-end, transmit-data-empty, receive-data-full, and receive error — that can issue
requests.
The transmit-data-empty interrupt and receive data full interrupts can be used to activate the
DMA controller (DMAC) or the Data Transfer Controller (DTC).
• Module stop mode can be set
Asynchronous Mode
• Data length: 7 or 8 bits
• Stop bit length: 1 or 2 bits
• Parity: Even, odd, or none
• Receive error detection: Parity, overrun, and framing errors
• Break detection: Break can be detected by reading the RxD pin level directly in the case of a
framing error
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 381 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
• Average transfer rate generator (SCI_0):
In H8S/2215
720 kbps, 460.784 kbps, or 115.196 kbps can be selected at 16 MHz.
In H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C
921.569 kbps, 720 kbps, 460.784 kbps, or 115.196 kbps can be selected at 16
MHz.
921.053 kbps, 720 kbps, 460.526 kbps, or 115.132 kbps can be selected at 24
MHz.
• A transfer rate clock can be input from the TPU (SCI_0)
• A multiprocessor communication function is provided that enables serial data
communication with a number of processors
Clocked Synchronous Mode
• Data length: 8 bits
• Receive error detection: Overrun errors detected
• SCI select function (SCI_0): TxD0 = high-impedance and SCK0 = fixed high-level input can
selected when IRQ7 = 1)
• Serial data communication can be carried out with other chips that have a synchronous
communication function
Smart Card Interface
• An error signal can be automatically transmitted on detection of a parity error during reception
• Data can be automatically re-transmitted on detection of a error signal during transmission
• Both direct convention and inverse convention are supported
Page 382 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.1.1
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Block Diagram
Bus interface
Module data bus
SCMR
TDR
RDR
Internal data bus
Figure 13.1 shows the block diagram of the SCI_0 for H8S/2215, figure 13.2 shows the block
diagram of the SCI_0 for H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C. Figure 13.2 shows the block
diagram of the SCI_1 and SCI_2.
BRR
SSR
φ
SCR
RxD0
RSR
Baud rate
generator
SMR
TSR
SEMR
control
transmission
and reception
TxD0
φ/4
φ/16
φ/64
Detecting parity
Parity
Clock
check
TEI
TXI
RXI
ERI
PG1/IRQ7
C/A
CKE1
Average transfer
rate generator
SSE
External clock
SCK0
10.667 MHz
· 115.152 kbps
· 460.606 kbps
16 MHz
· 115.196 kbps
· 460.784 kbps
· 720 kbps
TIOCA1
TCLKA
TIOCA2
Legend:
RSR: Receive shift register
RDR: Receive data register
TSR: Transmit shift register
TDR: Transmit data register
SMR: Serial mode register
SCR:
SSR:
SCMR:
BRR:
SEMR:
TPU
Serial control register
Serial status register
Smart card mode register
Bit rate register
Serial Extended mode register
Figure 13.1 Block Diagram of SCI_0 (H8S/2215)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 383 of 846
Bus interface
Module data bus
RDR
RxD0
TDR
RSR
TxD0
PG1/IRQ7
Parity generation
Parity
check
BRR
SCMR
SSR
SCR
SMR
SEMRA_0
SEMRB_0
control
transmission
and reception
TSR
Internal data bus
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
φ
Baud rate
generator
φ/4
φ/16
φ/64
Clock
TEI
TXI
RXI
ERI
C/A
CKE1
SSE
Average transfer
rate generator
External clock
SCK0
SCI transfer
clock generator
in TPU
10.667 MHz
· 115.152 kbps
· 460.606 kbps
16 MHz
· 115.196 kbps
· 460.784 kbps
· 720 kbps
· 921.569 kbps
24 MHz
· 115.132 kbps
· 460.526 kbps
· 720 kbps
· 921.053 kbps
TIOCA0
TIOCC0
TIOCA1 TPU
TIOCA2
Legend:
RSR: Receive shift register
RDR: Receive data register
TSR: Transmit shift register
TDR: Transmit data register
SMR: Serial mode register
SCR:
SSR:
SCMR:
BRR:
SEMRA_0:
SEMRB_0:
Serial control register
Serial status register
Smart card mode register
Bit rate register
Serial extended mode register A_0
Serial extended mode register B_0
Figure 13.2 Block Diagram of SCI_0 (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)
Page 384 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Module data bus
RDR
TDR
SCMR
BRR
SSR
φ
SCR
RxD
RSR
TSR
Baud rate
generator
SMR
Detecting parity
φ/4
φ/16
control
transmission
and reception
TxD
Internal data bus
Bus interface
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
φ/64
Clock
Parity check
External clock
SCK
Legend:
RSR: Receive shift register
RDR: Receive data register
TSR: Transmit shift register
TDR: Transmit data register
SMR: Serial mode register
SCR: Serial control register
SSR: Serial status register
SCMR: Smart card register
BRR: Bit rate register
TEI
TXI
RXI
ERI
Figure 13.3 Block Diagram of SCI_1 and SCI_2
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 385 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.2
Input/Output Pins
Table 13.1 shows the serial pins for each SCI channel.
Table 13.1 Pin Configuration
Channel
Pin Name*
I/O
Function
0
SCK0
I/O
SCI_0 clock input/output
1
2
Note:
13.3
*
RxD0
Input
SCI_0 receive data input
TxD0
Output
SCI_0 transmit data output
SCK1
I/O
SCI_1 clock input/output
RxD1
Input
SCI_1 receive data input
TxD1
Output
SCI_1 transmit data output
SCK2
I/O
SCI_2 clock input/output
RxD2
Input
SCI_2 receive data input
TxD2
Output
SCI_2 transmit data output
Pin names SCK, RxD, and TxD are used in the text for all channels, omitting the
channel designation.
Register Descriptions
The SCI has the following registers for each channel. Some bits in the serial mode register (SMR),
serial status register (SSR), and serial control register (SCR) have different functions in different
modes⎯normal serial communication interface mode and smart card interface mode; therefore,
the bits are described separately for each mode in the corresponding register sections.
• Receive shift register (RSR)
• Receive data register (RDR)
• Transmit data register (TDR)
• Transmit shift register (TSR)
• Serial mode register (SMR)
• Serial control register (SCR)
• Serial status register (SSR)
• Smart card mode register (SCMR)
• Serial extended mode register (SEMR) (only for channel 0 in H8S/2215)
• Serial extended mode register A_0 (SEMRA_0) (only for channel 0 in H8S/2215R,
H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)
Page 386 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
• Serial extended mode register B_0 (SEMRB_0) (only for channel 0 in H8S/2215R,
H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)
• Bit rate register (BRR)
13.3.1
Receive Shift Register (RSR)
RSR is a shift register that is used to receive serial data input to the RxD pin and convert it into
parallel data. When one byte of data has been received, it is transferred to RDR automatically.
RSR cannot be directly accessed by the CPU.
13.3.2
Receive Data Register (RDR)
RDR is an 8-bit register that stores received data. When the SCI has received one byte of serial
data, it transfers the received serial data from RSR to RDR, where it is stored. After this, RSR is
receive-enabled. As RSR and RDR function as a double buffer in this way, continuous receive
operations are possible. After confirming that the RDRF bit in SSR is set to 1, read RDR only
once. RDR cannot be written to by the CPU.
13.3.3
Transmit Data Register (TDR)
TDR is an 8-bit register that stores data for transmission. When the SCI detects that TSR is empty,
it transfers the transmit data written in TDR to TSR and starts transmission. The double-buffered
structure of TDR and TSR enables continuous serial transmission. If the next transmit data has
already been written to TDR during serial transmission, the SCI transfers the written data to TSR
to continue transmission. Although TDR can be read from or written to by the CPU at all times, to
achieve reliable serial transmission, write transmit data to TDR only once after confirming that the
TDRE bit in SSR is set to 1.
13.3.4
Transmit Shift Register (TSR)
TSR is a shift register that transmits serial data. To perform serial data transmission, the SCI first
transfers transmit data from TDR to TSR, then sends the data to the TxD pin. TSR cannot be
directly accessed by the CPU.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 387 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.3.5
Serial Mode Register (SMR)
SMR is used to set the SCI's serial transfer format and select the baud rate generator clock source.
Some bits in SMR have different functions in normal mode and smart card interface mode.
• Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 0)
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
C/A
R/W
Communication Mode
0
0: Asynchronous mode
1: Clocked synchronous mode
6
CHR
0
R/W
Character Length (enabled only in asynchronous mode)
0: Selects 8 bits as the data length
1: Selects 7 bits as the data length. LSB-first is fixed and
the MSB of TDR is not transmitted in transmission
In clocked synchronous mode, a fixed data length of 8
bits is used.
5
PE
0
R/W
Parity Enable (enabled only in asynchronous mode)
When this bit is set to 1, the parity bit is added to
transmit data before transmission, and the parity bit is
checked in reception. For a multiprocessor format, parity
bit addition and checking are not performed regardless
of the PE bit setting.
4
O/E
0
R/W
Parity Mode (enabled only when the PE bit is 1 in
asynchronous mode)
0: Selects even parity
1: Selects odd parity
3
STOP
0
R/W
Stop Bit Length (enabled only in asynchronous mode)
Selects the stop bit length in transmission.
0: 1 stop bit
1: 2 stop bits
In reception, only the first stop bit is checked. If the
second stop bit is 0, it is treated as the start bit of the
next transmit character.
Page 388 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
2
MP
R/W
Multiprocessor Mode (enabled only in asynchronous
mode)
0
When this bit is set to 1, the multiprocessor
communication function is enabled. The PE bit and O/E
bit settings are invalid in multiprocessor mode. For
details, see section 13.5, Multiprocessor Communication
Function.
1
CKS1
0
R/W
Clock Select 0 and 1:
0
CKS0
0
R/W
These bits select the clock source for the baud rate
generator.
00: φ clock (n = 0)
01: φ/4 clock (n = 1)
10: φ/16 clock (n = 2)
11: φ/64 clock (n = 3)
For the relationship between the bit rate register setting
and the baud rate, see section 13.3.12, Bit Rate Register
(BRR). n is the decimal representation of the value of n
in BRR (see section 13.3.12, Bit Rate Register (BRR)).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 389 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
• Smart Card Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 1)
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
GM
0
R/W
GSM Mode
Setting this bit to 1 allows GSM mode operation. In GSM
mode, the TEND set timing is put forward to 11.0 etu
from the start and the clock output control function is
appended. For details, see section 13.7.9, Clock Output
Control.
0: Normal smart card interface mode operation
(initial value)
(1) The TEND flag is generated 12.5 etu (11.5 etu in the
block transfer mode) after the beginning of the start
bit.
(2) Clock output on/off control only.
1: GSM mode operation in smart card interface mode
(1) The TEND flag is generated 11.0 etu after the
beginning of the start bit.
(2) In addition to clock output on/off control, high/how
fixed control is supported (set using SCR).
6
BLK
0
R/W
Setting this bit to 1 allows block transfer mode operation.
For details, see section 13.7.4, Block Transfer Mode.
0: Normal smart card interface mode operation
(initial value)
(1) Error signal transmission, detection, and automatic
data retransmission are performed.
(2) The TXI interrupt is generated by the TEND flag.
(3) The TEND flag is set 12.5 etu (11.0 etu in the GSM
mode) after transmission starts.
1: Operation in block transfer mode
(1) Error signal transmission, detection, and automatic
data retransmission are not performed.
(2) The TXI interrupt is generated by the TDRE flag.
(3) The TEND flag is set 11.5 etu (11.0 etu in the GSM
mode) after transmission starts.
Page 390 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
5
PE
R/W
Parity Enable
0
When this bit is set to 1, the parity bit is added to
transmit data before transmission, and the parity bit is
checked in reception. Set this bit to 1 in smart card
interface mode.
4
O/E
0
R/W
Parity Mode (valid only when the PE bit is 1)
0: Selects even parity
1: Selects odd parity
For details on the usage of this bit in smart card interface
mode, see section 13.7.2, Data Format (Except for Block
Transfer Mode).
3
BCP1
0
R/W
Basic Clock Pulse 1,0
2
BCP0
0
R/W
These bits select the number of basic clock cycles in a 1bit data transfer time in smart card interface mode.
00: 32 clock cycles (S = 32)
01: 64 clock cycles (S = 64)
10: 372 clock cycles (S = 372)
11: 256 clock cycles (S = 256)
For details, see section 13.7.5, Receive Data Sampling
Timing and Reception Margin. S is described in section
13.3.12, Bit Rate Register (BRR).
1
CKS1
0
R/W
Clock Select 1,0
0
CKS0
0
R/W
These bits select the clock source for the baud rate
generator.
00: φ clock (n = 0)
01: φ/4 clock (n = 1)
10: φ/16 clock (n = 2)
11: φ/64 clock (n = 3)
For the relation between the bit rate register setting and
the baud rate, see section 13.3.12, Bit Rate Register
(BRR). n is the decimal display of the value of n in BRR
(see section 13.3.12, Bit Rate Register (BRR)).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 391 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.3.6
Serial Control Register (SCR)
SCR is a register that enables or disables SCI transfer operations and interrupt requests, and is also
used to selection of the transfer clock source. For details on interrupt requests, refer to section
13.9, Interrupts. Some bits in SCR have different functions in normal mode and smart card
interface mode.
• Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 0)
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
7
TIE
R/W
0
Description
Transmit Interrupt Enable
When this bit is set to 1, the TXI interrupt request is
enabled.
TXI interrupt request cancellation can be performed by
reading 1 from the TDRE flag, then
clearing it to 0, or clearing the TIE bit to 0.
6
RIE
0
R/W
Receive Interrupt Enable
When this bit is set to 1, RXI and ERI interrupt requests
are enabled.
RXI and ERI interrupt request cancellation can be
performed by reading 1 from the RDRF flag, or the FER,
PER, or ORER flag, then clearing the flag to 0, or
clearing the RIE bit to 0.
5
TE
0
R/W
Transmit Enable
When this bit s set to 1, transmission is enabled.
In this state, serial transmission is started when transmit
data is written to TDR and the TDRE flag in SSR is
cleared to 0. SMR setting must be performed to decide
the transfer format before setting the TE bit to 1. The
TDRE flag in SSR is fixed at 1 if transmission is disabled
by clearing this bit to 0.
4
RE
0
R/W
Receive Enable
When this bit is set to 1, reception is enabled.
Serial reception is started in this state when a start bit is
detected in asynchronous mode or serial clock input is
detected in clocked synchronous mode. SMR setting
must be performed to decide the transfer format before
setting the RE bit to 1.
Clearing the RE bit to 0 does not affect the RDRF, FER,
PER, and ORER flags, which retain their states.
Page 392 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
3
MPIE
R/W
Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (enabled only when the
MP bit in SMR is 1 in asynchronous mode)
0
When this bit is set to 1, receive data in which the
multiprocessor bit is 0 is skipped, and setting of the
RDRF, FER, and ORER status flags in SSR is
prohibited. On receiving data in which the multiprocessor
bit is 1, this bit is automatically cleared and normal
reception is resumed. For details, refer to section 13.5,
Multiprocessor Communication Function.
When receive data including MPB = 0 is received,
receive data transfer from RSR to RDR, receive error
detection, and setting of the RDRF, FER, and ORER
flags in SSR, is not performed. When receive data
including MPB = 1 is received, the MPB bit in SSR is set
to 1, the MPIE bit is cleared to 0 automatically, and
generation of RXI and ERI interrupts (when the TIE and
RIE bits in SCR are set to 1) and FER and ORER flag
setting is enabled.
2
TEIE
0
R/W
Transmit End Interrupt Enable
This bit is set to 1, TEI interrupt request is enabled. TEI
cancellation can be performed by reading 1 from the
TDRE flag in SSR, then clearing it to 0 and clearing the
TEND flag to 0, or clearing the TEIE bit to 0.
1
CKE1
0
R/W
Clock Enable 0 and 1
0
CKE0
0
R/W
Selects the clock source and SCK pin function.
Asynchronous mode
00: Internal baud rate generator
SCK pin functions as I/O port
01: Internal baud rate generator
Outputs a clock of the same frequency as the bit rate
from the SCK pin.
1X: External clock
Inputs a clock with a frequency 16 times the bit rate
from the SCK pin.
Clocked synchronous mode
0X: Internal clock (SCK pin functions as clock output)
1X: External clock (SCK pin functions as clock input)
Legend:
X: Don’t care
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 393 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
• Smart Card Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 1)
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
TIE
R/W
Transmit Interrupt Enable
0
When this bit is set to 1, TXI interrupt request is enabled.
TXI interrupt request cancellation can be performed by
reading 1 from the TDRE flag in SSR, then clearing it to 0,
or clearing the TIE bit to 0.
6
RIE
0
R/W
Receive Interrupt Enable
When this bit is set to 1, RXI and ERI interrupt requests
are enabled.
RXI and ERI interrupt request cancellation can be
performed by reading 1 from the RDRF, FER, PER, or
ORER flag in SSR, then clearing the flag to 0, or clearing
the RIE bit to 0.
5
TE
0
R/W
Transmit Enable
When this bit s set to 1, transmission is enabled.
In this state, serial transmission is started when transmit
data is written to TDR and the TDRE flag in SSR is
cleared to 0.
SMR setting must be performed to decide the transfer
format before setting the TE bit to 1. When this bit is
cleared to 0, the transmission operation is disabled, and
the TDRE flag is fixed at 1.
4
RE
0
R/W
Receive Enable
When this bit is set to 1, reception is enabled.
Serial reception is started in this state when a start bit is
detected in asynchronous mode or serial clock input is
detected in clocked synchronous mode.
SMR setting must be performed to decide the reception
format before setting the RE bit to 1.
Clearing the RE bit to 0 does not affect the RDRF, FER,
PER, and ORER flags, which retain their states.
Page 394 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
3
MPIE
0
R/W
Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (enabled only when the
MP bit in SMR is 1 in asynchronous mode)
Write 0 to this bit in Smart Card interface mode.
When receive data including MPB = 0 is received, receive
data transfer from RSR to RDR, receive error detection,
and setting of the RERF, FER, and ORER flags in SSR,
are not performed.
When receive data including MPB = 1 is received, the
MPB bit in SSR is set to 1, the MPIE bit is cleared to 0
automatically, and generation of RXI and ERI interrupts
(when the TIE and RIE bits in SCR are set to 1) and FER
and ORER flag setting are enabled.
2
TEIE
0
R/W
Transmit End Interrupt Enable
Write 0 to this bit in Smart Card interface mode.
TEI cancellation can be performed by reading 1 from the
TDRE flag in SSR, then clearing it to 0 and clearing the
TEND flag to 0, or clearing the TEIE bit to 0.
1
CKE1
0
R/W
0
CKE0
0
Clock Enable 0 and 1
Enables or disables clock output from the SCK pin. The
clock output can be dynamically switched in GSM mode.
For details, refer to section 13.7.9, Clock Output Control.
When the GM bit in SMR is 0:
00: Output disabled (SCK pin can be used as an I/O port
pin)
01: Clock output
1X: Reserved
When the GM bit in SMR is 1:
00: Output fixed low
01: Clock output
10: Output fixed high
11: Clock output
Legend:
X: Don’t care
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 395 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.3.7
Serial Status Register (SSR)
SSR is a register containing status flags of the SCI and multiprocessor bits for transfer. 1 cannot
be written to flags TDRE, RDRF, ORER, PER, and FER; they can only be cleared. Some bits in
SSR have different functions in normal mode and smart card interface mode.
• Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 0)
Bit
7
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
TDRE
R/(W)* Transmit Data Register Empty
1
Description
1
Displays whether TDR contains transmit data.
[Setting conditions]
•
•
When the TE bit in SCR is 0
When data is transferred from TDR to TSR and data
can be written to TDR
[Clearing conditions]
3
• When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1*
2
• When the DMAC or the DTC* is activated by a TXI
interrupt request and writes data to TDR
6
RDRF
0
R/(W)* Receive Data Register Full
1
Indicates that the received data is stored in RDR.
[Setting condition]
•
When serial reception ends normally and receive
data is transferred from RSR to RDR
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1*
2
When the DMAC or the DTC* is activated by an RXI
interrupt and transferred data from RDR
RDR and the RDRF flag are not affected and retain their
previous values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
3
The RDRF flag is not affected and retains their previous
values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
Page 396 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Bit
5
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
ORER
R/(W)* Overrun Error
0
Description
1
[Setting condition]
•
When the next serial reception is completed while
RDRF = 1
The receive data prior to the overrun error is retained
in RDR, and the data received subsequently is lost.
Also, subsequent serial reception cannot be
continued while the ORER flag is set to 1. In clocked
synchronous mode, serial transmission cannot be
continued, either.
[Clearing condition]
3
• When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER = 1*
The ORER flag is not affected and retains its
previous state when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to
0.
4
FER
0
1
R/(W)* Framing Error
[Setting condition]
•
When the stop bit is 0
In 2-stop-bit mode, only the first stop bit is checked
for a value of 0; the second stop bits not checked. If
a framing error occurs, the receive data is transferred
to RDR but the RDRF flag is not set. Also,
subsequent serial reception cannot be continued
while the FER flag is set to 1. In clocked
synchronous mode, serial transmission cannot be
continued, either.
[Clearing condition]
3
• When 0 is written to FER after reading FER = 1*
The FER flag is not affected and retains its previous
state when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 397 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
3
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
PER
R/(W)* Parity Error
0
Description
1
[Setting condition]
•
When a parity error is detected during reception
If a parity error occurs, the receive data is transferred
to RDR but the RDRF flag is not set. Also,
subsequent serial reception cannot be continued
while the PER flag is set to 1. In clocked
synchronous mode, serial transmission cannot be
continued, either.
[Clearing condition]
3
• When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1*
The PER flag is not affected and retains its previous
state when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
2
TEND
1
R
Transmit End
[Setting conditions]
•
•
When the TE bit in SCR is 0
When TDRE = 1 at transmission of the last bit of a 1byte serial transmit character
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
1
MPB
0
R
When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1
2
When the DMAC or the DTC* is activated by a TXI
interrupt and writes data to TDR
Multiprocessor Bit
MPB stores the multiprocessor bit in the receive data.
When the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0 its previous state
is retained. This bit retains its previous state when the
RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
0
MPBT
0
R/W
Multiprocessor Bit Transfer
MPBT stores the multiprocessor bit to be added to the
transmit data.
Notes: 1. The write value should always be 0 to clear the flag.
2. The clearing conditions using the DTC are that DISEL bit be cleared to 0 and the
transfer counter value be other than 0.
3. To clear the flag by the CPU on the H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T, and H8S/2215C, reread
the flag after writing 0 to it.
Page 398 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
• Smart Card Interface Mode (When SMIF in SCMR is 1)
Bit
7
Bit Name Initial Value R/W
TDRE
1
Description
R/(W)* Transmit Data Register Empty
1
Indicates whether TDR contains transmit data.
[Setting conditions]
•
•
When the TE bit in SCR is 0
When data is transferred from TDR to TSR and data
can be written to TDR
[Clearing conditions]
3
• When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1*
2
• When the DMAC or the DTC* is activated by a TXI
interrupt request and writes data to TDR
6
RDRF
0
1
R/(W)* Receive Data Register Full
Indicates that the received data is stored in RDR.
[Setting condition]
•
When serial reception ends normally and receive data
is transferred from RSR to RDR
[Clearing conditions]
3
• When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1*
2
• When the DMAC or the DTC* is activated by an RXI
interrupt and transferred data from RDR
The RDRF flag is not affected and retains their previous
values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
If reception of the next data is completed while the RDRF
flag is still set to 1, an overrun error will occur and the
receive data will be lost.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 399 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
5
Bit Name Initial Value R/W
ORER
0
Description
R/(W)* Overrun Error
1
Indicates that an overrun error occurred during reception,
causing abnormal termination.
[Setting condition]
•
When the next serial reception is completed while
RDRF = 1
The receive data prior to the overrun error is retained in
RDR, and the data received subsequently is lost. Also,
subsequent serial cannot be continued while the ORER
flag is set to 1. In clocked synchronous mode, serial
transmission cannot be continued, either.
[Clearing condition]
• When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER = 1*
The ORER flag is not affected and retains its previous
state when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
4
ERS
0
3
1
R/(W)* Error Signal Status
Indicates that the status of an error, signal 1 returned from
the reception side at reception
[Setting condition]
• When the low level of the error signal is sampled
[Clearing condition]
3
• When 0 is written to ERS after reading ERS = 1*
The ERS flag is not affected and retains its previous state
when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
3
PER
0
1
R/(W)* Parity Error
Indicates that a parity error occurred during reception
using parity addition in asynchronous mode, causing
abnormal termination.
[Setting condition]
• When a parity error is detected during reception
If a parity error occurs, the receive data is transferred to
RDR but the RDRF flag is not set. Also, subsequent serial
reception cannot be continued while the PER flag is set to
1. In clocked synchronous mode, serial transmission
cannot be continued, either.
[Clearing condition]
3
• When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1*
The PER flag is not affected and retains its previous state
when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
Page 400 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value R/W
Description
2
TEND
Transmit End
1
R
This bit is set to 1 when no error signal has been sent
back from the receiving end and the next transmit data is
ready to be transferred to TDR.
[Setting conditions]
•
•
When the TE bit in SCR is 0 and the ERS bit is also 0
When the ESR bit is 0 and the TDRE bit is 1 after the
specified interval following transmission of 1-byte data.
The timing of bit setting differs according to the register
setting as follows:
When GM = 0 and BLK = 0, 2.5 etu after transmission
starts
When GM = 0 and BLK = 1, 1.0 etu after transmission
starts
When GM = 1 and BLK = 0, 1.5 etu after transmission
starts
When GM = 1 and BLK = 1, 1.0 etu after transmission
starts
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
1
MPB
0
R
When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1
2
When the DMAC or the DTC* is activated by a TXI
interrupt and transfers transmission data to TDR
Multiprocessor Bit
This bit is not used in Smart Card interface mode.
0
MPBT
0
R/W
Multiprocessor Bit Transfer
Write 0 to this bit in Smart Card interface mode.
Notes: 1. The write value should always be 0 to clear the flag.
2. The clearing conditions using the DTC are that DISEL bit be cleared to 0 and the
transfer counter value be other than 0.
3. To clear the flag by the CPU on the H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T, and H8S/2215C, reread
the flag after writing 0 to it.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 401 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.3.8
Smart Card Mode Register (SCMR)
SCMR selects the operation in smart card interface or the data Transfer formats.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to 4 —
All 1
—
Reserved
3
0
R/W
Smart Card Data Transfer Direction
These bits are always read as 1.
DIR
Selects the serial/parallel conversion format.
0: LSB-first in transfer
1: MSB-first in transfer
The bit setting is valid only when the transfer data format
is 8 bits.
2
INV
0
R/W
Smart Card Data Invert
Specifies inversion of the data logic level. The SINV bit
does not affect the logic level of the parity bit. To invert
the parity bit, invert the O/E bit in SMR.
0: TDR contents are transmitted as they are. Receive
data is stored as it is in RDR
1: TDR contents are inverted before being transmitted.
Receive data is stored in inverted form in RDR
1
—
1
—
Reserved
This bit is always read as 1.
0
SMIF
0
R/W
Smart Card Interface Mode Select
When this bit is set to 1, smart card interface mode is
selected.
0: Normal asynchronous or clocked synchronous mode
1: Smart card interface mode
Page 402 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.3.9
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Serial Extended Mode Register (SEMR) (Only for Channel 0 in H8S/2215)
SEMR extends the functions of SCI_0. SEMR0 enables selection of the SCI_0 select function in
synchronous mode, base clock setting in asynchronous mode, and also clock source selection and
automatic transfer rate setting. Figure 13.3 shows an example of the internal base clock when an
average transfer rate is selected and figure 13.4 shows as example of the setting when the TPU
clock input is selected.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description
7
SSE
0
R/W SCI_0 Select Enable
Allows selection of the SCI0 select function when an
external clock is input in synchronous mode.
The SSE setting is valid when external clock input is used
(CKE1 = 1 in SCR) in synchronous mode (C/A = 1 in SMR).
0: SCI_0 select function disabled
1: SCI_0 select function enabled
When the SCI_0 select function is enabled, if 1 is input to
the PG1/IRQ7 pin, TxD0 output goes to the high-impedance
state, SCK0 input is fixed high.
6 to 4 —
Undefined
—
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
3
ABCS
0
R/W Asynchronous Base Clock Select
Selects the 1-bit-interval base clock in asynchronous mode.
The ABCS setting is valid in asynchronous mode (C/A = 0
in SMR).
0: SCI_0 operates on base clock with frequency of 16 times
transfer rate
1: SCI_0 operates on base clock with frequency of 8 times
transfer rate
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 403 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description
2
ACS2
0
R/W Asynchronous Clock Source Select 2 to 0
1
ACS1
0
0
ACS0
0
R/W These bits select the clock source in asynchronous mode.
R/W When an average transfer rate is selected, the base clock is
set automatically regardless of the ABCS value. Note that
average transfer rates are not supported for operating
frequencies other than 10.667 MHz and 16 MHz. The
setting in bits ACS2 to ACS0 is valid when external clock
input is used (CKE1 = 1 in SCR) in asynchronous mode
(C/A = 0 in SMR). Figures 13.3 and 13.4 show setting
examples.
000: External clock input
001: 115.152 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 10.667
MHz only) is selected* (SCI_0 operates on base clock
with frequency of 16 times transfer rate)
010: 460.606 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 10.667
MHz only) is selected* (SCI_0 operates on base clock
with frequency of 8 times transfer rate)
011: Reserved
100: TPU clock input (AND of TIOCA1 and TIOCA2)
The signal generated by TIOCA1 and TIOCA2, which
are the compare match outputs for TPU_1 and TPU_2
or PWM outputs, is used as a base clock. Note that
IRQ0 and IRQ1 cannot be used since TIOCA1 and
TIOCA2 are used as outputs. The high pulse width for
TIOCA1 should be its low pulse width or less.
101: 115.196 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16 MHz
only) is selected (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
frequency of 16 times transfer rate)
110: 460.784 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16 MHz
only) is selected (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
frequency of 16 times transfer rate)
111: 720 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16 MHz only) is
selected (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
frequency of 8 times transfer rate)
Note:
*
Cannot be used in this LSI because the operating frequency φ in this LSI is 13 MHz or
greater.
Page 404 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Sep 16, 2010
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
5
7
8
9 10 11 12
Base clock
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
5
7
8
9 10 11 12
1
1
2
2
4
5
6
7
5.76 MHz
4 5
8 MHz
6
8
3
4
5
6 7
8
13 14 15 16 1
2
3
4
5
6 7
8
7
1
2
3
4
Average transfer rate = 5.76 MHz/8 = 720 kbps
Average error = ±0%
8
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 1
1 bit = base clock × 8*
3
3
Note: * As the base clock synchronization varies, so does the length of one bit.
(average)
8 MHz × (18/25) = 5.76 MHz
16 MHz/2 = 8 MHz
Base clock
2
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
4
2
5
3
4
6
5
7
6
7
8
8
2
3
4
5
6
7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 1
2
3
4
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1
2
16 1
2
16 1
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 1
1 bit = base clock × 16*
7.3725 MHz
5 6 7 8
6
Average transfer rate = 7.3725 MHz/16 = 460.784 kbps
Average error = -0.004%
4
8 MHz
Base clock with 720 kbps average transfer rate (ACS2 to 0 = B'111)
(average)
8 MHz × (47/51) = 7.3725 MHz
16 MHz/2 = 8 MHz
13 14 15 16 1
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 1
1 bit = base clock × 16*
1.8431 MHz
5 6 7 8
6
Average transfer rate = 1.8431 MHz/16 = 115.196 kbps
Average error = -0.004%
4
2 MHz
Base clock with 460.784 kbps average transfer rate (ACS2 to 0 = B'110)
(average)
2 MHz × (47/51) = 1.8431 MHz
16 MHz/8 = 2 MHz
Base clock
Base clock with 115.196 kbps average transfer rate (ACS2 to 0 = B'101)
When φ = 16 MHz
2 3
3 4
2 3
3 4
4
5
4
5
5
6
5
6
6 7
7 8
6 7
7 8
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Figure 13.4 Examples of Base Clock when Average Transfer Rate Is Selected (1)
Page 405 of 846
Page 406 of 846
6 7
8 9
1 bit = base clock × 16*
1.8421 MHz
2 3
4 5
10 11
Average transfer rate =1.8421 MHz/16 = 115.132 kbps
Average error with 115.2 kbps = -0.0059%
1
3 MHz
12
13 14
15 16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 1 2
6 7
8 9
1 bit = base clock × 16*
7.3684 MHz
2 3
4 5
1
5
6
1 bit = base clock × 8*
5.76 MHz
3
4
7
Average transfer rate = 5.76 MHz/8= 720 kbps
Average error with 720 kbps = ±0%
2
12 MHz
13 14
15 16
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
1
6 7
8
Average transfer rate = 7.3684 MHz/8= 921.053 kbps
Average error with 921.1 kbps = -0.059%
1 bit = base clock × 8*
7.3684 MHz
2 3
4 5
12 MHz
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 1 2
8
Note: * The lengh of one bit varies according to the base clock synchronization.
Base clock
24 MHz/2 = 12 MHz
12 MHz × (35/57)
= 7.3684 MHz
(Average)
12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 1 2 3 4
Base clock with 921.053-kbps average transfer rate (ACS3 to ACS0 = B'1011)
Base clock
24 MHz/2 = 12 MHz
12 MHz × (12/25)
= 5.76 MHz
(Average)
10 11
Average transfer rate = 7.3684 MHz/16 = 460.526 kbps
Average error with 460.6kbps = -0.059%
1
12 MHz
Base clock with 720-kbps average transfer rate (ACS3 to ACS0 = B'1010)
Base clock
24 MHz/2 = 12 MHz
12 MHz × (35/57)
= 7.3684 MHz
(Average)
Base clock with 460.526-kbps average transfer rate (ACS3 to ACS0 = B'1001)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 1 2
Base clock
24 MHz/8 = 3 MHz
3 MHz × (35/57)
= 1.8421 MHz
(Average)
Base clock with 115.132-kbps average transfer rate (ACS3 to ACS0 = B'1000)
When φ = 24 MHz
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
H8S/2215 Group
Figure 13.4 Examples of Base Clock when Average Transfer Rate Is Selected (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
1
1
1
4
4
7.3846 MHz
3
4
8 MHz
3
3
5
5
5
6
6
6
7
7
7
8
8
8
Average transfer rate = 7.3846 MHz/8 = 923.077 kbps
Average error relative to 921.6 kbps = +0.16%
1 bit = 8 base clocks*
2
2
2
1
9
9
Note: * As the base clock synchronization varies, so does the length of one bit.
Internal base clock
= 8 MHz x 12/13
= 7.3846 MHz
TIOCA2 (TPU_2) output
TIOCA1(TPU_1) output = 8 MHz
Main clock: 16 MHz
2
10
10
3
11
11
4
12
12
Sample TPU and SCI settings
TMDR_1 = TMDR_2 = H'C2 [PWM mode 1]
TCR_1 = H'20 [TCNT_1 incremented on rising edge of ø/1, TCNT_1 cleared by TGRA_1 compare match]
TGRB_1 = H'0000, TGRA_1 = H'0001
TIOR_1 = H'21 [1 output on TGRB_1 compare match, TIOCA1 initial output 0, 0 output on TGRA_1 compare match]
TCR_2 = H'2C [TCNT_2 incremented on falling edge of TCLKA (TIOCA1), TCNT_2 cleared by TGRA_2 compare match]
TGRB_2 = H'0000, TGRA_2 = H'000C
TIOR_2 = H'21 [1 output on TGRB_2 compare match, TIOCA2 initial output 0, 0 output on TGRA_2 compare match]
SEMR = H'0C (ABCS = 1, ACS2-0 = B'100)
(1) An 8 MHz base clock provided by TPU_1 is multiplied by 12/13 by TPU_2 to generate a 7.3846 MHz base clock
(2) By making 1 bit = 8 base clocks, the average transfer rate is made 7.3846 MHz/8 = 923.077 kbps.
Example for 921.6 kbps when φ = 16 MHz
Generation of clock with 923.077 kbps average transfer rate by means of TPU (ACS2 to 0 = B'100)
13
5
1
1
6
2
2
7
3
3
8
4
4
1
5
5
2
6
6
3
7
7
4
8
8
5
9
9
6
10
10
7
11
11
8
12
12
13
1
1
1
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Figure 13.5 Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (1)
Page 407 of 846
Page 408 of 846
SCK0
Base clock
= 9.6 MHz × 15/16
= 9 MHz (Average)
Clock enable
TIOCA1 output
Base clock
(TIOCA0 + TIOCC0) output
= 9.6 MHz
TIOCC0 output
= 4.8 MHz
TIOCA0 output
= 4.8 MHz
5
5
9.6 MHz
4
4
6
6
6
7
7
7
8
8
8
1 bit = Base clock × 16*
9 MHz
3
4
5
3
3
9
9
9
10 11 12 13 14 15
10 11 12 13 14 15
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Average transfer rate = 9 MHz/16 = 562.5 kbps
2
2
2
16
1
1
Note: * The length of one bit varies according to the base clock synchronization.
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
3
3
3
4
4
4
5
5
5
6
6
• TCR_0 = H'20 [TCNT_0 cleared by TGRA_0 compare match, TCNT_0 incremented at rising edge of φ/1]
• TCR_1 = H'2D [TCNT_1 cleared by TGRA_1 compare match, TCNT_1 incremented at falling edge of TCLKB
• TMDR_0 = TMDR_1 = H'C2 [PWM mode 1]
• TIORH_0 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA0 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_0 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_0 compare match]
• TIORL_0 = H'21 [0 as TIOCC0 initial output, 0 output on TGRC_0 compare match, 1 output on TGRD_0 compare match]
• TIOR_1 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA1 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_1 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_1 compare match]
• TCNT_0 = TCNT_1 = H'0000
• TGRA_0 = H'0004, TGRB_0 = H'0002, TGRC_0 = H'0001, TGRD_0 = H'0000
• TGRA_1 = H'000F, TGRB_1 = H'0000
• SCR_0 = H'03 (external clock)
• SEMRA_0 = H'14 (TCS2 to TCS0 = B'001, ABCS = 0, ACS2 to ACS0 = B'100)
• SEMRB_0 = H'00 (ACS3 = 0)
TPU and SCI settings
Example for TPU clock generation for 562.5 kbps average transfer rate when φ = 24 MHz (TCS2 to TCS0 = B'001)
(1) 9.6-MHz base clock provided by TPU_0 is multiplied by 15/16 by TPU_1 to generate 9-MHz base clock
(2) By making 1 bit = 16 base clocks, the average transfer will be 9 MHz/16 = 562.5 kbps
6
7
7
7
8
8
8
9
9
Q
φ
>CK
D
9
10 11 12 13 14
10 11 12 13 14 15
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TCLKB
TCLKA
TIOCA0
TIOCC0
TIOCA1
TIOCA2
TPU
2
2
15 16
1
1
1
3
3
2
4
4
Base clock
Clock enable
3
5
5
4
6
6
5
7
7
6
8
8
SCK0
7
9
9
SCI_0
8
9
10 11
10 11
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
H8S/2215 Group
Figure 13.5 Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
SCK0
Base clock
= 6 MHz × 23/25
= 5.52 MHz (Average)
25
1
1
1
2
4
5
5
5
6
6
6
7
7
7
8
8
8
9
9
9
10 11 12
10 11 12
10 11 12 13
Average transfer rate = 5.52 MHz/16 = 345 kbps
1 bit = Base clock × 16*
4
6 MHz
3
4
5.52 MHz
2 3
2
3
13
13
18
14 15 16
1
2
18
19 20
14 15 16 17
14 15 16 17
Note: * The length of one bit varies according to the base clock synchronization.
Clock enable
(TIOCA1×TIOCA2) output
TIOCA2(TPU_2) output
TIOCA1(TPU_1) output
Base clock
TIOCA0 (TPU_0) output
= 6 MHz
3
4
24 25
5
6
7
1
TCLKB
TCLKA
TIOCA0
TIOCC0
TIOCA1
TIOCA2
TPU
21 22 23
21 22 23
19 20
• TCR_0 = H'20 [TCNT_0 cleared by TGRA_0 compare match, TCNT_0 incremented at rising edge of φ/1]
• TCR_1 = H'2D [TCNT_1 cleared by TGRA_1 compare match, TCNT_1 incremented at falling edge of TCLKB]
• TCR_2 = H'2D [TCNT_2 cleared by TGRA_2 compare match, TCNT_2 incremented at falling edge of TCLKB
• TMDR_0 = TMDR_1 = TMDR_2 = H'C2 [PWM mode 1]
• TIORH_0 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA0 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_0 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_0 compare match]
• TIOR_1 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA1 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_1 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_1 compare match]
• TIOR_2 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA2 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_2 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_2 compare match]
• TCNT_0 = TCNT_1 = H'0000, TCNT_2 = H'000C
• TGRA_0 = H'0003, TGRB_0 = H'0001
• TGRA_1 = H'0018, TGRB_1 = H'0000
• TGRA_2 = H'0018, TGRB_2 = H'0000
• SCR_0 = H'03 (external clock)
• SEMRA_0 = H'24 (TCS2 to TCS0 = B'010, ABCS = 0, ACS2 to ACS0 = B'100)
• SEMRB_0 = H'00 (ACS3 = 0)
TPU and SCI settings
Example for TPU clock generation for 345 kbps average transfer rate when φ = 24 MHz (TCS2 to TCS0 = B'010)
(1) 6-MHz base clock provided by TPU_0 is multiplied by 23/25 by TPU_1 and TPU_2 to generate 5.52-MHz base clock
(2) By making 1 bit = 16 base clocks, the average transfer will be 5.52 MHz/16 = 345 kbps
8
1
2
9
2
3
4
5
10 11
3
4
12
5
6
7
8
8
9
16
9
1
2
3
10 11 12
10 11 12 13
Base clock
13 14 15
6
7
φ
>CK
D
Q Clock enable
4
5
6
13 14 15
14 15 16 17
SCK0
SCI_0
7
8
9
18
19 20
16 17
18
10
19
24 25
11 12 13 14
20 21 22 23
21 22 23
1
2
3
15 16
1
2
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Figure 13.5 Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (3)
Page 409 of 846
Page 410 of 846
SCK0
Base clock
= 9.6 MHz × 23/25
= 8.832 MHz (Average)
Clock enable
(TIOCA1×TIOCA2) output
TIOCA2 output
TIOCA1 output
Base clock
(TIOCA0 + TIOCC0) output
= 9.6 MHz
TIOCC0 output
= 4.8 MHz
TIOCA0 output
= 4.8 MHz
5
5
6
6
8.832 MHz
4
5
6
9.6 MHz
4
4
7
7
7
8
8
8
1 bit = Base clock × 16*
3
3
3
9
9
9
10 11 12
10 11 12
13
13
14 15
14 15
16
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
Average transfer rate = 8.832 MHz/16 = 552 kbps
2
2
2
Note: * The length of one bit varies according to the base clock synchronization.
1
1
1
TCLKB
TCLKA
TIOCA0
TIOCC0
TIOCA1
TPU and SCI settings
• TCR_0 = H'20 [TCNT_0 cleared by TGRA_0 compare match, TCNT_0 incremented at rising edge of φ/1]
• TCR_1 = H'2D [TCNT_1 cleared by TGRA_1 compare match, TCNT_1 incremented at falling edge of TCLKB]
• TCR_2 = H'2D [TCNT_2 cleared by TGRA_2 compare match, TCNT_2 incremented at falling edge of TCLKB
• TMDR_0 = TMDR_1 = TMDR_2 = H'C2 [PWM mode 1]
• TIORH_0 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA0 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_0 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_0 compare match]
• TIORL_0 = H'21 [0 as TIOCC0 initial output, 0 output on TGRC_0 compare match, 1 output on TGRD_0 compare match]
• TIOR_1 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA1 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_1 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_1 compare match]
• TIOR_2 = H'21 [0 as TIOCA2 initial output, 0 output on TGRA_2 compare match, 1 output on TGRB_2 compare match]
• TCNT_0 = TCNT_1 = H'0000, TCNT_2 = H'000C
• TGRA_0 = H'0004, TGRB_0 = H'0002, TGRC_0 = H'0001, TGRD_0 = H'0000
• TGRA_1 = H'0018, TGRB_1 = H'0000
• TGRA_2 = H'0018, TGRB_2 = H'0000
• SCR_0 = H'03 (external clock)
• SEMRA_0 = H'34 (TCS2 to TCS0 = B'011, ABCS = 0, ACS2 to ACS0 = B'100)
• SEMRB_0 = H'00 (ACS3 = 0)
TIOCA2
TPU
Example for TPU clock generation for 552 kbps average transfer rate when φ = 24 MHz (TCS2 to TCS0 = B'011)
(1) 9.6-MHz base clock provided by TPU_0 is multiplied by 23/25 by TPU_1 and TPU_2 to generate 8.832-MHz base clock
(2) By making 1 bit = 16 base clocks, the average transfer will be 8.832 MHz/16 = 552 kbps
8
1
1
9
2
2
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
10 11 12 13 14
3
3
φ
9
9
15 16
8
8
SCK0
1
2
3
10 11 12
4
5
6
7
8
13 14 15 16 17
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Base clock
Q Clock enable
>CK
D
SCI_0
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
H8S/2215 Group
Figure 13.5 Example of Average Transfer Rate Setting when TPU Clock Is Input (4)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.3.10 Serial Extended Mode Register A_0 (SEMRA_0) (Only for Channel 0 in
H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)
SEMRA_0 extends the functions of SCI_0. SEMR0 enables selection of the SCI_0 select function
in synchronous mode, base clock setting in asynchronous mode, and also clock source selection
and automatic transfer rate setting. Figure 13.4 shows an example of the internal base clock when
an average transfer rate is selected and figure 13.5 shows as example of the setting when the TPU
clock input is selected.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description
7
SSE
0
R/W SCI_0 Select Enable
Allows selection of the SCI0 select function when an
external clock is input in synchronous mode.
The SSE setting is valid when external clock input is used
(CKE1 = 1 in SCR) in synchronous mode (C/A = 1 in SMR).
0: SCI_0 select function disabled
1: SCI_0 select function enabled
When the SCI_0 select function is enabled, if 1 is input to
the PG1/IRQ7 pin, TxD0 output goes to the high-impedance
state, SCK0 input is fixed high.
6
TCS2
0
R/W TPU Clock Select
5
TCS1
0
4
TCS0
0
R/W When the TPU clock is input (ACS3 to ACS0 = B'0100) as
R/W the clock source in asynchronous mode, serial transfer
clock is generated depending on the combination of the
TPU clock.
Base Clock
Clock Enable
TCLKA
TCLKB
TCLKC
000
TIOCA1
TIOCA2
Base clock written
in the left column
Pin input
Pin input
001
TIOCA0 | TIOCC0
TIOCA1
Pin input
Base clock written
in the left column
Pin input
010
TIOCA0
TIOCA1 & TIOCA2
Pin input
Base clock written
in the left column
Pin input
011
TIOCA0 | TIOCC0
TIOCA1 & TIOCA2
Pin input
Base clock written
in the left column
Pin input
1××
Reserved (Setting prohibited)
Legend:
&: AND (logical multiplication)
I : OR (logical addition)
Note: The functions of bits 6 to 4 are not supported by the
E6000 emulator. Figure 13.5 shows the setting
examples.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 411 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description
3
ABCS
0
R/W Asynchronous Base Clock Select
Selects the 1-bit-interval base clock in asynchronous mode.
The ABCS setting is valid in asynchronous mode (C/A = 0
in SMR).
0: SCI_0 operates on base clock with frequency of 16
times transfer rate
1: SCI_0 operates on base clock with frequency of 8 times
transfer rate
2
ACS2
0
R/W Asynchronous Clock Source Select 2 to 0
1
ACS1
0
0
ACS0
0
R/W These bits select the clock source in asynchronous mode
R/W depending on the combination with the bit 7 (ACS3) in
SEMRB_0 (serial extended mode register B_0). When an
average transfer rate is selected, the base clock is set
automatically regardless of the ABCS value. Note that
average transfer rates support only 10.667 MHz, 16 MHz,
and 24 MHz, and not support other operating frequencies.
Set ACS3 to ACS0 when inputting the external clock (the
CKE1 bit in the SCR register is 1) in asynchronous mode
(the C/A bit in the SMR register is 0). Figures 13.4 and 13.5
show the setting examples.
ACS 3210
0000: External clock input
0001: 115.152 kbps average transfer rate (for φ =
10.667 MHz only) is selected (SCI_0 operates
on base clock with frequency of 16 times
transfer rate)
0010: 460.606 kbps average transfer rate (for φ =
10.667 MHz only) is selected (SCI_0 operates
on base clock with frequency of eight times
transfer rate)
0011: 921.569 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16
MHz only) is selected (SCI_0 operates on base
clock with frequency of eight times transfer rate)
0100: TPU clock input
The signal generated by TIOCA0, TIOCC0,
TIOCA1, and TIOCA2, which are the compare
match outputs for TPU_0 to TPU_2 or PWM
outputs, is used as a base clock. Note that
IRQ0 and IRQ1 cannot be used since TIOCA1
and TIOCA2 are used as outputs.
Page 412 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value R/W Description
2
ACS2
0
1
ACS1
0
0
ACS0
0
R/W 0101: 115.196 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16 MHz
only) is selected (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
R/W
frequency of 16 times transfer rate)
R/W
0110: 460.784 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16 MHz
only) is selected (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
frequency of eight times transfer rate)
0111: 720 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 16 MHz only)
is selected (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
frequency of eight times transfer rate)
1000: 115.132 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 24 MHz
only) is selected* (SCI_0 operates on base clock
with frequency of 16 times transfer rate)
1001: 460.526 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 24 MHz
only) is selected* (SCI_0 operates on base clock
with frequency of 16 times transfer rate)
1010: 720 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 24 MHz only)
is selected* (SCI_0 operates on base clock with
frequency of eight times transfer rate)
1011: 921.053 kbps average transfer rate (for φ = 24 MHz
only) is selected* (SCI_0 operates on base clock
with frequency of eight times transfer rate)
11××: Reserved (Setting prohibited)
Note:
The average transfer rate select functions for 24 MHz only (ACS3 to ACS0 = B'10XX)
are not supported by the E6000 emulator.
*
13.3.11 Serial Extended Mode Register B_0 (SEMRB_0) (Only for Channel 0 in
H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)
SEMRB_0 enables clock source selection with the combination of SEMRA_0, automatic transfer
rate setting, and control of port 1 pins (P16, P14, P12, and P10) at the transfer clock generation by
TPU.
Note: SEMRB_0 is not supported by the E6000 emulator.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 413 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
ACS3
R/W
Asynchronous Clock Source Select
0
Selects the clock source in asynchronous mode
depending on the combination with the ACS2 to ACS0
(bits 2 to 0 in SEMRA_0). For details, see section 13.3.9,
Serial Extended Mode Register (SEMR) (Only for
channel 0 in H8S/2215).
6 to
4
—
Undefined
3
TIOCA2E 1
—
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
R/W
TIOCA2 Output Enable
Controls the TIOCA2 output on the P16 pin.
When the TIOCA2 in TPU is output to generate the
transfer clock, P16 is used as other function pin by
setting this bit to 0.
0: Disables output of TIOCA2 in TPU
1: Enables output of TIOCA2 in TPU
2
TIOCA1E 1
R/W
TIOCA1 Output Enable
Controls the TIOCA1 output on the P14 pin.
When the TIOCA1 in TPU is output to generate the
transfer clock, P14 is used as other function pin by
setting this bit to 0.
0: Disables output of TIOCA1 in TPU
1: Enables output TIOCA1 in TPU
1
TIOCC0E 1
R/W
TIOCC0 Output Enable
Controls the TIOCC0 output on the P12 pin.
When the TIOCC0 in TPU is output to generate the
transfer clock, P12 is used as other function pin by
setting this bit to 0.
0: Disables output of TIOCC0 in TPU
1: Enables output of TIOCC0 in TPU
0
TIOCA0E 1
R/W
TIOCA0 Output Enable
Controls the TIOCA0 output on the P10 pin.
When the TIOCA0 in TPU is output to generate the
transfer clock, P10 is used as other function pin by
setting this bit to 0.
0: Disables output of TIOCA0 in TPU
1: Enables output of TIOCA0 in TPU
Page 414 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.3.12 Bit Rate Register (BRR)
BRR is an 8-bit register that adjusts the bit rate. As the SCI performs baud rate generator control
independently for each channel, different bit rates can be set for each channel. Table 13.2 shows
the relationships between the N setting in BRR and bit rate B for normal asynchronous mode,
clocked synchronous mode, and Smart Card interface mode. The initial value of BRR is H'FF, and
it can be read from or written to by the CPU at all times.
Table 13.2 Relationships between the N Setting in BRR and Bit Rate B
Mode
ABCS
Asynchronous
mode
0
1
Clocked
synchronous
mode
x
Smart Card
interface mode
x
Bit Rate
Error
B=
φ × 106
φ × 106
Error (%) = |
– 1 | × 100
B × 64 × 22n-1 × (N + 1)
64 × 22n-1 × (N + 1)
B=
φ × 106
φ × 106
Error (%) = |
– 1 | × 100
2n-1
B × 32 × 22n-1 × (N + 1)
32 × 2
× (N + 1)
B=
φ × 106
8 × 22n-1 × (N + 1)
⎯
B=
φ × 106
S×
(N + 1)
Error (%) = |
22n+1 ×
φ × 106
– 1 | × 100
B × S × 22n+1 × (N + 1)
Legend:
B: Bit rate (bps)
N: BRR setting for baud rate generator (0 ≤ N ≤ 255)
φ:
Operating frequency (MHz)
n, S: Determined by the SMR settings shown in the following tables.
x:
Don’t care
SMR Setting
SMR Setting
CKS1
CKS0
Clock Source
n
BCP1
BCP0
S
0
0
φ
0
0
0
32
0
1
φ/4
1
0
1
64
1
0
φ/16
2
1
0
372
1
1
φ/64
3
1
1
256
Table 13.3 shows sample N settings in BRR in normal asynchronous mode. Table 13.4 shows the
maximum bit rate for each frequency in normal asynchronous mode. Table 13.6 shows sample N
settings in BRR in clocked synchronous mode. Table 13.8 shows sample N settings in BRR in
Smart Card interface mode. In Smart Card interface mode, S (the number of basic clock periods in
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 415 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
a 1-bit transfer interval) can be selected. For details, see section 13.7.5, Receive Data Sampling
Timing and Reception Margin. Tables 13.5 and 13.7 show the maximum bit rates with external
clock input.
When the ABCS bit in SCI_0's serial extended mode register (SEMR) is set to 1 in asynchronous
mode, the maximum bit rates are twice those shown in table 13.3.
Table 13.3 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Asynchronous Mode)
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
2
2.097152
2.4576
3
Bit Rate
(bit/s)
n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%)
110
1
141
0.03
1
148
–0.04
1
174
–0.26
1
212
0.03
150
1
103
0.16
1
108
0.21
1
127
0.00
1
155
0.16
300
0
207
0.16
0
217
0.21
0
255
0.00
1
77
0.16
600
0
103
0.16
0
108
0.21
0
127
0.00
0
155
0.16
1200
0
51
0.16
0
54
–0.70
0
63
0.00
0
77
0.16
2400
0
25
0.16
0
26
1.14
0
31
0.00
0
38
0.16
4800
0
12
0.16
0
13
–2.48
0
15
0.00
0
19
–2.34
9600
—
—
—
—
6
–2.48
0
7
0.00
0
9
–2.34
19200
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
3
0.00
0
4
–2.34
31250
0
1
0.00
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
2
0.00
38400
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
1
0.00
—
—
—
Page 416 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
3.6864
4
4.9152
5
Bit Rate
(bit/s)
n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%)
110
2
64
0.70
2
70
0.03
2
86
0.31
2
88
–0.25
150
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
1
255
0.00
2
64
0.16
300
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
1
127
0.00
1
129
0.16
600
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
0
255
0.00
1
64
0.16
1200
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
0
127
0.00
0
129
0.16
2400
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
0
63
0.00
0
64
0.16
4800
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
0
31
0.00
0
32
–1.36
9600
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
0
15
0.00
0
15
1.73
19200
0
5
0.00
—
—
—
0
7
0.00
0
7
1.73
31250
—
—
—
0
3
0.00
0
4
–1.70
0
4
0.00
38400
0
2
0.00
—
—
—
0
3
0.00
0
3
1.73
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
6
6.144
7.3728
8
Bit Rate
(bit/s)
n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%)
110
2
106
–0.44
2
108
0.08
2
130
–0.07
2
141
0.03
150
2
77
0.16
2
79
0.00
2
95
0.00
2
103
0.16
300
1
155
0.16
1
159
0.00
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
600
1
77
0.16
1
79
0.00
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
1200
0
155
0.16
0
159
0.00
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
2400
0
77
0.16
0
79
0.00
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
4800
0
38
0.16
0
39
0.00
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
9600
0
19
–2.34
0
19
0.00
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
19200
0
9
–2.34
0
9
0.00
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
31250
0
5
0.00
0
5
2.40
—
—
—
0
7
0.00
38400
0
4
–2.34
0
4
0.00
0
5
0.00
—
—
—
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 417 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
9.8304
10
12
12.288
Bit Rate
(bit/s)
n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%)
110
2
174
–0.26
2
177
–0.25
2
212
0.03
2
217
0.08
150
2
127
0.00
2
129
0.16
2
155
0.16
2
159
0.00
300
1
255
0.00
2
64
0.16
2
77
0.16
2
79
0.00
600
1
127
0.00
1
129
0.16
1
155
0.16
1
159
0.00
1200
0
255
0.00
1
64
0.16
1
77
0.16
1
79
0.00
2400
0
127
0.00
0
129
0.16
0
155
0.16
0
159
0.00
4800
0
63
0.00
0
64
0.16
0
77
0.16
0
79
0.00
9600
0
31
0.00
0
32
–1.36
0
38
0.16
0
39
0.00
19200
0
15
0.00
0
15
1.73
0
19
–2.34
0
19
0.00
31250
0
9
–1.70
0
9
0.00
0
11
0.00
0
11
2.40
38400
0
7
0.00
0
7
1.73
0
9
–2.34
0
9
0.00
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
14
14.7456
16
Bit Rate
(bit/s)
n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%) n
N
Error (%)
110
2
248
–0.17
3
64
0.70
3
70
0.03
150
2
181
0.16
2
191
0.00
2
207
0.16
300
2
90
0.16
2
95
0.00
2
103
0.16
600
1
181
0.16
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
1200
1
90
0.16
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
2400
0
181
0.16
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
4800
0
90
0.16
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
9600
0
45
–0.93
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
19200
0
22
–0.93
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
31250
0
13
0.00
0
14
–1.70
0
15
0.00
38400
—
—
—
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
Page 418 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
17.2032
Bit Rate
(bps)
n
N
18
Error (%)
n
N
19.6608
Error (%)
n
N
20
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
75
0.48
3
79
–0.12
3
86
0.31
3
88
–0.25
150
2
223 0.00
2
233
0.16
2
255 0.00
3
64
0.16
300
2
111 0.00
2
116
0.16
2
127 0.00
2
129
0.16
600
1
223 0.00
1
233
0.16
1
255 0.00
2
64
0.16
1200
1
111 0.00
1
116
0.16
1
127 0.00
1
129
0.16
2400
0
223 0.00
0
233
0.16
0
255 0.00
1
64
0.16
4800
0
111 0.00
0
116
0.16
0
127 0.00
0
129
0.16
9600
0
55
0.00
0
58
–0.69
0
63
0.00
0
64
0.16
19200
0
27
0.00
0
28
1.02
0
31
0.00
0
32
–1.36
31250
0
16
1.20
0
17
0.00
0
19
–1.17
0
19
0.00
38400
0
13
0.00
0
14
–2.34
0
15
0.00
0
15
1.73
Operating Frequency
φ (MHz)
24
Bit Rate
(bps)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
106
–0.44
150
3
77
0.16
300
2
155
0.16
600
2
77
0.16
1200
1
155
0.16
2400
1
77
0.16
4800
0
155
0.16
9600
0
77
0.16
19200
0
38
0.16
31250
0
23
0.00
38400
0
19
–2.34
Note: This table shows bit rates when the ABCS bit in SEMRA_0 is cleared to 0.
When the ABCS bit in SEMRA_0 is set to 1, the bit rates are twice those shown in this
table.
In this LSI, operating frequency φ must be 13 MHz or greater.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 419 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Table 13.4 Maximum Bit Rate for Each Frequency (Asynchronous Mode)
Maximum Bit Rate
(kbps)
Maximum Bit Rate
(kbps)
φ (MHz)
ABCS = 0 ABCS = 1 n
N
φ (MHz)
ABCS = 0
ABCS = 1 n
N
2
62.5
125.0
0
0
9.8304
307.2
614.4
0
0
2.097152
65.536
131.027
0
0
10
312.5
625.0
0
0
2.4576
76.8
153.6
0
0
12
375.0
750.0
0
0
3
93.75
187.5
0
0
12.288
384.0
768.0
0
0
3.6864
115.2
230.4
0
0
14
437.5
875.0
0
0
4
125.0
250.0
0
0
14.7456
460.8
921.6
0
0
4.9152
153.6
307.2
0
0
16
500.0
1000.0
0
0
5
156.25
312.5
0
0
17.2032
537.6
1075.2
0
0
6
187.5
375.0
0
0
18
562.5
1125.0
0
0
6.144
192.0
384.0
0
0
19.6608
614.4
1228.8
0
0
7.3728
230.4
460.8
0
0
20
625.0
1250.0
0
0
8
250.0
500.0
0
0
24
750.0
1500.0
0
0
Table 13.5 Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode)
Maximum Bit Rate
(kbps)
Maximum Bit Rate
External
(kbps)
Input
Clock
(MHz)
ABCS = 0 ABCS = 1
φ (MHz)
External
Input
Clock
(MHz)
ABCS = 0 ABCS = 1
2
0.5000
31.25
62.5
9.8304
2.4576
153.6
307.2
2.097152
0.5243
327.68
65.536
10
2.5000
156.25
312.5
φ (MHz)
2.4576
0.6144
38.4
76.8
12
3.0000
187.5
375.0
3
0.7500
46.875
93.75
12.288
3.0720
192.0
384.0
3.6864
0.9216
57.6
115.2
14
3.5000
218.75
437.0
4
1.0000
62.5
125.0
14.7456
3.6864
230.4
460.8
4.9152
1.2288
76.8
153.6
16
4.0000
250.0
500.0
5
1.2500
78.125
156.25
17.2032
4.3008
268.8
537.6
6
1.5000
93.75
187.5
18
4.5000
281.25
562.5
6.144
1.5360
96.0
192.0
19.6608
4.9152
307.2
614.4
7.3728
1.8432
115.2
230.4
20
5.0000
312.5
625.0
8
2.0000
125.0
250.0
24
6.0000
375.0
750.0
Note: In this LSI, operating frequency φ must be 13 MHz or greater.
Page 420 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Table 13.6 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates (Clocked Synchronous Mode)
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
Bit Rate
2
4
6
8
10
16
(bps)
n
N
n
N
n
N
n
N
n
N
n
N
110
3
70 — —
250
2
124 2
249
3
124 — — 3
249
500
1
249 2
124
2
249 — — 3
124
1k
1
124 1
249
2
124 — — 2
249
2.5 k
0
199 1
99 1
149 1
199 1
249 2
99
5k
0
99 0
199 1
74 1
99 1
124 1
199
10 k
0
49 0
99 0
149 0
199 0
249 1
99
25 k
0
19 0
39 0
59 0
79 0
99 0
159
50 k
0
9
0
19 0
29 0
39 0
49 0
79
100 k
0
4
0
9
0
14 0
19 0
24 0
39
250 k
0
1
0
3
0
5
0
7
0
9
0
15
500 k
0
0* 0
1
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
7
1M
0
0*
0
1
0
3
2M
0
0*
0
1
2.5 M
0
0*
4M
0
0*
5M
6M
Legend:
Blank: Cannot be set.
—:
Can be set, but there will be a degree of error.
*:
Continuous transfer is not possible.
n
20
N
n
—
—
2
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
—
—
124
249
124
199
99
49
19
9
4
0
1
0
0*
24
N
—
—
2
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
—
—
—
149
74
149
239
119
59
23
11
5
2
—
—
0
—
0*
Table 13.7 Maximum Bit Rate with External Clock Input (Clocked Synchronous Mode)
φ (MHz)
External Input
Clock (MHz)
Maximum Bit
Rate (Mbps)
φ (MHz)
External Input
Clock (MHz)
Maximum Bit
Rate (Mbps)
2
0.333
0.333
14
2.333
2.333
4
0.667
0.667
16
2.667
2.667
6
1.000
1.000
18
3.000
3.000
8
1.333
1.333
20
3.333
3.333
10
1.667
1.667
24
4.000
4.000
12
2.000
2.000
Note: In this LSI, operating frequency φ must be 13 MHz or greater.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 421 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Table 13.8 BRR Settings for Various Bit Rates
(Smart Card Interface Mode, when n = 0 and S = 372)
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
5.00
Bit Rate
(bps)
N
Error
(%)
6720
0
0.01
9600
0
30.00
7.00
7.1424
10.00
10.7136
13.00
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
1
30.00
1
28.57
1
0.01
1
7.14
2
13.33
0
1.99
0
0.00
1
30.00
1
25.00
1
8.99
N
N
Error (%)
Operating Frequency φ (MHz)
14.2848
16.00
18.00
20.00
24.00
Bit Rate
(bps)
N
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
N
Error
(%)
6720
2
4.76
2
6.67
3
0.01
3
0.01
4
3.99
9600
1
0.00
1
12.01
2
15.99
2
6.66
2
12.01
Table 13.9 Maximum Bit Rate at Various Frequencies (Smart Card Interface Mode)
Maximum Bit Rate (bps)
φ (MHz)
S = 32
S = 64
S = 256
5.00
78125
39063
6.00
93750
46875
7.00
109375
7.1424
S = 372
n
N
9766
6720
0
0
11719
8065
54688
13672
9409
0
0
111600
55800
13950
9600
0
0
10.00
156250
78125
19531
13441
0
0
10.7136
167400
83700
20925
14400
0
0
13.00
203125
101563
25391
17473
0
0
14.2848
223200
111600
27900
19200
0
0
16.00
250000
125000
31250
21505
0
0
18.00
281250
140625
35156
24194
0
0
20.00
312500
156250
39063
26882
0
0
24.00
375000
187500
46875
32258
0
0
Note: In this LSI, operating frequency φ must be 13 MHz or greater.
Page 422 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.4
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Operation in Asynchronous Mode
Figure 13.6 shows the general format for asynchronous serial communication. One frame consists
of a start bit (low level), followed by data (in LSB-first order), a parity bit (high or low level), and
finally stop bits (high level). In asynchronous serial communication, the transmission line is
usually held in the mark state (high level). The SCI monitors the transmission line. When the
transmission line goes to the space state (low level), the SCI recognizes a start bit and starts serial
communication. Inside the SCI, the transmitter and receiver are independent units, enabling fullduplex. Both the transmitter and the receiver also have a double-buffered structure, so data can be
read from or written during transmission or reception, enabling continuous data transfer.
1
Serial
data
LSB
0
D0
Idle state
(mark state)
1
MSB
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
Start
bit
Transmit/receive data
1 bit
7 or 8 bits
D6
D7
0/1
Parity
bit
1 bit,
or none
1
1
Stop bit
1 or
2 bits
One unit of transfer data (character or frame)
Figure 13.6 Data Format in Asynchronous Communication
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, Two Stop Bits)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 423 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.4.1
Data Transfer Format
Table 13.10 shows the data transfer formats that can be used in asynchronous mode. Any of 12
transfer formats can be selected according to the SMR setting. For details on the multiprocessor
bit, refer to section 13.5, Multiprocessor Communication Function.
Table 13.10 Serial Transfer Formats (Asynchronous Mode)
CHR
SMR Settings
PE
MP
STOP
1
2
Serial Transfer Format and Frame Length
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
12
0
0
0
0
S
8-bit data
STOP
0
0
0
1
S
8-bit data
STOP STOP
0
1
0
0
S
8-bit data
P
STOP
0
1
0
1
S
8-bit data
P
STOP STOP
1
0
0
0
S
7-bit data
STOP
1
0
0
1
S
7-bit data
STOP STOP
1
1
0
0
S
7-bit data
P
STOP
1
1
0
1
S
7-bit data
P
STOP STOP
0
–
1
0
S
8-bit data
MPB STOP
0
–
1
1
S
8-bit data
MPB STOP STOP
1
–
1
0
S
7-bit data
MPB STOP
1
–
1
1
S
7-bit data
MPB STOP STOP
Legend:
S:
Start bit
STOP: Stop bit
P:
Parity bit
MPB: Multiprocessor bit
Page 424 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.4.2
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin in Asynchronous Mode
In asynchronous mode, the SCI operates on a basic clock with a frequency of 16 times the transfer
rate. In reception, the SCI samples the falling edge of the start bit using the basic clock, and
performs internal synchronization. Receive data is latched internally at the rising edge of the 8th
pulse of the basic clock as shown in Figure 13.7. Thus, the reception margin in asynchronous
mode is given by formula (1) below.
|
M = (0.5 –
1
) – (L – 0.5) F –
2N
| D – 0.5 |
N
|
(1+ F) × 100 [%]
... Formula (1)
Where M: Reception margin
N: Ratio of bit rate to clock (N = 16 if ABCS = 0, N = 8 if ABCS = 1)
D: Clock duty (D = 0 to 1.0)
L: Frame length (L = 9 to 12)
F: Absolute value of clock rate deviation
Assuming values of F (absolute value of clock rate deviation) = 0, D (clock duty) = 0.5, and N
(ratio of bit rate to clock) = 16 in formula (1), the reception margin can be given by the formula.
M = {0.5 – 1/(2 × 16)} × 100 [%] = 46.875%
However, this is only the computed value, and a margin of 20% to 30% should be allowed for in
system design.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 425 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
16 clocks *
8 clocks *
0
7
15 0
7
15 0
Internal basic
clock
Receive data
(RxD)
Start bit
D0
D1
Synchronization
sampling timing
Data sampling
timing
Note: * Figure 13.7 shows an example when the ABCS bit of SEMR is cleared to 0. When ABCS is set to 1, the clock
frequency of basic clock is 8 times the bit rate and the receive data is sampled at the rising edge of the 4th pulse
of the basic clock.
Figure 13.7 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode
13.4.3
Clock
Either an internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input at
the SCK pin can be selected as the SCI's serial clock, according to the setting of the C/A bit in
SMR and the CKE0 and CKE1 bits in SCR. When an external clock is input at the SCK pin, the
clock frequency should be 16 times the bit rate used. When an external clock is selected, the basic
clock of average transfer rate can be selected according to the ACS2 to ACS0 bit setting of SEMR.
When the SCI is operated on an internal clock, the clock can be output from the SCK pin by
setting CKE1 = 0 and CKE0 = 1. The frequency of the clock output in this case is equal to the bit
rate, and the phase is such that the rising edge of the clock is in the middle of the transmit data, as
shown in figure 13.8.
SCK
0
TxD
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
0/1
1
1
1 frame
Figure 13.8 Relationship between Output Clock and Transfer Data Phase
(Asynchronous Mode)
Page 426 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.4.4
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode)
Before transmitting and receiving data, you should first clear the TE and RE bits in SCR to 0, then
initialize the SCI as described in a sample flowchart in figure 13.9. When the operating mode, or
transfer format, is changed for example, the TE and RE bits must be cleared to 0 before making
the change using the following procedure. When the TE bit is cleared to 0, the TDRE flag is set to
1. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not initialize the contents of the RDRF, PER, FER, and
ORER flags, or the contents of RDR. When the external clock is used in asynchronous mode, the
clock must be supplied even during initialization.
[1]
Start initialization
Set the clock selection in SCR.
Be sure to clear bits RIE, TIE, TEIE, and
MPIE, and bits TE and RE, to 0.
Clear TE and RE bits in SCR to 0
Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR
(TE, RE bits 0)
[1]
Set data transfer format in
SMR, SCMR, and SEMR
[2]
Set value in BRR
[3]
When the clock is selected in
asynchronous mode, it is output
immediately after SCR settings are
made.
[2]
Set the data transfer format in SMR,
SCMR, and SEMR.
[3]
Write a value corresponding to the bit
rate to BRR. Not necessary if an external
clock or average transfer rate clock by
ACS2 to ACS0 is used.
[4]
Wait at least one bit interval, then set the
TE bit or RE bit in SCR to 1. Also set the
RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits.
Wait
No
1-bit interval elapsed?
Yes
Set TE and RE bits* in
SCR to 1, and set RIE, TIE, TEIE,
and MPIE bits
<Initialization completion>
[4]
Note: * Set this bit while the RxD pin is 1. If
the RE bit is set to 1 while the RxD
pin is 0, the signal may erroneously
be recognized as a start bit.
Figure 13.9 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 427 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.4.5
Data Transmission (Asynchronous Mode)
Figure 13.10 shows an example of operation for transmission in asynchronous mode. In
transmission, the SCI operates as described below.
1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. If the flag is cleared to 0, the SCI recognizes that
data has been written to TDR, and transfers the data from TDR to TSR.
2. After transferring data from TDR to TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts
transmission. If the TIE bit is set to 1 at this time, a transmit data empty interrupt request (TXI)
is generated. Continuous transmission is possible because the TXI interrupt routine writes next
transmit data to TDR before transmission of the current transmit data has been completed.
3. Data is sent from the TxD pin in the following order: start bit, transmit data, parity bit or
multiprocessor bit (may be omitted depending on the format), and stop bit.
4. The SCI checks the TDRE flag at the timing for sending the stop bit.
5. If the TDRE flag is 0, the data is transferred from TDR to TSR, the stop bit is sent, and then
serial transmission of the next frame is started.
6. If the TDRE flag is 1, the TEND flag in SSR is set to 1, the stop bit is sent, and then the "mark
state" is entered, in which 1 is output. If the TEIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, a TEI
interrupt request is generated.
1
Start
bit
0
Data
D0
D1
Parity Stop Start
bit
bit
bit
D7
0/1
1
0
Data
D0
D1
Parity Stop
bit
bit
D7
0/1
1
1
Idle state
(mark state)
TDRE
TEND
TXI interrupt
Data written to TDR and
TXI interrupt
request generated TDRE flag cleared to 0 in
request generated
TXI interrupt service routine
TEI interrupt
request generated
1 frame
Figure 13.10 Example of Operation in Transmission in Asynchronous Mode
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit)
Page 428 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Figure 13.11 shows a sample flowchart for transmission in asynchronous mode.
[1]
Initialization
[1]
SCI initialization:
The TxD pin is automatically designated
as the transmit data output pin.
After the TE bit is set to 1, a frame of 1s
is output, and transmission is enabled.
[2]
SCI status check and transmit data write:
Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag
is set to 1, then write transmit data to
TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0.
[3]
Serial transmission continuation
procedure:
To continue serial transmission, read 1
from the TDRE flag to confirm that writing
is possible, then write data to TDR, and
then clear the TDRE flag to 0. Checking
and clearing of the TDRE flag is
automatic when the DMAC or the DTC*
is activated by a transmit data empty
interrupt (TXI) request, and data is written
to TDR.
[4]
Break output at the end of serial
transmission:
To output a break in serial transmission,
set DDR for the port corresponding to the
TxD pin to 1, clear DR to 0, then clear the
TE bit in SCR to 0.
Start transmission
Read TDRE flag in SSR
TDRE = 1
[2]
No
Yes
Write transmit data to TDR
and clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0
All data transmitted?
No
Yes
[3]
Read TEND flag in SSR
TEND = 1
No
Yes
Break output?
No
[4]
Yes
Clear DR to 0 and set DDR to 1
Clear TE bit in SCR to 0
<End>
Note: * Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag are performed automatically by the DTC when the DTC’s DISEL bit is
cleared to 0 and the transfer counter value is not 0. Consequently, it is necessary to use the CPU to clear the
TDRE flag if DISEL is set to 1 or if the transfer counter value is 0.
Figure 13.11 Sample Serial Transmission Data Flowchart
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 429 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.4.6
Serial Data Reception (Asynchronous Mode)
Figure 13.12 shows an example of operation for reception in asynchronous mode. In serial
reception, the SCI operates as described below.
1. The SCI monitors the communication line. If a start bit is detected, the SCI performs internal
synchronization, receives receive data in RSR, and checks the parity bit and stop bit.
2. If an overrun error occurs (when reception of the next data is completed while the RDRF flag
is still set to 1), the ORER bit in SSR is set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an
ERI interrupt request is generated. Receive data is not transferred to RDR. The RDRF flag
remains to be set to 1.
3. If a parity error is detected, the PER bit in SSR is set to 1 and receive data is transferred to
RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an ERI interrupt request is generated.
4. If a framing error is detected (when the stop bit is 0), the FER bit in SSR is set to 1 and receive
data is transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an ERI interrupt
request is generated.
5. If reception is completed successfully, the RDRF bit in SSR is set to 1, and receive data is
transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an RXI interrupt request is
generated. Continuous reception is possible because the RXI interrupt routine reads the receive
data transferred to RDR before reception of the next receive data has been completed.
1
Start
bit
0
RxD
Data
D0
D1
Parity Stop Start
bit
bit
bit
D7
0/1
1
0
Data
D0
D1
Parity Stop
bit
bit
D7
0/1
0
1
Idle state
(mark state)
After confirming that RxD = 1, set the RE bit to 1
RE
RDRF
FER
RXI interrupt
request
generated
RDR data read and RDRF
flag cleared to 0 in RXI
interrupt service routine
ERI interrupt request
generated by framing
error
1 frame
Figure 13.12 Example of SCI Operation in Reception
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Parity, One Stop Bit)
Page 430 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Table 13.11 shows the states of the SSR status flags and receive data handling when a receive
error is detected. If a receive error is detected, the RDRF flag retains its state before receiving
data. Reception cannot be resumed while a receive error flag is set to 1. Accordingly, clear the
ORER, FER, PER, and RDRF bits to 0 before resuming reception. Figure 13.13 shows a sample
flow chart for serial data reception.
Table 13.11 SSR Status Flags and Receive Data Handling
SSR Status Flag
RDRF*
ORER
FER
PER
Receive Data
Receive Error Type
1
1
0
0
Lost
Overrun error
0
0
1
0
Transferred to RDR
Framing error
0
0
0
1
Transferred to RDR
Parity error
1
1
1
0
Lost
Overrun error + framing error
1
1
0
1
Lost
Overrun error + parity error
0
0
1
1
Transferred to RDR
Framing error + parity error
1
1
1
1
Lost
Overrun error + framing error +
parity error
Note:
*
The RDRF flag retains the state it had before data reception.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 431 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
[1]
Initialization
[1]
SCI initialization:
The RxD pin is automatically designated as
the receive data input pin.
[2]
[3] Receive error processing and break
detection:
If a receive error occurs, read the ORER,
PER, and FER flags in SSR to identify the
error. After performing the appropriate error
processing, ensure that the ORER, PER, and
FER flags are all cleared to 0. Reception
cannot be resumed if any of these flags are
set to 1. In the case of a framing error, a
break can be detected by reading the value
of the input port corresponding to the RxD
pin.
[4]
SCI status check and receive data read:
Read SSR and check that RDRF = 1, then
read the receive data in RDR and clear the
RDRF flag to 0. Transition of the RDRF flag
from 0 to 1 can also be identified by an RXI
interrupt.
[5]
Serial reception continuation procedure:
To continue serial reception, before the end
bit for the current frame is received, reading
the RDRF flag and RDR, and clearing the
RDRF flag to 0 should be finished. The RDRF
flag is cleared automatically when DMAC or
the DTC* is activated by a reception
complete interrupt (RXI) and the RDR value
is read.
Start reception
[2]
Read ORER, PER, and
FER flags in SSR
Yes
PER ∨ FER ∨ ORER = 1
[3]
No
Error processing
(Continued on next page)
Read RDRF flag in SSR
[4]
No
RDRF = 1
Yes
Read receive data in RDR, and
clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0
No
All data received?
Yes
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
[5]
<End>
Note: * Clearing of the RDRF flag are performed automatically by the DTC when the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared to 0
and the transfer counter value is not 0. Consequently, it is necessary to use the CPU to clear the RDRF flag if
DISEL is set to 1 or if the transfer counter value is 0.
Figure 13.13 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (1)
Page 432 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
[3]
Error processing
No
ORER = 1
Yes
Overrun error processing
No
FER = 1
Yes
Break?
Yes
No
Framing error processing
No
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
PER = 1
Yes
Parity error processing
Clear ORER, PER, and
FER flags in SSR to 0
<End>
Figure 13.13 Sample Serial Reception Data Flowchart (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 433 of 846
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.5
H8S/2215 Group
Multiprocessor Communication Function
Use of the multiprocessor communication function enables data transfer between a number of
processors sharing communication lines by asynchronous serial communication using the
multiprocessor format, in which a multiprocessor bit is added to the transfer data. When
multiprocessor communication is performed, each receiving station is addressed by a unique ID
code. The serial communication cycle consists of two component cycles; an ID transmission cycle
that specifies the receiving station, and a data transmission cycle. The multiprocessor bit is used to
differentiate between the ID transmission cycle and the data transmission cycle. If the
multiprocessor bit is 1, the cycle is an ID transmission cycle; if the multiprocessor bit is 0, the
cycle is a data transmission cycle. Figure 13.14 shows an example of inter-processor
communication using the multiprocessor format. The transmitting station first sends the ID code
of the receiving station with which it wants to perform serial communication as data with a 1
multiprocessor bit added. It then sends transmit data as data with a 0 multiprocessor bit added.
When data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is received, the receiving station compares that data with its
own ID. The station whose ID matches then receives the data sent next. Stations whose ID do not
match continue to skip data until data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is again received.
The SCI uses the MPIE bit in SCR to implement this function. When the MPIE bit is set to 1,
transfer of receive data from RSR to RDR, error flag detection, and setting the SSR status flags,
RDRF, FER, and ORER to 1, are inhibited until data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is received. On
reception of a receive character with a 1 multiprocessor bit, the MPB bit in SSR is set to 1 and the
MPIE bit is automatically cleared, thus normal reception is resumed. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to
1 at this time, an RXI interrupt is generated.
When the multiprocessor format is selected, the parity bit setting is rendered invalid. All other bit
settings are the same as those in normal asynchronous mode. The clock used for multiprocessor
communication is the same as that in normal asynchronous mode.
Page 434 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Transmitting
station
Serial transmission line
Receiving
station A
Receiving
station B
Receiving
station C
Receiving
station D
(ID = 01)
(ID = 02)
(ID = 03)
(ID = 04)
Serial
data
H'01
H'AA
(MPB = 1)
Legend:
MPB: Multiprocessor bit
ID transmission cycle =
receiving station
specification
(MPB = 0)
Data transmission cycle =
Data transmission to
receiving station specified by ID
Figure 13.14 Example of Communication Using Multiprocessor Format
(Transmission of Data H'AA to Receiving Station A)
13.5.1
Multiprocessor Serial Data Transmission
Figure 13.15 shows a sample flowchart for multiprocessor serial data transmission. For an ID
transmission cycle, set the MPBT bit in SSR to 1 before transmission. For a data transmission
cycle, clear the MPBT bit in SSR to 0 before transmission. All other SCI operations are the same
as those in asynchronous mode.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 435 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
[1]
Initialization
[1]
SCI initialization:
The TxD pin is automatically
designated as the transmit data
output pin.
After the TE bit is set to 1, a frame of
1s is output, and transmission is
enabled.
[2]
SCI status check and transmit data
write:
Read SSR and check that the TDRE
flag is set to 1, then write transmit
data to TDR. Set the MPBT bit in SSR
to 0 or 1. Finally, clear the TDRE flag
to 0.
[3]
Serial transmission continuation
procedure:
To continue serial transmission, be
sure to read 1 from the TDRE flag to
confirm that writing is possible, then
write data to TDR, and then clear the
TDRE flag to 0. Checking and
clearing of the TDRE flag is automatic
when the DMAC or the DTC* is
activated by a transmit data empty
interrupt (TXI) request, and data is
written to TDR.
[4]
Break output at the end of serial
transmission:
To output a break in serial
transmission, set the port DDR to 1,
clear DR to 0, then clear the TE bit in
SCR to 0.
Start transmission
Read TDRE flag in SSR
[2]
No
TDRE = 1
Yes
Write transmit data to TDR and
set MPBT bit in SSR
Clear TDRE flag to 0
No
[3]
All data transmitted?
Yes
Read TEND flag in SSR
No
TEND = 1
Yes
No
Break output?
Yes
Clear DR to 0 and set DDR to 1
[4]
Note: * Checking and clearing of the
TDRE flag are performed
automatically by the DTC when
the DTC’s DISEL bit is cleared
to 0 and the transfer counter
value is not 0. Consequently, it
is necessary to use the CPU to
clear the TDRE flag if DISEL is
set to 1 or if the transfer
counter value is 0.
Clear TE bit in SCR to 0
<End>
Figure 13.15 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Transmission Flowchart
Page 436 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.5.2
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Multiprocessor Serial Data Reception
Figure 13.17 shows a sample flowchart for multiprocessor serial data reception. If the MPIE bit in
SCR is set to 1, data is skipped until data with a 1 multiprocessor bit is sent. On receiving data
with a 1 multiprocessor bit, the receive data is transferred to RDR. An RXI interrupt request is
generated at this time. All other SCI operations are the same as in asynchronous mode. Figure
13.16 shows an example of SCI operation for multiprocessor format reception.
1
Start
bit
0
Data (ID1)
MPB
D0
D1
D7
1
Stop
bit
Start
bit
1
0
Data (Data1)
D0
D1
D7
Stop
MPB bit
0
1
1 Idle state
(mark state)
MPIE
RDRF
RDR
value
ID1
MPIE = 0
RXI interrupt
request
(multiprocessor
interrupt)
generated
If not this station’s ID, RXI interrupt request is
not generated, and RDR
MPIE bit is set to 1
retains its state
again
RDR data read
and RDRF flag
cleared to 0 in
RXI interrupt
service routine
(a) Data does not match station’s ID
1
Start
bit
0
Data (ID2)
D0
D1
D7
Stop
MPB bit
1
1
Start
bit
0
Data (Data2)
D0
D1
D7
Stop
MPB bit
0
1
1 Idle state
(mark state)
MPIE
RDRF
RDR
value
ID2
ID1
MPIE = 0
RXI interrupt
request
(multiprocessor
interrupt)
generated
RDR data read and
RDRF flag cleared
to 0 in RXI interrupt
service routine
Data2
MPIE bit set to 1
Matches this station’s ID,
so reception continues, and again
data is received in RXI
interrupt service routine
(b) Data matches station’s ID
Figure 13.16 Example of SCI Operation in Reception
(Example with 8-Bit Data, Multiprocessor Bit, One Stop Bit)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 437 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Initialization
Start reception
Read MPIE bit in SCR
[1]
SCI initialization:
The RxD pin is automatically designated as
the receive data input pin.
[2]
ID reception cycle:
Set the MPIE bit in SCR to 1.
[3]
SCI status check, ID reception and
comparison:
Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is
set to 1, then read the receive data in RDR
and compare it with this station’s ID.
If the data is not this station’s ID, set the MPIE
bit to 1 again, and clear the RDRF flag to 0.
If the data is this station’s ID, clear the RDRF
flag to 0.
[4]
SCI status check and data reception:
Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is
set to 1, then read the data in RDR.
[5]
Receive error processing and break detection:
If a receive error occurs, read the ORER and
FER flags in SSR to identify the error. After
performing the appropriate error processing,
ensure that the ORER and FER flags are all
cleared to 0.
Reception cannot be resumed if either of
these flags is set to 1.
In the case of a framing error, a break can be
detected by reading the RxD pin value.
[1]
[2]
Read ORER and FER flags in SSR
Yes
FER∨ORER = 1
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
[3]
No
RDRF = 1
Yes
Read receive data in RDR
No
This station’s ID?
Yes
Read ORER and FER flags in SSR
FER ∨ ORER = 1
Yes
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
[4]
No
RDRF = 1
Yes
Read receive data in RDR
No
All data received?
[5]
Error processing
Yes
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
(Continued on
next page)
<End>
Figure 13.17 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (1)
Page 438 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
[5]
Error processing
No
ORER = 1
Yes
Overrun error processing
No
FER = 1
Yes
Yes
Break?
No
Framing error processing
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
Clear ORER, PER, and
FER flags in SSR to 0
<End>
Figure 13.17 Sample Multiprocessor Serial Reception Flowchart (2)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 439 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.6
Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode
Figure 13.18 shows the general format for clocked synchronous communication. In clocked
synchronous mode, data is transmitted or received synchronous with clock pulses. In clocked
synchronous serial communication, data on the transmission line is output from one falling edge of
the serial clock to the next. In clocked synchronous mode, the SCI receives data in synchronous
with the rising edge of the serial clock. After 8-bit data is output, the transmission line holds the
MSB state. In clocked synchronous mode, no parity or multiprocessor bit is added. Inside the SCI,
the transmitter and receiver are independent units, enabling full-duplex communication through
the use of a common clock. Both the transmitter and the receiver also have a double-buffered
structure, so data can be read from or written during transmission or reception, enabling
continuous data transfer.
One unit of transfer data (character or frame)
*
*
Synchronization
clock
LSB
Bit 0
Serial data
MSB
Bit 1
Don't care
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Don't care
Note: * High except in continuous transfer
Figure 13.18 Data Format in Synchronous Communication (For LSB-First)
13.6.1
Clock
Either an internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external
synchronization clock input at the SCK pin can be selected, according to the setting of CKE0 and
CKE1 bits in SCR. When the SCI is operated on an internal clock, the serial clock is output from
the SCK pin. Eight serial clock pulses are output in the transfer of one character, and when no
transfer is performed the clock is fixed high.
Page 440 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.6.2
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
SCI Initialization (Clocked Synchronous Mode)
Before transmitting and receiving data, the TE and RE bits in SCR should be cleared to 0, then the
SCI should be initialized as described in a sample flowchart in figure 13.19. When the operating
mode, or transfer format, is changed for example, the TE and RE bits must be cleared to 0 before
making the change using the following procedure. When the TE bit is cleared to 0, the TDRE flag
is set to 1. Note that clearing the RE bit to 0 does not change the contents of the RDRF, PER,
FER, and ORER flags, or the contents of RDR.
Start initialization
Clear TE and RE bits in SCR to 0
[1]
Set the clock selection in SCR. Be sure to
clear bits RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, TE, and RE,
to 0.
[2]
Set the data transfer format in SMR and
SCMR.
Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR
(TE, RE bits 0)
[1]
[3]
Write a value corresponding to the bit rate to
BRR. Not necessary if an external clock is
used.
Set data transfer format in
SMR and SCMR
[2]
[4]
Set value in BRR
[3]
Wait at least one bit interval, then set the TE
bit or RE bit in SCR to 1.
Also set the RIE, TIE TEIE, and MPIE bits.
Setting the TE and RE bits enables the TxD
and RxD pins to be used.
Wait
No
1-bit interval elapsed?
Yes
Set TE and RE bits in SCR to 1, and
set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits
[4]
<Transfer start>
Note: In simultaneous transmit and receive operations, the TE and RE bits should both be cleared
to 0 or set to 1 simultaneously.
Figure 13.19 Sample SCI Initialization Flowchart
13.6.3
Serial Data Transmission (Clocked Synchronous Mode)
Figure 13.20 shows an example of SCI operation for transmission in clocked synchronous mode.
In serial transmission, the SCI operates as described below.
1. The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR, and if the flag is 0, the SCI recognizes that data has
been written to TDR, and transfers the data from TDR to TSR.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 441 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
2. After transferring data from TDR to TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts
transmission. If the TIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, a transmit data empty interrupt (TXI)
is generated. Continuous transmission is possible because the TXI interrupt routine writes the
next transmit data to TDR before transmission of the current transmit data has been completed.
3. 8-bit data is sent from the TxD pin synchronized with the output clock when output clock
mode has been specified, and synchronized with the input clock when use of an external clock
has been specified.
4. The SCI checks the TDRE flag at the timing for sending the MSB (bit 7).
5. If the TDRE flag is cleared to 0, data is transferred from TDR to TSR, and serial transmission
of the next frame is started.
6. If the TDRE flag is set to 1, the TEND flag in SSR is set to 1, and the TDRE flag maintains the
output state of the last bit. If the TEIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, a TEI interrupt request
is generated. The SCK pin is fixed high.
Figure 13.21 shows a sample flow chart for serial data transmission. Even if the TDRE flag is
cleared to 0, transmission will not start while a receive error flag (ORER, FER, or PER) is set to 1.
Make sure that the receive error flags are cleared to 0 before starting transmission. Note that
clearing the RE bit to 0 does not clear the receive error flags.
Transfer direction
Synchronization
clock
Serial data
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 6
Bit 7
TDRE
TEND
TXI interrupt request
generated
Data written to TDR and
TDRE flag cleared to 0 in
TXI interrupt service
routine
TXI interrupt request
generated
TEI interrupt request
generated
1 frame
Figure 13.20 Sample SCI Transmission Operation in Clocked Synchronous Mode
Page 442 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Initialization
[1]
Start transmission
Read TDRE flag in SSR
SCI initialization:
The TxD pin is automatically designated as
the transmit data output pin.
[2]
SCI status check and transmit data write:
Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag is
set to 1, then write transmit data to TDR
and clear the TDRE flag to 0.
[3]
Serial transmission continuation procedure:
To continue serial transmission, be sure to
read 1 from the TDRE flag to confirm that
writing is possible, then write data to TDR,
and then clear the TDRE flag to 0.
Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag is
automatic when the DMAC or the DTC* is
activated by a transmit data empty interrupt
(TXI) request and data is written to TDR.
[2]
No
TDRE = 1
Yes
Write transmit data to TDR and
clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0
No
All data transmitted?
[3]
Yes
Read TEND flag in SSR
No
TEND = 1
[1]
Note: * Checking and clearing of the
TDRE flag are performed
automatically by the DTC when
the DTC’s DISEL bit is cleared
to 0 and the transfer counter
value is not 0. Consequently, it
is necessary to use the CPU to
clear the TDRE flag if DISEL is
set to 1 or if the transfer
counter value is 0.
Yes
Clear TE bit in SCR to 0
<End>
Figure 13.21 Sample Serial Transmission Data Flowchart
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 443 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.6.4
Serial Data Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode)
Figure 13.22 shows an example of SCI operation for reception in clocked synchronous mode. In
serial reception, the SCI operates as described below.
1. The SCI performs internal initialization synchronous with a synchronous clock input or output,
starts receiving data, and stores the received data in RSR.
2. If an overrun error occurs (when reception of the next data is completed while the RDRF flag
in SSR is still set to 1), the ORER bit in SSR is set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this
time, an ERI interrupt request is generated, receive data is not transferred to RDR, and the
RDRF flag remains to be set to 1.
3. If reception is completed successfully, the RDRF bit in SSR is set to 1, and receive data is
transferred to RDR. If the RIE bit in SCR is set to 1 at this time, an RXI interrupt request is
generated. Continuous reception is possible because the RXI interrupt routine reads the receive
data transferred to RDR before reception of the next receive data has finished.
Synchronization
clock
Bit 7
Serial data
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 6
Bit 7
RDRF
ORER
RXI interrupt
request
generated
RDR data read and
RDRF flag cleared to 0
in RXI interrupt service
routine
RXI interrupt request
generated
ERI interrupt request
generated by overrun
error
1 frame
Figure 13.22 Example of SCI Operation in Reception
Reception cannot be resumed while a receive error flag is set to 1. Accordingly, clear the ORER,
FER, PER, and RDRF bits to 0 before resuming reception. Figure 13.23 shows a sample flow
chart for serial data reception.
When the internal clock is selected during reception, the synchronization clock will be output until
an overrun error occurs or the RE bit is cleared. To receive data in frame units, a dummy data of
one frame must be transmitted simultaneously.
Page 444 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Initialization
[1]
[1]
SCI initialization:
The RxD pin is automatically designated as
the receive data input pin.
[2]
[3] Receive error processing:
If a receive error occurs, read the ORER
flag in SSR, and after performing the
appropriate error processing, clear the
ORER flag to 0. Transfer cannot be
resumed if the ORER flag is set to 1.
[4]
SCI status check and receive data read:
Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag is
set to 1, then read the receive data in RDR
and clear the RDRF flag to 0.
Transition of the RDRF flag from 0 to 1 can
also be identified by an RXI interrupt.
[5]
Serial reception continuation procedure:
To continue serial reception, before the
MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is received,
reading the RDRF flag, reading RDR, and
clearing the RDRF flag to 0 should be
finished. The RDRF flag is cleared
automatically when the DMAC or the DTC*
is activated by a receive data full interrupt
(RXI) request and the RDR value is read.
Start reception
Read ORER flag in SSR
[2]
Yes
ORER = 1
[3]
No
Error processing
(Continued below)
Read RDRF flag in SSR
No
[4]
RDRF = 1
Yes
Read receive data in RDR, and
clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0
No
All data received?
[5]
Yes
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
<End>
[3]
Error processing
Overrun error processing
Note: * Clearing of the RDRF flag are
performed automatically by the DTC
when the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared to
0 and the transfer counter value is not
0. Consequently, it is necessary to use
the CPU to clear the RDRF flag if
DISEL is set to 1 or if the transfer
counter value is 0.
Clear ORER flag in SSR to 0
<End>
Figure 13.23 Sample Serial Reception Flowchart
13.6.5
Simultaneous Serial Data Transmission and Reception (Clocked Synchronous Mode)
Figure 13.24 shows a sample flowchart for simultaneous serial transmit and receive operations.
The following procedure should be used for simultaneous serial data transmit and receive
operations. To switch from transmit mode to simultaneous transmit and receive mode, after
checking that the SCI has finished transmission and the TDRE and TEND flags are set to 1, clear
TE to 0. Then simultaneously set TE and RE to 1 with a single instruction. To switch from receive
mode to simultaneous transmit and receive mode, after checking that the SCI has finished
reception, clear RE to 0. Then after checking that the RDRF and receive error flags (ORER, FER,
and PER) are cleared to 0, simultaneously set TE and RE to 1 with a single instruction.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 445 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Initialization
[1]
[1]
SCI initialization:
The TxD pin is designated as the
transmit data output pin, and the RxD pin
is designated as the receive data input
pin, enabling simultaneous transmit and
receive operations.
[2]
SCI status check and transmit data write:
Read SSR and check that the TDRE flag
is set to 1, then write transmit data to
TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0.
Transition of the TDRE flag from 0 to 1
can also be identified by a TXI interrupt.
Receive error processing:
If a receive error occurs, read the ORER
flag in SSR, and after performing the
appropriate error processing, clear the
ORER flag to 0. Transmission/reception
cannot be resumed if the ORER flag is
set to 1.
Start transmission/reception
Read TDRE flag in SSR
[2]
No
TDRE = 1
Yes
Write transmit data to TDR and
clear TDRE flag in SSR to 0
[3]
Read ORER flag in SSR
ORER = 1
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
Yes
[3]
[4]
SCI status check and receive data read:
Read SSR and check that the RDRF flag
is set to 1, then read the receive data in
RDR and clear the RDRF flag to 0.
Transition of the RDRF flag from 0 to 1
can also be identified by an RXI
interrupt.
[5]
Serial transmission/reception
continuation procedure:
To continue serial transmission/
reception, before the MSB (bit 7) of the
current frame is received, finish reading
the RDRF flag, reading RDR, and
clearing the RDRF flag to 0. Also, before
the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is
transmitted, read 1 from the TDRE flag
to confirm that writing is possible. Then
write data to TDR and clear the TDRE
flag to 0.
Checking and clearing of the TDRE flag
is automatic when the DMAC or the
DTC* is activated by a transmit data
empty interrupt (TXI) request and data is
written to TDR. Also, the RDRF flag is
cleared automatically when the DMAC or
the DTC* is activated by a receive data
full interrupt (RXI) request and the RDR
value is read.
Error processing
[4]
No
RDRF = 1
Yes
Read receive data in RDR, and
clear RDRF flag in SSR to 0
No
All data received?
[5]
Yes
Clear TE and RE bits in SCR to 0
<End>
Notes: When switching from transmit or receive operation to simultaneous
transmit and receive operations, first clear the TE bit and RE bit to 0,
then set both these bits to 1 simultaneously.
* The TDRE and RDRF flags are automatically cleared by the DTC
when the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared to 0 and the transfer counter
value is not 0. Consequently, it is necessary to use the CPU to
clear the TDRE and RDRF flags if DISEL is set to 1 or if the
transfer counter value is 0.
Figure 13.24 Sample Flowchart of Simultaneous Serial Transmit and Receive Operations
Page 446 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.7
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Operation in Smart Card Interface
The SCI supports an IC card (Smart Card) interface that conforms to ISO/IEC 7816-3
(Identification Card) as a serial communication interface extension function. Switching between
the normal serial communication interface and the Smart Card interface mode is carried out by
means of a register setting.
13.7.1
Pin Connection Example
Figure 13.25 shows an example of connection with the Smart Card. In communication with an IC
card, as both transmission and reception are carried out on a single data transmission line, the TxD
pin and RxD pin should be connected to the LSI pin. The data transmission line should be pulled
up to the VCC power supply with a resistor. If an IC card is not connected, and the TE and RE bits
are both set to 1, closed transmission/reception is possible, enabling self-diagnosis to be carried
out. When the clock generated on the Smart Card interface is used by an IC card, the SCK pin
output is input to the CLK pin of the IC card. This LSI port output is used as the reset signal.
VCC
TxD
RxD
SCK
Rx (port)
This LSI
Data line
Clock line
Reset line
I/O
CLK
RST
IC card
Connected equipment
Figure 13.25 Schematic Diagram of Smart Card Interface Pin Connections
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 447 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.7.2
Data Format (Except for Block Transfer Mode)
Figure 13.26 shows the transfer data format in Smart Card interface mode.
• One frame consists of 8-bit data plus a parity bit in asynchronous mode.
• In transmission, a guard time of at least 2 etu (Elementary time unit: the time for transfer of
one bit) is left between the end of the parity bit and the start of the next frame.
• If a parity error is detected during reception, a low error signal level is output for one etu
period, 10.5 etu after the start bit.
• If an error signal is sampled during transmission, the same data is retransmitted automatically
after a delay of 2 etu or longer.
When there is no parity error
Ds
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Dp
D6
D7
Dp
Transmitting station output
When a parity error occurs
Ds
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
DE
Transmitting station output
Legend:
DS:
D0 to D7:
Dp:
DE:
Receiving station
output
Start bit
Data bits
Parity bit
Error signal
Figure 13.26 Normal Smart Card Interface Data Format
Data transfer with other types of IC cards (direct convention and inverse convention) are
performed as described in the following.
(Z)
A
Z
Z
A
Z
Z
Z
A
A
Z
Ds
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Dp
(Z)
State
Figure 13.27 Direct Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 0)
With the direction convention type IC and the above sample start character, the logic 1 level
corresponds to state Z and the logic 0 level to state A, and transfer is performed in LSB-first order.
The start character data above is H'3B. For the direct convention type, clear the SDIR and SINV
Page 448 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
bits in SCMR to 0. According to Smart Card regulations, clear the O/E bit in SMR to 0 to select
even parity mode.
(Z)
A
Z
Z
A
A
A
A
A
A
Z
Ds
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Dp
(Z)
State
Figure 13.28 Inverse Convention (SDIR = SINV = O/E = 1)
With the inverse convention type, the logic 1 level corresponds to state A and the logic 0 level to
state Z, and transfer is performed in MSB-first order. The start character data for the above is
H'3F. For the inverse convention type, set the SDIR and SINV bits in SCMR to 1. According to
Smart Card regulations, even parity mode is the logic 0 level of the parity bit, and corresponds to
state Z. In this LSI, the SINV bit inverts only data bits D0 to D7. Therefore, set the O/E bit in
SMR to 1 to invert the parity bit for both transmission and reception.
13.7.3
Clock
Only an internal clock which is generated by the on-chip baud rate generator is used as a
transmit/receive clock. When an output clock is selected by setting CKE0 to 1, a clock with a
frequency S* times the bit rate is output from the SCK pin.
Note: * S is the value shown in section 13.3.12, Bit Rate Register (BRR).
13.7.4
Block Transfer Mode
Operation in block transfer mode is the same as that in the normal Smart Card interface mode,
except for the following points.
• In reception, though the parity check is performed, no error signal is output even if an error is
detected. However, the PER bit in SSR is set to 1 and must be cleared before receiving the
parity bit of the next frame.
• In transmission, a guard time of at least 1 etu is left between the end of the parity bit and the
start of the next frame.
• In transmission, because retransmission is not performed, the TEND flag is set to 1, 11.5 etu
after transmission start.
• As with the normal Smart Card interface, the ERS flag indicates the error signal status, but
since error signal transfer is not performed, this flag is always cleared to 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 449 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.7.5
Receive Data Sampling Timing and Reception Margin
In Smart Card interface mode an internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator can
only be used as a transmission/reception clock. In this mode, the SCI operates on a basic clock
with a frequency of 32, 64, 372, or 256 times the transfer rate (fixed to 16 times in normal
asynchronous mode) as determined by bits BCP1 and BCP0. In reception, the SCI samples the
falling edge of the start bit using the basic clock, and performs internal synchronization. As shown
in figure 13.29, by sampling receive data at the rising-edge of the 16th, 32nd, 186th, or 128th
pulse of the basic clock, data can be latched at the middle of the bit. The reception margin is given
by the following formula.
|
M = (0.5 –
1
) – (L – 0.5) F –
2N
| D – 0.5 |
N
|
(1+ F) × 100 [%]
Where M: Reception margin (%)
N: Ratio of bit rate to clock (N = 32, 64, 372, and 256)
D: Clock duty (D = 0 to 1.0)
L: Frame length (L = 10)
F: Absolute value of clock frequency deviation
Assuming values of F = 0, D = 0.5 and N = 372 in the above formula, the reception margin
formula is as follows.
M = (0.5 – 1/2 × 372) × 100%
= 49.866%
372 clocks
186 clocks
0
185
185
371 0
371 0
Internal
basic clock
Receive data
(RxD)
Start bit
D0
D1
Synchronization
sampling timing
Data sampling
timing
Figure 13.29 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Smart Card Mode
(Using Clock of 372 Times the Transfer Rate)
Page 450 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.7.6
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Initialization
Before transmitting and receiving data, initialize the SCI as described below. Initialization is also
necessary when switching from transmit mode to receive mode, or vice versa.
1. Clear the TE and RE bits in SCR to 0.
2. Clear the error flags ERS, PER, and ORER in SSR to 0.
3. Set the GM, BLK, O/E, BCP0, BCP1, CKS0, CKS1 bits in SMR. Set the PE bit to 1.
4. Set the SMIF, SDIR, and SINV bits in SCMR.
When the SMIF bit is set to 1, the TxD and RxD pins are both switched from ports to SCI pins,
and are placed in the high-impedance state.
5. Set the value corresponding to the bit rate in BRR.
6. Set the CKE0 and CKE1 bits in SCR. Clear the TIE, RIE, TE, RE, MPIE, and TEIE bits to 0.
If the CKE0 bit is set to 1, the clock is output from the SCK pin.
7. Wait at least one bit interval, then set the TIE, RIE, TE, and RE bits in SCR. Do not set the TE
bit and RE bit at the same time, except for self-diagnosis.
To switch from receive mode to transmit mode, after checking that the SCI has finished reception,
initialize the SCI, and set RE to 0 and TE to 1. Whether SCI has finished reception or not can be
checked with the RDRF, PER, or ORER flags. To switch from transmit mode to receive mode,
after checking that the SCI has finished transmission, initialize the SCI, and set TE to 0 and RE to
1. Whether SCI has finished transmission or not can be checked with the TEND flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 451 of 846
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.7.7
H8S/2215 Group
Serial Data Transmission (Except for Block Transfer Mode)
As data transmission in Smart Card interface mode involves error signal sampling and
retransmission processing, the operations are different from those in normal serial communication
interface mode (except for block transfer mode). Figure 13.30 illustrates the retransfer operation
when the SCI is in transmit mode.
1. If an error signal is sent back from the receiving end after transmission of one frame is
complete, the ERS bit in SSR is set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is enabled at this time, an ERI
interrupt request is generated. The ERS bit in SSR should be cleared to 0 by the time the next
parity bit is sampled.
2. The TEND bit in SSR is not set for a frame in which an error signal indicating an abnormality
is received. Data is retransferred from TDR to TSR, and retransmitted automatically.
3. If an error signal is not sent back from the receiving end, the ERS bit in SSR is not set.
Transmission of one frame, including a retransfer, is judged to have been completed, and the
TEND bit in SSR is set to 1. If the TIE bit in SCR is enabled at this time, a TXI interrupt
request is generated. Writing transmit data to TDR transfers the next transmit data.
Figure 13.32 shows a flowchart for transmission. A sequence of transmit operations can be
performed automatically by specifying the DTC or the DMAC to be activated with a TXI interrupt
source. In a transmit operation, the TDRE flag is set to 1 at the same time as the TEND flag in
SSR is set, and a TXI interrupt will be generated if the TIE bit in SCR has been set to 1. If the TXI
request is designated beforehand as a DTC* or the DMAC activation source, the DTC* or the
DMAC will be activated by the TXI request, and transfer of the transmit data will be carried out.
The TDRE and TEND flags are automatically cleared to 0 when data is transferred by the DTC*
or the DMAC. In the event of an error, the SCI retransmits the same data automatically. During
this period, the TEND flag remains cleared to 0 and the DTC* or the DMAC is not activated.
Therefore, the SCI and DTC* or the DMAC will automatically transmit the specified number of
bytes in the event of an error, including retransmission. However, the ERS flag is not cleared
automatically when an error occurs, and so the RIE bit should be set to 1 beforehand so that an
ERI request will be generated in the event of an error, and the ERS flag will be cleared.
When performing transfer using the DMAC or the DTC, it is essential to set and enable the
DMAC or the DTC* before carrying out SCI setting. For details of the DMAC or the DTC*
setting procedures, refer to section 8, Data Transfer Controller (DTC) or section 7, DMA
controller (DMAC).
Note: * The Flags are automatically cleared by the DTC when the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared
to 0 and the transfer counter value is not 0.
Page 452 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
nth transfer frame
Transfer
frame n + 1
Retransferred frame
Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE
Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp
(DE)
Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4
TDRE
Transfer to TSR from TDR
Transfer to TSR
from TDR
Transfer to TSR from TDR
TEND
FER/ERS
Figure 13.30 Retransfer Operation in SCI Transmit Mode
The timing for setting the TEND flag depends on the value of the GM bit in SMR. The TEND flag
set timing is shown in figure 13.31.
I/O data
Ds
TXI
(TEND interrupt)
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Dp
DE
Guard
time
12.5 etu
When GM = 0
11.0 etu
When GM = 1
Legend:
Ds:
D0 to D7:
Dp:
DE:
Start bit
Data bits
Parity bit
Error signal
Figure 13.31 TEND Flag Generation Timing in Transmission Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 453 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Start
Initialization
Start transmission
ERS = 0?
No
Yes
Error processing
No
TEND = 1?
Yes
Write data to TDR,
and clear TDRE flag
in SSR to 0
No
All data transmitted ?
Yes
No
ERS = 0?
Yes
Error processing
No
TEND = 1?
Yes
Clear TE bit to 0
End
Figure 13.32 Example of Transmission Processing Flow
Page 454 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.7.8
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Serial Data Reception (Except for Block Transfer Mode)
Data reception in Smart Card interface mode uses the same operation procedure as for normal
serial communication interface mode. Figure 13.33 illustrates the retransfer operation when the
SCI is in receive mode.
1. If an error is found when the received parity bit is checked, the PER bit in SSR is
automatically set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is set at this time, an ERI interrupt request is
generated. The PER bit in SSR should be kept cleared to 0 until the next parity bit is sampled.
2. The RDRF bit in SSR is not set for a frame in which an error has occurred.
3. If no error is found when the received parity bit is checked, the PER bit in SSR is not set to 1,
the receive operation is judged to have been completed normally, and the RDRF flag in SSR is
automatically set to 1. If the RIE bit in SCR is enabled at this time, an RXI interrupt request is
generated.
Figure 13.34 shows a flowchart for reception. A sequence of receive operations can be performed
automatically by specifying the DTC* or the DMAC to be activated using an RXI interrupt
source. In a receive operation, an RXI interrupt request is generated when the RDRF flag in SSR
is set to 1. If the RXI request is designated beforehand as a DTC* or the DMAC activation source,
the DTC* or the DMAC will be activated by the RXI request, and the receive data will be
transferred. The RDRF flag is cleared to 0 automatically when data is transferred by the DTC* or
the DMAC. If an error occurs in receive mode and the ORER or PER flag is set to 1, a transfer
error interrupt (ERI) request will be generated. Hence, so the error flag must be cleared to 0. In the
event of an error, the DTC* or the DMAC is not activated and receive data is skipped. Therefore,
receive data is transferred for only the specified number of bytes in the event of an error. Even
when a parity error occurs in receive mode and the PER flag is set to 1, the data that has been
received is transferred to RDR and can be read from there.
Notes: For details on receive operations in block transfer mode, refer to section 13.4, Operation in
Asynchronous Mode.
* The Flags are automatically cleared by the DTC when the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared
to 0 and the transfer counter value is not 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 455 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
nth transfer frame
Transfer
frame n + 1
Retransferred frame
Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp DE
Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Dp
(DE)
Ds D0 D1 D2 D3 D4
RDRF
PER
Figure 13.33 Retransfer Operation in SCI Receive Mode
Start
Initialization
Start reception
ORER = 0 and
PER = 0
No
Yes
Error processing
No
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read RDR and clear
RDRF flag in SSR to 0
No
All data received?
Yes
Clear RE bit to 0
Figure 13.34 Example of Reception Processing Flow
Page 456 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.7.9
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Clock Output Control
When the GM bit in SMR is set to 1, the clock output level can be fixed with bits CKE0 and
CKE1 in SCR. At this time, the minimum clock pulse width can be made the specified width.
Figure 13.35 shows the timing for fixing the clock output level. In this example, GM is set to 1,
CKE1 is cleared to 0, and the CKE0 bit is controlled.
CKE0
SCK
Specified pulse width
Specified pulse width
Figure 13.35 Timing for Fixing Clock Output Level
When turning on the power or switching between Smart Card interface mode and software standby
mode, the following procedures should be followed in order to maintain the clock duty.
Powering On: To secure clock duty from power-on, the following switching procedure should be
followed.
1. The initial state is port input and high impedance. Use a pull-up resistor or pull-down resistor
to fix the potential.
2. Fix the SCK pin to the specified output level with the CKE1 bit in SCR.
3. Set SMR and SCMR, and switch to smart card mode operation.
4. Set the CKE0 bit in SCR to 1 to start clock output.
When changing from smart card interface mode to software standby mode:
1. Set the data register (DR) and data direction register (DDR) corresponding to the SCK pin to
the value for the fixed output state in software standby mode.
2. Write 0 to the TE bit and RE bit in the serial control register (SCR) to halt transmit/receive
operation. At the same time, set the CKE1 bit to the value for the fixed output state in software
standby mode.
3. Write 0 to the CKE0 bit in SCR to halt the clock.
4. Wait for one serial clock period.
During this interval, clock output is fixed at the specified level, with the duty preserved.
5. Make the transition to the software standby state.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 457 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
When returning to smart card interface mode from software standby mode
1. Exit the software standby state.
2. Write 1 to the CKE0 bit in SCR and output the clock. Signal generation is started with the
normal duty.
Normal operation
Software
standby
Normal operation
Figure 13.36 Clock Halt and Restart Procedure
Page 458 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.8
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
SCI Select Function
The SCI_0 supports the SCI select function which allows clock synchronous communication
between master LSI and one of multiple slave LSI. Figure 13.37 shows an example of
communication using the SCI select function. Figure 13.38 shows the operation.
The master LSI can communicate with slave LSI_A by bringing SEL_A and SEL_B signals low
and high, respectively. In this case, the TxD0_B pin of the slave LSI_B is brought high-impedance
state and the internal SCK0_A signal is fixed high. This halts the communication operation of
slave LSI_B. The master LSI can communicate with slave LSI_B by bringing the SEL_A and
SEL_B signals high and low, respectively.
The slave LSI detects the selection by receiving the low level input from the IRQ7 pin and
immediately executes data transmission/reception processing.
Note: The selection signals (SEL_A and SEL_B) of the LSI must be switched while the serial
clock (M_SCK) is high after the end bit of the transmit data has been send. Note that one
selection signal can be brought low at the same time.
Master LSI
SEL_A
M_TxD
M_RxD
M_SCK
Slave LSI_A (This LSI)
IRQ7_A
Interrupt
controller
RxD0_A
RSR0_A
TSR0_A
TxD0_A
SCK0_A
SCK0
Transmission/
reception
control
C/A = CKE1 = SSE = 1
Slave LSI_B (This LSI)
SEL_B
IRQ7_B
RxD0_B
TxD0_B
SCK0
SCK0_B
Figure 13.37 Example of Communication Using the SCI Select Function
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 459 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Communication between master LSI
Communication between master LSI
and slave LSI_A
and slave LSI_B
Period of M_SCK = high
[Master LSI]
M_SCK
M_TxD
D0
D1
D7
D0
D1
D7
M_RxD
D0
D1
D7
D0
D1
D7
SEL_A
SEL_B
[Slave LSI_A]
IRQ7_A
(SEL_A)
SCK0_A
Fixed high level
RSR0_A
TxD0_A
D0
Hi-Z
D0
D6
D1
D7
Hi-Z
D7
[Slave LSI_B]
IRQ7_B
(SEL_B)
Fixed high level
SCK0_B
RSR0_B
TxD0_B
D0
Hi-Z
D0
D6
D1
D7
D7
Hi-Z
Figure 13.38 Example of Communication Using the SCI Select Function
Page 460 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.9
Interrupts
13.9.1
Interrupts in Normal Serial Communication Interface Mode
Table 13.12 shows the interrupt sources in normal serial communication interface mode. A
different interrupt vector is assigned to each interrupt source, and individual interrupt sources can
be enabled or disabled using the enable bits in SCR.
When the TDRE flag in SSR is set to 1, a TXI interrupt request is generated. When the TEND flag
in SSR is set to 1, a TEI interrupt request is generated. A TXI interrupt can activate the DMAC or
the DTC to perform data transfer. The TDRE flag is cleared to 0 automatically when data is
transferred by the DMAC or the DTC*.
When the RDRF flag in SSR is set to 1, an RXI interrupt request is generated. When the ORER,
PER, or FER flag in SSR is set to 1, an ERI interrupt request is generated. An RXI interrupt
request can activate the DMAC or the DTC to transfer data. The RDRF flag is cleared to 0
automatically when data is transferred by the DMAC or the DTC*.
A TEI interrupt is requested when the TEND flag is set to 1 and the TEIE bit is set to 1. If a TEI
interrupt and a TXI interrupt are requested simultaneously, the TXI interrupt has priority for
acceptance. However, if the TDRE and TEND flags are cleared simultaneously by the TXI
interrupt routine, the SCI cannot branch to the TEI interrupt routine later.
Note: * The Flags are automatically cleared by the DTC when the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared
to 0 and the transfer counter value is not 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 461 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Table 13.12 SCI Interrupt Sources
DTC
Activation
DMAC
Activation
ORER, FER,
PER
Not possible
Not possible High
Receive Data Full
RDRF
Possible
Possible
TXI0
Transmit Data Empty
TDRE
Possible
Possible
TEI0
Transmission End
TEND
Not possible
Not possible
ERI1
Receive Error
ORER, FER,
PER
Not possible
Not possible
RXI1
Receive Data Full
RDRF
Possible
Possible
TXI1
Transmit Data Empty
TDRE
Possible
Possible
TEI1
Transmission End
TEND
Not possible
Not possible
ERI2
Receive Error
ORER, FER,
PER
Not possible
Not possible
RXI2
Receive Data Full
RDRF
Possible
Not possible
TXI2
Transmit Data Empty
TDRE
Possible
Not possible
TEI2
Transmission End
TEND
Not possible
Not possible Low
Channel Name
0
1
2
Note:
*
Interrupt Source
Interrupt Flag
ERI0
Receive Error
RXI0
Priority*
This table shows the initial state immediately after a reset. The relative channel
priorities can be changed by the interrupt controller.
Page 462 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
13.9.2
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Interrupts in Smart Card Interface Mode
Table 13.13 shows the interrupt sources in Smart Card interface mode. The transmit end interrupt
(TEI) request cannot be used in this mode.
Note: In case of block transfer mode, see section 13.9.1, Interrupts in Normal Serial
Communication Interface Mode.
Table 13.13 Interrupt Sources in Smart Card Interface Mode
Channel
Name
Interrupt Source
Interrupt Flag
DTC Activation
DMAC
Activation
0
ERI0
Receive Error,
detection
ORER, PER,
ERS
Not possible
Not possible High
RXI0
Receive Data Full
RDRF
Possible
Possible
TXI0
Transmit Data Empty
TEND
Possible
Possible
ERI1
Receive Error,
detection
ORER, PER,
ERS
Not possible
Not possible
RXI1
Receive Data Full
RDRF
Possible
Possible
TXI1
Transmit Data Empty
TEND
Possible
Possible
ERI2
Receive Error,
detection
ORER, PER,
ERS
Not possible
Not possible
RXI2
Receive Data Full
RDRF
Possible
Not possible
TXI2
Transmit Data Empty
TEND
Possible
Not possible Low
1
2
Notes: *
Indicates the initial state immediately after a reset. Priorities in channels can be
changed by the interrupt controller.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Priority*
Page 463 of 846
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.10
H8S/2215 Group
Usage Notes
13.10.1 Break Detection and Processing (Asynchronous Mode Only)
When framing error detection is performed, a break can be detected by reading the RxD pin value
directly. In a break, the input from the RxD pin becomes all 0s, setting the FER flag, and possibly
the PER flag. Note that as the SCI continues the receive operation after receiving a break, even if
the FER flag is cleared to 0, it will be set to 1 again.
13.10.2 Mark State and Break Detection (Asynchronous Mode Only)
When TE is 0, the TxD pin is used as an I/O port whose direction (input or output) and level are
determined by DR and DDR. This can be used to set the TxD pin to mark state (high level) or send
a break during serial data transmission. To maintain the communication line at mark state until TE
is set to 1, set both DDR and DR to 1. As TE is cleared to 0 at this point, the TxD pin becomes an
I/O port, and 1 is output from the TxD pin. To send a break during serial transmission, first set
PCR to 1 and PDR to 0, and then clear TE to 0. When TE is cleared to 0, the transmitter is
initialized regardless of the current transmission state, the TxD pin becomes an I/O port, and 0 is
output from the TxD pin.
13.10.3 Receive Error Flags and Transmit Operations (Clocked Synchronous Mode Only)
Transmission cannot be started when a receive error flag (ORER, PER, or FER) is set to 1, even if
the TDRE flag is cleared to 0. Be sure to clear the receive error flags to 0 before starting
transmission. Note also that receive error flags cannot be cleared to 0 even if the RE bit is cleared
to 0.
13.10.4 Restrictions on Use of DMAC or DTC
• When an external clock source is used as the serial clock, the transmit clock should not be
input until at least 5 φ clock cycles after TDR is updated by the DMAC or the DTC.
Misoperation may occur if the transmit clock is input within 4 φ clocks after TDR is updated.
(figure 13.39)
• When RDR is read by the DMAC or the DTC, be sure to set the activation source to the
relevant SCI reception end interrupt (RXI).
• During data transfer, the TDRE and RDRF flags are automatically cleared by the DTC when
the DTC's DISEL bit is cleared to 0 and the transfer counter value is not 0. Consequently, it is
necessary to use the CPU to clear the TDRE and RDRF flags if DISEL is set to 1 or if the
transfer counter value is 0.
Page 464 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
In particular, data transmission cannot be completed correctly unless the TDRE flag is cleared
using the CPU.
SCK
t
TDRE
LSB
Serial data
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note: When operating on an external clock, set t>4 clocks.
Figure 13.39 Example of Clocked Synchronous Transmission by DMAC or DTC
13.10.5 Operation in Case of Mode Transition
• Transmission
Operation should be stopped (by clearing TE, TIE, and TEIE to 0) before making a module
stop mode, software standby mode, or subsleep mode transition. TSR, TDR, and SSR are reset.
The output pin states in module stop mode, software standby mode, or subsleep mode depend
on the port settings, and becomes high-level output after the relevant mode is cleared. If a
transition is made during transmission, the data being transmitted will be undefined. When
transmitting without changing the transmit mode after the relevant mode is cleared,
transmission can be started by setting TE to 1 again, and performing the following sequence:
SSR read -> TDR write -> TDRE clearance. To transmit with a different transmit mode after
clearing the relevant mode, the procedure must be started again from initialization. Figure
13.40 shows a sample flowchart for mode transition during transmission. Port pin states are
shown in figures 13.41 and 13.42.
Operation should also be stopped (by clearing TE, TIE, and TEIE to 0) before making a
transition from transmission by DTC transfer to module stop mode or software standby mode
transition. To perform transmission with the DTC after the relevant mode is cleared, setting TE
and TIE to 1 will set the TXI flag and start DTC transmission.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 465 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
<Transmission>
No
All data
transmitted?
[1]
Yes
Read TEND flag in SSR
No
TEND = 1
Yes
[1] Data being transmitted is interrupted.
After exiting software standby mode,
etc., normal CPU transmission is
possible by setting TE to 1, reading
SSR, writing TDR, and clearing
TDRE to 0, but note that if the DTC*
or the DMAC has been activated, the
remaining data in DTCRAM will be
transmitted when TE and TIE are set
to 1.
[2] Includes module stop mode.
TE = TIE = TEIE = 0
Transition to software
standby mode, etc.
[2]
Exit from software
standby mode, etc.
Change
operating mode?
No
Note: * The TDRE and RDRF flags are
automatically cleared by the DTC
when the DTC's DISEL bit is
cleared to 0 and the transfer
counter value is not 0.
Consequently, it is necessary to
use the CPU to clear the TDRE
and RDRF flags if DISEL is set to
1 or if the transfer counter value
is 0.
Yes
Initialization
TE = 1
<Start of transmission>
Figure 13.40 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Transmission
Start of transmission
End of
transmission
Exit from
software
standby
Transition
to software
standby
TE bit
Port input/output
SCK output pin
TxD output pin
Port input/output
Port
High output
Start
SCI TxD output
Stop
Port input/output
Port
High output
SCI TxD
output
Figure 13.41 Port Pin State of Asynchronous Transmission Using Internal Clock
Page 466 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Start of transmission
End of
transmission
Exit from
software
standby
Transition
to software
standby
TE bit
SCK output pin
Port input/output
TxD output pin Port input/output
Final TxD
bit retention
High output
Port
SCI TxD output
Port input/output
Port
High output*
SCI TxD
output
Note: * Initialized by the software standby.
Figure 13.42 Port Pin State of Synchronous Transmission Using Internal Clock
• Reception
Receive operation should be stopped (by clearing RE to 0) before making a module stop mode,
software standby mode, watch mode, subactive mode, or subsleep mode transition. RSR, RDR,
and SSR are reset. If a transition is made without stopping operation, the data being received
will be invalid.
To continue receiving without changing the reception mode after the relevant mode is cleared,
set RE to 1 before starting reception. To receive with a different receive mode, the procedure
must be started again from initialization.
Figure 13.43 shows a sample flowchart for mode transition during reception.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 467 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
<Reception>
Read RDRF flag in SSR
RDRF = 1
No
[1]
[1] Receive data being received becomes invalid.
Yes
[2] Includes module stop mode.
Read receive data in RDR
RE = 0
Transition to software
standby mode, etc.
[2]
Exit from software
standby mode, etc.
Change
operating mode?
No
Yes
Initialization
RE = 1
<Start of reception>
Figure 13.43 Sample Flowchart for Mode Transition during Reception
Page 468 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.10.6 Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function
When switching the SCK pin function to the output port function (high-level output) by making
the following settings while DDR = 1, DR = 1, C/A = 1, CKE1 = 0, CKE0 = 0, and TE = 1
(synchronous mode), low-level output occurs for one half-cycle.
1. End of serial data transmission
2. TE bit = 0
3. C/A bit = 0 ... switchover to port output
4. Occurrence of low-level output (see figure 13.44)
Half-cycle low-level output
SCK/port
1. End of transmission
Data
Bit 6
TE
C/A
4. Low-level output
Bit 7
2. TE = 0
3. C/A = 0
CKE1
CKE0
Figure 13.44 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 469 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
Sample Procedure for Avoiding Low-Level Output: As this sample procedure temporarily
places the SCK pin in the input state, the SCK/port pin should be pulled up beforehand with an
external circuit.
With DDR = 1, DR = 1, C/A = 1, CKE1 = 0, CKE0 = 0, and TE = 1, make the following
settings in the order shown.
1. End of serial data transmission
2. TE bit = 0
3. CKE1 bit = 1
4. C/A bit = 0 ... switchover to port output
5. CKE1 bit = 0
High-level output
SCK/port
Data
1. End of transmission
Bit 6
Bit 7
2. TE = 0
TE
4. C/A = 0
C/A
3. CKE1 = 1
CKE1
5. CKE1 = 0
CKE0
Figure 13.45 Operation when Switching from SCK Pin Function to Port Pin Function
(Example of Preventing Low-Level Output)
13.10.7 Module Stop Mode Setting
Operation of the SCI can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register. The initial
setting is for operation of the SCI to be halted. Register access is enabled by clearing module stop
mode. For details, refer to section 22, Power-Down Modes.
Page 470 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
This LSI incorporates a boundary scan function, which is a serial I/O interface based on the JTAG
(Joint Test Action Group, IEEEStd.1149.1 and IEEE Standard Test Access Port and Boundary
Scan Architecture). Figure 14.1 shows the block diagram of the boundary scan function.
14.1
Features
• Five test signals
⎯ TCK, TDI, TDO, TMS, TRST
• Six test modes supported
⎯ BYAPASS, SAMPLE/PRELOAD, EXTEST, CLAMP, HIGHZ, IDCODE
• Boundary scan function cannot be performed on the following pins.
⎯ Power supply pins: VCC, VSS, Vref, AVCC, AVSS, PLLVCC, PLLVSS, PLLCAP,
DrVCC, DrVSS
⎯ Clock signals:
EXTAL, XTAL, EXTAL48, XTAL48
⎯ Analog signals:
P40 to P43, P96, P97, USD+, USD-
⎯ Boundary scan signals: TCK, TDI, TDO, TMS, TRST
⎯ E10A signal (EMLE)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 471 of 846
IFJTAG0A_000020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
BSCANR
(Boundary scan cell chain)
IDCODE
MUX
TDO
MUX
BYPASS
TDI
INSTR
TCK
TMS
TAP controller
TRST
Legend:
BSCANR:
IDCODE:
BYPASS:
INSTR:
TAP:
Boundary scan register
IDCODE register
BYPASS register
Instruction register
Test access port
Figure 14.1 Block Diagram of Boundary Scan Function
Page 472 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
14.2
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Pin Configuration
Table 14.1 shows the I/O pins used in the boundary scan function.
Table 14.1 Pin Configuration
Pin Name
I/O
TMS
Input
Function
Test Mode Select
Controls the TAP controller which is a 16-state Finite State
Machine.
The TMS input value at the rising edge of TCK determines
the status transition direction on the TAP controller.
The TMS is fixed high when the boundary scan function is not
used.
The protocol is based on JTAG standard (IEEE Std.1149.1).
This pin has a pull-up resistor.
TCK
Input
Test Clock
A clock signal for the boundary scan function.
When the boundary scan function is used, input a clock of
50% duty to this pin.
This pin has a pull-up resistor.
TDI
Input
Test Data Input
A data input signal for the boundary scan function.
Data input from the TDI is latched at the rising edge of TCK.
TDI is fixed high when the boundary scan function is not
used.
This pin has a pull-up resistor.
TDO
Output
Test Data Output
A data output signal for the boundary scan function. Data
output from the TDO changes at the falling edge of TCK. The
output driver of the TDO is driven only when it is necessary
only in Shift-IR or Shift-DR states, and is brought to the highimpedance state when not necessary.
TRST
Input
Test Reset
Asynchronously resets the TAP controller when TRST is
brought low.
The user must apply power-on reset signal specific to the
boundary scan function when the power is supplied (For
details on signal design, see section 14.5, Usage Notes).
This pin has a pull-up resistor.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 473 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
14.3
Register Descriptions
The boundary scan function has the following registers. These registers cannot be accessed by the
CPU.
• Instruction register (INSTR)
• IDCODE register (IDCODE)
• BYPASS register (BYPASS)
• Boundary scan register (BSCANR)
14.3.1
Instruction Register (INSTR)
INSTR is a 3-bit register. At initialization, this register is specified to IDCODE mode. When
TRST is pulled low, or when the TAP controller is in the Test-Logic-Reset state, INSTR is
initialized. INSTR can be written by the serial data input from the TDI. If more than three bits of
instruction is input from the TDI, INSTR stores the last three bits of serial data.
If a command reserved in INSTR is used, the correct operation cannot be guaranteed.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
2
TI2
1
—
Test Instruction Bits
1
TI1
0
—
Instruction configuration is shown in table 14.2.
0
TI0
1
—
Table 14.2 Instruction configuration
Bit 2
Bit1
Bit 0
TI2
TI1
TI0
Instruction
0
0
0
EXTEST
0
0
1
SAMPLE/PRELOAD
0
1
0
CLAMP
0
1
1
HIGHZ
1
0
0
Reserved
1
0
1
IDCODE
1
1
0
Reserved
1
1
1
BYPASS
Page 474 of 846
(initial value)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
EXTEST: The EXTEST instruction is used to test external circuits when this LSI is installed on
the print circuit board. If this instruction is executed, output pins are used to output test data
(specified by the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction) from the boundary scan register to the print
circuit board, and input pins are used to input test results.
SAMPLE/PRELOAD: The SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction is used to input data from the LSI
internal circuits to the boundary scan register, output data from scan path, and reload the data to
the scan path. While this instruction is executed, input signals are directly input to the LSI and
output signals are also directly output to the external circuits. The LSI system circuit is not
affected by this instruction.
In SAMPLE operation, the boundary scan register latches the snap shot of data transferred from
input pins to internal circuit or data transferred from internal circuit to output pins. The latched
data is read from the scan path. The scan register latches the snap data at the rising edge of the
TCK in Capture-DR state. The scan register latches snap shot without affecting the LSI normal
operation.
In PRELOAD operation, initial value is written from the scan path to the parallel output latch of
the boundary scan register prior to the EXTEST instruction execution. If the EXTEST is executed
without executing this RELOAD operation, undefined values are output from the beginning to the
end (transfer to the output latch) of the EXTEST sequence. (In EXTEST instruction, output
parallel latches are always output to the output pins.)
CLAMP: When the CLAMP instruction is selected output pins output the boundary scan register
value which was specified by the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction in advance. While the CLAMP
instruction is selected, the status of boundary scan register is maintained regardless of the TAP
controller state. BYPASS is connected between TDI and TDO, the same operation as BYPASS
instruction can be achieved.
HIGHZ: When the HIGHZ instruction is selected, all outputs enter high-impedance state. While
this instruction is selected, the status of boundary scan register is maintained regardless of the
TAP controller state. BYPASS resistor is connected between TDI and TDO, the same operation as
BYPASS instruction can be achieved.
IDCODE : When the IDCODE instruction is selected, IDCODE register value is output to the
TDO in Shift-DR state of TAP controller. In this case, IDCODE register value is output from the
LSB. During this instruction execution, test circuit does not affect the system circuit. INSTR is
initialized by the IDCODE instruction in Test-Logic-Reset state of TAP controller.
BYPASS: The BYPASS instruction is a standard instruction necessary to operate bypass register.
The BYPASS instruction improves the serial data transfer speed by bypassing the scan path.
During this instruction execution, test circuit does not affect the system circuit.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 475 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
14.3.2
IDCODE Register (IDCODE)
IDCODE is a 32-bit register. If INSTR is set to IDCODE mode, IDCODE is connected between
TDI and TDO. The HD64F2215 and H8S/2215U output fixed code H'0002200F, HD6432215B
output fixed code H'001B200F, HD6432215C output fixed code H'001C200F, HD64F2215R,
HD64F2215RU and HD64F2215CU output fixed code H'08030447, and HD64F2215T and
HD64F2215TU output fixed code H'08031447, respectively, from the TDO. Serial data cannot be
written to IDCODE through TDI. Table 14.3 shows the IDCODE configuration.
Table 14.3 IDCODE Register Configuration
Bits
31 to 28
27 to 12
11 to 1
0
HD64F2215 code
0000
0000 0000 0010 0010
0000 0000 111
1
HD6432215B code
0000
0000 0001 1011 0010
0000 0000 111
1
HD6432215C code
0000
0000 0001 1100 0010
0000 0000 111
1
HD64F2215R code
0000
1000 0000 0011 0000
0100 0100 011
1
HD64F2215RU and
HD64F2215CU code
0000
1000 0000 0011 0000
0100 0100 011
1
HD64F2215T and
HD64F2215TU code
0000
1000 0000 0011 0001
0100 0100 011
1
Contents
Version
(4 bits)
Part No.
(16 bits)
Product No.
(11 bits)
Fixed code
(1 bit)
HD64F2215U code
14.3.3
BYPASS Register (BYPASS)
BYPASS is a 1-bit register. If INSTR is specified to BYPASS mode, CLAMP mode, or HIGHZ
mode, BYPASS is connected between TDI and TDO.
Page 476 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
14.3.4
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Boundary Scan Register (BSCANR)
BSCAN is a 217-bit shift register assigned on the pins to control input/output pins.
The I/O pins consists of three bits (IN, Control, OUT), input pins 1 bit (IN), and output pins 1 bit
(OUT) of shift registers. The boundary scan test based on the JTAG standard can be performed by
using instructions listed in table 14.2. Table 14.4 shows the correspondence between the LSI pins
and boundary scan registers. (In table 14.4, Control indicates the high active pin. By specifying
Control to high, the pin is driven by OUT.) Figure 14.2 shows the boundary scan register
configuration example.
TDI pin
IN
Control
OUT
I/O pin
TDO pin
Figure 14.2 Boundary Scan Register Configuration
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 477 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Table 14.4 Correspondence between LSI Pins and Boundary Scan Register
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
111
A4
PE0/D0
I/O
Bit Name
IN
216
Control
215
OUT
214
IN
213
From TDI
113
115
116
117
118
119
120
2
3
Page 478 of 846
D5
B4
A3
C4
B3
A2
C3
B2
B1
PE1/D1
PE2/D2
PE3/D3
PE4/D4
PE5/D5
PE6/D6
PE7/D7
PD0/D8
PD1/D9
Control
212
OUT
211
IN
210
Control
209
OUT
208
IN
207
Control
206
OUT
205
IN
204
Control
203
OUT
202
IN
201
Control
200
OUT
199
IN
198
Control
197
OUT
196
IN
195
Control
194
OUT
193
IN
192
Control
191
OUT
190
IN
189
Control
188
OUT
187
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
I/O
Bit Name
4
D4
PD2/D10
IN
186
Control
185
5
6
7
8
9
11
13
14
15
16
C2
C1
D3
D2
D1
E3
E2
F3
F1
F2
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
PD3/D11
PD4/D12
PD5/D13
PD6/D14
PD7/D15
PC0/A0
PC1/A1
PC2/A2
PC3/A3
PC4/A4
OUT
184
IN
183
Control
182
OUT
181
IN
180
Control
179
OUT
178
IN
177
Control
176
OUT
175
IN
174
Control
173
OUT
172
IN
171
Control
170
OUT
169
IN
168
Control
167
OUT
166
IN
165
Control
164
OUT
163
IN
162
Control
161
OUT
160
IN
159
Control
158
OUT
157
IN
156
Control
155
OUT
154
Page 479 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
I/O
Bit Name
17
F4
PC5/A5
IN
153
Control
152
18
19
20
21
23
25
26
27
28
29
Page 480 of 846
G1
G2
G3
H1
G4
H2
J1
H3
J2
K1
PC6/A6
PC7/A7
PB0/A8
PB1/A9
PB2/A10
PB3/A11
PB4/A12
PB5/A13
PB6/A14
PB7/A15
OUT
151
IN
150
Control
149
OUT
148
IN
147
Control
146
OUT
145
IN
144
Control
143
OUT
142
IN
141
Control
140
OUT
139
IN
138
Control
137
OUT
136
IN
135
Control
134
OUT
133
IN
132
Control
131
OUT
130
IN
129
Control
128
OUT
127
IN
126
Control
125
OUT
124
IN
123
Control
122
OUT
121
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
I/O
Bit Name
30
J3
PA0/A16
IN
120
Control
119
31
32
33
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
K2
L2
H4
K3
L3
J4
K4
L4
H5
J5
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
PA1/A17/TxD2
PA2/A18/RxD2
PA3/A19/SCK2/SUSPND
P10/TIOCA0/A20/VM
P11/TIOCB0/A21/VP
P12/TIOCC0/TCLKA/A22/RCV
P13/TIOCD0/TCLKB/A23/VPO
P14/TIOCA1/IRQ0
P15/TIOCB1/TCLKC/FSE0
P16/TIOCA2/IRQ1
OUT
118
IN
117
Control
116
OUT
115
IN
114
Control
113
OUT
112
IN
111
Control
110
OUT
109
IN
108
Control
107
OUT
106
IN
105
Control
104
OUT
103
IN
102
Control
101
OUT
100
IN
99
Control
98
OUT
97
IN
96
Control
95
OUT
94
IN
93
Control
92
OUT
91
IN
90
Control
89
OUT
88
Page 481 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
I/O
Bit Name
42
L5
P17/TIOCB2/TCLKD/OE
IN
87
Control
86
OUT
85
53
H7
USPND
OUT
84
55
K8
VBUS
IN
83
56
L9
UBPM
IN
82
67
H9
MD0
IN
81
68
H10
MD1
IN
80
69
H11
FWE
IN
79
70
G8
NMI
IN
78
71
G9
STBY
IN
77
72
G11
RES
IN
76
77
F8
MD2
IN
75
78
E11
PF7/φ
IN
74
Control
73
OUT
72
IN
71
Control
70
OUT
69
IN
68
Control
67
79
80
81
83
85
Page 482 of 846
E10
E9
D11
E8
D10
PF6/AS
PF5/RD
PF4/HWR
PF3/LWR/ADTRG/IRQ3
PF2/WAIT
OUT
66
IN
65
Control
64
OUT
63
IN
62
Control
61
OUT
60
IN
59
Control
58
OUT
57
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
I/O
Bit Name
86
C11
PF1/BACK
IN
56
Control
55
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
96
97
D9
C10
B11
C9
B10
A10
D8
B9
A9
C8
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
PF0/BREQ/IRQ2
P30/TxD0
P31/RxD0
P32/SCK0/IRQ4
P33/TxD1
P34/RxD1
P35/SCK1/IRQ5
P36
P74/MRES
P73/TMO1/CS7
OUT
54
IN
53
Control
52
OUT
51
IN
50
Control
49
OUT
48
IN
47
Control
46
OUT
45
IN
44
Control
43
OUT
42
IN
41
Control
40
OUT
39
IN
38
Control
37
OUT
36
IN
35
Control
34
OUT
33
IN
32
Control
31
OUT
30
IN
29
Control
28
OUT
27
IN
26
Control
25
OUT
24
Page 483 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
TFP-120,
TFP-120V
Pin No.
BP-112,
BP-112V
Pin No.
Pin Name
I/O
Bit Name
98
B8
P72/TMO0/CS6
IN
23
Control
22
OUT
21
IN
20
Control
19
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
A8
D7
C7
A7
B7
C6
A6
P71/CS5
P70/TMRI01/TMCI01/CS4
PG0
PG1/CS3/IRQ7
PG2/CS2
PG3/CS1
PG4/CS0
OUT
18
IN
17
Control
16
OUT
15
IN
14
Control
13
OUT
12
IN
11
Control
10
OUT
9
IN
8
Control
7
OUT
6
IN
5
Control
4
OUT
3
IN
2
Control
1
OUT
0
to TDO
Page 484 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
14.4
Boundary Scan Function Operation
14.4.1
TAP Controller
Figure 14.3 shows the TAP controller status transition diagram, based on the JTAG standard.
Test-Logic-Reset
0
1
Run-Test/Idle
1
Select-DR
0
1
0
0
1
Select-IR
0
1
Capture-DR
0
Shift-DR
1
Exit1-DR
1
Update-DR
0
1
Capture-IR
0
1
Shift-IR
1
0
Exit1-IR
1
Pause-DR
0
1
0
1
Exit2-DR
0
1
Update-IR
0
Pause-IR
0
1
1
0
Exit2-IR
0
Figure 14.3 TAP Controller Status Transition
Note: The transition condition is the TMS value at the rising edge of TCK. The TDI value is
sampled at the rising edge of the TCK and shifted at the falling edge of the TCK. The
TDO value changes at the falling edge of the TCK. In addition, TDO is high-impedance
state in a state other than Shift-DR or Shift-IR state. If TRST is 0, Test-Logic-Reset state
is entered asynchronously with the TCK.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 485 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
14.5
Usage Notes
1. When using the boundary scan function, clear TRST to 0 at power-on and after the tRESW time
has elapsed set TRST to 1 and set TCK, TMS, and TDI appropriately. During normal operation
when the boundary scan function is not used, set TCK, TMS, and TDI to Hi-Z, clear TRST to
0 at power-on, and after the tRESW time has elapsed set TRST to 1 or to Hi-Z. These pins are
pulled up internally, so care must be taken in standby mode because breakthrough current flow
can occur if there is a potential difference between the pin input voltage value when set to 1
and the power supply voltage Vcc.
2. The following must be noted on the power-on reset signal applied to the TRST pin.
• Reset signal must be applied at power-on.
• TRST must be separated in order not to affect the system operation.
• TRST must be separated from the system circuitry in order not to affect the system
operation.
• System circuitry must also be separated from the TRST in order not to affect TRST
operation as shown in figure 14.4.
Board edge pin
LSI
System
reset
RES
Power-on
reset circuit
TRST
TRST
Figure 14.4 Recommended Reset Signal Design
3. TCK clock speed should be slower than system clock frequency.
4. In serial communication, data is input or output from the LSB as shown in figure 14.5.
TDI
Bit n
Boundary scan register
Bit n - 1
Bit 1
Bit 0
TDO
Figure 14.5 Serial Data Input/Output
Page 486 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
5. If a pin with pull-up function is SAMPLEed with pull-up function enabled, the corresponding
IN register is set to 1. In this case, the corresponding Control register must be cleared to 0.
6. If a pin with open-drain function is SAMPLEed while its open-drain function is enabled and
while the corresponding OUT register is set to 1, the corresponding Control register is cleared
to 0 (the pin status is Hi-Z). If the pin is SAMPLEed while the corresponding OUT register is
cleared to 0, the corresponding Control register is set to 1 (the pin status is 0).
7. If EXTEST, CLAMP, or HIGHZ state is entered, this LSI enters guarded mode such as
hardware standby mode (RES = STBY = 0). Before entering normal operating mode from
EXTEST, CLAMP, or HIGHZ state, specify RES, STBY, FWE, and MD2 to MD0 pin to the
designated mode.
8. When using the boundary scan function, leave the EMLE pin open.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 487 of 846
Section 14 Boundary Scan Function
Page 488 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
This LSI incorporates a USB function module complying with USB standard version 1.1. Figure
15.1 shows the block diagram of the USB.
15.1
Features
• USB standard version 2.0 full speed mode (12 Mbps) support
• Bus-powered mode or self-powered mode is selectable via the USB specific pin (UBPM)
• On-chip 48-MHz clock generator and PLL circuit (16 MHz × 3 = 48 MHz, 24 MHz* × 2 = 48
MHz)
Note: * Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
• On-chip bus transceiver
• Standard commands are processed automatically by hardware
⎯ Only Set_Descriptor, Get_Descriptor, Class/VendorCommand, and SynchFrame
commands should be processed by software
• Configuration value, InterfaceNumber value, and AlternateSetting value can be checked by
Set_Configuration and Set_Interface interrupts
• Four transfer mode supported (Control, Interrupt, Bulk, Isochronous)
• Endpoint configuration selectable
Maximum of 9 endpoints can be specified (including endpoint 0)
The size of the FIFO buffer used by each endpoint can be specified via firmware
The FIFO buffer for bulk transfer and isochronous transfer has a double-buffer configuration
Total 1288-byte FIFO
—EP0s fixed: Control_setup FIFO, 8 bytes
—EP0i fixed: Control_in FIFO, 64 bytes
—EP0o fixed: Control_out FIFO, 64 bytes
—EPn selectable: Interrupt_in FIFO, variable 0 to 64 bytes
—EPn selectable: Bulk_in FIFO, 64 bytes × 2 (double-buffer configuration)
—EPn selectable: Bulk_out FIFO, 64 bytes × 2 (double-buffer configuration)
—EPn selectable: Isochronous_in FIFO, variable 0 to 128 bytes × 2 (double-buffer
configuration)
—EPn selectable: Isochronous_out FIFO, variable 0 to 128 bytes × 2 (double-buffer
configuration)
—EPn selectable: Bulk_in FIFO, 64 bytes × 2 (double-buffer configuration)
—EPn selectable: Bulk_out FIFO, 64 bytes × 2 (double-buffer configuration)
—EPn selectable: Interrupt_in FIFO, variable 0 to 64 bytes
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 489 of 846
IFUSB30A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
• Maximum Configuration, InterfaceNumber, and AlternateSetting configuration specifications
of this LSI
H8S/2215:
EP0
Configuration 1 ----- InterfaceNumber 0 to 2 ----- AlternateSetting 0 to 7 ----- EP1 to EP8
H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C:
EP0
Configuration 1 ----- InterfaceNumber 0 to 3 ----- AlternateSetting 0 to 7 ----- EP1 to EP8
• Start of frame (SOF) marker function
⎯ SOF interrupt occurs every 1 ms even though broken SOF received by error
• 23 kinds of interrupts (H8S/2215)
25 kinds of interrupts (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C)
⎯ Suspend/resume interrupt source can be assigned for IRQ6
⎯ Each interrupt source can be assigned for EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 via registers
• DMA transfer interface
⎯ Two DMA requests are selectable from four Bulk transfer requests
• 8-bit bus (3 cycle bus access timing) connected to the external bus interface
⎯ Internal registers are addressed to a part of area 6 of external address (H'C00000 to
H'DFFFFF)
⎯ The area of H'C00100 to H'DFFFFF is reserved for USB and should not be accessed
Page 490 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB
[Power mode selection]
1288-byte FIFO
EP0s
EP2i
EP4i
EP0i
EP2o
EP4o
EP0o
EP3i
EP5i
EP1i
EP3o
UBPM
[Connection/disconnection]
VBUS
[Suspend]
USPND
[Interrupt request signal]
[Power supply]
IRQ6
DrVcc
EXIRQ0, EXIRQ1
[DMA internal request signal]
DREQ0, DREQ1
DrVss
Registers
[Internal bus]
Peripheral data bus
Peripheral address bus
Internal
transceiver
Interface
[Data]
USD+
USD-
Rs
Rs
D+
D-
Peripheral bus control
signal
UDC synchronization
circuit
(12 MHz)
[System clock]
φ
(16 MHz or 24 MHz*)
[USB operating clock]
EXTAL48
XTAL48
Legend:
UDC:
EP0s:
EP0i to 5i:
EP0o to 4o:
PLL
circuit
(×3)
(×2)*
(48 MHz)
UDC core
USB
clock
generator
(48 MHz)
[External transceiver connection]
RCV
VP
VM
VPO
FSE0
OE
SUSPEND
USB Device Controller
Endpoint 0 setup FIFO
Endpoint 0 to 5 In FIFO
Endpoint 0 to 4 Out FIFO
Note: * Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
Figure 15.1 Block Diagram of USB
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 491 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.2
Input/Output Pins
Table 15.1 shows the USB pin configuration.
Table 15.1 Pin Configuration
Pin Name
I/O
Function
USD+
I/O
I/O pin for USB data
DrVCC
Input
USB internal transceiver power supply pin
DrVSS
Input
USB internal transceiver ground pin
VBUS
Input
USB cable connection/disconnection detection signal pin
UBPM
Input
USD-
USB bus-power/self-power mode selection pin
When USB is used in bus-power mode, UBPM must be fixed low.
When USB is used in self-power mode, UBPM must be fixed high.
XTAL48,
EXTAL48
Input
USB operating clock input pin
48-MHz clock for USB communication is input.
When the internal PLL is used, EXTAL48 and XTAL48 must be fixed
low and open, respectively.
USPND
Output
USB suspend output pin
Set to high level when the system enter the suspend state.
RCV
Input
External transceiver connection signals
VP
Input
Signals used to connect with the transceiver (ISP1104)
VM
Input
manufactured by NXP.
VPO
Output
FSE0
Output
OE
Output
SUSPND
Output
Page 492 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.3
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Register Descriptions
The USB has the following registers for each channel.
• USB endpoint information register 00_0 to 22_4 (UEPIR00_0 to UEPIR22_4)
• USB control register (UCTLR)
• USB DMAC transfer request register (UDMAR)*
• USB device resume register (UDRR)
• USB trigger register 0 (UTRG0)*
• USB trigger register 1 (UTRG1)*
• USB FIFO clear register 0 (UFCLR0)*
• USB FIFO clear register 1 (UFCLR1)*
• USB endpoint stall register 0 (UESTL0)*
• USB endpoint stall register 1 (UESTL1)*
• USB endpoint data register 0s (UEDR0s) [for Setup data reception]
• USB endpoint data register 0i (UEDR0i) [for Control_in data transmission]
• USB endpoint data register 0o (UEDR0o) [for Control_out data reception]
• USB endpoint data register 1i (UEDR1i)* [for Interrupt_in data transmission]
• USB endpoint data register 2i (UEDR2i)* [for Bulk_in data transmission]
• USB endpoint data register 2o (UEDR2o)* [for Bulk_out data reception]
• USB endpoint data register 3i (UEDR3i)* [for Isochronous_in data transmission]
• USB endpoint data register 3o (UEDR3o)* [for Isochronous_out data reception]
• USB endpoint data register 4i (UEDR4i)* [for Bulk_in data transmission]
• USB endpoint data register 4o (UEDR4o)* [for Bulk_out data reception]
• USB endpoint data register 5i (UEDR5i)* [for Interrupt_in data transmission]
• USB endpoint receive data size register 0o (UESZ0o) [for Control _out data reception]
• USB endpoint receive data size register 2o (UESZ2o)* [for Bulk_out data reception]
• USB endpoint receive data size register 3o (UESZ3o)* [for Isochronous_out data reception]
• USB endpoint receive data size register 4o (UESZ4o)* [for Bulk _out data reception]
• USB interrupt flag register 0 (UIFR0)*
• USB interrupt flag register 1 (UIFR1)*
• USB interrupt flag register 2 (UIFR2)*
• USB interrupt flag register 3 (UIFR3)
• USB interrupt enable register 0 (UIER0)*
• USB interrupt enable register 1 (UIER1)*
• USB interrupt enable register 2 (UIER2)*
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 493 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
H8S/2215 Group
• USB interrupt enable register 3 (UIER3)
• USB interrupt selection register 0 (UISR0)*
• USB interrupt selection register 1 (UISR1)*
• USB interrupt selection register 2 (UISR2)*
• USB interrupt selection register 3 (UISR3)
• USB data status register (UDSR)*
• USB configuration value register (UCVR)
• USB time stamp register H, L (UTSRH, L)
• USB test register 0 (UTSTR0)
• USB test register 1 (UTSTR1)
• USB test register 2 (UTSTR2)
• USB test register A (UTSTRA)
• USB test register B (UTSTRB)
• USB test register C (UTSTRC)
• USB test register D (UTSTRD)
• USB test register E (UTSTRE)
• USB test register F (UTSTRF)
• Module stop control register B (MSTPCRB)
Note: * Indicates the register name or bit name when each endpoint formation is specified
based on the Bluetooth standard. Register names and bit names must be modified
according to the endpoint configuration selected. For details, refer to section 15.7,
Endpoint Configuration Example.
The area of H'C00100 to H'DFFFFF is reserved for USB and should not be accessed.
Page 494 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.3.1
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB Endpoint Information Registers 00_0 to 22_4 (UEPIR00_0 to UEPIR22_4)
UEPIR is used to set 23 kinds of endpoint (EPINFO data). EPINFO data for each endpoint
consists of 40 bits (five bytes). 115 bytes of endpoint data for all UEPIR00_0 to UEPIR22_4
registers must be written after the UDC interface software reset has been cancelled (the UIFST bit
of the UCTLR register is cleared to 0). The endpoint data is automatically loaded and stored in the
buffers in the UDC core after the UDC core software reset has been cancelled (the UDCRST bit of
the UCTLR register is cleared to 0). For details on EPINFO data setting procedure, refer to section
15.5, Communication Operation.
The USB module in this LSI is designed to automatically load EPINFO data after UDC software
reset. Accordingly, EPINFO data must be specified correctly. Otherwise, USB communication
cannot be performed correctly.
EPINFO data written to UEPIR is maintained in the register. This EPINFO data is automatically
re-loaded after each UDC core reset. Accordingly, EPINFO data need to be written only once.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 495 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
• UEPIRnn_0
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
4
D39 to D36
—
R/W
Endpoint number (4-bit configuration, settable
values: 0 to 8)
0000: Control transfer (EP0)
0001 to 1000: Other than Control transfer (EP1 to
EP8)
There are restrictions on settable endpoint
numbers according to the Interface number and
Alternate number to which the endpoint belongs.
Restriction 1: Set different endpoint numbers
under one Alternate.
However, there is no problem with
use of the same endpoint number if
the transfer directions (IN/OUT) are
different. (Ex: Alt0 -- EP1, EP2i,
EP2o)
Restriction 2: Do not set the same endpoint
number under different Interface
numbers. (Ex: Int0 -- Alt0 -- EP1,
EP2, Int1 -- Alt0 -- EP3)
3
D35
—
R/W
2
D34
—
R/W
Configuration number to which endpoint belongs
(2-bit configuration, settable values: 0, 1)
00: Control transfer
01: Other than Control transfer
1
D33
—
R/W
H8S/2215
0
D32
—
R/W
Interface number to which endpoint belongs (2-bit
configuration, settable values: 0 to 2)
00: Control transfer
00 to 10: Other than Control transfer
H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C
Interface number to which endpoint belongs (2-bit
configuration, settable values: 0 to 3)
00: Control transfer
00 to 11: Other than Control transfer
Page 496 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
• UEPIRnn_1
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
5
D31 to D29
—
R/W
Alternate number to which endpoint belongs (3-bit
configuration, settable values: 0 to 7)
000: Control transfer
000 to 111: Other than Control transfer
4
D28
—
R/W
Endpoint transfer type (2-bit configuration)
3
D27
—
R/W
00: Control (UEPIR00)
01: Isochronous (UEPIR04 to UEPIR19)
10: Bulk (UEPIR02, UEPIR03, UEPIR20,
UEPIR21)
11: Interrupt (UEPIR01, UEPIR22)
2
D26
—
R/W
Endpoint transfer direction (1-bit configuration)
0: out (UEPIR00, 03, 05, 07, 09, 11, 13, 15, 17,
19, 21)
1: in (UEPIR01, 02, 04, 06, 08, 10, 12, 14, 16, 18,
20, 22)
1
D25
—
R/W
0
D24
—
R/W
Endpoint maximum packet size (D25 to D16 10-bit
configuration)
Control transfer = 64 only (UEPIR00)
Interrupt transfer = 0 to 64 (UEPIR01, UEPIR22)
Bulk transfer = 0 or 64 (UEPIR02, UEPIR03,
UEPIR20, UEPIR21)
Isochronous transfer = 0 to 128 (UEPIR04 to
UEPIR19)
•
UEPIRnn_2
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
0
D23 to D16
—
R/W
Endpoint maximum packet size (D25 to D16 10-bit
configuration)
Control transfer = 64 only (UEPIR00) Interrupt
transfer = 0 to 64 (UEPIR01, UEPIR22)
Bulk transfer = 0 or 64 (UEPIR02, UEPIR03,
UEPIR20, UEPIR21)
Isochronous transfer = 0 to 128 (UEPIR04 to
UEPIR19)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 497 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
• UEPIRnn_3
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
0
D15 to D8
—
R/W
Endpoint internal address (D15 to D0 16-bit
configuration)
Set UEPIR00_3, UEPIR00_4 = H'0000
Set UEPIR01_3, UEPIR01_4 = H'0001
:
Set UEPIR21_3, UEPIR21_4 = H'0015
Set UEPIR22_3, UEPIR22_4 = H'0016
•
UEPIRnn_4
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7 to
0
D7 to D0
—
R/W
Endpoint internal address (D15 to D0 16-bit
configuration)
Set UEPIR00_3, UEPIR00_4 = H'0000
Set UEPIR01_3, UEPIR01_4 = H'0001
:
Set UEPIR21_3, UEPIR21_4 = H'0015
Set UEPIR22_3, UEPIR22_4 = H'0016
This manual assumes that endpoint information (EPINFO data) is configured based on the
Bluetooth standard shown in figure 15.2. If endpoint data is configured in a configuration other
than that shown in figure 15.2, care must be taken for the correspondence between endpoint
number, Configuration/Interface/Alternate number and maximum packet size, and register name
and bit name. For details, refer to section 15.7, Endpoint Configuration Example.
Endpoint data configured based on the Bluetooth standard can be specified as shown in table 15.2.
Endpoint data shown in table 15.2 includes unused endpoints (EP4i, EP4o, and EP5i). To load all
EPINFO data items from UEPIR00_0 to UEPIR22_4 correctly, unused end pints must also be
dummy written as shown in table 15.2.
In addition, to prevent unused endpoints from being accessed from the host, descriptor information
for the unused endpoints must not be returned in the enumeration phase at connection. This
correctly informs the host of usable endpoint information and enables access control for unused
endpoints. If descriptor information for the unused endpoints is returned to the host, the USB
cannot operate correctly when the host accesses the unused endpoint.
Page 498 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Note that endpoint data information must match the corresponding descriptor information to be
returned to the host . Otherwise, the USB cannot operate correctly. For example, if the descriptor
information is returned as 16 bytes while the maximum packet size of the EPINFO data is eight
bytes, the host attempts to access the EPINFO data in 16 byte units and cannot operate correctly.
Configuration 1
InterfaceNumber 0
AlternateSetting 0
InterfaceNumber 1
AlternateSetting 0
AlternateSetting 1
AlternateSetting 2
AlternateSetting 3
AlternateSetting 4
AlternateSetting 5
AlternateSetting 6
AlternateSetting 7
InterfaceNumber 2
AlternateSetting 0
EP0 Control(in,out) 64 bytes
EP1i Interrupt(in) 16 bytes
EP2i Bulk(in) 64 bytes
EP2o Bulk(out) 64 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 0 bytes
EP3o Isoch(out) 0 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 9 bytes
EP3o Isoch(out) 9 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 17 bytes
EP3o Isoch(out) 17 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 25 bytes
EP3o Isoch(out) 25 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 33 bytes
EP3o Isoch(out) 33 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 49 bytes
EP3o Isoch(out) 49 bytes
EP3i Isoch(in) 0 bytes
(Unused)
EP3o Isoch(out) 0 bytes (Unused)
EP3i Isoch(in) 0 bytes
(Unused)
EP3o Isoch(out) 0 bytes (Unused)
EP4i Bulk(in) 0 bytes
(Unused)
EP4o Bulk(out) 0 bytes (Unused)
EP5i Interrupt(in) 0 bytes (Unused)
Figure 15.2 Example of Endpoint Configuration based on Bluetooth Standard
Table 15.2 shows the example of EPINFO data setting for endpoint configuration based on the
Bluetooth standard.
The USB module of this LSI is optimized by the hardware specific to the transfer type.
Accordingly, endpoints cannot be configured completely freely. Endpoints can be modified within
the restrictions (only data within parentheses [ ] ) in table 15.2. Data other than that within
parentheses [ ] must be specified according to table 15.2. For details on other endpoint
configuration, refer to section 15.7, Endpoint Configuration Example.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 499 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.2 EPINFO Data Settings
EPINFO Data Settings Based on Bluetooth Standard
Register
No. Name
Address
Corresponding UEPIRn_0 to
Transfer Mode*1 UEPIRn_4 Settings*2
UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI
Rn_0 Rn_1 Rn_2 Rn_3 Rn_3
1
UEPIR00_0 to H'C00000 to Specific to
Control transfer
UEPIR00_4
H'C0004
B'0000_00_00_000_00_0_
0001000000_0000000000000000
H'00
H'00
H'40
H'00
H'00
2
UEPIR01_0 to H'C00005 to Specific to
UEPIR01_4
H'C0009
Interrupt in
transfer
B’[0001]_01_[00]_[000]_11_1_
[0000010000]_0000000000000001*3
H'14
H'1C
H'10
H'00
H'01
3
UEPIR02_0 to H'C0000A to Specific to Bulk in B’[0010]_01_[00]_[000]_10_1_
UEPIR02_4
H'C000E
transfer
[0001000000]_0000000000000010*4
H'24
H'14
H'40
H'00
H'02
4
UEPIR03_0 to H'C0000F to Specific to Bulk
UEPIR03_4
H'C0013
out transfer
B’[0010]_01_[00]_[000]_10_0
[0001000000]_0000000000000011*4
H'24
H'10
H'40
H'00
H'03
5
UEPIR04_0 to H'C00014 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR04_4
H'C0018
in transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000000100*5
H'35
H'0C
H'00
H'00
H'04
6
UEPIR05_0 to H'C00019 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR05_4
H'C001D
out transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000000101*5
H'35
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'05
7
UEPIR06_0 to H'C0001E to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[001]_01_1_
UEPIR06_4
H'C0022
in transfer
[0000001001]_0000000000000110*5
H'35
H'2C
H'09
H'00
H'06
8
UEPIR07_0 to H'C00023 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[001]_01_0_
UEPIR07_4
H'C0027
out transfer
[0000001001]_0000000000000111*5
H'35
H'28
H'09
H'00
H'07
9
UEPIR08_0 to H'C00028 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[010]_01_1_
UEPIR08_4
H'C002C
in transfer
[0000010001]_0000000000001000*5
H'35
H'4C
H'11
H'00
H'08
10
UEPIR09_0 to H'C0002D to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[010]_01_0_
UEPIR09_4
H'C0031
out transfer
[0000010001]_0000000000001001*5
H'35
H'48
H'11
H'00
H'09
11
UEPIR10_0 to H'C00032 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[011]_01_1_
UEPIR10_4
H'C0036
in transfer
[0000011001]_0000000000001010*5
H'35
H'6C
H'19
H'00
H'0A
12
UEPIR11_0 to H'C00037 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[011]_01_0_
UEPIR11_4
H'C003B
out transfer
[0000011001]_0000000000001011*5
H'35
H'68
H'19
H'00
H'0B
13
UEPIR12_0 to H'C0003C to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[100]_01_1_
UEPIR12_4
H'C0040
in transfer
[0000100001]_0000000000001100*5
H'35
H'8C
H'21
H'00
H'0C
14
UEPIR13_0 to H'C00041 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[100]_01_0_
UEPIR13_4
H'C0045
out transfer
[0000100001]_0000000000001101*5
H'35
H'88
H'21
H'00
H'0D
15
UEPIR14_0 to H'C00046 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[101]_01_1_
UEPIR14_4
H'C004A
in transfer
[0000110001]_0000000000001110*5
H'35
H'AC H'31
H'00
H'0E
16
UEPIR15_0 to H'C0004B to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[101]_01_0_
UEPIR15_4
H'C004F
out transfer
[0000110001]_0000000000001111*5
H'35
H'A8
H'31
H'00
H'0F
17
UEPIR16_0 to H'C00050 to Specific to Isoch B’[0011]_01_[01]_[110]_01_1_
H'35
UEPIR16_4
H'C0054
in transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000010000*5*6
H'CC H'00
H'00
H'10
Page 500 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
EPINFO Data Settings Based on Bluetooth Standard
Register
No. Name
Address
Corresponding UEPIRn_0 to
Transfer Mode*1 UEPIRn_4 Settings*2
UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI
Rn_0 Rn_1 Rn_2 Rn_3 Rn_3
18
UEPIR17_0 to H'C00055 to Specific to Isoch B'[0011]_01_[01]_[110]_01_0_
H'35
UEPIR17_4
H'C0059
out transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000010001*5*6
H'C8
H'00
H'00
H'11
19
UEPIR18_0 to H'C0005A to Specific to Isoch B'[0011]_01_[01]_[111]_01_1_
H'35
UEPIR18_4
H'C005E
in transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000010010*5*6
H'EC H'00
H'00
H'12
20
UEPIR19_0 to H'C0005F to Specific to Isoch B'[0011]_01_[01]_[111]_01_0_
H'35
UEPIR19_4
H'C0063
out transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000010011*5*6
H'E8
H'00
H'00
H'13
21
UEPIR20_0 to H'C00064 to Specific to Bulk in B'[0100]_01_[10]_[000]_10_1_
H'46
UEPIR20_4
H'C0068
transfer
[0000000000]_0000000000010100*4*6
H'14
H'00
H'00
H'14
22
UEPIR21_0 to H'C00069 to Specific to Bulk
UEPIR21_4
H'C006D
out transfer
B'[0100]_01_[10]_[000]_10_0_
H'46
[0000000000]_0000000000010101*4*6
H'10
H'00
H'00
H'15
23
UEPIR22_0 to H'C0006E to Specific to
UEPIR22_4
H'C0072
Interrupt in
transfer
B'[0101]_01_[10]_[000]_11_1_
H'56
[0000000000]_0000000000010110*3*6
H'1C
H'00
H'00
H'16
Notes: 1. Each endpoint is optimized by the hardware specific for the transfer mode.
The transfer mode shown in table 15.2 must be specified. (D28 and D27 for all EPINFO
data items must e specified as shown in table 15.2.)
2. Data indicated within parentheses [ ] can be modified. Data other than that within
parentheses [ ] must be specified as shown in table 15.2.
3. Maximum packet size of Interrupt transfer must be from 0 to 64.
4. Maximum packet size of Bulk transfer must be 64 when used or 0 when unused.
5. Maximum packet size of Isochronous transfer must be from 0 to 128.
6. Maximum packet size of endpoint must be 0 when unused.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 501 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.2
USB Control Register (UCTLR)
UCTLR is used to select USB data input/output pin and USB operating clock, specify SOF marker
function, and controls the USB module reset. UCTLR can be read from or written to even in USB
module stop mode. For details on UCTLR setting procedure, refer to section 15.5, Communication
Operation.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
FADSEL
0
I/O Analog or Digital Selection
R/W
Selects USB function data I/O pins
0: USD+ and USD- are used as data I/O pins
1: Control I/O ports 1 and A compatible with Philips
Corp. transceiver are connected to data I/O pins.
P17 (output) → OE: Output enable
P15 (output) → FSE0: SE0 setting
P13 (output) → VPO: Data+ output
P12 (input) ← PCV: Differential input
P11 (input) ← VP: Data+ input
P10 (input) ← VM: Data– input
PA3 (output) → SUSPND: Suspend enable
Ports 1 and A are prioritized to address outputs.
Accordingly, before setting FADSEL to 1, disable A23
to A19 output via PFCR. In addition, FADSEL must be
set during USB module stop mode.
6
SFME
0
R/W
Start Of Frame (SOF) Marker Function Enable
Controls the SOF marker function. If SFME is set to 1,
the SOF interrupt flag can be set to 1 every 1ms even
if the SOF packet has been broken. Note, however,
that UTSR stores a time stamp when the correct SOF
packet is received. The USB does not support UTSR
automatic update function when the SOF packet is
broken.
To set SFME the first time, SFME must be set after
SOF flag detection. SFME must be cleared to 0 when
the suspension is detected. To set SFME after resume
detection, SFME must also be set after SOF flag
detection.
0: Disables the SOF marker function
1: Enables the SOF marker function
Page 502 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
5
UCKS3
0
R/W
USB Operating Clock Selection 3 to 0
4
UCKS2
0
R/W
3
UCKS1
0
R/W
2
UCKS0
0
R/W
Select the USB operating clock (48 MHz). When
UCKS0 to UCKS3 are 0000, both the 48-MHz
oscillator and internal PLL circuit stop and USB
operating clock must be selected according to the
clock source.
The internal PLL circuit and 48-MHz oscillator start
operating after USB module stop mode has been
cancelled. In addition, the USB operating clock is
supplied to the UDC core after 48-MHz clock
stabilization time has been passed. The USB clock
stabilization wait time completion can be detected by
the CK48READY flag of UIFR3.
UCKS0 to UCKS3 muse be written during USB
module stop mode.
0000: USB operating clock stops
(Both 48-MHz oscillator and PLL stop)
0001: Reserved
0010 (H8S/2215): Reserved
0010 (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C): Uses
a clock (48 MHz) generated by doubling the 24MHz system clock by the PLL circuit. The 48MHz oscillator stops. The USB operating clock
stabilization time is 2 ms.
0011: Uses a clock (48 MHz) generated by tripling the
16-MHz external clock (EXTAL pin input) by the
PLL circuit.
0100: Reserved
0101: Reserved
0110 (H8S/2215): Reserved
0110 (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C): Uses
a clock (48 MHz) generated by doubling the 24MHz system clock by the PLL circuit. The 48MHz oscillator stops. The USB operating clock
stabilization time is 8 ms.
0111: Uses a clock (48 MHz) generated by tripling the
16-MHz crystal oscillator (system clock pulse
generator) by the PLL circuit.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 503 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
5
UCKS3
0
R/W
4
UCKS2
0
R/W
3
UCKS1
0
R/W
1000: Uses a clock supplied by the 48-MHz external
clock (EXTAL48 pin input) directly. The PLL
stops. The USB operating clock stabilization
time is 246 to 200 μs.
2
UCKS0
0
R/W
1001 (H8S/2215): Reserved
1001 (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C): Uses
the clock supplied by the 48-MHz external clock
(EXTAL48 pin input) directly. The PLL stops.
The USB operating clock stabilization time is
300 to 200 µs (when using a 16-MHz to 24-MHz
system clock).
1010: Reserved
1011: Reserved
1100: Uses the USB operating clock (48 MHz) directly.
The PLL stops. The USB operating clock
stabilization time is 9.9 to 8 ms.
1101 (H8S/2215): Reserved
1101 (H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C): Uses
the USB operating clock (48 MHz) directly. The
PLL stops. The USB operating clock
stabilization time is 12 to 8 ms (when using a
16-MHz to 24-MHz system clock).
1110: Reserved
1111: Reserved
Note that the USB operating clock stabilization time
differs according to the selected clock source and is
automatically counted by the system clock. The USB
operating clock stabilization time shown above is for
the case when the 13- to 24- MHz system clock is
used.
Page 504 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
1
UIFRST
1
USB Interface Software Reset
R/W
Controls USB module internal reset. When the
UIFRST bit is set to 1, the USB internal modules other
than UCTLR, UIER3, and the CK48 READY bit of
UIFR3 are all reset. At initialization, the UIFRST bit
must be cleared to 0 after the USB operating clock
stabilization time has passed following USB module
stop mode cancellation.
0: Sets the USB internal modules to the operating
state (at initialization, this bit must be cleared after
the USB operating clock stabilization time has
passed).
1: Sets the USB internal modules other than UCTLR,
UIER3, and the CK48 READY bit of UIFR3 reset
state.
If after being cleared to 0 the UIFIRST bit is again set
to 1, the UDCRST bit must also be set to 1 at the
same time.
0
UDCRST
1
R/W
UDC Core Software Reset
Controls reset of the UDC core in the USB module.
When the UDCRST bit is set to 1, the UDC core is
reset and USB bus synchronization operation stops.
At initialization, UDCRST must be cleared to 0 after
D+ pull-up following UIFRST clearing to 0. In the
suspend state, to maintain the internal state of the
UDC core, enter software standby mode after setting
USB module stop mode with the UDCRST bit to be
maintained. After VBUS disconnection detection,
UDCRST must be set to 1.
0: Sets the UDC core in the USB module to operating
state (at initialization, UDCRST must be cleared
after D+ pull-up following UIFRST clearing to 0).
1: Sets the UDC core in the USB module to reset state
(in the suspend state, UDCRST must not be set to
1; after VBUS disconnection detection, UDCRST
must be set to 1).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 505 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.3
USB DMAC Transfer Request Register (UDMAR)
UDMAR is set when data transfer by means of a USB request of the on-chip DMAC is performed
for data registers UEDR2i, UEDR2o, UEDR4i, and UEDR4o corresponding to EP2i, EP2o, EP4i,
and EP4o used for Bulk transfer, respectively. DMAC transfer request sources specified in
UDMAR must be two or less. If two DMAC transfer request sources are specified, a source must
use DREQ0 and another source must use DREQ1. If three or more DMAC transfer requests are
specified or if DREQ0 and DREQ1 usage overlaps, the USB cannot operate correctly. For details
on DMAC transfer, refer to section 15.6, DMA Transfer Specifications.
Note: As the DREQ signal is not used in the data transfer by auto request of the on-chip DMAC,
set UDMAR to H'00.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
EP4oT1
0
R/W
EP4o DMAC Transfer Request Selection 1, 0
6
EP4oT0
0
R/W
00: Does not request EP4o DMAC transfer
01: Reserved
10: Requests EP4o DMAC transfer by DREQ0
11: Requests EP4o DMAC transfer by DREQ1
5
EP4iT1
0
R/W
EP4i DMAC Transfer Request Selection 1, 0
4
EP4iT0
0
R/W
00: Does not request EP4i DMAC transfer
01: Reserved
10: Requests EP4i DMAC transfer by DREQ0
11: Requests EP4i DMAC transfer by DREQ1
3
EP2oT1
0
R/W
EP2o DMAC Transfer Request Selection 1, 0
2
EP2oT0
0
R/W
00: Does not request EP2o DMAC transfer
01: Reserved
10: Requests EP2o DMAC transfer by DREQ0
11: Requests EP2o DMAC transfer by DREQ1
1
EP2iT1
0
R/W
EP2i DMAC Transfer Request Selection 1, 0
0
EP2iT0
0
R/W
00: Does not request EP2i DMAC transfer
01: Reserved
10: Requests EP2i DMAC transfer by DREQ0
11: Requests EP2i DMAC transfer by DREQ1
Page 506 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.3.4
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB Device Resume Register (UDRR)
UDRR indicates remote wakeup according to the host enable/disable state and enables or disables
remote wakeup of the USB modules in the suspend state.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 2 —
Initial Value R/W
All 0
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
1
RWUPs
0
R
Remote Wakeup Status
Indicates the enabled or disabled state of remote
wakeup by the host. This bit is a status bit and cannot
be written to. If the remote wakeup from the host is
disabled by Device_Remote_Wakeup through the
Set_Feature/Clear_Feature request, this bit is cleared
to 0. If the remote wakeup is enabled, this bit is set to
1.
0: Remote wakeup disabled state
1: Remote wakeup enabled state
0
DVR
0
W
Device Resume
Cancels suspend state (remote wakeup execution).
This bit can be written to 1 and is always read as 0.
Before executing remote wakeup, software standby
mode or USB module stop mode must be cancelled to
provide a clock for the USB module.
0: Performs no operation
1: Cancels suspend state (executes remote wakeup)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 507 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.5
USB Trigger Register 0 (UTRG0)
UTRG0 generates one-shot triggers to the FIFO for each endpoint EP0 to EP2. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
5
EP2oRDFN 0
W
EP2o Read Completion
0: Performs no operation
1: Writes 1 to this bit after reading data for EP2o OUT
FIFO. EP2o FIFO has a dual FIFO configuration.
This trigger is generated to the currently effective
FIFO.
4
EP2iPKTE
0
W
EP2i Packet Enable
0: Performs no operation
1: Generates a trigger to enable data transfer to the
EP2i IN FIFO. EP2i FIFO has a dual FIFO
configuration. This trigger is generated for the
currently effective FIFO.
3
EP1iPKTE
0
W
EP1i Packet Enable
0: Performs no operation
1: Generates a trigger to enable data transfer to the
EP1i IN FIFO.
2
EP0oRDFN 0
W
EP0o Read Completion
0: Performs no operation
1: Writes 1 to this bit after reading data for EP0o OUT
FIFO. This trigger enables the next packet to be
received.
1
EP0iPKTE
0
W
EP0i Packet Enable
0: Performs no operation
1: Generates a trigger to enable data transfer to the
EP0i IN FIFO.
Page 508 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
0
EP0sRDFN 0
W
Description
EP0s Read Completion
0: Performs no operation. A NAK handshake is
returned in response to transmit/receive requests
from the host in the data stage until 1 is written to
this bit.
1: Writes 1 to this bit after reading data for EP0s OUT
FIFO. After receiving the setup command, this
trigger enables the next packet to be received by the
EP0i and EP0o in the data stage. EP0s can always
be overwritten and receive data regardless of this
trigger.
Note: As triggers to EP3i and EP3o for Isochronous transfer are automatically generated each
time the SOF packet is received from the host, the user need not generate triggers to EP3i
and EP3o. Accordingly, data write to UEDR3i and data read from UEDR3o must be
completed before the next packet has been received.
15.3.6
USB Trigger Register 1 (UTRG1)
UTRG1 generates one-shot triggers to the FIFO for each endpoint EP4 and EP5. For information
on accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7 to
3
—
All 0
2
EP5iPKTE
0
W
EP5i Packet Enable
0:
Performs no operation
1:
Generates a trigger to enable data transfer to
the EP5i IN FIFO.
1
EP4oRDFN 0
W
EP4o Read Completion
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
0: Performs no operation
1: Writes 1 to this bit after reading data for EP4o OUT
FIFO. EP4o FIFO has a dual FIFO configuration.
This trigger is generated to the currently effective
FIFO.
0
EP4iPKTE
0
W
EP4i Packet Enable
0: Performs no operation
1: Generates a trigger to enable data transfer to the
EP4i IN FIFO. EP4i FIFO has a dual FIFO
configuration. This trigger is generated for the
currently effective FIFO.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 509 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.7
USBFIFO Clear Register 0 (UFCLR0)
UFCLR0 is a one-shot register used to clear the FIFO for each end point from EP0 to EP3.
Writing 1 to a bit clears the data in the corresponding FIFO. For IN FIFO, writing 1 to a bit in
UFCLR0 clears the data for which the corresponding PKTE bit in UTRG0 is cleared to 0 after
data write, or data that is validated by setting the corresponding PKTE bit in UTRG0. For OUT
FIFO, writing 1 to a bit in UFCLR0 clears data that has not been fixed during reception or
received data for which the corresponding RDFN bit is not set to 1. Accordingly, care must be
taken not to clear data that is currently being received or transmitted. EP2i, EP2o, EP3i, and EP3o
FIFOs, having a dual FIFO configuration, are cleared by entire FIFOs. Note that this trigger does
not clear the corresponding interrupt flag. For information on accessing this register, see 2.9.4,
Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
EP3oCLR
0
EP3o clear
W
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP3o OUT FIFO
6
EP3iCLR
0
W
EP3i clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP3i IN FIFO
5
EP2oCLR
0
W
EP2o clear*
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP2o OUT FIFO
4
EP2iCLR
0
W
EP2i clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP2i IN FIFO
3
EP1iCLR
0
W
EP1i clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP1i IN FIFO
2
EP0oCLR
0
W
EP0o clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP0o OUT FIFO
1
EP0iCLR
0
W
EP0i clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP0i IN FIFO
0
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
Page 510 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Note:
When DMA transfers are enabled (EP2oT1 bit set to 1 and EP2oT0 bit set to 0 or 1 in
the UDMAR register), the data in the FIFO is cannot be cleared by writing 1 to
EP2oCLR. To clear the data in the FIFO, first disable DMA transfers (clear the EP2oT1
and EP2oT0 bits in the UDMAR register to 0) and then write 1 to EP2oCLR.
*
15.3.8
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USBFIFO Clear Register 1 (UFCLR1)
UFCLR1 is a one-shot register used to clear the FIFO for each endpoint from EP4 to EP5. Writing
1 to a bit clears the data in the corresponding FIFO. For IN FIFO, writing 1 to a bit in UFCLR1
clears the data for which the corresponding PKTE bit in UTRG1 is cleared to 0 after data write, or
data that is validated by setting the corresponding PKTE bit in UTRG1. For OUT FIFO, writing 1
to a bit in UFCLR1 clears data that has not been fixed during reception or received data for which
the corresponding read completion bit is not set to 1. Accordingly, care must be taken not to clear
data that is currently being received or transmitted. EP4i and EP4o FIFOs, having a dual FIFO
configuration, are cleared by entire FIFOs. Note that this trigger does not clear the corresponding
interrupt flag. For information on accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers
Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 3 —
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
2
EP5iCLR
0
W
EP5i clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP5i IN FIFO
1
EP4oCLR
0
W
EP4o clear*
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP4o OUT FIFO
0
EP4iCLR
0
W
EP4i clear
0: Performs no operation
1: Clears EP4i IN FIFO
Note:
*
When DMA transfers are enabled (EP4oT1 bit set to 1 and EP4oT0 bit set to 0 or 1 in
the UDMAR register), the data in the FIFO is cannot be cleared by writing 1 to
EP4oCLR. To clear the data in the FIFO, first disable DMA transfers (clear the EP4oT1
and EP4oT0 bits in the UDMAR register to 0) and then write 1 to EP4oCLR.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 511 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.9
USB Endpoint Stall Register 0 (UESTL0)
UESTL0 is used to forcibly stall the endpoints for EP0 to EP3. While the bit is set to 1, the
corresponding endpoint returns a stall handshake to the host. However, note that EP3 (Isochronous
transfer) does not return a stall handshake.
The stall bit for endpoint 0 (EP0STL) is cleared automatically on reception of 8-bit command data
for which decoding is performed by the function. When the SetupTS flag in UIFR0 is set, a write
of 1 to the EP0STL bit is ignored. For details, refer to section 15.5.11, Stall Operations.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
EP3oSTL
0
EP3o stall
R/W
0: Cancels the EP3o stall state
1: Places the EP3o stall state
6
EP3iSTL
0
R/W
EP3i stall
0: Cancels the EP3i stall state
1: Places the EP3i stall state
When the EP3i is placed in the stall state, a 0-length
packet is returned for the first IN token. For the
following IN token, nothing is returned.
5
EP2oSTL
0
R/W
EP2o stall
0: Cancels the EP2o stall state
1: Places the EP2o stall state
4
EP2iSTL
0
R/W
EP2i stall
0: Cancels the EP2i stall state
1: Places the EP2i stall state
3
EP1iSTL
0
R/W
EP1i stall
0: Cancels the EP1i stall state
1: Places the EP1i stall state
2 ,1
—
All 0
R
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
0
EP0STL
0
R/W
EP0 stall
0: Cancels the EP0 stall state
1: Places the EP0 stall state
Page 512 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.10 USB Endpoint Stall Register 1 (UESTL1)
UESTL1 is used to forcibly stall the endpoints for EP4 and EP5. In addition, UESTL1 can cancel
all endpoint stall states. While the bit is set to 1, the corresponding endpoint returns a stall
handshake to the host. For details, refer to section 15.5.11, Stall Operations.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
SCME
0
Reserved
R/W
The write value should always be 0.
6 to 3 —
All 0
R
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
2
EP5iSTL
0
R/W
EP5i stall
0: Cancels the EP5i stall state
1: Places the EP5i stall state
1
EP4oSTL
0
R/W
EP4o stall
0: Cancels the EP4o stall state
1: Places the EP4o stall state
0
EP4iSTL
0
R/W
EP4i stall
0: Cancels the EP4i stall state
1: Places the EP4i stall state
15.3.11 USB Endpoint Data Register 0s (UEDR0s)
UEDR0s stores the setup command for endpoint 0s (for Control_out transfer). UEDR0s stores 8byte command data sent from the host in setup stage.
For details on USB operation when the data for the next setup stage is received while data in
UEDR0s is being read, refer to section 15.9, Usage Notes.
UEDR0s is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR0s allows
the user to read 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
—
These bits store setup command for Control_out
transfer
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R
Page 513 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.12 USB Endpoint Data Register 0i (UEDR0i)
UEDR0i is a data register for endpoint 0i (for Control_in transfer). UEDR0i stores data to be sent
to the host. The number of data items to be written continuously must be the maximum packet size
or less.
UEDR0i is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR0i allows
the user to write 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
These bits store data for Control_in transfer
W
15.3.13 USB Endpoint Data Register 0o (UEDR0o)
UEDR0o is a data register for endpoint 0o (for Control_out transfer). UEDR0o stores data
received from the host. The number of data items to be read must be specified by UESZ0o.
When 1 byte is read from UEDR0o, UESZ0o is decremented by 1.
UEDR0o is a 1-byte register to which a 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR0o
allows the user to read 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
—
These bits store data for Control_out transfer
R
15.3.14 USB Endpoint Data Register 1i (UEDR1i)
UEDR1i is a data register for endpoint 1i (for Interrupt_in transfer). UEDR1i stores data to be sent
to the host. The number of data items to be written continuously must be the maximum packet size
or less.
UEDR1i is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR1i allows
the user to write 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Page 514 of 846
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
These bits store data for Interrupt_in transfer
W
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.15 USB Endpoint Data Register 2i (UEDR2i)
UEDR2i is a data register for endpoint 2i (for Bulk_in transfer). UEDR2i stores data to be sent to
the host. The number of data items to be written continuously must be the maximum packet size or
less.
UEDR2i is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR2i allows
the user to write 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
These bits store data for Bulk_in transfer
W
15.3.16 USB Endpoint Data Register 2o (UEDR2o)
UEDR2o is a data register for endpoint 2o (for Bulk_out transfer). UEDR2o stores data received
from the host. The number of data items to be read must be specified by UESZ2o.
When 1 byte is read from UEDR2o, UESZ2o is decremented by 1.
UEDR2o is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR2o allows
the user to read 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
—
These bits store data for Bulk_out transfer
R
15.3.17 USB Endpoint Data Register 3i (UEDR3i)
UEDR3i is a data register for endpoint 3i (for Isochronous_in transfer). UEDR3i stores data to be
sent to the host. The number of data items to be written continuously must be the maximum packet
size or less.
All data items must be written to before the next SOF packet is received.
UEDR3i is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR3i allows
the user to write 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
These bits store data for Isochronous_in transfer
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
W
Page 515 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.18 USB Endpoint Data Register 3o (UEDR3o)
UEDR3o is a data register for endpoint 3o (for Isochronous_out transfer). UEDR3o stores data
received from the host. The number of data items to be read must be specified by UESZ3o.
When 1 byte is read from UEDR3o, UESZ3o is decremented by 1.
All data items must be read before the next SOF packet is received.
UEDR3o is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR3o allows
the user to read 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
—
These bits store data for Isochronous_out transfer
R
15.3.19 USB Endpoint Data Register 4i (UEDR4i)
UEDR4i is a data register for endpoint 4i (for Bulk_in transfer). UEDR4i stores data to be sent to
the host. The number of data items to be written continuously must be the maximum packet size or
less.
UEDR4i is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR4i allows
the user to write 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
These bits store data for Bulk_in transfer
W
15.3.20 USB Endpoint Data Register 4o (UEDR4o)
UEDR4o is a data register for endpoint 4o (for Bulk_out transfer). UEDR4o stores data received
from the host. The number of data items to be read must be specified by UESZ4o.
When 1 byte is read from UEDR4o, UESZ4o is decremented by 1.
UEDR4o is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR4o allows
the user to read 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Page 516 of 846
Initial Value R/W
Description
—
These bits store data for Bulk_out transfer
R
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.21 USB Endpoint Data Register 5i (UEDR5i)
UEDR5i is a data register for endpoint 5i (for Interrupt_in transfer). UEDR5i stores data to be sent
to the host. The number of data items to be written continuously must be the maximum packet size
or less.
UEDR5i is a byte register to which 4-byte address area is assigned. Accordingly, UEDR5i allows
the user to write 2-byte or 4-byte data by word transfer or longword transfer. For information on
accessing this register, see 2.9.4, Accessing Registers Containing Write-Only Bits.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
These bits store data for Interrupt_in transfer
W
15.3.22 USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 0o (UESZ0o)
UESZ0o is the receive data size register for endpoint 0o (for Control_out transfer). UESZ0o
indicates the number of bytes of data to be received from the host.
Note that UESZ0o is decremented by 1 every time when 1 byte is read from UEDR0o.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
—
—
R
Reserved
6 to 0 D6 to D0
—
R
These bits indicate the size of data to be received in
Control_out transfer
15.3.23 USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 2o (UESZ2o)
UESZ2o is the receive data size register for endpoint 2o (for Bulk_out transfer). UESZ2o indicates
the number of bytes of data to be received from the host.
Note that UESZ2o is decremented by 1 every time when 1 byte is read from UEDR2o.
The FIFO for endpoint 2o (for Bulk_out transfer) has a dual-FIFO configuration. The data size
indicated by this register refers to the currently selected FIFO.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
—
—
R
Reserved
6 to 0 D6 to D0
—
R
These bits indicate the size of data to be received in
Bulk_out transfer
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 517 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.24 USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 3o (UESZ3o)
UESZ3o is the receive data size register for endpoint 3o (for Isochronous_out transfer). UESZ3o
indicates the number of bytes of data to be received from the host.
Note that UESZ3o is decremented by 1 every time when 1 byte is read from UEDR3o.
The FIFO for endpoint 3o (for Isochronous_out transfer) has a dual-FIFO configuration. The data
size indicated by this register refers to the currently selected FIFO.
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Initial Value R/W
Description
—
These bits indicate the size of data to be received in
Isochronous_out transfer
R
15.3.25 USB Endpoint Receive Data Size Register 4o (UESZ4o)
UESZ4o is the receive data size register for endpoint 4o (for Bulk_out transfer). UESZ4o indicates
the number of bytes of data to be received from the host.
Note that UESZ4o is decremented by 1 every time when 1 byte is read from UEDR4o.
The FIFO for endpoint 4o (for Bulk_out transfer) has a dual-FIFO configuration. The data size
indicated by this register refers to the currently selected FIFO.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
—
—
R
Reserved
6 to 0 D6 toD0
—
R
These bits indicate the size of data to be received in
Bulk_out transfer
15.3.26 USB Interrupt Flag Register 0 (UIFR0)
UIFR0 is an interrupt flag register indicating the setup command reception, EP0 and EP1
transmission/reception, and bus reset states. If the corresponding bit is set to 1, the corresponding
EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 interrupt is requested to the CPU. A bit in this register can be cleared by
writing 0 to it. Writing 1 to a bit is invalid and causes no operation.
Consequently, to clear only a specific flag it is necessary to write 0 to the bit corresponding to the
flag to be cleared and 1 to all the other bits. (To clear bit 5 only, write H'DF.) The bit-clear
instruction is a read/modify/write instruction. There is a danger that the wrong bits may be cleared
if a new flag is set between the read and write. Therefore, the bit-clear instruction should not be
used to clear bits in this interrupt flag register.
Page 518 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7
BRST
0
Description
R/(W)* Bus Reset
Set to 1 when the bus reset signal is detected on the
USB bus. The corresponding interrupt output is
EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note that BRST is also set to 1if D+ is not pulled-up
during USB cable connection.
6
5
—
EP1iTR
0
R
Reserved
0
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
*
R/(W) EP1i Transfer Request
Set to 1 if there is no valid transmit data in the FIFO
when an IN token is sent from the host to EP1i. The
corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
4
EP1iTS
0
R/(W)* EP1i Transfer Complete
Set to 1 if the transmit data written in EP1i is
transferred to the host normally and the ACK
handshake is returned. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
3
EP0oTS
0
R/(W)* EP0o Receive Complete
Set to 1 if the EP0o receives data from the host
normally and returns the ACK handshake to the host.
The corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1.
2
EP0iTR
0
R/(W)* EP0i Transmit Request
Set to 1 if there is no valid transmit data in the FIFO
when an IN token is sent from the host to EP0i. The
corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
1
EP0iTS
0
R/(W)* EP0i Transmit Complete
Set to 1 if the transmit data written in EP0i is
transferred to the host normally and the ACK
handshake is returned. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
0
SetupTS
0
R/(W)* Setup Command Receive Complete
Set to 1 if the EP0s normally receives 8-byte data to
be decoded by the function from the host and returns
the ACK handshake to the host. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 519 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.27 USB Interrupt Flag Register 1 (UIFR1) (Only in H8S/2215)
UIFR1 is an interrupt flag register indicating the EP2i, EP2o, EP3i, and EP3o. If the
corresponding bit is set to 1, the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 interrupt is requested from
the CPU. EP2iTR and EP3iTR flags can cleared by writing 0 to them. Writing 1 to them is invalid
and causes no operation. However, EP2iEMPTY, EP2oREDY, EP3oTS and EP3oTF are status
bits, and cannot be cleared.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
EP3oTF
0
EP3o Abnormal Receive
R
Indicates the status of EP3o FIFO, which can be read
after the next SOF packet has been received following
the data transmission from the host. This flag is set to
1 if a PID error, CRC error, bit staff error, data size
error, or Bad EOP occurs when the data is transferred
from the host to the EP3o. This is a status bit and
cannot be cleared. In addition, an interrupt cannot be
requested by this flag.
6
EP3oTS
0
R
EP3o Normal Receive
Indicates the status of EP3o FIFO, which can be read
after the next SOF packet has been received following
the data transmission from the host. This flag is set to
1 if data is normally transferred from the host to the
EP3o. This is a status bit and cannot be cleared. In
addition, an interrupt cannot be requested by this flag.
5
EP3iTF
0
R/(W)* EP3i Abnormal Transfer
Set to 1 if data to be written to the EP3i FIFO is lost
because no IN token has been returned. This flag is
set when the SOF packet that is two packets after the
data write is received. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
4
EP3iTR
0
R/(W)* EP3i Transmit Request
Set to 1 if there is no valid transmit data in the FIFO to
be accessed by the UDC when an IN token is sent
from the host to EP3i. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Page 520 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
3
—
0
Reserved
R
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
2
EP2oREADY 0
R
EP2o Data Ready
EP2o FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if there is a valid data in at least one EP2o FIFO.
This flag is cleared to 0 if there is no valid data in
EP2o FIFO. This flag is a status flag and cannot be
cleared. The corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0
or EXIRQ1.
1
EP2iTR
0
R/(W)* EP2i Transmit Request
Set to 1 if the EP2i FIFO is empty when an IN token is
sent from the host to EP2i. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
0
EP2iEMPTY 1
R
EP2i FIFO Empty
EP2i FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if at least one EP2i FIFO is empty. This flag is
cleared to 0 if EP2i FIFO is full. This flag is a status
flag and cannot be cleared. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 521 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.28 USB Interrupt Flag Register 1 (UIFR1) (Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and
H8S/2215C)
UIFR1 is an interrupt flag register indicating the EP2i, EP2o, EP3i, and EP3o. If the
corresponding bit is set to 1, the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 interrupt is requested from
the CPU. EP2iTR and EP3iTR flags can cleared by writing 0 to them. Writing 1 to them is invalid
and causes no operation. Consequently, to clear only a specific flag it is necessary to write 0 to the
bit corresponding to the flag to be cleared and 1 to all the other bits. (To clear bit 5 only, write
H'DF.) The bit-clear instruction is a read/modify/write instruction. There is a danger that the
wrong bits may be cleared if a new flag is set between the read and write. Therefore, the bit-clear
instruction should not be used to clear bits in this interrupt flag register. However, EP2iEMPTY,
EP2oREDY, EP3oTS and EP3oTF are status bits, and cannot be cleared.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
EP3oTF
0
EP3o Abnormal Receive
R
Indicates the status of EP3o FIFO, which can be read
after the next SOF packet has been received following
the data transmission from the host. This flag is set to
1 if a PID error, CRC error, bit staff error, data size
error, or Bad EOP occurs when the data is transferred
from the host to the EP3o. This is a status bit and
cannot be cleared. In addition, an interrupt cannot be
requested by this flag.
6
EP3oTS
0
R
EP3o Normal Receive
Indicates the status of EP3o FIFO, which can be read
after the next SOF packet has been received following
the data transmission from the host. This flag is set to
1 if data is normally transferred from the host to the
EP3o. This is a status bit and cannot be cleared. In
addition, an interrupt cannot be requested by this flag.
5
EP3iTF
0
R/(W)* EP3i Abnormal Transfer
Set to 1 if data to be written to the EP3i FIFO is lost
because no IN token has been returned. This flag is
set when the SOF packet that is two packets after the
data write is received. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
4
EP3iTR
0
R/(W)* EP3i Transmit Request
Set to 1 if there is no valid transmit data in the FIFO to
be accessed by the UDC when an IN token is sent
from the host to EP3i. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Page 522 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
3
EP2iALL
1
EP2i FIFO All Empty Status
R
EMPTYS
2
EP2i FIFO has a dual FIFO configuration. This flag is
set to 1 if both FIFOs are empty. (Corresponds to a
UDSR/EP2iDE negative-polarity signal.)
EP2oREADY 0
R
EP2o Data Ready
EP2o FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if there is a valid data in at least one EP2o FIFO.
This flag is cleared to 0 if there is no valid data in
EP2o FIFO. This flag is a status flag and cannot be
cleared. The corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0
or EXIRQ1.
1
EP2iTR
0
R/(W)* EP2i Transmit Request
Set to 1 if the EP2i FIFO is empty when an IN token is
sent from the host to EP2i. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
0
EP2iEMPTY 1
R
EP2i FIFO Empty
EP2i FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if at least one EP2i FIFO is empty. This flag is
cleared to 0 if EP2i FIFO is full. This flag is a status
flag and cannot be cleared. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 523 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.29 USB Interrupt Flag Register 2 (UIFR2) (Only in H8S/2215)
UIFR2 is an interrupt flag register indicating the state of EP4i, EP4o, and EP5i. If the
corresponding bit is set to 1, the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 interrupt is requested to the
CPU. EP4iTR EP5iTS and EP4iTR flags can cleared by writing 0 to them. Writing 1 to them is
invalid and causes no operation. However, EP4iEMPTY and EP4oREADY are status bits
indicating the EP4i and EP4o FIFO status, and cannot be cleared.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
5
EP5iTR
0
R/(W)* EP5i Transfer Request
Set to 1 if there is no valid transmit data in the FIFO
when an IN token is sent from the host to EP5i. The
corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
4
EP5iTS
0
R/(W)* EP5i Transfer Complete
Set to 1 if the transmit data written in EP5i is
transferred to the host normally and the ACK
handshake is returned. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
3
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
2
EP4oREADY 0
R
EP4o Data Ready
EP4o FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if there is a valid data in at least one EP4o FIFO.
This flag is cleared to 0 if there is no valid data in EP4o
FIFO. This flag is a status flag and cannot be cleared.
The corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1.
1
EP4iTR
0
R/(W)* EP4i Transfer Request
Set to 1 if the EP4i FIFO is empty when an IN token is
sent form the host to EPi4. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
0
EP4iEMPTY 1
R
EP4i FIFO Empty
EP4i FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if at least one EP4i FIFO is empty. This flag is
cleared to 0 if EP4i FIFO is full. This flag is a status
flag and cannot be cleared. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
Page 524 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.30 USB Interrupt Flag Register 2 (UIFR2) (Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and
H8S/2215C)
UIFR2 is an interrupt flag register indicating the state of EP4i, EP4o, and EP5i. If the
corresponding bit is set to 1, the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 interrupt is requested to the
CPU. EP4iTR EP5iTS and EP4iTR flags can cleared by writing 0 to them. Writing 1 to them is
invalid and causes no operation. Consequently, to clear only a specific flag it is necessary to write
0 to the bit corresponding to the flag to be cleared and 1 to all the other bits. (To clear bit 5 only,
write H'DF.) The bit-clear instruction is a read/modify/write instruction. There is a danger that the
wrong bits may be cleared if a new flag is set between the read and write. Therefore, the bit-clear
instruction should not be used to clear bits in this interrupt flag register. However, EP4iEMPTY
and EP4oREADY are status bits indicating the EP4i and EP4o FIFO status, and cannot be cleared.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
5
EP5iTR
0
R/(W)* EP5i Transfer Request
Set to 1 if there is no valid transmit data in the FIFO
when an IN token is sent from the host to EP5i. The
corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
4
EP5iTS
0
R/(W)* EP5i Transfer Complete
Set to 1 if the transmit data written in EP5i is
transferred to the host normally and the ACK
handshake is returned. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
3
EP4iALL
1
R
EMPTYS
2
EP4oREADY 0
EP4i FIFO All Empty Status
EP4i FIFO has a dual FIFO configuration. This flag is
set to 1 if both FIFOs are empty. (Corresponds to a
UDSR/EP4iDE negative-polarity signal.)
R
EP4o Data Ready
EP4o FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if there is a valid data in at least one EP4o FIFO.
This flag is cleared to 0 if there is no valid data in EP4o
FIFO. This flag is a status flag and cannot be cleared.
The corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 525 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
1
EP4iTR
0
Description
R/(W)* EP4i Transfer Request
Set to 1 if the EP4i FIFO is empty when an IN token is
sent form the host to EPi4. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
0
EP4iEMPTY 1
R
EP4i FIFO Empty
EP4i FIFO has a dual-FIFO configuration. This flag is
set if at least one EP4i FIFO is empty. This flag is
cleared to 0 if EP4i FIFO is full. This flag is a status
flag and cannot be cleared. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
Page 526 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.31 USB Interrupt Flag Register 3 (UIFR3)
UIFR3 is an interrupt flag register indicating the USB status. If the corresponding bit is set to 1,
the corresponding EXIRQ0, EXIRQ1, or IRQ6 interrupt is requested from the CPU. VBUSi,
SPRSi, SETI, SETC, SOF, and CK48READY flags can be cleared by writing 0. Writing 1 to them
is invalid and causes no operation. Consequently, to clear only a specific flag it is necessary to
write 0 to the bit corresponding to the flag to be cleared and 1 to all the other bits. (To clear bit 5
only, write H'DF.) The bit-clear instruction is a read/modify/write instruction. There is a danger
that the wrong bits may be cleared if a new flag is set between the read and write. Therefore, the
bit-clear instruction should not be used to clear bits in this interrupt flag register. VBUSs and
SPRSs are status flags and cannot be cleared.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7
CK48READY 0
Description
R/(W)* USB Operating Clock (48 MHz) Stabilization Detection
Set to 1 when the 48-MHz USB operating clock
stabilization time has been automatically counted after
USB module rest mode cancellation. The
corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
CK48READY can also operate in USB interface
software reset state (the UIFRST bit of UCTLR is set
to 1).
Note that USB operating clock stabilization time differs
according to the clock source, refer to the UCKS3 to
UCKS0 bits of the UCTLR.
6
SOF
0
R/(W)* Start of Frame Packet Detection
Set to 1 if the SOF packet is detected. This flag can
be used to start time stamp check, EP3i transmit data
write, or EP3o receive data read timing in EP3
isochronous transfer. The corresponding interrupt
output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
5
SETC
0
R/(W)* Set_Configuration Command Detection
Set to 1 if the Set_Configuration command is
detected. The corresponding interrupt output is
EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
4
SETI
0
R/(W)* Set_Inferface Command Detection
Set to 1 if the Set_Interface command is detected.
The corresponding interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 527 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
3
SPRSs
0
Suspend/Resume Status
R
Indicates the suspend/resume status and cannot
request an interrupt.
0: Indicates that the bus is in the normal state.
1: Indicates that the bus is in the suspend state.
2
SPRSi
0
R/(W)* Suspend/Resume Interrupt
Set to 1 if a transition from normal state to suspend
state or suspend state to normal state has occurred.
The corresponding interrupt output is IRQ6. This bit
can be used to cancel software standby state at
resume.
1
VBUSs
0
R
VBUS Status
Indicates the VBUS state by the USB cable
connection and disconnection. An interrupt cannot be
requested by the VBUSs.
0: Indicates that the VBUS (USB cable) bus is
disconnected.
1: Indicates that the VBUS (USB cable) bus is
connected.
0
VBUSi
0
R/(W)* VBUS Interrupt
Set to 1 if a VBUS state changes by USB cable
connection or disconnection. The corresponding
interrupt output is EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1.
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
Page 528 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.32 USB Interrupt Enable Register 0 (UIER0)
UIER0 enables the interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 0 (UIFR0). When an
interrupt flag is set while the corresponding bit in UIER0 is set to 1, an interrupt is requested by
asserting the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 pin. Either EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 must be
selected by the interrupt select register 0 (UISR0).
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
BRSTE
0
R/W
Enables the BRST interrupt
6
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0.
5
EP1iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP1iTR interrupt
4
EP1iTSE
0
R/W
Enables the EP1iTS interrupt
3
EP0oTSE
0
R/W
Enables the EP0oTS interrupt
2
EP0iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP0iTR interrupt
1
EP0iTSE
0
R/W
Enables the EP0iTS interrupt
0
SetupTSE
0
R/W
Enables the SetupTS interrupt
15.3.33 USB Interrupt Enable Register 1 (UIER1) (Only in H8S/2215)
UIER1 enables the interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 1 (UIFR1). When an
interrupt flag is set while the corresponding bit in UIER1 is set to 1, an interrupt is requested by
asserting the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 pin. Either EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 must be
selected by the interrupt select register 1 (UISR1).
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0.
5
EP3iTFE
0
R/W
Enables the EP3iTF interrupt
4
EP3iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP3iTR interrupt
3
—
0
R
Reserved
2
EP2oREADYE 0
R/W
Enables the EP2oREADY interrupt
1
EP2iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP2iTR interrupt
0
EP2iEMPTYE 0
R/W
Enables the EP2iEMPTYE interrupt
This bit is always read as 0.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 529 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.34 USB Interrupt Enable Register 1 (UIER1) (Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and
H8S/2215C)
UIER1 enables the interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 1 (UIFR1). When an
interrupt flag is set while the corresponding bit in UIER1 is set to 1, an interrupt is requested by
asserting the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 pin. Either EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 must be
selected by the interrupt select register 1 (UISR1).
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0.
5
EP3iTFE
0
R/W
Enables the EP3iTF interrupt
4
EP3iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP3iTR interrupt
3
EP2iALL
0
R/W
Enables EP2iALLEMPTYE interrupt
2
EP2oREADYE 0
R/W
Enables the EP2oREADY interrupt
1
EP2iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP2iTR interrupt
0
EP2iEMPTYE 0
R/W
Enables the EP2iEMPTYE interrupt
EMPTYE
15.3.35 USB Interrupt Enable Register 2 (UIER2)
UIER2 enables the interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 2 (UIFR2). When an
interrupt flag is set while the corresponding bit in UIER2 is set to 1, an interrupt is requested by
asserting the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 pin. Either EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 must be
selected by the interrupt select register 2 (UISR2).
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0.
5
EP5iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP5iTR interrupt
4
EP5iTSE
0
R/W
Enables the EP5iTS interrupt
3
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0.
2
EP4oREADYE
0
R/W
Enables the EP4oREADY interrupt
1
EP4iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP4iTR interrupt
0
EP4iEMPTYE
0
R/W
Enables the EP4iEMPTY interrupt
Page 530 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.36 USB Interrupt Enable Register 2 (UIER2) (Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and
H8S/2215C)
UIER2 enables the interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 2 (UIFR2). When an
interrupt flag is set while the corresponding bit in UIER2 is set to 1, an interrupt is requested by
asserting the corresponding EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 pin. Either EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 must be
selected by the interrupt select register 2 (UISR2).
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0.
5
EP5iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP5iTR interrupt
4
EP5iTSE
0
R/W
Enables the EP5iTS interrupt
3
EP4iALL
0
R/W
Enables EP4iALLEMPTYE interrupt
EMPTYE
2
EP4oREADYE
0
R/W
Enables the EP4oREADY interrupt
1
EP4iTRE
0
R/W
Enables the EP4iTR interrupt
0
EP4iEMPTYE
0
R/W
Enables the EP4iEMPTY interrupt
15.3.37 USB Interrupt Enable Register 3 (UIER3)
UIER3 enables the interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 3 (UIFR3). This register
is readable/writable even though in USB module stop mode. When an interrupt flag is set while
the corresponding bit in UIER3 is set to 1, an interrupt is requested by asserting the corresponding
EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 pin. Either EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 must be selected by the interrupt select
register 3 (UISR3). Note, however, that the SPRSiE bit is an interrupt enable bit specific to the
IRQ6 pin and cannot be selected by UISR3.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 531 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Bit
Bit Name
7
Initial Value
R/W
Description
CK48READYE 1
R/W
Enables the CK48READY interrupt
6
SOFE
0
R/W
Enables the SOF interrupt
5
SETCE
0
R/W
Enables the SETC interrupt
4
SETIE
0
R/W
Enables the SETI interrupt
3
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0.
2
SPRSiE
0
R/W
Enables the SPRSi interrupt (only for IRQ6)
1
—
0
R
Reserved
0
VBUSiE
0
R/W
This bit is always read as 0.
Enables the VBUSi interrupt
15.3.38 USB Interrupt Select Register 0 (UISR0)
UISR0 selects the EXIRQ pin to output interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 0
(UIFR0). When a bit in UIER0 corresponding to the UISR0 bit is cleared to 0, an interrupt request
is output to EXIRQ0. When a bit in UIER0 corresponding to the UISR0 bit is set to 1, an interrupt
request is output to EXIRQ1.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
BRSTS
0
R/W
Selects the BRST interrupt
6
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0.
5
EP1iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP1iTR interrupt
4
EP1iTSS
0
R/W
Selects the EP1iTS interrupt
3
EP0oTSS
0
R/W
Selects the EP0oTS interrupt
2
EP0iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP0iTR interrupt
1
EP0iTSS
0
R/W
Selects the EP0iTS interrupt
0
SetupTSS
0
R/W
Selects the SetupTS interrupt
Page 532 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.39 USB Interrupt Select Register 1 (UISR1) (Only in H8S/2215)
UISR1 selects the EXIRQ pin to output interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 1
(UIFR1). When a bit in UIER1 corresponding to the UISR1 bit is cleared to 0, an interrupt request
is output to EXIRQ0. When a bit in UIER1 corresponding to the UISR1 bit is set to 1, an interrupt
request is output to EXIRQ1.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Reserved
5
EP3iTFS
0
R/W
Selects the EP3iTF interrupt
4
EP3iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP3iTR interrupt
3
—
0
R
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0.
This bit is always read as 0.
2
EP2oREADYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP2oREADY interrupt
1
EP2iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP2iTR interrupt
0
EP2iEMPTYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP2iEMPTY interrupt
15.3.40 USB Interrupt Select Register 1 (UISR1) (Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and
H8S/2215C)
UISR1 selects the EXIRQ pin to output interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 1
(UIFR1). When a bit in UIER1 corresponding to the UISR1 bit is cleared to 0, an interrupt request
is output to EXIRQ0. When a bit in UIER1 corresponding to the UISR1 bit is set to 1, an interrupt
request is output to EXIRQ1.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0.
5
EP3iTFS
0
R/W
Selects the EP3iTF interrupt
4
EP3iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP3iTR interrupt
3
EP2iALL
0
R/W
Selects EP2iALLEMPTY interrupt
2
EP2oREADYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP2oREADY interrupt
1
EP2iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP2iTR interrupt
0
EP2iEMPTYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP2iEMPTY interrupt
EMPTYS
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 533 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.41 USB Interrupt Select Register 2 (UISR2) (Only in H8S/2215)
UISR2 selects the EXIRQ pin to output interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 2
(UIFR2). When a bit in UIER2 corresponding to the UISR2 bit is cleared to 0, an interrupt request
is output to EXIRQ0. When a bit in UIER2 corresponding to the UISR2 bit is set to 1, an interrupt
request is output to EXIRQ1.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Reserved
5
EP5iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP5iTR interrupt
4
EP5iTSS
0
R/W
Selects the EP5iTS interrupt
3
—
0
R
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0.
This bit is always read as 0.
2
EP4oREADYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP4oREADY interrupt
1
EP4iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP4iTR interrupt
0
EP4iEMPTYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP4iEMPTY interrupt
15.3.42 USB Interrupt Select Register 2 (UISR2) (Only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and
H8S/2215C)
UISR2 selects the EXIRQ pin to output interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 2
(UIFR2). When a bit in UIER2 corresponding to the UISR2 bit is cleared to 0, an interrupt request
is output to EXIRQ0. When a bit in UIER2 corresponding to the UISR2 bit is set to 1, an interrupt
request is output to EXIRQ1.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0.
5
EP5iTRS
0
R/W
4
EP5iTSS
0
R/W
Selects the EP5iTS interrupt
3
EP4iALL
0
R/W
Selects the EP4iALLEMPTY
EMPTYS
Selects the EP5iTR interrupt
interrupt
2
EP4oREADYS 0
R/W
Selects EP4oREADY interrupt
1
EP4iTRS
0
R/W
Selects the EP4iTR interrupt
0
EP4iEMPTYS 0
R/W
Selects the EP4iEMPTY interrupt
Page 534 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.43 USB Interrupt Select Register 3 (UISR3)
UISR3 selects the EXIRQ pin to output interrupt request indicated in the interrupt flag register 3
(UIFR3). When a bit in UIER3 corresponding to the UISR3 bit is cleared to 0, an interrupt request
is output to EXIRQ0. When a bit in UIER3 corresponding to the UISR3 bit is set to 1, an interrupt
request is output to EXIRQ1.
Bit
Bit Name
7
CK48READYS 1
R/W
Selects the CK48READY interrupt
6
SOFS
0
R/W
Selects the SOF interrupt
5
SETCS
0
R/W
Selects the SETC interrupt
4
SETIS
0
R/W
Selects the SETI interrupt
All 0
R
3 to 1 —
Initial Value R/W
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0.
0
VBUSiS
0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R/W
Selects the VBUSi interrupt
Page 535 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.44 USB Data Status Register (UDSR)
UDSR indicates whether the IN FIFO data registers (EP0i, EP1i, EP2i, EP4i, and EP5i) contain
valid data or not. A bit in USDR is set when data written to the corresponding IN FIFO becomes
valid after the corresponding PKTE bit in UTRG is set to 1. A bit in USDR is cleared when all
valid data is sent to the host. For EP2i and EP4i, having a dual-FIFO configuration, the
corresponding bit in USDR is cleared to 0 and FIFO becomes empty.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7, 6
—
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
5
EP5iDE
0
R
EP5i Data Enable
0: Indicates that the EP5i contains no valid data
1: Indicates that the EP5i contains valid data
4
EP4iDE
0
R
EP4i Data Enable
0: Indicates that the EP4i contains no valid data
1: Indicates that the EP4i contains valid data
3
—
0
R
Reserved
This bit is always read as 0 and cannot be modified.
2
EP2iDE
0
R
EP2i Data Enable
0: Indicates that the EP2i contains no valid data
1: Indicates that the EP2i contains valid data
1
EP1iDE
0
R
EP1i Data Enable
0: Indicates that the EP1i contains no valid data
1: Indicates that the EP1i contains valid data
0
EP0iDE
0
R
EP0i Data Enable
0: Indicates that the EP0i contains no valid data
1: Indicates that the EP0i contains valid data
Page 536 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.45 USB Configuration Value Register (UCVR)
UCVR stores the Configuration value, Interface Number value and Alternate Setting value when
the Set_Configuration and Set_Interface commands are received from the host.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
7, 6
—
All 0
R
Description
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
5
CNFV0
0
R
Configuration Value 0
Stores the Configuration value when the
Set_Configuration command is received. CNFV0 is
modified when the SETC bit in UIFR3 is set to 1.
4
INTV1
0
R
Interface Number Value 1, 0
3
INTV0
0
R
Store the Interface number value when the
Set_Interface command is received. INTV1 and
INTV0 are modified when the SETI bit in UIFR3 is
set to 1.
2
ATLV2
0
R
Alternate Setting Value 2 to 0
1
ATLV1
0
R
0
ATLV0
0
R
Store the Alternate Setting value when the
Set_Interface command is received. ATLV2 to
ATLV0 are modified when the SETI bit in UIFR3 is
set to 1.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 537 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.46 USB Time Stamp Registers H, L (UTSRH, UTSRL)
UTSRH and UTSRL store the current time stamp values. The time stamp values in UTSRH and
UTSRL are modified when the SOF flag in UIFR3 is set to 1.
UTSRH combined with UTSRL can also be handled as a 16-bit register. The USB module has an
8-bit bus. The upper byte of UTSRH can be read directly, while the lower byte of UTSRL is read
through an 8-bit temporary register. Accordingly, UTSRH and UTSRL must be read in this order.
If only UTSRL is read, the read data cannot be guaranteed. In addition, note that the time stamp
automatic update function is not supported if the SOF packed has been broken even if the SOF
marker function is enabled by setting the SFME bit of UCTLR.
• UTSRH
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 3 —
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
Reserved
R
These bits are always read as 0.
2 to 0 D10 to D8
All 0
R
Stores time stamp D10 to D8.
• UTSRL
Bit
Bit Name
7 to 0 D7 to D0
Page 538 of 846
Initial Value R/W
Description
All 0
Stores time stamp D7 to D0.
R
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.47 USB Test Register 0 (UTSTR0)
UTSTR0 controls internal or external transceiver output signals. After clearing UCTLR/UIFRST
and UDCRST to 0, setting the PTSTE bit to 1 enable user setting of transceiver output. Table 15.3
shows the relationship between UTSTR0 settings and pin outputs.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
PTSTE
0
Pin Test Enable
R/W
Enables the test control of the internal/external
transceiver output signals.
When FADSEL in UCTLR is 0, the test control for the
internal transceiver output pins (USD+ and USD-) and
USPND pin are enabled.
When FADSEL in UCTLR is 1, the test control for the
external transceiver output pins (P17/OE, P15/FSE0,
P13/VPO, and PA3/SUSPND) and USPND pin are
enabled.
6 to 4 —
All 0
R
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
3
SUSPEND
0
R/W
Internal/External Transceiver Output Signal
2
OE
1
R/W
Setting Bits
1
FSE0
0
R/W
SUSPEND: Specifies USPND and PA3/SUSPND pin.
0
VPO
0
R/W
OE:
Specifies internal transceiver OE signal and
P17/OE pin.
FSE0: Specifies internal transceiver FSE0 signal and
P15/FSE0 pin.
VPO: Specifies internal transceiver VPO signal and
P13/VPO pin.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 539 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.3 Relationship between the UTSTR0 Setting and Pin Outputs
Pin
Input
Register Setting
Pin Outputs
P17/
P15/
P13/
VBUS
UCTLR/
FADSEL PTSTE SUSPEND OE
FSE0 VPO
USD+ USD-
USPND SUSPND
PA3/
OE
FSE0
VPO
0
×
0
×
×
×
×
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0
0
1
0/1
×
×
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
0/1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0
1
1
0/1
×
×
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
0/1
1
1
⎯
⎯
0
1
1
×
×
0/1
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
⎯
1
1
0/1
⎯
0
1
1
×
×
×
0/1
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
⎯
1
1
⎯
0/1
1
×
0
×
×
×
×
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
0
0
1
×
0
0
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
0
1
×
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
1
0
1
×
0
0
1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
0
1
1
1
×
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
1
1
0/1
×
×
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
0/1
0/1
⎯
⎯
⎯
1
1
1
×
0/1
×
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
⎯
⎯
0/1
⎯
⎯
1
1
1
×
×
0/1
×
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
⎯
⎯
⎯
0/1
⎯
1
1
1
×
×
×
0/1
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0/1
Legend:
×:
Don’t care
0/1:
Register setting equals pin output
—:
Cannot be controlled. Indicates state in normal operation according to the USB operation
and port settings.
Page 540 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.48 USB Test Register 1 (UTSTR1)
UTSTR1 allows internal or external transceiver input signals to be monitored. When the FADSEL
bit of UCTLR is set to 0, internal transceiver input signals can be monitored. When the FADSEL
bit is FADSEL = 1, external transceiver input signals can be monitored. Table 15.4 shows the
relationship between UTSTR1 settings and pin inputs.
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value R/W
Description
7
VBUS
R
Internal/External Transceiver Input Signal Monitor Bits
6
UBPM
—*
—*
R
VBUS: Monitors VBUS pin
UBPM: Monitors UBPM pin
5 to 3 —
Al 0
R
Reserved
These bits are always read as 0 and cannot be
modified.
R
Internal/External Transceiver Input Signal Monitor Bits
VP
—*
—*
R
VM
—*
R
RCV: Monitors the RCV signal of the internal/external
transceiver
2
RCV
1
0
Note:
*
Monitors the VP signal of the internal/external
transceiver
VM:
Monitors the VM signal of the internal/external
transceiver
Determined by the status of the VBUS, UBPM, USD+, USD-, RCV, VP, and VM pins.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
VP:
Page 541 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.4 Relationship between the UTSTR1 Settings and Pin Inputs
Pin Input
UTSTR1 Monitor
VBUS
UBPM
0/1
×
Register Settings
VBUS
UBPM
×
0/1
×
0/1
×
0/1
UTSTR1
Monitor
Pin Input
UCTLR/ UTSTR0/ UTSTR0/
FADSEL PTSTE SUSPEND VBUS
USD+
P12/
USD- RCV
P11/
VP
P10/
VM
RCV
VP
VM
0
×
×
0
×
×
×
×
×
0
0
0
1
×
×
0
×
×
0/1
×
×
0/1
0
0
0
0
×
1
0
0
×
×
×
×
0
0
0
0
×
1
0
1
×
×
×
0
0
1
0
0
×
1
1
0
×
×
×
1
1
0
0
0
×
1
1
1
×
×
×
×
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
×
×
×
×
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
×
×
×
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
×
×
×
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
×
×
×
×
1
1
0
1
1
1
0/1
×
×
×
×
0
0/1 ×
0
1
1
1
×
0/1
×
×
×
0
×
0/1
1
×
×
1
×
×
0/1
×
×
0/1
×
×
1
×
×
1
×
×
×
0/1
×
×
0/1 ×
1
×
×
1
×
×
×
×
0/1
×
×
0/1
Legend:
×:
Don’t care
0/1: Register setting equals pin output
Page 542 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.3.49 USB Test Registers 2 and A to F (UTSTR2, UTSRA to UTSRF)
UTSTR2 and UTSRTA to UTSRTF are test registers and cannot be written to.
15.3.50 Module Stop Control Register B (MSTPCRB)
Bit
Bit Name
Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
MSTPB7
1
R/W
Module Stop Bits
6
MSTPB6
1
R/W
5
MSTPB5
1
R/W
For details, refer to section 22.1.2, Module Stop
Control Registers A to C (MSTPCRA to MSTPCRC).
4
MSTPB4
1
R/W
3
MSTPB3
1
R/W
2
MSTPB2
1
R/W
1
MSTPB1
1
R/W
0
MSTPB0
1
R/W
Module Stop USB
0: Cancels USB module stop mode. A clock is provided
for the USB module. After this bit has been cleared,
the USB operating clock (48 MHz) oscillator or
internal PLL circuit starts operation. Registers in the
USB module must be accessed after the USB
operating clock stabilization time (CK48READY bit of
UIFR3 is set ) has passed.
1: Places the USB module in stop mode. Both the USB
operating clock (48 MHz) oscillator and internal PLL
circuit stop operation. In this mode, the USB module
register contents are maintained.
Note: For details on USB module stop mode cancellation procedure, refer to section 15.5,
Communication Operation.
15.4
Interrupt Sources
This module has three interrupt signals. Table 15.5 shows the interrupt sources and their
corresponding interrupt request signals. EXIRQ interrupt signals are activated at low level. The
EXIRQ interrupt requests can only be detected at low level (specified as level sensitive). The
suspend/resume interrupt request IRQ6 must be specified to be detected at the falling edge
(falling-edge sensitive) by the interrupt controller register.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 543 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.5 SCI Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source
Description
SetupTS*1
Setup command receive
completion
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
1
EP0iTS*1
EP0i transfer completion
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
2
EP0iTR*1
EP0i transfer request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
3
EP0oTS *1
EP0o receive request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP1iTS
EP1i transfer completion
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP1iTR
EP1i transfer request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
Register Bit
UIFR0
0
4
Transfer
Mode
Control transfer
(EP0)
Interrupt_in
transfer (EP1i)
5
UIFR1
DMAC
Activation
by USB
Request*9
Interrupt
Request
Signal
6
—
Reserved
—
—
—
7
(Status)
BRST
Bus reset
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
0
Bulk_in transfer
(EP2i)
EP2iEMPTY
EP2i FIFO empty
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
DREQ0 or
DREQ1*2
EP2iTR
EP2i transfer request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP2o data ready
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
DREQ0 or
DREQ1*3
1
2
Bulk_out transfer EP2oREADY
(EP2o)
3
Bulk_in transfer*7 EP2iALLEMPTYS*8 EP2i all empty states*7
(EP2i)
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1*7
×* 7
4
Isochronous_in
Transfer (EP3i)
5
6
7
Page 544 of 846
Isochronous_out
Transfer (EP3o)
EP3iTR
EP3i transfer request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP3iTF
EP3i abnormal transfer
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP3oTS
EP3o normal receive
×
×
EP3oTF
EP3o abnormal receive
×
×
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Register Bit
Interrupt
Request
Signal
DMAC
Activation
by USB
Request*9
UIFR2
0
Transfer
Mode
Bulk_in transfer
(EP4i)
1
EP4i FIFO empty
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
DREQ0 or
DREQ1*4
EP4iTR
EP4i transfer request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP4o data ready
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
DREQ0 or
DREQ1*5
Bulk_out transfer EP4oREADY
(EP4o)
3
Bulk_in transfer*7 EP4iALLEMPTYS*8 EP4i all empty states*7
(EP4i)
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1*7
×* 7
4
Interrupt_in
transfer (EP5i)
EP5iTS
EP5i transfer completion
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
EP5iTR
EP5i transfer request
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
—
Reserved
—
—
×
7
—
Reserved
—
—
×
0
⎯
(Status)
VBUSi
VBUS interrupt
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
1
VBUSs
VBUS status
×
×
2
SPRSi
Suspend/resume interrupt IRQ6 *6
6
Notes:
Description
EP4iEMPTY
2
5
UIFR3
Interrupt Source
×
3
SPRSs
Suspend/resume status
×
×
4
SETI
Set_Interface detection
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
5
SETC
Set_Configuration
detection
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
6
SOF
Start of Frame packet
detection
EXIRQ0 or
EXIRQ1
×
7
CK48READY
USB bus clock stabilization EXIRQ0 or
detection
EXIRQ1
×
1. EP0 interrupts must be assigned to the same interrupt request signal.
2. An EP2i DMA transfer by a USB request is specified by the EP2iT1 and EP2iT0 bits of UDMAR.
3. An EP2o DMA transfer by a USB request is specified by the EP2oT1 and EP2oT0 bits of UDMAR.
4. An EP4i DMA transfer by a USB request is specified by the EP4iT1 and EP4iT0 bits of UDMAR.
5. An EP4oDMA transfer by a USB request is specified by the EP4oT1 and EP4oT0 bits of UDMAR.
6. The suspend/resume interrupt request IRQ6 must be specified to be detected at the falling edge
(IRQ6SCB, A = 01 in ISCRH) by the interrupt controller register.
7. Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C. “—” in H8S/2215.
8. Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C. Reserved in H8S/2215.
9. The DREQ signal is not used for auto-request. The CPU can activate the DMAC using any flags
and interrupts.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 545 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
H8S/2215 Group
• EXIRQ0 signal
The EXIRQ0 signal requests interrupt sources for which the corresponding bits in interrupt
select registers 0 to 3 (UISR0 to UISR3) are cleared to 0. The EXIRQ0 is driven low if a
corresponding bit in the interrupt flag register is set to 1.
• EXIRQ1 signal
The EXIRQ1 signal requests interrupt sources for which the corresponding bits in interrupt
select registers 0 to 3 (UISR0 to UISR3) are cleared to 0. The EXIRQ1 is driven low if a
corresponding bit in the interrupt flag register is set to 1.
• IRQ6 signal
The IRQ6 signal is specific to the suspend/resume interrupt request. The rising edge of the
IRQ6 signal is output at the transition from the suspend state or from the resume state.
Page 546 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5
Communication Operation
15.5.1
Initialization
The USB must be initialized as described in the flowchart in figure 15.3.
USB function
Firmware
Cancel power-on reset
Select USB operating clock
Write UCKS3 to UCKS0
in UCTLR
Start USB operationg clock
oscillation
Cancel USB module stop
mode
Clear MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB
to 0
USB operating clock
stabilization time has
passed?
No
Wait for USB operating
clock stabilization
Yes
USB operating clock
stabilization detection
interrupt occurs
EXIRQ0
Cancel USB interface reset
Clear UIFRST in UCTLR
to 0
USB interface operation OK
Clear CK48READY in UIFR3
to 0
Set EPINFO
Write 115-byte data to
UEPIR00_0 to UEPIR22_4
Set EPINFO
Set each interrupt
Set each interrupt
(Bus powered)
No
Self powered?
Yes (Self powered)
System
enters power-down
mode?
No
Yes
To USB cable
connecting procedure
Stop USB module operation
Write MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB to 1
*
Enter software standby state
(If necessary)
*
Wait for USB cable
connection
15.5.2 to (1)
Note: * Before entering the software standby state, USB module operation must be stopped by setting the
MSTPB0 bit in MSTPCRB register to 1.
Figure 15.3 USB Initialization
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 547 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.2
USB Cable Connection/Disconnection
(1) USB Cable Connection (When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Not Used)
If the USB cable enters the connection state from the disconnection state in an application (self
powered) where USB module stop or software standby mode is not used, perform the operation
shown in figure 15.4. In bus-powered mode, perform the operation described in note 2.
USB function
Firmware
Connect the USB cable
*1
A VBUS interrupt occurs
EXIRQx
Clear VBUSi in UIFR3
from 15.5.1
Check the USB cable
connection state
Check if VBUSs in UIFR3
is set to 1
*2
After completing the buspowered function initialization
Clear all FIFOs
System ready?
No
Yes
Enable D+ pull-up by the
port
Automatical load
EPINFO to UDC core
Cancel UDC core reset
Clear UDCRST in UCTLR to 0
Complete the USB module
initialization
Receive bus reset from the host
A bus reset interrupt occurs.
EXIRQx
Initialize the firmware
Wait for a setup interrupt
Notes: 1. A VBUS interrupt in the USB module cannot be detected in the software standby state or in the USB module stop state.
2. During the password function, power is applied after the USB cable has been connected.
Accordingly, immediately after completing the power-on reset, initialization (15.5.1), clearing all FIFO,
and system preparation, enable the D+ pull-up via a general port and cancel the UDC core reset state.
Figure 15.4 USB Cable Connection
(When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Not Used)
Page 548 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(2) USB Cable Connection (When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Used)
If the USB cable enters the connection state from disconnection state an application (self powered)
where USB module stop or software standby mode is used, perform the operation as shown in
figure 15.5.
USB function
Firmware
Connect the USB cable
*
External interrupt IRQx *
Yes
Software
standby?
No
USB module
stopped?
No
Yes
Start USB operating
clock oscillation
USB
operating clock stabilization
time has passed?
Cancel USB module stop mode
Clear MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB to 0
Wait for USB operating clock
stabilization
No
Yes
A USB operating clock
stabilization detection
interrupt occurs
EXIRQx
Clear CK48READY in UIFR3
to 0
Check the USB cable
connection state
Check by using
the port function in IRQx = 1
Clear all FIFOs
System ready?
No
Yes
Enable D+ pull-up by
the port
Automatically load
EPINFO to the UDC core
Cancel UDC core reset
Clear UDCRST in UCTLR to 0
Complete USB
module initialization
Receive bus reset
A bus reset interrupt occurs
EXIRQx
Initializa the firmware
Wait for a setup interrupt
Note: * A VBUS interrupt in the USB module cannot be detected in the software standby state or in the USB
module stop state. Accordingly, in an application in which software standby or USB module stop is used
in self-powered mode, a VBUS interrupt of the USB must be detected via the external interrupt pin IRQx.
In this case, the IRQx pin must be specified as both-edge sensitive. When IRQx is used, a VBUS interrupt
in the USB module need not to be used.
Figure 15.5 USB Cable Connection (When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Used)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 549 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(3) USB Cable Disconnection (When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Not Used)
If the USB cable enters the disconnection state from the connection state in an application (self
powered) where USB module stop or software standby mode is not used, perform the operation
shown in figure 15.6. In bus-powered mode, the power is automatically turned off when the USB
cable is disconnected and the following processing is not required.
USB function
Firmware
Disconnect the USB cable
A VBUS interrupt occurs
*
EXIRQx
Clear VBUSi in UIFR3 to 0
Check if VBUSs in UIFR3
is cleared to 0
SOF marker
function enabled?
No
Yes
Stop the SOF marker function
Clear SFME in UCTLR to 0
Stop SOF marker function
Reset the UDC core
Write UDCRST in UCTLR to1
Reset the UDC core
Enable D + pull-up by
the port
Wait for a USB cable
connection
Note: * A VBUS interrupt in the USB module cannot be detected in the software standby state
or in the USB module stop state.
Figure 15.6 USB Cable Disconnection
(When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Not Used)
Page 550 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(4) USB Cable Disconnection (When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Used)
If the USB cable enters the disconnection state from the connection state in an application (self
powered) where USB module stop or software standby mode is used, perform the operation shown
in figure 15.7.
USB function
Firmware
Disconnect the USB cable
*1
1
External interrupt IRQx *
Yes
Software
standby?
No
USB module
stopped?
No
Yes
Start USB operating
clock oscillation
USB
operating clock stabilization
time has passed?
Cancel USB module stop mode
Clear MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB to 0
Wait for USB operating clock
stabilization
No
Yes
A USB operating clock
stabilization detection
interrupt occurs
EXIRQx
Clear CK48READY in UIFR3
to 0
Check connections by using
the port function in IRQx = 0
SOF marker
function enabled?
Check the USB cable
disconnection state
No
Yes
Stop SOF marker fouction
Clear SFME in UCTLR to 0
Stop SOF marker function
Reset UDC core
Write UDCRST in UCTRL to 1
Reset UDC core
Enable D+ pull-up
by the port
System needs
to enter power-down
mode?
No
Yes
Stop USB module
Write MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB to 1
Enter software standby
(only if necessary)
*2
*2
Wait for USB
cable connection
Notes: 1. A VBUS interrupt in the USB module cannot be detected in the software standby state or in the USB module
stop state. Accordingly, in an application in which software standby or USB module stop is used in self-powered mode,
a VBUS interrupt of the USB must be detected via the external interrupt pin IRQx. In this case, the IRQx pin must be
specified as both edge sensitive. When IRQx is used, a VBUS interrupt in the USB module need not to be used.
2. Before entering the software standby state, USB module operation must be stopped by setting the MSTPB0 bit in
MSTPCRB register to 1.
Figure 15.7 USB Cable Disconnection
(When USB Module Stop or Software Standby Is Used)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 551 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.3
Suspend and Resume Operations
(1) Suspend and Resume Operations
Figures 15.8 and 15.9 are flowcharts of the suspend and resume operations. If the USB bus enters
the suspend state from a non-suspend state, or if it enters a non-suspend state from the suspend
state due to a resume signal from up-stream, perform the operations shown below.
USB function
Firmware
Main process
Suspend/resume interrupt
processing
Enable SPRSi and
IRQ6 interrupts
(Set SPRSiE in UIER3 to 1)
(Set IRQ6E in IER to 1) *1
Initialize standby
enable flag
(Clear standby enable
flag to 0)
USB cable connected
A bus idle of 3 ms or
more occurs
A suspend/resume
interrupt occurs
IRQ6
Run user program
Suspend interrupt
processing
(see figure 15.9)
*1
Suspend state
Standby enable
flag = 1?
No
Yes
Mask all interrupts
(Manipulate bit I using
LDC instruction, etc.)
*2
Enable IRQ6 interrupt
(Set IRQ6E in IER to 1)
*2
Unmask all interrupts
(Clear bit I using LDC
instruction, etc.)
Transition to software
standby
(Execute SLEEP
instruction)
*2
A resume interrupt is
generated from up-stream
A suspend/resume
interrupt occurs
Software standby state
IRQ6
Resume interrupt
processing
(see figure 15.9)
*1
Standby enable
flag = 0?
Notes: 1. The standby enable flag is a software flag for controlling transition to the standby
state. There is no such hardware flag.
2. Interrupts should be masked from when the IRQ6 interrupt is received until the
SLEEP instruction is executed. Finally, unmask the interrupts using the LDC
instruction or the like and execute the SLEEP instruction immediately afterward.
No
Yes
Figure 15.8 Example Flowchart of Suspend and Resume Operations
Page 552 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(2) Suspend and Resume Interrupt Processing
Figure 15.9 is a flowchart of suspend and resume interrupt processing.
USB function
Firmware
IRQ6
Resume interrupt
processing
Suspend interrupt
processing
*1
No
Yes
Standby enable
flag = 0?
*5
Clear USB module
stop mode
(Clear MSTPB0
in MSTPCRB to 0)
Suspend
state confirmed?
(SPRSs in UIFR3 =
1?)
No
Yes
Clear resume flag
(Clear SPRSi in UIFR3
to 0)
Start USB operating
clock oscillation
USB operating
clock stabilization time
has passed?
No
Prohibit IRQ6
(Clear IRQ6E in IER to 0)
Clear standby enable
flag to 0
*1
Wait for USB operating
clock stabilization
*5
*2
Clear suspend flag
(Clear SPRSi in UIFR3
to 0)
Suspend
state confirmed?
(SPRSs in UIFR3
= 1?)
Yes
Clear suspend flag
(Clear SPRSi in UIFR3
to 0)
No
Enable IRQ6 interrupt
(Set IRQ6E in IER to 1)
Yes
SOF marker
function enabled?
A USB operating clock
stabilization detection
interrupt occurs
EXIRQx
USB operating clock stabilization
detection interrupt processing
Clear USB operating clock *6
stabilization detection flag
(Clear CK48READY
in UIFR3 to 0)
*6
Suspend
state confirmed?
(SPRSs in UIFR3 =
1?)
Start SOF marker function
EXIRQx
Yes
Disable SOF marker
function
(Clear SFME in UCTLR
to 0)
Remote*3
wakeup enabled?
(RWUPs in UDRR
= 1)
Yes
No
Yes
No
Receive SOF
Detect SOF packet
An interrupt occurs
No
Confirm that
remote-wakeup is enabled
Confirm that
remote-wakeup is
prohibited
SOF interrupt processing
Clear SOF packet
*4
detection flag
(Clear SOF in UIFR3 to 0)
Enable USB module
stop mode
(Set MSTPB0
in MSTPCRB to 1)
Enable SIF marker
*4
function
(Set SFME in UCTLR to 1)
Set standby enable
flag to 1
*1
Resume main process
Notes: 1. The standby enable flag is a software flag for controlling transition to the standby state. There is no such hardware flag.
2. Interrupts should be masked from when the IRQ6 interrupt is received until the SLEEP instruction is executed. Finally, unmask the interrupts
using the LDC instruction or the like and execute the SLEEP instruction immediately afterward.
3. The remote-wakeup function cannot be used unless it is enabled by the host. Accordingly, the remote-wakeup function cannot be used
unless it is enabled by the host. Accordingly, make sure to check RWUPs in UDRR before using the remote-wakeup function. However, it is
not necessary to confirm that the remote-wakeup function is enabled by the host if the application does not make use of this function.
4. Make this setting only if the SOF marker function will be used.
5. When resuming by means of remote-wakeup the USB operating clock has already stabilized, so this step is not necessary.
6. Return to the main process and wait for the USB operating clock stabilization detection interrupt. When resuming by means of remotewakeup the USB operating clock has already stabilized, so this step is not necessary.
Figure 15.9 Example Flowchart of Suspend and Resume Interrupt Processing
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 553 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(3) Suspend and Remote-Wakeup Operations
Figures 15.10 and 15.11 are flowcharts of the suspend and remote-wakeup operations. If the USB
bus enters a non-suspend state from the suspend state due to a remote-wakeup signal from this
function, perform the operations shown below.
USB function
Firmware
Main process
Suspend/remote-wakeup
interrupt processing
Enable SPRSi and
IRQ6 interrupts
(Set SPRSiE in UIER3 to 1)
(Set IRQ6E in IER to 1) *1
Initialize standby
enable flag
(Clear standby enable
flag to 0)
USB cable connected
A bus idle of 3 ms or
more occurs
IRQ6
A suspend/resume
interrupt occurs
Run user program
Suspend interrupt
processing
(see figure 15.9)
*1
Suspend state
Standby enable
flag = 1?
No
Yes
Mask all interrupts
(Manipulate bit I using
LDC instruction, etc.)
*2
Enable IRQ6 interrupt
(Set IRQ6E in IER to 1)
*2
Unmask all interrupts
(Clear bit I using LDC
instruction, etc.)
Transition to software
standby
(Execute SLEEP
instruction)
*2
Software standby state
Output resume signal
to USB bus
A suspend/resume
interrupt occurs
NMI or IRQx
Remotewakeup
Remote-wakeup
interrupt processing
(see figure 15.11)
IRQ6
*1
Standby enable
flag = 0?
Notes: 1. The standby enable flag is a software flag for controlling transition to the standby
state. There is no such hardware flag.
2. Interrupts should be masked from when the IRQ6 interrupt is received until the
SLEEP instruction is executed. Finally, unmask the interrupts using the LDC
instruction or the like and execute the SLEEP instruction immediately afterward.
No
Yes
Figure 15.10 Example Flowchart of Suspend and Remote-Wakeup Operations
Page 554 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(4) Remote-Wakeup Interrupt Processing
Figure 15.11 is a flowchart of remote-wakeup interrupt processing.
USB function
Firmware
NMI or IRQx
Remote-wakeup
interrupt processing
No
Is remotewakeup enabled
by host?
Wait for resume signal
from up-stream
Start USB operating
clock oscillation
USB operating
clock stabilization time
has passed?
No
USB operating clock stabilization
detection interrupt processing
EXIRQx
Remotewakeup
Output resume signal
to USB bus
A suspend/resume
interrupt occurs
Clear USB module
stop mode
(Clear SPRSi in UIFR3
to 0)
Wait for USB operating
clock stabilization
Yes
A USB operating clock
stabilization detection
interrupt occurs
Yes
Clear USB operating clock
stabilization detection flag
(Clear CK48READY
in UIFR3 to 0)
Execute remote-wakeup
(Set DVR in UDRR to 1)
IRQ6
Resume interrupt
processing
(see figure 15.9)
Resume main process
Figure 15.11 Example Flowchart of Remote-Wakeup Interrupt Processing
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 555 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.4
Control Transfer
The control transfer consists of three stages; setup, data (sometimes omitted), and status, as shown
in figure 15.12. The data stage consists of multiple bus transactions. Figures 15.13 to 15.17 show
operation flows in each stage.
Setup stage
Control-in
Control-out
No data
Data stage
SETUP (0)
IN (1)
IN (0)
DATA0
DATA1
DATA0
SETUP (0)
OUT (1)
OUT (0)
DATA0
DATA1
DATA0
Status stage
...
...
IN (0/1)
OUT (1)
DATA0/1
DATA1
OUT (0/1)
IN (1)
DATA0/1
DATA1
SETUP (0)
IN (1)
DATA0
DATA1
Figure 15.12 Control Transfer Stage Configuration
Page 556 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(1) Setup Stage
USB function
Firmware
Receive SETUP token
Receive 8-byte command
data in UEDR0s
Command
to be processed by
firmware?
No
Automatic
processing by
this module
Yes
Set setup command
receive complete flag
(SetupTS in UIFR0 = 1)
To data stage
EXIRQx
Clear SetupTS flag
(SetupTS in UIFR0 = 0)
Clear EP0iFIFO (EP0iCLR in UFCLR0 = 1)
Clear EP0oFIFO (EP0oCLR in UFCLR0 = 1)
Read 8-byte data from UEDR0s
Decode command data
Determine data stage direction*1
Write 1 to EP0s read complete bit
(EP0sRDFN in UTRG0 = 1)
*2
To control-in
data stage
To control-out
data stage
Notes: 1. In the setup stage, the firmware first analyzes the command data sent from the host required to be
processed by the firmware, and determines subsequent processing.
(For example, the data stage direction.)
2. When the transfer direction must be enabled here. When the transfer direction is control-in, an EP0i
transfer request interrupt is not required and must be disabled.
Figure 15.13 Setup Stage Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 557 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
H8S/2215 Group
(2) Data Stage (Control-In)
The firmware first analyzes command data from the host in the setup stage, and determines the
subsequent data stage direction. If the result of command data analysis is that the data stage is intransfer, one packet of data to be sent to the host is written to the FIFO. If there is more data to be
sent, this data is written to the FIFO after the data written first has been sent to the host (EP0iTS of
UIFR0 is set to 1).
The end of the data stage is identified when the host transmits an OUT token and the status stage
is entered.
Page 558 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB function
Firmware
Receive IN token
From setup stage
1 written
to EP0sRDFN in
UTRG0?
Write data to USB endpoint
data register 0i (UEDR0i)
No
NAK
Yes
Valid data
in EP0iFIFO?
Write 1 to EP0i packet
enable bit
(EP0iPKTE in UTRG0 = 1)
No
NAK
Yes
Transmit data to host
ACK
Set EP0i transmit
complete flag
(EP0iTS in UIFR0 = 1)
EXIRQx
Clear EP0i transmit
complete flag
(EP0iTS in UIFR0 = 0)
Write data to USB endpoint
data register 0i (UEDR0i)
Write 1 to EP0i packet
enable bit
(EP0iPKTE in UTRG0 = 1)
Note:
If the size of the data transmitted by the function is smaller than the data size requested by the host,
the function indicates the end of the data stage by returnning to the host a packet shorter than the
maximum packet size. If the size of the data transmitted by the function is an integral multiple of the
maximum packet size, the function indicates the end of the data stage by transmitting a zero-length
packet.
Figure 15.14 Data Stage Operation (Control-In)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 559 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(3) Data Stage (Control-Out)
The firmware first analyzes command data from the host in the setup stage, and determines the
subsequent data stage direction. If the result of command data analysis is that the data stage is outtransfer, the application waits for data from the host, and after data is received (EP0oTS of UIFR0
is set to 1), reads data from the FIFO. Next, the firmware writes 1 to the EP0o read complete bit,
empties the receive FIFO, and waits for reception of the next data.
The end of the data stage is identified when the host transmits an IN token and the status stage is
entered.
USB function
Firmware
Receive OUT token
1 written
to EP0sRDFN in
UTRG0?
No
NAK
Yes
Receive data from host
ACK
EXIRQx
Set EP0o receive
complete flag
(EP0oTS in UIFR0 = 1)
Read data from USB endpoint
receive data size register 0o
(UESZ0o)
Receive OUT token
1 written
to EP0oRDFN in
UTRG0?
Clear EP0o receive
complete flag
(EP0oTS in UIFR0 = 0)
No
NAK
Read data from USB endpoint
data register 0o (UEDR0o)
Yes
Write 1 to EP0o read
complete bit
(EP0oRDFN in UTRG0 = 1)
Figure 15.15 Data Stage Operation (Control-Out)
Page 560 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(4) Status Stage (Control-In)
The control-in status stage starts with an OUT token from the host. The firmware receives 0-byte
data from the host, and ends control transfer.
USB function
Firmware
Receive OUT token
0-byte reception from host
ACK
Set EP0o receive
complete flag
(EP0oTS UIFR0 = 1)
End of control transfer
EXIRQx
Clear EP0o receive
complete flag
(EP0oTS in UIFR0 = 0)
Write 1 to EP0o read
complete bit
(EP0oRDFN in UTRG0 = 1)
End of control transfer
Figure 15.16 Status Stage Operation (Control-In)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 561 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(5) Status Stage (Control-Out)
The control-out status stage starts with an IN token from the host. When an IN-token is received at
the start of the status stage, there is not yet any data in the EP0iFIFO, and so an EP0i transfer
request interrupt is generated. The application recognizes from this interrupt that the status stage
has started. Next, in order to transmit 0-byte data to the host, 1 is written to the EP0i packet enable
bit but no data is written to the EP0iFIFO. As a result, the next IN token causes 0-byte data to be
transmitted to the host, and control transfer ends.
After the application has finished all processing relating to the data stage, 1 should be written to
the EP0i packet enable bit.
USB function
Firmware
Receive IN token
Valid data
in EP0iFIFO?
No
EXIRQx
NAK
Clear EP0i transfer
request flag
(EP0iTR in UIFR0 = 0)
Yes
Write 1 to EP0i packet
enable bit
(EP0iPKTE in UTRG0 = 1)
Transfer 0-byte data to host
ACK
Write 0 to EP0i transfer
request interrupt enable bit
(EP0iTRE in UIER0 = 0)
Set EP0i transmit
complete flag
(EP0iTS in UIFR0 = 1)
End of control transfer
EXIRQx
Clear EP0i transmit
complete flag
(EP0iTS in UIFR0 = 0)
End of control transfer
Figure 15.17 Status Stage Operation (Control-Out)
Page 562 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.5.5
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Interrupt-In Transfer (EP1i Is specified as Endpoint)
USB function
Firmware
Is there
transmit data
to host?
No
Yes
Receive IN token
Write data to USB endpoint
data register 1i (UEDR1i)
Valid data
in EP1iFIFO?
No
NAK
Yes
Write 1 to EP1i packet
enable bit
(EP1iPKTE in UTRG0 = 1)
Transmit data to host
ACK
Set EP1i transmit
complete flag
(EP1iTS in UIFR0 = 1)
Interrupt request
Clear EP1i transmit
complete flag
(EP1iTS in UIFR0 = 0)
Is there
transmit data
to host?
No
Yes
Write data to USB endpoint
data register 1i (UEDR1i)
Write 1 to EP1i packet
enable bit
(EP1iPKTE in UTRG0 = 1)
Note: This flowchart shows just one example of interrupt transfer processing. Other possibilities include an
operation flow in which, if there is data to be transferred, the EP1i data enable bit in the USB data status
register is referenced to confirm that the FIFO is empty, and then data is written to the FIFO.
Figure 15.18 EP1i Interrupt-In Transfer Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 563 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.6
Bulk-In Transfer (Dual FIFOs) (EP2i Is specified as Endpoint)
EP2i has two 64-byte FIFOs, but the user can perform data transmission and transmit data writes
without being aware of this dual-FIFO configuration. However, one data write is performed for
one FIFO. For example, even if both FIFOs are empty, it is not possible to perform EP2iPKTE at
one time after consecutively writing 128 bytes of data. EP2iPKTE must be performed for each 64byte write.
When transmitting data to the host using a bulk-in transfer, the EP2iFIFO empty interrupt must
first be enabled. 1 is written to the UIER1/EP2iEMPTYE bit, and the EP2iFIFO empty interrupt is
enabled. At first, both EP2iFIFOs are empty, and so an EP2iFIFO empty interrupt is generated
immediately.
The data to be transmitted is written to the data register using this interrupt. After the first transmit
data write for one FIFO, the other FIFO is empty, and so the next transmit data can be written to
the other FIFO immediately. When both FIFOs are full, EP2iEMPTY is cleared to 0. If at least
one FIFO is empty, UIFR1/EP2iEMPTY is set to 1. When ACK is returned from the host after
data transmission is completed, the FIFO used in the data transmission becomes empty. If the
other FIFO contains valid transmit data at this time, transmission can be continued.
When transmission of all data has been completed, write 0 to UIER1/EP2iEMPTYE and disable
EXIRQ0 or EXIRQ1 interrupt requests.
Page 564 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB function
Firmware
Receive IN token
No
Valid data
in EP2iFIFO?
Is there data
to be transmitted to
the host?
NAK
Yes
No
Yes
Write 1 to EP2iFIFO
empty enable
(EP2iEMPTYE in UIER1 = 1)
Transmit data to host
ACK
Yes
Space
in EP2iFIFO?
Set EP2iFIFO
empty status
(EP2iEMPTY
in UIFR1 = 1)
EXIRQx
EP2iEMPTY in UIFR1
interrupt
No
Clear EP2iFIFO empty status
(EP2iEMPTY in UIFR1 = 0)
Write one packet of data
to USB endpoint data register
2i (UEDR2i)
Write 1 to EP2i packet
enable bit
(EP2iPKTE in UTRG0 = 1)
Is there data
to be transmitted to
the host?
No
Yes
Write 0 to EP2iFIFO empty
interrupt enable bit
(EP2iEMPTYE in UIER1 = 0)
Figure 15.19 EP2i Bulk-In Transfer Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 565 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.7
Bulk-Out Transfer (Dual FIFOs) (EP2o Is specified as Endpoint)
EP2o has two 64-byte FIFOs, but the user can perform data reception and receive data reads
without being aware of this dual-FIFO configuration.
When one FIFO is full after reception is completed, the UIFR1/EP2oREADY bit is set. After the
first receive operation into one of the FIFOs when both FIFOs are empty, the other FIFO is empty,
and so the next packet can be received immediately. When both FIFOs are full, NAK is returned
to the host automatically. When reading of the receive data is completed following data reception,
1 is written to the UTRG0/EP2oRDFN bit. This operation empties the FIFO that has just been
read, and makes it ready to receive the next packet.
Page 566 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB function
Firmware
Receive OUT token
Space
in EP2oFIFO?
No
NAK
Yes
Transmit data from host
ACK
EXIRQx
Set EP2o data ready status
(EP2oREADY in UIFR1 = 1)
Read USB endpoint receive
data size register 2o (UESZ2o)
Read data from USB endpoint
data register 2o (UEDR2o)
Write 1 to EP2o read
complete bit
(EP2oRDFN in UTRG0 = 1)
Both
EP2oFIFOs empty?
No
EXIRQx
Yes
Clear EP2o data ready status
(EP2oREADY in UIFR1 = 0)
Figure 15.20 EP2o Bulk-Out Transfer Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 567 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.8
H8S/2215 Group
Isochronous–In Transfer (Dual-FIFO) (When EP3i Is Specified as Endpoint)
EP3i has two 128-byte (maximum) FIFOs, however the user can perform data transmission and
transmit data writes without being aware of this dual-FIFO configuration.
In isochronous transfer, as a transmission is performed once a frame (1 ms), the hardware
automatically switches FIFOs when the hardware receives the SOF. Even when SOF cannot be
received by an error, enabling the SOF marker function allows the hardware to automatically
switch the FIFOs every 1 ms. In addition, the USB function checks if the valid data of the
previous frame was transferred from the FIFO to the host after SOF has been received. As a result,
if the valid data in the FIFO is not transferred to the host (if the host does not return an IN token or
if an IN token error has occurred), the USB regards it as EP3i IN token not received and sets the
EP3iTF bit of UIFR1 to 1.
Two FIFOs are switched when the SOF is received, the FIFO used to transfer data to the host
differs from the FIFO to which the firmware writes transmit data. Accordingly, no contention
occurs between one FIFO read and the other FIFO write. The data to be written by the firmware is
transferred to the host in the next frame. As two FIFOs are automatically switched when the SOF
is received, data must be written within a single frame.
The USB function transfers data to the host if the FIFO contains data to be sent to the host after an
IN token has been received. If the FIFO contains no data, the USB function sets the TR flag to 1
and sends 0-byte data to the host.
The firmware first calls the isochronous transfer process routine by the SOF interrupt and checks
the time stamp. The firmware then writes 1-packet data to the FIFO and this 1-packed data is sent
to the host in the next frame.
Page 568 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB function
Firmware
EXIRQx
Receive SOF
Valid data in FIFO B
has been transferred?
No
EP3i IN token not received
(Set EP3iTF in UIFR1 to 1)
Yes
Clear the SOF packet
detection flag
(Clear SOF in UIFR3 to 0)
Read USB time stamp
registers H and L
(UTSRH and UTSRL)
Switch to FIFO A
FIFO A
FIFO B
Receive IN token
Valid data in FIFO A
has been transferred?
No
Set EP3i transfer
request flag
(Set EP3iTR in UIFR1 to 1)
Write 1-packet data to the
USB endpoint data
register 3i (UEDR3i)
Yes
Send 0-byte data
Send data to the host
EXIRQx
Receive SOF
Valid data in FIFO A
has been transferred?
EP3i IN token not received
(Set EP3iTF in UIFR1 to 1)
No
Yes
Start of Frame
Clear the SOF packet
detection flag
(Clear SOF in UIFR3 to 0)
Read USB time stamp
registers H and L
(UTSRH and UTSRL)
Switch to FIFO B
FIFO A
FIFO B
Receive IN token
Is there a valid data
in EP3iFIFO?
No
EP3i IN token not received
(Set EP3iTR in UIFR1 to 1)
Write 1-packet data to the
USB endpoint data
register 3i
(UEDR3i)
Yes
Send 0-byte data
Send data to the host
Figure 15.21 EP3i Isochronous-In Transfer Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 569 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.9
H8S/2215 Group
Isochronous–Out Transfer (Dual-FIFO) (When EP3o Is Specified as Endpoint)
EP3o has two 128-byte (maximum) FIFOs, however the user can perform data transmission and
transmit data writes without being aware of this dual-FIFO configuration.
In isochronous transfer, as a transmission is performed once a frame (1 ms), the hardware
automatically switches FIFOs when the hardware receives the SOF. (Even when SOF cannot be
received by an error, enabling the SOF marker function allows the hardware to automatically
switch the FIFOs every 1 ms.)
Two FIFOs are switched when the SOF is received, the FIFO used to transfer data from the host to
the firmware differs from the FIFO from which the firmware reads transmit data. Accordingly, no
contention occurs between one FIFO read and the other FIFO write. The firmware read the data in
the previous frame. As two FIFOs are automatically switched when the SOF is received, data must
be read within a single frame.
The USB function receives data from the host after an OUT token has been received. If a data
error occurs on data reception, the USB function sets the TF flag to 1; if no data error occurs, the
USB function sets the TS flag to 1.
The firmware first calls the isochronous transfer process routine via the SOF interrupt, checks the
time stamp, and then reads from the FIFO. Accordingly, the firmware checks whether a data error
occurs or not via status information indicated by the TF and TS flags. These TF and TS flags
indicate the status of the FIFO currently being read.
Page 570 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB function
Firmware
EXIRQx
Receive SOF
Switch to FIFO
B-side UIFR1/EP3oTS, EP3oTF update
Start of Frame
Clear the SOF packet
detection flag
(Clear SOF in UIFR3 to 0)
Read USB time stamp
registers H and L
(UTSRH and UTSRL)
FIFO B
FIFO A
Receive OUT token
Read EP3o statis
(Read EP3oTS and
EP3oTF in UIFR1)
Receive data from the host
Receive data
error?
Read USB endpoint
receive data size
register 3o (UESZ3o)
No
Read data from the USB
endpoint data register 3o
(UEDR3o)
Yes
Set EP3o normal
receive status to 1
Set EP3o abnormal
receive status to 1
(Set internal EP3oTS to 1)
(Set internal EP3oTF to 1)
EXIRQx
Receive SOF
Switch to FIFO
A-side UIFR1/EP3oTS, EP3oTF update
Start of Frame
Clear the SOF packet
detection flag
(Clear SOF in UIFR3 to 0)
Read USB time stamp
registers H and L
(UTSRH and UTSRL)
FIFO A
FIFO B
Receive OUT token
Read EP3o status
(Read EP3oTS and
EP3oTF in UIFR1)
Receive data from the host
Receive data
error?
Read USB endpoint
receive data size
register 3o (UESZ3o)
No
Yes
Set EP3o normal
receive status to 1
Set EP3o abnormal
receive status to 1
(Set Internal EP3oTS to 1)
(Set Internal EP3oTF to 1)
Read data from the USB
endpoint data register 3o
(UEDR3o)
Figure 15.22 EP3o Isochronous-Out Transfer Operation
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 571 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.10 Processing of USB Standard Commands and Class/Vendor Commands
(1) Processing of Commands Transmitted by Control Transfer
A command transmitted from the host by control transfer may require decoding and execution of
command processing by the firmware. Whether or not command decoding is required by the
firmware is indicated in table 15.6 below.
Table 15.6 Command Decoding on Firmware
Decoding not Necessary on Firmware
Decoding Necessary on Firmware
Clear Feature
Get Descriptor
Get Configuration
Synch Frame
Get Interface
Get Status
Set Descriptor
Class/Vendor command
Set Address
Set Configuration
Set Feature
Set Interface
If decoding is not necessary on the firmware, command decoding and data stage and status
stage processing are performed automatically. No processing is necessary by the user. An interrupt
is not generated in this case.
If decoding is necessary on the firmware, the USB function module stores the command in
the EP0sFIFO. After normal reception is completed, the SetupTS flag of UIER0 is set and an
interrupt request is generated from the EXIRQx. In the interrupt routine, eight bytes of data must
be read from the EP0s data register (UEDR0s) and decoded by firmware. The necessary data stage
and status stage processing should then be carried out according to the result of the decoding
operation.
Page 572 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.5.11 Stall Operations
(1) Overview
This section describes stall operations in the USB function module. There are two cases in which
the USB function module stall function is used:
1. When the firmware forcibly stalls an endpoint for some reason
2. When a stall is performed automatically within the USB function module due to a USB
specification violation
The USB function module has internal status bits that hold the status (stall or non-stall) of each
endpoint. When a transaction is sent from the host, the module references these internal status bits
and determines whether to return a stall to the host. These bits cannot be cleared by the
application; they must be cleared with a Clear Feature command from the host.
(2) Forcible Stall by Firmware
The firmware uses UESTL to issue a stall request for the USB function module. When the
firmware wishes to stall a specific endpoint, it sets the corresponding EPnSTL bit (1-1 in figure
15.23). The internal status bits are not changed.
When a transaction is sent from the host for the endpoint for which the EPnSTL bit was set, the
USB function module references the internal status bit, and if this is not set, references the
corresponding EPnSTL bit (1-2 in figure 15.23). If the corresponding EPnSTL bit is not set, the
internal status bit is not changed and the transaction is accepted. If the corresponding EPnSTL bit
is set, the USB function module sets the internal status bit and returns a stall handshake to the host
(1-3 in figure 15.23).
Once an internal status bit is set, it remains set until cleared by a Clear Feature command from the
host, without regard to EPnSTL. Even after a bit is cleared by the Clear Feature command (3-1 in
figure 15.23), the USB function module continues to return a stall handshake while the EPnSTL
bit is set, since the internal status bit is set each time a transaction is executed for the
corresponding endpoint (1-2 in figure 15.23). To clear a stall, therefore, it is necessary for the
corresponding EPnSTL bit to be cleared by the firmware, and also for the internal status bit to be
cleared with a Clear Feature command (2-1 to 2-3 in figure 15.23).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 573 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(1) Transition from normal operation to stall
USB function module
(1-1)
USB
EPnSTL
0→1
Internal status bit
0
1. Set EPnSTL to 1 by
firmware
(1-2)
Reference
Transaction request
EPnSTL
1
Internal status bit
0
1. Receive IN/OUT
token from the host
2. Refer to EPnSTL
To (1-3)
(1-3)
Stall
STALL handshake
EPnSTL
1 (SCME = 0)
Internal status bit
0→1
To (2-1) or (3-1)
1. SCME is set to 1
2. EPnSTL is set to 1
3. Set internal status
bit to 1
4. Transmit STALL
handshake
(2) When Clear Feature is sent after EPnSTL is cleared
(2-1)
Transaction request
Internal status bit
1
EPnSTL
1→0
Internal status bit
1
EPnSTL
0
Internal status bit
1→0
EPnSTL
0
1. Clear EPnSTL to 0
by firmware
2. Receive IN/OUT
token from the host
3. Internal status bit
has been set to 1
4. EPnSTL not
referenced
5. No change in
internal status bit
(2-2)
STALL handshake
1. Transmit STALL
handshake
(2-3)
Clear Feature command
1. Clear internal status
bit to 0
Normal status restored
(3) When Clear Feature is sent before EPnSTL is cleared to 0
(3-1)
Clear Feature command
EPnSTL
1
Internal status bit
1→0
1. Clear internal status
bit to 0
2. No change in
EPnSTL bit
To (1-2)
Figure 15.23 Forcible Stall by Firmware
Page 574 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(3) Automatic Stall by USB Function Module
When a stall setting is made with the Set Feature command, when the information of this module
differs from that returned to the host by the Get Descriptor, or in the event of a USB specification
violation, the USB function module automatically sets the internal status bit for the relevant
endpoint without regard to EPnSTL, and returns a stall handshake (1-1 in figure 15.24).
Once an internal status bit is set, it remains set until cleared by a Clear Feature command from the
host, without regard to EPnSTL. After a bit is cleared by the Clear Feature command, EPnSTL is
referenced (3-1 in figure 15.24). The USB function module continues to return a stall handshake
while the internal status bit is set, since the internal status bit is set even if a transaction is
executed for the corresponding endpoint (2-1 and 2-2 in figure 15.24). To clear a stall, therefore,
the internal status bit must be cleared with a Clear Feature command (3-1 in figure 15.24). If set
by the firmware, EPnSTL should also be cleared (2-1 in figure 15.24).
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 575 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(1) Transition from normal operation to stall
USB function module
(1-1)
STALL handshake
Internal status bit
0→1
EPnSTL
0
To (2-1) or (3-1)
1. In case of USB
specification
violation, USB
function module
stalls endpoint
automatically.
(2) When transaction is performed when internal status bit is set
(2-1)
Transaction request
Internal status bit
1
EPnSTL
0
Internal status bit
1
EPnSTL
0
1. Receive IN/OUT
token from the host
2. Internal status bit
has been set to 1
3. EPnSTL not
referenced
4. No change internal
status bit
(2-2)
STALL handshake
1. Transmit STALL
handshake
Stall status maintained
(3) When Clear Feature is sent before transaction is performed
(3-1)
Clear Feature command
Internal status bit
1→0
EPnSTL
0
1. Clear the internal
status bit to 0
2. No change in
EPnSTL
Normal status restored
Figure 15.24 Automatic Stall by USB Function Module
Page 576 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.6
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
DMA Transfer Specifications
Two methods of USB request and auto request are available for the DMA transfer of USB data.
15.6.1
DMA Transfer by USB Request
(1) Overview
Only normal mode in full address mode (cycle steal mode) supports the transfer by a USB request
of the on-chip DMAC. Endpoints that can be transferred by the on-chip DMAC are EP2 and EP4
in Bulk transfer (corresponding registers are UEDR2i, UEDR2o, UEDR4i, and UEDR4o). In
DMA transfer, the USB module must be accessed as an external device in area 6. The USB
module cannot be accessed as a device with external ACK (single-address transfer cannot be
performed). 0-byte data transfer to EP2o or EP4o is ignored even if the DMA transfer is enabled
by setting the EP2oT1 or EP4oT1 bit of UDMAR to 1.
(2) On-Chip DMAC Settings
The on-chip DMAC must be specified as follows: A USB request (DREQ signal), activated by
low-level input, byte size, full-address mode transfer, and the DTA bit of DMABCR = 1. After
completing the DMA transfers of specified time, the DMAC automatically stops. Note, however,
that the USB module keeps the DREQ signal low while data to be transferred by the on-chip
DMAC remains regardless of the DMAC status.
(3) EP2i and EP4i DMA Transfer
The EP2iT1 and EP4iT1 bits of UDMAR enable DMA transfer. The EP2iT0 and EP4iT0 bits of
the UDMAR specify the DREQ signal to be used by the DMA transfer. When the EP2iT1 or
EP4iT1 is set to 1, the DREQ signal is driven low if at least one of EP2i and EP4i data FIFOs are
empty; the DREQ signal is driven high if both EP2i and EP4i data FIFOs are full.
(a) EP2iPKTE and EP4iPKTE Bits of UTRG
When DMA transfer is performed on EP2i and EP4i transmit data, the USB module automatically
performs the same processing as writing 1 to EP2iPKTE and EP4iPKTE if one data FIFO (64
bytes) becomes full. Accordingly, to transfer data of integral multiples of 64 bytes, the user need
not write EP2iPKTE and EP4iPKTE to 1. To transfer data of less than 64 bytes, the user must
write EP2iPKTE and EP4iPKTE to 1 using the DMA transfer end interrupt of the on-chip DMAC.
If the user writes 1 to EP2iPKTE and EP4iPKTE in cases other than the case when data of less
than 64 bytes is transferred, excess transfer occurs and correct operation cannot be guaranteed.
Figure 15.25 shows an example for transmitting 150 bytes of data from EP2i to the host. In this
case, internal processing the same as writing 1 to EP2iPKTE is automatically performed twice.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 577 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
This kind of internal processing is performed when the currently selected data FIFO becomes full.
Accordingly, this processing is automatically performed only when 64-byte data is sent. This
processing is not performed automatically when data less than 64 bytes is sent.
(b) EP2i DMA Transfer Procedure
1. Set bits EP2iT1 and EP2iT0 in UDMAR.
2. DMAC settings (in DMAC specify number of transfers for 150 bytes).
3. Start DMAC.
4. DMA transfer.
5. Write 1 to EP2iPKTE in UTRG0 using DMA transfer end interrupt.
64 bytes
64 bytes
EP2iPKTE
(Automatically
performed)
22 bytes
EP2iPKTE
(Automatically
performed)
EP2iPKTE is
not performed
Execute by DMA transfer
end interrupt (user)
Figure 15.25 EP2iPKTE Operation in UTRG0
(4) EP2o and EP4o DMA Transfer
The EP2oT1 and EP4oT1 bits of UDMAR enable DMA transfer. The EP2oT0 and EP4oT0 bits of
the UDMAR specify the DREQ signal to be used by the DMA transfer. When the EP2oT1 or
EP4oT1 is set to 1, the DREQ signal is driven low if at least one of EP2o and EP4o data FIFOs are
full (ready state); the DREQ signal is driven high if both EP2o and EP4o data FIFOs are empty
when all receive data items are read.
(a) EP2oRDFN and EP4oRDFN Bits of UTRG
When DMA transfer is performed on EP2o and EP4o receive data, do not write 1 to EP2oRDFN
or EP4oRDFN after one data FIFO (64 bytes) has been read. In data transfer other than DMA
transfer, the next data cannot be read after one data FIFO (64 bytes) has been read unless
EP2oRDFN and EP4oRDFN are set to 1. While in DMA transfer, the USB module automatically
performs the same processing as writing 1 to EP2oRDFN and EP4oRDFN if the currently selected
FIFO becomes empty. Accordingly, in DMA transfer, the user need not write EP2oRDFN and
EP4oRDFN to 1. If the user writes EP2oRDFN and EP4oRDFN to 1 in DMA transfer, excess
transfer occurs and correct operation cannot be guaranteed.
Figure 15.26 shows an example of EP2o receiving 150 bytes of data from the host. In this case,
internal processing the same as writing 1 to EP2oRDFN is automatically performed three times.
Page 578 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
This kind of internal processing is performed when the currently selected data FIFO becomes
empty. Accordingly, this processing is automatically performed both when 64-byte data is sent
and when data less than 64 bytes is sent.
(b) EP2o DMA Transfer Procedure
The DMAC transfer unit should be one packet. Therefore, after the EP2oREADY flag is set, check
the size of the data received from the host and make DMAC settings to match the number of
transfers required.
1. Set bits EP2oT1 and EP2oT0 in UDMAR.
2. Wait for EP2oREADY flag to be set.
3. DMAC settings.
Read value of UESZ2o and specify number of transfers to match size of received data (64
bytes or less).
4. Start DMAC.
5. DMA transfer (transfer of 64 bytes or less).
6. Wait for end of DMA transfer.
7. Repeat steps 2 to 6 above.
64 bytes
64 bytes
EP2oRDFN
(Automatically
performed)
22 bytes
EP2oRDFN
EP2oRDFN
(Automatically (Automatically
performed)
performed)
Figure 15.26 EP2oRDFN Operation in UTRG0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 579 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.6.2
DMA Transfer by Auto-Request
(1) Overview
Burst mode transfer or ycle steal transfer can be selected for the on-chip DMAC auto-request
transfer. Endpoints that can be transferred by the on-chip DMAC are all registers (UEDR0s,
UEDR0i, UEDR0o, UEDR1i, UEDR2i, UEDR2o, UEDR3i, UEDR3o, UEDR4i, UEDR4o, and
UEDR5i). Confirm flags and interrupts corresponding to each data register before activating the
DMA. As UDMAR is not used in auto-request mode, set UDMAR to H'00.
(2) On-Chip DMAC Settings
The on-chip DMAC must be specified as follows: Auto-request, byte size, full-address mode
transfer, and number of transfers equal to or less than the maximum packet size of the data
register. After completing the DMAC transfers of specified time, the DMAC automatically stops.
(3) EPni DMA Transfer (n = 0 to 5)
(a) EPniPKTE Bits of UTRG (n = 0 to 5)
Note that 1 is not automatically written to EPniPKTE in case of auto-request transfer. Always
write 1 to EPniPKTE by the CPU. The following example shows when 150-byte data is
transmitted from EP2i to the host. In this case, 1 should be written to EP2iPKTE three times as
shown in figure 15.27.
(b) EP2i DMA Transfer Procedure
The DMAC transfer unit should be one packet. Therefore, set the number of transfers so that it is
equal to or less than the maximum packet size of each endpoint.
1. Confirm that UIFR1/EP2iEMPTY flag is 1.
2. DMAC settings for EP2i data transfer (such as auto-request and address setting).
3. Set the number of transfers for 64 bytes (the maximum packet size or less) in the DMAC.
4. Activate the DMAC (write 1 to DTE after reading DTE as 0).
5. DMA transfer.
6. Write 1 to the UTRG0/EP2iPKTE bit after the DMA transfer is completed.
7. Repeat steps 1 to 6 above.
8. Confirm that UIFR1/EP2iEMPTY flag is 1.
9. Set the number of transfer for 22 bytes in the DMAC.
10. Activate the DMAC (write 1 to DTE after reading DTE as 0).
11. DMA transfer.
12. Write 1 to the UTRG0/EP2iPKTE bit after the DMA transfer is completed.
Page 580 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
64 bytes
64 bytes
Write 1 to
EP2iPKTE
22 bytes
Write 1 to
EP2iPKTE
Write 1 to
EP2iPKTE
Figure 15.27 EP2iPKTE Operation in UTRG0 (Auto-Request)
(4) EPno DMA Transfer (n = 0, 2, 4)
(a) EPnoRDFN Bits of UTRG (n = 0, 2, 4)
Note that 1 is not automatically written to EPnoRDFN in case of auto-request transfer. Always
write 1 to EPnoRDFN by the CPU. The following example shows when EP2o receives 150-byte
data from the host. In this case, 1 should be written to EP2oRDFN three times as shown in figure
15.28.
(b) EP2o DMA Transfer Procedure
The DMAC transfer unit should be one packet. Therefore, set the number of transfers so that it is
equal to or less than the maximum packet size of each endpoint.
1. Wait for the UIFR1/EP2oREADY flag to be set.
2. DMAC settings for EP2o data transfer (such as auto-request and address setting). Read value
of UESZ2o and specify number of transfers to match size of received data (64 bytes or less).
3. Activate the DMAC (write 1 to DTE after reading DTE as 0).
4. DMA transfer (transfer of 64 bytes or less).
5. Write 1 to the UTRG0/EP2oRDFN bit after the DMA transfer is completed.
6. Repeat steps 1 to 5 above.
64 bytes
64 bytes
Write 1 to
EP2oRDFN
22 bytes
Write 1 to
EP2oRDFN
Write 1 to
EP2oRDFN
Figure 15.28 EP2oRDFN Operation in UTRG0 (Auto-Request)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 581 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.7
Endpoint Configuration Example
Figure 15.29 shows an example of endpoint configuration. EPINFO data for the endpoint
configuration shown in figure 15.29 is shown in table 15.9. In this example, two endpoints are not
used. However, note that to load all EPINFO data from UEP1R00_0 to UEPIR22_4, dummy data
must be written to the unused endpoints. An example of dummy data is also shown in table 15.9.
Configuration 1
InterfaceNumber 0
AlternateSetting 0
InterfaceNumber 1
AlternateSetting 0
EP0 Control(in,out) 64 bytes
EP1 Bulk(out) 64 bytes
EP2 Bulk(in) 64 bytes
EP3 Interrupt(in) 32 bytes
EP4 Interrupt(in) 64 bytes
EP5 Bulk(in) 64 bytes
EP6 Bulk(out) 64 bytes
Unused EP
Unused EP
Figure 15.29 Endpoint Configuration Example
If endpoints are configured as shown in figure 15.27, some register names change as shown in
table 15.7. In addition, some register bit names also change as shown in table 15.8. In the example
shown in figure 15.27, register or bit names are modified for those determined based on the
Bluetooth standard as follows: EP1i→EP3, EP2i→EP2, EP2o→EP1, EP4i→EP5, EP4o→EP6,
and EP5i→EP4.
Page 582 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.7 Register Name Modification List
Register
Name Based
on Bluetooth
Standard
Modified Register Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value Address
UEDR1i
USB endpoint data register 3
(For Interrupt_in data transfer)
UEDR3
W
H'00
H'C0009C to 8
H'C0009F
UEDR2i
USB endpoint data register 2
(For Bulk_in data transfer)
UEDR2
W
H'00
H'C000A0 to 8
H'C000A3
UEDR2o
USB endpoint data register 1
(For Bulk_out data transfer)
UEDR1
R
Undefined
H'C000A4 to 8
H'C000A7
UEDR3i
Reserved register
(For Isochronous_in data transfer)*
(UEDRn)* W
H'00
H'C000A8 to 8
H'C000AB
UEDR3o
Reserved register
(For Isochronous_out data transfer)*
(UEDRn)* R
Undefined
H'C000AC to 8
H'C000AF
UEDR4i
USB endpoint data register 5
(For Bulk_in data transfer)
UEDR5
W
H'00
H'C000B0 to 8
H'C000B3
UEDR4o
USB endpoint data register 6
(For Bulk_out data transfer)
UEDR6
R
Undefined
H'C000B4 to 8
H'C000B7
UEDR5i
USB endpoint data register 4
(For Interrupt_in data transfer)
UEDR4
W
H'00
H'C000B8 to 8
H'C000BB
USEZ2o
USB endpoint receive data size
UESZ1
register 1 (For Bulk_out data transfer)
R
Undefined
H'C000BD
8
USEZ3o
Reserved register
(For Isochronous_out data transfer)*
(UESZn)* R
Undefined
H'C000BE
8
USEZ4o
USB endpoint receive data size
UESZ6
register 6 (For Bulk_out data transfer)
Undefined
H'C000BF
8
Note:
*
Registers related to unused endpoints are handled as reserved registers.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
R
Access
Width
Page 583 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.8 Bit Name Modification List
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Address
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
UDMAR
R/W
H'00
H'C00082
EP6T1
EP6T0
EP5T1
EP5T0
EP1T1
EP1T0
EP2T1
EP2T0
UTRG0
W
H'00
H'C00084
—
—
EP1RDFN
EP2PKTE
EP3PKTE
EP0o
RDFN
EP0iPKTE
EP0s
RDFN
UTRG1
W
H'00
H'C00085
—
—
—
—
—
EP4PKTE
EP6RDFN
EP5PKTE
UFCLR0
W
H'00
H'C00086
(EPnCLR)
(EPnCLR)
EP1CLR
EP2CLR
EP3CLR
EP0oCLR
EP0iCLR
—
UFCLR1
W
H'00
H'C00087
—
—
—
—
—
EP4CLR
EP6CLR
EP5CLR
UESTL0
R/W
H'00
H'C00088
(EPnSTL)
(EPnSTL)
EP1STL
EP2STL
EP3STL
—
—
EP0STL
EP5STL
UESTL1
R/W
H'00
H'C00089
SCME
—
—
—
—
EP4STL
EP6STL
UIFR0
R/W
H'00
H'C000C0
BRST
—
EP3TR
EP3TS
EP0oTS
EP0iTR
EP0iTS
SetupTS
UIFR1
R/W
H'01*1
H'C000C1
(EPnTF)
(EPnTS)
(EPnTF)
(EPnTR)
*2
EP1
READY
EP2TR
EP2
EMPTY
EP6
READY
EP5TR
EP5
EMPTY
or
H'09
UIFR2
R/W
H'01*1
EP2ALL
EMPTY
H'C000C2
—
—
EP4TR
EP4TS
or
H'09
UIER0
UIER1
R/W
R/W
H'00
H'00
*2
EP5ALL
EMPTY
H'C000C4
H'C000C5
BRSTE
(EPnTFE)
—
(EPnTSE)
EP3TRE
(EPnTFE)
EP3TSE
EP0oTSE
EP0iTRE
EP0iTSE
SetupTSE
(EPnTRE)
*2
EP1
READYE
EP2TRE
EP2
EMPTYE
EP6
READYE
EP5TRE
EP5
EMPTYE
EP2ALL
EMPTYE
UIER2
R/W
H'00
H'C000C6
—
—
EP4TRE
EP4TSE
*2
EP5ALL
EMPTYE
UISR0
UISR1
R/W
R/W
H'00
H'00
H'C000C8
H'C000C9
BRSTS
(EPnTFS)
—
(EPnTSS)
EP3TRS
(EPnTFS)
EP3TSS
EP0oTSS
EP0iTRS
EP0iTSS
SetupTSS
(EPnTRS)
*2
EP1
READYS
EP2TRS
EP2
EMPTYS
EP6
READYS
EP5TRS
EP5
EMPTYS
EP2DE
EP3DE
EP0iDE
EP2ALL
EMPTYS
UISR2
R/W
H'00
H'C000CA
—
—
EP4TRS
EP4TSS
*2
EP5ALL
EMPTYS
UDSR
R
H'00
H'C000CC
—
—
EP4DE
EP5DE
—
Notes: 1. H'01 in H8S/2215. H'09 in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
2. Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C. “⎯” in H8S/2215.
Table 15.9 shows the EPINFO data for the endpoint configuration shown in figure 15.27.
This USB module is optimized by the hardware specific to the transfer type. Accordingly,
endpoints cannot be configured completely freely. Endpoint configuration can be modified within
the restriction as shown in table 15.9 (data indicated within parentheses [ ]), data other than that
within parentheses [ ] must be specified the value shown in table 15.9. For unused endpoints,
dummy data (0) must be written.
Page 584 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Table 15.9 EPINFO Data Settings
EPINFO Data Settings Based on Bluetooth Standard
Register
No. Name
1
2
Address
Corresponding UEPIRn_0 to
Transfer Mode*1 UEPIRn_4 Settings*2
UEPIR00_0 to H'C00000 to Specific to
B'0000_00_00_000_00_0_
UEPIR00_4
0001000000_0000000000000000
H'C0004
Control transfer
UEPIR01_0 to H'C00005 to Specific to
B'[0011]_01_[00]_[000]_11_1_
UEPIR01_4
3
[0000100000]_0000000000000001*
H'C0009
Interrupt in
UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI
Rn_0 Rn_1 Rn_2 Rn_3 Rn_4
H'00
H'00
H'40
H'00
H'00
H'34
H'1C H'20
H'00
H'01
H'24
H'14
H'40
H'00
H'02
H'14
H'10
H'40
H'00
H'03
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'04
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'05
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'06
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'07
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'08
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'09
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'0A
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'0B
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'0C
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'0D
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'0E
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'0F
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'10
transfer
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
UEPIR02_0 to H'C0000A to Specific to Bulk
B'[0010]_01_[00]_[000]_10_1_
UEPIR02_4
4
[0001000000]_0000000000000010*
H'C000E
in transfer
UEPIR03_0 to H'C0000F to Specific to Bulk
B'[0001]_01_[00]_[000]_10_0
UEPIR03_4
4
[0001000000]_0000000000000011*
H'C0013
out transfer
UEPIR04_0 to H'C00014 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR04_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000000100* *
H'C0018
in transfer
UEPIR05_0 to H'C00019 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR05_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000000101* *
H'C001D
out transfer
UEPIR06_0 to H'C0001E to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR06_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000000110* *
H'C0022
in transfer
UEPIR07_0 to H'C00023 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR07_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000000111* *
H'C0027
out transfer
UEPIR08_0 to H'C00028 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR08_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001000* *
H'C002C
in transfer
UEPIR09_0 to H'C0002D to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR09_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001001* *
H'C0031
out transfer
UEPIR10_0 to H'C00032 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR10_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001010* *
H'C0036
in transfer
UEPIR11_0 to H'C00037 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR11_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001011* *
H'C003B
out transfer
UEPIR12_0 to H'C0003C to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR12_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001100* *
H'C0040
in transfer
UEPIR13_0 to H'C00041 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR13_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001101* *
H'C0045
out transfer
UEPIR14_0 to H'C00046 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR14_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001110* *
H'C004A
in transfer
UEPIR15_0 to H'C0004B to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR15_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000001111* *
H'C004F
out transfer
UEPIR16_0 to H'C00050 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR16_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000010000* *
H'C0054
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
in transfer
Page 585 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
EPINFO Data Settings Based on Bluetooth Standard
Register
No. Name
18
19
20
21
22
23
Address
Corresponding UEPIRn_0 to
Transfer Mode*1 UEPIRn_4 Settings*2
UEPIR17_0 to H'C00055 to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR17_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000010001* *
H'C0059
out transfer
UEPIR18_0 to H'C0005A to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_1_
UEPIR18_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000010010* *
H'C005E
in transfer
UEPIR19_0 to H'C0005F to Specific to Isoch
B'[0000]_01_[00]_[000]_01_0_
UEPIR19_4
5 6
[0000000000]_0000000000010011* *
H'C0063
out transfer
UEPIR20_0 to H'C00064 to Specific to Bulk
B'[0101]_01_[01]_[000]_10_1_
UEPIR20_4
4
[0001000000]_0000000000010100*
H'C0068
in transfer
UEPIR21_0 to H'C00069 to Specific to Bulk
B'[0110]_01_[01]_[000]_10_0_
UEPIR21_4
4
[0001000000]_0000000000010101*
H'C006D
out transfer
UEPIR22_0 to H'C0006E to Specific to
B'[0100]_01_[01]_[000]_11_1_
UEPIR22_4
3
[0001000000]_0000000000010110*
H'C0072
Interrupt in
UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI UEPI
Rn_0 Rn_1 Rn_2 Rn_3 Rn_4
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'11
H'04
H'0C H'00
H'00
H'12
H'04
H'08
H'00
H'00
H'13
H'55
H'14
H'40
H'00
H'14
H'65
H'10
H'40
H'00
H'15
H'45
H'1C H'40
H'00
H'16
transfer
Notes: 1. Each endpoint is optimized by the hardware specific for the transfer mode. The transfer
mode shown in table 15.8 must be specified. (D28 and D27 for all EPINFO data items
must e specified as shown in table 15.8.)
2. Data indicated within parentheses [ ] can be modified. Data other than that within
parentheses [ ] must be specified as shown in table 15.8.
3. Maximum packet size of Interrupt transfer must be from 0 to 64.
4. Maximum packet size of Bulk transfer must be 64 when used or 0 when unused.
5. Maximum packet size of Isochronous transfer must be from 0 to 128. Endpoint number
of Isochronous_in can differ from that of Isochronous_out. However, note that endpoint
numbers of all Isochronous_in must be the same. Endpoint numbers of all
Isochronous_out must also be the same.
6. Maximum packet size of the unused endpoint must be 0.
Page 586 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.8
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB External Circuit Example
Figures 15.30 and 15.31 show the USB external circuit examples when the on-chip transceiver is
used. Figures 15.32 and 15.33 show the USB external circuit examples when an external
transceiver is used.
USB
Internal transceiver
*3
Pxx
VCC
*4 DrVCC
(P36) (3.3 V) VBUS (3.3 V)
USD+
VCC
(3.3 V)
Regulator *1
USD-
24 Ω
DrVSS
24 Ω
VSS
UBPM
0: Bus-powered mode
VCC
*2
Pull-up
control external
circuit for
full speed
D+
1.5 kΩ
DGND
VBUS
(5 V)
USB connector
Notes: 1. Step-down to the operating voltage VCC (3.3 V) of this LSI.
2. To protect the LSI, voltage applicable IC such as HD74LV-A series must be used
even when the system power is turned off.
3. In HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, HD64F2215T, HD6432215B, and HD6432215C,
Pxx should be assigned to an output port as the D+ pull-up control pin.
In HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU, in which on-chip ROM can be
programmed by using the USB, P36 should be used as the D+ pull-up control pin.
4. Steps should be taken prevent noise from affecting the VBUS terminal during USB communications.
Figure 15.30 USB External Circuit in Bus-Powered Mode
(When On-Chip Transceiver Is Used)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 587 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
USB
Internal transceiver
*3
Pxx VCC
*2
*4 DrVCC
(P36)(3.3 V) IRQx VBUS (3.3 V) USD+ USD-
DrVSS
VSS
UBPM
VCC
VCC
3.3 V
24 Ω
24 Ω
1: Self-powered mode
*1
VCC
*1
1.5 kΩ
Pull-up control
external circuit
for full speed
VBUS D+
(5 V)
D-
GND
USB connector
Notes: 1. To protect the LSI, voltage applicable IC such as HD74LV-A series must be used
even when the system power is turned off.
2. To cancel software standby state by detecting the USB cable disconnection, the level
shifter signal must also be connected to the IRQx pin. Note that the software standby
state cannot be canceled by the USB interrupt EXIRQx.
3. In HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, HD64F2215T, HD6432215B, and HD6432215C,
Pxx should be assigned to an output port as the D+ pull-up control pin.
In HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU, in which on-chip ROM can be
programmed by using the USB, P36 should be used as the D+ pull-up control pin.
4. Steps should be taken prevent noise from affecting the VBUS terminal during USB communications.
Figure 15.31 USB External Circuit in Self-Powered Mode
(When On-Chip Transceiver Is Used)
Page 588 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
P17
SUSPND
PA3
SPEED
P15
DrVSS
VSS
UBPM
VCC
OE
P13
FSE0
VPO
VM
RCV
VP
P12
P11
*3
Pxx
VCC
*4 DrVCC
(P36) (3.3 V) VBUS (3.3 V)
P10
USB
D-
MODE
D+
GND
VCC
External transceiver
(ISP1104 manufactured by NXP)
VCC
(3.3 V)
Regulator
*1
Rs
0: Bus-powered mode
Rs
VCC
D+
*2
1.5 kΩ
Pull-up control
external circuit
for full speed
DGND
VBUS
(5 V)
USB connector
Notes: 1. Step-down to the operating voltage VCC (3.3 V) of this LSI.
2. To protect the LSI, voltage applicable IC such as HD74LV-A series must be used
even when the system power is turned off.
3. In HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, HD64F2215T, HD6432215B, and HD6432215C,
Pxx should be assigned to an output port as the D+ pull-up control pin.
In HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU, in which on-chip ROM can be
programmed by using the USB, P36 should be used as the D+ pull-up control pin.
4. Steps should be taken prevent noise from affecting the VBUS terminal during USB communications.
Figure 15.32 USB External Circuit in Bus-Powered Mode
(When External Transceiver Is Used)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 589 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
P17
SUSPND
PA3
SPEED
P15
DrVSS
VSS
UBPM
VCC
OE
P13
FSE0
P10
VPO
VM
RCV
VP
*3
Pxx VCC
*2
*4 DrVCC
(P36)(3.3 V) IRQx VBUS (3.3 V)
P12
P11
USB
*1
D-
Rs
MODE
D+
GND
VCC
VCC
3.3 V
External transceiver
(ISP1104 manufactured by NXP)
VCC
1: Self-powered mode
Rs
VCC
*1
1.5 kΩ
Pull-up control
external circuit
for full speed
D+
D-
VBUS
(5 V)
GND
USB connector
Notes: 1. To protect the LSI, voltage applicable IC such as HD74LV-A series must be used
even when the system power is turned off.
2. To cancel software standby state by detecting the USB cable disconnection, the VBUS
signal must also be connected to the IRQx pin (Note that the software standby
state cannot be canceled by the USB internal interrupt EXIRQx).
3. In HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, HD64F2215T, HD6432215B, and HD6432215C,
Pxx should be assigned to an output port as the D+ pull-up control pin.
In HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU, in which on-chip ROM can be
programmed by using the USB, P36 should be used as the D+ pull-up control pin.
4. Steps should be taken prevent noise from affecting the VBUS terminal during USB communications.
Figure 15.33 USB External Circuit in Self-Powered Mode
(When External Transceiver Is Used)
Page 590 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.9
Usage Notes
15.9.1
Operating Frequency
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
• In H8S/2215
When the on-chip PLL circuit is used, the system clock of this LSI must be 16 MHz. This 16MHz system clock, used as base clock, is tripled in the on-chip PLL circuit to generate the 48MHz USB operating clock. When the USB operating clock (48 MHz) oscillator or 48-MHz
external clock is used, the system clock of the LSI must be 13-MHz to 16-MHz. Mediumspeed mode is not supported; use full-speed mode.
• In H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C
When the on-chip PLL circuit is used, the system clock of this LSI must be 16 MHz or 24
MHz. If the system clock frequency is 16 MHz, it is tripled by the on-chip PLL circuit, and if
the system clock frequency is 25 MHz, it is doubled, to generate the 48-MHz USB operating
clock. When the USB operating clock (48 MHz) oscillator or 48-MHz external clock is used,
the system clock of the LSI must be 13 MHz to 24 MHz*. Medium-speed mode is not
supported; use full-speed mode.
Note: * On the H8S/2215T, use a 16-MHz or 24-MHz system clock for the MCU, even if a 48MHz oscillator or 48-MHz external clock is used as the USB operation clock. For the
H8S/2215C, use a MCU system clock in the range of 16 MHz to 24 MHz.
15.9.2
Bus Interface
This module’s interface is based on the bus specifications of external area 6. Before accessing the
USB, area 6 must be specified as having an 8-bit bus width and 3-state access using the bus
controller register. In mode 7 (single-chip mode), the USB module cannot be accessed. In mode 6
(internal ROM enabled mode), CS6 and A7 to A0 pins are used as inputs at initialization and USB
cannot be accessed. Before access to this module, set P72DDR to 1 and PC7DDR to PC0DDR to
H'FF, respectively, to use CS6 and A7 to A0 pins as outputs. In mode 4 or 5 (on-chip ROM
disabled mode), set P72DDR to 1 to use the CS6 pin as an output.
15.9.3
Setup Data Reception
The following must be noted for the EP0s FIFO used to receive 8-byte setup data. The USB is
designed to always receive setup commands. Accordingly, write from the UDC has higher priority
than read from the LSI. If the reception of the next setup command starts while the is LSI reading
data after completing reception, this data read from the LSI is forcibly cancelled and the next setup
command write starts. After the next setup command write, data read from the LSI is thus
undefined. Read operation is forcibly disabled because data cannot be guaranteed if DP-RAM
used as FIFO accesses the same address for write and read.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 591 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.9.4
FIFO Clear
If the USB cable is disconnected during communication, old data may be contained in the FIFO.
Accordingly, FIFO must be cleared immediately after USB cable connection. In addition, after bus
reset, all FIFO must also be cleared. Note, however, that FIFOs that are currently used for data
transfer to or from the host must not be cleared.
15.9.5
IRQ6 Interrupt
A suspend/resume interrupt requested by IRQ6 must be specified as falling-edge sensitive.
15.9.6
Data Register Overread or Overwrite
When the CPU reads or writes to data registers, the following must be noted:
• Transmit data registers (UEDR0i, UEDR1i, UEDR2i, UEDR3i, UEDR4i, UEDR5i)
Data to be written to the transmit data registers must be within the maximum packet size. For
the transmit data registers of EP2i, EP3i, and EP4i having a dual-FIFO configuration, data to
be written at any time must be within the maximum packet size. In this case, after a data write,
the FIFO is switched to the other FIFO, enabling an further data write when the PKTE bit of
UTRG is set to 1 (in EP3i, the same operation is automatically performed when the SOF
packet is received). Accordingly, data of size corresponding to two FIFO must not be written
to the transmit data registers of EP2i, EP3i, and EP4i at a time.
• Receive data registers (UEDR0o, UEDR2o, UEDR3o, UEDR4o)
Receive data registers must not read a data size that is greater than the effective size of the read
data item. In other words, receive data registers must not read data with data size larger than
that specified by the receive data size register. For the receive data registers of EP2o, EP3o,
and EP4o having a dual-FIFO configuration, data to be read at any time must be within the
maximum packet size. In this case, after reading the currently selected FIFO, set the RDFN bit
of UTRG to 1 (in EP3o, the same operation is automatically performed when the SOF packet
is received). This switches the FIFO to the other FIFO and updates the receive data size,
enabling the next data read. In addition, if there is no receive data in a FIFO, data must not be
read. Otherwise, the pointer that controls the internal module FIFO is updated and correct
operation cannot be guaranteed.
Page 592 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.9.7
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
EP3o Isochronous Transfer
• Reception of EP3o data larger than the maximum packet size
The EP3o data FIFO cannot receive data with size larger than the maximum packet size; the
excessive data is lost. In this case, the receive size register 3o (UESZ3o) can count up to the
maximum packet size and the EP3o abnormal transfer flag (EP3oTF) is set to 1.
Figure 15.34 shows the 10-byte data reception when the maximum packet size is specified as 9
bytes.
EP3o FIFO
Data (1)
Data (2)
Data (3)
Data (4)
Data (5)
Data (6)
Data (7)
Data (8)
Data (9)
Data (10)
Data storage
Data (1)
Data (2)
Data (3)
Data (4)
Data (5)
Data (6)
Data (7)
Data (8)
Data (9)
UESZ3o
H'09
Count up to maximum
packet size
UIFR1/EP3oTF
1
Set the EP3o abnormal
transfer flag
Store data items within the
maximum packet size
Exessive data items are lost
Figure 15.34 10-Byte Data Reception
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 593 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
• EP3o receive data and status bit reading
As shown in figure 15.35, FIFO are switched on SOF packet reception. FIFOs thus store the
latest data. Accordingly, receive data sent from the host in frame [N] can only be read in frame
[N+1]. In addition, the EP3oTF and EP3oTS status bits of UIFR1 are automatically switched
on with each SOF packet reception; the EP3oTF and EP3oTS status in frame [N] can only be
read in frame [N + 1].
[In frame N]
EP3o FIFO A
Data (1)
Receive USB
data (1)
EP3o FIFO B
—
Internal flag (A-side)
TF TS
Modify
UIFR1
No change
— —
Internal flag (B-side)
— —
Next frame
[In frame N + 1]
EP3o FIFO A
Data (1)
Receive USB
data (2)
EP3o FIFO B
Data (2)
Internal flag (A-side)
TF TS
UIFR1
A-side flag update
TF TS Can be read
Internal flag (B-side)
Data (1) can be read in
TF TS
Modify frame [N + 1]
Next frame
[In frame N + 2]
EP3o FIFO A
Data (3)
Receive USB
data (3)
EP3o FIFO B
Data (2)
Internal flag (A-side)
TF TS
UIFR1
Modify
B-side flag update
TF TS Can be read
Internal flag (B-side)
TF TS
Data (2) can only be read in
frame [N + 2]
Figure 15.35 EP3o Data Reception
Page 594 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
15.9.8
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Reset
• A manual reset should not be performed during USB communication as the LSI will stop with
the USD+, USD- pin state maintained. This USB module uses synchronous reset for some
registers. The reset state of these registers must be cancelled after the clock oscillation
stabilization time has passed. At initialization, reset must be cancelled using the following
procedure:
1. Select the USB operating clock: Specify the UCKS3 to UCKS0 bits in UCTLR.
2. Cancel the USB module stop mode: Clear the MSTPB0 bit in MSTPCRB to 0.
3. Wait for the USB clock stabilization time: Wait until the CK48READY bit in UIFR3 is set
to 1.
4. Cancel the USB interface reset state: Clear the UIFRST bit in UCTLR to 0.
5. Cancel the UDC core reset state: Clear the UDCRST bit in UCTLR to 0.
For detail, see the flowcharts in section 15.5.1, Initialization, and section 15.5.2, USB Cable
Connection/Disconnection.
• The USB registers are not initialized when the watchdog timer (WDT) triggers a power-on
reset. Therefore, the USB may not operate properly after a power-on reset is triggered by the
WDT due to CPU runaway or a similar cause. (If a power-on reset is triggered by input of a
power-on reset signal from the RES pin, the USB registers are initialized and there is no
problem.) Consequently, an initialization routine should be used to write the initial values
listed below to the following three registers, thereby ensuring that all the USB registers are
properly initialized, immediately following a reset.
UCTLR = H'03, UIER3 = H'80, UIFR3 = H'00
15.9.9
EP0 Interrupt Assignment
EP0 interrupt sources assigned to bits 3 to 0 in UIFR0 must be assigned to the same interrupt sign
(EXIRQx) by setting UISR0. There are no other restrictions on EP0 interrupt sources.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 595 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
H8S/2215 Group
15.9.10 Level Shifter for VBUS and IRQx Pins
The VBUS and IRQx pins of this USB module must be connected to the USB connector’s VBUS
pin via a level shifter. This is because the USB module has a circuit that operates by detecting
USB cable connection or disconnection.
Even if the power of the device incorporating this USB module is turned off, 5-V power is applied
to the USB connector’s VBUS pin while the USB cable is connected to the device set. To protect
the LSI from destruction, use a level shifter such as the HD74LV-A series, which allows voltage
application to the pin even when the power is off.
15.9.11 Read and Write to USB Endpoint Data Register
To write data to an USB endpoint data register (UEDRni) on the transmit side using a CPU word
or longword transfer instruction, the correct size of data must be written to the USB endpoint data
register. Otherwise, an error may occur.
For example, when 7-byte data is transferred to the host, 8-byte data is sent to the host if data is
written twice by the longword transfer instructions or if data is written four times by the word
transfer instructions. To write 7-byte data correctly, data must be written once by a longword
transfer instruction, once by a word transfer instruction, and once by a byte transfer instruction, or
data must be written three times by a word transfer instruction and once by a byte transfer
instruction.
To read data from the USB endpoint data register (UEDRno) on the receive side, the correct size
of data must be read. In this case, the data size is specified by the USB endpoint receive size data
register (UESZno).
To execute DMA transfer on data in the USB endpoint data register using the on-chip DMAC,
byte transfer musts be used. In word transfer, odd-byte data cannot be transferred. Word transfer is
thus disabled.
15.9.12 Restrictions for Software Standby Mode Transition
Before entering the software standby mode, disabled the SOF marker function and set the USB
module stop state as shown in figure 15.34. The UDC core must not be reset.
To access the USB module after software standby mode, cancel the USB module stop state and
wait for the USB operating clock (48 MHz) stabilization time as shown in figure 15.34.
Page 596 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
Procedure to enter software standby mode
(1)
Specify IRQ6 to falling edge sensitive
(Set IRQ6E in IER to 1)
(Write IRQ6SCB and A in ISCRH to 01)
(2)
Detect USB bus suspend state
USPND pin = High
(3)
IRQ6 = Low (falling edge output)
Set IRQ6F in ISR to 1
Set SPRSi and SPRSs in UIFR3 to 1
(4)
Confirm SPRSs in UIFR3 as 1
Clear IRQ6E in IER to 0*
Clear SPRSi in UIFR3 to 0
Clear SFME in UCTLR to 0
Procedure to cancel software standby mode
(10)
Detect USB bus resume
USPND pin = Low
(11)
IRQ6 = Low (falling edge output)
Set IRQ6F in ISR to 1
(12)
(13)
Cancel software standby mode
Wait for system clock stabilization time
(For external clock: 16 states min)
(For crystal oscillator clock: 4 ms min)
Enter active mode
(LSI internal clock starts oscillation)
(14)
(5)
IRQ6 = High
(6)
Enter USB module stop state
(Stop MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB to 1)
(7)
All USB module internal clocks stop
(8)
Mask all interrupts with LDC instruction, etc.*
Set IRQ6E in IER to 1*
Unmask all interrupts with LDC instruction, etc.*
Enter software standby mode*
(Execute SLEEP instruction)
(9)
All LSI clocks stop
Guide to Flowchart Figures
: Indicates operations to be done
by firmware.
: Indicates operations to be
automatically done by hardware
in this LSI.
(15)
(16)
(17)
Cancel USB module stop mode
(Clear MSTPB0 in MSTPCRB to 0)
USB module internal clock operation starts
Wait 2 ms for USB operation clock to stabilize
(Wait for CK48READY in UIFR3 is set to 1)
(18)
Set SPRSi in UIFR3 to 1
Clear SPRSs in UIFR3 to 0
(19)
Clear SPRSi in UIFR3 to 0
(20)
IRQ6 = High
(21)
(22)
Set CK48READY in UIFR3 to 1
(USB operating clock stabilized)
(23)
(24)
Detect SOF packet
Set SOF in UIFR3 to 1
(25)
Set SFME in UCTLR to 1
USB communication operations can be
restarted by using several USB registers
Note: * Interrupts should be masked from when the IRQ6 interrupt is received until the SLEEP instruction is executed.
Finally, unmask the interrupts using the LDC instruction or the like and execute the SLEEP instruction immediately
afterward.
Figure 15.36 Transition to and from Software Standby Mode
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 597 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
(1)
USB bus state
Normal
(10)
(2)
USPND
IRQ6
(23)
SOF
Resume → Normal
Suspend
(10)
(3)
(5)
(11)
ISR/IRQ6F
(3)
(4)
(11)
UIFR3/SPRSi
(3)
(4)
(18)
(19)
UIFR3/SPRSs
(3)
(4)
(18)
(19)
(20)
(14)
UIFR3/SOF
(24)
UCTLR/SFME
(4)
USB module
stop
(6)
Standby mode
(25)
(15)
(8)
(12)
System clock
(16 MHz)
(9)
φ (16 MHz)
(9)
USB internal clock
(16 MHz)
(13)
(14)
(7)
(16)
UIFR3/
CK48READY
(21)
CLK48 (48 MHz)
(7)
USB operating clock
(48 MHz)
(7)
(17)
(22)
Software
standby mode
4 ms wait
for oscillator
to stabilize
2 ms wait for
USB operation
clock to stabilize
USB operation resumes
USB module stop state
Figure 15.37 USB Software Standby Mode Transition Timing
15.9.13 USB External Circuit Example
The USB external circuit examples are used for reference only. In actual board design, carefully
check the system operation. In addition, the USB external circuits examples cannot guarantee
correct system operation. The user must individually take measures against external surges or ESD
noise by incorporating protective diodes or other components if necessary.
Page 598 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
15.9.14 Pin Processing when USB Not Used
Pin processing should be performed as follows.
DrVCC = Vcc, DrVSS = 0 V, USD+ = USD- = USPND = open state, VBUS = UBPM = 0 V
15.9.15 Notes on Emulator Usage
Using the I/O register window function, or the like, to display UEDR0o, UEDR2o, UEDR3o, and
UEDR4o can cause the EP0oFIFO, EP2oFIFO, EP3oFIFO, and EP4oFIFO read pointers to
malfunction, preventing UEDR0o to UEDR4o and UESZ0o to UESZ4o from being read correctly.
Therefore, UEDR0o to UEDR4o should not be displayed.
15.9.16 Notes on TR Interrupt
Note the following when using the transfer request interrupt (TR interrupt) for IN transfer to EP0i,
EP2i, EP3i, EP4i, or EP5i.
The TR interrupt flag is set if the FIFO for the target EP has no data when the IN token is sent
from the USB host. However, at the timing shown in figure 15.38, multiple TR interrupts occur
successively. Take appropriate measures against malfunction in such a case.
Note: This module determines whether to return NAK if the FIFO of the target EP has no data
when receiving the IN token, but the TR interrupt flag is set only after a NAK handshake
is sent. If the next IN token is sent before PKTE of UTRGx is written to, the TR interrupt
flag is set again.
TR interrupt routine
CPU
Host
TR interrupt routine
Clear
Writes
TR flag transmit data
UTRGx/
PKTE
IN token
IN token
Determines whether
to return NAK
Determines whether
to return NAK
USB
NAK
IN token
Transmits data
NAK
Sets TR flag
Sets TR flag
(Sets the flag again)
ACK
Figure 15.38 TR Interrupt Flag Set Timing
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 599 of 846
Section 15 Universal Serial Bus Interface (USB)
H8S/2215 Group
15.9.17 Notes on UIFRO
The bit-clear instruction cannot be used to clear a flag in some USB interrupt flag registers to 0.
These registers have flags which are cleared to 0 by writing 0 and to which writing 1 is ignored.
The concerning registers are USB interrupt flag registers 0 to 3 (UIFR0 to UIFR3) in the
H8S/2215 Group.
A single bit-clear instruction actually executes reading the value of a register, modifying the read
value, and writing the modified value. When clearing a flag with the bit-clear instruction, if a
source which will set another flag is activated between reading and writing, the flag is
unintentionally cleared to 0. Therefore, the bit-clear instruction cannot be used.
To clear these flags, write 0 to a flag which should be cleared and write 1 to other flags with the
MOVE instruction. For example, to clear only bit 7, write H'7F and to clear bits 6 and 7, write
H'3F.
15.9.18 Clearing the FIFOs in DMA Transfer Mode
When DMA transfers are enabled at endpoints 2 and 4, it is not possible to clear the EP2o
OUTFIFO and EP4o OUTFIFO. To clear the FIFOs, first disable DMA transfers.
Page 600 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
Section 16 A/D Converter
This LSI includes a successive approximation type 10-bit A/D converter that allows up to six
analog input channels to be selected. The block diagram of the A/D converter is shown in figure
16.1.
16.1
Features
• 10-bit resolution
• Six input channels
• Conversion time: 8.1 µs per channel (at 16-MHz operation), 10.7 µs per channel (at 24-MHz
operation)*
Note: * Available only in H8S/2215R, H8S/2215T and H8S/2215C.
• Two operating modes
⎯ Single mode: Single-channel A/D conversion
⎯ Scan mode: Continuous A/D conversion on 1 to 4 channels
• Four data registers
⎯ Conversion results are held in a 16-bit data register for each channel
• Sample and hold function
• Three methods conversion start
⎯ Software
⎯ Timer (TPU or TMR) conversion start trigger
⎯ External trigger signal (ADTRG)
• Interrupt request
⎯ An A/D conversion end interrupt request (ADI) can be generated
• Module stop mode can be set
• Settable analog conversion voltage range
Analog conversion voltage range settable using the reference voltage pin (Vref) as the
reference voltage
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 601 of 846
ADCMS34A_000120020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
AVCC
Module data bus
Bus interface
Successive approximation register
10 bit D/A
Vref
Internal data bus
A
D
D
R
A
A
D
D
R
B
A
D
D
R
C
A
D
D
R
D
A
D
C
S
R
A
D
C
R
+
AN0
AN2
AN3
AN14
AN15
φ/2
Multiplexer
AN1
Comparator
Control circuit
Sample and
hold circuit
φ/4
φ/8
φ/16
ADI interrupt signal
Time conversion start trigger
from TPU or 8 bit timer
ADTRG
Off during A/D conversion standby
On during A/D conversion
AVSS
Legend:
ADCR:
ADCSR:
ADDRA:
ADDRB:
ADDRC:
ADDRD:
A/D control register
A/D control/status register
A/D data register A
A/D data register B
A/D data register C
A/D data register D
Figure 16.1 Block Diagram of A/D Converter
Page 602 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
16.2
Section 16 A/D Converter
Input/Output Pins
Table 16.1 summarizes the input pins used by the A/D converter. The AN0 to AN3 and AN14 to
AN15 pins are analog input pins. The AVCC and AVSS pins are the power supply pins for the
analog block in the A/D converter. The Vref pin is the reference voltage pin for the A/D
conversion.
Table 16.1 Pin Configuration
Pin Name
Symbol
I/O
Function
Analog power supply pin
AVCC
Input
Analog block power supply and
reference voltage
Analog ground pin
AVSS
Input
Analog block ground and reference
voltage
Analog reference voltage pin
Vref
Input
Reference voltage pin for the A/D
Analog input pin 0
AN0*
Input
Analog input pins
Analog input pin 1
AN1*
Input
Analog input pin 2
AN2
Input
Analog input pin 3
AN3
Input
Analog input pin 14
AN14
Input
Analog input pin 15
AN15
Input
A/D external trigger input pin
ADTRG
Input
Note:
16.3
External trigger input pin for starting A/D
conversion
AN0 and AN1 can be used only when Vcc = AVcc.
*
Register Descriptions
The A/D converter has the following registers.
• A/D data register A (ADDRA)
• A/D data register B (ADDRB)
• A/D data register C (ADDRC)
• A/D data register D (ADDRD)
• A/D control/status register (ADCSR)
• A/D control register (ADCR)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 603 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
16.3.1
A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD)
There are four 16-bit read-only ADDR registers; ADDRA to ADDRD, used to store the results of
A/D conversion. The ADDR registers, which store a conversion result for each channel, are shown
in table 16.2.
The converted 10-bit data is stored in bits 6 to 15. The lower 6 bits are always read as 0.
The data bus between the CPU and the A/D converter is 8 bits wide. The upper byte can be read
directly from the CPU, however the lower byte should be read via a temporary register. The
temporary register contents are transferred from the ADDR when the upper byte data is read.
When reading the ADDR, read the upper byte before the lower byte, or read in word unit.
The initial value of ADDR is H'0000.
Table 16.2 Analog Input Channels and Corresponding ADDR Registers
Analog Input Channel
A/D Data Register to Be Stored the Results of A/D Conversion
AN0
ADDRA
AN1
ADDRB
AN2, AN14
ADDRC
AN3, AN15
ADDRD
16.3.2
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR)
ADCSR controls A/D conversion operations.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
7
ADF
R/(W)* A/D End Flag
A status flag that indicates the end of A/D conversion.
[Setting conditions]
0
Description
•
•
When A/D conversion ends
When A/D conversion ends on all channels specified
in scan mode
[Clearing conditions]
•
•
Page 604 of 846
When 0 is written after reading ADF = 1
When the DMAC or DTC is activated by an ADI
interrupt and ADDR is read when DISEL = 0 and the
transfer counter ≠ 0
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
6
ADIE
0
R/W
A/D Interrupt Enable
A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) request enabled
when 1 is set.
5
ADST
0
R/W
A/D Start
Clearing this bit to 0 stops A/D conversion, and the A/D
converter enters the unit state.
Setting this bit to 1 starts A/D conversion. It can be set to
1 by software, the timer conversion start trigger, and the
A/D external trigger (ADTRG). In single mode, this bit is
cleared to 0 automatically when conversion on the
specified channel is complete. In scan mode, conversion
continues sequentially on the specified channels until
this bit is cleared to 0 by software, a reset, a transition to
standby mode, or module stop mode.
4
SCAN
0
R/W
Scan Mode
Selects single mode or scan mode as the A/D
conversion operating mode.
0: Single mode
1: Scan mode
3
2
1
0
CH3
CH2
CH1
CH0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Channel Select 3 to 0
Select analog input channels.
When SCAN = 0
When SCAN = 1
0000: AN0
0000: AN0
0001: AN1
0001: AN0 to AN1
0010: AN2
0010: AN0 to AN2
0011: AN3
0011: AN0 to AN3
01××: Setting prohibited
01××: Setting prohibited
10××: Setting prohibited
1×××: Setting prohibited
110×: Setting prohibited
1110: AN14
1111: AN15
Legend:
×: Don’t care
Note:
*
The write value should always be 0 to clear this flag.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 605 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
16.3.3
A/D Control Register (ADCR)
The ADCR enables A/D conversion started by an external trigger signal.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
TRGS1
0
R/W
Timer Trigger Select 1 and 0
6
TRGS0
0
R/W
Enables the start of A/D conversion by a trigger signal.
Only set bits TRGS1 and TRGS0 while conversion is
stopped (ADST = 0).
00: A/D conversion start by software
01: A/D conversion start by TPU
10: A/D conversion start by TMR
11: A/D conversion start by external trigger pin
(ADTRG)
5, 4
—
All 1
—
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1 cannot be modified.
3
CKS1
0
R/W
Clock Select 1 and 0
2
CKS0
0
R/W
These bits specify the A/D conversion time. The
conversion time should be changed only when ADST =
0.
00: Conversion time = 530 states (max.)
01: Conversion time = 266 states (max.)
10: Conversion time = 134 states (max.)
11: Conversion time = 68 states (max.)
The conversion time setting should exceed the
conversion time shown in section 24.6, A/D Converter
Characteristics.
1, 0
—
All 1
—
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1 cannot be modified.
Page 606 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
16.4
Section 16 A/D Converter
Interface to Bus Master
ADDRA to ADDRD are 16-bit registers. As the data bus to the bus master is 8 bits wide, the bus
master accesses to the upper byte of the registers directly while to the lower byte of the registers
via the temporary register (TEMP).
Data in ADDR is read in the following way: When the upper-byte data is read, the upper-byte data
will be transferred to the CPU and the lower-byte data will be transferred to TEMP. Then, when
the lower-byte data is read, the lower-byte data will be transferred to the CPU.
When data in ADDR is read, the data should be read from the upper byte and lower byte in the
order. When only the upper-byte data is read, the data is guaranteed. However, when only the
lower-byte data is read, the data is not guaranteed.
Figure 16.2 shows data flow when accessing to ADDR.
Read the upper byte
Module data bus
Bus master
(H'AA)
Bus interface
TEMP
(H'40)
ADDRnH
(H'AA)
ADDRnL
(H'40)
(n = A to D)
Read the lower byte
Module data bus
Bus master
(H'40)
Bus interface
TEMP
(H'40)
ADDRnH
(H'AA)
ADDRnL
(H'40)
(n = A to D)
Figure 16.2 Access to ADDR (When Reading H'AA40)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 607 of 846
Section 16 A/D Converter
16.5
H8S/2215 Group
Operation
The A/D converter operates by successive approximation with 10-bit resolution. It has two
operating modes; single mode and scan mode. When changing the operating mode or analog input
channel, in order to prevent incorrect operation, first clear the bit ADST to 0 in ADCSR. The
ADST bit can be set at the same time as the operating mode or analog input channel is changed.
16.5.1
Single Mode
In single mode, A/D conversion is to be performed only once on the specified single channel. The
operations are as follows.
1. A/D conversion is started when the ADST bit is set to 1, according to software, TPU, or
external trigger input.
2. When A/D conversion is completed, the result is transferred to the corresponding A/D data
register to the channel.
3. On completion of conversion, the ADF bit in ADCSR is set to 1. If the ADIE bit is set to 1 at
this time, an ADI interrupt request is generated.
4. The ADST bit remains set to 1 during A/D conversion. When A/D conversion ends, the ADST
bit is automatically cleared to 0 and the A/D converter enters the wait state.
Page 608 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
Set*
ADIE
ADST
A/D
conversion
starts
Set*
Set*
Clear*
Clear*
ADF
State of channel 0 (AN0)
Idle
State of channel 1 (AN1)
Idle
State of channel 2 (AN2)
Idle
State of channel 3 (AN3)
Idle
A/D conversion 1
Idle
A/D conversion 2
Idle
ADDRA
ADDRB
Read conversion result*
A/D conversion result 1
Read conversion result*
A/D conversion result 2
ADDRC
ADDRD
Note: * Vertical arrows ( ) indicate instructions executed by software.
Figure 16.3 A/D Conversion Timing (Single-Chip Mode, Channel 1 Selected)
16.5.2
Scan Mode
In scan mode, A/D conversion is to be performed sequentially on the specified channels (four
channels maximum). The operations are as follows.
1. When the ADST bit is set to 1 by software, TPU, or external trigger input, A/D conversion
starts on the first channel in the group (AN0 when CH3 and CH2 = 00, AN4 when CH3 and
CH2 = 01, or AN8 when CH3 and CH2 = 10).
2. When A/D conversion for each channel is completed, the result is sequentially transferred to
the A/D data register corresponding to each channel.
3. When conversion of all the selected channels is completed, the ADF flag is set to 1. If the
ADIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an ADI interrupt is requested after A/D conversion ends.
Conversion of the first channel in the group starts again.
4. Steps 2 to 3 are repeated as long as the ADST bit remains set to 1. When the ADST bit is
cleared to 0, A/D conversion stops.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 609 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
Continuous A/D conversion execution
Clear*1
Set*1
ADST
Clear*1
ADF
A/D conversion time
State of channel 0 (AN0)
State of channel 1 (AN1)
State of channel 2 (AN2)
Idle
Idle
A/D conversion 1
Idle
Idle
A/D conversion 2
Idle
Idle
A/D conversion 4
A/D conversion 5 *2
Idle
A/D conversion 3
State of channel 3 (AN3)
Idle
Idle
Transfer
ADDRA
A/D conversion result 1
ADDRB
ADDRC
A/D conversion result 4
A/D conversion result 2
A/D conversion result 3
ADDRD
Notes: 1. Vertical arrows ( ) indicate instructions executed by software.
2. Data currently being converted is ignored.
Figure 16.4 A/D Conversion Timing (Scan Mode, Channels AN0 to AN3 Selected)
16.5.3
Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time
The A/D converter has a built-in sample-and-hold circuit. The A/D converter samples the analog
input when the A/D conversion start delay time (tD) has passed after the ADST bit is set to 1, then
starts conversion. Figure 16.5 shows the A/D conversion timing. Tables 16.3 and 16.4 show the
A/D conversion time.
As indicated in figure 16.5, the A/D conversion time (tCONV) includes tD and the input sampling time
(tSPL). The length of tD varies depending on the timing of the write access to ADCSR. The total
conversion time therefore varies within the ranges indicated in table 16.4.
In scan mode, the values given in table 16.4 apply to the first conversion time. The values given in
table 16.5 apply to the second and subsequent conversions.
Page 610 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
(1)
φ
Address
(2)
Write signal
Input sampling
timing
ADF
tD
tSPL
tCONV
Legend:
(1):
ADCSR write cycle
(2):
ADCSR address
tD:
A/D conversion start delay
tSPL: Input sampling time
tCONV: A/D conversion time
Figure 16.5 A/D Conversion Timing
Table 16.3 A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode)
CKS1 = 0
Item
Symbol
CKS0 = 0
CKS1 = 1
CKS0 = 1
CKS0 = 0
CKS0 = 1
Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max
A/D conversion start
delay
tD
18
—
33
10
—
17
6
—
9
4
—
5
Input sampling time
tSPL
—
127
—
—
63
—
—
31
—
—
15
—
A/D conversion time
tCONV
515
—
—
134
67
—
68
530 259
—
266 131
Note: All values represent the number of states.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 611 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
Table 16.4 A/D Conversion Time (Scan Mode)
CKS1
CKS0
Conversion Time (State)
0
0
512 (Fixed)
1
256 (Fixed)
0
128 (Fixed)
1
64 (Fixed)
1
16.5.4
External Trigger Input Timing
A/D conversion can be externally triggered. When the TRGS0 and TRGS1 bits are set to 11 in
ADCR, external trigger input is enabled at the ADTRG pin. A falling edge at the ADTRG pin sets
the ADST bit to 1 in ADCSR, starting A/D conversion. Other operations, in both single and scan
modes, are the same as when the bit ADST has been set to 1 by software. Figure 16.6 shows the
timing.
φ
ADTRG
Internal trigger signal
ADST
A/D conversion
Figure 16.6 External Trigger Input Timing
Page 612 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
16.6
Section 16 A/D Converter
Interrupts
The A/D converter generates an A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) at the end of A/D conversion.
Setting the ADIE bit to 1 enables ADI interrupt requests while the bit ADF in ADCSR is set to 1
after A/D conversion is completed. The DMAC or DTC can be activated by an ADI interrupt.
Table 16.5 A/D Converter Interrupt Source
Name
Interrupt Source
Interrupt Source Flag
DMAC or DTC Activation
ADI
A/D conversion completed
ADF
Possible
16.7
A/D Conversion Precision Definitions
This LSI's A/D conversion precision definitions are given below.
• Resolution
The number of A/D converter digital output codes
• Quantization error
The deviation inherent in the A/D converter, given by 1/2 LSB (see figure 16.7).
• Offset error
The deviation of the analog input voltage value from the ideal A/D conversion characteristic
when the digital output changes from the minimum voltage value B'0000000000 (H'000) to
B'0000000001 (H'001) (see figure 16.8).
• Full-scale error
The deviation of the analog input voltage value from the ideal A/D conversion characteristic
when the digital output changes from B'1111111110 (H'3FE) to B'1111111111 (H'3FF) (see
figure 16.8).
• Nonlinearity error
The error with respect to the ideal A/D conversion characteristic between zero voltage and fullscale voltage. Does not include offset error, full-scale error, or quantization error (see figure
16.8).
• Absolute precision
The deviation between the digital value and the analog input value. Includes offset error, fullscale error, quantization error, and nonlinearity error.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 613 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
Digital output
Ideal A/D conversion
characteristic
111
110
101
100
011
010
Quantization error
001
000
1
2
1024 1024
1022 1023 FS
1024 1024
Analog
input voltage
Figure 16.7 A/D Conversion Precision Definitions (1)
Full-scale error
Digital output
Ideal A/D conversion
characteristic
Nonlinearity
error
Actual A/D conversion
characteristic
Offset error
FS
Analog
input voltage
Figure 16.8 A/D Conversion Precision Definitions (2)
Page 614 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
16.8
Usage Notes
16.8.1
Permissible Signal Source Impedance
This LSI's analog input is designed such that conversion precision is guaranteed for an input signal
for which the signal source impedance is 5 kΩ or less. This specification is provided to enable the
A/D converter's sample-and-hold circuit input capacitance to be charged within the sampling time;
if the sensor output impedance exceeds 5 kΩ, charging may be insufficient and it may not be
possible to guarantee A/D conversion precision. However, for A/D conversion in single mode with
a large capacitance provided externally, the input load will essentially comprise only the internal
input resistance of 10 kΩ, and the signal source impedance is ignored. However, as a low-pass
filter effect is obtained in this case, it may not be possible to follow an analog signal with a large
differential coefficient (e.g., 5 mV/Ωs or greater) (see figure 16.9). When converting a high-speed
analog signal, a low-impedance buffer should be inserted.
16.8.2
Influences on Absolute Precision
Adding capacitance results in coupling with GND, and therefore noise in GND may adversely
affect absolute precision. Be sure to make the connection to an electrically stable GND such as
AVSS.
Care is also required to insure that filter circuits do not communicate with digital signals on the
mounting board (i.e., acting as antennas).
This LSI
Sensor output
impedance
to 5 kΩ
A/D converter
equivalent circuit
10 kΩ
Sensor input
Low-pass
filter C
to 0.1 μF
Cin =
15 pF
20 pF
Figure 16.9 Example of Analog Input Circuit
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 615 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
16.8.3
Range of Analog Power Supply and Other Pin Settings
If the conditions below are not met, the reliability of the device may be adversely affected.
• Analog input voltage range
The voltage applied to analog input pin ANn during A/D conversion should be in the range
AVSS ≤ ANn ≤ Vref.
• Relationship between AVcc, AVss and Vcc, Vss
Set AVss = Vss as the relationship between AVcc, AVss and Vcc, Vss. If the A/D converter is
not used, the AVcc and AVss pins must not be left open. In addition, AN0 and AN1 can be
used only when Vcc = AVcc.
• Vref input range
The analog reference voltage input at the Vref pin set is the range Vref ≤ AVcc.
16.8.4
Notes on Board Design
In board design, digital circuitry and analog circuitry should be as mutually isolated as possible,
and layout in which digital circuit signal lines and analog circuit signal lines cross or are in close
proximity should be avoided as far as possible. Failure to do so may result in incorrect operation
of the analog circuitry due to inductance, adversely affecting A/D conversion values.
Also, digital circuitry must be isolated from the analog input signals (AN0 to AN3 or AN14 to
AN15), analog reference voltage pin (Vref), and analog power supply (AVcc) by the analog
ground (AVss). Also, the analog ground (AVss) should be connected at one point to a stable
digital ground (Vss) on the board.
16.8.5
Notes on Noise Countermeasures
A protection circuit should be connected in order to prevent damage due to abnormal voltage, such
as an excessive surge at the analog input pins (AN0 to AN3 or AN14 to AN15) and analog
reference voltage pin (Vref), between AVcc and AVss, as shown in figure 16.10. Also, the bypass
capacitors connected to AVcc and the filter capacitor connected to analog input pins (AN0 to AN3
or AN14 to AN15) must be connected to AVss.
If a filter capacitor is connected, the input currents at the analog input pins (AN0 to AN3 or AN14
to AN15) are averaged, and so an error may arise. Also, when A/D conversion is performed
frequently, as in scan mode, if the current charged and discharged by the capacitance of the
sample-and-hold circuit in the A/D converter exceeds the current input via the input impedance
(Rin), an error will arise in the analog input pin voltage. Careful consideration is therefore
required when deciding circuit constants.
Page 616 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 16 A/D Converter
AVCC
Vref
*1
100 Ω
Rin*2
*1
AN0 to AN11
0.1 μF
AVSS
Notes: Values are reference values.
1.
10 μF
0.01 μF
2. Rin: Input impedance
Figure 16.10 Example of Analog Input Protection Circuit
Table 16.6 Analog Pin Specifications
Item
Min
Max
Unit
Analog input capacitance
—
20
pF
—
5*
kΩ
Permissible signal source impedance
Note:
*
Vcc = 2.7 to 3.6 V
10 kΩ
ANn
To A/D converter
20 pF
Note: Values are reference values.
Figure 16.11 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 617 of 846
Section 16 A/D Converter
16.8.6
H8S/2215 Group
Module Stop Mode Setting
Operation of the A/D converter can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register.
The initial setting is for operation of the A/D converter to be halted. Register access is enabled by
clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 22, Power-Down Modes.
Page 618 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 17 D/A Converter
Section 17 D/A Converter
This LSI includes a D/A converter with 2 channels.
17.1
Features
D/A converter features are listed below.
• 8-bit resolution
• Two output channels
• Maximum conversion time of 10 µs (with 20 pF load)
• Output voltage of 0 V to Vref
• D/A output hold function in software standby mode
• Module stop mode can be set
Figure 17.1 shows a block diagram of the D/A converter.
Internal data bus
Bus interface
Module data bus
Vref
AVCC
8 bit D/A
DA1
DA0
D
A
D
R
0
D
A
D
R
1
D
A
C
R
AVSS
Control cycle
Legend:
DACR: D/A control register
DADR0: D/A data register 0
DADR1: D/A data register 1
Figure 17.1 Block Diagram of D/A Converter
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 619 of 846
DAC0004A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 17 D/A Converter
17.2
Input/Output Pins
Table 17.1 summarizes the input and output pins of the D/A converter.
Table 17.1 Pin Configuration
Pin Name
Symbol
I/O
Function
Analog power pin
AVCC
Input
Analog power
Analog ground pin
AVSS
Input
Analog ground and reference voltage
Analog output pin 0
DA0
Output
Channel 0 analog output
Analog output pin 1
DA1
Output
Channel 1 analog output
Reference voltage pin
Vref
Input
Analog reference voltage
17.3
Register Description
The D/A converter has the following registers.
• D/A data register (DADR)
• D/A control register (DACR)
17.3.1
D/A Data Register (DADR)
DADR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that store data for conversion. Whenever output is
enabled, the values in DADR are converted and output from the analog output pins. This register
is initialized to H'00 on reset or in hardware standby mode.
Page 620 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
17.3.2
Section 17 D/A Converter
D/A Control Register (DACR)
DACR controls the operation of the D/A converter.
DACR01
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
DAOE1
0
R/W
D/A Output Enable 1
6
DAOE0
0
R/W
D/A Output Enable 0
5
DAE
0
R/W
D/A Enable
Control the D/A conversion and analog output.
00×: Channel 0 and 1 D/A conversions disabled
010: Channel 0 D/A conversion enabled
Channel 1 D/A conversion disabled
011: Channel 0 and 1 D/A conversions enabled
100: Channel 0 D/A conversion disabled
Channel 1 D/A conversion enabled
101: Channel 0 and 1 D/A conversions enabled
11×: Channel 0 and 1 D/A conversions enabled
Legend: ×: Don’t care
If this LSI enters software standby mode when D/A
conversion is enabled, the D/A output is held and the
analog power current is the same as during D/A
conversion. When it is necessary to reduce the analog
power current in software standby mode, clear the
DAOE0, DAOE1, and DAE bits to 0 to disable D/A
output.
4 to 0 —
All 1
—
Reserved
These bits are always read as 1 and cannot be modified.
17.4
Operation
D/A conversion takes place constantly as long as the D/A converter is enabled by the DACR.
When DADR_0 and DADR_1 are overwritten, the new data is converted immediately. The
conversion result is output by setting the DAOE0 and DAOE1 bits to 1.
The operation example concerns D/A conversion on channel 0. Figure 17.2 shows the timing of
this operation.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 621 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 17 D/A Converter
[1] Write the conversion data to DADR_0.
[2] Set the DAOE0 bit in DACR01 to 1. D/A conversion is started. The conversion result is output
after the conversion time tDCONV has elapsed. The output value is expressed by the following
formula:
DADR contents
——————— × Vref
256
The conversion results are output continuously until DADR_0 is written to again or the
DAOE0 bit is cleared to 0.
[3] If DADR_0 is written to again, the conversion is immediately started. The conversion result is
output after the conversion time tDCONV has elapsed.
[4] If the DAOE0 bit is cleared to 0, analog output is disabled.
DADR0
write cycle
DADR0
write cycle
DACR
write cycle
DACR
write cycle
φ
Address
DADR_0
Conversion data 1
Conversion data 2
DAOE0
DA0
Conversion
result 2
Conversion
result 1
High-impedance state
tDCONV
tDCONV
Legend:
tDCONV: D/A conversion time
Figure 17.2 Example of D/A Converter Operation
Page 622 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
17.5
Usage Note
17.5.1
Module Stop Mode Setting
Section 17 D/A Converter
Operation of the D/A converter can be disabled or enabled using the module stop control register.
The initial setting is for operation of the D/A converter to be halted. Register access is enabled by
clearing module stop mode. For details, refer to section 22, Power-Down Modes.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 623 of 846
Section 17 D/A Converter
Page 624 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 18 RAM
Section 18 RAM
This LSI has on-chip high-speed static RAM. The RAM is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data
bus, enabling one-state access by the CPU to both byte data and word data. This makes it possible
to perform fast word data transfer.
The on-chip RAM can be enabled or disabled by means of the RAM enable bit (RAME) in the
system control register (SYSCR). For details on SYSCR, refer to section 3.2.2, System Control
Register (SYSCR).
Product Class
H8S/2215
Group
ROM Type
HD64F2215R Flash memory Version
RAM Size
RAM Address
20 kbytes
H'FFA000 to H'FFEFBF
H'FFFFC0 to H'FFFFFF
HD64F2215RU
HD64F2215T
HD64F2215TU
HD64F2215CU
HD64F2215
16 kbytes
H'FFFFC0 to H'FFFFFF
HD64F2215U
HD6432215B
HD6432215C
H'FFB000 to H'FFEFBF
Masked ROM Version
8 kbytes
H'FFD000 to H'FFEFBF
H'FFFFC0 to H'FFFFFF
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 625 of 846
Section 18 RAM
Page 626 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
The features of the on-chip flash memory are summarized below. The block diagram of the flash
memory is shown in figure 19.1.
19.1
•
Features
Size
Product Category
H8S/2215 Group
HD64F2215, HD64F2215U,
HD64F2215R, HD64F2215RU,
HD64F2215T, HD64F2215TU,
HD64F2215CU
ROM Size
ROM Addresses
256 kbytes
H'000000 to H'03FFFF
(Modes 6 and 7)
• Programming/erase methods
⎯ The flash memory is programmed 128 bytes at a time. Erase is performed in single-block
units. The flash memory is configured as follows: four kbytes × eight blocks, 32 kbytes × 1
block, 64 kbytes × 3 and blocks. To erase the entire flash memory, each block must be
erased in turn.
• Reprogramming capability
⎯ Flash memory can be reprogrammed a minimum of 100 times.
• Two flash memory operating modes
⎯ Boot mode (SCI boot mode: HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, HD64F2215T. USB boot mode:
HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU, HD64F2215CU)
⎯ User program mode
On-board programming/erasing can be done in boot mode in which the boot program built
into the chip is started for erase or programming of the entire flash memory. In normal user
program mode, individual blocks can be erased or programmed.
• Automatic bit rate adjustment (SCI boot mode)
⎯ With data transfer in SCI boot mode, this LSI’s bit rate can be automatically adjusted to
match the transfer bit rate of the host.
• Programming/erasing protection
⎯ Sets hardware protection, software protection, and error protection against flash memory
programming/erasing.
• Programmer mode
⎯ Flash memory can be programmed/erased in programmer mode, using a PROM
programmer, as well as in on-board programming mode.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 627 of 846
ROMF252A_010020020100
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
• Flash memory emulation in RAM
⎯ Flash memory programming can be emulated in real time by overlapping a part of RAM
onto flash memory.
Internal data bus (upper 8 bits)
Module bus
Internal data bus (lower 8 bits)
FLMCR1
FLMCR2
EBR1
Bus interface/controller
Operating
mode
EBR2
FWE pin
Mode pins
(MD2 to MD0)
PF3, PF0, P16, P14
RAMER
H'000000
H'000002
H'000001
H'000003
Flash memory
(256 kbytes)
H'03FFFE
Legend:
FLMCR1:
FLMCR2:
EBR1:
EBR2:
RAMER:
H'03FFFF
Flash memory control register 1
Flash memory control register 2
Erase block register 1
Erase block register 2
RAM emulation register
Figure 19.1 Block Diagram of Flash Memory
Page 628 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.2
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Mode Transitions
When the mode pins and the FWE pin are set in the reset state and a reset-start is executed, this
LSI enters an operating mode as shown in figure 19.2. In user mode, flash memory can be read but
not programmed or erased. The boot and user program modes are provided as modes to write and
erase the flash memory.
The differences between boot mode and user program mode are shown in table 19.1. Boot mode
and user program mode operations are shown in figures 19.3 and 19.4, respectively.
MD2 to 0 = 11x,
FWE = 0
*1
User mode
(on-chip ROM
enabled)
FWE = 1
Reset state
RES = 0
MD2 to 0 = 11x,
FWE = 1
FWE = 0
RES = 0
RES = 0
MD2 to 0 = 01x
or 10x*3
FWE = 1
*2
RES = 0
Programmer
mode
*1
User
program mode
SCI,USB
Boot mode
On-board programming mode
Notes: Only make a transition between user mode and user program mode when the CPU is
not accessing the flash memory.
1. RAM emulation possible
2. MD2 to MD0 = 000, PF3, PF0, P16, P14 = 1100
3. 10x applies only to the HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU
with 24-MHz system clock.
Figure 19.2 Flash Memory State Transitions
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 629 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Table 19.1 Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode
SCI,USB
Boot Mode
User Program Mode
User Mode
Total erase
Yes
Yes
No
Block erase
No
Yes
No
Programming control
program*
Program/program-verify Erase/erase-verify
—
Program/program-verify
Emulation
Note:
*
To be provided by the user, in accordance with the recommended algorithm.
Page 630 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
1. Initial state
The old program version or data remains written
in the flash memory. The user should prepare the
programming control program and new
application program beforehand in the host.
2. Programming control program transfer
When boot mode is entered, the boot program in
this LSI (originally incorporated in the chip) is
started and the programming control program in
the host is transferred to RAM via SCI or USB
communication. The boot program required for
flash memory erasing is automatically transferred
to the RAM boot program area.
Host
Host
Programming control
program
New application
program
New application
program
This LSI
This LSI
SCI or USB
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
SCI or USB
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
Boot program area
Application program
(old version)
Application program
(old version)
3. Flash memory initialization
The erase program in the boot program area (in
RAM) is executed, and the flash memory is
initialized (to H'FF). In boot mode, total flash
memory erasure is performed, without regard to
blocks.
Programming control
program
4. Writing new application program
The programming control program transferred
from the host to RAM is executed, and the new
application program in the host is written into the
flash memory.
Host
Host
New application
program
This LSI
Boot program
Flash memory
This LSI
SCI or USB
RAM
Boot program
Flash memory
Boot program area
Flash memory
preprogramming
erase
Programming control
program
SCI or USB
RAM
Boot program area
New application
program
Programming control
program
Program execution state
Figure 19.3 Boot Mode (Sample)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 631 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
1. Initial state
The FWE assessment program that confirms that
user program mode has been entered, and the
program that will transfer the programming/erase
control program from flash memory to on-chip
RAM should be written into the flash memory by
the user beforehand. The programming/erase
control program should be prepared in the host
or in the flash memory.
2. Programming/erase control program transfer
When user program mode is entered, user
software confirms this fact, executes transfer
program in the flash memory, and transfers the
programming/erase control program to RAM.
Host
Host
Programming/
erase control program
New application
program
New application
program
This LSI
This LSI
SCI or USB
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
SCI or USB
Boot program
RAM
Flash memory
FWE assessment
program
FWE assessment
program
Transfer program
Transfer program
Programming/
erase control program
Application program
(old version)
Application program
(old version)
3. Flash memory initialization
The programming/erase program in RAM is
executed, and the flash memory is initialized (to
H'FF). Erasing can be performed in block units,
but not in byte units.
4. Writing new application program
Next, the new application program in the host is
written into the erased flash memory blocks. Do
not write to unerased blocks.
Host
Host
New application
program
This LSI
Boot program
Flash memory
This LSI
SCI or USB
RAM
FWE assessment
program
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
FWE assessment
program
Transfer program
Transfer program
Programming/
erase control program
Flash memory
erase
SCI or USB
Programming/
erase control program
New application
program
Program execution state
Figure 19.4 User Program Mode (Sample)
Page 632 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.3
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Block Configuration
Figure 19.5 shows the block configuration of 256-kbyte flash memory. The thick lines indicate
erasing units, the narrow lines indicate programming units, and the values are addresses. The flash
memory is divided into 4 kbytes (eight blocks), 32 kbytes (one block), and 64 kbytes (three
blocks). Erasing is performed in these divided units. Programming is performed in 128-byte units
starting from an address whose lower eight bits are H'00 or H'80.
EB0
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'000000
H'000001
H'000002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'001001
H'001002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'002001
H'002002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'003001
H'003002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'004001
H'004002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'005001
H'005002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'006001
H'006002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'007001
H'007002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'008001
H'008002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'010001
H'010002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'020001
H'020002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'030001
H'030002
Programming unit: 128 bytes
H'00007F
H'000080
H'000FFF
EB1
H'001000
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'001080
EB2
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'002000
EB3
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'003000
EB4
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'004000
H'00107F
H'001FFF
H'00207F
H'002080
H'002FFF
H'00307F
H'003080
H'003FFF
H'00407F
H'004080
H'004FFF
EB5
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'005000
EB6
H'006000
H'00507F
H'005080
H'005FFF
Erase unit
4 kbyte
EB7
Erase unit
4 kbyte
H'00607F
H'006080
H'006FFF
H'007000
H'00707F
H'007080
H'007FFF
EB8
Erase unit
32 kbyte
H'008000
EB9
Erase unit
64 kbyte
H'010000
EB10
H'020000
H'00807F
H'008080
H'00FFFF
H'01007F
H'010080
H'01FFFF
Erase unit
64 kbyte
EB11
Erase unit
64 kbyte
H'02007F
H'020080
H'02FFFF
H'030000
H'03007F
H'030080
H'03FFFF
Figure 19.5 Flash Memory Block Configuration
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 633 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
19.4
Input/Output Pins
The flash memory is controlled by means of the pins shown in table 19.2.
Table 19.2 Pin Configuration
Pin Name
I/O
Function
RES
Input
Reset
FWE
Input
Flash program/erase protection by hardware
MD2,MD1,MD0
Input
Sets this LSI’s operating mode
PF3,PF0,P16,
P14
Input
Sets this LSI’s operating mode in
programmer mode
TxD2
Output
Serial transmit data output
RxD2
Input
Serial receive data input
USB+,USB-
Input/Output
USB data output
VBUS
Input
USB cable connection/disconnection detection
UBPM
Input
USB bus power mode/self power mode setting
USPND
Output
USB suspend output
P36 (PUPD+)
Output
D+ pull-up control
19.5
HD64F2215
and
HD64F2215U
HD64F2215
HD64F2215U
Register Descriptions
The flash memory has the following registers. For details on register addresses and register states
during each processing, refer to section 23, List of Registers.
• Flash memory control register 1 (FLMCR1)
• Flash memory control register 2 (FLMCR2)
• Erase block register 1 (EBR1)
• Erase block register 2 (EBR2)
• RAM emulation register (RAMER)
• Serial control register X (SCRX)
The above registers are not implemented in the mask ROM version, so attempting to read from
them will return undefined values. It is not possible to write to them.
Page 634 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.5.1
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1)
FLMCR1 is a register that makes the flash memory transit to program mode, program-verify
mode, erase mode, or erase-verify mode. For details on register setting, refer to section 19.8, Flash
Memory Programming/Erasing.
Bit
7
Bit Name Initial Value
FWE
—*
R/W
Description
R
Flash Write Enable
Reflects the input level at the FWE pin. It is set to 1
when a low level is input to the FWE pin, and cleared to
0 when a high level is input.
6
SWE1
0
R/W
Software Write Enable
When this bit is set to 1, flash memory
programming/erasing is enabled. When this bit is cleared
to 0, other FLMCR1 register bits and all EBR1, EBR2
bits cannot be set.
[Setting condition]
•
5
ESU1
0
R/W
When FWE = 1
Erase Setup
When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory transits to the
erase setup state. When it is cleared to 0, the erase
setup state is cancelled. Set this bit to 1 before setting
the E1 bit in FLMCR1.
[Setting condition]
•
4
PSU1
0
R/W
When FWE = 1 and SWE1 = 1
Program Setup
When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory transits to the
program setup state. When it is cleared to 0, the
program setup state is cancelled. Set this bit to 1 before
setting the P1 bit in FLMCR1.
[Setting condition]
•
3
EV1
0
R/W
When FWE = 1 and SWE1 = 1
Erase-Verify
When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory transits to
erase-verify mode. When it is cleared to 0, erase-verify
mode is cancelled.
[Setting condition]
•
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
When FWE = 1 and SWE1 = 1
Page 635 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
2
PV1
R/W
Program-Verify
0
When this bit is set to 1, the flash memory transits to
program-verify mode. When it is cleared to 0, programverify mode is cancelled.
[Setting condition]
•
1
E1
0
R/W
When FWE = 1 and SWE1 = 1
Erase
When this bit is set to 1 while the SWE1 and ESU1 bits
are 1, the flash memory transits to erase mode. When it
is cleared to 0, erase mode is cancelled.
[Setting condition]
•
0
P1
0
R/W
When FWE = 1, SWE1 = 1, and ESU1 = 1
Program
When this bit is set to 1 while the SWE1 and PSU1 bits
are 1, the flash memory transits to program mode. When
it is cleared to 0, program mode is cancelled.
[Setting condition]
•
Note:
*
19.5.2
When FWE = 1, SWE1 = 1, and PSU1 = 1
Set according to the FWE pin state.
Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2)
FLMCR2 is a register that displays the state of flash memory programming/erasing. FLMCR2 is a
read-only register, and should not be written to.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
FLER
R
Indicates that an error has occurred during an operation
on flash memory (programming or erasing). When FLER
is set to 1, flash memory goes to the error-protection
state.
0
See section 19.9.3 Error Protection, for details.
6 to 0 —
All 0
—
Reserved
These bits always read as 0.
Page 636 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.5.3
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1)
EBR1 specifies the flash memory erase area block. EBR1 is initialized to H'00 when the SWE bit
in FLMCR is 0. Do not set more than one bit at a time, as this will cause all the bits in EBR1 and
EBR2 to be automatically cleared to 0.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
R/W
Description
7
EB7
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB7 (H'007000 to
H'007FFF) are to be erased.
6
EB6
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB6 (H'006000 to
H'006FFF) are to be erased.
5
EB5
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB5 (H'005000 to
H'005FFF) are to be erased.
4
EB4
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB4 (H'004000 to
H'004FFF) are to be erased.
3
EB3
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB3 (H'003000 to
H'003FFF) is to be erased.
2
EB2
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB2 (H'002000 to
H'002FFF) is to be erased.
1
EB1
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB1 (H'001000 to
H'001FFF) is to be erased.
0
EB0
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 4 kbytes of EB0 (H'000000 to
H'000FFF) is to be erased.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 637 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
19.5.4
Erase Block Register 2 (EBR2)
EBR2 specifies the flash memory erase area block. EBR2 is initialized to H'00 when the SWE bit
in FLMCR1 is 0. Do not set more than one bit at a time, as this will cause all the bits in EBR1 and
EBR2 to be automatically cleared to 0.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
7 to 4 —
All 0
R/W
R/W
Description
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
3
EB11
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 64 kbytes of EB11 (H'030000 to
H'03FFFF) are to be erased.
2
EB10
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 64 kbytes of EB10 (H'020000 to
H'02FFFF) are to be erased.
1
EB9
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 64 kbytes of EB9 (H'010000 to
H'01FFFF) are to be erased.
0
EB8
0
R/W
When this bit is set to 1, 32 kbytes of EB8 (H'008000 to
H'0'0FFFF) are to be erased.
Page 638 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.5.5
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
RAM Emulation Register (RAMER)
RAMER specifies the area of flash memory to be overlapped with part of RAM when emulating
real-time flash memory programming. RAMER settings should be made in user mode or user
program mode. To ensure correct operation of the emulation function, the ROM for which RAM
emulation is performed should not be accessed immediately after this register has been modified.
Normal execution of an access immediately after register modification is not guaranteed. For
details, refer to section 19.7, Flash Memory Emulation in RAM.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
7 to 5 —
All 0
R/W
—
Description
Reserved
These bits always read as 0.
4
—
0
R/W
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
3
RAMS
0
R/W
RAM Select
Specifies selection or non-selection of flash memory
emulation in RAM. When RAMS = 1, the flash memory is
overlapped with part of RAM, and all flash memory block
are program/erase-protected.
2
RAM2
0
R/W
Flash Memory Area Selection
1
RAM1
0
R/W
0
RAM0
0
R/W
When the RAMS bit is set to 1, selects one of the
following flash memory areas to overlap the RAM area.
The areas correspond with 4-kbyte erase blocks.
000: H'000000 to H'000FFF (EB0)
001: H'001000 to H'001FFF (EB1)
010: H'002000 to H'002FFF (EB2)
011: H'003000 to H'003FFF (EB3)
100: H'004000 to H'004FFF (EB4)
101: H'005000 to H'005FFF (EB5)
110: H'006000 to H'006FFF (EB6)
111: H'007000 to H'007FFF (EB7)
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 639 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
19.5.6
Serial Control Register X (SCRX)
SCRX performs register access control.
Bit
Bit Name Initial Value
7 to 4 —
All 0
R/W
Description
R/W
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
3
FLSHE
0
R/W
Flash Memory Control Register Enable
Controls CPU access to the flash memory control
registers (FLMCR1, FLMCR2, EBR1, and EBR2).
Setting the FLSHE bit to 1 enables read/write access to
the flash memory control registers. If FLSHE is cleared
to 0, the flash memory control registers are deselected.
In this case, the flash memory control register contents
are retained.
0: Flash control registers deselected in area
H'FFFFA8 to H'FFFFAC
1: Flash control registers selected in area H'FFFFA8
to H'FFFFAC
2 to 0 —
All 0
R/W
Reserved
The write value should always be 0.
Page 640 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.6
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
On-Board Programming Modes
When pins are set to on-board programming mode and a reset-start is executed, a transition is
made to the on-board programming state in which program/erase/verify operations can be
performed on the on-chip flash memory. There are two on-board programming modes: boot mode
and user program mode. The pin settings for transition to each of these modes are shown in table
19.3. For a diagram of the transitions to the various flash memory modes, see figure 19.2.
Table 19.3 Setting On-Board Programming Modes
Mode
FWE
MD2
MD1
MD0
SCI boot mode
(HD64F2215,
HD64F2215R,
HD64F2215T)
Advanced: On-chip ROM extended
mode
1
0
1
0
Advanced: Single-chip mode
1
0
1
1
USB boot mode
(HD64F2215U,
HD64F2215RU,
HD64F2215TU,
1
HD64F2215CU)*
Advanced: On-chip ROM extended
mode
1
0
1
0
Advanced: Single-chip mode
1
0
1
1
USB boot mode
(HD64F2215RU,
HD64F2215TU,
2
HD64F2215CU)*
Advanced: On-chip ROM extended
mode
1
1
0
0
Advanced: Single-chip mode
1
1
0
1
User program mode
Advanced: On-chip ROM extended
mode
(MCU operating mode 6)
1
1
1
0
Advanced: Single-chip mode
(MCU operating mode 7)
1
1
1
1
Notes: 1. When the system clock is 16 MHz.
2. When the system clock is 24 MHz.
19.6.1
SCI Boot Mode (HD64F2215, HD64F2215R, and HD64F2215T)
When a reset-start is executed after the LSI’s pins have been set to boot mode, the boot program
built into the LSI is started and the programming control program prepared in the host is serially
transmitted to the LSI via the SCI. In the LSI, the programming control program received via the
SCI is written into the programming control program area in on-chip RAM. After the transfer is
completed, control branches to the start address of the programming control program area and the
programming control program execution state is entered (flash memory programming is
performed). The system configuration in SCI boot mode is shown in figure 19.6.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 641 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
H8S/2215 Group
1
01×
Host
Write data reception
Verify data transmission
FWE*
MD2 to 0*
RxD2
SCI_2
TxD2
Flash memory
On-chip RAM
Legend: ×: Don’t care
Note: * FWE pin and mode pin input must satisfy the mode programming setup time (tMDS = 200 ns)
when a reset is released.
Figure 19.6 System Configuration in SCI Boot Mode
Table 19.4 shows the boot mode operations between reset end and branching to the programming
control program.
1. When boot mode is used, the flash memory programming control program must be prepared in
the host beforehand. Prepare a programming control program in accordance with the
description in section 19.8, Flash Memory Programming/Erasing. In boot mode, if any data has
been programmed into the flash memory (if all data is not 1), all flash memory blocks are
erased. Boot mode is for use in enforced exit when user program mode is unavailable, such as
the first time on-board programming is performed, or if the program activated in user program
mode is accidentally erased.
2. The SCI_2 should be set to asynchronous mode, and the transfer format as follows: 8-bit data,
1 stop bit, and no parity.
3. When the boot program is initiated, the chip measures the low-level period of asynchronous
SCI communication data (H'00) transmitted continuously from the host. The chip then
calculates the bit rate of transmission from the host, and adjusts the SCI_2 bit rate to match
that of the host. The reset should end with the RxD pin high. The RxD and TxD pins should be
pulled up on the board if necessary. After the reset ends, it takes approximately 100 states
before the chip is ready to measure the low-level period.
4. After matching the bit rates, the chip transmits one H'00 byte to the host to indicate the end of
bit rate adjustment. The host should confirm that this adjustment end indication (H'00) has
been received normally, and transmit one H'55 byte to the chip. If reception could not be
Page 642 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
performed normally, initiate boot mode again by a reset. Depending on the host’s transfer bit
rate and system clock frequency of this LSI, there will be a discrepancy between the bit rates
of the host and the chip. To operate the SCI properly, set the host’s transfer bit rate and system
clock frequency of this LSI within the ranges listed in table 19.5.
5. In boot mode, a part of the on-chip RAM area (4 kbytes) is used by the boot program.
Addresses H'FFE000 to H'FFEFBF is the area to which the programming control program is
transferred from the host. The boot program area cannot be used until the execution state in
boot mode switches to the programming control program.
6. Before branching to the programming control program, the chip terminates transfer operations
by the SCI_2 (by clearing the RE and TE bits in SCR to 0), but the adjusted bit rate value
remains set in BRR. Therefore, the programming control program can still use it for transfer of
write data or verify data with the host. The TxD pin is high. The contents of the CPU general
registers are undefined immediately after branching to the programming control program.
These registers must be initialized at the beginning of the programming control program, since
the stack pointer (SP), in particular, is used implicitly in subroutine calls, etc.
7. Boot mode can be cleared by a reset. End the reset* after driving the reset pin low, waiting at
least 20 states, and then setting the FWE pin and the mode (MD) pins. Boot mode is also
cleared when a WDT overflow occurs.
8. Do not change the MD pin input levels in boot mode. If the mode pin input levels are changed
(for example, from low to high) during a reset, the state of ports with multiplexed address
functions and bus control output pins (AS, RD, WR) will change according to the change in
the microcomputer’s operating mode . Therefore, care must be taken to make pin settings to
prevent these pins from becoming output signal pins during a reset, or to prevent collision with
signals outside the microcomputer.
9. All interrupts are disabled during programming or erasing of the flash memory.
Note: * Mode pin and FWE pin input must satisfy the mode programming setup time (tMDS =
200 ns) with respect to the reset release timing.
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
Page 643 of 846
H8S/2215 Group
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
Table 19.4 SCI Boot Mode Operation
Item
Host Operation
LSI Operation
Branches to boot program at resetstart.
Bit rate adjustment
Continuously transmits data H'00
at specified bit rate.
Measures low-level period of
receive data H'00.
Calculates bit rate and sets it in
BRR of SCI_2.
Transmits data H'55 when data
H'00 is received error-free.
Transmits data H'00 to host as
adjustment end indication.
Transmits data H'AA to host when
data H'55 is received.
Transmits number of
Transmits number of bytes (N) of Echobacks the 2-byte data received
bytes (N) of programming programming control program to
as verification data.
control program
be transferred as 2-byte data (loworder byte following high-order
byte)
Transmits 1-byte of
programming control
program (repeated for N
times)
Transmits 1-byte of programming
control program
Echobacks received data to host
and also transfers it to RAM
Flash memory erase
Checks flash memory data, erases
all flash memory blocks in case of
written data existing, and transmits
data H'AA to host. (If erase could
not be done, transmits data H'FF to
host and aborts operation.)
Programming control
program execution
Branches to programming control
program transferred to on-chip
RAM and starts execution.
Table 19.5 System Clock Frequencies for Which Automatic Adjustment of LSI Bit Rate Is
Possible
Host Bit Rate
System Clock Frequency Range of LSI
19,200 bps
HD64F2215: 13 to 16 MHz
9,600 bps
HD64F2215R: 13 to 24 MHz
4,800 bps
HD64F2215T: 16 MHz and 24 MHz
Page 644 of 846
REJ09B0140-0900 Rev. 9.00
Sep 16, 2010
H8S/2215 Group
19.6.2
Section 19 Flash Memory (F-ZTAT Version)
USB Boot Mode (HD64F2215U, HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and
HD64F2215CU)
• Features
⎯ Selection of bus-powered mode or self-powered mode
⎯ HD64F2215U: Supports only 16-MHz system clock, with USB operating clock generation
by means of PLL3 multiplication
HD64F2215RU, HD64F2215TU and HD64F2215CU: Supports either 16-MHz or 24-MHz
system clock, with USB operating clock generation by means of PLL2 or PLL3
multiplication, respectively.
⎯ 
Similar pages